THE VOYAGES AND ADVENTURES, OF Fernand Mendez Pinto, A Portugal: During his TRAVELS for the space of one and twenty years in The Kingdoms of Ethiopia, China, Tartary, Cauchinchina, Calaminham, Siam, Pegu, Japan, and a great part of the East-Indiaes. With a Relation and Description of most of the Places thereof; their Religion, Laws, Riches, Customs, and Government in time of Peace and War. Where he five times suffered Shipwreck, was sixteen times sold, and thirteen times made a Slave. Written Originally by himself in the Portugal Tongue, and Dedicated to the Majesty of Philip King of Spain. Done into English by H. C. Gent. LONDON, Printed by I. Macock, for Henry Cripps, and Lodowick Lloyd, and are to be sold at their shop in Pope's head Alley near Lumbar-street. 1653. TO THE Right Noble Lord, and worthy of all Honour, William, Earl of Strafford, Viscount Wentworth, Baron Wentworth of Wentworth, Woodhouse, Newmarsh, Oversley, and Raby. My Lord, PVrchas, a Writer of good credit here in England, giveth this testimony of my Author, that no man before him, to his knowledge, hath spoken so much, and so truly, of those Oriental parts of the World, which are so little known to us, as he hath done: And that too, not upon hearsay, and report, but for the most part as an ocular Witness, and personal Actor, of, and in, all that he hath related, which is so full of Variety, and strange Occurrences, that, as another Writer affirms, the like will hardly be met withal elsewhere: So that the most curious Wits, which delight in reading of rare Books, will, I believe, find all the satisfaction they can desire in this same of his; where, without so much as stirring out of their Studies, or running the danger of Shipwreck, they may traverse the Seas, view the goodliest Provinces of the World, entertain themselves with stupendious and unheard-of things, consider in the manner of those people's living, whom we term Barbarians, their Laws, their Riches, their Government in time of Peace and War; and, in a word, represent unto themselves, as in a picture, all that is most exquisite, and of greatest marvel, in the extent of Europe, Africa, and Asia. These, together with many other remarkable matters, are contained in this Work, which I have taken the presumption to present unto your Honour, being invited thereunto by the example of two Translators of it into the Spanish and French Tongues, whereof the one dedicated it to the Archbishop of Toledo in Spain, and the other to the Cardinal Richelieu of France, both of them, the most eminent persons, of their time, in those Kingdoms: And with whom your Honour may justly be ranked, especially in respect of the Nobility of your Birth, as well as for the great Hope, which your many present Virtues, and Abilities, do give unto the World, of your future Worth, and Estimation. Be pleased then, my Lord, to receive it favourably, as a tender of the great desire I have to appear in all occasions, Your Honour's most humble, and devoted Servant, HENRY COGAN. AN Apologetical Defence OF FERNAND MENDEZ PINTO HIS HISTORY. IF it be true that Authors do render themselves commendable by their Works, there is no doubt, but that Fernand Mendez Pinto hath by this same of his justly acquired such reputation, as will make him be esteemed for ever. He was a man of a strong wit, and sound judgement, and endued with a most rare, and extraordinary memory, as appears in the Relation of his Voyages and Adventures, which sufficiently testify how far he excelled therein, retaining in his remembrance an infinity of such strange and wonderful things, (whereof to his cost he was for the most part an eye witness) as many great Personages of Asia and Europe took no little delight in hearing him recount them; especially Philip the second King of Spain, who at several times spent many hours in discoursing with him there about, which questionless he would never have done, being a Prince, in the opinion of all the world, of a most exact and profound judgement, had he not been verily persuaded that what he delivered was true. Nevertheless since there may be some who in regard of the stupendious things which he delivers, will seem to give no credit thereunto; I have held it very necessary to cite here many several authentic Authors, that in their writings have confirmed the verity of his Narrations, as followeth. Of the Riches and Grandeurs of these Oriental Countries, and particularly of the Kingdom of China, Nicholas Trigault, the jesuit treats diffusedly in his book entitled, De Christiana expeditione apud Sinas, in the first part thereof, principally in the 6th Chapter. Gasper de la Cruz, in his book of China, the third, fourth, fifth, and nineteen Chapters. John de Lucena, in the life of Francis Xavier the jesuit, in the tenth Book, from the seventeenth to the twenty fourth Chapter. Anthony Galuan in his Treatise of the Discovery of those Parts, fol. 39 and in his History of Florida. Mendoza, in his History of China, the second Chapter of the third Book. Trigault, in his first Book, the seventh Chapter, Palatii Regis. Doctor Babia, in the third part of his Pontifical History, the 18 Chapter, in the life of Sixtus Quintus. Boterus, in his Relations. John de Sanctis, in his Oriental Aethiopian History, Chap. 8. and in the Ecclesiastical History of Rebullosa. Ribadeneyra, Matthew, and Lewes Gusman, in divers Chapters of the Oriental Histories. Josephus de Acosta, Peter of Leon, Zarate, Michael Vazquez de Padilla, Peter Martyr, Cefas Bishop of Chiapa, Francisco Lopez de Gomorra, Hierosme du Pré, Ferdinand de Cordova, Hierosme Romain, Illescas, Antonio de Herrera, Pineda, Prudentius de Sandobal, and Garcilasso in divers places of his Royal Commentaries, and in the 20th Chapter of his third Book. Touching that which Fernand Mendez writes of the Governors of those Kingdoms, of the strict observation of justice, of the Names of the judges, Viceroys, Magistrates, Captains, Governors, and Ministers of the State, Boterus, in his universal Relations, says the same. Trigault, in divers places, particularly in the sixth Chapter of the first book, de Senensis Reipublicae administratione. Gaspar de la Cruz, in the 16.17.18. and 19 Chapters. Babia, in the third page of his Ponticall book, in the life of Sixtus Quintus. Lucena, in the life of Francis Xavier, the tenth book. Mendoza, in the ninth and tenth chapters of his third Book, and in many other Chapters of his new world. Mafeus', in his Oriental History; and in the Letters of China, written by Guerrier the jesuit. Concerning the great number of prisons, and other particularities, the same may be seen at large in the History of China. Mendoza, in the twelfth Chapter of his first book. Gaspar de la Cruz, Chapter ninth and twenty second. Trigault, in divers places of his History. Lucena, in the twenty first Chapter of his tenth book. and Alexander Valignario, in his Letters missive. That which he speaks of the great multitudes of people that are in those Countries, read in Lucena, the nineteenth Chapter of his tenth Book. Trigault, in sundry places, chiefly in the second Chapter, de nomine, situ, et magnitudine Regni Sinarum. Fernand Mendez in the eighty ninth Chapter writes of a Temple built upon a great company of pillars; Read de la Cruz, the seventh Chapter. Mendoza, the third Chapter of his first Book. Mafeus'; Anthony de St Romain; and George Bruno, in his book of the City of the World. In this History are set forth huge Statues of Brass and Iron. See the first, third, fourth, fifth, Chapters of the first book of Gasper de la Cruz. Mendoza, the ninth and tenth Chapters of his first Book. The second Book of Boterus, in his relation of Siam. Rebullosa, in his Ecclesiastical History, fol. 117. and 118. John de Sanctis, in his Aethiopian History, the seventh, and twelfth Chapters. Lucena, in the 1.6.8. and 9 Chapters of his seventh book. Trigault, in the ninth and eighteenth Chapters of his first Book. Mafeus', and S. Romain, in the 90th Chapter. Mendoza, in the seventh Chapter of his first Book, and in the fourteenth Chapter of his second Part, as also in divers places of his Itinerary. Lucena, in the nineteenth Chapter of his nineteenth Book; and many other Authors. Touching the manner of breeding and keeping of wild Ducks in Rivers, mentioned in the 97. Chapter. See De la Cruz, the 7. and 8. Chapters. Mendoza, the 21. Chapter. Trigault, the second chapter of his first Book; and divers others. As for that which he writes of the Towns that are made on Rivers and the Sea, with an infinite company of ships in the 98. Chap. read Lucena, in the 19 chapter of his 10. Book. Mendoza, in his Itineraries the 17. chap. De la Cruz, in the 8. and 12. Chapters. Trigault, in the third Chapter of his first Book, Navium Capia. Lucena, in his first Book the 19 Chapter. For so much as is spoken of the Wall which separates Tartary from China: See Lucena, in the 21. Chapter of his tenth Book. Gasper de la Cruz, the second and fourth Chapters. Trigault, in the second Chapter of his first Book, and in the 12. Chapter of his fifth Book. Galvan, in his Commentaries fol. 70. Mendoza, the first part, in the fifth chapter of his first book, and in the seventeenth chapter of the second part. Babia, in the second part of his Pontifical History, chap. 18. and generally all that write of those parts of China. Concerning that which Fernand says of the Treasure of the Dead, read Lucean, in the eighth chapter of the seventh Book. De la Cruz, and Mendoza. Paulus Jovius, in his History of the Turks. But that which Passavinus delivers in the Description of the Persians, and Belorus, in his Chronologie of the Kings of Persia, is yet a greater mervel. The like do Celius and Augustinus Corion write of the War of the Cimbrians, wherein such an infinite number of Saracens were slain, near to Marseilles, as they made up the fences of their fields with the bones of them. Anthony Boussin in his Decades of Hungary. Our Author employs many Chapters in the description of the stately edifices of those Eastern Countries; The same may be seen in all the other Writers, that entreat of those parts of Asia, who set them forth strangely rich and great. Lucena, in the fifth Book of the life of Frances Xavier. Father Lewis in his Letters. The same Lucena, in the eighth Chapter. For the innumerable company of Religious men and women (as they term them) which serve for the worship of their false Gods, it shall suffice to read De la Cruz, in his first Chapter. And for a full clearing thereof read Damien De Gois, in the History of King Don Emanuel. Mafeus', in his eleventh and fou●teenth Books. St Roman, and Trigault. As also for the removing of all doubt in the reading of those things, as incridible, look on the sixteenth Chapter of the Book of Prester john, written by Francisco Alvarez. John de Sanctis, in his Ethiopian History, the 17th Chapter. Levis de Parama, de Origine Inquisitionis, the nineteenth Chapter of his second Book, entitled In sexta aetate Mundi Razis, in his Chronicle Sancti Dominice, folio 299. Galvan, in his Discoveries, folio 70. Lucena, in divers places of his Book. Mendoza, in the eighteenth, nineteenth, twentieth, and twenty third Chapters, and throughout his first and second Books. Gaspar de la Cruz, the fifth, seventh, and nineth Chapters. Boterus, in his Relations of China, Narsingua, Japon, and Siam. Rebullosa, fol 141. Leonard Abel in his Relations. Paul Maria, in his journey into Egypt; and many others. Concerning the setting forth, sumptuousness, and magnificence of those people's Banquets; their Comedies, Feasts, Dances, Music, and diversity of Instruments; see Lucena, in the thirteenth Chapter of his tenth Book. Mendoza, in the twenty fourth and twenty eighth Chapters of his first Book; as also in the fourteenth and eighteenth Chapters of his third Book. Trigault, in the seventh Chapter of his first Book, Conrinia. Touching their Feasts read Mafeus', in the sixth Book of his History, St Romain in his, and generally Trigault, de expeditione apud Chinas'. For the manner of their sacrificing, see de Sanctis, in the eighth Chapter of his Ethiophia. Damen de Gois, in the History of King Emanuel. Mendoza, in the twenty sixth Chapter of his Itenerary. Trigault, throughout the whole tenth Chapter of his first Book. Lucena, in several places of his seventh Book. De la Cruz, the thirteenth Chapter. Boterus, in his Relations. The Maps of Japon, and China. Matthew Ricio, St Romain, and Mafeus'. In the 116. and 117. Chapters of the present Book, the Author treats of the Castle of Nixiancoo, for which peruse Trigault, de Christiana expeditione, the eleventh Chapter of his fourth Book. Polenus, in his Book of Stratagems. Vegetius, de re militari; Vanitius, and Vasionzelos. Touching that which Fernand speaks of the Chinese, their penances and mortifications in the Temple of Tinagoogoo; as also of their processions, and the sacrificing of themselves there, read John de Sanctis, in the eighth Chapter of his Ethiopian History. Mendoza, in the twenty eighth Chapter of his Itinerary. Trigault, in the tenth Chapter of his first Book; and in the second part of the History of China. Galvan, in his discoveries, fol. 56. Mafeus', St. Romain, Boterus, and Anthony de Govea, in the Archbishop of Goa his Voyage. Of that which is said concerning the great number of Idols and Statues, Mendoza speaks amply, in the ninth Chapter of his first Book, in the seventh Chapter of his second Book, and in many other places; de sanctis, in the second part of his Aethiopian History, the seventh Chapter. Lucena, throughout his whole seventh Book. Trigault, in the tenth Chapter of his first Book, §. Idolorum multitudo. Rebullosa; from folio 116. to folio 120. De la Cruz, in many places of his Book. Damien de Gois; Boterus, in his relations of Pegu: Babia, in the third part of his Pontifall History, the eighteenth Chapter, In vita Sexti Quinti. Fernand makes a narration of certain men, whom he calls Caloges, and Fingaos, which have their feet round, like unto those of Cows, and hands all over hairy; for the clearing of the truth whereof read Galvan, in his discoveries, folio 32. and 72. Gaspar de la Cruz, the s●venth Chapter. Touching the triumphant Arches, which they have in their streets, together with their manner of accommodating, and enriching them, when as they solemnised certain Feasts, read de la Cruz, the seventh chapter. Of the Universities, which they have in China, see Trigault, in the third and fifth Chapters of his first Book, De Artibus apud Sinas liberalibus, ac Scientiis, etc. And in another, entitled, De Artibus apud Sinas mechanicis. For a Confirmation of that which our Author says of the strange Ceremonies and Compliments, used by them at their saluting one another, when they meet together by chance in the streets, and in their visits, read Mafeus', in the sixth Book of his Indian History, folio 134. beginning with these words, Salutandi ritus miter plebeios, etc. And Mendoza, in divers places of his Book declares the same. Trigault, in the seventh Chapter of his first Book, at the title, De Sinarum ritibus non nullis, describes their manner of Salutations. Babia, in the third Part of his Pontifical History, in the life of Gregory the thirteenth. The History of the King of Bramaa, together with his Victories and Conquests, may be found in the Relations of Boterus. De la Cruz, in the second and fourth Chapters. Mafeus', and St Romain. Of the entrance of the Tartars into China, and their besieging of Pequin: Boterus in his Relations; De la Cruz, the fourth Chapter; Paulus Jovius, Antonius Armenius, and Mathias de Micuy, discourse at large. That which is written of the subversion of the Provinces of Guy, and Sansii, and of the doleful and dreadful events ensuing thereupon, Gaspar de la Cruz hath spoken of sufficiently in the 29th Chapter of his Book. As for that which Fernand says of their Gods, Fatoquis, Amida, Xaca, Gizon, and Canom; as also of the fooleries, dreams, and leasings, which they recount of them; and of their original, and the respests and reverences they bear unto them; it may be all seen in the twelfth Book of Mafeus' his Indian History; and in the first and fourth Chapters of his Epistles. Trigault, in his first and second Book. Boterus, in his Relations. St Roman, and many others. By all this now is my Author throughly vindicated from all aspersions of falsehood, that may be cast upon this his Work, which, were it otherwise, and merely devised, yet is it so full of variety, and of such strange, both Comic and Tragic Events, as cannot choose but delight far more than any Romance, or other of that kind. But being accompanied with the truth, as I have sufficiently proved, it will no doubt give all the satisfaction and content, that can be desired of the Reader. The Contents. CHAP. I. IN what manner I passed my youth in the Kingdom of Portugal, until my going to the Indias. Fol. 1. CHAP. II. My Departure from Portugal for the East-Idiaes; and my embarking there for the Strait of Mecqua. 3 CHAP. III. Our travelling from Mazua by Land to the Mother of Prester John; as also our reimbarquing at the Port of Arquico; and that which befell us by the encounter of three Turkish Vessels. 5 CHAP. IV. A Mutiny happening in the Town of Mocaa; the occasion thereof; that which befell thereupon, and by what means I was carried to Ormuz; as also my sailing from thence to Goa; and what success I had in that Voyage. 8. CHAP. V. Goncalo vas Co●inhoes Treaty with the Queen of Onor; his assaulting of a Turkish 〈◊〉; and that which happened unto us as we were upon our return to Goa. 11 CHAP. VI What passed till such time as Pedro de Faria arrived at Malaca; his receiving an Ambassador from the King of Batas, with his sending me to that King, and that which arrived unto me in that Voyage. 14 CHAP. VII. What happened to me at Panaiu, with the King of Batas expedition against the Tyrant of Achem, and what he did after his Victory over him. 18 CHAP. VIII. That which passed between the King of Batas and me, until such time as I embarked for Malaca; my arrival in the Kingdom of Queda, and my return from thence to Malaca. 21 CHAP. IX. The arrival of an Ambassador at the Fortress of Malaca, from the King of Aaru to the Captain thereof; his sending me to the said King, my coming to Aaru, and that which happened unto me after my departure from thence. 26 CHAP. X. By what means I was carried to the Town of Siaca, and that which befell me there; my going to Malaca with a Mahometan Merchant; and the Tyrant of Achems' Army marching against the King of Aaru. CHAP. XI. The death of the King of Aaru, and the cruel justice that was executed on him by his Enemies; the going of his Queen to Malaca, and her reception there. 33 CHAP. XII. The Queen of Aarus departure from Malaca▪ her going to the King of Jantana, his summoning the Tyrant of Achem to restore the Kingdom of Aaru; and that which passed between them thereupon. 36 CHAP. XIII. My departure to go to Pan; that which fortuned after my arrival there, with the murder of the King of Pan, and the cause thereof. 39 CHAP. XIV. The misfortune that befell us at our entry into the River of Lugor; our hiding ourselves in a Wood, with that which happened unto us afterwards; and our return unto Malaca. 42 CHAP. XV. Antonio de Faria his setting forth for the Isle of Anyan, his arrival at the River of Tinacoreu; and that which befell us in this Voyage. 46 Faria's arrival at the Bay of Camoy, where was the fishing of Pearls for the King of China; the relation made to him of the Isle of Aynan; with that which happened to him by the means of a renegado Pirate, and other ways. 52 CHAP. XVII. The information that Antonio de Faria had of the Country; some passages betwixt him and the Nautarel of the Town; his going to the River of Madel, with his encountering a Pirate there, and that which passed between them. 58 CHAP. XVIII. What Antonio de Faria did with the Captain of the Pirates junck; that which passed between him and the people of the Country, with our casting away upon the Island of Thiefs. 61 CHAP. XIX. In what sort we escaped miraculously out of this Island; our passage from thence to the River of Xingrau; our encountering with a Chinese Pirate, and the agreement we made with him. 65 CHAP. XX. Our encounter at Sea with eight Portugals very sorely hurt, and Antonio de Faria's meeting and fight with Coia Acem the Pirate. 69 CHAP. XXI. What Antonio de Faria did after his Victory; his departure from the River of Tinlau, with his ill success thereupon, and the succour we met withal. 73 CHAP. XXII. Antonio de Faria hath news of the five Portugals that were made Captives; his Letter to the Mandarin of Nouday about them, and his assaulting the said Town. 76 Faria's Navigation till he came to the Port of Liampoo; his arrival, and gallant reception there by the Portugals. 81 CHAP. XXIV. Antonio de Faria departs from Liampoo for to go and seek out the Island of Calempluy; the strange things that we saw, and the hazard we ran in our Voyage thither. 87 CHAP. XXV. Our arrival at the Island of Calempluy, with the description thereof; what happened to Antonio de Faria in one of the Hermitages there, and how we were discovered. 92 CHAP. XXVI. Our casting away in the gulf of Nanquin, with all that befell us after this lamentable shipwreck. 97 CHAP. XXVII. Our arrival at the Town of Taypor, where we were made Prisoners, and so sent to the City of Nanquin. 103 CHAP. XXVIII. The Marvels of the City of Nanquin; our departure from thence towards Pequin, and that which happened unto us till we arrived at the Town of Sempitay. 107 CHAP. XXIX. Our arrival at Sempitay, our encounter there with a Christian woman; together with the original and foundation of the Empire of China, and who they were that first peopled it. 112 CHAP. XXX. The foundation of the four chief Cities of China; together with which of the Kings of China it was that built the wall betwixt China and Tartary; and many things that we saw as we passed along. 116 CHAP. XXXI. The order which is observed in the moving Towns, that are made upon the Rivers; and that which further befell us. 122 CHAP. XXXII. Our arrival at the City of Pequin; with our imprisonment, and that which moreover happened unto us there; as also the great Majesty of the Officers of their Court of justice.. 125 CHAP. XXXIII. What past between us and the Tanigores of Mercy, with the great favour they did us; and a brief relation of the City of Pequin, where the King of China keeps his Court. 131 CHAP. XXXIV. The order which is observed in the Feasts that are made in certain Inns, and the state which the Chaems of the two and thirty Universities keeps, with certain remarkable things in the City of Pequin. 134 CHAP. XXXV. The Prison of Ximanguibaleu, wherein those are kept which have been condemned to serve at the reparations of the wall of Tartary; and another Enclosure, called the Treasure of the dead, with the revenues whereof this Prison is maintained. 137 CHAP. XXXVI. Of an Edifice situated in the midst of the River, wherein were the hundred and thirteen Chapels of the Kings of China, and the public Granaries established for the relief of the poor. 142 CHAP. XXXVII. The great number of Officers and other people, which are in the King of China's Palace; with our going to Quincay to accomplish the time of our Exile, and what befell us there. 144 CHAP. XXXVIII. A Tartar Commander enters with his Army into the Town of Quincay, and that which followed thereupon; with the Nauticors besieging the Castle of Nixiamcoo, and the taking of it by the means of some of us Portugals. 149 CHAP. XXXIX. The Mitaquer departs from the Castle of Nixiamcoo, and goes to the King of Tartaria's Camp before Pequin; with that which we saw till we arrived there; and the Mitaquers presenting us unto the King. 154 CHAP. XL. The King of Tartaria's raising his siege from before Pequin for to return into his Country; and that which passed until his arrival there. 158 CHAP. XLI. In what manner we were brought again before the King of Tartary, with our departure from that Kingdom; and all that we saw and befell us in our Voyage, till our arrival at the Court of the King of Chauchinchina. 160 CHAP. XLII. The reception of the Tartarian Ambassador by the King of Chauchinchina, with the said Kings going to the City of Uzanguea, and his triumphal entry thereinto. 167 CHAP. XLIII. Our departure from the City of Uzanguea, and our adventures till our arrival at the Isle of Tanixumaa, with our going a shore there. 170 CHAP. XLIV. The great Honour, which the Nautaquin, Lord of the Isle, did to one of us for having seen him shoot with an Harquebuse; and his sending me to the King of Bungo, with that which passed till my arrival at this Court. 172 CHAP. XLV. The great mishap which befell the King of Bungoes son, with the extreme danger that I was in for the same, and what followed thereupon. 176 CHAP. XLVI. My curing the young Prince of Bungo; with my return to Tanixumaa, and embarking there for Liampoo; and also that which happened to us on land after the shipwreck we suffered by the way thither. 178 CHAP. XLVII. The carrying of us to the Town of Pungor, and presenting us to the Broquen, Governor of the Kingdom, with that which ensued upon it. 181 CHAP. XLVIII. The King of Lequios' sending a cruel sentence against us to the Broquen of the Town where we were Prisoners, to the end he should put it in execution; and that which further happened unto us till our arrival at Liampoo. 184 CHAP. XLIX. My sailing from Liampoo to Malaca, with the sending me by the Captain of the Fortress there to the Chaubainhaa at Martibano; and all that befell us in our Voyage thither. 189 CHAP. L. The Continuance of our Voyage to the Bar of Martibano, and certain memorable particularities happening there. 195 CHAP. LI. In what manner the Chaubinhaa rendered himself to the King of Bramaa; and the cruel pr●ceeding against the Queen of Martabano, and the Ladies her attendants. 201 CHAP. LII. In what manner the sentence of death was executed on the person of the Chaubinhaa, King of Martabano, Nhay Canatoo his wife, and an hundred and forty women; with that which the King of Bramaa did after his return to Pegu. 205 CHAP. LIII. That which passed between the Queen of Prom and the King of Bramaa, together with the first assault that was given to the City, and the success thereof. 209 CHAP. LIV. The King of Bramaa his besieging the Fortress of Meleytay, with his going from thence to Avaa, and that which passed there. 282 CHAP. LV. Our going with the King of Bramaa's Ambassador to the Calaminham; with the course which we held until we arrived at the Temple, or Pagode of Tinagoogoo; and a description thereof. 215 CHAP. LVI. The great and sumptuous Procession made in this Pagode; together with their Sacrifices, and other particularities. 218 CHAP. LVII. What we saw in the continuing of our Voyage, until we arrived at the City of Timplan. 223 CHAP. LVIII. The Magnificent Reception of the King of Bramaa his Ambassador, at the City of Timplan; and that which passed betwixt the Calaminham, and him. 226 CHAP. LIX. An ample Relation of the Empire of Calaminham, and of the Kingdoms of Pegu, and Bramaa; with the continuance of our Voyage, and what we saw during the same. 241 CHAP. LX. Our arrival at Pegu, with the death of the Roolim of Mounay. 245 CHAP. LXI. The Election of the new Roolim of Mounay, the grand Talagrepo of these Gentiles of the Kingdom of Pegu. 248 CHAP. LXII. In what manner the Roolim of Mounay was conducted to the Isle of Mounay, and put into possession of his Dignity. 252 CHAP. LXIII. A continuation of the success which we had in this Voyage; with my departure from Goa to Zunda, and what passed during my abode there. 255 CHAP. LXIV. The expedition of the Pangueyram, Emperor of Jao●, and King of Demaa, against the King of Passervan; and all that which passed in this War. 258 CHAP. LXV. The death of the King of Demaa by a very strange accident, and that which arrived thereupon. 263 CHAP. LXVI. That which befell us until our departure towards the Port of Zunda, from whence we set sail for China, and what afterwards happened unto us. 266 CHAP. LXVII. My passing from Zunda to Siam, where in the company of Portugals I went to the War of Chyamay; and that which the King of Siam did until he returned into his Kingdom, where his Queen poisoned him. 269 CHAP. LXVIII. The lamentable death of the King of Siam; with certain illustrious and memorable things done by him during his life; and many other accidents, which arrived in that Kingdom. 273 CHAP. LXIX. The King of Bramaa's enterprise against the Kingdom of Siam, and that which passed until his arrival at the City of Odi●●, with his besieging of it, and all that ensued thereupon. 278 CHAP. LXX. The King of Bramaa's raising his siege from before the City of Odia●, with a description of the Kingdom of Siam, and the fertility thereof. 283 CHAP. LXXI. A continuation of that which happened in the Kingdom of Pegu, as well during the life, as after the death of the King of Bramaa. 286 CHAP. LXXII. That which arrived in the time of Xemin de Satan, and an abominable case that happened to Diego Suarez, together with the Xemindooes expedition against Xemin de Satan, and that which ensued thereupon. 289 CHAP. LXXIII. That which the Xemindoo did, after he was crowned King of Pegu; with the Chaumigre●s, the King of Bramaa's Foster-brothers marching against him with a great Army▪ and divers other memorable things. 295 CHAP. LXXIV. The finding of the Xemindoo, and bringing him to the King of Bramaa; with the manner of his execution and death; and other particularities concerning the same. 301 CHAP. LXXV. My embarking in the Kingdom of Pegu to go to Malaca, and from thence to Japon; with a strange accident which arrived there. 305 CHAP. LXXVI. Our passing from the Town of Fucheo to the Port of Hiamangoo, and ●hat which befell us there, together with my departure from Malaca, and arrival at Goa. 310 CHAP. LXXVII. Father Belquiors and my departure from the Indias to go to Japon; and that which befell us till my arrival at the Island of Champeiloo. 312 CHAP. LXXVIII. Our departure from the Island of Champeiloo, and our arrival at that of Lampacau; with a relation of two great disasters, which happened in China unto two Portugal Colonies; and of a strange accident besides that fell out in the Country. 314 CHAP. LXXIX Our arrival in the Kingdom of Bungo, and that which passed thereupon. 318 CHAP. LXXX. My reception by the King of Bungo, as Ambassador from the Viceroy of the Indias. 321 CHAP. LXXXI. What past after our departure from Zequa, till my arrival in the Indias, and from thence into the Kingdom of Portugal. 323 THE Travels, Voyages & Adventures OF Ferdinand Mendez Pinto. CHAP. I. After what manner I passed my Youth in the Kingdom of Portugal, until my going to the Indias. SO often as I represent unto myself the great and continual Travels that have accompanied me from my birth, §. 1. and amidst the which I have spen● my first years, I find that I have a great deal of reason to complain of Fortune, for that she seemeth to have taken a particular care to persecute me, and to make me feel that which is most insupportable in her, as if her glory had no other foundation than her cruelty. For not content to have made me be born, and to live miserably in my Country during my youth, she conducted me, notwithstanding the fear I had of the dangers that menaced me, to the East India's, where in stead of the relief which I went thither to seek, she made me find an increase of my pains, according to the increase of my age. Since than it hath pleased God to deliver me from so many dangers, and to protect me from the fury of that adverse Fortune, for to bring me into a Port of safety and assurance, I see that I have not so much cau●e to complain of my Travels past, as I have to render him thanks for the benefits which until now I have received of him, seeing that by his divine bounty he hath preserved my life, to the end I might have means to leave this rude and unpolished Discourse unto my children for a memorial and an inheritance. For my intention is no other but to write it for them, that they may behold what strange fortunes I have run for the space of one and twenty years, during the which I was thirteen times a captive, and seventeen times sold in the Indias, in Aethiopia, in Arabia, in China, in Tartary, in Madagascar, in Sumatra, and in divers other Kingdoms and Provinces of that Oriental Archipalage upon the Confines of Asia, which the Chineses, Siames', Gu●os, and Lecquios' name, and that with reason in their Geography, the eyelids of the World, whereof I hope to entreat more particularly and largely hereafter. Whereby men, for the time to come, may take example, and a resolution not to be discouraged for any crosses that may arrive unto them in the course of their lives. For no disgrace of Fortune ought to esloign us never so little from the duty which we are bound to render unto God, because there is no adversity, how great soever, but the nature of man may well undergo it, being favoured with the assistance of Heaven. Now that others may help me to praise the Lord Almighty for the infinite mercy he hath showed me, without any regard to my sins, which I confess were the cause and original of all my misfortunes, and that from the same divine Power I received strength and courage to resist them, escaping out of so many dangers with my life saved, I take for the beginning of my Voyage the time which I spent in this Kingdom of Portugal, and say, That after I had lived there till I was about eleven or twelve years old in the misery and poverty of my father's house within the Town of Monte-mor Ovelho, an Uncle of mine, desirous to advance me to a better fortune then that whereunto I was reduced at that time, and to take me from the caresses and cockering of my Mother, brought me to this City of Lisbon, where he put me into the service of a very honourable Lady: To the which he was carried out of the hope he had, that by the favour of herself and her friends he might attain to his desire for my advancement, and this was in the same year, that the funeral pomp of the deceased King Emanuel of happy memory was celebrated at Lisbon, namely Saint Luce's day, the thirteenth of December, 1521. which is the furthest thing I can remember. In the mean time my Uncle's des●g● had a success 〈◊〉 contrary to that which he had promised to himself in favour of me; For having been in the service of this Lady about a year and an half, an accident befell me, that cast me into manifest peril of my life, so that to save myself I was constrained to abandon her house with all the speed that possibly I could. Flying away then in very great fear, I arrived before I was aware at the Ford of Pedra, which is a small Port so called; There I found a Carvel of Alfama, that was laden with the horses and stuff of a Lord, who was going to Setuval, where at that instant King joana the Third kept his Court by reason of a great plague that reigned in divers parts of the Kingdom. Perceiving then that this Carvel was ready to put to Sea, I embarked myself in her, and departed the next day. But alas! a little after we had set sail, having gotten to a place named Cezmibra, we were set upon by a French Pirate, who having boarded us, caused fifteen or sixteen of his men to leap into our Vessel, who finding no resistance made themselves Masters of her: Now after they had pillaged every one of us, they emptied all the Merchandise wherewithal ours was laden, which amounted to above six thousand ducats, into their ship, and then sunk her; so that of seventeen of us that remained alive, not so much as one could escape slavery, for they clapped us up all bond hand and foot under hatches, with an intent to go and sell us at La Rache in Barbary, whither also, as we found by being amongst them, they carried Arms to the Mahometans in way of Trade; for this purpose they kept us thirteen days together, continually whipping us; but at the end thereof it fortuned that about Sun set they discovered a ship, unto which they gave chase all the night, following her close, like old Pirates long used to such Theeveries; Having fetched her up by break of day, they gave her a volley of thre● p●eces of Ordnance, and presently invested her with a great deal of courage; Now though at first they found some resistance, yet they quickly rendered themselves M●sters of her, killing six Portugals, and ten or eleven slaves. This was a goodly Vessel, and belonged to a Portugal Merchant of the Town of Conde, named Silvestre Godinho, which divers other Merchants of Lisbon had laden at Saint Tom with great store of Sugar and Slaves; In such sort that those poor people seeing themselves thus▪ taken and robbed fell to lament their loss, which they estimated to be forty thousand Ducats. Whereupon these Pirates, having gotten so rich a booty, changed their design for going to lafoy Rache, and bend their course for the Ghost of France, carrying with them such of ours for slaves, as they judged fit for the service of their Navigation. The remainder of us they left at night in the Road, at a place called Melides, where we were landed miserably naked, our bodies covered with nothing but with the stripes of the lashes which so cruelly we had received the days before. In this pitiful case we arrived the next morning at Saint jago de Cacen, where we were relieved by the inhabitants of the place, especially by a Lady, that was there at that time, named Donna Beatrix, daughter to the Earl of Villanova, and wife to Alonso Perez Pantoia, Commander and grand Provost of the Town. Now after the sick and wounded were recovered, each of us departed, and got him where he hoped to find best assistance; for myself, poor wretch, I went with six or seven that accompanied me in my misery to Setuval: Thither I was no sooner come, but my good fortune placed me in the service of Francisco de Faria, a Gentleman belonging to the great Commander of Saint jago, who in recompense of four years' service, that I did him, put me to the said Commander to wait on him in his chamber, which I performed for an year and an half after. But in regard the entertainment, which was given at that time in Nobleman's houses, was so small as I was not able to live on it, necessity constrained me to quit my Master, with a design to embark myself by his favour to go to the Indias; for that I thought was the best way I could take to free me of my poverty. So albeit I were but meanly accommodated I embarked myself notwithstanding, submitting myself to whatsoever fortune should arrive unto me in those far Countries, either good or bad. CHAP. II. My departure from Portugal for the Indias, and my embarking there for the Strait of Mecqua. IT was in the year 1537. and the eleventh of March, that I parted from this Kingdom in a Fleet of five Ships, whereof there was no General; §. 1. for each of those Vessels was commanded by a particular Captain: For example, in the ship named the Queen, commanded Don Pedro de Silua, surnamed the Cock, son to the Admiral Don Vasco de Gama; In the ship, called St Rock, commanded Don Fernando de Lima, son to Diego Lopez de Lima, grand Provost of the Town of Guimaranes, who died valiantly in defence of the Fortress of Ormuz, whereof he was Captain the year following, 1538. In the S. Barba, commanded Don Fernando de Lima, who was to be Governor of the Town of Chaul; Of that, which was called the Flower of the Sea, Lope Vaz Vagado was Captain; And in the fifth and last ship, named Galega, commanded Martimde Freitas, born in the Isle of Madera, who the same year was slain at Damao, together with five and thirty men that followed him. These Vessels, sailing different ways, arrived at length at a good Port called Mozambique; There we met with the S. Michael, that wintered there, and was commanded by Duart Tristao, who parted thence richly laden for to return into Portugal; Howbeit I believe she was taken, or suffered shipwreck, as it happens but too often in this Voyage to the Indias, for he was never heard of since. After our five Vessels were equipped with all that was necessary for them, and ready to set sail from Mozambique, the Lieutenant of the Fortress, called Vincent Pegado, showed the Captains of the said five ships a Mandate from the Governor, named Nunho de Cunha, whereby he expressly commanded that all Portugal ships, which did arrive in that Port this year, should go to Diu, and leave their men there for the guard of the Fortress, because of the fear they were in of the Turkish Army, which was every hour expected in the Indias, by reason of the death of Sultan Bandur King of Cambaya, whom the said Governor had put to death the Summer before. In regard this affair was of great importance, it was the cause that all the Captains assembled together to deliberate thereupon; At length to meet with the present necessity they concluded, that three of those five ships, appertaining to the King, should go to Diu, conformable to the contents of the said Mandate, and that the other two, which belonged to particular Merchants, should pursue their course to Goa: The Kings three ships sailing to Diu, and the other two Merchants towards Goa, it pleased God to conduct them safe thither. Now as soon as the Kings three ships came to the mouth of the River of the Port of Diu, which fell on the fifth of September the same year, 1538. Antonio de Silv●ra, the Brother of Lovys Silvera, Earl of Sortelha, who was Captain there at that time, gave them all the testimony that possibly he could of the joy he took at this their arrival; For proof whereof he bestowed liberally on every one, keeping a set table for above seven hundred persons which they brought along with them, besides his secret rewards, and extraordinary gifts, whereby he supplied the necessities they had suffered during their Voyage. Whereupon the Soldiers considering how this Captain entreated them very royally, that he paid them beforehand, distributed their pay and munition unto them with his own hands, caused the sick to be carefully tended, and showed himself most ready to assist every one, it so wrought upon them, that of their own accord they offered to stay there for to serve him, being no way constrained thereunto, as they use to be in those Countries in all the Fortresses which expect a siege. This done, as soon as the three ships had sold the Merchandise they had brought, they set sail for Goa, carrying none with them but the Officers of the Vessels, and some Seamen to conduct them; where they abode till such time as the Governor had given them dispatches for to go to Cochin, where being arrived they took in their lading, and returned all five safe into Portugal. Seventeen days after we were arrived at the Fortress of Diu, §. 2. where at that time two Foists were ready prepared to go to the Straight of Mecqua, for to discover, and find out the design of the Turkish Army, whose coming was greatly feared in the Indias, because one of those Foists was commanded by a Captain that was a great friend of mine, who gave me good hope of the Voyage he was bound for, I embarked myself with him; Relying then on the promises which the Captain made me, that by his favour and means I should quickly be rich, the only thing in the world that I most desired, and suffering myself to be deceived by my hopes, I imagined that I was already Master of great wealth, never considering how vain and uncertain the promises of men are, and that I could not reap much benefit by the Voyage I was going to undertake, by reason it was dangerous, and unseasonable for Navigation in that Country. Now being departed from Diu, we sailed in a time full of storms, because it was about the end of Winter, which seemed to begin anew, so impetuous were the winds, and so great was the rain: Nevertheless, how violent soever the Tempest was, and dark the weather, we letted not to discover the Isles of Curia, Muria, and Avedalcuria, at the sight whereof we thought ourselves quite lost, and without hope of life. Whereupon to decline the danger we turned the prow of our Vessel to the Southeast, knowing no other mean then that to avoid shipwreck; But by good fortune for us, it pleased God, that we let fall an anchor at the point of the Island of Socotora; there we presently anchored, a league below the place, where Don Francisco d' Almeyda caused a Fortress to be built in the year 1507. when he came from Portugal, as the first Victory that ever was in the Indias. In the said place we took in fresh water, and some provision of Victuals, that we bought of the Christians of the Country, which are the descendants of those, whom the Apostle S. Thomas converted in those parts. Being refreshed thus, we parted from thence with a purpose to enter the Strait, so that after we had sailed nine days with a favourable wind we found ourselves right against Mazua; There about Sun set we descried a sail at Sea, whereunto we gave so hard chase, that before the first watch of the night we came up close to her, and then to satisfy the desire we had for to learn something of the Captain by gentleness touching the Turkish Army, we demanded of him whether it was parted from Sues, or whether he had not met with it in any place; and that we might be the better informed we spoke aloud to all those that were in the ship. But in stead of answer, without speaking a word, and in contempt of us, they gave us a dozen pieces of Ordnance, whereof, five were small, and the other seven, field Pieces, together with good store of Musket shot; And withal, in a kind of jollity, and as it were believing that we were already theirs, they made all the air about resound again with their confused cries; After this, to brave and terrify us the more, they flourished a many flags and streamers up and down, and from the top of their poop they brandished a number of naked Scymitars, commanding us with great threatening to come aboard and yield ourselves unto them. At the first view of so many Rhodomontades and brave we were in some doubt and amaze, which caused the Captains of our Foists to call the Soldiers to Council for to know what they should do, and the conclusion was to continue shooting at them till the next morning, that so by daylight they might be the better fought withal and invested, it being agreed upon of all sides that they were not to be let go unpunished for their presumption: Which accordingly was performed, and all the rest of the night we gave them chase, plying them with our Ordnance. So morning come, their ship being shot through and through in many places, and cruelly battered all over, they rendered themselves into our hands. In the encounter there were threescore and four of their men killed, and of fourscore that remained, the most part, seeing themselves reduced to extremity, cast themselves into the Sea, choosing rather there to be drowned, then to be burnt in their ship with the artificial fires that we had hurled into her, so that of all the fourscore there escaped but five very sore hurt, whereof one was the Captain. This same, by force of torture, whereunto he was exposed by the Command of our two Captains, confessed that he came from judaa, and that the Turkish Army was already departed from Sues, with a design to take in Ad●m, and then to build a Fortress there before they attempted any thing in the Indias, according to an express charge sent by the great Turk from Constantinople to the Bassa of grand Cair●, who was going to be General of the Army: Besides this, he confessed many other things conformable to our desire, amongst the which he said, that he was a renegado Christian, a Maliorquin by Nation, born at Cerdenha, and son to one named Paul Andrez, a Merchant of that Island, and that about four years before growing enamoured of a very ●air Greekish Mahometan, that was then his wife, for the love of her he had abjured Christianity, and embraced the Law of Mahomet. Our Captains much amazed hereat, gently persuaded him to acquit this abominable belief, and become a Christian again, whereunto the wicked caitiff made answer with a brutish obstinacy, that at no hand he would yield to forsake his Law, showing himself so hardened in the resolution to continue therein, as if he had been born in it, and never had professed any other. By these speeches of his, the Captains, perceiving there was no hope of recalling him from his damnable error, caused him to be bound hand and foot, and so with a great stone tied about his neck to be cast alive into the Sea, sending him to participate with the torments of his Mahomet, and to be his companion in the other world, as he had been his confident in this. This Infidel being executed in this sort, we put the other prisoners into one of our Foists, and then sunk their Vessel with all the goods that were in her, which consisted most in packs of stained clothes, whereof we had no use, and a few pieces of Chamlet that the Soldiers got to make them apparel. CHAP. III. Our travelling from Mazua by land to the Mother of Prester john; as also our reimbarquing at the Port of Arquic●, and that which befell us by the encounter of three Turkish Vessels. WE departed from this place with an intent to go to Arquico, §. 1. the Territory of Prester john, Emperor of Aethiopia, for we had a Letter to deliver, which Antonio de Sylvera sent to a Factor of his, named Anrique Barbosa, who had been three years resident in that Country by the Commandment of the Governor Nuno de Cunha. When we were arrived at Gottor, a league lower than the Port of Mazua, we were all received there very courteously, as well by the Inhabitants, as by a Portugal, called Vasco martin's de Seixas, born in the Town of Obidos, who was come thither by Henrico Barbosa's order, and had been there a month attending the arrival of some Portugal ship. The cause of that his abode was to deliver a Letter from the said Henrico, as accordingly he did to the Captains of our Foists; By this Letter he certified the estate of the Turkish Army, and besought them at any hand to send him some Portugals, to induce them whereunto, he remonstrated unto them how it much imported the service both of God and the King, and that for his own part he could not come unto them, because he was employed with forty other Portugals in the Fort of Gileytor for the guard of the person of the Princess of Tigremahon, Mother to Prester john. The two Captains, having perused this Letter, communicated it to the chiefest of the Soldiers, and sat in Council upon it, where it was determined that four of them should go along with Vasco Martin's to Barbosa, and that they should carry the Letter which Antonio de Sylvera had sent him: This was no sooner resolved then executed, for the next day three other Portugals, and myself, departed accordingly, and we went by Land mounted upon good Mules, which the Ciquaxy, Captain of the Town, sent us by the Command of the Princess, the Emperor's Mother, together with six Abissins' to accompany us. The first night we lay at a very fair Monastery, called Satilgaon; The next day before the Sun rose we traveled along by a River, and by that time we had rode five leagues we arrived at a place, named Bitonte, where we spent that night in a Convent of religious persons, dedicated to S. Michael; there we were very well entertained both by the Prior, and the Friars: A little after our arrival, the son of Bernagais, Governor of that Empire of Aethiopia, a very proper and courteous Gentleman, about seventeen years old, came to see us, accompanied with thirty men, all mounted upon Mules, and himself on a horse furnished after the Portugal manner; the furniture was of Purple Velvet trimmed with Gold fringe, which two years before the Governor Nuno de Cunha sent him from the Indias, by one Lopez Chanoca, who was afterwards made a slave at Gran Cairo, whereof this young Prince being advertised, he presently dispatched away a jewish Merchant of Azabiba to redeem him, but as ill fortune would he died before the Jew could get thither, which so grieved this Prince when he understood of it, as the s●id Vasco martin's assured us that in the said Monastery of S. Michael he caused the most honourable funerals to be celebrated for him that ever he saw, wherein assisted above four thousand Priests, besides a greater number of Novices, which in their language are called Santilcos': No● was this all, for this Prince hearing that the deceased had been married at Goa, and likewise that he had left three daughters there behind him, which were very young and poor, he bestowed on them three hundred O qu●●● of Gold, that are worth twelve Crusadoes of our money a piece, ● liberality truly royal, and which I relate here, as well to amplify the nobleness of this Prince, as that it may serve for an example to others, and render them more charitable upon like occasions. The next morning we continued our journey, making all the hast● that possibly we could, to which end we got upon good Horses, that were given us by this Prince, and withal he appointed four of his servants to accompany us, who during our Voyage entertained us every where very sumptuously. That day our lodging was at a goodly place, called Betenigus, which signifies a royal house, and in truth it was not without reason so named, for on whatsoever part one cast an eye it was environed with gallant high Trees for three leagues about, nor is it to be credited how pleasing this Wood was, for that it was composed all of Cedars, Cypress, Palm, Date Trees, and Cocos, like to those in the Indias; Here we passed the night with all kind of contentment; In the morning we proceeded on our journey, and travelling after five leagues a day we passed over a great Plain, all full of goodly Corn; Then we arrived at a Mountain, named Vangaleu, inhabited by Jews, which were very white and handsome; Two days and an half after we came to a good Town, called Fumbau, not above two leagues distant from the Fort of Gileytor, there we found Barbosa, and the forty Portugal's aforesaid, who received us with great demonstrations of joy, but not without shedding of some tears, for though they lived there at their ease, and were absolute Masters of all the Country, as they said, yet the consideration how they were as men banished from their Country into this place, did very much trouble them. Now because it was night when we arrived, and that we had all need of rest, Barbosa was of the opinion that we should not see the Emperor's Mother till the next morning, which was a Sunday, the fourth of October; that come, and we well refreshed, we went, accompanied with Barbosa and his forty Portugals, to the Princess' Palace, where we found her at Mass in her Chapel: A while after being advertised of our arrival, she caused us to be admitted into her presence; Whereupon we fell on our knees before her, and with all kind of humility kissed the Ventilow that she held in her hand; To these submissions we adjoined many other Ceremonies according to their fashion, conformable to the instructions we had taken from the Portugals that conducted us thither. She received us with a smiling countenance, and to testify how much she was pleased with our coming; Verily, said she, you cannot imagine how glad I am to see you, that are right Christians, for it hath been a thing which I have always as much desired, as a fair garden enamelled with flowers doth the morning's dew, wherefore you are most welcome come, and may your entrance into my house be as propitious, as that of the virtuous Queen Helena 's was into blessed jerusalem. Herewith she made us to sit down upon ma●●, not above five or six paces distant from her; Then showing herself exceedingly contented, she questioned us about certain matters, of which, she assured us, that she very much longed to be satisfied: First she asked us the name of our holy Father the Pope, also how many Kings there were in Christendom, and whether any of us had ever been in the holy Land; whereupon she much condemned the Christian Princes, for their neglect and want of care in seeking to ruin the power of the Turk, who, she said, was the common Enemy of them all. Likewise she would know of us whether the King of Portugal was great in the Indias, what Forts he had there, in what places they were seated, and how defended. She made us many other like demands, to the which we answered the best we could for to content her; whereupon she dismissed us, and we returning to our lodging, continued there nine days, which we spent in waiting on this Princess, with whom we had much discourse on several subjects: That Term expired, we went to take our leaves of her, and in kissing of her hands she seemed to be somewhat troubled at our departure. Truly, said she, it grieves me that you will be gone so soon, but since there is no remedy, I wish your Voyage may be so prosperous, that at your arrival in the Indias you may be as well received by yours, as the Queen of Sheba was heretofore by King Solomon in the admirable Palace of his greatness. Now before we departed she bestowed on us twenty four Oquea● of Gold, which make two hundred forty Ducats of our money; She caused us also to be conducted by a Naiqu●, and twenty Abissins', as well to serve us for Guides, and guard us from Robbers, whereof that Country was full, as to furnish us with Victuals and Horses until such time as we got to Arquico, where our Foists attended for us. This Princess also sent a rich present of divers Jewels of Gold and Stones by Vasco martin's de S●ixas unto the Governor of the Indias, which by ill fortune was lost in this Voyage, as shall be declared hereafter. §. 2. After we were returned to the Port of Arquico, where we found our companions caulking of our Foists, and furnishing them with all that was necessary for our Voyage, we fell to work with them for the space of nine days. At length all things being ready, we set sail, and parted from thence on Tuesday, the sixth of November, 1538. We carried with us both Vasco martin's de Seixas, that had the Present and a Letter from the Princess to the Governor of the Indias, as also an Abissin Bishop, who was bound for Portugal, with an intent to go from thence to Galicia, Rome, and Venice, and afterwards to travel to jerusalem, which especially he desired to see in regard of the holiness of the place. An hour before day we left the Port, and sailed along the Coast afore the wind, until such time as about noon we reached the point of the Cape of Coçam, and before we arrived at the Island of Rocks, we discerned three Vessels on the other side, that seemed to us to be Gelvas or Terrades, which are the names of the Vessels of that Country; Whereupon we gave them chase, and with the strength of our oars, because the wind was then somewhat down, we pursued them in such sort, that in less than two hours, having gotten up to them, we might easily perceive them to be Turkish Galleys, whereof we were no sooner assured, but that we presently betook ourselves to flight, and made towards the Land with all the haste that might be, so if it were possible to escape the danger that inevitably threatened us: But whether the Turks suspected our design, or knew it, in less than a quarter of an hour they hoist up all their sails, and having the wind favourable they followed us very hard, so as in a little while getting within a small falcon shot of us, they discharged all their Ordnance upon us, wherewith they not only killed nine of our men, and hur● six and twenty, but so b●ttered our Foists, that we were fain to cast a great part of our goods into the Sea; Mean while the Turks lost no time, but joined us so close, that from their poop they hurt us easily with their pikes: Now there were four and forty good Soldiers remaining yet unhurt in our Foists, who knowing that upon their valour, and the force of their arms, depended the lives both of themselves, and all the rest, they determined to fight it out; With this resolution they set courageously upon the Admiral of the three Galleys, wherein was Solyman Dragu●, General of the Fleet; Their onset was so furious, as they invested her from poop to prow, and killed seven and twenty janissaries, nevertheless she being instantly succoured with fresh men by the other two Galleys, which had stayed a little behind, we were so wearied and oppressed with numbers, that we were not able to make any further resistance, for of four and fifty that we were at first, there was but eleven left alive, whereof two also died the next day, whom the Turks caused to be cut in quarters, which they hung at the end of their main yards for a sign of their Victory, and in that manner carried them to the Town of Mocaa, whereof the Father-in-law of the said Solyman Dragu●, that had taken us, was Governor; who with all the Inhabitants waited the coming of his Son-in-law at the entry into the Port, to receive and welcome him for his Victory. In his Company he had a certain Cacis, who was Moulana, the chiefest Sacerdotal dignity, and because he had been a little before in pilgrimage at the Temple of their Prophet Mahomet in Mecca, he was held by all the people for a very holy man: This Impostet rode up and down the Town in a triumphant Chariot, covered all over with Silk Tapestry, and with a deal of Ceremony blessed the people as he went along, exhorting them to render all possible thanks unto their Prophet for the Victory, which Solyman Dragu● had obtained over us. As soon as they arrived at this place, we nine that remained alive were set on shore, tied altogether with a great chain, and amongst us was the Abissin Bishop, so pitifully wounded that he died the next day, and in his end showed the repentance of a true Christian, which very much encouraged and comforted us. In the mean time all the Inhabitants, that were assembled about us, hearing that we were the Christians which were taken Captives, being exceedingly transported with choler, fell to beating of us in that cruel manner, as for my own part I never thought to have escaped alive out of their hands, whereunto they were especially incited by the wicked Cacis, who made them believe that they should obtain the more favour and mercy from their Mahomet, the worse they entreated us. Thus chained all together, and persecuted by every one, we were led in triumph over all the Town, where nothing was heard but acclamations and shouts, intermingled with a world of music, as well of instruments, as voices. Moreover, there was not a woman, were she never so retired, that came not forth then to see us, and to do us some outrage; for from the very least children to the oldest men, all that beheld us pass by cast out of the windows and balcons upon us pots of piss, and other filth, in contempt and derision of a name of a Christian, wherein every one strove to be most forward, in regard their cursed Priest continued still preaching unto them, that they should gain remission of their sins by abusing us. Having been tormented in this sort until the evening, they went and laid us bound as we were in a dark Dungeon, where we remained seventeen days, exposed to all kind of misery, having no other victual all that time, but a little oatmeal, which was distributed to us every morning to serve us all the day: Sometimes they gave us the same measure in dry Peason a little soaked in water, and this was all the meat we had. CHAP. IU. A Mutiny happening in the Town of Moca●, the occasion thereof, that which befell thereupon, and by what means I was carried to Ormuz; as also my sailing from thence to Goa, and what success I had in that Voyage. §. 1. THe next day, in regard that we had been so miserably moiled, and our hurts, that were great, but ill looked unto, of us nine there died two, whereof one was named Nuno Delgado, and the other Andre Borges, both of them men of courage, and of good families. The Jailor, which in their language is called Mocadan, repairing in the morning to us, and finding our two companions dead, goes away in all haste therewith to acquaint the Gauzil, which is as the Judge with us, who came in person to the prison, attended by a great many of Officers, and other people; Where having caused their irons to be stricken off, and their feet to be tied together with a rope, he commanded them so to be dragged from thence clean through the Town, where the whole multitude, to the very children, pursued and palted them with staves and stones, until such time as being wearied with harrying those poor bodies in such fashion, they cast them all battered to pieces into the Sea. At last we seven, that were left alive, were chained all together, and brought forth into the public place of the Town, to be sold to them that would give most: There all the people being met together, I was the first that was put to sale; whereupon, just as the Crier was offering to deliver me unto whomsoever would buy me, in comes that very Cacis Moulana, whom they held for a Saint, with ten or eleven other Cacis his Inferiors, all Priests like himself of their wicked Sect, and addressing his speech to Heredrin Sofo, the Governor of the Town, who sat as Precedent of the Portsale, he required him to send us, as an alms, unto the Temple of Mecqua, saying, that he was upon returning thither, and having resolved to make that pilgrimage in the name of all the people, it were not fit to go thither without carrying some offering to the Prophet Noby, (so they termed their Mahomet,) a thing, said he, that would utterly displease Razaadat Moulana, the Chief Priest of Medina Talnab, who without that would grant no kind of grace or pardon to the Inhabitants of this Town, which by reason of their great offences stood in extreme need of the favour of God, and of his Prophet. The Governor having heard the Cacis speak thus, declared unto him that for his particular he had no power to dispose with any part of the booty, and that therefore he should apply himself to Solyman Dragut his Son-in-law, who had made us slaves, so that in right it appertained only unto him to do with us as he pleased; and I do not think, added he, that he will contradict so holy an intention as this is. Thou hast reason for it, answered the Cacis, but withal thou must know, that the things of God, and the alms that are done in his name, lose their value and force, when they are sifted through so many hands, and turmoiled with such humane opinions, for which very cause seldom doth any divine resolution follow thereupon, especially in a subject such as this is, which thou mayst absolutely dispose of, as thou art sovereign Commander of this people: Moreover, as there is no body can be displeased therewith, so I do not see how it can bring thee any discontent. For besides that, this demand is very just, it is also most agreeable to our Prophet Noby, who is the absolute Lord of this prize, in regard the Victory came solely from his holy hand, though with as much falsehood as malice thou goest about to attribute the glory of it to the valour of thy Son-in law, and the courage of his Soldiers. At this instant a janisary was present, Captain of one of the three Galleys that took us, a man that for his exceeding valour was in great esteem amongst them, called Copa Geynal, who nettled with that which he heard the Cacis speak, so much in contempt both of himself, and the rest of the Soldiers, that had carried themselves very valiantly in the fight with us, returned him this answer. Certainly you might do better for the Salvation of your Soul, to distribute some part of the excessive riches you possess amongst these poor Soldiers, then seek with feigned speeches, full of hypocrisy and deceit, to rob them of these slaves, which have cost the lives of so many brave men, their fellows in arms, and have been dearly bought by us that survive, even with our dearest blood, as the wounds we have upon us can but two well witness; so can it not be said of your Cabayage (a Sacerdotal Robe after their fashion,) which for all it sits so trim and neat upon you, covers a pernicious habit you have of purloining other men's estates from them: Wherefore I would wish you to desist from the damnable plot you have laid against the absolute Masters of this Prize, whereof you shall not have so much as a token, and seek out some other Present for the Cacis of Mecqua, to the end he may conceal your theeveties, and impiety, provided it be not done with the expense of our lives and blood, but rather with the goods you have so lewdly gotten by your wicked and cunning devices. This Cacis Moulana having received so bold an answer from this Captain, found it very rude, and hard of digestion, which made him in bitter terms, and void of all respects, exceedingly to blame the Captain, and the Soldiers that were there present, who, as well Turks as Saracens, being much offended with his ill language, combined together and mutined against him, and the rest of the people, in whose favour he had spoken so insolently; nor could this mutiny be appeased by any kind of means, though the Governor of the Town, Father-in-law to the said Solyman Dragut, together with the Officers of Justice, did all that possibly they could. In a word, that I may not stand longer upon the particulars of this affair, I say, that from this small mutiny did arise so cruel and enraged a contention, as it ended not but with the death of six hundred persons, of the one and the other side: But at length the Soldiers party prevailing, they pillaged the most part of the Town, especially the said Cacis Moulana's house, killing seven wives and nine children that he had, whose bodies together with his own were dismembered, and cast into the Sea with a great deal of cruelty. In the same manner they entreated all that belonged unto him, not so much as giving life to one that was known to be his. As for us seven Portugals, which were exposed to sale in the public place, we could find out no better expedient to save our lives, then to return into the same hole, from whence we came, and that too without any Officer of Justice to carry us thither; neither did we take it for a small favour that the Jailor would receive us into the prison. Now this Mutiny had not ceased but by the authority of Solyman Dragut, General of the Galleys aforesaid▪ For this man with very gentle words gave an end to the sedition of the people, and pacified the Mutineers, which shows of what power courtesy is, even with such as are altogether ignorant of it. In the mean time Heredrin Sopho, Governor of the Town, came off but ill from this hurly burly, by reason that in the very first encounter he had one of his arms almost cut off. Three days after this disorder was quieted we were led all seven again to the Market place, there to be sold with the rest of the booty, which consisted of our Stuff, and Ordnance, that they had taken in our Foists, and were sold at a very easy rate: For myself, miserable that I was, and the most wretched of them all, Fortune, my sworn enemy, made me fall into the hands of a Greek renegado, whom I shall detest as long as I have a day to live, because that in the space of three Months I was with him, he used me so cruelly, that becoming even desperate, for that I was not able to endure the evil he did me, I was seven or eight times upon the point to have poisoned myself, which questionless I had done, if God of his infinite mercy and goodness had not diverted me from it, whereunto I was the rather induced to make him lose the money he paid for me, because he was the most covetous man in the world, and the most inhuman, and cruelest enemy to the name of a Christian. But at the end of three Months it pleased the Almighty to deliver me out of the hands of this Tyrant, who for fear of losing the money I cost him, if I should chance to make myself away, as one of his neighbours persuaded him I would, telling him that he had discovered so much by my countenance, and manner of behaviour, wherefore in pity of me he counselled him to sell me away, as he did ●ot long after unto a Jew, named Abraham Muça, Natif● of a Town, called in those quarters Toro, not above a league and an half distant from Mount Sinai: This man gave for me 〈◊〉 value of three hundred Reals in Dates, which was the Merchandise that this Jew did ordinarily trade in with my late Master, and so I parted with him in the company of divers Merchants for to go from Babylon to Cayxem, whence he carried me to Ormuz, and there presented me to Don Fernand de Lima, who was at that time Captain of the Fort, and to Doctor Pedro Fernandez, Commissary General of the Indias, that was then residing at Ormuz for the service of the King by order from the Governor Nunho de Cunha. These two, namely Fernandez and de Lima gave the Jew in recompense for me two hundred Pardaos, which are worth three shillings and nine pence a piece of our coin, whereof part was their own money, and the rest was raised of the alms which they caused to be gathered for me in the Town, so we both remained contented, the Jew for the satisfaction he had received from them, and I to find myself at full liberty as before. Seeing myself by God's mercy delivered from the miseries I had endured; §. 2. after I had been seventeen days at Ormuz, I embarked myself for the Indias in a ship that belonged to one jorge Fernandez Taborda, who was to carry Horses to Goa. In the course that we held we sailed with so prosperous a gale, that in seventeen days we arrived in view of the Fort of Diu; There, by the advice of the Captains, coasting along by the Land for to learn some news, we descried a great number of fires all that night, also at times we heard divers Pieces of Ordnance discharged, which very much troubled us, by reason we could not imagine what those fires, o● that shooting in the night should mean, in so much that we were divided into several opinions. During this incertainty our best advice was, to sail the rest of the night with as little cloth as might be, until that on the next morning by the favour of day light we perceived a great many sails, which environed the Fort on all sides. Some affirmed that it was the Governor newly come from Goa to make peace for the death of Sultan Bandur, King of Cambaya, that was slain a little before. Others said that it was the Infant, Brother to the King Dom jovan, lately arrived there from Portugal, because he was every day expected in the Indias. Some thought that it was the Pat●marcaa, with the King of Cabicuts hundred Foists of Camorin. And the last assured us, how they could justify with good and sufficient reasons that they were the Turks. As we were in this diversity of minds, and terrified with that which we discerned before our eyes, five very great Galleys came forth of the midst of this Fleet, with a many of banners, flags, and streamers, which we saw on the tops of their Masts, and the ends of their sailyards, whereof some were so long that they touched even the very water. These Galleys, being come forth in this sort, turned their prows towards us in such a courageous and confident manner, that by their sailing we presently judged them to be Turks; Which we no sooner knew to be so indeed, but we clapped on all our cloth, for to avoid them, and to get into the main Sea, not without exceeding fear, le●t for our sins we should fall into the like estate, from whence I was so lately escaped. These five Galleys having observed our flight, took a resolution to pursue us, and chased us till night, at which time it pleased God that they tacked about, and returned to the Army from whence they came. Seeing ourselves freed from so great a danger we went joyfully on, and two days after arrived at the Town of Chaul, where our Captain and the Merchants only landed for to visit the Captain of the Fort, named Simon Guedez, unto whom they reported that which had befallen them. Assuredly, said he, you are very much bound to give God thanks for delivering you from one of the greatest perils that ever you were in, for without his assistance it had been impossible for you ever to have declined it, or to tell me of it with such joy as now you do: Thereupon he declared unto them▪ that the Army they had encountered was the very same, which had held Antonio de Silveyra twenty days together besieged, being composed of a great number of Turks, whereof Solyman the Bassa, Viceroy of Cairo, was General, and that those Sails they had seen, were eight and fifty Galleys great and small, each of which carried five Pieces of Ordnance in her prow, and some of them were Pieces of Battery, besides eight other great Vessels, full of Turks, that were kept in reserve to succour the Army, and supply the places of such as should be killed; Moreover he added, that they had great abundance of victuals, amongst the which there was twelve Basilisks. This news having much amazed us, we rendered infinite praise to the Lord for showing us such grace, as to deliver us from so imminent a danger. §. 3. We stayed at Chaul but one day, and then we set sail for Goa; Being advanced as far as to the River of Carapatan, we met with Fernand de Morais, Captain of three Foists, who by the command of the Viceroy, Dom Garcia de Noronha, was going to Dabul, to the end he might see whether he could take or burn a Turkish Vessel, which was in the Port, laden with Victuals by order from the Bassa. This Fernand de Morais had no sooner gotten acquaintance of our ship, but he desired our Captain to lend him fifteen men, of twenty that he had, for to supply the great necessity he was in that way, by reason of the Vice-roys hastening him away upon the sudden, which, said he, would much advance the service both of God, and his Highness. After many contestations of either part upon this occasion, and which, to make shor●, I will pass under silence, at length they were agreed, that our Captain should let Fernand de Morais have twelve, of fifteen men, that he requested, wherewithal he was very well satisfied: Of this number I was one, as being always of the least respected. The ship departing for Goa, Fernand de Morais with his three Foists continued his Voyage towards the Port of Dabul, where we arrived the next day about nine of the clock in the morning, and presently took a Patach of Malabar, which laden with Cotton Wool and Pepper, rode at anchor in the midst of the Port. Having taken it we put the Captain and Pilot to torture, who instantly confessed that a few days before a ship came into that Port expressly from the Bassa to lad Victuals, and that there was in her an Ambassador, who had brought Hidalcan a very rich Cabaya, that is a garment worn by the Gentlemen of that Country, which he would not accept of, for that thereby he would not acknowledge himself subject to the Turk, it being a custom among the mahometans, for the Lord to do that honour to his Vassal; and further, that this refusal had so much v●xed the Ambassador, as he returned without taking any kind of provision of Victuals, and that Hidalcan had answered, he made much more esteem of the King of Portugal's amity, then of his, which was nothing but deceit, as having usurped the Town of Goa upon him, after he had offered to aid him with his favour and forces to regain it. Moreover they said, that it was not above two days since the ship, they spoke of, parted from the Port, and that the Captain of her, named Cide Ale, had denounced War against Hidalcan, vowing that as soon as the Fort of Diu was taken, which could not hold out above eight days, according to the estate wherein h● had left it, Hidalcan should lose his Kingdom, or life, and that then he should to his cost know how little the Portugals, in whom he put his confidence, could avail him. With these news Captain Morais returned towards Goa, where he arrived two days after, and gave account to the Viceroy of that which had past. There we found Gonçallo vaz Coutinho, who was going with five Foists to Onor, to demand of the Queen thereof one of the Galleys of Soliman's Army, which by a contrary wind had been driven into her Ports: Now one of the Captains of those Foists my special friend, seeing me poor and necessitous, persuaded me to accompany him in this Voyage, and to that end got me five ducats pay, which I very gladly accepted of, out of the hope I had that God would thereby open me a way to a better fortune. Being embarked then, the Captain and Soldiers pitying the case I was in, bestowed such spare clothes as they had upon me, by which means being reasonably well pieced up again, we parted the next morning from the Road of Bardees, and the Monday following we cast anchor in the Port of Onor; where, that the inhabitants of the place might know how little account we made of that mighty Army, we gave them a great peal of Ordnance, putting forth all our fights, beating our D●ums, and sounding our Trumpets, to the end that by these exterior demonstrations they might conclude we regarded not the Turks awhit. CHAP. V. Gonçallo vaz Coutinho's Treaty with the Queen of Onor; his assaulting of a Turkish Galley, and that which happened unto us as we were upon our return to Goa. OU● Fleet making a stand upon the discharging of our peal of Ordnance, §. 1. the General Gonçallo vaz Coutinho sent Bento Castanho, a very discreet and eloquent man, to the Queen of Onor, to present her with a Letter from the Viceroy, and to tell her that he was come to complain of her, for that she had sworn a peace and amity with the King of Portugal, and yet suffered the Turks, mortal enemies to the Portugals, to abide in her Ports. Hereunto she returned this answer; That both himself and his company were very welcome, that she greatly esteemed of them, because they were Vassals to the King of Portugal, and as touching that he said of the peace which she had with the King, and his Governors, it was most true, and that she desired to maintain it as long as she lived: For that which he said of the Turks, she took her God to witness how much against her will she had received and suffered them in her Ports, but that finding herself too weak for to resist such powerful enemies, she was constrained to dissemble, which she would never have done had she been furnished with sufficient forces; furthermore, to clear herself the better unto them, she offered both her power and people for to r●p●l them out of her Ports, and whereas he had brought men enough to chase them thence, she requested him to do it, wherein she would assist him all that possibly she could, which she confirmed with oaths, swearing by the golden Sandals of the Sovereign God whom she adored: To this speech she added, that she should be as well pleased if God would give him the victory over them, as if the King of Narsingu●, whose slave she was, should set her at the table with his wife. Gonçallo vaz Coutinho having received this Embassage, and other compliments from the Qu●en, though he had little hope of any performance on her part, yet did he wisely dissemble it. Afterwards being fully informed by the people of the Country of the Turks intention, of the place where they were, and what they did at that instant, he called a Council thereupon, and having throughly debated and considered all things, it was unanimously concluded, that both for the King of Portugal their Master's honour, and his own, it was expedient to set upon this Galley, either for to take, or fire it, wherein it was hoped that God, for whose glory we ●ought, would be assisting to us against those enemies of his holy Faith. This resolution being made, and signed by us all, he entered some two falcons shot within the River, where he had s●●rc● anchored, when as a little Boat, which they call an Almadia, came aboard us, with a Brachman that spoke very good Portugu●ze: This man delivered a message from the Queen unto our Captain, whereby she earnestly desired him, that for the Viceroys sake he would desi●● from the enterprise he had undertaken, and not to assault the Turks any manner of way, w●ich, said she, could not be done without great disadvantage, for that she had been advertised by her Spies, that they had fortified themselves with a good Trench, which they had cast up near the place where they had moored their Galley, in regard whereof it seemed to her almost impossible for him with no more Forces than he had to be able to prevail in so great an attempt: wherefore she took her God to witness how much she was troubled with the fear she was in lest some misfortune should betid him. Hereunto our Captain returned an answer full of wisdom and cour●●sie, saying, that he kissed her Highness' hands for the extraordinary favour she did him in giving him so good advice: but as for his Combat with the Turks he could not follow her counsel, and therefore would proceed in his determination, it being always the custom of the Portugal's not to inquire whether their Enemies were few, or many, since the more they were, the more should be their loss, and the greater his profit and honour. Thus was the Brachman dismissed, our Captain bestowing on him a piece of green Chamlet, and an Hat li●ed with red Satin, wherewith he returned very well contented. §. 2. The Brachman dismissed, Gonçallo vaz Coutinho resolved to fight with the Turks, but before h● proceeded any further he was advertised by Spies what stratagems the Enemy would use against us, and that the precedent night by the favour of the Queen they had moored up the Galley, and by it raised up a platform, whereupon they had flanked five and twenty Pieces of Ordnance, but all that stayed him not from advancing towards the Enemy; Seeing himself then within a Cannon shot of them, he went out of his Foist, and with fourscore men only landed, the rest which he had brought with him from Goa for this enterprise, being but an hundred more, he left for the guard of the Foists. So after he had set his men in Battle array, he marched courageously against his adversaries, who perceiving us making towards them valiantly resolved to defend themselves, to which end they sallied some five and twenty or thirty paces out of their Trenches, where the fight began on either side with such fury, that in less than a quarter of an hour five and forty lay dead in the place, amongst the which there was not above eight of ours; Hereupon our General, not contented with this first charge, gave them a second, by means whereof i● pleased God to make them turn their backs, in such sort that they retired pellmell, as men routed and in fear of death: Mean while we pursued them to their very Tren●hes, where they turned upon us, and m●de head anew, in the heat hereof we were so far engaged and entangled together, that we knocked one another with the pummels of our swords; Mean while our Foists arrived, which were come along by the shore to succour us, and accordingly they discharged all their Ordnance upon our Enemies, to such good purpose, as they killed eleven or twelve of the valiantest janissaries, which wore green Turbans, as a mark of their Nobility. The death of these so terrified the rest, that they presently forsook the field, by means whereof we had leisure to set the Galley on fire upon the express command of our General Gonçallo, so that having cast into her five pots of powder, the fire took hold on her with such violence, as it was apparent it could not be long before she were utterly consumed, for the mast and sail yards were all of a flame, had not the Turks, knowing the danger she was in, most courageously quenched the fire; but we laboured all that possibly we could to hinder them from it, and to make good that we had so bravely begun, which the enemies perceiving, as their last refuge they gave fire to a great Piece of Ordnance, which charged with stones, and other shot, killed six of ours, whereof the principal was Diego vas Coutinho, the General's son, besides a dozen others were hurt, that put us quite in disorder; Whereupon the Enemies finding how they had spoiled us, fell to shouting in sign of Victory, and to rendering of thanks to their Mahomet; at the naming of this their false Prophet, whom they invoked, our General the better to encourage his Soldiers, Fellows in arms, said he, seeing these Dogs call upon the Devil to aid them, let us pray unto our Saviour jesus Christ to assist us. This said, we once more assaulted the Trench, which the Enemies no sooner perceived, but they craftily turned their backs, and took their flight towards the Galley, but they were instantly followed by some of ours, who within a while made themselves Masters of all their Trenches, in the mean time the Infidel's gave fire to a secret ours, which they had made a little within their Trenches, and blew up six of our Portugals, and eight Slaves, maiming many others besides; Now the smoke was such and so thick, as we could hardly discern one another, in regard whereof our General, fearing lest some greater loss than the former should befall him, retreated to the water side, carrying along with him both the dead bodies, and all the hurt men, and so went where his Foists lay, into the which every one being embarked, we returned with strength of rowing to the place from whence we came, where with extreme sorrow he caused the slain to be interred, and all that were hurt to be dressed, which were a very great number. The same day that was so fatal to us, a list being taken of all the surviving Soldiers, §. 3. that so it might be known how many had been lost in the l●st fight upon assaulting of the Trench, we found that of fourscore which we were, there was fifteen slain, fifty four hurt, and nine quite maimed for ever: The rest of the day, and the night following, we kept very good watch to avoid all surprises of the Enemy. As soon as the next morning appeared, there came an Ambassador from the Queen of Onor to the General Gonçallo, with a Present of Hens, Chickens, and new laid Eggs for the relief of our sick men; Now though we had great need of those things, yet in stead of receiving our General utterly refused them, and showing himself very much displeased with the Queen he could not forbear lashing out some words, that were a little more harsher than was requisite; saying, that the Viceroy should ere long be advertised of the bad Offices she had rendered the King of Portugal, and how much he was obliged to pay her that debt, when occasion should serve: Further he bid him tell her, that for an assurance of that which he said, he had left his son dead and buried in her Land, together with the other Portugals, who had been miserably slaughtered through her practices, by assisting the Turks against them: and in a word, that he would thank her more fully another time for the Present she had sent, the better to dissemble what she had executed against him, for which he would one day return her a recompense according to her merit. The Ambassador, very much terrified with this speech, departed; and being come to the Queen his Mistress, he so throughly represented Gonçallo's answer unto her, as she greatly doubted that this Galley would be an occasion of the loss of her Kingdom; wherefore to decline so great a mischief she thought it necessary to seek by all means possible to maintain the League with our General, to which end she assembled her Council, by whose advice she dispatched another Ambassador unto him, who was a Brachman, a grave and reverend personage, and her nearest kinsman. At his arrival where our Foists lay, our General gave him very good entertainment, and after the ordinary ceremonies and compliments the Brachman having demanded permission to deliver his Embassage; Signior, said he to our Governor, if you will give me audience, I will declare the cause of my coming hither from the Queen of Onor my Mistress. Hereunto Gonçallo replied, That Ambassadors had always assurance for their persons, and permission freely to deliver the particulars of their Embassy, so that he might boldly say what he would. The Brachman having thanked him, Verily, continued he, I am not able to express unto you, how sensible the Queen my Mistress is of the death of your son, and of those other Portugals, that were yesterday slain in the fight; And without lying I swear unto you by her life, and by this string of a Brachman that I wear, the mark of my Priestly dignity, and only proper to those which are of that profession, wherein I have been exercised from my youth, that she was so exceedingly afflicted at the notice of your disaster, and the unlucky success of your conflict, as she could not have been more vexed if she had been made to eat Cow's flesh (which is the greatest sin committed amongst us) at the principal gate of the Temple, where her father is interred: Whereby you may judge, Signior, what a share she bears of your sorrow. But since there is no remedy for things done, she desireth, and very instantly beseecheth you to confirm the Peace unto her anew which other Governors have always granted her heretofore; Whereunto she the rather entreats you, because she knows of what power you are with the Viceroy: Now that confirmed unto her, she assures you, and faithfully promiseth, within four days to burn the Galley, that hath put you to so much pain, and turn the Turks out of the limits of her Kingdom, which is all that she can do, and which you may be most confident she will not fail to execute accordingly. Our General knowing of what importance this affair was, §. 4. presently accepted of the brahmin's offer, and told him that he was contented that the League should be renewed betwixt them, according whereunto it was instantly published on either part with all the ceremonies accustomed in such cases; Thereupon the Brachman returned to the Queen, who afterwards laboured all she could to make good her word; But because Gonçallo could not stay the four days, which she had demanded, in regard of the extreme danger he should thereby have exposed our hurt men unto, he resolved to be gone, and so the same day after dinner we departed; Howbeit he first left one, named Georgio Neogueyra, there, with express order exactly to observe all that was done concerning that affair, and thereof to give certain intelligence to the Viceroy, as the Queen herself had requested. CHAP. VI What passed till such time as Pedro de Faria arrived at Malaca; his receiving an Ambassador from the King of Batas; with his sending me to that King, and that which arrived to me in that Voyage. §. 1. THe next day our General Gonçallo vaz Coutinho arrived at Goa, with so many of us as remained alive; There he was exceedingly welcomed by the Viceroy, unto whom he rendered an account of his Voyage, as also of that which he had concluded with the Queen of Onor, who had promised to burn the Galley within four days, and to chase the Turks out of all the Confines of her Kingdom, wherewith the Viceroy was very well satisfied. In the mean time after I had remained three and twenty days in the said Town of Goa, where I was cured of two hurts which I had received in fight at the Turks Trenches, the necessity whereunto I saw myself reduced, and the counsel of a Friar, my Friend, persuaded me to offer my service unto a Gentleman, named Pedro de Faria, that was then newly preferred to the Charge of Captain of Malaca, who upon the first motion was very willing to entertain me for a Soldier, and promised me withal to give me something over and above the rest of his Company during the Voyage which he was going to make with the Viceroy. For it was at that very time when as the Viceroy Dom Garcia de Noronha was preparing to go to the succour of the Fortress of Diu, which he certainly knew was besieged, and in great danger to be taken, by reason of the great Forces wherewithal it was invested by the Turk, and to relieve it the Viceroy had assembled a mighty Fleet at Goa, consisting of about two hundred and twenty five Vessels, whereof fourscore and three were great ones, namely Ships, Galleons, Carvels, and the rest Brigantins, Foists, and Galleys, wherein it was said there were ten thousand Land-men, and thirty thousand Mariners, besides a great number of Slaves. The time of setting sail being come, and the Foists provided of all things necessary, the Viceroy embarked himself on Saturday the fourteenth of November, 1538. Howbeit five days passed away before he put out of the Haven, in regard he stayed for his men that were not all ready to embark, the mean while a Catur arrived from the Town of Diu with a Letter from Antonio de Silveyra, Captain of the Fortress, whereby he advertised the Viceroy, that the Turks had raised the siege, and were retired. Now though these were good news, yet was the whole Fleet grieved thereat for the great desire every one had to fight with the Enemies of our Faith. Hereupon the Viceroy abode there five days longer, during the which he took order for all things necessary to the conservation of his Government of the Indias, and then commanding to hoist sail he departed from Goa on a Thursday morning the sixteenth of December: The four●eenth of his Navigation he went and cast anchor at Chaul, where he remained three days, during the which he entered into conference with Inezamuluco, a Mahometan Prince, and took order for certain affairs very much importing the surety of the Fortress: After that he cau●ed some of the Vessels of the Fleet to be rigged, which he furnished with Soldiers and Victuals, and then d●parted for to go to Diu; But it was his ill fortune, as he was crossing the Gulf, to be suddenly overtaken by such a furious Tempest, that it not only separated his Fleet, but was the loss of many Vessels, chiefly of the Bastard Galley, which was cast away at the mouth of the River Dabul, whereof Dom Alvero de Noronha, the Viceroys son, and General of the Sea-forces, was Captain; In the same Gulf also perished the Galley named Espinheyro, commanded by jovan de Sousa, howbeit the most part of their men were saved by Christophilo de Gama, who came most opportunely to their succour. During this Tempest there were seven other ships likewise cast away, the names of which I have forgotten, in so much that it was a month before the Viceroy could recover himself of the loss he had sustained, and re-assemble his Fleet again which this storm had scattered in divers places: At length the sixteenth of january, 1539. he arrived at the Town of Diu, where he caused the Fortress to be rebuilt, the greater part whereof had been demolished by the Turks, so as it seemed that it had been defended by the besieged, rather by miracle, than force: Now to effect it the better he made proclamation, that all the Captains with their Soldiers should each of them take in charge to rebuild that quarter, which should be allotted them; and because never a Commander there had more than Pedro de Faria, he thought fit to appoint him the Bulwark, which looked to the Sea, for his quarter, together with the outwall that was on the Lands side; wherein he bestowed such care and diligence, that in six and twenty days space, both the one and the other were restored to a better state than before, by the means of three hundred Soldiers that were employed about it. This done, for that it was the fourteenth of March, and a fit time for Navigation to Malaca, Pedro de Faria set sail for Goa, where by virtue of a Patent granted him by the Viceroy he furnished himself with all things necessary for his Voyage; Departing then from Goa on the thirteenth of April with a Fleet of eight Ships, four Foists, and one Galley, wherein there were five hundred men, he had so favourable a wind, that he arrived at Malaca the fifth day of june in the same year, 1539. Pedro de Faria succeeding Dons Estevano de Gama in the Charge of Captain of Malaca, §. 2. arrived there safely with his Fleet, nothing happening in his Voyage worthy of writing. Now because at his arrival, Estevan de Gama had not yet ended the time of his Commission, he was not put into the possession of that Government until the day that he was to enter upon his Charge. Howbeit, in regard Pedro de Faria was ere long to be Governor of the Fortress, the neighbouring Kings sent their Ambassadors to congratulate with him, and to make a tender of their amity, and of a mutual conservation of Peace with the King of Portugal. Amongst these Ambassadors there was one from the King of Batas, who reigned in the Isle of Samatra, where it is held for a surety that the Island of Gold is, which the King of Portugal, Dom joana the Third, had resolved should have been discovered by the advice of certain Captains of the Country. This Ambassador, that was Brother-in-law to the King of Batas, named Aquarem Dabolay, brought him a rich Present of Wood of Aloes, Calambaa, and five quintals of Benjamon in flowers, with a Letter written on the bark of a Palm tree, where these words were inserted. More ambitious than all men of the service of the crowned Lion, seated in the dreadful Throne of the Sea, the rich and mighty Prince of Portugal, thy Master and mine, to whom, in thee Pedro de Faria, I do now render obedience with a sincere and true amity, to the end I may become his Subject with all the purity and affection which a Vassal is obliged to carry unto his Master; I Angeessiry Timorraia, King of Batas, desiring to insinuate myself into thy friendship, that thy Subjects may be enriched with the fruits of this my Country, I do offer by a new Treaty to replenish the Magazines of thy King, who is also mine, with Gold, Pepper, Camfire, Benjamon, and Aloes, upon condition that with an entire confidence thou shalt send me a safe conduct, written and assigned with thine own hand, by means whereof all my Lanchares and Jurupanges may navigate in safety. Furthermore, in favour of this new amity, I do again beseech thee to succour me with some Powder and great Shot, whereof thou hast but too much in thy Storehouses, and therefore mayst well spare them; for I had never so great need of all kind of warlike munitions as at this present. This granted, I shall be much indebted to thee if by thy means I may once chastise those perjured Achems, the mortal and eminent Enemies of thy Malaca, with whom, I swear to thee, I will never have peace as long as I live, until such time as I have had satisfaction for the blood of my three children, which call upon me for vengeance, and that therewith I may assuage the sorrow of their noble Mother, who having given them suck, and brought them up, hath seen them since miserably butchered by that cruel Tyrant of Achem in the Towns of Jacur and Lingua, as thou shalt be more particularly informed by Aquarem Dabolay, the Brother of those children's desolate Mother, whom I have sent unto thee for a confirmation of our new amity, to the end, Signior, that he may treat with thee about such things as shall seem good unto thee, as well for the service of God, as for the good of thy people. From Paniau the fifth day of the eighth Moon. This Ambassador received from Pedro de Faria all the honour that he could do him after their manner, and as soon as he had delivered him the Letter it was translated into the Portugal out of the Malayan Tongue wherein it was written. Whereupon the Ambassador by his Interpreter declared the occasion of the discord, which was between the Tyrant of Achem, and the King of Batas, proceeding from this, that the Tyrant had not long before propounded unto this King of Batas, who was a Gentile, the embracing of Mahomet● Law, conditionally that he would wed him to a Sister of his, for which purpose he should quit his wife, that was also a Gentile, and married to him six and twenty years; Now because the King of Batas would by no means condescend thereunto, the Tyrant, incited by a Cacis of his, immediately denounced War against him: So each of them having raised a mighty Army, they fought a most bloody Battle, that continued three hours, and better, during the which the Tyrant perceiving the advantage the Bataes had of him, after he had lost a great number of his people, he made his retreat into a Mountain, called Cagerrendan, where the Bataes held him besieged by the space of three and twenty days, but because in that time many of the King's men fell sick, and that also the Tyrant's Camp began to want Victuals, they concluded a Peace, upon condition that the Tyrant should give the King five bars of Gold (which are in value two hundred thousand crowns of our money) for to pay his Soldiers, and that the King should marry his eldest son to that sister of the Tyrant, who had been the cause of making that War. This accord being signed by either part, the King returned into his Country, where he was no sooner arrived, but relying on this Treaty of Peace he dismissed his Army, and discharged all his Forces. The tranquillity of this Peace lasted not above two months and an half, in which time there came to the Tyrant three hundred Turks, whom he had long expected from the Strait of Mecqua, and for them had sent four Vessels laden with Pepper, wherein also were brought a great many Cases full of Muskets and Hargebusezes, together with divers Pieces both of Brass and Iron Ordnance. Whereupon the first thing the Tyrant did was to join those three hundred Turks to some Forces he had still afoot, then making as though he would go to Pacem for to take in a Captain that was revolted against him, he cunningly fell upon two places, named jacur and Lingua, that appertained to the King of Batas, which he suddenly surprised when they within th●m least thought of it, for the Peace newly made between them took away all the mistrust of such an attempt, so as by that means it was easy for the Tyrant to render himself Master of those Fortresses. Having taken them he put three of the King's sons to death, and seven hundred Ouroballones, so are the noblest and the valiantest of the Kingdom called. This while the King of Batas, much resenting, and that with good cause, so great a Treachery, swore by the head of his god Quiay Hocombinor, the principal Idol of the Gentiles sect, who hold him for their god of Justice, never to eat either fruit, salt, or any other thing, that might bring the least gust to his palate, before he had revenged the death of his children, and drawn reason from the Tyrant for this loss; protesting further, that he was resolved to die in the maintenance of so just a War. To which end, and the better to bring it to pass, the King of Batas straightway assembled an Army of fifteen thousand men, as well natives, as strangers, wherewithal he was assisted by some Princes his friends: and to the same effect he emplored the Forces of us Christians, which was the reason why he sought to contract that new amity, we have spoken of before, with Pedro de Faria, who was very well contented with it, in regard he knew that it greatly imported, both the service of the King of Portugal, and the conservation of the Fortress, besides that by this means he hoped very much to augment the Revenue of the Customs, together with his own particular, and all the rest of the Portugals profit, in regard of the great Trade they had in those Countries of the South. §. 3. After that the King of Batas Ambassador had been seventeen days with us, Pedro de Faria dismissed him, having first granted whatsoever the King his Master had demanded, and something over and above, as fire-pots, darts, and murdering Pieces, wherewith the Ambassador departed from the Fortress so contented, that he shed tears for joy, nay, it was observed, that passing by the great door of the Church, he turned himself towards it, with his hands and eyes lift up to Heaven, and then as it were praying to God; Almighty Lord, said he openly, that in rest and great joy livest there above seated on the Treasure of thy Riches, which are the spirits form by thy Will, here I promise thee, if it may be thy good pleasure to give us the victory against this Tyrant of Achem, and to permit us to regain that from him, which with such notable treachery he hath taken from us in those places of Jacur and Lingua, we will always most faithfully and sincerely acknowledge thee according to the Law of the Portugals, and according to that holy Verity, wherein consists the Salvation of all that are born in the world: Furthermore, in our Country we will build fair Temples unto thee, perfumed with sweet odours, where all living Souls shall on their bended knees adore thee, as it hath been always used to be done unto this present in the Land of Portugal. And hear what besides I promise, and swear unto thee with all the assuredness of a good and faithful servant, that the King my Master shall never acknowledge any other King than the great Portugal, who is now Lord of Malaca. Having made this protestation, he presently embarked himself in the same Lanchara, wherein he came thither, being accompanied with eleven or twelve Balons, which are small Barks, and so went to the Isle of Vpa, distant not above half a league from the Port. There the Bandara of Malaca (who is as it were chief Justicer amongst the Mahometans) was present in person by the express commandment of Pedro de Faria for to entertain him; And accordingly he made him a great Feast, which was celebrated with Oboe, Drums, Trumpets, and Cymbals, together with an excellent consort of voices framed to the tune of Harps, Lutes, and Viols after the Portugal manner. Whereat this Ambassador did so wonder, that he would often put his finger on his mouth, an usual action with those of that Country when they marvel at any thing. About twenty days after the departure of this Ambassador, Pedro de Faria being informed, that if he would send some Commodities from the Indias to the Kingdom of Batas, he might make great profit thereof, and much more of those which should be returned from thence, he to that effect set forth a jurupango, of the bigness of a small Carvel, wherein he ventured a matter of some ten thousand ducats; In this Vessel he sent, as his Factor, a certain Mahometan, born at Malaca, and was desirous to have me to accompany him, telling me that thereby I should not only much oblige him, but that also under pretext of being sent as Ambassador thither, I might both see the King of Batas, and going along with him in his journey against the Tyrant of Achem, which some way or other would questionless redound to my benefit. Now to the end that upon my return out of those Countries I might make him a true relation of all that I had seen, he prayed me carefully to observe whatsoever should pass there, and especially to learn whether the Isle of Gold, so much talked of, was in those parts, for that he was minded, if any discovery of it should be made, to write unto the King of Portugal about it. To speak the truth, I would fain have excused myself from this Voyage, by reason those Countries were unknown to me, and for that the inhabitants were by every one accounted faithless and treacherous, having small hope besides to make any gain by it, in regard that all my stock amounted not to above an hundred ducats; But because I durst not oppose the Captains desire I embarked myself, though very unwillingly, with that Infidel who had the charge of the Merchandise. Our Pilot steered his course from Malaca to the Port of Sorotilau, which is in the Kingdom of Aaru, always coasting the Isle of Samatra towards the Mediterranean Sea, till at length we arrived at a certain River, called Hicandure; After we had continued five days sailing in this manner we came to an Harbour, named Minhatoley, distant some ten leagues from the Kingdom of Peedir. In the end finding ourselves on the other side of the Ocean we sailed on four days together, and then cast anchor in a little river, called Gaateamgim, that was not above seven fathom deep, up the which we passed some seven or eight leagues. Now all the while we sailed in this River with a fair wind, we saw athwart a Wood, which grew on the bank of it, such a many Adders, and other crawling creatures, no less prodigious for their length, then for the strangeness of their forms, that I shall not marvel if they that read this History will not believe my report of them; especially such as have not traveled, for they that have seen little believe not much, whereas they that have seen much believe the more. All along this River, that was not very broad, there were a number of Lizards, which might more properly be called Serpents, because some of them were as big as an Almadia, with scales upon their backs, and mouths two foot wide. Those of the Country assured us, that these creatures are so hardy, as there be of them that sometimes will set upon an Almadia, chiefly when they perceive there is not above four or five persons in her, and overturn it with their tails, swallowing up the men whole, without dismembering of them. In this place also we saw strange kind of creatures, which they call Caquesseitan; They are of the bigness of a great Goose, very black, and scaly on their backs, with a row of sharp pricks on their chins, as long as a writing pen: Moreover, they have wings like unto those of Bats, long necks, and a little bone growing on their heads resembling a Cock's spur, with a very long tail spotted black and green, like unto the Lizards of that Country; These creatures hop and fly together, like Grasshoppers, and in that manner they hunt Apes, and such other beasts, whom they pursue even to the tops of the highest Trees. Also we saw Adders, that were copped on the crowns of their heads, as big as a man's thigh, and so venomous, as the Negroes of the Country informed us, that if any living thing came within the reach of their breath, it died presently, there being no remedy nor antidote against it. We likewise saw others, that were not copped on the crowns, nor so venomous as the former, but far greater and longer, with an head as big as a Calves. We were told that they hunt their prey in this manner: They get up into a tree, and winding their tails about some branch of it, let their bodies hang down to the foot of the tree, and then laying one of their ears close to the ground, they hearken whether they can hear any thing stir during the stillness of the night, so that if an Ox, a Boar, or any other beast doth chance to pass by, they presently seize on it, and so carries it up into the tree where he devours it. In like sort we descried a number of Baboons, both grey and black, as big as a great Mastiff, of whom the Negroes of the Country are more afraid, then of all the other beasts, because they will set upon them with that hardiness, as they have much ado to resist them. CHAP. VII. What happened to me at Penaiu with the King of Batas expedition against the Tyrant of Achem; and what he did after his Victory over him. §. 1. BY that time we had sailed seven or eight leagues up the River, at the end we arrived at a little Town, named Botterrendan, not above a quarter of a mile distant from Panaiu, where the King of Batas was at that time making preparation for the War he had undertaken against the Tyrant of Achem. This King understanding that I had brought him a Letter and a Present from the Captain of Malaca, caused me to be entertained by the Xabandar, who is he that with absolute power governs all the affairs of the Army: This General, accompanied with five Lanchares, and twelve Ballons, came to me to the Port where I road at anchor; Then with a great noise of Drums, Bells, and popular acclamations, he brought me to a certain Key of the Town, called Campalator; There the Bendara, Governor of the Kingdom, stayed for me in great solemnity, attended by many Our●balons and Amborraias, which are the noblest persons of his Court, the most part of whom, for all that, were but poor and base, both in their habit, and manner of living, whereby I knew that the Country was not so rich as it was thought to be in Malaca. When I was come to the King's Palace, and had passed through the first Court, at the entrance of the second I found an old woman, accompanied with other persons far nobler, and better apparelled then those that marched before me, who beckoning m● with her hand, as if she had commanded me to enter: Man of Malaca, said she unto me, Thy arrival in the King my Master's Land, is as agreeable unto him, as a s●owre of rain is to a crop of Rice in dry and hot weather; Wherefore enter boldly, and be afraid of nothing, for the people, which by the goodness of God thou seest here, are no other than those of thine own Country, since the hope which we have in the same God makes us believe that he will maintain us all together unto the end of the world. Having said so, she carried me where the King was, unto whom I did obeisance according to the man-of the Country, than I delivered him the Letter and the Present I had brought him, which he graciously accepted of, and asked me what occasion drew me thither. Whereunto I answered, as I had in commission, that I was come to serve his Highness in the Wars, where I hoped to 〈◊〉 the honour to attend on him, and not to leave him till such time as he returned Conqueror of his Enemies: Hereunto I likewise added, that I desired to see the City of Achem, as also the situation and fortifications of it, and what depth the River was of, whereby I might know whether it would bear great Vessels and Galleons, because the Captain of Malaca had a design to come and succour his Highness, as soon as his men were returned from the Indias, and to deliver his mortal Enemy, the Tyrant of Achem, into his hands. This poor King presently believed all that I said to be true, and so much the rather, for that it was conformable to his desire, in such sort, that rising out of his Th●one where he was set, I saw him go and fall on his knees before the carcase of a Cow's head, set up against the wall, whose horns were guilt, and crowned with flowers; Then lifting up his hands and eyes, O thou, said he, that not constrained by any material love, where●nto Nature hath obliged thee, dost continually make glad all those that desire thy milk, as the own mother doth him whom she hath brought into the world, without participating either of the miseries, or pains, which ordinarily she suffers from whom we take our Being, be favourable unto the prayer which now with all my heart I offer up unto thee: and it is no other but this, that in the meadows of the Sun, where with the payment and recompense which thou receivest, thou art contented with the good that thou dost here below, thou wilt be pleased to conserve me in the new amity of this good Captain, to the end he may put in execution all that this man here hath told me. At these words all the Courtiers, which were likewise on their knees, said three times as it were in answer, How happy were he that could see that, and then die incontinently? Whereupon the King arose, and wiping his eyes, which were all beblubbered with the tears that proceeded from the zeal of the prayer he had made, he questioned me about many particular things of the Indias, and Malaca. Having spent some time therein, he very courteously dismissed me, with a promise to cause the Merchandise, which the Mahometan had brought in the Captain of Mala●a's name, to be well and profitably put off, which indeed was the thing I most desired. Now for as much as the King at my arrival was making his preparations for to march against the Tyrant of Achem, and had taken order for all things necessary for that his Voyage, after I had remained nine days in Panaiu, the Capital City of the Kingdom of Batas, he departed with some Troops towards a place, named Turban, some five leagues of, where he arrived an hour before Sunset, without any manner of reception, or show of joy, in regard of the grief he was in for the death of his children, which was such as he never appeared in public, but with great demonstrations of sorrow. The next morning the King of Batas marched from Turban towards the Kingdom of Achem, §. 2. being eighteen leagues thither: He carried with him fifteen thousand men of War, whereof eight thousand were Bataes, and the rest Menancabes, Lusons', Andraguires, jambes, and Bournees, whom the Princes his neighbours had assisted him with, as also forty Elephants, and twelve Carts with small Ordnance, namely, Falcons, Bases, and other field Pieces, amongst the which there were three that had the Arms of France, and were taken in the year 1526. at such time as Lopo Vaz d● Sampayo governed the State of the Indias. Now the King of Batas marching five leagues a day came to a River, called Quilem; There by some of the Tyrant's Spies, which he had taken, he learned that his Enemy waited for him at Tondacur, two leagues from Achem, with a purpose to fight with him, and that he had great store of strangers in his Army, namely Turks, Cambayans, and Malabars: Whereupon the King of Batas assembling his Council of War, and falling into consultation of this affair, it was concluded as most expedient to set upon the Enemy before he grew more strong. With this resolution having quit the River he marched somewhat faster than ordinary, and arrived about ten of the clock in the night at the foot of a Mountain, half a league from the Enemy's Camp, where, after he had reposed himself a matter of three hours, he marched on in very good order, for which effect having divided his Army into four Squadrons, and passing along by a little hill, when he came to the end thereof he discovered a great Plain sowed with Rice, where the Enemy stood ranged in two Battalions. As soon as the two Armies descried one another, and that at the sound of their Trumpets, Drums, and Bells the Soldiers had set up a terrible cry, they encountered very valiantly together, and after the discharge of their shot on both sides, they came to fight hand to hand with such courage, that I trembled with fear to behold their fury. The Battle continued in this manner above an hour, and yet could it not possibly be discerned which party had the better. At last the Tyrant foreseeing, that if he persisted in the fight, he should lose the day, because he perceived his men to grow faint and weary, he retreated to a rising ground, that lay South of the Bataes, and about a Falcons shot distant from them. There his intention was to fortify himself in certain Trenches which before he had caused to be cast up against a Rock in form of a garden, or tilth of Rice; But a brother to the King of Andraguire interrupted his design, for stepping before him with two thousand men, he cut off his way, and stopped him from passing further, in so much that the medley grew to be the same it was before, and the fight was renewed between them with such fury, as cruelly wounding one another, they testified sufficiently how they came but little short of other Nations in courage. By this means the Tyrant, before he could recover his Trenches, lost fifteen hundred of his men, of which number were the hundred and threescore Turks, that a little before were come to him from the Strait of Mecqua, with two hundred Sarrazins, Malabars, and some Abissins', which were the best men he had; Now because it was about midday, and therefore very hot, the King of Batas retired towards the Mountain, where he spent the rest of the day in causing those that were wounded to be looked unto, and the dead to be buried. Hereupon, not being well resolved what to do, in regard he was altogether ignorant of the Enemy's design, he took care to have good watch kept all that night in every part. The next morning no sooner began the Sun to appear but he perceived the Valley, wherein the Achems had been the day before, to be quite abandoned, and not one of them to be seen there, which made him think the Enemy was defeated: In this opinion, the better to pursue the first point of his Victory, he dismissed all the hurt men, as being unfit for service, and followed the Tyrant to the City, where arriving two hours before Sunset, to show that he had strength and courage enough to combat his Enemies, he resolved to give them proof of it by some remarkable action before he would encamp himself; To which effect he fired two of the Suburbs of the Town, as also four Ships, and two Galleons, which were drawn on Land, and were those that had brought the Turks from the Strait of Mecqua: And indeed the fire took with such violence on those six Vessels, as they were quite consumed in a very little time, the Enemy not daring to issue forth for to quench it. After this, the King of Batas seeing himself favoured by Fortune, to lose no opportunity began to assault a Fort, called Penacao, which with twelve Pieces of Ordnance defended the entry of the River, to the Scalado of this he went in person, his whole Army looking on, and having caused some seventy or eighty ladders to be planted, he behaved himself so well, that with the loss only of seven and thirty men he entered the place, and put all to the sword that he found in it, to the number of seven hundred persons, without sparing so much as one of them. Thus did he on the day of his arrival perform three memorable things, whereby his Soldiers were so heartened, as they would fain have assaulted the City the very same night if he would have permitted them, but in regard it was very dark, and his men weary, he gave thanks to God, and contented himself with that which he had done. §. 3. The King of Batas held the City besieged by the space of three and twenty days, during the which two sallies were made, wherein nothing past of any reckoning, for there were but ten men slain on either part; Now as victories and good success in War do ordinarily encourage the victorious, so oftentimes it happens that the weak become strong, and cowards so hardy, as laying aside all fear they dare undertake most difficile and dangerous things▪ whence also it as often falls out, that the one prospers, and the other is ruined, which appeared but too evidently in that which I observed of these two Princes; For the King of Batas, seeing that the Tyrant had shut himself up in his City, thereby as it were confessing that he was vanquished, grew to such an height of confidence, that both he and his people believing it was impossible for them to be resisted, and trusting in this vain opinion, that blinded them, were twice in hazard to be lost by the rash and inconsiderate actions which they entered into. In the third sally, made by the inhabitants, the King of Batas people encountered them very lustily in two places, which those of Achem perceiving▪ they made as though they were the weaker, and so retreated to the same Fort, that was taken from them by the Bataes the first day of their arrival, being closely followed by one of the King's Captains, who taking hold of the opportunity, entered pellmell with the Achems, being persuaded that the Victory was sure his own; But when they were all together in the Trenches the Achems turned about, and making head afresh defended themselves very courageously▪ At length in the heat of their medley, the one side endeavouring to go on, and the other to withstand them, those of Achem gave fire to a Mine they had made, which wrought so effectually, as it blew up the Captain of the Bataes, and above three hundred of his Soldiers, with so great a noise, and so thick a smoke, as the place seemed to be the very portraiture of Hell: In the mean time the Enemies giving a great shout, the Tyrant sallied forth in person, accompanied with five thousand resolute men, and charged the Bataes very furiously; Now for that neither of them could see one another by reason of the smoke proceeding from the Mine, there was a most confused and cruel conflict between them, but to speak the truth I am not able to deliver the manner of it, sufficeth it that in a quarter of an hours space, the time this fight endured, four thousand were slain in the place on both sides, whereof the King of Batas lost the better part, which made him retire with the remainder of his Army to a Rock, called Minacaleu, where causing his hurt men to be dressed, he found them to be two thousand in number, besides those that were killed, which because they could not be so suddenly buried were thrown into the current of the River. Hereupon the two Kings continued quiet for four days after, at the end whereof one morning, when nothing was less thought of, there appeared in the midst of the River on Penaticans' side a Fleet of fourscore and six Sails, with a great noise of music, and acclamations of joy: At first this object much amazed the Bataes, because they knew not what it was, howbeit the night before their scouts had taken five fishermen, who put to torture confessed, that this was the Army which the Tyrant had sent some two months before to Tevassery, in regard he had War with the Sornau, King of Siam, and it was said that this Army was composed of five thousand Lussons and Sornes, all choice men, having to their General a Turk▪ named Hametecam, Nephew to the Bassa of Cairo. Whereupon the King of Batas making use of these fisher-men's confession, resolved to retire himself in any sort whatsoever, well considering that the time would not permit him to make an hours stay, as well because his Enemy's Forces were far greater than his, as for that every minute they expected succours from Pedir and Pazen, whence, as it was reported for certain, there were twelve ships full of strangers coming. No sooner was the King fortified in this resolution, but the night ensuing he departed very sad, and ill contented for the bad success of his enterprise, wherein he had lost above three thousand and five hundred men, not comprising the wounded, which were more in number, nor those that were burnt with the fire of the Myn●. Five days after his departure he arrived at Panaiu, where he dismissed all his Forces, both his own subjects and strangers; That done, he embarked himself in a small Lanchara, and went up the River without any other company then two or three of his Favourites: With this small retinue he betook himself to a place, called Pachissaru, where he shu● himself up for fourteen days, by way of penance, in a Pagod of an Idol, named Gi●nasser●d, which signifies the God of Sadness. At his return to Panaiu he sent for me, and the Mahometan that brought Pedro de Faria's Merchandise; The first thing that he did was to inquire particularly of him whether he made a good sale of it, adding withal, that if any thing were still owing to him he would command it to be presently satisfied; Hereunto the Mahometan and I answered, that through his Highness' favour all our business had received a very good dispatch, and that we were well paid for that we had sold, in regard whereof the Captain of Malaca would not fail to acknowledge that courtesy, by sending him succour for to be revenged on his Enemy the Tyrant of Achem, whom he would enforce to restore all the places, which he had unjustly usurped upon him. The King hearing me speak in this manner stood a while musing with himself, and then in answer to my speech, A● Portugal, said he, since thou constrainest me to tell thee freely what I think, believe me not hereafter to be so ignorant, as that thou mayst be able to persuade me, or that I can be capable to imagine, that he, which in thirty years' space could not revenge himself, is of power to succour me at this present in so short a time; or if yet thou thinkest I deceive myself, tell me I pray thee now whence comes it that thy King and his Governors could not hinder this cruel King of Achem from gaining from you the Fort of Pazem, and the Galley which went to the Molu●quaes, as also three Ships in Queda, and the Gallion of Malaca, at such time as Garcia was Captain there, besides the four Foists that were taken since at Salengor, with the two Ships that came from Bengali, or Lop● Chanoc● 's jounk and Ship, as likewise many other Vessels, which I cannot now remember, 〈◊〉 the which, as I have been assured, this Inhuman h●th put to death above a thousand Portugals, and gotten an extreme rich bo●ty. Wherefore if this Tyrant should happen to come once more against me, how canst thou have me rely upon their word which have been so often overcome? I must of necessity then continue as I am with three of my children murdered, and the greatest part of my Kingdom destroyed, seeing you yourselves are not much more assured in your Fortress of Malaca. I must needs confess that this answer, made with so much resentment, rendered me so ashamed, knowing he spoke nothing but truth, that I durst not talk to him afterwards of any succour, nor for our honour reiterate the promises which I had formerly made him. CHAP. VIII. What past between the King of Batas and me, until such time as I embarked for Malaca; my Arrival in the Kingdom of Queda, and my return from thence to Malaca. THe Mahometan and I returning to our lodging, departed not in four days after, §. 1. employing that time in shipping an hundred Bars of Tin, and thirty of Benjamin, which were still on Land. Then being fully satisfied by our Merchants, and ready to go, I went to wait upon the King at his Passeiran, which was a great place before the Palace, where those of the Country kept their most solemn Fairs; There I gave him to understand, that now we had nothing more to do but to depart if it would please his Majesty to permit us: The entertainment that he gave me then was very gracious, and for answer he said to me, I am very glad for that Hermon Xabandar (who was chief General of the Wars) assured me yesterday that your Captain's commodities were well sold, but it may be that that which he told me was not so, and that he delivered not the truth for to please me, and to accommodate himself to the desire he knew I had to have it so, wherefore, continued he, I prithee declare unto me freely whether he dealt truly with me, and whether the Mahometan that brought them be fully satisfied, for I would not that to my dishonour those of Malaca should have cause to complain of the Merchants of Panaiu, saying, that they are not men of their word, and that there is not a King there who can constrain them to pay their debts; and I swear to thee by the faith of Pagan, that this affront would be no less insupportable to my condition, then if I should chance to make peace with that Tyrant, and perjured Enemy of mine, the King of Achem. Whereunto having replied, that we had dispatched all our affairs, and that there was nothing due to us in his Country; Verily, said he, I am very well pleased to hear that it is so, wherefore since thou hast nothing else to do here, I hold it requisite, that without any further delay thou shouldst go, for the ●●me is now fit to set sail, and to avoid the great heats that ordinarily are endured in passing the Gulf, which is the cause that ships are many times cast upon Pazem by foul weather at Sea, from which I pray God deliver thee, for I assure thee that if thy ill fortune should carry thee thither, the men of Achem would eat thee alive, and the Tyrant himself would have the first bite at thee, there being nothing in the world these Inhumanes so much vaunt of, as to car●y on the crest of their Arms the device of Drinkers of the troubled blood of miserable Ca●sers, who they say are come from the end of the world, calling them Tyrannical men, and Usurpers in a sovereign degree of other men's Kingdoms in the Indias, and Isles of the Sea. This is the title wherein they glory most, and which they attribute particularly to themselves, as being sent them from Mecqua in recompense of the golden Lamps, which they offered to the Alcoran of their Mahomet, as they use to do every year. Furthermore, although heretofore I 〈◊〉 often advised thy Captain of Malaca to take careful heed of this Tyrant of Achem, yet do not thou omit to advertise him of it once more from me; for know that he never had, nor shall have other thoughts then to labour by all means to expel him out of the Indias, and make the Turk Master of them, who to that end promiseth to send him great succours; but I hope that God will so order it, as all the malice and cunning of this disloyal wretch shall have a contrary success to his intentions. After he had used this language to me, he gave me a Letter in answer to my Embassage, together with a present, which he desired me to deliver from him to Captain de Faria; this was six small Javelins headed with Gold, twelve Cates of Calambuca Wood, every one of them weighing twenty ounces, and a box of exceeding value, made of a Tortoise sh●ll, beautified with Gold, and full of great seed pearl, amongst the which there were sixteen fair pearls of rich account: For myself, he gave me two Cates of Gold, and a little Courtel●●● garnished with the same. Then he dismissed me with as much demonstration of honour as he had always used to me before, protesting to me in particular, that the amity which he had contracted with our Nation should ever continue inviolable on his part. Thus I embarked myself with Aquarem Dab●lay, his Brother-in-law, who was the same he had sent Ambassador to Malaca, as I have related before. Being departed from the Port of Panaiu, we arrived about two hours in the ●ight at a little Island, called Apofingua, distant some league and an half from the mouth of the River, and inhabited by poor people, who lived by the fishing of Shad●. §. 2. The next morning, leaving that Island of Apofingua, we ran along by the coast of the Ocean Sea for the space of five and twenty leagues, until such time as at length we entered into the Strait of Minhagaruu, by which we came; then passing by the contrary coast of this other Mediterranean Sea, we continued our course along by it, and at last arrived near to Pullo Bugay: There we crossed over to the firm Land, and passing by the Port of junçalan, we sailed two days and an half with a favourable wind, by means whereof we got to the River of Parles in the Kingdom of Queda, there we road five days at anchor in expectation of a fit wind to carry us on. During that time, the Mahometan and myself, by the counsel of certain Merchants of the Country, went to visit the King with an Odiaa, or Present of divers things, that we thought were convenient for our design, which was received with much demonstration of being very well pleased therewith. When we came to his Court we found, that with a great deal of pomp, excellent music, dancing, and largess to the poor, he was solemnising the funerals of his Father, whom he himself had poynarded, of purpose for to marry his own mother, after he had gotten her with child: Wherewithal not being contented, to decline the murmur, which so wicked and horrible an act might provoke unto, he had made proclamation, that on pain of a most rigorous death no person whatsoever should be so daring, as to speak a word of that which had passed, and it was told us there, how for that cause he had most tyrannically put the principal Personages of his Kingdom, and a number of Merchants already to death, whose goods he had confiscated to his own use, and thereby enriched his Coffers with two millions of Gold; So that upon our arrival we perceived such a general fear to be amongst the people, as not the most hardy of them all durst so much as make the least mention in the world of it. Now in regard the Mahometan, my companion, named Coia Ale, was a man liberal of his tongue, and that would say any thing which came into his head, he persuaded himself, in regard he was a stranger, and the Captain of Malaca's Factor, that he might with more liberty than those of the Country talk what he listed, and the King not punish him for it, as he did his Subjects; But he found himself far short of his account, and this presumption cost him his life: For being invited to a feast by another Mahometan like himself, a Merchant stranger, born at Patana, when as they were both of them high with wine and meat, as I learned since, they began to talk boldly, and without any respect of the King's Brutality and Parricide, whereof the King, being incontinently advertised by Spies, which he had in every corner for that purpose, he caused the house to be presently invested, and all the guests to be apprehended, to the number of seventeen persons; These poor wretches were no sooner brought bound before him, but immediately, without observing any form of Justice, or hearing what they could say for themselves either good or bad, he commanded them to be put to a most cruel kind of death, called by them Gregoge, which is, to saw off the feet, hands, and heads of them that are condemned to it, as I beheld afterwards myself. This execution done, the King, fea●ing lest the Captain of Malaca should be offended for that he had executed his Factor thus with the rest, and therefore might arrest some goods that he had at Malaca, sent the night following for me to the jurupango, where I was sleeping, and altogether ignorant of that which had passed: understanding the King's pleasure away I went, and coming about midnight to the Palace I perceived in the outward Court a great many men in arms; the sight whereof I must confess put me into a mighty amazement and mistrust, because I could not imagine what should be the cause of it, and doubting lest it might be some such Treason as at other times they had practised against us, I would fain have returned, but they that accompanied me, judging that my fear proceeded from the Soldiers which I beheld there, bid me be afraid of nothing, for these men were only going forth to apprehend an offendor by the King's commandment; Having said thus with an intent to confirm me, I could not for all that be satisfied, but was seized with so terrible a fear, as I was not able to utter a word, howbeit at length recollecting myself a little, I signified to them the best I could, how if they would permit me to return to my Skiff for to fetch a thing which I had forgotten, I would give them forty Crowns in Gold; whereunto they answered, that if I would give them all the Silver in Malaca they would not let me go, for if they should, they were sure to lose their heads: This speech of theirs redoubled my fear, which yet increased when I saw myself invironned with twenty more of those armed men, who guarded me all that night. The next morning the King being advertised that I was there, commanded me to be brought unto him, into the next Court, where I found him mounted on an Elephant, and accompanied with an hundred persons besides those of his guard, which were far more in number; When he saw me coming towards him, much troubled, and indeed more dead than alive, he said twice to me, Be not afraid, but come nearer to me, and thou shalt know the cause why I sent for thee. Thereupon having made a sign to me with his hand that I should look that way he pointed me to, I turned me about and beheld a great many bodies extended on the place, and weltering in their own blood, amongst the which I presently knew the Mahometan, Coia Ale, with whom I came, which I no sooner perceived, but like a man distraught of his wits I cast myself at the feet of the Elephant whereupon the King road, and with tears in my eyes cried out, O Sir, have pity on me, and take me for thy slave, rather than cause me to end my days with the torments which have taken those out of the world whom I see here; I swear unto thee by the faith of a Christian, that I have not deserved death, as having no way offended thee; Consider likewise, I beseech thee, that I am Nephew to the Captain of Malaca, who will give thee any ransom for me thou wil● desire, as also that thou hast the jurupango, wherein I came, in thy Port, full of goods, all which thou mayst take it if thou pleasest. Hearing me speak in this sort, God forbid, said he, that ever I should do any such thing, no, no, be not afraid, but stand up, and recollect thyself, for I see well thou art much troubled, and when thou art in better case to hear me I will tell thee wherefore I caused the Moor, that came with thee, to be executed; and in good faith if he had been either a Portugal, or a Christian, I would not have put him to death, no, though he had killed mine own son. Howbeit perceiving, that all which he could say would not rid me of my fear, he commanded a pot of fresh water to be brought me, whereof I drunk a pretty quantity, and withal made one of his followers to fan me with a ventilow for to refresh me: A quarter of an hour, or thereabouts, was spent in this action, at the end thereof finding that I was so well recovered, as I was able with good sense to answer unto the questions he should ask me; Portugal, said he unto me, I know that thou hast bern told, since thy coming hither, how I killed my Father, as indeed I did, because I was sure he would have killed me, incited thereunto by the false reports of some of his slaves, would have made him believe that I had gotten my mother with child, whereof I had never so much as the least thought, whereby thou mayst see what ill tongues can do. Indeed it is true, that being most assured he had without all reason given such credit to those slanderous reports, as he was fully resolved to have taken away my life, to decline that imminent peril I prevented him, and caught him in the same snare he had laid for me; But God knows how much against my mind this fell out, and how I always made it my chiefest glory to render him the dutiful offices of a most obedient son, as it may well appear now at this present: for to keep my mother from being a sad and desolate widow, as many others are, seeing myself to be the cause of her misery, and obliged to comfort her, I have taken her to wife; judge then whether I have been wrongfully blamed, or no, since that for her I have refused many great parties, that have been propounded unto me from Patacia, Berdio, Tanauçarin, Siaca, jamba, and Andragia, who were no less than Sisters and Daughters of Kings, and offered unto me with very rich dowries. Now being informed that such false reports had been dispersed abroad of me, for to arrest the tongues of Detractors, which are so audacious as to talk of any thing comes in their heads, I caused it to be proclaimed, that none should dare to speak of that affair; But for as much as without any regard at all of this my Injunction, this fellow of thine, which lies there in the company of those other Dogs, like unto himself, spoke yesterday of me most reproachfully in public, saying, I was an Hog, or worse than a very Hog, and my mother a salt Bitch; as well to punish his slanders, as to preserve my honour, I was constrained to put him to death, together with these other Dogs, who were no less slanderous than he: Wherefore I am to desire thee, that as my friend thou wilt not think this procedure of mine any way strange. Now if thou shouldst happen to think, that I have done it on purpose to seize upon the Captain of Malaca's goods, be confident that I never meant it, & thou mayst truly certify him so much; For I swear unto thee by my Law, that I have ever been a great friend to the Portugals, and so will continue all my life. Hereupon being somewhat recovered from the fear I was in a little before, I answered him, How his Highness had much obliged his very good friend, and brother, the Captain of Malaca, by the execution of that Mahometan, who had embezzled away a great part of the goods committed to his charge, and understanding that I had discovered his knavery he had twice gone about to poison me; whereunto also I added, how this Dog when he was drunk would bark at every one, and speak his pleasure at large. This answer made upon the sudden, and not knowing well what I said, very much pleased the King, who commanding me to come nearer to him, Verily, continued he, by this speech of thine I perceive thou art an honest man, and my friend, and being so I doubt not but thou wilt give a good interpretation to my actions, contrary to those mastiff Dogs that lie there weltering in their own blood. Having said so, he took a purse from his girdle trimmed with gold, and gave it me, as also a Letter directed to Pedro de Faria, whereupon I took my leave of him, with a promise that I would stay there a week longer; howbeit getting speedily aboard my jurupango, I made not a minutes stay, but instantly caused the Mariners to hoist sail, and away, still imagining that some were following to apprehend me, by reason of the extreme fear I was in, having so lately escaped, as I thought, the danger of a most cruel death. §. 3. Being departed from the River of Parles on a Saturday about Sunset, I made all the speed that possibly I could, and continued my course until the Tuesday following, when it pleased God that I reached to the Isles of Pullo Sambalin, the first Land on the Coast of Mallayo. There by good fortune I met with three Portugal ships (whereof two came from Bengala, and the other from Pegu) commanded by Tristan de Gaa, who had sometimes been Governor of the person of Don Lorenzo, son to the Viceroy Don Francisco d' Almeda, that was afterward put to death by Miroocem in Chaul Road, as is at large delivered in the History of the Discovery of the Indias. This same Tristan furnished me with many things that I had great need of, as tackle, and Mariners, together with two Soldiers, and a Pilot; moreover, both himself and the other to ships had always a care of me until our arrival at Malaca▪ where dis-imbarquing myself, the first thing I did was to go to the Fortress for to salute the Captain, and to render him an account of the whole success of my Voyage, where I discoursed unto him at large what Rivers, Ports, and Havens I had newly discovered in the Isle of Samatra, as well on the Mediterranean, as on the Ocean Seas side, as also what commerce the inhabitants of the Country used; Then I declared unto him the manner of all that Coast, of all those Ports, and of all those Rivers; whereunto I added the situations, the heights, the degrees, the names, and the depths of the Ports, according to the direction he had given me at my departure. Therewithal I made him a description of the Road wherein Rosado, the Captain of a French ship, was lost, and another, named Matelote de Brigas, as also the Commander of another ship, who by a storm at Sea was cast into the Port of Diu in the year 1529. during the reign of Sultan Bandur, King of Cambaya. This Prince having taken them all, made fourscore and two of them abjure their ●aith, who served him in his Wars against the great Mogor, and were every one of them miserably slain in that expedition. Moreover I brought him the description of a place fit for anchorage in Pullo Botum Roade, where the Bisquayn Ship suffered shipwreck, which was said to be the very same, wherein Mag●llan compassed the World, and was called the Vittoria, which traversing the Isle of jooa was cast a way at the mouth of the River of Sonda. I made him a recital likewise of many different Nations, which inhabit all along this Ocean, and the River of Lampon, from whence the Gold of Menancabo is transported to the Kingdom of Campar, upon the waters of jambes and Broteo. For the inhabitants affirm out of their Chronicles, how in this very Town of Lampon there was anciently a Factory of Merchants, established by the Queen of Sheba, whereof one, named Nausem, sent her a great quantity of Gold, which she carried to the Temple of jerusalem, at such time as she went to visit the wise King Solomon; From whence, some say, she returned with child of a son, that afterwards succeeded to the Empire of Aethiopia, whom now we call Prester-Iohn, of whose race the Abissins' vaunt they are descended. Further, I told him what course was usually held for the fishing of seed pearl betwixt Pullo Tiquos and Pullo Quenim, which in times past were carried by the Bataes to Pazem and Pedir, and exchanged with the Turks of the Strait of Mecqua, and the Ships of Iud●a, for such Merchandise as they brought from Grand Cairo, and the Ports of Arabia Foelix. Divers other things I recounted unto him, having learned them of the King of Batas, and of the Merchants of Pan●i●: And for conclusion, I gave him an information in writing, as he had formerly desired me, concerning the Island of Gold: I told him, how this Island is beyond the River of Calandor five degrees to the Southward, environed with many shelves of sand, and currents of water, as also that it was distant some hundred and threescore leagues from the point of the Isle of Samatra. With all which reports Pedro de Faria remained so well satisfied, that he made present relation thereof to the King Don jovan the Third of happy memory, who the year after ordained Francisco d' Almeida for Captain to discover the Isle of Gold, a Gentleman of merit, and very capable of that charge, who indeed had long before petitioned the King for it in recompense of the services by him performed in the Islands of Banda, of the Molucques, of Ternate, and Geilolo: But by ill fortune this Francisco d' Almeida, being gone from the India●s to discover that place, died of a fever in the Isles of Nicubar; Whereof the King of Portugal being advertised, he honoured one Diego Cabral, born at the Maderaes, with that Command, but the Court of Justice deprived him of it by express order from Martinez Alphonso de Sousa, who was at that time Governor, which partly proceeded, according to report, for that he had murmured against him; Whereupon he gave it to jeronimo Figuereydo, a Gentleman belonging to the Duke of Braganca, who in the year 1542. departed from Goa with two Foists, and one Carvel, wherein there were fourscore men, as well Soldiers, as Mariners; But it is said, that his Voyage was without effect, for that, according to the appearances that he gave of it afterward, it seemed that he desired to enrich himself too suddenly: To which end he passed to the Coast of Tanassery, where he took certain Ships, that came from Mecqua, Adem, Alcosser, judaa, and other places upon the Coast of Persia. And verily this booty was the occasion of his undoing, for upon an unequal partition thereof falling at difference with his Soldiers, they mutined in such fort against him, as after many affronts done him they bound him hand and foot, and so carried him to the Isle of Ceilan, where they set him on Land; and the Carvel, with the two Foists, they returned to the Governor Don joano de Castra, who in regard of the necessity of the time pardoned them the fault, and took them along with him in the Army, which he led to Diu for the succour of Don joana Mascarenhas, that was then straight besieged by the King of Cambaya's Forces. Since that time there hath been no talk of the discovery of this Island of Gold, although it seems very much to import the common good of our Kingdom of Portugal, if it would please God it might be brought to pass. CHAP. IX. The Arrival of an Ambassador at Malaca from the King of Aaru to the Captain thereof; his sending me to the said King, my coming to Aaru, and that which happened to me after my departing from thence. §. 1. FIve and twenty days after my coming to Malaca, Dom Stephano de Gama being still Captain of the Fortress, an Ambassador arrived there from the King of Aaru, for to demand succour of men from him, and some munitions of War, as Powder, and Bullets, for to defend himself from a great Fleet that the King of Achem was setting forth against him, with an intention to deprive him of his Kingdom, and so be a nearer neighbour unto us, to the end that having gained that passage, he might afterwards send his forces the more easily against our Fortress of Malaca: whereof Pedro de Faria was no sooner advertised, but representing unto himself how important this affair was for the service of the King, and preservation of the Fortress, he acquainted Dom Stephano de Gama with it, in regard his Command of the place was to continue yet six weeks longer; howbeit he excused himself from giving the succour, which was required, saying, that the time of his Government was now expiring, and that his being shortly to come in the duty of his charge did oblige him to take care of this business, and to think of the danger that menaced him. Hereunto Pedro de Faria made answer, that if he would relinquish his Government for the time he had yet to come in it, or give him full power to dispose of the public Magazines, he would provide for the succour that he thought was necessary. In a word, and not to stand long on that which passed betwixt them, it shall suffice to say, that this Ambassador was utterly denied his demand by these two Captains, whereof the one alleged for excuse, that he was not yet entered upon his Charge, and the other that he was upon the finishing of his: whereupon he returned very ill satisfied with this refusal, and so far resented injustice, which he thought was done unto his King, as the very morning wherein he embarked himself, having met by chance with the two Captains at the gate of the Fortress, he said aloud before them publicly with the tears in his eyes; O God that with a sovereign Power and Majesty raignest in the highest of the Heavens, even with deep sighs fetched from the bottom of my heart, I take thee for judge of my cause, and for witness of the just occasion I have to make this request to these Captains here, and that in the name of my King, the faithful Vassal of the great King of Portugal, upon homage sworn by his Ancestors to the famous Albuque●que, who promised us, that if the Kings of our Kingdom did always continue true and loyal Subjects to his Master, that then both he and his successors would oblige themselves to defend them against all their enemies, as belonged to their sovereign Lord to do; wherefore since we have continued still loyal to this day, what reason have you, my Masters, not to accomplish this obligation, wherein your King and you are so deeply engaged, especially seeing you know that only in respect of you this perfidious Tyrant of Achem takes our Country from us; For there is nothing he so much reproacheth us withal, as that my King is as good a Portugal, and Christian, as if he had been born in Portugal; and yet now that he desires you to succour him in his need, as allies and true friends ought to do, you excuse yourselves with reasons that are of no validity. The succour we require of you for to secure us, and to keep this faithless wretch from seizing on our Kingdom, is a very small matter, namely, forty or fifty Portugals, that may instruct us in the military art, together with four barrels of Powder, and two hundred Bullets for field Pieces; a poor thing in comparison of that you have. Now if you can yet be persuaded to grant us this little aid, you shall thereby so much oblige our King, as he will ever remain a faithful slave to the mighty Prince of Portugal, your Master and ours, in whose name I beseech you, once, twice, nay an hundred times, that you will perform that appertains unto your duty to do, for this which I thus publicly demand of you is of so great importance, that therein consists, not so much the preservation of the Kingdom of Aaru, as the safety of this your Fortress of Malaca, which that Tyrant of Achem our enemy so extremely desires to possess, and to that purpose he hath gotten the assistance of divers strange Nations; but because he finds that our Kingdom is a let to the execution of his design, he endeavours to usurp it upon us, and then he intends to guard this Strait in such sort, as he will quite exclude you from all Commerce with the Spices of Banda and the Molucques, and from all the Trade and Navigation of the Seas of China, Sunda, Borneo, Timor, and Jappon, and this his own people stick not to boast of even already, being also further manifested by the accord, which he hath lately made with the Turk, through the interpos●ure of the Bassa of grand Cairo, who in consideration thereof hath promised to ay● him with great Forces: Wherefore at length give ear unto the request which I have made unto you in the name of my King, and that so much concerns the service of yours, for since you may yet give a remedy to the mischief, which you see is ready to fall, I desire you to do it speedily; And let not one of you excuse himself by alleging that the time of his Government is almost at an end, nor the other, that he is not as yet entered upon his Charge, for it is sufficient that you know you are both of you equally obliged thereunto. Having finished this speech in form of a request, which availed him nothing, he stooped down to the ground, from whence taking up two stones, he knocked with them upon a Piece of Ordnance, and then the tears standing in his eyes he said, The Lord, who hath created us, will defend us if he please, and so embarking himself he departed greatly discontented for the bad answer he carried back. Five days after his departure Pedro de Faria was told how all the Town murmured at the small respect, that both he and Dom Stephano had carried to that poor King, who had ever been a friend both to them, and the whole Portugal Nation, and continually done very good offices to the Fort, for which cause his Kingdom was now like to be taken from him: This advice causing him to see his fault, and to be ashamed of his proceeding, he laboured to have palliated it with certain excuses, but at last he sent this King by way of succour fifteen quintals of fine Powder, an hundred pots of Wildfire, an hundred and fifty Bullets for great Ordnance, twelve Harquebusses, forty sacks of stones, threescore Head-pieces, and a Coat of guilt Mail, lined with Crimson Satin for his own person, together with many other garments of divers sorts, as also twenty pieces of Caracas, which are stained linen, or Cotten Tapestry, that come from the Indias, and cloth of Malaya, wherewith they usually apparel themselves in that Country, as well for his wife, as his daughters. All these things being laden aboard a Lanchara with oars, he desired me to conduct and present them from him to the King of Aaru, adding withal, that this business greatly concerned the King of Portugal's service, and that at my return, besides the recompense I should receive from him, he would give me an extraordinary pay, and upon all occasions employ me in such Voyages, as might redound to my profit; whereupon I undertook it, in an ill hour as I may say, and for a punishment of my sins, in regard of what arrived unto me thereupon, as shall be seen hereafter. So then I embarked myself on Tuesday morning, the fifth of October, 1539. and used such speed, that on Sunday following I arrived at the River of Panetican, upon which the City of Aaru is situated. I no sooner got to the River of Panetican, but presently landing I went directly to a Trench, §. 2. which the King in person was causing to be made at the mouth of the River for to impeach the Enemies dis-imbarquing; Presenting myself unto him, he received me with great demonstration of joy, whereupon I delivered him Pedro de Faria's Letter, which gave him some hope of his coming in person to succour him, if need required, with many other compliments, that cost little the saying, wherewith the King was wonderfully contented, because he already imagined that the effect thereof would infallibly ensue; But after he saw the Present I brought him, consisting of Powder, and Ammunitions, he was so glad, that taking me in his arms, My good friend, said be unto me, I assure thee that the last night I dreamt how all these things, which I behold here before me, came unto me from the King of Portugal, my Master's Fortress, by m●ans whereof, with God's assistance, I hope to defend my Kingdom, and to serve him, in the manner I have always hitherto done, that is, most faithfully, as all the Captains can very well testify, which have heretofore commanded in Malaca. Hereupon questioning me about certain matters, that he desired to know, as well concerning the Indias, as the Kingdom of Portugal, he recommended the finishing of the Trench to his people, who wrought very earnestly and cheerfully in it, and taking me by the hand, on foot as he was, attended only by five or six Gentlemen, ●e led me directly to the City, that was about some quarter of a league from the Trench, where in his Palace he entertained me most magnificently, yea and made me to salute his wife, a matter very rarely practised in that Country, and held for a special honour, which when I had done with abundance of tears he said unto me, Portugal, here is the cause that makes me so much to redoubt the coming of mine Enemies, for were I not withheld by my wife I swear unto thee by the Law of a good and true Moor, that I would prevent them in their designs without any other aid then of my own Subjects; for it is not now that I begin to know what manner of man the perfidious Achem is, or how far his power extends; Alas! it is the great store of Gold, which he possesseth, that covers his weakness, and by means whereof he wageth such forces of strangers, wherewith he is continually served: But now that thou mayst on the other side understand how vile and odious poverty is, and how hurtful to a poor King, such as I may be, come thee along with me, and by that little which I will presently let thee see thou shalt perceive, whether it be not too true, that Fortune hath been exceeding niggardly to me of her goods; Saying so, he carried me to his Orsenal, which was covered with thatch, and showed me all that he had within it, whereof he might say with reason, that it was nothing in comparison of what he needed for to withstand the attempts of two hundred and thirty Vessels, replenished with such warlike people, as the Achems and Mulabar Turks were; Moreover, with a sad countenance, and as one that desired to discharge his mind of the grief he was in for the danger was threatened him, he recounted unto me, that he had in all but six thousand men Aaruns, without any other foreign succour, forty Pieces of small Ordnance, as Falconets, and Bases, and one cast Piece, which he had formerly bought of a Portugal, named Antonio de Garcia, sometimes Receiver of the Toll and Customs of the Ports of the Fortress of Pacem, whom Georgio ● ' Albuqurque caused since to be hanged and quartered at Malaca, for that he treated by Letters with the King of Bintham about a plot of Treason, which they had contrived together; He told me besides, that he had also forty Muskets, six and twenty Elephants, fifty Horsemen for the guard of the place, eleven or twelve thousand staves hardened in the fire, called Salignes, whose points were poisoned, and for the defence of the Trench fifty Lances, good store of Targets, a thousand pots of unslacked Lime made into Powder, and to be used in stead of pots of Wildfire, and three or four Barks full laden with great flints; In a word, by the view of these, and such other of his miseries, I easily perceived he was so unprovided of things necessary for his defence, that I presently concluded the Enemy would have no great ado to seize on this Kingdom: Nevertheless he having demanded of me what I thought of all this Ammunition in his Magazine, and whether there were not enough to receive the guests he expected, I answered him, that it would serve to entertain them; but he understanding my meaning stood musing a pretty while, and then shaking his head, Verily, said he unto me, if your King of Portugal did but know what a loss it would be to him, that the Tyrant of Achem should take my Kingdom from me, doubtless he would chastise the little care of his Captains, who, blinded as they are, and wallowing in their avarice, have suffered my Enemy to grow so strong, that I am much afraid they shall not be able to restrain him when they would, or if they could, that then it must be with an infinite expense. I laboured to answer this which he had said unto me with such resentment, but he confuted all my reasons with so much truth, as I had not the heart to make any farther reply; withal he represented divers foul and enormous actions unto me, wherewithal he charged some particulars amongst us, which I am contented to pass by in silence, both in regard they are nothing pertinent to my discourse, and that I desire not to discover other men's faults; For a conclusion of his speech, he related unto me the little punishment which was ordained for such as were culpable of these matters, and the great rewards that he had seen conferred on those which had not deserved them; whereunto he added, that if the King desired throughly to perform the duty of his Charge, and by Arms to conquer people so far distant from his Kingdom, and to preserve them, it was as necessary for him to punish the wicked, as to recompense the good. This said, he sent me to lodge in a Merchant's house, who for five days together, that I remained there, entertained me bravely, though to speak truth I had rather have been at that time in some other place with any poor victuals, for here I was always in fear, by reason of the Enemies continual alarms, and the certain news that came to the King the next day after my arrival, how the Achems were already marching towards Aaru, and would be there within eight days at the farthest, which made him in all haste to give directions for such things as he had not taken order for before, and to send the women, and all that were unfit for War, out of the City five or six leagues into the Wood, amongst the which the Queen herself made one, mounted on an Elephant. Five days after my arrival, the King sent for me, and asked me when I would be gone, whereunto I replied, at such time as it would please his Greatness to command me, though I should be glad it might be with the soon, for that I was to be employed by my Captain with his Merchandise to China: Thou hast reason, answered he; then taking two Bracelets of massy Gold off from his wrists, worth some thirty Crowns, I prithee now, said he, giving them to me, do not impute it to miserableness that I bestow so little on thee, for thou mayst be assured, that it hath been always my desire for to have much for to give much; withal I must desire thee to present this Letter, and this Diamond from me to thy Captain, to whom thou shalt say, that whatsoever I am further engaged to him in for the pleasure he hath done me by succouring me with those Ammunitions he hath sent me by thee, I will bring it to him myself hereafter, when I shall be at more liberty than now I am. Having taken leave of the King of Aaru, I presently embarked myself, §. 3. and departed about Sunset, rowing down the River to an Hamlet, that is at the entrance thereof, composed of ten or eleven houses covered with straw: This place is inhabited with very poor people, that get their living by killing of Lizards, of whose livers they make a poison, wherewith they anoint the heads of their arrows; For the poison of this place, chiefly that, which is called Pocausilim, is held by them the best of those Countries, because there is no remedy for him that is hurt with it. The next day, having left this small Village, we sailed along the coast with a land wind until evening, that we doubled the Islands of Anchepisan, than the day and part of the night following we put forth somewhat farther to Sea: But about the first watch the wind changed to the North-east, for such winds are ordinary about the Isle of Samatra, and grew to be so tempestuous, that it blew our mast over board, tore our sails in pieces, and so shattered our Vessel, that the water came in that abundance into her at two several places, as she sunk incontinently to the bottom, so that of eight & twenty persons, which were in her, three and twenty were drowned in less than a quarter of an hour. For as five that escaped by the mercy of God, we passed the rest of the night upon a Rock, where the waves of the Sea had cast us. There all that we could do was with tears to lament our sad fortune, not knowing what counsel or course to take, by reason the Country was so moorish, and invironned with so thick a Wood, that a bird, were she never so little, could hardly make way through the branches of it, for that the trees grew so close together; We sat crouching for the space of three whole days upon this Rock, where for all our sustenance we had nothing but Snails, and such filth, as the ●oam of the Sea produced there. After this time, which we spent in great misery and pain, we walked a whole day along by the Isle of Samatra, in the owze up to the girdlestead, and about Sunset we came to the mouth of a little River, some Crossbow-shot broad, which we durst not undertake to swim over, for that it was deep, and we very weak and weary; so that we were forced to pass all that night, standing up to the chin in the water. To this misery was there adjoined the great affliction which the Flies and Gnats brought us, that coming out of the neighbouring Woods, bit and stung us in such sort, as not one of us but was gore blood. The next morning as soon as we perceived day, which we much desired to see, though we had little hope of life, I demanded of my four companions, all Mariners, whether they knew the Country, or whether there was any habitation thereabout; Whereupon the eldest of them, who had a wife at Malaca, not able to contain his tears, Alas! answered he, the place that now is most proper for you, and me, is the house of death, where ere it be long we must give an account of our sins, it therefore behoves us to prepare ourselves for it without any further delay, and patiently to attend that which is sent us from the hand of God: For my part, let me entreat thee to be of a good courage whatsoever thou seest, and not be terrified with the fear of dying, since, every thing well considered, it matters not whether it be to day, or to morrow. This spoken, he embraced me, and with tears in his eyes desired me to make him a Christian, because he believed, as he said, that to be so was sufficient to save his Soul, which could not otherwise be done in the cursed sect of Mahomet, wherein he had lived till then, and for which he craved pardon of God. Having finished these last words, he remained dead in mine arms, for he was so weak, as he was not able to subsist any longer, as well for that he had not eaten ought in three or four days before, as in regard of a great wound the wrack of the Lanchara had given him in his head, through which one might see his brains all putrefied and corrupted, occasioned both for want of looking unto, as by salt water and flies that were gotten into it. Verily this accident grieved me very much, but for myself I was in little better case, for I was likewise so weak, that every step I made in the water I was ready to swoon, by reason of certain hurts on my head and body, out of which I had lost a great deal of blood. Having buried him in the owze the best we could, the other three Mariners and myself resolved to cross the River, for to go and sleep on certain great Trees, that we saw on the other side, for fear of the Tigers and Crocodiles, whereof that Country is full, besides many other venomous creatures, as an infinite of those copped Adders I have spoken of before in the sixth Chapter, and divers sorts of Serpents with black and green scales, whose venom is so contagious, as they kill men with their very breath. This resolution being thus taken by us, I desired two of them to swim over first, and the other to stay with me for to hold me up in the water, for that in regard of my great weakness I could hardly stand upon my legs: whereupon they two cast themselves presently into the water, exhorting us to follow them, and not be afraid; But alas! they were scarce in the midst of this River, when as we saw them caught by two great Lizards, that before our faces, and in an instant tearing them in pieces, dragged them to the bottom, leaving the water all bloody, which was so dreadful a spectacle to us, as we had not the power to cry out; and for myself, I knew not who drew me out of the water, nor how I escaped thence, for I was gone before into the River as deep as my waste, with that other Mariner which h●ld me by the hand. CHAP. X. By what means I was carried to the Town of Ciaca, and that which befell me there; my going to Malaca with a Mahometan Merchant; and the Tyrant of Achems' Army marching against the King of Aaru. FInding myself reduced to that extremity I have spoken of, I was above three hours so besides myself, §. 1. as I could neither speak, nor weep; At length the other Mariner and I went into the Sea again, where we continued the rest of that day. The next morning having discovered a Ba●que, that was seeking the mouth of the River, as soon as it was near we got out of the water, and falling on our knees with our hands lift up we desired them to come and take us up; whereupon they gave over rowing, and considering the miserable state we were in they judged immediately that we had suffered shipwreck, so that coming somewhat nearer they asked us what we desired of them; we answered, that we were Christians, dwelling at Malaca, and that in our return from Aaru we were cast away by a storm about nine days before, and therefore prayed them for God's sake to take us away with them whithersoever they pleased. Thereupon one amongst them, whom we guessed to be the chiefest of them, spoke to us thus, By that which I see, you are not in case to do us any service, and gain your meat, if we should receive you into our Bark, wherefore if you have any money hidden, you shall do well to give it us aforehand, and then we will use towards you that charity you require of us, for otherwise it is in vain for you to hope for any help from us: Saying so, they made show as though they would be gone; whereupon we besought them again weeping, that they would take us for slaves, and go sell us where they pleased; hereunto I added, how they might have any ransom for me they would require, as having the honour to appertain very nearly unto the Captain of Malaca. Well, answered he then, we are contented to accept of thy offer, upon condition, that if that which thou sayst be not true, we will cast thee, bound hand and foot, alive into the Sea. Having replied, that they might do so if they found it otherwise, four of them got presently to us, and carried us into their Bark, for we were so weak at that time, as we were not able to stir of ourselves. When they had us aboard, imagining that by whipping they might make us confess where we had hid our money, for still they were persuaded that we had som●, they tied us both to the foot of the Mast, and then with two double coards they whipped us till we were nothing but blood all over. Now because that with this beating I was almost dead, they gave not to me, as they did to my companion, a certain drink, made of a kind of Lime, ●●eep●d in Urine, which he having taken it, made him fall into such a furious vomiting, as he cast up both his lungs and his liver, so as he died within an hour after. And for that they found no gold come up in his vomit, as they hoped, it pleased God that that was the cause why they deal● not so with me, but only they washed the stripes they had given me with the said liquor, to keep them from festering, which notwithstanding put me to such pain, as I was even at the point of death. Being departed from this River, which was called Arissumhea, we went the next day after dinner ashore at a place, where the houses were covered with straw, named Ciaca, in the Kingdom of jambes, there they kept me seven and twenty days, in which time by the assistance of Heaven I got myself throughly cured of all my hurts. Then they that had a share in my person, who were seven in number, seeing me unfit for their Trade, which was fishing, exposed me to sale three several times, and yet could meet with no body that would buy me; whereupon being out of hope of selling me, they turned me out of doors, because they would not be at the charge of feeding me. I had been six and thirty days thus abandoned by these Inhumanes, and put a grazing like a cast Horse, having no other means to live but what I got by begging from door to door, which God knows was very little, in regard those of the Country were extreme poor, when as one day, as I was lying in the Sun upon the sand by the Sea side, and lamenting my ill fortune with myself, it pleased God that a Mahometan, born in the Isle of Palimban, came accidentally by: This man, having been sometimes at Malaca in the company of Portugals, beholding me lie naked on the ground, asked me if I were not a Portugal, and willed me to tell him the truth; whereunto I answered, that indeed I was one, and descended of very rich parents, who would give him for my ransom whatsoever he would demand, if he would carry me to Malaca, where I was Nephew to the Captain of the Fortress, as being the son of his sister. The Mahometan hearing me say thus, If it be true, replied he, that thou art such as thou deliverest thyself to be, what so great sin hast thou committed that could reduce thee to this miserable estate wherein I now see thee? Then I recounted to him from point to point how I was cast away, and in what sort the fishermen had first brought me thither in their Bark, and afterwards had turned me out to the wide world, because they could not find any body that would buy me. Hereat he seemed to be much astonished, so that musing a pretty while by himself, Know stranger, said he unto me, that I am but a poor Merchant, all whose wealth amounts not to above an hundred Pardains (which are worth two shillings a piece of our money) with which I trade for the rows of Shads, thereby hoping to get my living; Now I am assured that I might gain something at Malaca, if so be the Captain, and the Officers of the Custom-house there, would not do me the wrong, which I have heard say they do to many Merchants that come thither to traffic; wherefore if thou thinkst that for thy sake I should be well used there, I could be contented to redeem thee from the fishermen, and go thither with thee. Thereunto I answered him, with tears in mine eyes, that considering the state I was in at the present, it was not likely he could give credit to any thing I said, because it was probable that to free myself out of my miserable captivity I would prise my person at a far higher value than it would be esteemed for at Malaca; howbeit if he would lend any belief to my oaths, since I had no other assurance to give him, I would swear to him, and also set it under my hand, that if he would carry me to Malaca, the Captain should do him a great deal of honour for my sake, and besides the exempting of his Merchandise from paying of custom, he should receive ten times as much as he should disburse for me. Well, replied the Mahometan, I am contented to redeem, and reconduct thee to Malaca, but thou must take heed that thou speakest not a word of that we have concluded on, for fear thy Masters hold thee at so dear a rate, as I shall not be able to draw thee out of their hands though I would never so fain; whereupon I gave him my faith to do nothing but what he would have me do, especially in that particular, which I held to be most necessary for the better effecting of our desire. Four days after this agreement, the Mahometan Merchant, §. 2. that he might the more easily redeem me, used the interposure of a man born in the Country, who under hand went to the fishermen, and carried the business so cunningly with them, as they quickly consented to my redemption, for they were already very weary of me, as well in regard that I was sickly, as for that I could no way stand them in any stead, and therefore, as I delivered before, they had turned me out of doors, where I had continued a month and better; so by the means of this third person, whom the Mahometan had employed, the fishermen sold me to the Merchant for the sum of seven mazes of gold, which amounts in our money to seventeen shillings and six pence. The Mahometan as soon as he had redeemed me, brought me to his house, where I was five days out of the tyranny of these fishermen, and in a far better captivity than the former; At the end whereof my new Master went five leagues off to a place, named Sorobaya, where he got his Merchandise aboard, which, as I said before, was nothing but the rows of Shads; For there is such great abundance of them in that River, as the Inhabitants do therewith every year lad above two thousand Vessels, which carry at least an hundred and fifty, or two hundred Barrels, whereof each one contains a thousand rows, the rest of the fish not yielding them a penny. After that the Mahometan had laden a Lanchara with this commodity, he presently set sail for Malaca, where within a while he safely arrived, and carrying me to the Fortress presented me to the Captain, relating unto him what agreement we had made together. Pedro de Faria was so amazed to see me in such a lamentable plight, as the tears stood in his eyes, whereupon he bade me speak out aloud, that he might know whether it was I that he beheld, for that I did not seem to be myself, in regard of the strange deformity of my face. Now because that in three months' space there had been no news of me, and that every one thought me to be dead, there came so manyfolks to see me, as the Fortress could scarce hold them: Here being demanded the occasion of my misfortune, and who had brought me into that miserable case, I recounted the adventures of my Voyage, just in the same manner as I have already delivered them, whereat the whole company were so astonished, that I saw some go away without speaking a word, and others shrink up their shoulders, and bless themselves in admiration of that which they had heard from me; but in conclusion their compassion towards me was such, that with the very alms they bestowed on me I became far richer than I was before I undertook that unlucky Voyage. As for Pedro de Faria, he caused threescore ducats to be given to the Mahometan Merchant that brought me, besides two pieces of good China Damask; moreover he freed him of all the duties he was to pay for the custom of his Merchandise, which amounted to very near a like sum, so as he remained exceeding well satisfied of the bargain he had made with me. After this, to the end I might be the better used and looked unto, the Captain commanded me to be lodged in the Registers house of the King's Customs, where for that he was married there he thought I might be better accommodated then in any other place, as indeed I was very well entreated by him and his wife, so that having kept my bed about the space of a month, it pleased God to restore me unto my perfect health. §. 3. When I had recovered my health, Pedro de Faria sent for me to the Fortress, where he questioned me about that which had passed betwixt me and the King of Aaru, as also how and in what place I was cast away, whereupon I made him an ample relation thereof. But before I proceed any further, it is requisite I should here report what was the success of the War between the Kings of Aaru and Achem, to the end, that the desolation, which I have so often foretold, of our Fortress of Malaca, may the more evidently appear, it being a matter of too much importance for to be so neglected as it is by those, who ought to have more care of it. For this is certain, that either the power of the King of Achem is utterly to be ruined, or by it we shall be miserably expelled out of all the Countries we have conquered all along the Southern Coast, as Malaca, Banda, Maluco, Sunda, Borneo, and Timor, and Northwards, China, japan, and the L●qmos, as also many other parts and Ports, where the Portugals are very much interessed by reason of the Traffic which they daily use there, and where they reap more profit than in any other place, that is yet discovered, beyond the Cape of good hope, the extent thereof being so great, that it contains along the Coast above three thousand leagues, as may easily be seen by the cards and globes of the world, if so be their graduation be true. Besides, if this loss should happen, which God of his infinite mercy forbid, though we have but two much deserved it for our carelessness and sins, we are in danger in like manner to lose the Customs of Mandorim of the City of Goa, which is the best thing the King of Portugal hath in the Indias, for they are Ports and Islands, mentioned heretofore, whereon depends the greatest part of his Revenue, not comprehending the Spices, namely, the Nutmegs, Cloves, and Maces, which are brought into this Kingdom from those Countries. Now to return to my discourse, I say, that the Tyrant of Achem was advised by his Council how there was no way in the world to take Malaca, if he would assail it by Sea, as he had done divers times before, when as Dom Stephano de Gama and his Predecessors were Captains of the Fortress, but first to make himself Master of the Kingdom of Aaru, to the end he might afterwards fortify himself on the River of Panetican, where his Forces might more commodiously and nearly maintain the War he intended to make: For than he might have means with less charge to shut up the straits of Cincapura, and Sabaon, and so stop our Ships from passing to the Seas of China, Sunda, Banda, and the Molucques, whereby he might have the profit of all the Drugs which came from that great Archipelague; And verily this counsel was so approved by the Tyrant, that he prepared a Navy of an hundred and threescore Sails, whereof the most part were Lanchares with oars, Galiots, Calabuzes of jaoa, and fifteen Ships high built, furnished with Munition and Victual. In these Vessels he embarked seventeen thousand men, namely twelve thousand Soldiers, the rest Sailors and pioneers. Amongst these were four thousand Strangers, Turks, Abissins', Malabares, Gusurates, and Lusons' of the Isle of Borneo. Their General was one, named Heredin Mahomet, Brother-in-law to the Tyrant, by marriage with a Sister of his, and Governor of the Kingdom of Baarros. This Fleet arrived safely at the River of Panetican, where the King of Aaru attended them with six thousand of his own natural Subjects, and not a foreigner amongst them, both in regard he wanted money for to entertain Soldiers, and that also he had a Country unprovided of victual to feed them. At their arrival the Enemies found them fortifying of the Trench, whereof I spoke heretofore; Whereupon without any further delay they began to play with their Ordnance, and to batter the Town on the Sea side with great fury, which lasted six whole days together. In the mean time the besieged defended themselves very valiantly, so as there was much blood spilt on either side: The General of the Achems, perceiving he advanced but little, caused his Forces to Land, and mounting twelve great Pieces he renewed the battery three several times with such impetuosity, that it demolished one of the two Forts that commanded the River, by means whereof, and under the shelter of certain packs of Cotton which the Achems carried before them, they one morning assaulted the principal Fortress: In this assault an Abissin commanded, called Mamedecan, who a month, or thereabout, before was come from juda, to confirm the new League made by the Bassa of Cairo on the behalf of the grand Signior with the Tyrant of Achem, whereby he granted him a Custom-house in the Port of Pazem. This Abissin rendered himself Master of the Bulwark, with threescore Turks, forty janissaries, and some Malabar Moo●s, who instantly planted five Ensigns on the walls; In the mean time the King of Aaru, encouraging his people with promises, and such words as the time required, wrought so effectually, that with a valorous resolution they set upon the Enemy, and recovered the Bulwark which they had so lately lost, so as the Abissin Captain was slain on the place, and all those that were there with him. The King following his good fortune, at the same instant caused the gates of the Trench to be opened, and sallying out with a good part of his Forces, he combated his Enemies so valiantly, as he quite routed them; In like manner he took eight of their twelve Pieces of Ordnance, and so retreating in safety he fortified himself the best he could for to sustain his Enemies future assaults. CHAP. XI. The Death of the King of Aaru, and the cruel justice that was executed on him by his Enemies; the going of his Queen to Malaca, and her reception there. THe General of Achem, seeing the bad success which he received in this encounter, §. 1. was more grieved for the death of the Abissin Captain, and the loss of those eight Pieces of Ordnance, then for all them that were slain besides; whereupon he assembled his Council of War, who were all of opinion that the commenced siege was to be continued, and the Trench assailed on every side, which was so speedily put in execution, that in seventeen days it was assaulted nine several times, in so much as by divers sorts of fireworks, continually invented by a Turkish Engineer, that was in their Camp, they demolished the greater part of the Trench; Moreover they overthrew two of the principal Forts on the South side, together with a great Platform, which in the manner of a falsebray defended the entry of the River, notwithstanding all the resistance the King of Aaru could make with his people, though they behaved themselves so valiantly, as the Achems lost above two thousand and five hundred men, besides those that were hurt, which were far more than the slain, whereof the most part died shortly after for want of looking to. As for the King of Aaru, he lost not above four hundred men, howbeit for that his people were but few, and his Enemies many, as also better ordered, and better armed, in the last assault, that was given on the thirteenth day of the Moon, the business ended unfortunately by the utter defeat of the King of Aarus Forces; For it was his ill hap, that having made a sally forth by the advice of a Cacis of his, whom he greatly trusted, it fell out that this Traitor suffering himself to be corrupted with a bar of gold, weighing about forty thousand ducats, which the Achem gave him, whereof the King of Aaru being ignorant, set courageously on his Enemies, and fought a bloody battle with them, wherein the advantage remained on his side in all men's judgement, but that Dog, the perfidious Cacis, whom he had left Commander of the Trench, sallied forth with five hundred men, under colour of seconding the King in his pursuit of so prosperous a beginning, and left the Trench without any manner of defence, which perceived by one of the Enemy's Captains, a Mahometan Malabar, named Cutiale Marcaa, he presently with six hundred Gusarates and Malabars, whom he had led thither for that purpose, made himself Master of the Trench, which the traitorous Cacis for the bar of gold he had received had left unguarded, and forthwith put all the sick and hurt men that he found there to the sword, amounting to the number of about fifteen hundred, whereof he would not spare so much as one. In the mean time the unhappy King of Aaru, who thought of nothing less than the treachery of his Cacis, seeing his Trench taken, ran to the succoring of it, being a matter that most imported him: But finding himself the weaker, he was constrained to quit the place, so that as he was making his retreat to the Town ditch, it was his ill fortune to be killed by a shot of an Harquebuse from a Turk his enemy. Upon this death of his ensued the loss of all the rest, by reason of the great disorder it brought amongst them. Whereat the Enemies exceedingly rejoicing, took up the Corpse of that wretched King, which they found amongst the other dead bodies, and having embowelled and salted him they put him up in a Case, and so sent him as a Present to the Tyrant, who, after many ceremonies of Justice, caused him to be publicly sawed into sundry pieces, and then boiled in a great Cauldron full of Oil and Pitch, with a dreadful Publication, the tenor whereof was this: See here the justice, which Sultan Laradin, King of the Land of the two Seas, hath caused to be executed, whose will and pleasure it is, that as the body of this miserable Mahometan hath been sawed in sunder, and boiled here on Earth, so his Soul shall suffer worse torments in Hell, and that most worthily, for his transgressing of the Law of Mahomet, and of the perfect belief of the Musselmen of the House of M●●qua: For this execution is very just, and conformable to the holy Doctrine of the Book of Flowers, in regard this Miscreant hath showed himself in all his works to be so far without the fear of God, as he hath incessantly from time to time betrayed the most secret and important affairs of this Kingdom to those accursed Dogs of the other end of the world, who for our sins, and through our negligence, have with notorious Tyranny made themselves Lords of Malaca. This Publication ended, a fearful noise arose amongst the people, who cried out, This punishment is but too little for so execrable a crime. Behold truly the manner of this passage, and how the loss of the Kingdom of Aaru was joined with the death of that poor King, who lived in such good correspondence with us, and that in my opinion might have been succoured by us with very small charge and pains, if at the beginning of the War he had been assisted with that little he demanded by his Ambassador; Now who was in the fault hereof, I will leave to the judgement of them which most it concerns to know it. §. 2. After that this infortunate King of Aaru had miserably ended his days, as I have before related, and that his whole Army was utterly defeated, both the Town and the rest of the Kingdom were easily and quickly taken in. Thereupon the General of the Achems repaired the Trenches, and fortified them in such manner as he thought requisite for the conservation and security of all that he had gained: which done, he left there a Garrison of eight hundred of the most courageous men of his Army, who were commanded by a certain Lusan Mahometan, named Sapetù de Raia, and incontinently after departed with the rest of his Forces. The common report was that he went to the Tyrant of Achem, who received him with very much honour for the good success of this enterprise; For, as I have already delivered, being before but Governor and Mandara of the Kingdom of Baarros, he gave him the title of King, so that ever after he was called Sultan of Baarros, which is the proper denomination of such as are Kings amongst the Mahometans. Now whilst things passed in this sort, the desolate Queen remained some seven leagues from Aaru, where being advertised and assured of the death of the King her husband, and of the lamentable issue of the War, she presently resolved to cast herself into the fire, for so she had promised her husband in his life time, confirming it with many and great oaths; But her friends and servants, to divert her from putting so desperate a design in execution, used many reasons unto her, so that at length, overcome by their persuasions, Verily, said she unto them, although I yield to your request, yet I would have you know, that neither the considerations you have propounded, nor the zeal you seem to sh●w of good and faithful Subjects, were of power to turn me from so generous a determination, as that is which I promised to my King, my Husband, and my Master, if God had not inspired me with this thought, that living I may better revenge his death, as by his dear blood I vow unto you to labour as long as I live to do, and to that end I will undergo any extremity whatsoever, nay if need be turn Christian a thousand times over, if by that means I may be able to compass this my desire. Saying so, she immediately got up on an Elephant, and accompanied with a matter of seven hundred men, she marched towards the Town with a purpose to set it on fire, where encountering some four hundred Achems, that were busy about pillaging of such goods as were yet remaining, she so encouraged her people with her words and tears, that they cut them all presently in pieces; This execution done, knowing herself too weak for to hold the Town, she returned into the Wood, where she sojourned twenty days, during which time she made War upon the Townsmen, surprising and pillaging them as often as they issued forth to get water, wood, or other necessaries, so as they durst not stir out of the Town to provide themselves such things as they needed, in which regard if she could possibly have continued this War other twenty days longer, she had so famished them, as they would have been constrained to render the Town: But because at that time it reigned continually by reason of the Climate, and that the place was boggy and full of bushes, as also the fruits, wherewithal they nourished themselves in the Wood, were all rotten, so that the most part of her people fell sick, and no means there to relieve them, the Queen was constrained to depart to a River, named Minhaçumbaa, some five leagues from thence, where she embarked herself in sixteen Vessels, such as she could get, which were fishermen Paroos, and in them she went to Malaca, with a belief that at her Arrival there she should not be denied any thing she would ask. Pedro de Faria, being advertised of the Queens coming, sent Alvero de Faria, his son, §. 3. and General of the Sea-forces, to receive her with a Galley, five Foists, two Catures, twenty Balons, and three hundred men, besides divers persons of the Country. So she was brought to the Fortress, where she was saluted with an honourable peal of Ordnance, which lasted the space of a good hour. Being landed, and having seen certain things, which Pedro de Faria desired to show her, as the Custom-house, the River, the Army, the Manufactures, stores of Powder, and other particulars, prepared before for that purpose, she was lodged in a fair house, and her people, to the number of six hundred, in a field, called Ilher, in Tents and Cabins, where they were accommodated the best that might be. During all the time of her abode, which was about a matter of five months, she continued soliciting for succour, and means to revenge the death of her husband. But at length perceiving the small assistance she was likely to have from us, and that all we did was but a mere entertainment of good words, she determined to speak freely unto Pedro de Faria, that so she might know how far she might trust to his prom says; To which end, attending him one Sunday at the gate of the Fortress, at such time as the place was full of people, and that he was going forth to hear Mass, she went to him, and after some compliments between them, she said unto him; Noble and valiant Captain, I beseech you by the generosity of your race, to give me the hearing in a few things I have to represent unto you. Consider, I pray you, that albeit I am a Mahometan, and that for the greatness of my sins I am altogether ignorant in the knowledge of your holy Law, yet in regard I am a woman, and have been a Queen, you ought to carry some respect to me, and to behold my misery with the eyes of a Christian. Hereunto at first Pedro de Faria knew not what to answer, in the end putting off his cap, he made her a low reverence, and after they had both continued a good while without speaking, the Queen bowed to the Church gate, that was just before them, and then spoke again to Pedro de Faria. Truly, said she, the desire I have always had to revenge the death of my husband, hath been, and still is, so great, that I have resolved to seek out all the means that possibly I may to effect it, since by reason of the weakness of my sex Fortune will not permit me to bear arms; Being persuaded then that this here, which is the first I have tried, was the most assured, and that I more relied upon then any other, as trusting in the ancient amity which hath always been betwixt us and you Portugals, and the obligation wherein this Fortress is engaged to us, passing by many other considerations well known to you, I am now to desire you with tears in mine eyes, that for the honour of the high and mighty King of Portugal, my sovereign Lord, and unto whom my husband was ever a loyal Subject and Vassal, you will aid and succour me in this my great adversity, which in the presence of many noble Personages you have promised me to do; howbeit now I see that in stead of performing the promises which you have so often made me, you allege for an excuse that you have written unto the Viceroy about it, whereas I have no need of such great Forces as you speak of, for that with an hundred men only, and such of my own people as are flying up and down in hope and expectation of my return, I should be able enough, though I be but a woman, in a short space to recover my Country, and revenge the death of my husband, through the help of Almighty God, in whose Name I beseech and require you, that for the service of the King of Portugal, my Master, and the only refuge of my widowhood, you will, since you can, assist me speedily, because expedition is that which in this affair imports the most, and so doing you shall prevent the plot which the wicked enemy hath upon this Fortress, as too well you may perceive by the means he hath used to effect it. If you will be pleased to give me the succour I demand of you, say so; if not, deal clearly with me, for that you will prejudice me as much in making me lose time, as if you refused me that which so earnestly I desire, and which as a Christian you are obliged to grant me, as the Almighty Lord of Heaven and Earth doth well know▪ whom I take to witness of this my request. CHAP. XII. The Queen of Aarus departure from Malaca; her going to the King of Jantana; his summoning the Tyrant of Achem to restore the Kingdom of A●ru, and that which passed between them thereupon. PEdro de Faria, having heard what this desolate Queen said openly unto him, convinced by his own conscience, 1. and even ashamed of having delayed her in that fashion, answered her, that in truth, and by the faith of a Christian, he had recommended this affair unto the Viceroy, and that doubtless there would some succour come for her ere it were long, if so be there were no trouble in the Indias that might hinder it, wherefore he advised and prayed her to stay still in Malaca, and that shortly she should see the verity of his speeches. Thereunto this Princess having replied upon the uncertainty of such succour, Pedro de Faria grew into choler, because he thought she did not believe him, so that in the heat of his passion he lashed out some words that were more rude than was fit. Whereupon the desolate Queen, with tears in her eyes, and beholding the Church gate, which was just against her, and sobbing in such manner as she could scarcely speak; The clear Fountain, said she, is the God which is adored in that house, out of whose mouth proceeds all truth, but the men of the Earth are sinks of troubled water, wherein change and faults are by nature continually remaining, wherefore accursed is he that trusts to the opening of their lips; For I assure you, Captain, that ●ver since I knew myself to this present I have neither heard, nor seen aught, but that the more such unhappy wretches, as my late husband was, and myself now am, do for you Portugals, the less you regard them, and the more you are obliged, the less you acknowledge, whence I may well conclude that the recompense of the Portugal Nation consists more in favour, then in the merits of persons; And would to God, my deceased husband had nine and twenty years ago but known what now for my sins I perceive too well, for than he had not been so deceived by you as he was: But since it is so, I have this only left to comfort me in my misery, that I see many others scandalised with your amity as well as myself; For if you had neither the power nor the will to succour me, why would you so far engage yourself to me, a poor desolate widow, concerning that which I hoped to obtain from you, and so beguile me with your large promises? Having spoken thus, she turned her back to the Captain, and without harkening to what he might say she instantly returned to her lodging, than caused her Vessels, wherein she came thither, to be made ready, and the next day set sail for Bi●tan, where the King of jantana was at that time, who, according to the report was made of it to us afterward, received her with great honour at her arrival. To him she recounted all that had passed betwixt her and Pedro de Faria, and how she had lost all hope of our friendship; Unto whom, it is said, the King made this answer, That he did not marvel at the little faith she had found in us, for that we had showed it but too much upon sundry occasions unto all the world. Now the better to confirm his saying, he recited some particular examples of matters, which he said had befallen us, conformable to his purpose; and like a Mahometan, and our Enemy, he made them appear more enormous than they were: So after he had recounted many things of us very ill done, amongst the which he interlaced divers Treacheries, Robberies, and Tyrannies, at length he told her, that as a good King, and a good Mahometan, he would promise her, that ere it were long she should see herself by his means restored again to every foot of her Kingdom; and to the end she might be the more assured of his promise, he told her that he was content to take her for his wife, if so she pleased, for that thereby he should have the greater cause to become the King of Achems' Enemy, upon whom for her sake he should be constrained to make War, if he would not by fair means be persuaded to abandon that which he had unjustly taken from her. Whereunto she made answer, that albeit the honour he did her was very great, yet she would never accept of it, unless he would first promise, as in way of a dowry, to revenge the death of her former husband, saying, it was a thing she so much desired, as without it she would not accept of the Sovereignty of the whole world. The King condescended to her request, and by a solemn Oath taken on a Book of their Sect confirmed the promise which to that effect he made her. §. 2. After that the King of jantana had taken that Oath before a great Cacis of his, called Raia Moulana, upon a festival day when as they solemnised their Ramadan, he went to the Isle of Compar, where immediately upon the celebration of their Nuptials he called a Council for to advise of the course he was to hold for the performance of that whereunto he had engaged himself, for he knew it was a matter of great difficulty, and wherein he should be forced to hazard much of his Estate. The resolution that he took hereupon was before he enterprised any thing to send to summon the Tyrant of Achem to surrender the Kingdom of Aaru, which in the right of his new wife belonged now unto him▪ and then according to the answer he should receive to govern himself. This Council seemed so good to the King, that he presently dispatched an Ambassador to the Tyrant, with a rich Present of Jewels, and Silks, together with a Letter containing these words. Sibri Laya quendou, pracama de Raia, lawful King by a long succession of Malaca, which by strong hand, and the injustice of the faithless Kings of Jantana and Bintan hath been usurped from me, To thee Siry Sultan Aaradin, King of Achem, and of all the Land of the two Seas, my true Brother by the ancient Amity of our forefathers. ay, thine Ally in flesh and in blood, do give thee to understand by my Ambassador, that about the seventh Moon of this present year the noble Widow Anchesiny, Queen of Aaru, came to me full of grief and tears, and prostrating herself on the ground before me, she told me that thy Captains had taken her Kingdom from her, as also the two Rivers of Lava and Panetican, and slain Aliboncar her husband, together with five thousand Amborraias and Ouroballons, all men of mark, that were with him, and made three thousand children slaves, which had never offended, tying their hands behind them, and scourging them continually without pity, as if they had been the sons of unbelieving mothers. Wherefore being moved with compassion I have received her under the protection of my faith, to the end that I might with more certainty inform myself of the reason and right thou hadst so to do, and perceiving by her oaths that thou hadst none, I have taken her to my wife, that I might the more freely before God demand that which is hers. I desire thee then, as being thy true Brother, that thou wilt render that thou hast taken from her, and thereof make her a good and full restitution; And touching the proceeding that is to be held in this restitution which I demand of thee, it is to be done according to the manner that Syribican my Ambassador will show thee. And not doing thus conformable to what in justice I require of thee, I declare myself thine Enemy in the behalf of this Lady, unto whom I am obliged by a solemn Oath to defend her in her affliction. This Ambassador being come to Ache●, the Tyrant received him very honourably, and took his Letter; But after he had opened it, and read the contents, he would presently have put him to death, had he not been diverted by his Council, who told him, that in so doing he would incur great infamy: Whereupon he instantly dismissed the Ambassador with his Present, which in contempt of him he would not accept of, and in answer of that he brought him he returned him a Letter, wherein it was thus written. I Sultan Aaradin, King of Achem, Baarros, Pedir, Paacem, and of the Signories of Dayaa, and Batas, Prince of all the Land of the two Seas, both Mediterranean and Ocean, and of the Ours of Menencabo, and of the Kingdom of Aaru newly conquered upon just cause, To thee King, replenished with joy, and desirous of a doubtful heritage: I have seen thy Letter, written at the table of thy Nuptials, and by the inconsiderate words thereof have discerned the drunkenness of thy Councillors and Secretaries, whereunto I would not have vouchsafed an answer, had it not been for the humble prayers of my servants. As touching the Kingdom of Aaru, do not thou dare to speak of it if thou desirest to live, sufficeth it that I have caused it to be taken in, and that it is mine, as thine also shall be ere long, if thou hast married Anchesiny with a purpose upon that occasion to make claim to a Kingdom, that now is none of hers; wherefore live with her as other husbands do with their wives, that tilling the ground are contented with the labour of their hands. Recover first thy Malaca, since it was once thine, and then thou mayst think of that which never belonged to thee. I will favour thee as a Vassal, and not as a Brother, as thou qualifiest thyself. From my great and Royal House of rich Achem, the very day of this thy Ambassadors arrival, whom I have presently sent away without further seeing or hearing of him, as he may tell thee upon his return to thy presence. The King of Iantana's Ambassador, §. ●. being dismissed with this Answer the very same day that he arrived, which amongst them they hold for a mighty affront, carried back the Present, which the Tyrant would not accept of in the greater contempt both of him that sent, and he that brought it, and arrived at Compar, where the King of jantana was at that instant, who upon the understanding of all that had passed grew by report so sad and vexed, that his servants have vowed they have divers times seen him weep for very grief that the Tyrant should make so little reckoning of him; Howbeit he held a Council there upon the second time, where it was concluded, that at any hand he should make War upon him, as on his mortal Enemy, and that the first thing he should undertake, should be the recovery of the Kingdom of Aaru, and the Fort of Panetican, before it was further fortified▪ The King accordingly set forth a Fleet of two hundred Sails, whereof the most part were Lanchares, Calaluses, and fifteen tall Juncks, furnished with Munition necessary for the enterprise; And of this Navy he made General the great Laque Xemena, his Admiral, of whose valour the History of the Indias hath spoken in divers places. To him he gave two thousand Soldiers, as also four thousand Mariners and galley slaves, all choice and trained men. This General departed immediately with his Fleet, and arrived at the River of Panetican close by the Enemy's Fort, which he assaulted five several times, both with scaling ladders, and divers artificial fires, but perceiving he could not prevail that way, he began to batter it with four hundred great Pieces of Ordnance▪ which shot continually for the space of seven whole days together, at the end whereof the most part of the Fort was ruined, and overthrown to the ground, whereupon he presently caused his men to give an assault to it, who performed it so valiantly, that they entered it, and slew fourteen hundred Achems, the most of which came thither but the day before the Fleet arrived under the conduct of a Turkish Captain, Nephew to the Bassa of Cairo, named Mora do Arraiz, who was also sl●i●● there with four hundred Turks he had brought along with him, whereof Laque Xemena would not spare so much as one. After this he used such diligence in repairing that which was fallen, wherein most of the Soldiers laboured, that in twelve days the Fort was rebuilt, and made as strong as before, with the augmentation of two Bulwarks. The news of this Fleet, which the King of jantana prepared in the Ports of Bintan and Compar, came to the Tyrant's ears, who fearing to lose that which he had gotten, put instantly to Sea another Fleet of fourteen hundred and twenty Sails, Foists, Lanchares, Galiots, and fifteen Galleys of five and twenty banks of oa●s a piece, wherein he caused fifteen thousand men to be embarked, namely, twelve thousand Soldiers, and the rest Mariners, and such as were for the service of the Sea; Of this Army he made the same Heredin Mahomet General, who had before (as I have already declared) conquered the Kingdom of Aaru, in regard he knew him to be a man of a great spirit, and fortunate in War, who departing with this Army arrived at a place, called Aapessumhee, within four leagues of the River of Panetican, where he learned of certain fishermen, whom he took and put to torture, all that had past concerning the Fort and the Kingdom, and how Laque Xemena had made himself Master both of the Land and Sea in expectation of him. At this news, it is said, that Heredin Mahomet was much perplexed, because intruth he did not believe the Enemy could do so much in so little time; By reason whereof he assembled his Council, where it was concluded, that since both the Fort and Kingdom were regained, and all the men he had left there cut in pieces, as likewise for that the Enemy was very strong, both at Sea and Land, and the season very unfit for their design, therefore they were to return back: Nevertheless Heredin Mahomet was of a contrary opinion, saying, that he would rather die like a man of courage, then live in dishonour, and that seeing the King had made choice of him for that purpose, by the help of God he would not lose one jot of the reputation he had gotten; wherefore he vowed and swore by the bones of Mahomet, and all the Lamps that perpetually burn in his Chapel, to put all those to death as Traitors that should go about to oppose this intent of his, and that they should be boiled alive in a Cauldron of Pitch, in such manner as he meant to deal with Laque Xemena himself; and with this boiling resolution he parted from the place where he road at anchor, with great cries, and noise of Drums, and Bells, as they are accustomed to do upon like occasions. In this sort by force of oars and sails they got into the entry of the River, and coming in sight of Laque Xemena's Navy, who was ready waiting for him, and well reinforced with a great number of Soldiers, that were newly come to him from P●ra, Bintan, Siaca▪ and many other places thereabout, he made towards him, and after the discharging of their Ordnance afar off, they joined together with as much violence as might be. The fight was such, that during the space of an hour and an half there could no advantage be discerned on either part, until such time as Heredin Mahomet, General of the Achems, was slain with a great shot, that hit him just in the breast, and battered him to pieces. The death of this Chieftain discouraged his people in such manner, as labouring to return unto a Point, named Baroquirin, with a purpose there to unite and fortify themselves until night, and then by the favour thereof to fly away, they could not execute their design, in regard of the great currant of the water, wh●ch separated and dispersed them sundry ways, by which means the Tyrant's Army ●ell into the power of Laque Xemena, who defeated it, so that but fourteen Sails of them escaped, and the other hundred threescore and six were taken, and in them were thirteen thousand and five hundred men killed, besides the fourteen hundred that were slain in the Trench. These fourteen Sails that so escaped returned to Achem, where they gave the Tyrant to understand how all had passed, at which, it is reported, he took such grief, as he shut up himself for twenty days without seeing any body, at the end whereof he struck off the heads of all the Captains of the fourteen Sails, and commanded all the Soldiers beards that were in them to be shaved off, enjoining them expressly upon pain of being sawed asunder alive, to go ever after attired in women's apparel, playing upon Timbrels in all places where they went, and that whensoever they made any protestation, it should be in saying, So may God bring me back my husband again, as this is true, or, So may I have joy of the children I have brought into the world. Most of these men seeing themselves enforced to undergo a chastisement so scandalous to them, fled their Country, and many made themselves away, some with poison, some with halters, and some with the sword. A relation altogether true, without any addition of mine. Thus was the Kingdom of Aaru recovered from the Tyrant of Achem, and remained in the hands of the King of jantana until the year 1574. At which time the said Tyrant with a Fleet of two hundred Sails, feigning as though he would go to take in Patava, fell cunningly one night on jantana, where the King was at that time, whom, together with his wife, children, and many others, he took prisoners, and carried into his Country, where he put them all to most cruel deaths, and for the King himself he caused his brains to be beaten out of his head with a great club. After these bloody executions he possessed the Kingdom of Aaru, whereof he presently made his eldest son King, the same that was afterward slain at Malaca, coming to besiege it in the time of Don Lionis P●reyra, son to the Earl of Feyra, Captain of the Fortress, who defended it so valiantly, that it seemed to be rather a miracle then any natural work, by reason the power of that Enemy was so great, and ours so little in comparison of theirs, as it may be truly spoken how they were two hundred Mahometans against one Christian. CHAP. XIII. My departure from Malaca to go to Pan; that which fortuned after my arrival there; with the murder of the King of Pan, and the cause thereof. TO return unto the Discourse where I left, I say, §. 1. that when I was recovered of the sickness which I got in my Captivity at Siaca, Pedro de Faria, desiring to find out some occasion to advance and benefit me, sent me in a Lanchara to the Kingdom of Pan with goods of his, to the value of ten thousand ducats, for to consign them into the hands of a Factor of his, that resided there, named Tom Lobo, and from thence to go to Patava, which is an hundred leagues beyond that. To that purpose he gave me a Letter and a Present for the King, and an ample Commission to treat with him about the redemption of five Portugals, who in the Kingdom of Siam were Slaves to Monteo de Bancha his Brother-in-law. I parted then from Malaca upon this employment, and the seventh day of our Voyage, just as we were opposite to the Island of Pullo Timano, which may be distant from Malaca some ninety leagues, and ten or twelve from the mouth of the River of Pan, a little before day we heard at two several times great lamentations at Sea, and being not able in regard of the darkness of the night to know what it was, we were all suspended into divers opinions, for that we could not imagine what it should be, in so much that to learn the certainty thereof I caused them to hoist up sail, and row towards that part where we heard the lamentation, every one looking down round about close to the water, the better to discern and hear that of which we were in such doubt. After we had continued a pretty while in this manner, we perceived far from us a black thing that floated on the Sea, and unable at first to discover what it was, we advised together about it. Now there being but four Portugals of us in the Lanchara, we were all of different minds, so that I was told how I was to go directly to the place whither Pedro de Faria had sent me, that losing but an hours time I might endanger the Voyage, and hazard the goods, and so for want of performing the duty of my charge I might very much wrong him. Whereunto I answered, that happen what might, I would not leave off labouring to know what it was, and that if in so doing I committed any fault, the Lanchara appertained to none but Pedro de Faria, unto whom myself was to render an account of the goods in it, and not they, that had nothing else in the Vessel but their persons, which were in no more danger than mine: During this debate it pleased God that the day appeared, by the light whereof we perceived people that were cast away, who floated pellmell together upon planks, and other pieces of wood: Whereupon without further fear we turned our prow towards them, and with force of sails and oars we made to them, hearing them cry six or seven times, without using any other speech, Lord have mercy upon us. At the sight of this strange and pitiful spectacle we remained so amazed, that we were almost besides ourselves, and causing some of the Mariners to get with all speed into the Cockboat, they fetched three and twenty persons of them into the Lanchara, namely fourteen Portugals, and nine Slaves, which were all so disfigured in the face, as they made us afraid to look on them, and so weak as they could neither speak nor stand. After they had been thus taken up by us, and entreated in the best manner we could, we demanded of them the cause of their misfortune, whereunto one of the company weeping answered, My Masters, I am named Fernand Gil Porcal●o, and the eye, which you behold I want, was strucken out by the Achems at the siege of Malaca, when as the second time they came to surprise Dom Est●vano de Gama, who desiring to do something for me, because he saw me poor, as I was at that time, gave me leave to go to the Molucques, where would to God I had never been, since my Voyage was to have so bad a success: for after I departed from the Port of Talagame, which is the Road of our Fort at Ternate, having sailed three and twenty days with a favourable gale in a Junck that carried a thousand bars of Cloves, worth above an hundred thousand ducats, my ill fortune would, that at the point of Surabaya in the Isle of jaoa, there arose so impetuous a Northwind, that our Junck broke in the prow, which constrained us to lighten the hatches; So we passed that night by the shore, without bearing so much as a rag of sail, by reason the Sea was exceedingly moved, and the waves most insupportable. The next day we perceived that our Junk sank, so that of an hundred forty and seven persons that were in her there were saved but six and twenty, and now it is fourtain days that we have been upon these planks, having during all that time eaten nothing but a slave of mine that died, with whom we have sustained ourselves eight days, and the very last night two Portugals more died, on whom we would not feed, although we were very much pressed to it by our hunger, because we hoped that this or the next day would give an end both to our lives and misery. §. 2. The relation, which this man made us, having rendered us all very pensive, and full of amazement to see him and his companions reduced to so deplorable an estate, we greatly wondered at the means, whereby God had so miraculously delivered them, wherefore we gave him most humble thanks for it, and comforted our new guests, in representing unto them all those things which the duty of true Christians and our poor captivity obliged us to tell them. After that we bestowed part of our clothes on them, and laid them in our ordinary beds, than we applied those remedies to them, which we thought necessary for their recovery; for not having slept of a long time, they were so exceeding dizzy in the head, that they would fall down stunned in such sort, as they continued without any knowledge for an hour together. This done, we went to seek out the Port of Pan, where we arrived near about midnight, casting anchor in the Road, just against a little inhabited place, called Campalaru. The next morning by break of day we rowed up the River about some league to the Town, where we found Tome Lobo, who, as I have already declared, resided there, as Factor for the Captain of Malaca, into whose hands I consigned all the Merchandise that I brought along with me. The same day three of the fourteen Portugals, which we took up at Sea, died, whereof the afore-named Fernando Gil Porcalho was one, as also five young men that were Christians, whom we cast all into the Sea, with great stones tied to their feet and about their necks for to make them sink to the bottom, in regard we could not be permitted to bury them in the Town, although Tome Lobo offered them forty ducats for that purpose, the reason they alleged was, that if they should suffer it, their Country would remain accursed, and incapable of nourishing any thing, because the deceased were not purged from the Hog's flesh they had eaten, it being the most detestable and enormous sin of all others; As for those which rested alive, Tome Lobo gave them very good entertainment, and furnished them with all things that they wanted, until such time as they recovered and returned to Malaca. Not long after, preparing myself for my Voyage to Patana, Tom Lobo very earnestly desired me not to go thither, and told me that he held not himself safe in that Town, by reason he was advertised that one Taan N●rrafa, a man of reputation, and of the chiefest of the Town, had sworn to burn him in his house, with all the goods that were in it, saying, that at Malaca the Captain's Factor had taken from him the value of five thousand ducats in Benjamin, Silk, and wood of Aloes, at a far lower rate than it was worth, and that he had paid him at his own pleasure, and therewith not contented had in part of payment given him rotten stuffs, which he could make nothing of; moreover, that for all his five thousand ducats worth of Commodities, that in Malaca would have yielded him ten thousand, and by exchange of vendible wares, he might easily have returned, would have made him ten thousand more, he never could get above seven hundred ducats; and therefore to be revenged of this wrong, he had picked quarrels of purpose to toll him forth to kill him, in regard whereof he instantly desired me to stay, and not abandon him and the Captain's stock to such apparent danger: Whereupon having used all the reasons I could to facilitate my voyage, he would by no means approve of them, but contradicted me in all my propositions. For conclusion, I remonstrated unto him, that if it were his ill fortune, as he said he feared, to be killed for that which he had, I should be in no better case, and therefore I marvelled why he would let those eleven Portugals go, with whom rather he should have embarked himself for Malaca. Hereunto after a little pause he made answer, that he was very sorry he had not done so, but since it was now too late, he entreated me not to forsake him in this extremity, and that for the Captain's sake, who he knew would not take it well I should leave him so alone with his goods, which were no less worth than thirty thousand ducats, besides those belonging to himself, that amounted to almost as much more. This request of his made to me with such instance on the one side, somewhat perplexed me, and on the other considering the extreme hazard I ran if I stayed, I knew not what to resolve; At length after I had well thought of the matter, I was constrained to come to this accord with him, that in case he did not within fifteen days embark himself with me in my Lanchara for Patana, with all his Commodities reduced into gold, or stones, whereof there was great plenty in the Town, that then I might go where I pleased without him; an offer that he was forced to accept of, and so we remained agreed. The fear Tom Lobo was in, left that wherewithal he was threatened should befall him, §. 3. made him use such diligence in selling away of his commodities, that by means of the good pennyworths he afforded them at, in less than eight days he cleared his Warehouse, and the other places wherein they lay; so that utterly refusing Pepper; Cloves, and such other Drugs, which took up too much room, he trucked all away for gold of Menencabo, for Diamonds of Lavo and Taucampura, and Pearls of Borneo. Now having made a full dispatch of all, and that we were resolved to embark the next day, by ill fortune a most terrible accident happened the night ensuing, which was, that one, named Coin Geinal, the King of Borneo's Ambassador, who had been three or four years resident in the King of Pan's Court, and a marvellous rich man, killed the King upon finding him in bed with his wife, which caused such a commotion in the Town, that it seemed to be a Tumult of Hell rather than any humane business; Whereupon certain rogues and vagabonds, that wished for nothing more than such like occasions, to the end they might do what before for fear of the King they durst not enterprise, made a Troop of five or six hundred, which separated into three bands, went directly to the house, where Tome Lobo dwelled. Having assaulted it in six or seven places, they entered by force, notwithstanding all the resistance we could make, and that in defending it we lost eleven men, whereof the Portugals, which came with me from Malaca, were three. During this violence, all that Tome Lobo could do was to escape away with six great blows of a sword, one of the which had cut his right cheek almost away, so as he was like to die of that hurt. We were both of us then constrained to abandon the house to them, together with all the goods that were in it, and retire to the Lanchara, where we remained with five Boys and eight Mariners, not having so much as the worth of a penny left of all our merchandise, which amounted to fifty thousand crowns in gold and stone only. In this Lanchara we passed away all the night very much afflicted, and still harkening what might be the end of this mutiny, which was risen among the people, as I have before related. At length perceiving the matters grew worse and worse, and that there was no hope for us to recover any part of our goods, we thought it a far safer course to go away to Patana, then by staying to run a hazard of being killed, as above four thousand persons were. With this resolution we parted from this place, and in six days arrived at Patana, where we were very well received by the Portugals which were in that Country, unto whom we recounted all that had passed at Pan▪ and the piteous estate wherein we had left that miserable Town. This accident very much afflicted them, so that desiring to give some remedy thereunto, with a true affection of charitable Christians they went all to the Palace of the King, and complained to him of the wrong that had been done to the Captain of Malaca, beseeching him thereupon they might be permitted to recover, if it were possible, the loss they had sustained, and have leave granted to right themselves upon any merchants goods belonging to the Kingdom of Pan, to the value of the sum they had been despoiled of. The King having heard their complaint, and presently granting what they demanded; It is reasonable, said he, that you should do as you have been done unto, and that you should spoil them that first have spoilt you, especially in a matter that concerns the Captain of Malaca, unto whom all of you are so much obliged. The Portugals, having rendered him very humble thanks for this grace, returned to their houses, where they concluded to seize upon all the goods they could meet with belonging to the Kingdom of Pan, until such time as they had fully recovered their loss. It happened then about nine days after they being advertised, that some ten leagues off, in the river of Calantan, were three Junks of China, very rich, and appertaining to Mahometan Merchants, Natives of the Kingdom of Pan, that by foul weather at Sea were constrained to put in there, our people resolved to fall upon them: To which effect, out of three hundred Portugals, that were then in the Country, we chose out fourscore, with whom we embarked ourselves in two Foists, and one round ship, well provided of all things we thought to be necessary for this enterprise. So we departed three days after with all speed, for fear lest the Mahometans of the Country, having discovered our design, should advertise them of it whom we went to seek; Of these three vessels one joano Fernandez Dabrea, born in the Isle of Madera, was General, who with forty Soldiers went in the round ship, and the other two Foists were commanded by Laurenco de Goes, and Vasco Sermento, both of them of the City of Braganea in Portugal, and very well experienced in Sea-service. The next day we arrived at the river of Calentan, where as soon as we decried the three Junks riding at anchor, which we had been told of, we set very valiantly upon them, and albeit those that were in them did at first do their best endeavour to defend themselves, yet at length all their resistance was in vain, for in less than an hour we reduced them all under our power, so as seventy and four of theirs were slain, and but three of ours, though we had many men hurt. I will not hold you here with any particular discourse of what was done on either side, let it suffice, that after the three Junks had rendered themselves, we presently set sail, and carried them away with us in all haste, because the whole Country thereabout was in an uproar, directing our course towards Patana, where by the favour of a fair wind we arrived the next day in the afternoon: Having then cast anchor, we saluted the Town with a peal of Ordnance in sign of joy, which put the Mahometans of the Country out of all patience; for though we stood in the terms of good friends with them, yet they left not to use all possible means, both of Presents which they gave to the Governors and the King's Favourites, and otherwise, for to make our prizes void, and that the King would expel us out of his dominions, whereunto he would at no hand consent, saying, that he would not for any thing in the world break the peace, which his Ancestors had made with the Christians of Malaca, ●nd that all that he could do therein was to become a third betwixt them: Whereupon he de●●●ed us, that the three Necodas of the Junks, so are the Commanders of them called in that Country, restoring unto us what had been taken from the Captain of Malaca, we would likewise render unto them as well their vessels free, as the overplus, a matter which joano Fernandez Dabrea, and the rest of the Portugals very willingly agreed unto, to testify the desire they had to content him; As indeed he was exceedingly well pleased with them for it, which he expressed both in courteous language, and many promises of his future favour. Thus were the fifty thousand ducats recovered, that Pedro de Faria and Tom Lobo had lost, and the Portugals were in great esteem over all that Country, so that their valour rendered them very formidable to the Mahometans. A little after the Soldiers assured us, that in the three Junks we had taken, there was only in lingo●s of silver, besides the other merchandise wherewithal they were laden, to the value of two hundred Taieis, which in our money amounts to an hundred thousand ducats. CHAP. XIV. The Misfortune that befell us at the entry into the River of Lugor; our hiding ourselves in a Wood, with that which happened unto us afterwards; and our return unto Malaca. §. 1. HAving sojourned six and twenty days at Patana for to sell away some few commodities of China that I had, there arrived a Foist from Malaca, commanded by one Antonio de Faria, who came thither by the express commandment of Pedro de Faria to treat with the King about some accord, as also to confirm the ancient league anew which he had with Malaca, and withal to give him thanks for the good entertainment he gave in his Kingdom to those of the Portugal Nation. This business was carried with a fair show of an Embassy, accompanied with a Letter and a Present of Jewels, sent in the name of the King of Portugal our Master, and taken out o● his Coffers, as all the Captains of that place used to do. Now for as much as the said Antonio de Faria had brought along with him some ten or twelve thousand crowns worth of Indian woollen and linen cloth, which he had taken up on his credit at Malaca, and that he saw there was so little utterance of that commodity, as he could not meet with any Merchant that would deal for it, he was fain to resolve for to spend the winter there until such time as he might meet with some opportunity to put it off; Howbeit he was advised by some of the best experienced of the Country to send it unto Lugor, which is a great Town in the Kingdom of Siam, an hundred leagues lower towards the North, for they alleged that this Port was very rich, and of great vent, by reason of a world of Junks that arrived there daily from the Isle of jaoa, from Lava, Taniampura, japara, Demaa, Panaruca Sydayo, Passarvan, Solor, and Borneo, whose Merchants were used to give a good rate for such like commodities, in exchange of gold, or stone. This advice was well approved of by Antonio de Faria, who instantly went about to put it in execution; To which end he took order for the providing of a vessel, by reason the Foist wherein he came was altogether unfit for a further voyage: Matters thus disposed of, he deputed one, named Christovano Borhalho, for his Factor, a man exceeding well versed in business of Traffic, with whom there embarked some sixteen men, as well Soldiers as Merchants, with a hope that one crown would yield them six or seven, what in the commodities they should carry, as in those they should return. Hereupon▪ wretched I being one of the sixteen, we parted from the Port on a Saturday, and sailed with a favourable wind along the coast till Thursday next in the morning, that we arrived at Lugor Road, and anchored at the mouth of the River; There it was thought fit to pass the rest of the day, to the end we might inform ourselves of what was behoveful for us to do, as well for the sale of our commodities, as for the safety of our persons: And to say truth, we learned such good news, that we were confident of gaining above six times double, and to be sure of freedom and liberty during all the month of September, according to the Ordinance of the King of Siam, because it was the month of the Kings Sumbayas. Now the better to clear this, you must know, that all along this coast of Malaya, and within the Land, a great King commands, who for a more famous and recommendable Title above all other Kings, causeth himself to be called Prechau Saleu, Emperor of all Sornau, which is a Country wherein there are thirteen Kingdoms, by us commonly called Siam, to the which fourteen petty Kings are subject, and yield homage, that were anciently obliged to make their personal repair unto Odiaa, the Capital City of this Empire, as well to bring their Tribute thither, as to do the Sumbaya to their Emperor, which was indeed to kiss the Courtelas that he beware by his side; Now because this City was seated fifty leagues within the Land, and the Currents of the Rivers so strong, as these Kings were oftentimes forced to abide the whole winter there to their great charge, they petitioned the Prechau, King of Siam, that the place of doing this their homage might be altered, whereupon he was pleased to ordain, that for the future there should be a Viceroy resident in the Town of Lugor, which in their language is called Poyho, unto whom every three years those fourteen Kings should render that duty and obedience they were accustomed to do unto himself, and that during that time they spent there in performing the same, being the whole month of September, both their own merchandise, and that of all others, as well natives as strangers, that either came in, or went out of the Country, should be free from all manner of imposts whatsoever: So that we arriving in the time of this freedom, there was such a multitude of Merchants that flocked thither from all parts, as we were assured there was no less than fifteen hundred Vessels in the Port, all laden with an infinity of Commodities of very great value: And this was the good news we learned at such time as we arrived at the mouth of the River; wherewith we were so well pleased, that we presently resolved to put in as soon as the wind would permit us. But alas! we were so unfortunate, that we could never come to see what we so much desired; for about ten of the clock, just as we had dined, and were preparing to set sail, we saw a great Junk coming upon us, which perceiving us to be Portugals, few in number, and our Vessel small fell close with our prow on the larboard side, and then those that were in her threw into us great Cramp-irons, fastened unto two long chains, wherewithal they grappled us fast unto them, which they had no sooner done, but straightway some seventy or eighty Mahometans came flying out from under their hatches, that till then had lain lurking there, who with a mighty cry cast so many stones, darts, and lances, which ●ell as thick as hail upon us, that of us sixteen Portugals twelve rested dead in the place, together with six and thirty others, as well Boys as Mariners. Now for us four remaining Portugals, after we had escaped so dreadful ●n encounter, we leapt all of us into the Sea, where one was drowned, and we three that were left getting to land as well as we could, being dangerously hurt, and wading up to the waist in mud, went and hid ourselves in the next adjoining wood. In the mean time the Mahometans of the Junk, entering into our Frigate, not contented with the slaughter they had made of our men, like mad dogs they killed six or seven Boys outright, whom they found wounded on the D●ck, not sparing so much as one of them: That done, they embarked all the goods of our Vessel into their Junk, then made a great hole in her, and so sunk her: Immediately whereupon, leaving their anchor in the Sea, and the Cramp-irons wherewithal they had grappled us unto them, they set sail, and made away as fast as ever they could for fear of being discovered. §. 2. After this our escape, seeing ourselves all sore hurt, and without any hope of help, we did nothing but weep and complain, for in this disaster we knew not what to resolve on, so much were we amazed with that which had befallen us within the space of half an hour. In this desolation we spent the rest of that sad day, but considering with ourselves, that the place was moorish, and full of Adders and Lizards, we thought it our safest course to continue there all the night too, as accordingly we did, standing up to the middle in the Owze: The next morning as soon as it was day we went along by the River's side, until we came unto a little channel, which we durst not pass, as well for that it was very deep, as for fear of a great number of Lizards that we saw in it, so that in great pain we stayed not only that night there, but five days a●ter, being not able either to go forward, or turn aside, by reason of the bogs round about us, all covered over with rushes: In the mean time one of our companions died, whose name was Bastian Anriques, a rich man, and that had lost eight thousand crown● in the Lanchara, in so much that of all the company we were before there remained none but Christovano Borralho and myself, that with tears sat lamenting over the poor dead man's body, which we had covered with a little earth as well as we could, for we were then so weak, that we could hardly stir, or almost speak, so as we had set up our rest to make an end of those few hours we hoped to live in that place. The next day, being the seventh of our disaster, about Sunset we espied a great Bark coming rowing up the River, whereupon as soon as it was near us, we prostrated ourselves on the ground, beseeching those that were aboard her to take us in; They wondering at us, presently made a stand, seeming much amazed to see us so on our knees, and our hands lift up to Heaven, as though we were at our prayers; nevertheless without speaking at all to us, they made as if they would go on, which constrained us afresh to cry aloud to them with tears that they would not suffer us for want of succour to die miserably there. Upon thos● our cries and lamentations an ancient woman came forth from under the hatches, whose grave countenance represented her to be such as afterwards we found her to be; she seeing us in so pitiful a plight, moved with our misfortune, and our wounds that we showed her, she took up a stick, and therewith struck three or four of the Mariners because they would not take us in, whereupon approaching to the bank, five or six of them leapt on shore, and by her commandment took us upon their shoulders, and carried us into the Bark. This honourable woman, much grieved to behold us so hurt, and our shirts and linen drawers all bloody and mired, caused them straightway to be washed, and having given each of us, a linen cloth to cover us withal, she would needs have us to sit down by her, where commanding meat to be brought us, she herself presenting it to us with her own hand, Eat, eat, said she, poor strangers, and be not afflicted to see your selves reduced unto the estate you are in; for I, whom now you look upon, and that am but a woman, not having as yet attained to the age of fifty years, have seen myself a slave, and despoiled of above an hundred thousand ducats worth of goods: Nor is that all, for to this misfortune was the death of three of my sons adjoined, and that of my husband, whom I held far more dearer than these eyes of mine, these eyes, alas! wherewith I beheld both the father and the sons torn in pieces by the King of Siams' Elephants, together with two brothers, and a son-in-law I had; Ever since I have had a languishing life, and to all these miseries have many others far greater succeeded, for so implacable hath fortune been unto me, that I have seen three daughters of mine ready to be married, as also my father, mother, and two and thirty of my kinsmen, nephews, and cousins, thrown into burning furnaces, where their cries and lamentations could not choose but reach unto Heaven, for God to succour them in the violence of that insupportable torment; but alas! the enormity of my sins no doubt so stopped the ears of the clemency of the Lord of Lords, that he would not hea● our request, which seemed very just to me; nevertheless I deceived myself, since nothing is just but what it pleaseth his divine Majesty to ordain. Hereunto we answered, that the sins which we also had committed against him were the cause of our calamities. Seeing it is so, replied she, mingling her tears with ours, it is always good in your adversities to acknowledge, that the touches of the hand of God are evermore righteous, for both in that, as also in a confession of the mouth, in a sorrow for having offended, and in a firm resolution to do so no more, consisteth all the remedy of your sufferings and mine. Having entertained us thus with the discourse of her misfortune, she enquired of us the occasion of ours, and by what means we came to be in that miserable estate, whereupon we recounted unto her all that had passed, and that we neither knew who it was that had so ill entreated us, nor wherefore he did it; Her people, hearing us, said, that the great Junk, whereof we spoke, belonged to a Mahometan, a Guzarat by Nation, named Coia Acem, who the same morning went out of the River laden with Brazil, and was bound for the Isle of Ainan: Hereat the good woman smote her breast, and seeming to be much moved, Let me not live, said she, if it be not so, for I have heard that Mahometan, of whom you speak, vaunt publicly before all that would give ear unto him, that he had s●ain a great number of the race of those of Malaca, and that he hated them in such sort, as he had promised to his Mahomet to kill more of them in time. Being amazed hereat, we desired her to declare unto us who that man was, and why he was so much our enemy, whereunto she answered, that she knew no other reason, but for that a great Captain of our Nation, named Hector de Sylv●ira, had killed his father and two of his brothers in a ship, which he took from them in the strait of M●cqua, that was going from judas to Dabul. Thus much did this good Matron tell us, and many other things afterwards concerning the great hatred this Mahometan bore us, as also what lies he devised to render us infamous. This honourable woman, departing from the place where she found us, §. 3. went some two leagues up the River, till she came to a little Village, where she lay that night; The next morning parting from thence, she made directly to the Town of Lugor, which was above five leagues further. Arriving there about noon, she landed, and went to her house, whither she carried us with her, and kept us there three and twenty days, during which time we were very well looked unto, and plentifully accommodated with all that was necessary for us▪ This woman was a widow, and of an honourable family, as afterwards we learned, and that had been married to the Captain General, which they call Xabandar of Prevedim, whom the Pata of Lasapara King of Quaijuan had put to death in the Isle of jaoa the year 1538. At the time she met with us, as I have related, she came from a Junk of hers, that lay at the Road laden with Salt; and because it was great, and could not pass up by reason of the shelves, she caused it to be unladen by little and little with tha● Bark. By that time the three and twenty days, I spoke of, were expired, it pleased God to restore us to our perfect health, so that this virtuous D●me seeing us able to travel, recommended us to a Merchant, her kinsman, that was bound for Patana, with whom, after we had taken our leave of that noble Matron, unto whom we were so much obliged, we embarked ourselves in a Cataluz with Oars, and sailing on a River, called Sumh●chitano, we arrived seven days after at Patana. Now for as much as Antonio de Faria looked every day for our return, with a hope of good success in his business, as soon as he saw us, and understood what had passed, he remained so sad and discontented, that he continued above an hour without speaking a word; in the mean time such a number of Portugals came in, as the house was scarce able to contain them, by reason the greatest part of them had ventured goods in the Lanchara, whose lading in that regard amounted to seventy thousand ducats and better, the most of it being in silver coin, of purpose with it to return gold. Antonio de Faria seeing himself stripped of the twelve thousand ducats he had borrowed at Malaca, resolved not to return thither, because he had no means to pay his Creditors, but rather thought it fitter to pursue those that had robbed him of his goods; so that he took a solemn Oath upon the holy Evangelists to part incontinently from that place for to go in quest of those Pirates, for to revenge upon them the death of those fourteen Portugals, and thirty six Christians, Boys and Mariners, killed by them as aforesaid; Adding withal, that if such a course were not taken, they should every day be used so, ●ay far worse. All the Assistants very much commended him valorous resolution, and for the execution thereof there were many young Soldiers amongst them that offered to accompany him in that voyage; some likewise presented him with money, and others furnished him with divers necessaries: Having accepted these offers and presents of his friends, he used such diligence, that within eighteen days he made all his preparations, and got together five and fifty Soldiers, amongst whom poor unfortunate I was fain to be one; for I saw myself in that case, as I had not so much as a single token, nor knew any one that would either give or lend me one, being indebted besides at Malaca above five hundred ducats, that I had borrowed there of some of my friends, which, with as much more, that dog had ●obbed me of amongst others, as I have related before, having been able to save nothing but my miserable carcase, wounded in three places with a Javelin, and my skull cracked with a stone, whereby I was three or four times at the point of death; But my companion Christovan Borralho was yet ●ar worse entreated than myself, and that with more hurts, which he received in satisfaction of five and twenty hundred ducats that he was robbed of as the rest. CHAP. XV. Antonio de Faria's setting forth for the Isle of Ainan, his arrival at the River of Tinacoren; and that which befell us in this Voyage. §. 1. AS soon as Antonio de Faria was ready, he departed from Patana on a Saturday the ninth of May, 1540 and steered North Northwest, towards the Kingdom of Champaa, with an intent to discover the Ports and Havens thereof, as also by the means of some good booty to furnish himself with such things as he wanted; for his haste to part from Patana was such, as he had not time to furnish himself with that which was necessary for him, no not with victual and warlike ammunition enough. After we had sailed three days we had sight of an Island, called Pullo Condor, at the height of eight degrees and three quarters, on the North Coast, and almost Northwest towards the mouth of the River of Camboia, so that having rounded all the Coast, we discovered a good Haven Eastward, where in the Island of Camboia, distant some six leagues from the firm Land, we met with a Junk of Lequios, that was going to the Kingdom of Siam with an Ambassador from the Nautauquim of Lindau, who was Prince of the Island of Tosa, and that had no sooner discovered us but he sent a message by a Chinese Pilot to Antonio de Faria, full of compliments, whereunto was added these words from them all: That the time would come when as they should communicate with us in the true love of the Law of God, and of his infinite clemency, who by his death had given life to all men, and a perpetual inheritance in the house of the good, and that they believed this should be so, after the half of the half time was passed. With this compliment they sent him a Courtelas of great value, whose handle and scabbard was of gold, as also six and twenty Pearls in a little Box likewise of gold, made after the fashion of a Salt-seller, whereat Antonio de Faria was very much grieved, by reason he was not able to render the like unto this Prince, as he was obliged to do, for wh●n the Chinese arrived with this message they were distant above a league at Sea from us. Hereupon we went ashore, where we spent three days in taking in fresh water, and fishing. Then we put to Sea again, labouring to get to the firm Land, there to seek out a River, named Pullo Cambim, which divides the State of Camboia from the Kingdom of Champaa, in the height of nine degrees, where arriving on a Sunday the last of May, we went up three leagues in this River, and anchored just against a great Town, called Catimparu, there we remained twelve days in peace, during the which we made our provision of all things necessary. Now b●cause Antonio de Faria was naturally curious, he endeavoured to understand from the people of the Country what Nation inhabited beyond them, and whence that mighty River took its source; whereunto he was answered, that it was derived from a lake, named Pinator, distant from them Eastward two hundred and sixty leagues in the Kingdom of Quitirvan, and that it was environed with high mountains, at the foot whereof, upon the brink of the water, were eight and thirty villages, of which thirteen were very great, and the rest small, and that only in one of the great on●s, called Xincaleu, there was such a huge ours of gold, as by the rep●●t of those that lived thereabout, there was every day a bar and a half drawn out of it, which, according to the value of our money, makes two and twenty millions in a year, and that four Lords had share in it, who continually were in war together, each one striving to make himself master of it; I, and that one of them, named Raiahitau, had in an inner yard of his house, in pots under ground, that were full to the very brims, above six hundred bars of gold in powder, like to that of Mexancabo of the Island of Samatra; And th●● if three hundred Harquebusiers of our Nation should go and assault it, without doubt they would carry it: Moreover that in another of those Villages, called Buaquirim, there was a quarry, where out of an old Rock they digged a great quantity of Diamonds, that were very fine, and of greater value than those of Lava and Taniampura in the Isle of jaoa. Whereupon Antonio de Faria having questioned them about many other particularities, they made him a relation of the fertility of the Country, which was further up this River, no less fit to be desired, then easy to be conquered, and that with little charge. Being departed from this River of Pullo Cambim, §. 2. we sailed along the Coast of the Kingdom of Champaa, till we came to an Haven, called Saleyzacau, seventeen leagues farther on towards the North, whereinto we entered. Now because there was nothing to be gotten there, we went out of this place about sunset, and the next morning we came to a River, named Toobasoy, without the which Antonio de Faria cast anchor, because the Pilot would not venture to enter into it, for that he had never been there before, and therefore knew not the depth of it. As we were contesting hereabout, some for to enter, and others gainsaying it, we discerned a great sail making towards this Port from the main Sea. Hereupon, without stirring from the place where we were, we prepared to receive them in a peaceable manner, so that as soon as they came near us, we saluted them, and hung up the flag of the Country, called Charachina, which is a sign of friendship, used among them in such like occasions. They of the ship, in stead of answering us in the same manner, as in reason it seemed they should have done, and knowing that we were Portugals, to whom they wished not well, gave us very vile and base words, and from the top of their poup made a capher slave hold up his arse bare to us with a mighty noise and din of Trumpets, Drums, and Bells, by way of scorn and derision of us. Whereat Antonio de Faria was so offended, that he gave them a whole broad side, to see if that would make them more courteous; To this sho● of ours they returned us an answer of five pieces of Ordnance, namely three Falcons, and two little field-pieces; whereupon consulting together what we should do, we resolved to abide where we were, for we held it not fit to undertake so doubtful an enterprise, until such time as the next days light might discover the forces of this Vessel unto us, that so we might afterwards either set upon her with the more security, or let her pass by: This counsel was approved both by Antonio de Faria, and us all, so that keeping good watch, and giving order for all that was necssary, we continued in that place expecting day; now about two of the clock in the morning we perceived three black things close to the water coming towards us, which we could not well discern, whereupon we wakened Antonio de Faria, who was then asleep on the hatches, and showed him what we had discovered, being by that time not far from us; He fearing, as we did, lest they were Enemies, cried out presently, Arm, Arm, Arm, wherein he was straightway obeyed; for now plainly perceiving that they were Vessels rowing towards us, we betook us to our Arms, and were bestowed by our Captain in places most necessary to defend ourselves. We conceived by their silent approaching to us, that they were the Enemies we had seen over night, so that Antonio de Faria said unto us, My masters, this is some Pirate coming to set upon us, who thinks we are not above six or seven at the most, as the manner is in such kind of Vessels; wherefore let every man stoop down, so as they may not see any of us, and then we shall soon know their design; in the mean time let the pots of powder be made ready, with which, and our sword's, I hope we shall give a good end to this adventure: Let every one also hide his match in such sort, as they may not be discovered, whereby they may be persuaded that we are asleep: all which, as he had prudently ordained, was incontinently executed. These three Vessels, being come within a ●light shoot of our●, went round about her, and after they had viewed her well, they joined all close together, as if they had entered into some new consultation, continuing so about a quarter of an hour; that done, they separated themselves into two parts, namely the two lesser went together to our poup, and the third, that was greater, and better armed, made to the starboard of us; Hereupon they entered our Lorch where most conveniently they could, so that in less than half a quarter of an hour above forty men were gotten in, which seen by Antonio de Faria, he issued out from under the hatches with some forty Soldiers, and invoking Saint james our Patron, he fell so courageously upon them, that in a short time he killed them almost all; Then with aid of the pots of powder, that he caused to be cast in amongst those that were remaining in the three Vessels which he presently took, he made an end of defeating them, the most of them being constrained to leap into the Sea, where they were all drowned but five, whom we took up alive, whereof one was the capher slave that showed us his tail, and the other four were one Turk, two A●hems, and the Captain of the Junk, named Similau, a notorious Pirate, and our mortal Enemy. Antonio de Faria commanded them instantly to be put to torture, for to draw out of them who they were, from whence they came, and what they would have had of us, whereunto the two Achems answered most brutishly; and when as we were going about to torment the slave in like manner, he began with tears to beseech us to spare him, for that he was a Christian as we were, and that without torture he would answer truly to all our demands; whereupon Antonio de Faria caused him to be unbound, and setting him by him, gave him a piece of Biscuit, and a glass of wine, then with fair words he persuaded him to declare the truth of every thing to him, since he was a Christian, as he affirmed; To which he replied in this sort, If I do not speak the truth unto you▪ then take me not for such as I am; my name is Sebastian, and I was slave to Gaspar de melo, whom this dog Simila●, here present, slew about two years ago in Liampao, with five and twenty other Portugals that were in his ship. Antonio de Faria hearing this, cried out, like a man amazed, and said, Nay now I care not for knowing any more; is this then that dog Similau, that slew thy master? Yes, answered he, it is he, and that meant likewise to have done as much to you, thinking that ye were not above six or seven, for which effect he came away in haste with a purpose, as he said, to take you alive, for to make your brains fly out of your heads with a frontal of cord, as he did to my Master, but God I hope will pay him for all the mischief he hath committed. Antonio de Faria being also advertised by this slave, that this dog Similau had brought all his men of war along with him, and left none in his Junk but some Chinese Mariners, he resolved to make use of this good fortune, after he had put Similau and his companions to death, by making their brains fly out of their heads with a cord, as Similau had done to Gaspar de melo, and the other Portugals in Liampao: Wherefore he presently embarked himself with thirty Soldiers in his Boat, and the three Machna●, wherein the Enemies came, and by means of the ●lood and a favourable wind, he arrived withless than an hour, where the Junk road at anchor within the River about a league from us, whereupon he presently boarded her, and made himself master of the poup, from whence, with only four pots of powder, which he cast in among the Rascals that were asleep upon the hatches, he made them all leap into the Sea, where nine or ten of them were drowned, the rest crying out for help were taken up and saved, because we stood in need of them for the navigation of the Junk, that was a great tall Vessel. Thus you see how it pleased God out of his divine justice to make the arrogant confidence of this cursed dog a means to chastise him for his cruelties, and to give him by the hands of Portugals a just punishment for that which he had done unto them. The next morning, taking an inventory of this prize, we found six and thirty thousand Ta●is in silver of japan, which amounts in our money to fifty four thousand ducats, besides divers other good commodities, that were not then praised for want of time, because the Country was all in an uproar, and fires every where kindled, whereby they use to give warning one to another upon any alarm or doubt of Enemies, which constrained us to make away with all speed. §. 3. Antonio de Faria parted from this River of Toobasoy on a Wednesday morning, being Corpus Christi Eve, in the year 1540 and sailed along by the Coast of the Kingdom of Champaa, fearing to abandon it, the wind being Easterly, which in that place is oftentimes very impetuous, especially in the conjunction of the new and full Moons. The Friday following we found ourselves just against a River, called by the inhabitants of the Country Tinacoreu, and by us Varella, whereinto we thought fit to enter, as well to be informed of certain things Antonio de Faria desired to know, as also to see whether he could learn any news of Coia Acem whom he sought for, in regard that all the Junks of Siam, and of all the Coast of Malaya, that sail to China, use to trade in this River, where many times they sell their commodities well in exchange of gold, Calembouc wood, and Ivory, whereof there is abundance in that Kingdom; and having cast anchor a little within the mouth of the River, over against a Village, named Taquilleu, there came a number of Paroos, and many other small Boats with fishermen, full of refreshments, who having never seen men made like unto us, said one to another; Lo, this is a strange novelty wherewithal God doth visit us, let us beseech him he will be pleased, that these bearded men may not be such as for their particular profit do spy Countries like Merchants, and afterwards rob them like Thiefs. Let us get to the woods for fear lest the sparks of these firebrands do not burn up our houses, and reduce the fields of our labours into ashes, as they use to do unto the Lands of other men. Whereunto some of them made answer, God forbid it should be so; but if by misfortune they should come amongst us, let us carry ourselves in such sort, as they may not perceive we fear them as Enemies, for so they would set upon us with the more confidence; wherefore the best course for us will be, in a fair way, and with gentle words, to endeavour to learn of th●m what they would have of us, that upon knowledge thereof we may certify it unto Hoyaa Paquir, who is now at Congrau. Antonio de Faria, making as though he did not understand them, although all that they said was delivered to him by an Interpreter, received them very courteously, and bought the refreshments, which they brought, of them at their own price, wherewithal they were very well satisfied; And they demanding of him from whence he came, and what he would have, he answered them, that he was of the Kingdom of Siam, and as a Merchant was going to traffic in the Isle of Lequios, being come into that place only to learn some news of a friend of his named Coia Acem, that was also bound thither: whereupon he enquired of them whether he were passed by, or no; howsoever he intended to depart thence suddenly, both for to lose no time, as for that he knew he could not sell his commodities there. To which they replied, You say true, for in this village of ours there is nothing but nets and fisher Boats, wherewith we get our living, and that poorly enough God knows. Howbeit, added they, if thou wilt go up the River to the Town of Pilaucacem, where the King is, thou wilt sell not only the commodities which are in thy ships, be they never so rich, but likewise more than ten such ships as thine could carry, by reason that there are Merchants in that place so wealthy, and that drive so great a trade, as they go with whole Troops of Elephants, Oxen, and Camels, whom they send laden with goods to the Lands of the Lauhos, Pafuaas, and Gueos, which are inhabited by very rich people. Antonio de Faria seeing a good occasion offered to inform himself of that he desired to know, questioned them at large concerning many things, whereunto some of them, that seemed to be of more authority than the rest, answered very aptly, how the River, where we road at anchor, was called Tinacoreu, and that it extended to Moncalor, a mountain dist●nt from thence some fourscore leagues, and that further upwards it was far broader, but not so deep, where in many places there was great shelves of sand, and a world of land overflown with water, in the which wer● such a multitude of fowls, as they covered all the Country thereabout; And how beyond that it was all mountainous and rocky, and so full of Elephants, Rhinoceroses, Lions, wild Boars, Buffles, and such other wild beast's, as men could not possibly live there for them; And moreover, how in the midst of that continent there was a great Lake, which the inhabitants thereof called Cunebetea, and others Chiammay, from whence this River took its beginning, as also three others, that watered a good part of this Country; And that the said Lake, according to the report of those who have written of it, was threescore Jaos about, each Jao containing three Leagues, all along the which there were many Ours of Silver, Copper, Tin, and Led, from whence great quantities thereof were continually drawn, which the Merchants carried away with Troops of Elephants and Rhinoceroses, for to transport it into the Kingdoms of Sornau, by us called Siam, Passiloco, Sarady, Tangu, Prom, Calamniham, and other Provinces, that are very far within land, and distant from these Coasts two or three months' journey. Further, they told us, that these Countries were divided into Kingdoms, and Regions inhabited with people, that were white, tawny, and others somewhat blacker; and that in exchange of those commodities they returned Gold, Diamonds, and Rubies. Having thereupon demanded of them whether those people had Arms, they answered none, but staves hardened in the fire, and daggers with blades two spans long; They also assured us that from hence one could not go thither by the River in less than half two months, or two months and an half, by reason of the impetuosity of the waters descending with a great and strong current the most part of the year, and that one might return in eight or ten days at the most. After these demands Antonio de Faria made them divers others, wherein they also gave him good satisfaction▪ and reported many other particulars unto him, whereby it may be gathered, that if the Country could be taken, it would, without so much labour and loss of blood, be of greater profit, and less charge, than the Indias. The Friday following we left this River of Tinacoreu, §. 4. and by our Pilots advice we went to find out Pullo Champeiloo, which is an inhabited Island, situate in the entrance to the Bay of Cauchenchina in forty degrees and a third to the Northward; Being come to it, we cast anchor in an Haven, where there was good and safe riding, and there we remained three days, accommodating our artillery in the best manner we could; That done, we set sail towards the Isle of Ainan, hoping to meet with the Pirate Coia Acem there whom we sought for, and arriving at Pullo Capas, which was the first land that we saw of it, we sailed close to the shore, the better to discover the Ports and Rivers on that side, and the entries into them. Now because the Lorch, wherein Antonio de Faria came from Pa●ana, leaked very much, ●e commanded all his Soldiers to pass into another better Vessel, which was immediately performed, and arriving at a River, that about evening we found towards the East, he cast anchor a league out at Sea, by reason his Junk was great, and drew much water, so that fearing the sands, which he had often met withal in this Voyage, he sent Christovano B●rralho with fourteen Soldiers in the Lorch up the River to discover what fires those might be that he saw. Being gone then about a league in the River, he encountered a Fleet of forty very great Junks, whereupon fearing le●t it was the Mandarims' Army, whereof we had heard much talk, he kept aloof off from them, and anchored close by the shore; now about midnight the tide began to come in, which B●rralho no sooner perceived, but he presently without noise weighed anchor, and declining the Junks he went on to that part where he had seen the fires, that by this time were almost all out, there being not above two or three that gave any light, and which served to guide him. So continuing his course very discreetly, he came to a place where he beheld a mighty company of great and small Ships, to the number as he guessed of thousand Sails, passing through the which very stilly he arrived at a Town of above ten thousand households, enclosed with a strong wall of Brick, with Towers and Bulwarks after our manner, and with Curtains full of water. Here five of the fourteen Soldiers, that were in the Lorch, went on shore with two of those Chinese●es, that were saved out of Similaus Junk, who had left their wives as hostages with us for their return; These having spent three hours in viewing and surveying the Town on the outside, reimbarqued themselves without any notice taken of them at all, and so went back very quietly as they came to the mouth of the River, where they found a Junk riding at anchor, that was come thither since their departure in the evening. Being returned to Antonio de Faria, they related unto him what they had seen, particularly the great Army that lay up in the River, as also the Junk, which they had left riding at anchor at the entrance into it, telling him that it might well be the Dog Coia Acem whom he sought for. These news so rejoiced him, that instantly he weighed anchor, and set sail, saying, his mind gave him that it was undoubtedly he; and if it proved so, he assured us all that he was contented to lose his life in fight with him, for to be revenged of such a Rogue as had done him so much wrong. Approaching within sight of the Junk, he commanded the Lorch to pass unto the other side of her, to the end they might board her both together at once, and charged that not a Piece should be shot off, for fear they should be heard of the Army that lay up in the River, who might thereupon come to discover them. As soon as we were come to the Junk, she was presently invested by us, and twenty of our Soldiers leaping in made themselves Masters of her without any resistance, for the most of her men threw themselves into the Sea, the rest that were more courageous valiantly made head against our people; but Antonio de Faria presently getting in with twenty Soldiers more made an end of defeating them, killing above thirty of theirs, so as there remained none alive but those which voluntarily cast themselves into the Sea, whom he caused to be drawn up to serve for the Navigation of his Vessels, and for to learn who they were, and from whence they came, to which purpose he commanded four of them to be put to torture, whereof two chose rather to die so then to confe●● any thing; and as they were about to do the like to a little boy, an old man, his father, that was laid on the deck, cried out with tears in his eyes for to give him the hearing before they did any hurt to the child; Antonio de Faria made the Executioner stay, and bade the old man say what he would, provided he spoke truth, for otherwise he vowed, that both he and the boy should be thrown alive into the Sea, whereas on the contrary, if he dealt truly, he promised to set them both at liberty on shore, and restore unto him whatsoever he would take his oath did appertain unto him: Whereunto the old Mahometan answered, I accept of the promise which thou makest me, and I very much thank thee for sparing the life of this child, for as for mine, as a thing unprofitable, I make no reckoning of it, and I will rely on thy word, although the course thou heldest may well divert me from it, in regard it is no way conformable to the Christian Law, which thou hast professed in thy Baptism▪ An answer, that rendered Antonio de Faria so confounded and amazed, as he knew not wha●●o reply; Howbeit he caused him to come ne●rer to him, and questioned him gently without any further threatening. §. 5. This old man than sat him down by Antonio de Faria, who seeing him white like unto us, asked him whether he were a Turk, or a Persian? whereunto he answered, that he was neither, but that he was a Christian, born at Mount Sinai. Antonio de Faria thereupon replied, how he wondered much, being a Christian, as he said, that he lived not amongst Christians. To which the old man answered, that he was a Merchant of a good family, named Tom Mostanguo, and that riding one day at anchor in a Ship of his in the Port of judaa, in the year one thousand five hundred thirty and eight, Soliman the Bassa, Viceroy of Cairo, took his, and sev●n others Ships, to carry Victual and Munition for his Army of threescore Galleys, wherewith he went by the Command of the grand Signior to restore Sultan Bandur to his Kingdom of Cambaya, which the great Mogul had deprived him of; And that at the end of the Voyage going to demand the freight which they had promised him, the Turks, that were ever cruel and faithless, took his wife, and a young daughter he had; and forced them before his face, and because his son wept at the sight of this injury they threw him bound hand and foot into the Sea; as for himself, they laid him in Irons, and continually scourging him they stripped him of all his goods, to the value of six thousand ducats and better, saying, that it was not lawful for any to enjoy the blessings of God, but the holy and just Mouss●limans, such as they were: And that his wife and daughter dying not long after, he found means one night to cast himself into the Sea with that little boy, which was his son, at the mouth of the River of Diu, from whence he went by Land to Surrat, and so to Malaca in a ship of Garcia de Saas, Captain of Bacaim; then how by the commandment of Estevano de Gama, going to China with Christovano Sardinha, which had been Factor at the Molucques, one night as they road at anchor in Cincaapura, Quiay Taijano, Master of the Junk, surprised them, and killed the said Sardinha, together with six and twenty Portugals more; as for him, because he was a Gunner they saved his life. At this report Antonio de Faria striking himself on the breast, as a man amazed at this discourse, Lord, Lord, said he, this seems to be a dream that I hear; then turning himself to his Soldiers that stood about him, he related the life of this Quiay unto them, and further affirmed, that he had slain at times in strayed Vessels above an hundred Portugals, and despoiled them of an hundred thousand ducats at least; And though his name was such, as this Armenian delivered, to wit, Quiay Taijano, yet after he had killed Christovano Sardinha in Cincaapura, in a vainglory of that which he had done he caused himself to be called Captain Sardinha. Whereupon having demanded of the Armenian where he was, he told us, that he was very sore hurt, and hidden in the hold of the Junk amongst the Cables with five or six others. Hereat Antonio de Faria arose, and went directly to the place where this Dog was hidden, followed by the greatest part of his Soldiers, which opened the scuttle where the Cables lay to see whether the Armenian spoke true or no; in the mean time the Dog, and the six others that were with him, got out at another scuttle, and most desperately fell upon our men, who were above thirty in number, besides fourteen boys. Then began there so furious and bloody a fight, that in less than a quarter of an hour we made a clean dispatch of them all, but in the mean while two Portugals, and seven boys were slain, besides I know not how many hurt, whereof Antonio de Faria received two downright blows on his head, and one on his arm, which put him to very much pain. After this defeat, and that the wounded men were dressed, he set sail, for fear of the forty Junks that were in the River: So getting far from Land, about evening we went and anchored on the other side of Cauchenchina, where Antonio de Faria causing an Inventory to be taken of all that was in this Pirates Junk, there was found in her five hundred Bars of Pepper, after fifty quintals to the Bar, forty of Nutmegs and Mace, fourscore of Tin, thirty of Ivory, twelve of Wax, and five of Wood of fine Aloes, which might be worth according to the rate of the Country seventy thousand ducats; besides a little field Piece, four Falcons, and thirty Bases of Brass, the greatest part of which Artillery had been ours, for this Mahometan had taken them in the ships of Sardinha, Oliveyra, and Bartolemeu de Matos: There were also found three Coffers covered with Leather, full of Silk quilts, and the apparel of Portugals, with a great Basin and Ewer silver and guilt, and a Salt-seller of the same, two and twenty Spoons, three Candlesticks, five guilt Cups, eight and fifty Harquebusses, twelve hundred twenty and two pieces of Bengala Cloth, all which were Portugal's goods, eighteen quintals of Powder, and nine Children about seven or eight years of age, chained together by the hands and the feet, most lamentable to behold, for that they were so weak and lean, that one might easily through their skins have counted all the bones in their bodies. CHAP. XVI. Antonio de Faria's Arrival at the Bay of Camoy, where was the fishing of Pearls for the King of China; the Relation made to him of the Isle of Ainan; with that which happened to him by the means of a renegado Pirate, and otherwise. §. 1. THe next day after noon, Antonio de Faria parted from the place where he road at anchor, and returned towards the Coast of Ainan, by the which he kept all the rest of that day, and the next night with five and twenty or thirty fathom water. In the morning he came to a Bay, where there were many great Boats fishing for Pearls, and being unresolved what course to take, he bestowed all the forenoon in counsel with his company thereabout, whereof some were of the opinion that he should seize upon the Boats that were fishing for Pearls, and others opposed it, saying, it was a safer way to treat with them as Merchants, for that in exchange of the great store of Pearls, which were in that place, they might easily put off the most part of their Commodities. This appearing to be the best and safest advice, Antonio de Faria caused the Flag of Trade to be hung out, according to the Custom of China, so that instantly there came two Lanteaas from Land to us, which are Vessels like to Foists, with great abundance of refreshments, and those that were in them, having saluted us after their manner, went aboard the great Junk wherein Antonio de Faria was; but when they beheld men, such as we were, having never seen the like before, they were much amazed, and demanded what people we were, and wherefore we came into their Country. Whereunto we answered by an Interpreter, that we were Merchants born in the Kingdom of Siam, and were come thither to sell or barter our Commodities with them, if so be they would permit us. To this, an old man, much respected of all the rest, replied, that here was no Traffic used, but in another place ●urther forward, called Guamboy, where all strangers that came from Cantan, Chincheo, Lamau, Comhay, Sumbor, Liampau, and other Sea-coast Towns, did ordinarily trade: Wherefore he counselled him to get him suddenly from thence, in regard this was a place destined only to the fishing of Pearls for the Treasure of the house of the son of the Sun, to the which, by the Ordinance of the Tutan of Comhay, who was the sovereign Governor of all the Country of Cauchenchina, no Vessel was permitted to come, but only such as were appointed for that service, and that all other ships, which were found there, were by the Law to be burnt, and all that were in them; but since he, as a stranger, and ignorant of the Laws of the Country, had transgressed the same, not out of contempt, but want of knowledge, he thought fit to advertise him of it, to the end he might be gone from thence before the arrival of the Mandarim of the Army, which we call General, to whom the Government of that fishing appertained, and that would be within three or four days at the most, being gone not above six or seven leagues from thence to a Village, named Buhaquirim, for to take in Victual. Antonio de Faria thanking him for his good advice, asked him how many Sails, and what Forces the Mandarim had with him: Whereunto the old man answered, that he was accompanied with forty great Junks, and twenty five Vancans with oars, wherein there were seven thousand men, namely, five thousand Soldiers, and the rest Slaves and Mariners; and that he was there every year six Months, during the which time was the fishing for Pearls, that is to say, from the first of March to the last of August. Our Captain desiring to know what duties were paid out of this fishing, and what revenue it yielded in those six Months, the old man told him, that of Pearls which weighed above five Carats they gave two thirds, of the worse sort h●lf less, and of seed Pearl the third part; and that this Revenue was not always alike, because the fishing was sometimes better in one year, then in another, but that one with another he thought it might yield annually four hundred thousand Ta●is. Antonio de Faria made very much of the old man, and gave him two cakes of Wax, a bag of Pepper, and a tooth of Ivory, wherewith both he and the rest were exceedingly well pleased. He also demanded of them, of what bigness this Isle of Ainan might be, whereof so many wonders were spoken. Tell us first, replied they, who you are, and wherefore you are come hither, then will we satisfy you in that you desire of us; for we vow unto you, that in all our lives we never saw so many young fellows together in any Merchant's ships, as we now see in this of yours, nor so spruce and ne●t; and it seems that in their Country China Silks are so cheap as they are of no esteem, or else that they have had them at so easy a rate, as they have given nothing near the worth for them, for we see them play away a piece of Damask at one cast at Dice, as those that come lightly by them: A speech that made Antonio de Faria secretly to smile, for that thereby he well perceived how these fishermen had a shrewd guess that the same were stolen, which made him tell them, that they did this like young men, who were the sons of very rich Merchants, and in that regard valued things far under that they were worth, and had cost their fathers; dissembling then what they thought, they answered in this manner, It may very well be as you say. Whereupon Antonio de Faria gave a sign to the Soldiers to leave off their play, and to hide the pieces of Silk that they were playing for, to the end they might not be suspected for Robbers by these folks, which immediately they did, and the better to assure these Chineses that we were honest men, and Merchants, our Captain commanded the scuttles of the Junk to be opened, that we had taken the night before from Captain Sardinha, which was laden with Pepper, whereby they were somewhat restored to a better opinion than they had of us before, saying one to another, Since now we find that they are Merchants indeed, let us freely answer to their demand, so as they may not think, though we be rude, that we know nothing but how to catch fish and Oysters. The old man desiring to satisfy Antonio de Faria's demand, Sir, said he, §. 2. since now I know what you are, and that only out of curiosity you fairly require to learn this particular of me, I will clearly tell you all that I know thereof, and what I have heard others deliver concerning it, that have been elder than myself, and which have a long time governed this Archipelague; They said then, that this Island was an absolute State under a very rich and mighty King, who, for an higher and more transcendent title than other Monarches his Contemporaries carried, caused himself to be styled Prechau Gam●u; He dying without heirs, so great a discord arose amongst the people about the succession to the Crown, as increasing by little and little it caused such effusion of blood, that the Chronicles of those times affirm, how only in four years and an half sixteen Lacazaas of men were slain, every Lacazaa containing an hundred thousand, by means wheroof the Country remained so deserted of people, that unable to defend itself the King of Cauchin conquered it, only with seven thousand Mogores, which the King of Tartary sent him from the City of Tuymican, that then was Metrapolitan of all his Empires. This Island of Ainan being conquered, the King of Cauchin returned into his Country, and for Governor thereof left behind him a Commander of his, named Hoyha Paguarol, who revolted from him for certain just causes, as he pretended, that invited him thereunto. Now to have the assistance and support of the King of China, he became his Tributary for four hundred thousand Taeis by the year, which amount to six hundred thousand ducats, in consideration whereof the King of China obliged himself to defend him against all his enemies, whensoever he should have need: This accord continued between them the space of thirteen years, during the which the King of Cauchin was five several times defeated in open Battle; At length this Hoyha Paguarol coming to die without issue, in regard of the good offices that in his life time he had received from the King of China, he by his testament declared him for his Successor and lawful Heir, so that ever since, being now two hundred thirty and five years ago, to this present, this Isle of Ainan hath remained annexed to the Sceptre of the great Chinese. And touching that you have further demanded of me concerning the Treasures, and Revenue of this Island, I am able to say no more than what I have learned of some ancient Personages, who, as I have related before, have governed it in quality of Teutons, and Chaems, and I remember they said, that all the Revenues thereof, as well in Ours of Silver, Customs, and otherways, amounted unto two Millions and an half Taeis yearly; And perceiving that our Captain was amazed to hear him speak of so mighty a riches, continuing his discourse, Truly, my Masters, said he laughing, if you make such a matter of that little I have spoken of, what would you do if you saw the great City of Pequin, where the son of the Sun (the name they give to their King) with his Court is always resident, and where the Revenues of two and thirty Kingdoms, that depend on this Monarchy, are received, of which out of fourscore and six Ours of Gold and Silver only is annually drawn above fifteen thousand Picos, which according to our weight comes to twenty thousand quintals? After Antonio de Faria had given him many thanks for satisfying him so fully in his demands, he desired him to tell him in what Port he would advise him to go and sell his Commodities, seeing the season was not proper to set sail for Liampoo. Whereunto he answered, that we were not to go into any Port of that Country, nor to put trust in any Chinese whatsoever; for I assure you, said he, there is not one of them will speak truth in any thing he says to you, and believe me, for I am rich, and will not lie to you like a poor man; besides, I would wish you to go in this Strait always with the plummet in your hand for to sound your way, because there are very many dangerous shelus all along till you come to a River called Tanauquir, and there is a Port where is very good anchoring, and where you may be as safe as you can desire, as also you may there, in less than two days, put off all your commodities, and much more if you had them. Nevertheless I will not counsel you to disimbarque your goods on land, but to sell them in your Vessels, in regard that many times the sight causeth desire, and desire disorder amongst peaceable persons, much more with them that are mutinous and of an evil conscience, whose wicked inclination carries them rather to take away another man's goods from him, then give of their own to the needy for God's sake. This said, both he that spoke, and those that accompanied him, took leave of our Captain, and us, with many compliments and promises, whereof they are not ordinarily very sparing in those parts, bestowing on Antonio de Faria, in return of that he had given them, a little Box made of a Tortoise shell, full of seed-pearl, and twelve pearls of a pretty bigness, craving his pardon for that they durst not traffic with him in this place, for fear lest if they should do so, to be all put to death, conformably to the Law of the rigorous justice of the Country; and they again entreated him to make haste away before the Mandarims' arrival with his Army, for if he found him there, he would burn both his Vessel, and him and all his company. Antonio de Faria unwilling to neglect the counsel of this man, lest that which he told him should prove true, he set sail immediately, and passed to the other side towards the South, and in two days with a Westerly wind he arrived at the River of Tanauquir, where just over against a little village, called Neytor, he cast anchor. §. 3. We remained all that day, and the next night, at the mouth of the River of Tanauquir, intending the next morning to sail up to the Town, which was some five leagues from thence in the River, to see if by any means we might put off our commodities there, for our Vessels were so heavy laden with them, as there was scarce a day wherein we ran not twice or thrice on some shelve or other, which in divers places were four or five leagues long, wherefore it was concluded that before we did any thing else we were to sell away our commodities, so that we laboured with all our might to get into the River, whose current was so strong, that though we had all our sails up, yet could we prevail but very little against it; As we were in this pain we perceived two great Junks in warlike manner come out of the River upon us, which chaining themselves together for the more strength, attaqued us so lively, as we had scarce the leisure to defend ourselves, so that we were constrained to throw into the Sea all that stood in our way to make room for our artillery, being that we had then most need of: The first salutation we had from them was a peal of six and twenty pieces of Ordnance, whereof nine were Falconets, and field-pieces: Antonio de Faria, as a man versed in such affairs, seeing them chained one to another, perceived their drift, and therefore made as though he fled, as well to win time to prepare himself, as to make them believe that they were no Christians; whereupon they, like cunning thiefs, desiring that the prey, which they held to be surely their own, should not escape out of their hands, loosed themselves the one from the other the better to set upon us, and approaching very near to us, they shot so many arrows and darts into our Junk, as no man was able to appear upon the deck: Antonio de Faria, to avoid this storm, retired under the half deck, with five and twenty Soldiers, and some ten or twelve others, Slaves and Mariners; there he entertained the Enemy with Harquebuse shot the space of half an hour, in which time, having used all their munitions of war, some forty of them, that seemed to be more valiant than the rest, longing to finish their enterprise, leapt into our Junk, with a purpose to make themselves master of the prow; but to hinder them from it, our Captain was constrained to go and receive them, so that there began a most bloody fight, wherein it pleased God within an hour to give us the upper hand by the slaughter of four and twenty of their forty in the place: Thereupon twenty of ours, pursuing this good success, boarded the Enemies Junk, where finding but small resistance, by reason the principals were already slain, all that were in her quickly rendered themselves unto us. That done, Antonio de Faria went with all speed to succour Christovano Borral●o, who was boarded by the other Junk, and very doubtful of the victory, in regard the greatest part of his men were hurt, but at our approach the Enemies threw themselves all into the Sea, where most of them were drowned, and so both the Junks remained in our power. After this we took a survey of our company, the better to understand what this victory had cost us, and we found there was one Portugal, five Boys, and nine Mariners killed, besides those that were hurt: and on the Enemy's part fourscore were slain, and almost as many taken. Having given order then for the dressing and accommodating of our wounded men in the best manner that could be, Antonio de Faria caused as many Mariners to be taken up as could be saved, and commanding them to be brought into the great Junk where he was, he demanded of them what those Junks were, how the Captain of them was named, and whether he were alive or dead, whereunto not one of them would make any answer, but chose rather to die in torments like mad dogs, when as Christovano Borralho cried out from the Junk where he was, Signior, Signior, come hither quickly, for we have more to do then we think of; whereat Antonio de Faria, accompanied with fifteen or sixteen of his men, leapt into his Junk, ask what the matter was? I hear a many talking together, said he, towards the prow, which I doubt are hidden there; hereupon opening the scuttle, they heard divers cry out, Lord jesus have mercy upon us; and that in such a woeful manner, as struck u● all with pity: Antonio de Faria approaching to the scuttle, and looking down, could perceive some persons there shut up, but not able to discern what they might be▪ he made two of his boys to go down, who a little after brought up seventeen Christians, namely two Portugals, five small children, two girls, and eight boys, which were in such a lamentable case, as would have grieved any heart to have beheld them; The first thing he did was to cause their Irons to be strucken off, and then he enquired of one of the Portugals (for the other was like a man dead) unto whom those children appertained, and how they fell into the hands of this Pirate, as also what his name was. Whereunto he answered, that the Pirate had two names, the one Christian, the other Pagan, and that his Pagan name, wherewith he used to be called of late, was Necoda Nicaulem, and his Christian name Francisco d● Saa, being Christened at Malaca, at such time as Garcia de Saa was Captain of the Fortress, and for that he was his godfather, and had caused him to be baptised, he gave him that name, and married him to an orphan maid, a very handsome wench, the daughter of an honourable Portugal, to oblige him the more to our Religion and Country; but in the year 1534. setting sail for China in a great Junk of his, wherein there accompanied him twenty of the wealthiest Portugals of Malaca, as also his wife, and arriving at the Island of Pullo Cat●n, they stayed two days to take in fresh water, during which time he and his Company, who were all Chineses like himself, and no better Christians, conspired the death of the poor Portugals for to despoil them of their goods, so that one night whilst the Portugals were asleep, and little dreamed of such Treason, they killed them all with their little hatchets, and their servants likewise, not sparing the life of any one that bore the name of a Christian; after which, he persuaded, with his wife, to turn Pagan, and adore an Idol, that Tucan, Captain of the Junk, had concealed in his chest, and that then being free from the Christian Religion he would marry her to Tucan, who in exchange would give him a sister of hi●to wife, that was a Chinese, and there with him. But in regard she would neither adore the Idol, nor consent to the rest, the dog struck her over the head with his hatchet till her brains fl●w out, and then departing from thence went to the Port of Liampoo, where the same year before he had traded; and not daring to go to Patana, for fear of the Portugals that resided there, he wintered at Siam, and the year following he returned to the Port of Chincheo, where he took a little Junk that came from Su●da, with ten Portugals in her, all which he slew; And because the wickedness that he had done us was known over all the Country, doubting to encounter some Portugal forces, he had retired himself into this strait of Cauche●china, where as a Merchant he traded, and as a Pirate rob those he met withal that were weaker than himself. It being now three years since he had taken this River for a refuge of his Robberies, thinking himself secure here from us Portugals, by reason we have not used to traffic in the Ports of this strait, and Island of Ainan. Antonio de Faria asked of him whether those children belonged to the Portugals he had mentioned before; whereunto he answered, that they did not, but that both they, and the boys and girls, were the children of Nuno Preto, Gian de Diaz, and of Pero B●rges, whom he had killed at Mompollacota, near the mouth of the River of Siam in joano Oliveyra's Junk, where he also put sixteen Portugals more to death, only he saved their two lives, because one was a shipwright, and the other a Caulker, and had carried them along with him in this manner, continually whipping, and almost famishing of them; further he said, that when he set upon us, he did not think we had been Portugal●, but some Chinese Merchant, like such as he had accustomed to rob when he found them at advantage, as he thought to have found us. Antonio de Faria demanded of him, whether he could know the Pirate amongst those other dead bodies? Having replied that he could, the Captain presently arose, and taking him by the hand, went with him into the other Junk, that was fastened to his, and having made him view all that lay dead upon the hatches, he said that it was none of them. Whereupon he commanded a Manchuas, which is a little boat, to be made ready, wherein he and this man went and sought for him amongst the other dead bodies that floated on the water, where they found him with a great cut over his head, and a thrust quite through the body; so causing him to be taken up, and laid upon the hatches, he demanded of that man again, if he were sure that this was he, who answered, how without doubt it was he. Whereunto Antonio de Faria gave the more credit, by reason of a great chain of gold he had about his neck, to which was fastened an Idol of gold with two heads, made in the form of a Lizard, having the tail and paws enammelled with green and black, and commanding him to be drawn towards the prow, he caused his head to be chopped off, and the rest of the body to be cut in pieces, which were cast into the Sea. §. 4. Having obtained this victory in the manner I have before declared, caused our hurt men to be dressed, and provided for the guard of our Captains, we took an Inventory of the goods that were in these two Junks, and found that our prize was worth forty thousand Taeis, which was immediately committed to the charge of Antonio Borges, who was Factor for the Prizes. Both the Junks were great and good, yet were we constrained to burn one of them for want of Mariners to man it: There was in them besides seventeen pieces of brass Ordnance, namely four Faulconets, and thirteen small pieces, the most part whereof had the Royal Arms of Portugal upon them, for the Pirate had taken them in the three ships where he killed the forty Portugals. The next day Antonio de Faria went about once more to get into the River, but he was advised by fishermen, which he took a little before, that he should beware of going to the Town, because they were advised there of all that had passed betwixt him and the renegado Pirate, for whose death the people were in an uproar, in so much that if he would let them have his commodities for nothing, yet would they not take them, in regard that Chileu, the Governor of that Province, had contracted with him, to give him the third part of all the prizes he took, in lieu whereof he would render him a safe retreat in his Country; so that his loss now being great by the death of the Pirate, he should be but badly welcomed by him, and to that purpose had already commanded two great Rafts, covered with dry wood, barrels of pitch, and other combustible stuff, to be placed at the entering into the Port, that were to be kindled and sent down upon us, as soon as we had cast anchor, for to fire us, besides two hundred Paraos, full of shot, and men of war were also in readiness to assault us. These news made Antonio de Faria conclude to make away unto another Port, named Mutipinan, distant from thence above ●orty leagues towards the East, for that there were many rich Merchants, as well Natives as Strangers, which came in great Troops from the Countries of Laubos, Pafuaas, and Gu●os, with great sums of money. So we set sail with the three Junks, and the Lor●h, wherein we came from Patana, coasting the Land from one side to the other, by reason of a contrary wind, until we arrived at a place called Tilaumera, where we anchored, for that the current of the water ran very strong against us. After we had continued so three days together, with a contrary wind, and in great want of victual, our good fortune about Evening brought four Lanteaas unto us, that are like unto Foists, in one of the which was a Bride, that was going to a Village, named Pandurea: Now because they were all in jollity, they had so many Drums beating aboard them, as it was almost impossible to hear one another for the noise they made. Whereupon we were in great doubt what this might be, and wherefore there was such triumphing; some thought that they were spies sent from the Captain of Tanauquir's Army, who insulting, for that we were already in their power, gave this testimony thereof. Antonio de Faria left his anchors in the Sea, and preparing himself to sustain all that might happen unto him, he displayed all his Banners and Flags, and with demonstration of joy attended the arrival of these Lanteaas, who when they perceived us to be all together, imagining it was the Bridegroom that stayed to receive them, they came joyfully towards us. So after we had saluted one another after the manner of the Country, they went and anchored by the shore. And because we could not comprehend the mystery of this affair, all our Captains concluded that they were spies from the Enemy's Army, which forbore assaulting us in expectation of some other Vessels that were also to come; In this suspicion we spent the little remainder of that Evening, and almost two hours of the night: But then the Bride, seeing that her Spouse sent not to visit her, as was his part to do, to show the love she bore him she sent her Uncle in one of the Lanteaas with a Letter to him, containing these words. If the feeble sex of a woman would permit me to go from the place where I am for to see thy face, without reproach to mine honour, assure thyself that to kiss thy tardy feet my body would fly as doth the hungry Falcon after the fearful Heron; But since I am parted from my father's house, for to seek thee out here, come thyself hither to me, where indeed I am not, for I cannot see myself, but in seeing thee; Now if thou dost not come to see me in the obscurity of this night, making it bright for me, I fear that to morrow morning when thou arrivest here, thou shalt not find me living. My Uncle Licorpinau will more particularly acquaint thee with what I keep concealed in my heart, for I am not able to say any more, such is my grief to be so long deprived of thy so much desired sight; Wherefore I pray thee come unto me, or permit me to come unto thee, as the greatness of my love to thee doth deserve, and as thou art obliged to do unto her, whom now thou art to possess in marriage until death, from which Almighty God of his infinite goodness keep thee as many years, as the Sun and Moon have made turns about the World since the beginning of their birth. This Lanteaa being arrived with the Bride's Uncle and Letter, Antonio de Faria caused all the Portugals to hide themselves, suffering none to appear but our Chinese Mariners, to the end they might not be afraid of us; To our Junk then they approached with confidence, and three of them coming aboard us, asked where the Bridegroom was? All the answer we made them was to lay hold of them, and clap them presently under hatches; now because the most part of them were drunk, those that were in the Lanteaa never heard our bustling with them, nor if they had, could they have had time to escape, for suddenly from the top of our poup we fastened a cable to their mast, whereby they were so arrested, as it was impossible for them to get loose of us; whereupon casting in some pots of powder amongst them, the most of them leapt into the Sea, by which time six or seven of our Soldiers, and as many Mariners, got into the Lanteaa, and strait rendered themselves masters of her, where the next thing they did was to take up the poor wretches, who cried out that they drowned: Having made them sure, Antonio de Faria went towards the other three Lanteaas, that anchored some quarter of a league from thence, and coming to the first, wherein was the Bride, he entered her without any resistance, in regard there were none other in her but a few Mariners, and six or seven men, that seemed to be of good reckoning, all of kin to the Bride, being there only to accompany her, together with two little boys her brothers, that were very white, and certain ancient women, of such as in China are hired for money to dance, sing, and play of instruments upon like festival occasions. The other two Lanteaas beholding this sad success, left their anchors in the Sea, and fled in such haste, as if the Devil had been in them, but for all that we took one of them, so that we had three of the four: This done, we returned aboard our Junk, and by reason it was now midnight, we did nothing for the present but take our prisoners, and shut them up under the hatches, where they remained until day, that Antonio de Faria came to view them, and seeing they were most of them aged, full of sorrow, and fit for nothing, he caused them to be set a shore, retaining only the Bride, and her two brothers, because they were young, white, and well-favored, and some twenty Mariners, which afterwards were of great use to us for the navigation of our Junks. This Bride, as since we learned, was daughter to the A●chary of Colem (which signifies Governor) and betrothed to a youth, the son of the Chifuu, Captain of Pandurea, who had written unto her that he would attend her in this place with three or four Junks of his fathers, who was very rich, but alas! we shamefully cozened him. After dinner, being departed from thence, the Bridegroom arrived, seeking for his Bride with five sail full of Flags, Streamers, and Banners; Passing by us, he saluted us with great store of music, and shows of gladness, ignorant of his misfortune, and that we carried away his wife. In this jollity he doubled the Cape of Tila●mera, where the day before we took this prize, and there anchored attending his Bride, according as he had written to her, whilst we sailing on arrived three days after at the Port of Muti●iman, which was the place we aimed at, in regard of the advice that Antonio de Faria had, that there he might sell off his commodities. CHAP. XVII. Antonio de Faria's Arrival at the Port: The Information that Antonio de Faria had of the Country; some passages between him and the Nautarel of the Town; his going to the River of Madel; with his encountering a Pirate there, and that which passed betwixt them. ●. 1. BEing arrived at this Port we anchored in a Road, which the Land makes near to a little Island on the South side of the mouth of the River, at the entry whereinto we remained without saluting the Port, or making any noise, intending as soon as it was night to send for to sound the River, and to be informed of that we desired to know. Upon the appearing of the Moon, which was about eleven of the clock, Antonio de Faria sent away one of his Lanteaas, well furnished, and twelve Soldiers in her, besides the Captain, named Valentino Martin's Dalpoem, a discreet man, and of great courage, that at other times had given good proof of himself in like occasions, who departing went always sounding the depth of the River, until he arrived where divers Vessels rode at anchor; There he took two men that were sleeping in a Bark laden with earthen ware, and returning aboard undiscovered he rendered Antonio de Faria an account of what he had found touching the greatness of the place, and the fewness of the Ships that were in the Port, wherefore his opinion was, that he might boldly enter into it, and if it happened he could not trade there as he desired, no body could hinder him from issuing forth whensoever he pleased, by reason the River was very large, clean, and without any shelves, sands, or other things that might endanger him. Having consulted then with his company, he concluded by their advice, not to put the two Mahometans, that were taken, to torture, as was before ordained, because there was no need of it; Day being come, Antonio de Faria desiring, before he stirred, to be informed from those two Mahometans of some particulars he would fain know, and thinking he might sooner prevail with them by fair mean●, then by menaces and torment, he made very much of them, and then declared his mind: Whereupon both of them with one accord said, that touching the entrance of the River there was nothing to be feared, in regard it was one of the best in all that Bay, and that ordinarily far greater Vessels than his went in and out there, for that the shallowest place was fifteen fathom at the least, and as for the people of the Country he was not to stand in any doubt of them, by reason they were naturally weak, and without arms; And that the strangers, which were at that instant there, arrived some nine days before from the Kingdom of Benan in two Companies of fifty Oxen a piece, laden with store of Silver, Wood of Aloes, Cloth, Silk, Linen, Ivory, Wax, Lacre, Benjamin, Camphire, and Gold in Powder, like to that of the Island of Samatra, who were come with th●● Merchandise to buy Pepper, Drugs, and Pearls of the Isle of Ainan. Being demanded whether there was any Army in those parts, they answered No, because most of the Wars, which the Prechau, that is, the Emperor of the Ca●chins, made, or were made against him, were by Land; and that when any was made upon the Rivers it was always with little Vessels, and not with such great Ships as his, for that they were not deep enough for them: Further being asked, whether the Prechau was near to that place, they replied, that he was twelve days journey from thence, at the City of Quangepaar●, where most commonly he with his Court resided, governing his Kingdom in Peace and Justice, and that the Ours, reserved for his Crown, rendered him in yearly ●ent fifteen thousand Pic●s of Silver, every Pico weighing five quintals, the moiety whereof by the divine Law, inviolably observed in his Countries, was for the poor Laborers, that tilled the ground, to sustain their families withal, but that all his people by a general consent h●d freely relinquished that right unto him, upon condition, that from thenceforward he should not constrain them to pay tribute, or any other thing that might concern them, and that the ancient Prechaus had protested to accomplish it as long as the Sun should give light to the Earth. Antonio de Faria further demanded of them, what belief they were of, whereunto they answered, that they hold the very verity of all verities, and that they believed there was but one God Almighty, who as he had created all, so he preserved all; howbeit if at any time our understandings were entangled with the disorder and discord of our desires, that no way proceeded from the sovereign Creator, in whom was no imperfection, but only from the sinner himself, that out of his impatience judged according to the wicked inclination of his heart. Moreover ask of them, whether in their Law they believed, that the great God, which governeth this All, came at any time into the world, clothed with a humane form, they said No, because there could be nothing that might oblige him to so great an extremity, in regard he was through the excellency of the divine Nature delivered from our miseries, and far esloigned from the Treasures of the Earth, all things being more than base in the presence of his splendour. By these answers of theirs, we perceived that these people had never attained to any knowledge of our truth, more than their eyes made them to see in the picture of Heaven, and in the beauty of the day, for continually in their Combayes, which are their prayers, lifting up their hands they say, By thy works, Lord, we confess thy greatness. After this Antonio de Faria set them at liberty, and having given them certain presents, wherewith they were very well pleased, he caused them to be conveyed to Land; that done, the wind beginning a little to rise he set sail, having all his Vessels adorned with divers coloured Silks, their Banners, Flags and Streamers displayed, and a Standart of Trade hung out after the manner of the Country, to the end they might be taken for Merchants, and not for Pirates, and so an hour after he anchored just against the Key of the Town, which he saluted with a little peal of Ordnance, whereupon ten or eleven Almadiaes' came presently to us with good store of refreshments; Howbeit finding us to be strangers, and discerning by our habits that we were neither Siams', jaos, nor Malayos, nor yet of any other Nation that ever they had seen, they said one to another, Please Heaven, that the dew of the fresh morning may be as profitable to us all, as this evening seems fair with the presence of these whom our eyes behold. Having said thus, one of the Almadiaes' asked leave to come aboard us, which they were told they might do, because we were all their brothers, so that three of nine, which were in that Almadia, entered into our Junk, whom Antonio de Faria received very kindly, and causing them to sit down upon a Turkey Carpet by him, he told them, that he was a Merchant of the Kingdom of Siam, and going with his goods towards the Isle of Ainan he had been advertised, that he might better and more securely sell off his Commodities in this Town, then in any other place, because the Merchants thereof were juster and truer of their word, than the Chineses of the Coast of Ainan; Whereunto they thus answered, Thou art not deceived in that which thou sayst, for if thou be a Merchant, as thou affirmest, believe it, that in every thing and every where thou shalt be honoured in this place, wherefore thou mayst sleep without fear. Antonio de Faria mistrusting some intelligence might come over Land concerning that which he had done to the Pirate upon the River of Tanauquir, §. 2. and so might work him some prejudice, would not dis-imbarque his goods, as the Officers of the Custom-house would have had him, which was the cause of much displeasure and vexation to him afterward, so that his business was twice interrupted by that means, wherefore perceiving that good words would not serve to make them consent to his Propositions, he sent them word by a Merchant, who dealt between them, that he knew well enough they had a great deal of reason to require the landing of his goods, because it was the usual course for every one so to do; But he assured them, that he could not possibly do it, in regard the season was almost past, and therefore he was of necessity to hasten his departure as soon as might be, the rather too for the accommodating of the Junk wherein he came, for as much as she took in so much water, that threescore Mariners were always labouring at three pumps to clear her, whereby he ran a great hazard of losing all his goods; And that touching the King's Customs he was contented to pay them, not after thirty in the hundred, as they demanded, but after ten, as they did in other Kingdoms, and so much he would pay presently and willingly. To this offer they rendered no answer, but detained him that carried the message prisoner; Antonio de Faria, seeing that his messenger returned not, set s●il immediately, hanging forth a number of flags, as one that cared not whether he sold or no; Whereupon the Merchant's strangers, that were come thither to trade, perceiving the Commodities, of which they hoped to make some profit, to be going out of the Port, through the perverseness and obstinacy of the Nautarel of the Town, they went all to him, and desired him to recall Antonio de Faria, otherwise they protested to complain to the King of the injustice he did them, in being the cause of hindering their Traffic. The Nautarel, that is the Governor, with all the Officers of the Custom-house, fearing left they might upon this occasion be turned out of their places, condescended to their request, upon condition, since we would pay but ten in the hundred, that they should pay five more, whereunto they agreed, and instantly sent away the Merchant, whom they had detained prisoner, with a Letter full of compliments, wherein they declared the agreement they had made. Antonio de Faria answered them, that since he was out of the Port, he would not re-enter it upon any terms, by reason he had not leisure to make any stay, howbeit if they would buy his Commodities in gross, bringing lingots of silver with them for that purpose, he would sell them to them, and in no other manner would deal, for he was much distasted with the little respect the Nautarel of the Town had carried towards him, by despising his messages; and if they were contented to accept thereof, that then they should let him know so much within an hour at the farthest, otherwise he would sail away to Ainan, where he might put off his Commodities far better than there. They finding him so resolved, and doubting to lose so fair an occasion, as this was, for them to return into their Country, embarked themselves in five great Lighters with forty chests full of lingots of silver, and a many sacks to bring away the Pepper, and arriving at Antonio de Faria's Junk, they were very well received by him, unto whom they represented anew the agreement they had made with the Nautarel of the Town, greatly complaining of his ill Government, and of some wrongs, which without all reason he had done them; but since they had pacified him by consenting to give him fifteen in the hundred, whereof they would pay five, they desired him to pay the ten, as he had promised, for otherways they could not buy his Commodities. Whereunto Antonio de Faria answered, that he was contented so to do, more for the love of them, then for any profit he hoped to reap thereby, for which they gave him many thanks, and so being on all sides agreed they used such diligence in discharging the goods, as in three days the most of it was weighed and consigned into the hands of the owners thereof; whereupon the accounts were made up, and the lingots of silver received, amounting in all to an hundred and thirty thousand Taeis, after the rate of seven shillings and six pence the Taei, as I have said elsewhere. And though all possible speed was used herein, yet before all was finished, news came of that which we had done to the Pirate in the River of Tananquir, in so much that not one of the inhabitants would come near us afterward, by reason whereof Antonio de Faria was constrained to set sail in all haste. §. 3. After we had quit the River of Mutepinan, directing our course Northward, Antonio de Faria thought good to make to the Coast of the Island of Ainan, for to seek out a River, named Madel, with a purpose there to accommodate the great Junk, wherein he was, because it took in much water, or provide himself of a better in exchange upon any terms whatsoever; So having sailed for the space of twelve days with a contrary wind, at length he arrived at the Cape of Pullo Hinhor, which is the Island of Cocos; There hearing no news of the Pirate he sought for, he returned towards the South Coast, where he took certain Prizes, which were of good value, and well gotten as we thought. For it was the main intention of this Captain to deal with the Pirate, which frequented this Coast of Ainan, as they before had done with divers Christians in depriving them of their lives and goods; For as God doth ordinarily draw good out of evil, so it pleased him out of his divine Justice to permit, that Antonio de Faria in revenge of the Robbery, committed by Coia Acem upon us in the Port of Lugor, should in the pursuit of him chastise other Thiefs, that deserved to be punished by the hands of the Portugals. Now having for certain days together with much labour continued our Navigation within this Bay of Cauchenchina, as we were newly entered into a Port, called Madel, upon the day of the nativity of our Lady, being the eight of September, for the fear that we were in of the new Moon, during the which there oftentimes happens in this Climate such a terrible storm of wind and rain, as it is not possible for ships to withstand it, which by the Chinese is named Tufan, and that the Sky charged full with Clouds had four days together threatened that which we feared, it pleased God amongst many other Junks that fled into this Port for shelter, there came in one belonging to a notorious Chinese Pirate, named Hinimilau, who of a Gentile, that he had been, was not long before become a Mahometan, induced thereunto (as it was said) by a Cacis of that accursed Sect, who had made him such an Enemy to the Christian name, as he vaunted publicly, that God did owe Heaven unto him for the great service he had done him upon Earth, in depopulating it by little and little of the Portugal Nation, who from their mother's wombs delighted in their offences, as the very Inhabitants of the smoky House, a name which they give to Hell; And thus did he with such sayings, and other like blasphemies, speak as villainously and abominably of us as could be imagined. This Pirate, entering into the River in a very great and tall Junk, came up to us where we road at anchor, and saluted us after the custom of the Country, whereunto we returned the like, as it is the manner there to do at the entry into any of the Ports, they neither knowing us to be Portugals, nor we what they were; for we thought they had been Chineses, and that they came into the Port to shrewd themselves from the storm as others did, whereupon, behold, five young men, that were Christians, whom this Robber held as Slaves in his Junk, guessing us to be Portugals, fell a crying out three or four times together, Lord, have mercy upon us. At these words we all stood up to see who they were, and perceiving them to be Christians, we called aloud to the Mariners for to stay their course, which they would not do, but contrarily beating up a Drum, as it were in contempt of us, they gave three great shouts, and withal brandished their naked Scymitars in the air in a way of threatening us, and then cast anchor some quarter of a league beyond us. Antonio de Faria desiring to learn the reason hereof, sent a Balloon to them, which no sooner arrived near them, but the barbarous Rogues pelted them with so many stones, that the Vessel was almost overwhelmed, so that they were glad to return, both Mariners and Soldiers being very sore hurt; Antonio de Faria seeing them come back all bloody, demanded the cause of it: Sir, answered they, we are not able to tell you, only you behold in what plight we are; saying so, and showing him the hurts on their heads, they declared unto him in what manner they had been entertained. At first this accident much troubled Antonio de Faria, so that he stood musing a good while upon it, but at length turning himself to them that were present, Let every one here, said he, prepare himself, for I cannot be persuaded but this is that Dog Coia Acem, who I hope this day shall pay for all the wrong he hath done us. Whereupon he commanded presently to weigh anchor, and with all the speed that might be he set sail with the three Junks and Lanteas. Being come within a Musket shot of them, he saluted them with six and thirty Pieces of Ordnance, whereof twelve were Faulconets, and other Field-pieces, amongst the which was one of Battery, that carried cast Bullets, wherewith the Enemies were so amated, as all the resolution they could take for the instant was to leave their anchors in the Sea, not having leisure to weigh them, and to make to the shore, wherein also they failed of their desire; for Antonio de Faria perceiving their design got before them, and boarded their Junk with all the Forces of his Vessels; hereupon began a most furious Combat both with Pikes, Darts, and pots full of Powder thrown from either side, so that for half an hour it could not be discerned who had the better: But at length it pleased God to favour us so much, that the Enemies, finding themselves weary, wounded, and hurt, threw themselves into the Sea. Antonio de Faria, seeing these wretches ready to sink by reason of the impetuousness and strength of the current, he embarked himself with some Soldiers in two Balons, and with much ado saved sixteen men, whereunto he was induced by the great need he stood in of them for the maning of his Lanteas, because he had lost a great many of his people in the former fights. CHAP. XVIII. What Antonio de Faria did with the Captain of the Pirates junk; that which passed between him and the people of the Country; with our casting away upon the Island of Thiefs. ANtonio de Faria having obtained this Victory in the manner I have related, §. 1. the first thing he did was to see his hurt men dressed, as that which chiefly imported him; then being given to understand that the Pirate Hinimilau, the Captain of the Junk he had taken, was one of the sixteen he had saved, he commanded him to be brought before him, and after he had caused him to be dressed of two wounds that he had received, he demanded of him what was become of the young Portugal's which he held as Slaves? Whereunto the Pirate, being mad with rage, having answered that he could not tell, upon the second demand that was made him with menaces, he said, that if first they would give him a little water, in regard he was so dry as he was not able to speak, that then he would consider what answer to make. Thereupon having water brought him, which he drunk so greedily as he spilt the most part of it without quenching his thirst, he desired to have some more given him, protesting, that if they would let him drink his fill, he would oblige himself by the Law of Mahomet's Alcoran voluntarily to confess all that they desired to know of him. Antonio de Faria, having given him as much as he would drink, questioned him again about the young Christians, whereto he replied, that he should find them in the chamber of the prow; thereupon he commanded three Soldiers to go thither and fetch them, who had no sooner opened the scuttle to bid them come up, but they saw them lie dead in the place with their throats cut, which made them cry out, jesus, jesus, come hither we beseech you, Sir, and behold a most lamentable spectacle; hereat Antonio de Faria, and those that were with him, ran thither, and beholding those youths lying so o●e upon another, he could not forbear shedding of tears; having caused them then to be brought upon the deck, together with a woman and two pretty children, about seven or eight years old, that had their throats also cut, he demanded of the Pirate why he had used such cruelty to those poor innocents': Whereunto he answered, that it was because they were Traitors, in discovering themselves to those, which were such great Enemies to him as the Portugals were, and also for that having heard them call upon their Christ for help, he desired to see whether he would deliver them; as for the two infants, there was cause enough to kill them, for that they were the children of Portugals, whom he ever hated: with the like extravagancy he answered to many other questions, which were propounded to him, and that with so much obstinacy as if he had been a very Devil. Afterwards being asked whether▪ he were a Christian, he answered, no, but that he had been one at such time as Don Paulo de Gama was Captain of Malaca. Whereupon Antonio de Faria demanded of him, what moved him, since he had been a Christian, to forsake the Law of jesus Christ, wherein he was assured of his salvation, for to embrace that of the false Prophet Mahomet, from whence he could hope for nothing but the loss of his Soul. Thereunto he answered, that he was induced so to do, for that so long as he was a Christian, the Portugals had always contemned him, whereas before when he was a Gentile they called him Quiay Necoda, that is to say, Signior Captain, but that respect immediately upon his Baptism forsook him, which he verily believed did arrive to him by Mahomet's express permission, to the end it should open his eyes to turn Mahometan, as after he did at Bintan, where the King of jantana was in person present at the ceremony, and that ever since he had much honoured him, and that all the Mandarins called him brother, in regard of the vow he had made upon the holy Book of Flowers, that as long as he lived he would be a sworn Enemy to the Portugals, and of all others that professed the Name of Christ, for which both the King and the Cacis Moulana had exceedingly commended him, promising that his Soul should be most blessed if he performed that vow. Being likewise demanded how long ago it was since he revolted, what Portugal Vessels he had taken, how many men he had put to death, and what Merchandise he had despoiled them of? He answered, that it was seven years since he became a Mahometan; that the first Vessel he took was Luiso de Pavia's Junk, which he surprised in the River of Liamp●o with four hundred Bars of Pepper only, and no other spice, whereof having made himself master, that he had put to death eighteen Portugals, besides their slaves, of whom he made no reckoning, because they were not such as could satisfy the Oath he had made; That after this prize he had taken four ships, and in them put to death above an hundred persons, amongst whom there was some threescore and ten Portugals, and that he thought the Merchandise in them amounted to fifteen or sixteen hundred Bars of Pepper, whereof the King of Pan had the better moiety for to give him a safe retreat in his Ports, and to secure him from the Portugals, giving him to that purpose an hundred men, with commandment to obey him as their King. Being further demanded, whether he had not killed any Portugals, or lent an hand for the doing thereof, he said no, but that some two years before, being in the River of Choaboquec on the Coast of China, a great Junk arrived there with a great many Portugals in her, whereof an intimate friend of his, named Ruy Lobo, was Captain, whom Don Estevan de Gama, than Governor of the Fortress of Malaca, had sent thither in the way of commerce, and that upon the sale of his commodities going out of the Port, his Junk about five days after took so great a leak, as not being able to clear her, he was constrained to return towards the same Port from whence he parted, but that by ill fortune clapping on all his sails to get the sooner to Land, she was overset by the violence of the wind, so as all were cast away saving Ruy Lobo, seventeen Portugals, and some slaves, who in their skiff made for the Island of Laman, without sail, without water, or ●ny manner of victual; That in this extremity Ruy Lobo, relying on the ancient friendship that was between them, came with tears in his eyes, and prayed him on his knees to receive him and his into his Junk, which was then ready to set sail for Patana, whereunto he agreed upon condition that therefore he should give him two thousand ducats, for the performance whereof he bound himself by his Oath of a Christian. But that after he had taken them in, he was counselled by the Mahometans not to trust unto the friendship of Christians, lest he might endanger his own life, for when they had recovered strength, they would without doubt seize upon his Junk, and all the goods that were in her, it being their usual custom so to do in all places where they found themselves the strongest: wherefore fearing lest that which the Mahometans suggested should befall him, he slew them all on a night as they slept, for the which notwithstanding he was sorry afterwards. This declaration so much incensed Antonio de Faria, and all that were about him, as indeed the enormity of so wicked a fact did require, that presently, without questioning or hearing of him further, he commanded him to be put to death with four more of his company, and so they were all thrown into the Sea. This justice being executed on the Pirate and his four companions, §. 2. Antonio de Faria caused an Inventory to be taken of all that was in the Junk, which was adjudged to amount unto forty thousand Taeis ●o raw and twisted Silk, pieces of Satin, Damask, Musk, fine Pourcelains, and other less valuable commodities, which with the Junk we were constrained to burn, because we wanted Mariners for our navigation. With these valorous exploits the Chineses were so amazed, as they stood in dread of the very mention of the name of the Portugals, in so much that the Necodae●, or Masters, of the Junks, that were in the Port, fearing the like might be done to them, assembled all together in council; and there making Election of two of the principal amongst them, whom they held most capable of performing their charge, they sent them as Ambassadors unto Antonio de Faria, desiring him, that as King of the Sea he would protect them upon the assurance of his word, so as they might pass safely out of the pl●ce where they were, for to make their voyage whilst the season served; in consideration whereof, as his Tributaries, subjects, and slaves, they would give him twenty thousand Taeis in Ingots of Silver, whereof payment should be made out of hand by way of acknowledging him to be their lord Antonio de Faria received them very courteously, and granting their request, protested and swore to perform the same, and upon his word to protect them for the future from having any of their goods taken from them by any Pirate. Whereupon one of the Ambassadors remained as surety for the twenty thousand Taeis, and the other went to fetch the Ingots, which he brought an hour after, together with a rich present of many several things sent him over and above by the Necodaes. This done, Antonio de Faria desiring to advance a servant of his, named Cost●▪ made him Clerk of the Patents that were to be granted to the Necodaes, whereof he presently set a rate, namely five Taeis for a Junk, and two Ta●is for a Vaneo, Lanta●, and small Bark, which proved so beneficial to him, that in the space of thirteen days, wherein these Patents were dispatched, he got (according the report of those that envied him) above four thousand Taeis in silver, besides many good gratuities that were given him for expedition: The form of these Patents was thus, I give assurance upon my word to Necoda such a one, that he shall sail safely all about the Coast of China without any disturbance of any that belongs to me, upon condition that wheresoever he meets with any Portugals he shall ●●●reat them as brethren; and underneath he signed, Antonio de Faria: All which Pa●ents were most exactly observed, and by that means he was so redoubted all along this Coast, as the Ch●●m himself of the Island of Ainan, who is the Viceroy thereof, upon the report which he heard of him, sent to visit him by his Ambassador, with a rich present of Pearls and Jewels, as also a Letter, whereby he desired him to take entertainment from the son of the Sun, a name which they give to the Emperor of this Monarchy, for to serve him as Commander General of all the Coast from Lamau to Liampoo, with ten thousand Taeis Pension yearly, and that if he carried himself well, according to the renown went of him, he assured him that upon the expiration of his three years' charge he should be advanced into the rank of the Chaems of the State, and that such men as he, if they were faithful, might attain to be one of the twelve Futoens of the Empire, whom the sovereign son of the Sun, being the Lion crowned on the Throne of the World, admitted to his bed and board, as members united to his person by means of the honour, power, and command that he gave them, with an annual Pension of an hundred thousand Taeis. Antonio de Faria gave him many thanks for this offer, and excused himself with compliments after their manner; saying, that he was not capable of so great favour as he would honour him withal, but that without any regard at all of money he would be ready to serve him as often as the Tutoens of Pequin would be pleased to command him. After this going out of the Port of Mad●l, where he had been fourteen days, he ran all along the Coast of that Country for to find out Coia Acem, it being the main design of all his voyage, as I have declared before: Imagining then that he might meet with him in some of these places, he stayed there above six months, with much pain and hazard of his person; At length he arrived at a very fair Town, named Quangiparu, wherein were goodly buildings and Temples: In this Port he abode all that day and the night following, under colour of being a Merchant, peaceably buying that which was brought him aboard; And because it was a Town of fifteen hundred fires, as we guessed, the next morning by break of day we set sail without any great notice taken of us. So returning to Sea, although it were with a contrary wind, in twelve days with a troublesome navigation he visited the shores both of the South and North Coasts, without encountering any thing worthy the observation, although they were replenished with a many of little Villages, whereof divers were enclosed with walls of brick, but not strong enough to withstand the force of thirty good Soldiers, the people of themselves being very weak, and having no other Arms but staves hardened in the fire; howsoever the situation of this Country was under one of the best and fertilest Climates on the Earth, abounding with great store of cattle, and many goodly large fields, sowed with Wheat, Rice, Barley, Millet, and sundry other kinds of grain; as also replenished with many great groves of Pine, and Angeline trees, as in the Indias, able to furnish a world of shipping: Moreover, by the relation of certain Merchants, Antonio de Faria was informed, that in this Land there were many Ours of Copper, Silver, Tin, Saltpetre, Sulphur, and an infinite deal of untilled, but excellently good ground, altogether neglected by this weak Nation, which were it in our power, we might in all probability be more advanced in the Indias, than now we are through the unhappiness of our sins. §. 3. After we had been seven months and an half in this Country, sometimes on the one side, sometimes on the other, from River to River, and on both Coasts, North and South, as also in the Isle of Ainan, without hearing any news of Coia Acem, the Soldiers, weary of so long and tedious travel, assembled all together, and desired Antonio de Faria to make a partition of that which had been gotten, according to a promise before made to them by a note under his hand, saying that thereupon they would return unto the Indias, or where else they thought good, whereby a great deal of stir arose amongst us; At length it was agreed, that we should go and winter in Siam, where all the goods which were in the Junk should be sold, and being reduced into gold, division should be made of it, as was desired. With this accord, sworn and signed by all, we went and anchored in an Island, called the Island of Thiefs, in regard it was the outermost Island of all that Bay, to the end that from thence we might make our voyage with the first fair wind that should blow. So having continued there twelve days with an earnest desire to effect the agreement we had made together, it fortuned, that by the conjunction of the new Moon in October, which we had always feared, there arose such a tempest of rain and wind, as seemed to be no natural thing, in so much that lying open to the South wind, as we traversed the Coast, the waves went so high, that though we used all means possible to save ourselves, cutting down our Masts, and all the dead works from poop to prow, as also casting into the Sea even the most part of our merchandise, reducing our great Ordnance into their places again, out of which they had been tossed, and strengthening our Cables, that were half rotten, with ropes; But all this was not able to preserve us, for the night was so dark, the weather so cold, the sea so rough, the wind so high, and the storm so horrible, that in these extremities nothing could deliver us but the mere mercy of God, whom with continual cries and tears we called upon for help: But for as much as in regard of our sins we did not deserve to receive this grace at his hands, his divine justice ordained, that about two hours after midnight there came such a fearful gust of wind, as drove our four vessels foul one of another upon the shore, where they were all broken to pieces, so that four hundred and fourscore men were drowned, amongst which were eight Portugals, and it pleased God that the remainder, being fifty three persons, were saved, whereof three and twenty were Portugals, the rest slaves and Mariners. After this lamentable shipwreck we got half naked, and most of us hurt, into a Marish hard by, where we stayed till the next morning, and as soon as it was day we returned to the Sea side, which we found all strewed with dead bodies, a spectacle of that dread and horror as scarce any one of us could forbear swooning to behold it; over them we stood lamenting a great while, till such time an Antonio de Faria, who by the mercy of God was one of those that remained alive, whereof we were all very glad, concealing the grief which we could not dissemble, came where we were, having on a scarlet coat, that he had taken from one of the dead, and with a joyful countenance, his eyes dry and void of tears, he made a short speech unto us, wherein he remonstrated how variable and uncertain the things of this world were, and therefore he desired us as Brethren, that we would endeavour to forget them, seeing the remembrance of them was but a means to grieve us; for considering the time and ●i●erable estate whereunto we were reduced, we saw how necessary his counsel was: And ●ow he hoped that God would in this desolate place present us with some good opportunity to ●ame ourselves, and how we might be assured that he never permitted any evil but for a greater good; moreover how he firmly believed, that though we had now lost five hundred thousand crowns, we should ere it were long get above six hundred thousand for them. This brief exhortation was heard by us all with tears and discomfort enough, so we spent two days and an half there in burying the dead, during which time we recovered some wet victuals and provisions to sustain us withal, but they lasted not above five days of fifteen that we stayed there, for by reason of their wetness they corrupted presently, and did us little good. After these fifteen days it pleased God, who never forsakes them that truly put their trust in him, miraculously to send us a remedy, whereby we escaped out of that misery we were in, as I will declare hereafter. CHAP. XIX. In what sort we escaped miraculously out of this Island; our passage from thence to the River of Xingrau; our encountering with a Chinese Pirate, and the agreement we made with him. BEing escaped from this miserable shipwreck, §. 1. it was a lamentable thing to see how we walked up and down almost naked, enduring such cruel cold and hunger, that many of us talking one to another fell down suddenly dead with very weakness, which proceeded not so much from want of victuals, as from the eating of such things as were hurtful to us, by reason they were all rotten, and stunk so vilely, that no man could endure the taste of them in his mouth; But as our God is an infinite good, there is no place so remote, or desert, where the misery of sinners can be hid from the assistance of his infinite mercy, which I speak, in regard that on the day when as the feast of S. Michael is celebrated, as we were drowned in tears, and without hope of any humane help, according as it seemed to the weakness of our little faith, a Kite came unexpectedly flying over our heads from behind a point, which the Island made towards the South, and by chance let fall a fish, called a Mullet, about a foot long. This fish falling close by Antonio de Faria, it somewhat amazed him till he perceived what it was, so that having considered a little he fell on his knees, and with tears pronounced these words from the bottom of his heart. O Lord jesus Christ, the eternal Son of God, I humbly beseech thee by the sorrows of thy sacred Passion, that thou wilt not suffer us to be overwhelmed with the unbelief, whereinto the misery of our weakness hath cast us; for I hope, and am almost assured, that the same succour which thou didst send unto Daniel in the Lion's den by the hand of thy Prophet Abacuc, thou wilt grant us at this present out of thy infinite goodness, and not only here, but in every other place, where a sinner shall invoke thy aid with a firm and true faith; Wherefore, my Lord, and my God, I pray thee, not for mine, but thine own sake, that thou wilt not cast thine eyes on that we have merited from thee, but on that thou hast merited for us, to the end it ●ay please thee to accord us the succour which we hope to receive from thee, and out of thy blessed mercy to send us the means whereby we may get from hence into some Christian Country, where still persevering in the holy Worship of thee, we may for ever continue thy faithful servants. This said, he took the Mullet and caused it to be broiled upon coals, and given to such of the sick as had most need of it; Then looking towards the point of the Island from whence the Kite came, we perceived divers others, that in their flying made many stoop, whence we concluded that there was some kind of prey there whereon these fowls fed; now all of us being most desirous of relief, we went thither in all haste, and coming to the top of the higher ground we discovered a low valley full of divers fruit trees, and in the middle a river of fresh water, whereupon by good fortune before we went down we saw a Stag newly killed, and a Tiger beginning to eat him, therewith we made a great cry, which frighted him away into the Wood, leaving us the Stag as he was; Then descended we to the River, and by the bank of it stayed all that night, making a feast, as well with the Stag, as with divers Mullets that we took there, for there were a great number of Kites, that from the water catched a many of those fishes, and oftentimes let them fall being scared with our cries: Thus continued we by this River till Saturday following, when about the break of day we discerned a Sail making as we thought towards the Island where we were, the better to be assured whereof we returned to the shore where we were wracked, and there staying about half an hour, we found it to be so indeed, in which regard we got us presently into the Wood to decline discovery from those in the V●ssel, which arriving in the Port we perceived it to be a Lantea, and that those that were in her fastened her to the shore with two cables, at the beak and the stern, the better to accommodate a plank for to pass in and out of her. Being all disimbarqued out of her to about the number of thirty persons, more or less, they went presently some to making provision of water and wood, some to washing of their linen, and dressing of meat, and others to wrestling, and such like pastimes, little thinking to find any body in that place which could any way annoy them. Antonio de Faria seeing them altogether without fear and order, and that there was none remaining in the Vessel able to resist us; My Masters, said he unto us, you behold the wretched estate whereinto our misfortune hath reduced us, whereof I confess my sins are the cause, but the mercy of God is so infinite, as I am verily persuaded he will not suffer us to perish thus miserably here, and therefore hath as it were miraculously sent this Vessel hither, by seizing whereupon we may escape from hence, which before to humane reason seemed almost impossible; wherefore I exhort you all to join with me in making ourselves Masters suddenly of her ere ever we be heard or seen, and having so done, let our only care be to possess ourselves of the Arms we shall find in her, that therewith we may defend ourselves, and make good our possession, upon which, next under God, our safety depends; and as soon as you shall hear me say three times, Jesus, do as you shall see me do: Whereunto we answered, that we would diligently perform what he had enjoined us; so that we standing all prepared to execute his design, Antonio de Faria gave the signal which he had spoken of, and withal ran as fast as over he could, and we along with him, till he arrived at the Lantea, whereinto we suddenly entered without any contradiction; then unloosing the two cables with which she was fastened, we put out to Sea about a Crossbow shot from Land. The Chineses surprised in this manner, ran all to the Sea side upon the noise that they heard, and seeing their Vessel taken, were much amazed, but knew not how to help it, for we shot at them with an Iron Base that was in the Lantea, which made them fly into the Wood, where no doubt they passed the rest of that day in lamenting the sad success of their ill fortune, as we had done ours before. §. 2. After we were gotten into the Lantea, and that we were sure the deceived Chineses could no way hurt us, we sat us down to eat that at leisure which they had caused to be made ready for their dinner by an old man, that we found there, and it was a great Skillet full of Rice with hached Lard, whereunto we fell with good stomaches, as being not a little hungry: Dinner done, and thanks rendered to God for his gracious mercy to us, an Inventory was taken of the goods that were in the Lantea, which was raw Silks, Damasks, Satins, together with three great pots of Musk, amounting in all to the value of four thousand Crowns, besides good store of Rice, Sugar, Gammons of Bacon, and two Coups full of Poultry, whereof we had more need than of all the rest for the recovery of our sick men, which were not a few amongst us. Hereupon we all began without fear to cut out pieces of Silk, therewith to accommodate every one with clothes. Antonio de Faria, having found a pretty boy in the Lantea, about some twelve or thirteen years old, demanded of him from whence she came, and what she did in this place, as also to whom she belonged, and whither she was bound. Alas! answered the boy, she not long since belonged to my unfortunate Father, whose ill hap it is to have that taken from him by you in less than an hour, which he hath been above thirty years in getting: He came from a place, called Quoaman, where in exchange of lingots of Silver he bought all th●se Commodities, that you have, with a purpose to have gone and sold them to the junks of Siam, which are in the Port of Comhay; And wanting fresh water, it was his ill hap to come hither for to take in some, where you have robbed him of all that he hath without any fear at all of the divine justice.. Whereupon Antonio de Faria bade him leave weeping, and making much of him promised to use him as his own son, and that he would always account him so; Here●● smiling as it were in disdain, he answered, Think not though I am but a child, that I am so foolish to believe, that having robbed my Father, thou canst ever use me like thy son: But if thou wilt do as thou sayst, I beseech thee for the love of thy God suffer me to swim unto that sad Land where he remains that begot me, who indeed is my true father, with whom I had rather die where I see him lamenting, then live with such wicked people as you are. Then some of them that were present reprehending and telling him that it was not well spoken; Would you know, replied he, why I said so? it was because I saw you after you had filled your bellies praise God with lifted up hands, and yet for all that like hypocrites never care for making restitution of that you have stolen; but he assured, that after death you shall feel the rigorous chastisement of the Lord Almighty for so unjustly taking men's goods from them●. Antonio de Faria admiring the child's speech, asked him whether he would become a Christian? Whereunto, earnestly beholding him, he answered, I understand not what you say, nor that you propound; declare it first unto me, and then you shall know my mind further. Then Antonio de Faria began to instruct him therein after the best manner he could, but the boy would not answer him a word, only lifting up his hands and eyes to Heaven he said weeping, Blessed be thy Power, O Lord, that permits such people to live on the Earth▪ that speak so well of thee, and yet so ill observe thy Law, as these blinded Miscreants do, who think that robbing and preaching are things that can be acceptable to thee. Having said so, he got him into a corner, and there remained weeping for three days together without eating any thing that was presented unto him. Hereupon falling to consult whether were the best course for us to hold from this place, either Northward, or Southward, much dispute arose thereabout, at length it was concluded that we should go to Liampoo, a Port distant from thence Northwards two hundred and threescore leagues, for we hoped that along this Coast we might happen to encounter and seize on some other greater and more commodious Vessel then that we had, which was too little for so long a Voyage, in regard of the dangerous storms that are ordinarily caused by the new Moons on the Coast of China, where daily many Ships are cast away. With this design we put to Sea about Sunset, and so went on this night with a South-west wind, and before day we discovered a little Island, named Quintoo, where we surprised a fisherboat full of fresh fish, of which we took as much as we had need of, as also eight of twelve men that were in her for the service of our Lantea, by reason our own were so feeble as they were not able to hold out any longer. These eight fishermen, being demanded what Ports there were on this Coast to Chincheo, where we thought we might meet with some Ship of Malaca, answered, that about eighteen leagues from thence there was a good River and a good Rode, called Xingrau, much frequented with Junks, where we might be easily and throughly accommodated with all that we stood in need of; that at the entering into it, there was a little Village, named Xamoy, inhabited with poor fishermen, and three leagues beyond that the Town, where there was great store of Silks, Musk, Pourcelains, and many other sorts of Commodities, which were transported into divers parts. Upon this advice we steered our course towards that River, where we arrived the next day immediately after dinner, and cast anchor just against it about a league in the Sea, for fear lest our ill fortune should run us into the same mischief we were in before. The night following we took a Paroo of fishermen, of whom we demanded what Junks there were in this River, and how they were man'd, with divers other questions proper for our design. Whereunto they answered, that at the Town up the River there was not above two hundred Junks, by reason the greatest part were already gone to Ainan, Sumb●r, Lailo●, and other Ports of Cauchenchina; moreover, that we might ride in safety at Xamoy, and that there we might buy any thing we wanted; Whereupon we entered into the River, and anchored close to the Village, where we continued the space of half an hour, being much about midnight. But Antonio de Faria seeing that the Lantea wherein we sailed could not carry us to Liampoo, where we purposed to lie all the Winter, he concluded by the advice of his company to furnish himself with a better Vessel, and although we were not then in case to enterprise any thing, yet necessity constrained us to undertake more than our Forces would permit; Now there being at that instant a little Junk riding at anchor fast by us alone, and no other near her, having but few men in her, and those asleep, Antonio de Faria thought he had a good opportunity to effect his purpose, wherefore leaving his anchor in the Sea, he got up close to this Junk, and with seven and twenty Soldiers and eight Boys boarded her on a sudden unespyed, where finding seven or eight Chinese Mariners fast asleep, he caused them to be taken, and bound hand and foot, threatening if they cried out never so little to kill them all, which put them in such a fear as they durst not so much as quetch. Then cutting her cables, he got him strait out of the River, and sailing away with all the speed he could; The next day we arrived at an Island, named Pullo Quirim▪ distant from Xamoy not above nine leagues, there meeting with a little favourable gale within three days we went and anchored at another Island, called Luxitay, where, in regard the air was wholesome, and the water good, we thought fit to stay some fifteen days for the recovery of our sick men: In this place we visited the Junk, but found no other commodity in her then Rice, the greatest part whereof we cast into the Sea, to make her the lighter and securer for our Voyage; Then we unladed all her furniture into the Lantea, and set her on ground for to caulk her, so that in doing thereof, and making our provision of water, we spent (as I said before) fifteen days in this Island, by which time our sick men fully recovered their health; whereupon we departed for Liampoo, being given to understand, that many Portugals were come thither from Malaca, Sunda, Siam, and Patana, as they used ordinarily to do about that time for to winter there. §. 3. We had sailed two days together along the Coast of Lama● with a favourable wind, when it pleased God to make us encounter with a Junk of Patana, that came from Lequio, which was commanded by a Chinese Pirate, named Quiay Panian, a great friend of the Portugal N●t●on, and much addicted to our fashions and manner of life, with him there were thirty Portugals, choice and proper men, whom he kept in pay, and advantaged more than the rest with gifts and presents, so that they were all very rich. This Pirate had no sooner discovered us but he resolved to attaque us, thinking nothing less than that we were Portugals, so that endeavouring to invest us, like an old Soldier as he was, and versed in the trade of Pirate, he got the wind of us; that done, falling down within a Musket shot of us, he saluted us with fifteen Pieces of Ordnance, wherewith we were much affrighted, because the most of them were Falconers; but Antonio de Faria encouraging his men, like a valiant Captain, and a good Christian, disposed them on the hatches in places most convenient, as well in the prow as the poop, reserving some to be afterwards fitted as need should require. Being thus resolved to see the end of that which Fortune should present us, it pleased God that we descried a Cross in our Enemy's Flag, and on the foredeck a number of red Caps, which our men were wont to wear at Sea in those times, whereby we were persuaded that they might be Portugal's, that were going from Liampoo to Malaca; Whereupon we made them a sign for to make ourselves known to them, who no sooner perceived that we were Portugals, but in token of joy they gave a great shout, and withal vailing their two top sails in show of obedience, they sent their long boat, called a B●lon, with two Portugals in her, for to learn what we were, and from whence we came: At length having well observed and considered us, they approached with some more confidence to our Junk, and having saluted us, and we them, they came aboard her, where Antonio de Faria received them very courteously; And for that they were known to some of our Soldier●, they continued there a good while, during the which they recounted divers particulars unto us necessary for our design. That done, Antonio de Faria sent Christovano Borralho to accompany them back, and to visit Quiay Panian from him, as also to deliver him a Letter, full of compliments, and many other offers of friendship, wherewith this Pirate Panian was so contented and proud, that he seemed not to be himself, such was his vanity, and passing close by our Junk he took in all his sails; then accompanied with twenty Portugals, he came and visited Antonio de Faria with a goodly rich Present, worth above two thousand ducats, as well in Ambergris and Pearls, as Jewels of Gold and Silver. Antonio de Faria, and the rest of us, received him with great demonstrations of love and honour: After that he and all his company were set, Antonio de Faria fell to discourse with them of divers things according to the time and occasion, and then recited unto them his unhappy Voyage, and the loss he had sustained, acquainting them with his determination to go unto Liampoo, for to reinforce himself with men, and make provision of Vessels with oars, to the end he might return again, to pass once more into the Straight of Cauchenchina, and so get to the Ours of Quoaniaparu, where he had been told there were ●ix large houses full of lingots of Silver, besides a far greater quantity that was continually melted all along the River, and that without any peril one might be wonderfully enriched. Whereunto the Pirate Panian made this answer, For mine own part, Signior Captain, I am not so rich as many think, though it is true I have been so heretofore, but having been beaten with the same misfortune, which thou sayst hath befallen thee, my riches have been taken from me; Now to return to Patana, where I have a wife and children, I dare not, by reason I am assured that the King will despoil me of all that I should bring thither,, because I departed from thence without his permission, which he would make a most heinous crime, to the end he might seize upon my estate, as he hath done to others f●r far lesser occasions then that wherewith he may charge me. Wherefore if thou canst be contented that I shall accompany thee in the Voyage thou meanest to undertaken, with an hundred men that I have in my junk, fifteen Pieces of Ordnance, thirty Muskets, and forty Harquebuses, which these Signiors, the Portugals that are with me, do carry, I shall most willingly do it, upon condition that thou wilt impart unto me a third part of that which shall be gotten, and to that effect I desire thee to give me an assurance under thy hand, as also to swear unto me by thy Law to perform it accordingly. Antonio de Faria accepted of this offer very gladly, and after he had rendered him many thanks for it, he swore unto him upon the holy Evangelists fully and without all fail to accomplish what he required, and thereof likewise made him a promise under his hand, to which divers of their company subscribed their names as witnesses. This accord passed between them, they went both together into a River, called Anay, some five leagues from thence, where they furnished themselves with all that they stood in need of, by means of a Present of an hundred ducats, which they gave to the Mandarin, Captain of the Town. CHAP. XX. Our Encounter at Sea with a little Fisherboat, wherein were eight Portugals very sore hurt; and Antonio de Faria's meeting and fight with Coia Acem the Pirate. BEing parted from this River of Anay, §. 1. and well provided of all things necessary for the Voyage we had undertaken, Antonio de Faria resolv●d by the advice and counsel of Quiay Panian, whom he much respected, to go and anchor in the Port of Chincheo, there to be informed by such Portugals as were come from Sunda, Malaca, Timor, and Patana, of certain matters requisite for his design, and whether they had any news from Liampoo, in regard the report went in the Country, that the King of China had sent thither a Fleet of four hundred Junks, wherein there were an hundred thousand men, for to take the Portugals that re●ided there, and to burn their houses, for that he would not endure them to be any longer in his dominions, because he had been lately advertised, that they were not a people so faithful and peaceable as he had been formerly given to understand. Arriving then in the Port of Chincheo, we found five Portugal ships that were come thither about a month before from the places above mentioned. These ships received us with great joy, and after they had given us intelligence of the Country, Traffic, and Tranquillity of the Ports, they told us they had no other news from Liampoo, but that it was said a great number of Portugals were come thither from many parts to winter there; and how that great Army, which we so much feared, was not thereabout; but that it was suspected to be gone for the Islands of Go●o, to the succour of Sucan de Pontir, from whom the brute went a Brother-in-law of his had taken his Kingdom, and that in regard Sucan had lately made himself subject to the King of China, and his Tributary for an hundred thousand Taeis by the year, he had in contemplation thereof given him this great Army of four hundred Junks, with the forces aforesaid, for to restore him to his Crown and Signiories, whereof he had been despoiled. Being very glad of this news, after we had remained in this Port of Chincheo the space of nine days, we departed from thence for Liampoo, taking along with us five and thirty Soldiers more out of the five ships we found there, to whom Antonio de Faria gave very good pay; and after we had sailed five days with a contrary wind, coasting from one side to another, without advancing any whit at all, it happened that one night about the first watch we met with a little Fisherboat, or Paroo, wherein there were eight Portugals, very sore hurt, two of the which were named M●m Taborda, and Antonio A●riques, men of honour, and very much renowned in those quarters, the cause why in particular I name them; These and the other six were in such a pitiful estate, and so hideous to see to, as they moved every one to compassion. This Paroo coming close to Antonio de Faria, he caused them to be taken up into his Junk, where they presently cast themselves at his feet, from whence he raised them up, weeping for pity to behold them so naked, and all bathed in their own blood with the wounds they had received, and then demanded of them the occasion of their misfortune: Whereunto one of the two made answer, that about seventeen days before they set sail from Liampoo for Malaca, and that being advanced as far as the Isle of Sumbor they had been set upon by a Pirate, a Guzarat by Nation, called Coia Acem, who had three Junks, and four Lanteaas, wherein were fifteen hundred men, namely an hundred and fifty Mahometans, the rest Luzzons, jaoas, and Champaas, people of the other side of Malaya, and that after they had fought with them from one to four in the afternon, they had been taken with the death of fourscore and two men, whereof eighteen were Portugals, and as many made slaves; And that in their Junk, what of his and of others, there was lost in merchandise above an hundred thousand Taeis. Antonio de Faria remaining a good while pensive at that which these men related unto him, at length said unto them, I pray tell me how was it possible for you to escape more than the rest, the fight passing as you deliver? After we had been fought withal about an hour and an half, ●he three great junks boarded us five times, and with the force of their s●ot they so tore the Prow of our Vessel, that we were ready to sink; wherefore to keep out the water, and lighten our ship, we were constrained to cast the most part of our goods into the Sea, and whilst our men were labouring to do so, our Enemies laid so close at us, as every one was fain to leave that he was about for to defend himself on the hatches: But whilst we were thus troubled, most of our company being hurt, and many slain, it pleased God that one of the Enemy's junks came to be so furiously fired, as it caught hold likewise of another that was fastened unto it, which made the Pirates Soldiers leave the fight for to go and save their Vessels, yet that they could not do so speedily, but that one of them was burnt down even to the very water, so that they of the junk were compelled to leap into the Sea to save themselves from burning, where most of them were drowned: In the m●an time we made shift to get our junk close to a stock of Piles, which Fishermen had planted there against a rock, hard by the mouth of the river, where at this present is the Temple of the Siams, but the dog Coia Acem was instantly with us, and having fast grappled us, h● leapt into our Vessel, being followed by a great number of Mahometans, all armed with Coats of Mail, and Buff jerkins, who straightway killed above an hundred and fifty of ours, whereof eighteen were Portugals; which we no sooner perceived, but all wounded as we were, and spoilt with the fire, as you see, we sought for some way to save ourselves, and to that end we sped us into a Manchu●, that was fastened to the stern of our junk, wherein it pleased God that fifteen of us escaped, whereof two died yesterday, and of the thirteen, that remain yet miraculously alive, there are eight Portugals, and five servants. In this sort we got us with all speed between this Palisade and the land amongst the rocks, the better to preserve us from being boarded by their junk, but they were otherwise employed in seeking to save the men of their burnt Vessel; and afterwards they entered all into our junk, where they were so carried away with covetousness of the booty, as they never thought of pursuing us; so that the Sun being almost set, and they wonderful glad of their victory over us, they retired into the River with great acclamations. Antonio de Faria, very joyful at this news, though he was as sad again on the other side for the bad success of those that had made him this relation▪ rendered thanks unto God for that he had found his Enemy, it being a matter so much desired of him and his: Certainly, said he unto them then, by your report they must needs be now in great disorder, and much spoiled in the River where they are, for I am persuaded, that neither your Junk, nor that of theirs, which was fastened to the burnt one, can do them any longer service, and that in the great Junk, which assaulted you, it is not possible but that you have hurt and killed a good many. Whereunto they answered, that without doubt they had killed and hurt a great number. Then Antonio de Faria, putting off his cap, fell down on his knees, and with his hands and eyes lifted up to Heaven he said weeping, O Lord jesus Christ, my God and Saviour, even as thou art the true hope of those that put their trust in thee, I, that am the greatest sinner of all men, do most humbly beseech thee in the name of thy servants, that are here present, whose Souls thou hast bought with thy precious blood, that thou wilt give us strength and victory against this cruel Enemy, the murderer of so many Portugals, whom with thy favour and aid, and for the honour of thy holy Name I have resolved to seek out, as hitherto I have done, to the end he may pay to thy Soldiers and faithful servants what he hath so long owed them. Whereunto all that were by answered with one cry, To them, to them, in the Name of jesus Christ, that this dog may now render us that, which for so long together he hath taken, as well from us, as from our poor miserable companions. Hereupon with marvellous ardour and great acclamations we set sail for the Port of Lailoo, which we had left eight leagues behind us, whither by the advice of some of his company Antonio de Faria went to furnish himself with all that was necessary for the fight he hoped to make with the Pirate, in the quest of whom (as I have already delivered) he had spent so much time, and yet could never till then hear any news of him in all the Ports and places where he had been. §. 2. The next morning we arrived at the Port of Lailoo, where Quiay Panian had much kindred, and many friends, so that he wanted no credit in that place; wherefore he entreated the Mandarin (who is the Captain of the Town) to permit us to buy for our money such things as we stood in need of, which he instantly granted, as well for fear lest some displeasure might be done him, as for the sum of a thousand ducats, presented unto him by Antonio de Faria, wherewith he rested very well satisfied. Hereupon some of our Company went ashore, who with all diligence bought whatsoever we wanted, as Saltpetre and Sulphur to make powder, Led, Bullets, Victual, Cordage, Oil, Pitch, Rosin, Ockam, Timber, Planks, Arms, Darts, Staves hardened in the fire, Masts, Sails, Sail-yards, Targets, Flints, Pulleys, and Anchors; that done, we took in fresh water, and furnished our Vessels with Mariners. Now although that this place contained not above three or four hundred houses, yet was there both there, and in the villages adjoining, such a quantity of the aforesaid things, that in truth it were hard to express it; for China i● excellent in this, that it may vaunt to be the Country in the world most abounding in all things that may be desired. Besides for that Antonio de Faria was exceeding liberal, in regard he spent out of the general booty, before the partitions were made, he paid for all that he bought at the price the sellers would set, by means whereof he had more brought him by far then he had use for, so that within thirteen days he went out of this Port wonderfully well accommodated, with two other new great Junks, which he had exchanged for two little ones that he had, and two Lanteaas with Oars, as also an hundred and sixty Mariners, both for rowing, and for governing the sails. After all these preparations were made, and we ready to weigh anchor, a general muster was taken of all that were in our Army, which in number was found to be five hundred persons, as well for fight, as for the service and navigation of our Vessels, amongst whom were fourscore and fifteen Portugals, young and resolute, the rest were Boys, and Mariners, and men of the other Coast, which Quiay Panian kept in pay, and were well practised in Sea-fight, as they that had been five years' Pirates. Moreover we had an hundred and sixty Harquebuses, forty pieces of brass Ordnance, whereof twenty were field-pieces, that carried stone-bullets, threescore quintals of powder, namely fifty four for the great Ordnance, and six for the Harquebuses, besides what the Harquebusiers had already delivered to them, nine hundred pots of artificial fire, whereof four hundred were of powder, and five hundred of uns●aked Lime after the Chinese manner, a great number of stones, Arrows, Half-pikes, four thousand small Javelins, store of Hatchets to serve at boarding, six Boats full of Flints, wherewith the Sailors fought, twelve Cramp-irons with their hooks fastened to great Iron chains for to grapple Vessels together, and many sorts of fireworks, which an Engineer of the Levant made for us. With all this equipage we departed from this Port of Lail●●, and within three days after it pleased God that we arrived at the fishing place, where Coia Acem took the Portugals Junk: There as soon as it was night Antonio de Faria sent spies into the River, for to l●●rn whereabout he was, who took a Paroo, with six Fishermen in her, that gave us to understand how this Pirate was some two leagues from thence in a River, called Tinlau, and that he was accommodating the Junk he had taken from the Portugals, for to go in her, with two others that he had, unto Siam, where he was born, and that he was to depart within two days. Upon this news Antonio de Faria called some of his company to council, where it was concluded, that first of all the places and forces of our Enemy was to be visited and seen, because in a matter of so much hazard, it was not safe to run as it were blindfold unto it, but to advise on it well beforehand, and that upon the certainty of that which should be known, such resolution might afterwards be taken, as should seem good to all; Then drawing the fishermen out of the Paroo, he put some of Quiay Panians Mariners into her, and sending her away only with two of those fishermen, keeping the rest as hostages, he committed the charge of her to a valiant Soldier, named Vincentio Morosa, attired after the Chinese fashion, for fear of discovery; who arriving at the place where the Enemy road, made show of fishing as others did, and by that means espied all that he came for, whereupon re●ur●ing, he gave an account of what he had seen, and assured us that the Enemies were so weak, ●s upon ●oarding of them they might easily be taken. Antonio de Faria caused the most experienced men of his company to be assembled, to advise thereon, and that in Quiay Panians Junk, to honour him the more, as also to maintain his friendship, which he much esteemed: At this meeting it was resolved, that as soon as it was night they should go and anchor at the mouth of the River, where the Enemy lay, for to set upon him the next morning before day. This agreed unto by all, Antonio de F●ria set down what order and course should be held at the entering into the River, and how the Enemy should be assaulted: Then dividing his men, he placed thirty Portugals in Quiay Panians Junk, such as he pleased to choose, because he would be sure to give him no distaste; Likewise he disposed six Portugals into each of the Lant●●as, and into Christovano Borralho's Junk twenty; the rest of the Portugals, being three and thirty, he retained with himself, besides slaves and divers Christians, all valiant and trusty men. Thus accommodated and ordered for the execution of his enterprise, he set sail towards the River of Tinlau, where he arrived about Sunset, and there keeping good watch he passed the night till three of the clock in the morning, at which time he made to the Enemy, who road some half a league up in the River. §. 3. It pleased God that the Sea was calm, and the wind so favourable, as our Fleet, sailing up the River, arrived in less than an hour close to the Enemy, unperceived of any; But because they were Thiefs, and feared the people of the Country, in regard of the great mischiefs and robberies which they daily committed, they stood so upon their guard, and kept so good watch, that as soon as they discerned us, in all haste they rung an alarm with a Bell, the sound whereof caused such a rumour and disorder, as well amongst them that were ashore, as those aboard, that one could hardly hear one another, by reason of the great noise they made. Whereupon Antonio de Faria, seeing we were discovered, cried out to his company, To them, my Masters, to them in the name of God before they be succoured by their Lorches, wherewith discharging all his Ordnance, it pleased Heaven, that the shot lighted to such purpose, as it overthrew and tore in pieces the most part of the valiantest, that then were mounted and appeared on the deck, even right as we could have wished: In the neck hereof our Harquebusiers, which might be some hundred and threescore, failed not to shoot upon the signal, that had formerly been ordained for it, so that the hatches of the Junk were cleared of all those that were upon them, and that with such a slaughter as not an Enemy durst appear there afterwards; At which very instant our two Junks boarded their two in the case they were in, where the fight grew so hot on either side, as I confess I am not able to relate in particular what passed therein, though I was present at it, for when it began it was scarce day. Now that which rendered the conflict betwixt us and our Enemies most dreadful was the noise of Drums, Basins, and Bells, accompanied with the report of the great Ordnance, wherewith the valleys and rocks thereabouts resounded again. This fight continuing in this manner some quarter of an hour, their Lorches and Lanteaas came from the shore to assist them with fresh men, which one, named Diego Meyrelez, in Quiay Panians Junk, perceiving, and that a Gunner employed not his shot to any purpose, in regard he was so beside himself with fear, that he knew not what he did, as he was ready to give fire to a Piece, he thrust him away so rudely, as he threw him down into the scuttle, saying to him, Away villain, thou canst do nothing, this business belongs to men, such as I am, not to thee: whereupon pointing the Gun with its wedges of level, as he knew very well how to do, he gave fire to the Piece, which was charged with bullets and stones, and hitting the Lorch that came foremost, carried away all the upper part of her from Poup to Prow, so that she presently sank, and all that were in her, not a man saved: The shot then having passed so through the first Lorch, fell on the hatches of another Lorch, that came a little behind, and killed the Captain of her, with six or seven more that were by him, wherewith the two other Lorches were so terrified, that going about to fly back to Land, they fell foul one of another, so as they could not clear themselves, but remained entangled together, and not able to go forward or backward, which perceived by the Captains of our two Lorches, called Gasparo d' Oliveyra, and Vincentio Morosa, they presently set upon them, casting a great many artificial pots into them, wherewith they were so fired, that they burned down to the very water, which made the most of those that were in them to leap into the Sea, where our men killed them all with their Pikes, so that in those three Lorches alone there died above two hundred persons; and in the other, whereof the Captain was slain, there was not one escaped, for Quiay Panian pursued them in a Champana, which was the Boat of his Junk, and dispatched most of them as they were getting to Land, the rest were all battered against the rocks that were by the shore: which the Enemies in the Junks perceiving, being some hundred and fifty Mahometans, Luzzons, Borneos, and jaos, they began to be so discouraged, that many of them threw themselves into the Sea; whereupon the dog Coia Acem, who yet was not known, ran to this disorder, for to animate his men. He had on a Coat of Mail lined with Crimson Satin, edged with gold fringe, that had formerly belonged to some Portugal, and crying out with a loud voice, that every one might hear him, he said three times, Lah hilah, hilah lafoy Mahumed, rocol halah, Massulmens, and true Believers in the holy Law of Mahomet, will you suffer yourselves to be vanquished by such feeble slaves, as these Christian Dogs, who have no more heart then white Pullet's, or bearded women? To them, to them, for we are assured by the Book of Flowers, wherein the Prophet Noby doth promise eternal delights to the Daroezes of the House of Mecqua, that he will keep his word both with you and me, provided that we bathe ourselves in the blood of these dogs without Law: With these cursed words the Devil so encouraged them, that rallying all into one body, they reinforced the fight, and so valiantly made head against us, as it was a dreadful thing to see how desperately they ran amongst our weapons. In the mean time Antonio de Faria thus exhorted his men: Courage valiant Christians, and whilst those wicked Miscreants fortify themselves in their devilish Sect, let us trust in our Lord jesus Christ, nailed on the Cross for us, who will never forsake us, how great sinners soever we be, for after all we are his, which these Dogs here are not. With this ferver and zeal of faith flying upon Coia Acem, to whom he had most spleen, he discharged so great a blow on his head with a two-handed sword, that cutting through a Cap of Mail he wore, he laid him at his feet, then redoubling with another reverse stroke he lamed him of both his legs, so as he could not rise, which his followers beholding they gave a mighty cry, and assaulted Antonio de Faria with such fury and hardiness, as they made no reckoning of a many of Portugals, by whom they were invironned, but gave him divers blows that had almost overthrown him to the ground; Our men seeing this ran presently to his aid, and behave●●hemselves so well, that in half a quarter of an hour forty eight of our enemies lay slaughtered on the dead body of Coia Acem, and but fourteen of ours, whereof there were not above five Portugals, the rest were servants and slaves, good and faithful Christians. The remainder of them, beginning to faint, retired in disorder towards the foredeck, with an intent to fortify themselves there, for prevention whereof twenty Soldiers, of thirty that were in Quiay Panians Junk, ran instantly and got before them, so that ere they could render themselves Masters of what they pretended unto, they were enforced to leap into the Sea, where they fell one upon another, and were by our men qu●te made an end of, so that of all their number there remained but only five, whom they took alive, and cast into the Hold bound hand and foot, to the end they might afterwards be forced by torments to confess certain matters that should be demanded of them, but they fairly tore out one another's throats with their teeth, for fear of the death they expected, which yet could not keep them from being dismembered by our servants, and after thrown into the Se●, in the company of the Dog Coia Acem their Captain, great Cacis of the King of Bintan, the Shedder and Drinker of the blood of Portugals, Titles which he ordinarily gave himself in his Letters, and which he published openly to all Mahometans, by reason whereof, and for the superstition of his cursed Sect, he was greatly honoured by them. CHAP. XXI. What Antonio de Faria did after his Victory; his departure from the River of Tinlau, with his ill success thereupon, and the succour we met withal. THis bloody Battle finished with the honour of the Victory, beforementioned, §. 1. in the description whereof I have not used many words; for if I should undertake to recount the particularies of it, and set forth all that was performed by ours, as also the valour wherewith the Enemies defended themselves, besides that I am unable to do it, I should then be forced to make a far larger discourse, and more ample History than this is: but it being my intention to declare things ●n passant, I have laboured to speak succinctly in divers places, where possibly better wits than mine would amplify matters in a more accomplished manner, and this is the reason that I have now delivered nothing but what was needful to be written. Returning then to my former discourse, I say, that the first thing Antonio de Faria did after this Victory was to see his hurt men looked unto, whereof there were about fourscore and twelve, the most part Portugals, our servants being included; As for the number of the dead, there were on our side forty two, amongst which eight were Portugals, the loss of whom afflicted Antonio de Faria more than all the rest, and of the Enemies three hundred and eighty, whereof an hundred and fifty fell by fire and sword, the remainder were drowned. Now albeit this Victory brought a great deal of content to us all, yet were there many tears shed both in general and particular for the slaughter of our companions, the most part of whose heads were cleft asunder with the Enemy's hatchets. After this Antonio de Faria, notwithstanding he was hurt in two or three places, went presently ashore with those that were in case to accompany him, where the first thing he did was to give order for the burial of the dead; thereupon he surrounded the Island for to see what he could discover: Compassing of it then in this sort he lighted upon a very pleasant Valley, wherein were many gardens, replenished with sundry kinds of fruits; there also was a Village of about forty or fifty very low houses, which the infamous Coia Acem had sacked, and in them slain many of the inhabitants, that had not the means to escape his hands. Further, in the said Valley, and by a delicate River of fresh water, wherein were a number of Mullets and Trout, he met with a very fair house, which seemed to be the Pagod of the Village, that was full of sick and hurt persons, whom Coia Acem had put there to be cured; amongst these were divers Mahometans of his kindred, and others of his best Soldiers, to the number of ninety six, who as soon as they perceived Antonio de Faria afar off cried out to him for mercy and forgiveness, but he would by no means hearken unto them, alleging that he could not spare those that had killed so many Christians; Saying so, he caused the house to be fired in six or seven places, which in regard it was of wood, bepitched; and covered with dry Palm tree leaves, burned in such ●ort as it was dreadful to behold; In the mean time it would have moved any man to pity to hear the lamentable cries made by these wretches within, and to see them cast themselves headlong out of the windows, where ou● men, provoked with a desire of revenge, received them upon their Pikes and Halberds. This cruelty performed, Antonio de Faria returned to the Sea side, where the Junk lay, that Coia Acem had taken a month b●fore from the Portugals of Liampoo, and caused it to be launched into the Sea, having been formerly repaired and caulked, which being done, and he aboard again, he restored it to Man Taborda, and Antonio Anriques, to whom it belonged, as I have already declared; But first, causing them to lay their hands on the Book of Prayers, Worthy Friends, said he unto them, for all those my companions sakes, as well living as dead, who for your junk here have lost so much blood, and so many lives, I present you with her, and all the goods that were in her, as a free gift, to the end that thereby our Lord may receive us into his everlasting Kingdom; and besides, be pleased to grant us an abolition of all our sins in this world, and in the other everlasting life, as I trust he hath given to our brethren, that this day died like good Christians for the holy Catholic Faith; Howbeit, I pray and expressly enjoin you, nay I conjure you by the oath you are now to make, that you take no other goods but such only as appertain unto you, and that you brought from Liampoo, both for yourselves, and those other Merchants that were Venturers with you: For more I do not give you, nor were i● reasonable I should, in regard it would be much against the duty of either of our consciences, for me to give, and you to receive it. Having spoken in this manner, Man Taborda and Antonio Anriques, who little looked for any such favour, fell down at his feet, and with tears of joy rendered him a world of thanks, and then presently went ashore for to seek out their goods, taking with them about fifty or threescore servants, whom their Masters had lent them for to help gather up the Silks that were wet, and hanged up by the Enemies on Trees a drying, besides two great rooms full of such as had never been wet, all which amounted, as it was said, to an hundred thousand Taeis, wherein above an hundred Merchants had a share, as well of them that dwelled at Liampoo, as at Malaca, to whom they were consigned; The rest of their Commodities, being a third part thereof, were lost, and could never be heard of. The next morning, as soon as it was light, he went to the great Junk that he had taken, which was full of the bodies of them that were slain in her the day before, whom without further ado he caused to be thrown into the Sea; howbeit for Coia Acems, in regard he was of a more eminent condition than the rest, and consequently deserving a greater honour in his funerals, he commanded him clothed and armed as he was to be cut into four quarters, and so cast also into the Sea, where for the merit of his works his body was entombed in the bellies of the hungry Lizards, whereof there was a great company all about our Junk, that showed themselves above water, alured by the appast of those formerly thrown overboard; and in precipitating him so dismembered into the Sea, Antonio de Faria in stead of a prayer, Go wicked wretch, said he, to the bottom of Hell, where thy damned Soul doth now enjoy the promised delights of thy Mahomet, as thou didst yesterday publish to these other Dogs such as thyself. Thereupon he commanded all the Slaves and Captives of his company, together with their Masters, before him, unto whom he made a speech like a true Christian, as indeed he was, whereby he prayed them in the Name of God to manumit these Slaves, according to the promise he had made them before the fight, engaging himself to satisfy them for it out of his own Estate: Whereunto they answered all with one consent, that since it was his desire they were well contented, and that they did even then set them at full liberty, whereof he caused a writing to be presently made with all their hands unto it, being as much as could be done for the instant, but afterwards each of them had in particular Letters of manumission granted unto them. This done, an Inventory was taken of such Commodities as were found to be good and merchantable, over and above those which were given to the Portugals, and all was praised at an hundred and thirty thousand Taeis in Silver Lingots of japan, consisting of Satin, Damask, raw Silk, Taffeta, Musk, and very fine Porcelain, for as touching the rest they were not put in writing; And all these Robberies the Pirates had committed on the Coasts between Sumbor and Fucheo, where for above a year together they had coursed up and down. After that Antonio de Faria had remained four and twenty days in this River of Tinlau, §. 2. during which time all his hurt men were cured, he set sail directly for Liampoo, where he purposed to pass the Winter, to the end that with the beginning of the Spring he might set forth on his Voyage to the Ours of Quoaniaparu, as he had resolved with Quiay Panian, the Chinese Pirate that was in his company, but being advanced even to the point of Micuy, which is at the height of six and twenty degrees, so great a Tempest arose towards the Northwest, that we were fain to strike our topsails, for fear we should be forced back again from our course; but after dinner it increased with such a terrible storm of rain, and the Sea went so high, that the two Lanteas were not able to brook it, so that about evening they made to Land, with an intent to recover the River of Xilendau, which was about a league and an half from thence, whereupon Antonio de Faria doubting some misfortune, carried as little sail as possibly he could, as well for that he would not outgo the Lanteas, as in regard of the violence of the wind, which was such, as they durst not carry more: Now by reason the night was so dark, and the billows so great, they could not discern a shelf of sand, that lay betwixt an Island and the point of a Rock, so that passing over it our Junk struck herself so rudely on it, as her upper keel cleft in two or three places, and her under keel a little, whereupon the Gunner would have given fire to a Falconet, for to have warned the other Junks to come in to succour us in this extremity, but Antonio de Faria would by no means permit him, saying, that since it pleased God he should be cast away in that place, there was no reason that others should be lost there also for his cause; But he desired every one to assist him, both with manual labour, and secret prayers unto God to pardon their sins: Having said so, he caused the main Mast to be cut down, whereby the Junk came to be in somewhat a better case than she was before; but alas! the fall of it cost three Mariners and one of our servants their lives, who chancing to be under it when it fell were battered all to pieces; In like manner he made all the other Masts from poop to prow to be hewed down, together with all the dead works, as the cabins and galleries without, so that all was taken away close to the hatches. And though all this was done with incredible diligence, yet it stood us in little stead, for that the weather was so foul, the sea so swollen, the night so dark, the waves so furious, the rain so great, and the violence of the storm so intolerable, that no man was able to withstand it: In the mean time the other four Junks made a sign to us, as if they also were cast away; Whereupon Antonio de Faria lifting up his eyes and hands to Heaven, Lord, said he before them all, as through thy infinite mercy thou wast fastened upon the Cross for the Redemption of sinners, so I beseech thee, who art all mercy, that for the satisfaction of thy justice I alone may suffer for the offences which these men have committed, since I am the principal cause of their trespassing against thy divine goodness; permit not then, O Lord, that in this woeful night they may fall into that danger wherein I see myself as this present by reason of my sins; but with a repentant Soul I most humbly beseech thee, and that in the name of all the rest, though I am most unworthy to be heard, that in stead of having regard to our sins, thou wilt behold us with the eyes of that pity and infinite clemency wherewith thou art replenished. Upon these words we all fell a crying out so lamentably, Lord have mercy upon us, that it would have grieved any heart in the world to have heard us; And as all men, that find themselves in the like extremity, are naturally carried to the preservation of their lives, without any regard at all of aught else, there was not one amongst us that sought not the means to safe his, so that all of us together employed ourselves in discharging our Vessel, by casting our goods into the Sea; To which effect about an hundred men of us, as well Portugal's, as Slaves and Mariners, leapt down into the Ship, and in less than an hour heaved all overboard, without any respect in so eminent a danger of that which we did, for amongst the rest we threw twelve great chests full of lingots of Silver into the Sea, which in the last encounter we had taken from Coia Acem, besides many other things of great value, whereby our Junk was somewhat lightened. Having past the night in that miserable state we were in, at length, §. 3. as the day began to break, it pleased God that the wind also began to slack, whereby our Junk remained a little more at rest, though she was still in great peril, by reason of the water sh● had taken in, it being almost four yards deep in her, so that to avoid the eminent danger we were threatened with, we all of us got forth, and catching hold by the tackle we hung on the outside of the Junk, because the waves beat with such violence against her, that we feared to be drowned, or cast against the Rocks, which had already happened to eleven or twelve of our company for want of taking heed: Now when the day began perfectly to appear, it pleased God that Man Taborda's and Antonio Anriquez Junks discovered us, and presently coming up close to us, they that were in her threw us a great many staves tied to cords, to the end we might fasten ourselves to them, as we presently did, and therein an hour was spent with much ado, by reason of the extreme disorder amongst us, every man desiring and striving to be first saved, by which occasion twenty men were drowned, whereof five were Portugals, for whom Antonio de Faria was more grieved, then for the loss of the Junk, and all the goods that were in her, although the value thereof was not so small, but that it amounted to above an hundred thousand Ta●is, and that in Silver alone; for the greatest part of the booty, taken from Coia Acem, had been put into Antonio de Faria's Junk, as that which was held to be freer from danger then all the rest: Thus after we had with much peril and pain gotten into Taborda's Junk, we passed all that day in continual lamentation for our ill success without hearing any news of our consorts; Nevertheless it pleased God, that about evening we discovered two Sails, which made so many short turnings from one side to another, as one might well guests they did it of purpose to spend time, whereby we were persuaded that they were of our company. Now because it was almost night, we thought it not fit to go to them for some reasons given thereupon, but having made them a sign they answered us presently with the like according to our desire, and about the end of the last watch they approached so near unto us, that after they had sadly saluted us they demanded how the Captain General and the rest did; whereunto we replied, that as soon as it was day we would tell them, and that in the mean time they should retire from thence till the next morning that it was light, for that the waves than went so high, as some disaster might otherwise ensue thereupon. The next day as soon as the Sun began to appeared two Portugals came to us from Quiay Panians Junk, who seeing Antonio de Faria in the case he was in aboard Man Taborda's Junk, and understanding the bad success of his fortune, they recounted theirs unto us, which seemed to be little better than ours; for they declared that a gust of wind had caught up and thrown three of their men a stones cast from the Vessel into the Sea, a thing never seen nor heard of before: Withal they delivered, how the little Junk was cast away, with fifty men in her, almost all Christians, amongst the which were seven Portugals, and the Captain, named Nuno Preto, an honourable man, and of great courage and wisdom, whereof he had given good proof in the former adversities: A● this relation Antonio de Faria was very much grieved, but much more when a little after one of the two Lanteas, of whom no news had been heard of till then, arriving, told us what dangers they had ran, and that the other having broken their cables, and left their anchors in the Sea, was in their sight battered all to pieces on the Sea shore, all that were in her being drowned, saving thirteen persons, whereof there were five Portugals, and three servants Christians, whom those of the Country had made Slaves, and carried to a place, called Nouday; so that by this unlucky Tempest two Junks, and one Lantea, or Lorch, were cast away, wherein above an hundred men were lost, besides Slaves, Apparel, Commodities, Silver, Jewels, Ordnance, Arms, Victual, and Munition, worth in all above two hundred thousand Ducats, in so much tha● both our General, and every one of us Soldiers, found ourselves destitute of all manner of relief, having nothing left us but what was upon our backs. We learned afterwards, that suchlike fortunes at Sea do ordinarily happen on this Coast of China, more than in any other part, so that it is impossible to sail there a whole year together without shipwreck, unless upon the Conjunction of the new Moons one fly into the Ports for shelter, which are there so many, and so good, that without fear of any thing one may enter them easily, because they are all very clear, except those of Lamau and Sumbor, which have certain Rocks lying some half a league Southward from the mouth of the River. CHAP. XXII. Antonio de Faria hath news of the five Portugals that were made Captives; his Letter to the Mandarin of Nouday about them; and his assaulting the said Town. §. 1. AFter this furious Tempest was wholly assuaged, Antonio de Faria incontinently embarked himself in the other great Junk, that he had taken from Coia Acem, whereof Pedro de Silua was Captain, and setting sail he departed with the rest of his Company, which consisted of three Junks, and one Lorch, or Lantea, as the Chineses term them. The first thing he did then was to go and anchor in the Haven of Nouday, to the end he might learn some news of the thirteen Captives, that were carried thither; being arrived there about night he sent two small Barks, called Baloes, well man'd, to spy the Port, and sound the depth of the River, as also to observe the situation of the Country, and to learn by some means what Ships were riding there, together with divers other matters answerable to his design; For which effect he commanded the Mariners to endeavour all they could for to surprise some of the Inhabitants of the Town, that by them he might be truly informed what was become of the Portugals, by reason he was afraid they were already carried further up into the Country. These Baloes went away about two hours after midnight, and arrived at a little Village seated at the mouth of the River on a little stream of water, called Nipaphau; There it pleased God that they behaved themselves so well, as they returned before day aboard our Junk, bringing along with them a Bark laden with earthen vessel, and Sugar canes, which they had found lying at anchor in the midst of the River: In this Bark there were eight men, and two women, together with a little child some six or seven years old, who seeing themselves thus in our power, became so transported with the fear of death, that they were in a manner besides themselves, which Antonio de Faria perceiving laboured all he could to comfort them, and began to speak them very fair, but to all his questions, he could draw no other answer from them then these words following, Do not kill us without cause, for God will require an account of our blood from you, because we are poor folks; and saying thus, they wept and trembled in such sort, as they could scarce pronounce a word; Whereupon Antonio de Faria, pitying their misery and simplicity, would importune them no further: Howbeit, the better to compass his intent, he entreated a Chinese woman, that was a Christian, and came along with the Pilot, to make much of them, and to assure them they should have no hurt, to the end, that being more confirmed by this means, they might answer to that should be demanded of them; Wherein the Chinese so well acquitted herself, and made them so tractable, as about an hour after they told her, that if the Captain would let them freely return in their boat to the place from whence they were taken, they would willingly confess all that either they had heard or seen. Antonio de Faria having promised them to do so, and that with many words and protestations one amongst them, that was ancienter, and that seemed to be of more authority than the rest, addressing himself to him: Truly, said he, I do not rely much on thy words, because that by amplifying of them in such manner thou makest me afeard, that the affect will not be conformable to thy steech; Wherefore I beseech thee to swear unto me by this Element that bears thee, that thou wilt not fail to perform that which thou hast promised unto me: for otherwise perjuring thyself, be assured that the Lord, whose hand is Almighty, will be incensed against thee with such indignation, as the winds from above, and the Seas from below, will never cease to oppose thy desires during thy Voyages; for I vow unto thee by the beauty of these Stars, that lying is no less odious and abominable in the sight of that Sovereign Lord, than the pride of those judges on Earth, that with scorn and contempt do answer those which demand justice of them. Antonio de Faria obliging himself by oath, as the old man required, to perform his word, the Chinese said he was satisfied, and then he continued in this sort: About two days since I saw those men, whom thou enquirest after, laid in prison at Nouday with great irons on their legs, because it was believed they were notorious Thiefs, that made a trade of robbing such as they met upon the Seas. This relation very much enraged and disquieted Antonio de Faria, who was persuaded that it might well be as the old man delivered, so that desiring to take some course for their deliverance as soon as might be, he sent them a Letter by one of the Chinese, retaining all the rest in hostage for him, who departed the next morning by break of day, and because it much imported the Chineses to be delivered out of captivity, he that carried the Letter, and that was husband to one of the two women, which had been taken in the boat of earthen vessel, and were now aboard in our Junk, made such speed, that he returned about noon with an answer, endorsed on the Letter we sent, and signed by all the five Portugals; Thereby they gave Antonio de Faria to understand, that they were cruelly detained in prison, out of which they did not think they should ever get, unless it were to go to execution, and therefore they besought him for the passion of our Lord Jesus Christ, that he would not suffer them to perish there for want of succour, according as he had promised them at their setting forth in that Voyage, and the rather in regard it was only for his sake that they were reduced to that miserable estate; Hereunto they added many other very pitiful entreaties, as might well come from such poor wretches, that were Captives under the Tyranny of such fell and cruel people, as the Chineses were. Antonio de Faria, having receiv●d this Letter, read it in the presence of all his Company, of whom he asked counsel thereupon; but as they were many, so were their opinions many and different, which was the occasion of much contention amongst them; whereby perceiving that nothing would be concluded concerning this affair, he said to them as it were in choler; My Masters and Friends, I promised to God by a solemn oath that I have taken, never to part from hence, till by some means or other I have recovered these poor Soldiers, my companions, though I should therefore venture my life a thousand times, yea and all my estate, which I make little reckoning of in regard of them; wherefore, my Masters, I earnestly desire you, that no man go about to oppose this resolution of mine, upon the execution whereof mine honour wholly depends, for whosoever shall contrary me therein I must take him for mine enemy, as one that would seek the prejudice of my Soul. To this speech all made answer, that he was in the right, and that for the discharge of his conscience nothing should stay him from performing the same; adding moreover, that all of them would stand to him in that behalf to the death. The Captain hereupon giving them many thanks, and with tears in his eyes and his hat in his hand embracing them, protested that he would when time should serve acknowledge this goodwill of theirs in such real manner as it deserved, wherewith they all remained very well satisfied. §. 2. This resolution being taken, they fell to council concerning the carriage of this affair, whereupon they concluded to treat with the Mandarin in a gentle manner, and for that end to send unto him to demand these Prisoners, with promise to give him for their ransom whatsoever should be thought reasonable, and that according to his answer such further course should be taken therein as should seem requisite: A Petition than was presently drawn answerable to the form, that was usually presented to the Judges, which Antonio de Faria sent to the Mandarin by two of the chiefest of the Chinese he had taken, who also carried him a present worth two hundred ducats, whereby he hoped to induce him to restore the poor prisoners; but it fell out far otherwise then he expected: For as soon as the Chineses had delivered the Petition and the Present, they returned the next day with an answer written on the back of the Petition, the tenor whereof was this: Let thy mouth come and present itself at my feet, and after I have heard thee I will do thee justice. Antonio de Faria seeing what high words the Mandarin gave was exceedingly troubled, because he well perceived by this beginning, that he should have much ado to deliver his companions, wherefore having communicated this affair in particular to some few, whom for that end he had called unto him, they were of several opinions; nevertheless after good deliberation it was at length concluded to send another Messenger, that should more effectually demand the Prisoners of him, and for their ransom offer the sum of two thousand Taces in lingots of Silver and Commodities, declaring unto him, that he would not part from that place till he had returned them; for he made account that it might be this resolution would oblige him to do that which he had refused him another way, or that he would be carried to it by the consideration of his own gain and interest. So the two Chinese went again the second time with a Letter sealed up, as from one person to another, without any kind of ceremony or compliment, which these Gentiles so much use amongst themselves; And this Antonio de Faria did of purpose, to the end that by the sharpness of this Letter the Mandarin might know he was displeased, and resolved to execute what he had written. But before I proceed any further I will only relate the two main points of the contents of the Letter, which were the cause of the utter ruin of this business. The first was, where Antonio de Faria said, that he was a Merchant stranger, a Portugal by Nation, that was going by way of Traffic towards the Port of Liampoo, where there were also many other Merchant's strangers like himself, who duly paid the usual Customs, without committing any manner of ill or injustice. The second point was, where he said, that the King of Portugal his Master was allied in a brotherly amity with the King of China, by reason whereof they traded in his Country, as the Chineses used to do at Malaca, where they were entertained with all favour and justice duly ministered unto them. Now though both these points were distasteful to the Mandarin, yet the last, wherein he mentioned the King of Portugal to be brother to the King of China, was that which put him so out of patience, that without any regard at all he commanded them that brought the Letter, not only to be cruelly scourged, but to have their noses cut off, and in that pickle he sent them back to Antonio de Faria with an answer written on a scurvy piece of torn p●p●r, where these words were written: Stinking carrion, begotten of vile flies in the filthiest sink that ●ver was in any dungeon of a loathsome prison, what hath made thy baseness so bold, as that thou darest undertake to meddle with heavenly things? Having caused thy Petition to be read, whereby like a Lord, as I am, thou prayest me to have pity on thee, which art but a poor wr●tch, my greatness, out of its generosity, was even deigning to accept of that little thou presentedst me withal, and was also inclining to grant thy request, when as my ears were touched with the horrible blasphemy of thy arrogance, which made thee t●rm thy King Brother to the son of the Sun, the Lion crowned by an incredible Power in the Throne of the World, under whose feet all the Diadems of those that govern the Universe are subjected, nay all Sceptres do ●●rve but as latches to his most rich sandals, as the Writers of the golden Temple do certify under the Law of their Verities, and that through the whole habitable Earth: Know then, that for the great Heresy thou hast uttered, I have caused thy Paper to be burnt, thereby representing the vile effigies of thy person, which I desire to use in like manner for the enormous ●rime thou hast committed; wherefore I command thee to be speedily packing, that the River which bears thee may not be accursed. So soon as the Interpreter had read the Letter, and expounded the contents thereof, all that heard it were much vexed therewith, but no man was so sensible of it as Antonio de Faria, who was exceedingly grieved to see himself thus wholly deprived of all hope of recovering his Prisoners, wherefore after they had well considered the insolent words of the Mandarins Letter, and his great discourtesy, they in the end concluded to go ashore, and attaque the Town, in hope that God would assist them, seeing their intentions were good; For this effect they instantly prepared Vessels to land with, which were the ●our fisher-men's great Barks they had taken the night before: Whereupon taking a muster of the Forces he could make for this enterprise, he found the number to be three hundred, whereof forty were Portugals, the rest were Slaves and Mariners, besides Quiay Panians men, amongst whom were an hundred and threescore Harquebusiers, the others were armed with Pikes and Lance●; he had also some Pieces of Ordnance, and other things necessary for his design. The next morning a little before day Antonio de Faria sailed up the River with three Junks, §. 3. the Lorches, and the four Barks he had taken, and so went and anchored at six fathom and an half of water close by the walls of the Town; Then causing the sails to be taken down without any noise, or discharge of Ordnance, he displayed the Banner of Trade according to the fashion of China, to the end that by this demonstration of peace no compliment should rest unperformed, although he was persuaded that nothing would prevail with the Mandarin: Hereupon he sent another Messenger unto him, never making show that he had received any ill usage from him, by whom with a great deal of compliment he demanded the Prisoners, and offered him a round sum of money for their ransom, with a promise of perpetual correspondence and amity; But so far was this Dog the Mandarin from harkening thereunto, that chose he made the poor Chinese, that carried the Letter, to be hewed in pieces, and so showed him from the top of the wall to the whole Fleet, the more to despite us. This tragical act wholly deprived Antonio de Faria of that little hope, which some had given him for the deliverance of the Prisoners; hereupon the Soldiers, being more incensed then before, said unto him, that since he had resolved to land, he should no longer defer it, because further delay would but give his Enemy's leisure to gather more strength: This counsel seeming good to him, he presently embarked with them he had chosen for the action, having first given order to his Junks to shoot continually at the Town, and the Enemy, wheresoever they perceived any store of people assembled, howbeit with this caution, to forbear till they saw them together by the ears with them. Having landed then about a Falcon shot below the Road, he marched without any le● along the shores side directly to the Town: In the mean time a number of people appeared upon the walls, with divers ensigns of different colours, where these Barbarous made a mighty nois● Fifes, Drums, and Bells, and withal hooting at us, made us signs with their caps to approach, thereby intimating the little reckoning they made of us: Now by that time we were come within a Musket shot of the walls, we discerned some thousand, or twelve hundred men, as we guessed, sally out at two several gates, of which some sixscore were mounted on horses, or to say better, on lean carrion Tits that were nothing but skin and bone, wherewith they began to course up and down the field in a skirmishing manner, wherein they showed themselves so untoward, as they often ran one upon another, and tumbled down together; which when Antonio de Faria saw he was exceeding glad, and encouraging his men to the fight he stood firm attending the Enemy, who continued still wheeling about us, being persuaded, it seems, that that would suffice to scare us, and make us retire to our vessels; But when they perceived us remain unmoved, without turning our backs as they believed, and as it may be, they desired we would do, they closed themselves into one body, and so in very ill order they made a stand without advancing on. But then our Captain, seeing them in this posture, caused all his Musketeers to discharge at one instant, who till that time had not stirred, which succeeded with such effect, as it pleased God that he most part of this goodly Cavalry fell to the ground with fear; we taking this for a good presage ran and lustily pursued them, invoking to our aid the name of Jesus, whose good pleasure it was though his divine mercy, to make our enemies sly before us so amazed, and in such disorder, as they tumbled pell mell one upon another, in which manner arriving at a bridge that crossed the town ditch, they were so pestered together, as they could neither go forward nor backward; in the mean time our forces coming up to them discharged their shot to such purpose amongst them, that we laid three hundred of them on the earth, which in truth was a pitiful sight to behold, because there was not one of them that had the heart so much as to draw a sword: whereupon hotly pursuing the first point of this victory, we ran to the g●te, where we found the Mandarin in the front of six hundred men, mounted upon a good Horse, having on ● cuirasse lined with purple Velvet, which had belonged, as we knew afterwards, to a Portugal, named Tom Perez, whom King Don Emanoel of glorious memory had sent as Ambassador to China, in Fernando Perez his ship, at such time as Lopo Suarez d' Albergaria governed the Indies. At the entrance into the gate the Mandarin and his people made head against us, so that there was a shrewd bickering between us, this enemy showing another manner of courage than we had met with on the bridge; but by good hap it fortuned that one of our servant hit the Mandarin just in the breast with an Harquebusse shot, and overthrew him dead from his Horse, wherewith all the Chinesses were so terrified, as they presently turned their backs, and in great disorder retired within the gate, not one of them having the wit to shut it after them, so that we chased them before us with our Lances, as if they had been a drove of cattle: In this sort they fled pell mel together quite through a great street, and issued out at another gate, which was on the lands from whence they got all away, not so much as one remaining behind. Thereupon Antonio de Faria, assembling his men into one body, for fear of some disorder, marched with them directly to the prison, where our companions lay, who seeing us coming, gave a great cry, saying, Lord have mercy upon us, straightway the doors and iron grates were broken up, and our poor fellows irons knocked off their legs, which being done, and they set at liberty, all our company had leave to make what purchase they could, to the end that without speaking afterwards of partition, every one might be Master of what he had gotten. Howbeit Antonio de Faria desired them to perform it suddenly, and therefore he gave them but half an hour's time for it, whereunto they all condescended very willingly, and so ●ell to ransacking the houses. In the mean space Antonio de Faria went to that of the Mandarin, which he took for his part, where he met with eight thousand Taeis in silver, together with eight great vessels full of Musk, and that he caused to be reserved for himself; the rest he left to the servants that were with him, who moreover found there a great deal of raw Silk, Satin, Damask, and fine Pourcellain, whereof every one took as much as he could carry, so as the four Barks, and the three Champanaes', that brought our men on shore, were four several times laden and unladen aboard the Juncks, insomuch that the meanest Mariner amongst us spoke not of this booty but by whole cases, besides what each one concealed in his particular. But when Antonio de Faria perceived that an hour and half had been spent in pillaging, he commanded a surcease thereof, but his company were so hot upon the spoil, that by no means they would be drawn from it, wherein the persons of quality were most saulty, in which regard our Captain fearing least some disaster might happen by reason the night approached, he caused the Town to be set on fire in eleven or twelve places; Now for that most of it was built of Fir, and other wood, it was in such a flame within a quarter of an hour, as to see it burn so, one would have taken it for a portraiture of Hell. This done, and all our company retired, Antonio de Faria embarked without any impediment, every man being well satisfied and contented, only it was great pity to behold a number of handsome maids lead away, tied four and four and five and five together with the matches of their Muskets, weeping and lamenting, whilst our people did nothing but laugh and sing. CHAP. XXIII. Antonio de Faria's Navigation till he came to the Port of Liampoo; his arrival and gallant reception there by the Portugals. AFter that Antonio de Faria had embarked his men, the first thing he did was ●o give order for the dressing of those that were hurt, §. 1. which were in number fifty, whereof eight of them were Portugals, and the rest slaves and Mariners: He also took care for the burial of the dead, that were not above nine, of which only one was a Portugal. All that night we kept good watch, and placed Sentinels in sundry parts, for fear of the Junks that were upon the River; The next morning as soon as it was day, our Captain went to a little Town that was on the other side of the water, where he met not with any Inhabitant, they being all fled, howbeit he found a great deal of Merchandise in their houses, together with good store of Victuals, wherewith he had laded the Junks, fearing lea●t that which he had done in this place, should be the occasion of barring him from being furnished with any in the Ports where he should happen to arrive. Furthermore, by the advice of his company, he resolved to go and winter, during the three months he had yet to make his voyage in, at a certain desert Island, distant some fifteen leagues from the Sea of Liampoo, called Pullo Hinhor, where there was a good road, and good water; whereunto he was chiefly induced, because he thought that going directly to Liampoo, his voyage thither might bring some prejudice to the traffic of the Portugals, who wintered there peaceably with their goods: And indeed this advice was so approved of every one, as it was generally applauded. Being departed then from Nouday▪ after we had sailed five days between the Isles of Comolem, and the continent, we were set upon on Saturday about noon by a Pirate, named Premata Gundel, a sworn enemy to the Portugals, unto whom he had oftentimes done much damage, as well at Patana, as at Sunda, Siam, and many other places, when he found himself the stronger. This Rover believing that we were Chineses came and assailed us with two great Juncks, wherein there were two hundred fight men, besides Mariners; One of them being grappled to Man Taborda's Junk had almost made herself Master of it, which Quiay Panian perceiving, who was a little before, he turned upon her, and with full sails running her on the Starboard side gave her so terrible a shock, that they sank both together, whereby Man Taborda was delivered from the danger he was in, howbeit Quia Panian was instantly, and so opportunely succoured by three Lorches, which Antonio de Faria had taken a little before at Nouday, that all his men in a manner were saved, but every one of the enemies were drowned: In the mean time the Pirate Premata Gundel, setting upon the great Junk, wherein Antonio de Faria was, the first thing he did was to grapple her poop to prow with two great cramp-irons, fastened to long chains, whereupon began such a fight betwixt them, as deserved to be seen, which for half an hour was so courageously maintained by the Enemy, that Antonio de Faria and most of his men were hurt, and himself besides in danger twice to have been taken; nevertheless it was his good hap to be relieved in time by three Lorches, and a small Junck, commanded by Pedro de Sylva, by which means it pleased God that ours not only recovered what they had lo●t, but pressed the Enemy in such sort, as the fight ended with the death of fourscore and six Mahometans, which were in Antonio de Faria's Junk, and had held him up so straight, that our men had nothing left them but the fore-deck in her: After this we entered into the Pirates Junck, and put all those to the edge of the Sword that we found there, not sparing so much as one, all the Mariners having cast themselves before into the Sea. Howbeit we got not this victory so cheap, but that it cost seventeen men's lives, whereof five were Portugals, and of the best Soldiers we had, besides three and forty were hurt▪ Antonio de Faria being one of them, who had one wound with a dart, and two with a sword. The fight being ended in this sort, an Inventory was taken of all that was in the enemy's Junck, and this prize was estimated at fourscore thousand Ta●is, the better part whereof consisted in Lingots of silver of japan, which the Pirate had taken in three Merchant's Ships, that from Firando were bound for Chincheo, so that the Pirate had in this only vessel to the value of sixscore thousand crowns, and it was thought that the other Junck which was sunk was worth ●s much, to the extreme grief of all our company. With this prize Antonio de Faria retired to a little Island, called Buncalou, which was three or four Leagues Westward from thence, and much commended for good water, and safe riding: Having landed in this place, we spent eighteen days there, lodging in Cabins, that were made for the accommodation of our hurt men. From this Island we sailed towards that part, whither we had resolved before to go, namely, Antonio de Faria in the great Junk, Man Taborda, and Antonio Anriquez in theirs, Pedro de Sylva in the little Junk, that was taken at Nouday, and Quiay Panian with all his followers in the Pirates, last taken, which was given him in recompense of his that he had lost, together with twenty thousand Taeis out of the general booty, wherewith he rested very well contented, being done with the consent of the whole company at the request of Antonio de Faria. Sailing in this manner we arrived six days after at the Ports of Liampoo, which are two Islands, one just against another, distant three Leagues from the place, where at that time the Portugals used their commerce; There they had built above a thousand houses, that were governed by Sheriffs, Auditors, Consuls, Judges, and six or seven other kind of Officers, where the Notaries underneath the public Acts, which they made, wrote thus, I▪ such a one, public Notary of this Town of Liampoo for the King our Sovereign Lord. And this they did with as much confidence and assurance, as if this place had been situated between Santarem and Lisbon; so that there were houses there which cost three or four thousand ducats the building, but both they and all the rest were afterwards demolished for our sins by the Chinese, as I hope to relate more amply hereafter: Whereby one may see how uncertain our affairs are in China, whereof the Portugals▪ discourse with so much curiosity, and abused by appearances make such account, never considering what hazard they hourly run, and how they are exposed to infinite disasters. §. 2. Between these two Islands, which the Inhabitants of the Country, and they that sail in those Seas, call the Ports of Liampoo, there is a channel, some two Harquebuse shot over, and five and twenty fathom deep, where in certain places is very good anchoring, as also a pleasant River of fresh water, which takes his beginning from the top of a mountain, and passeth by thick woods of Cedar, Oak, and Fir trees, whereof many Ships make their provision for Sail-yards, Masts and Planks, never costing them a penny. At these Island Antonio de Faria cast anchor on Wednesday morning, and there Man Taborda, and Antonio Anriquez desired him to give them leave to go and advertise the Town of his Arrival, as likewise to understand the news of the Country, and whether there was any speech of that which he had done at Nouday; For in case his coming should prove never so little prejudicial to them, he was resolved (as I have formerly related) to winter in the Isle of Pullo Hinhor, concerning the which they promised with all diligence to advertise him so much as they could learn: To this request of theirs, Antonio de Faria condescended very willingly, and withal sent certain Letters by them, directed to the Principal Governors of the Town, whereby he made them a brief Recital of the success of his Voyage, and instantly desired them to advise him what they would have him to do, being ready to obey them accordingly, with many other compliments of kindness, from whence oftentimes much profit arises, without any charge at all. Antonio Anriquez and Man Taborda departed about evening, and within two hours of night, they arrived at the Town, where as soon as the Inhabitants heard the effect of their Message, they presently assembled upon the ringing of a Bell, at the Church of the conception of our Lady, being the Cathedral of six or seven others in the Town, there they deliberated upon the Letters which Antonio Anrqivez and Man Taborda had delivered, and in the end having considered the great liberality that Antonio de Faria had used, as well to them as to all the rest that had part in the Junk, they concluded to acknowledge it unto him by all demonstrations of affection; For which purpose they returned him a Letter, signed by them all, as the Resolution of a General Assembly, and sent it him together with two Lantea●● full of divers refreshments, and that by an ancient Gentleman, named jeronimo de Rego, a Personage of great wisdom and authority amongst them: In this Letter they g●ve him thanks in very courteous terms, both for the exceeding favour he had done them by rescuing their goods out of the enemy's hands, and for the noble Testimony he had given them of his affection by his extraordinary liberality towards them, for which they hoped that God would throughly requite him: As for the fear he was in touching his wintering there, by reason of what had passed at Nouday, he might be confident that way, because the Country was so full of trouble, by occasion of a mighty uproar that was then amongst the people thereof, as if he had razed the very City of Canton itself, they would not much regard it, wherefore he might well think they would care much less for that which he had done at Nouday, which in China, compared with many others, was no greater than Oeyras in Portugal is, being equally with Lisbon: And concerning the good news he had sent them of his arrival in their Port, they earnestly desired him to continue still at anchor there six days longer, that they might in the mean while make some fit preparation for his entertainment, seeing that thereby only they should be able to testify their good will unto him, having not the power other ways to acquit so many obligations, wherein they stood engaged unto him. These words of kindness were accompanied with many other compliments, whereunto Antonio de Faria returned them a most courteous Answer, and condescending to their desire, he sent all his sick men on shore in the two Lanteaas, which brought the refreshments, whom those of Liampoo received with great show of affection and charity, for presently they were lodged in the richest houses of the Town, and plentifully accommodated with all things necessary for them, wanting nothing. Now during the six days Antonio de Faria remained in that place, there was not a man of any quality in all the Town, but came and visited him with many presents, and divers sorts of provisions, refreshments, and fruits, and that in such abundance, that we were amazed to behold them, the more too for the good order and magnificence wherewith every thing was accompanied. During the six days, §. 3. that Antonio de Faria continued in the Port according to his promise to them of Liampoo, he never budgd from his Ships▪ At length on Sunday morning before day, which was the time limited for our going to the Town, an excellent consort of Music was heard, both of Instruments and Voices, the harmony whereof was wonderfully pleasing, and after that a Triumph of Drums and Trumpets together, according to the manner of our own country: Then some two hours before Sunrising, the night being very quiet, and the Moon exceeding bright, Antonio de Faria set sail with his whole Fleet, having all his Ships decked with Silken Flags, and streamers of sundry Colours, and every scuttle both of the greater and lesser masts hung round about with cloth of Silver, and many brave Standards of the same: After these Vessels followed a number of row-Barges, wherein were a great many of Trumpets, Oboes, Flutes, Fifes, Drums, and other such Instruments, each one of a several Invention. When it was broad day the wind began to calm, as we were within half a League of the Town, whereupon there came presently to us some twenty Lanteaas, very well set forth, and full of Musicians, that played on divers Instruments; So in less than an hour we arrived at the Road, but first there came aboard Antonio de Faria about threescore Boats and Manchaas, adorned with Pavilions and Banners of Silk, as also with Turkey Carpets of great value; In these Boats were about three hundred men, all richly apparelled, with chains of Gold, and guilt Swords, hanging in Belts after the fashion of Africa, every thing so well accommodated, that we which beheld this Equipage, were no less contented than astonished therewith. With this train Antonio de Faria came to the Town, where there stood ranged in excellent order twenty six ships, and fourscore Junks, besides a great sort of Vancons and Barcasses, all in File one after another, so making as it were a fair long street, every where beautified with Pines, Laurels, and green Canes, with many Triumphal Arches, beset with Cherries, Pears, Lemons, Oranges, and sundry odoriferous green Herbs, wherewith the Masts and Cordage were covered all over. As soon as Antonio de Faria came near the place, which was prepared for his landing, he saluted the Town with a great pe●l of Ordnance, which was instantly answered with the like by all the Ships, Junks and Barks before mentioned, in order, a matter very pleasing, and wherewith the Chinese Merchants were so taken, as they demanded of us, Whether this man, unto whom we did so much honour, was either the brother or kinsman of our King? whereunto certain chief me● of the Town answered, That his Father shod the Horses, whereon the King of Portugal road, and that in that regard all this honour was done him; adding withal, That they thought themselves scarce worthy to be his slaves, much less his servants; The Chineses believing all this to be true, said one to another, as it were in admiration; Verily, there be great Kings in the world, whereof our ancient Historians for want of knowledge of them have made no mention in their Writings, and it seems that above them all, the King of these Portugals is to be most esteemed, for by that which is delivered to us of his greatness, he must needs be richer, more mighty, and greater than either the Tartar, or the Cauchin, as is most apparent, since be that shoes his horses, which is but an ordinary and contemptible trade in every Country, is so respected by those of his Nation; Whereupon another that heard his Companion say thus, Certainly, said he, this Prince is so great, that if it were not a blasphemy, one might almost compare him to the Son of the Sun; The rest that were about him added, It well appears to be so by the great riches which this bearded Nation get in every place where they come by the power of their arms, wherewith they affront all the People of the world. This salutation being ended on either part, a Lanteaa came aboard Antonio de Faria's Junk, gallantly equipped, and covered all over with boughs of Chesnut trees, full of their bristled ●ruit just as they grew, and intermingled with delicate small green trees, which those of the Country call Lechias, stuck every where with most fragrant Roses and Violets, all plashed so close together, that we could not see the Rowers; now upon the upper end of the Deck of this Vessel, there was a kind of State set up, made of Tynsell, under the which stood a silver chair, and about it six girls of about some ten or eleven years of age a piece, wonderful beautiful, and that very harmoniously accorded their voices, to certain Instruments of Music whereon they played: In this Lanteaa then Antonio de Faria embarked himself, and so arrived at the Key with a great noise of Hoyboys, Trumpets, Drums, Fifes, and other such like, after the manner of the Chinese, Malayoes', Champaas, Siamites, Borneos, Lequios, and other people, that were then in the Haven under the protection of th● Portugals, for fear of the Pirates, which in great numbers overran all that Sea. Being landed he found a chair of State provided for him, like unto one of those wherein the principal Charms of the Empire are usually carried; In this, but with much refusal first on his side, was he placed, and it being supported by eight silver pillars, it was taken up by eight of the chiefest persons amongst them, apparelled in gowns of cloth of Gold richly embroidered, and so was he carried on their shoulders into the Town, environed with threescore Halberdiers, bravely set forth, and their Halberds Damasked with ●old and Silver, before him also marched eight Sergeants at Arms, carrying great guilt Maces, clothed in Hongarlines of Crimson-Velvet embroidered with Gold; In the head of them road eight Knights mounted on gallant white Steeds, and attired in Satin of the same colour, with white Damask Ensigns, and brave plumes of white Feathers, and foremost of all were eight other men likewise on Horseback, wearing Crimson, and green Velvet Caps, which ever and anon cried out after the manner of China for people to make way. In this sort was Antonio de Faria carried along till alighting out of his chair he went to visit the Governors of the Town, who in way of compliment prostrated themselves at his feet, wherein some small time being spent, two ancient Gentlemen, who had lived long in that place, the one named Tristan de Gaa, and the other jeronimo de Rego, made an eloquent Oration in the commendation of him: That done, he was led from thence to the Church through a long street, adorned on both sides with Laurel and Fir Trees, below strewed with Rushes, and above hung with Satin and Damask, amongst the which divers court-cupboards were placed, whereon stood very curious perfuming pans of Silver, from whence most pleasing and delicious odours breathed forth: Near to the end of this street was a Tower of Deal Board's erected, painted all over, as if it had been stone, on the top whereof, under a Banner of white Damask, the Royal Arms of Portugal were limned in Gold; and in a window of the same Tower, certain little Boys were drawn, attired after the Portugal fashion, as al●o an old Woman, that seemed to weep, and hold a man lying dismembred at her feet, whom some eleven or twelve armed castilians were a kill, having their Halberds and Partisans died with his blood; All which Figures were done so to the life, that one would have thought them to have been the very persons they represented. Now this was to signify how Nimo Gonçalles de Faria, chief of that Noble Family, gave for his arms his own body, at such time as he was slain in the Wars, that had been anciently between Castille and Portugal. Presently hereupon as soon as a clock, that was on the top of the said Tower, had struck thrice, and that the people upon this signal were all silent, there came a venerable old man out of the principal gate, apparelled in a robe of Crimson Damask, accompanied with four Beadles, which carried silver Maces before him: Having made a low reverence to Antonio de Faria, he told him in terms full of respect, how much all the Inhabitants were obliged unto him, as well for the great liberality he had used towards them, as for the favour he had done them, by having been the only cause of the recovery of their goods, in acknowledgement whereof they all offered themselves to be his Vassals for the time to come, and to do him the Homage of Tributaries as long as he lived: And further, if he pleased to cast his eye upon that Table before him, he should behold there as in a clear Mirror, with how much fidelity his Ancestors had gained the honourable name of his Family, as it was manifest to all the people of Spain, whereby he might well perceive how much it was for his honour that he had performed such generous actions, in regard whereof he most earnestly besought him, and that in the Name of them all, that for a beginning of the Tribute, which they offered to give him by way of Vassalage, he would be pleased to accept of a small Present, they now had brought him, only for to defray the charge of Match for his Soldiers, and that for the rest wherein they stood so far engaged to him, they promised to disoblige themselves in time and place convenient; whereupon they presented him with five C●ses full of Lingots of Silver, to the value of ten thousand Taeis. Antonio de Faria having very courteously thanked the good old man for this many Honours had hitherto been done him, as also for the present they now offered unto him, excused himself from receiving of it, though he were very much importuned thereunto. Antonio de Faria setting forward then to go to the Church, whither he was to have been conducted under a rich Canopy, §. 4. which six of the chiefest and honourablest Inhabitants of Liampoo were there ready with for him, he would by no means accept of it, telling them that he was not born to have so much honour as they would do him, and so he proceeded on without other pomp then ordinary, being ac●mpanied with a world of people, as well Portugal's as others of divers Nations, who for commerce sake weet come to that Port, as the best and richest that was then in that Country. In the mean space wheresoever he cast his eye he saw nothing but public rejoicings, which consisted in dances, Masks, and Plays of several kinds, invented by those of the Country that lived amongst us; all which became more splendidious by the Trumpets, Cornets, Oboes, Flutes, Harps, Vials, Fifes, and Drums, that were heard in every corner, and confounded together in a Labyrinth of Voices after the manner of China, which so amazed the sense, that one knew not whether it were a dream or no, so extraordinary it seemed: Being arrived at the Church door, eight Priests came forth to receive him covered with Copes all embroidered with Gold and Silver, who going in Procession began to sing Te Deum, whereunto many excellent voices tuned to the Organs answered, which made up as harmonious Music as could be heard in the Chapel of any great Prince: In this sort he was carried up to the High Altar, where there was a State of White Damask, and under it a Chair of Carnation Velvet, and at the foot of it a Cushion of the same; In this Chair he sat him down and heard Mass, which was celebrated with a great deal of Ceremony, and a marvellous consort both of Voices and Instruments. Mass being ended, the Sermon followed, that was made by Estevano Nogueyra, an ancient man, and Curate of the place, who, to speak the truth through discontinuance of preaching, was but little versed in Pulpit matters, and illiterate withal, howbeit desiring to show himself that day a learned man in so remarkable a solemnity, he laboured to make demonstration of his best Rhetoric; To which effect he grounded all his Sermon on the Praises of Antonio de Faria, and that in words so ill placed, and so far from his Text, as our Captain was much ashamed at it, wherefore some of his friends plucked him three or four times by the Surplis for to make him give over, wherewith being nealed, he turned him about to those that would have had him leave off, I will not, said he unto them, but will rather say more, for I speak nothing but that which is as true as Gospel, in regard whereof, let me alone I pray you, for I have made a vow to God never to desist from commending this noble Captain, as he more than deserves at my hands, for saving me seven thousand ducats venture, that Man Taborda had of mine in his junk, and was taken from him by that dog Coia Acem, for which let the soul of so cursed a rogue and wicked Devil be tormented in Hell for ever and ever, whereunto say all with me, Amen. This Conclusion provoked all the Assembly so to laugh, that we could not hear one another in the Church for the noise that was made there. This tumult over, there came out of the Vestry six little Boys, attired like Angels, with Instruments of Music in their hands guilt all over, and then the same Priest falling on his knees before the Altar of our Lady, and lifting up his hands, began to sing aloud these words, Virgin, you are a Rose, whereunto the little Boys answered very melodiously with their Instruments, all being performed with such harmony and devotion, as it drew tears from most of the Assistants. § 5. Mass being finished, the four principal Governors of the Town, namely, Mateus de Brito, Lançarote Pereyra, jeronimo de Rego, and Tristan de Gaa, came unto Antonio de Faria, and b●ing accompanied with all the Portugals, which were above a thousand in number, they conducted him into a great place before the Town Hall, that was compassed about with a small thick wood of Chesnut Trees, all full of Fruit just as they grew, adorned above with Standards and Banners of Silk, and strewed below with Flower de luces, and Red and White Roses, whereof there is great abundance in China. In this Wood were three long Tables set, under a goodly spacious Arbour, that was covered over with Myrtle, and round about were divers Conduits of Water, which ran from one to the other by certain Inventions of the Chinese, that were so subtle, as one could not possibly discern the secret; For by the means of a kind of Bellows like unto that of an Organ, that was joined to the principal Conduit, the water rebounded up so high, that when it came to descend again it fell as small as dew, so that with one only pot full of water, they could gently moisten that great place; before these three Tables were three Court-cup-boards placed, upon the which was a great deal of very fine Porcelain, and six huge Vessels of Gold, that the Chinese Merchants had borrowed of the Mandarins of the Town of Liampoo; For in that Country Persons of quality are served all in Gold, Silver being for those of meaner condition: They brought likewise divers other pieces all of Gold, as great Basins, Saltsellers and Cups. After they were dismissed which were not for the Banquet, there only remained those that were invited, being fourscore in number, besides fifty of Antonio de Faria's Soldiers: These being set at Table were served by young Wenches, very beautiful, and finely apparelled, according to the manner of the Mandarins; At every course that was served up they sung very melodiously to the tune of certain Instruments whereon some of their companions played: As for Antonio de Faria he was served by eight Maidens, the Daughters of worthy Merchants, exceeding fair and comely, whom their Fathers had brought thither for that purpose at the request of Mateus de Brito, and Tristan de Gaa; They were attired like Mermaids, and carried the meat to the Table, dancing to the sound of divers Instruments, a marvellous thing to behold, and wherewithal the Portugals were so mightily taken, as they could not sufficiently commend the excellent Order and Gentleness of these Magnificencies, by which their eyes and ears were so charmed; Remarkable it was also, that at every health, the Trumpets, Oboe, and Drums played their parts. In this sort the Banquet continued two hours, during which there was always one device or other after the Portugal or Chinese fashion. I will not stand here to recount the delicacy or abundance of the meats, that were served up in it, for it would be a matter not only superfluous, but even infinite to recite every thing in particular. After they were risen from Table, they went all to another great place, that was environed with Scaffolds, all hung with Silk, and full of People, where ten Bulls and five wild Horses were baited, being accompanied with the sound of Trumpets, Fifes, and Drums; in sequel whereof, divers Mummeries of several Inventions were represented. Now because it was late Antonio de Faria would have embarked himself again for to have returned unto his Ships, but they of the Town would by no means suffer him, for they had prepared the Houses of Tristan de Gaa, and Mateus de Brito for his lodging, having caused a Gallery to be built from the one to the other for that purpose; There was he lodged very commodiously during the space of five Months that he abode in that place, always entertained with new sports and delights of Fishing, Hunting, Hawking, Comedies, and Masques, as also with sumptuous Feasts, as well on Sundays and Holidays, as other Days of the Week, so that we passed these five Months in such pleasure, as at our departure we did not think we had been there five days. This term expired Antonio de Faria made preparation of Vessels and Men, for his Voyage to the Mines of Quoaniapar●, for in regard the season was then proper for it, he resolved to be gone as soon as possibly he could, but in the mean time it happened that Quiay Panian fell into a dangerous sickness, whereof not long after he died, to the extreme grief of Antonio de Faria, who exceedingly affected him for many good qualities that were in him, worthy of his friendship, and therefore he caused him to be honourably buried, as the last duty that he could do to his Friend. After the the death of Quiay Pa●ia● he was counselled not to hazard himself in that Voyage, because it was reported for a certainty, how all that Country was up in arms by reason of the Wars which the Prechau Muan had with the Kings of Chamay, and Champaa; And withal he had Information given him of a famous Pirate, named Similau, whom he went presently to seek out, and having found him, the said Similau related strange wonders unto him of an Island, called Calempluy, where he assured him there were seventeen Kings of China interred in Tombs of Gold, as also a great number of Idols of the same Methal, and such other immense treasures, as I dare not deliver, for fear of not being credited. Now Antonio de Faria, being naturally curious, and carried with that ambition, whereunto Soldiers are for the most part inclined, lent so good ear to this Chineses report, as looking for no other assurance of it then what he gave him, he presently resolved to undertake this Voyage, and expose himself to danger, without taking further counsel of any man, whereat many of his friends were with reason offended. CHAP. XXIV. Antonio de Faria departs from Liampoo for to seek out the Island of Calempluy, the strange things that we saw, and the hazard we ran in our voyage thither. THe season being now fit for Navigation, §. 1. and Antonio de Faria furnished with all that was necessary for this new Voyage, which he had undertaken to make on Monday the fourteenth of May, in the year one thousand five hundred forty and two, he departed from this Port to go to the Island of Calempluy▪ For which purpose he embarked in two Pa●oures, resembling small Galleys, but that they were a little higher, by reason he was counselled not to use Junks, as well to avoid discovery, as in regard of the great curran●● of water that descended from the Bay of Nanquin, which great Vessels with all their sails were not able to stem, especially at the time wherein he set forth, for then the snows of Tartary and Nixihu●fla● dissolving ran all the Months of May, june, and july, into these Seas with a most violent impetuosity. In these two Vessels were fifty Portugals, one Priest to say Mass, and forty eight Mariners, all Natives of Patana, as also two and forty slaves, so that the whole number of our company amounted to an hundred forty and one persons, for the Pirate Simila●, who was our Pilot, would have no more men, nor Vessels, for fear of being known, because he was to traverse the straight of Nanquin, and to enter into Rivers that were much frequented, whereby we might probably be subject to great hazard. That day and all the night following we employed in getting out from amongst the Islands of Angitur, and pursued our course through Seas, which the Portugals had neither seen nor sailed on till then. The first five days we had the wind favourable enough, being still within sight of land till we came to the mouth of the River of the Fishings of Nanquin; There we cro●t over a Gulf of forty leagues, and discovered a very high Mountain, called Nangafo, towards the which bending Northerly, we sailed fifty days; at length the wind abated somewhat, and because in that place the Tides were very great, Similau put into a little River, where was good anchoring and riding, inhabited by men that were white and handsome, having very little eyes, like to the Chinese, but much different from them, both in language and attire. Now during the space of three days, that we continued there, the Inhabitants would have no manner of communication with us, but chose they came in troops to the shore, by which we anchored, and running up and down like madmen they howled in a most hideous fashion, and shot at us with slings and crossbows. As soon as the weather and the sea would permit us, Similau, by whom all was then governed, began to set sail, directing his course East Northeast, and so proceeded seven days in sight of land; then traversing another Gulf, and turning more directly to the East, he passed through a strait, ten leagues over, called Sileupaquin; There he sailed five days more, still in view of many goodly Cities and Towns, this River being frequented with an infinite company of Vessels; whereupon Antonio de Faria, knowing that if he happened to be discovered he should never escape with life, resolved to get from thence▪ and continue this course no longer, which Similau perceiving, and opposing the advice that every one gave him; Signior, said unto him, I do not think that any of your company can accuse me for mis-performing my duty hitherto, you know how at Liampoo I told you publicly in the General Council that was held in the Church before an hundred Portugals at the least, that we were to expose ourselves to great dangers, and chiefly myself, because I was a Chinese and a Pilot, for all you could be made to endure but one death, whereas I should be made to endure two thousand if it were possible, whereby you may well conclude, that setting apart all treason, I must of necessity be faithful unto you, ●s I am, and ever will be, not only this Voyage, but in all other erterprises, in despite of those that murmur, and make false reports unto you of me; howbeit if you fear this danger so much as you say, and are therefore pleased that we shall take some other way less frequented with men and vessels, and where we may sail without dread of any thing, than you must be contented to bestow a far longer time in this voyage, wherefore resolve with your company upon it without any further delay, or let us return back, for lo I am ready to do whatsoever you will. Antonio de Faria, embracing, and giving him many thanks, fell to discourse with him about that other safer way of which he spoke: Whereupon Similau told him, that some hundred and forty leagues further forwards to the North, there was a River somewhat larger by half a league, called Sumhepadano, where he should meet with no Obstacle, for that it was not peopled like the straight of Nanquin, wherein they now were, but that then they should be retarded a month longer, by the exceeding much winding of this River. Antonio de Faria thinking it far better to expose himself to a length of time, then to hazard his life for abridgement of way, followed the counsel that Similau gave him; so that going out of the straight of Nanquin, he coasted the land five days, at the end whereof we discovered a very high Mountain towards the East, which Similau told us was called Fanius; approaching somewhat near unto it we entered into a very fair Port, forty fathom deep, that extending itself in the form of a Crescent was sheltered from all sorts of winds, so spacious withal, as two thousand Vessels how great soever might ride there at ease. Antonio de Faria went ashore with some ten or eleven Soldiers, and rounded this haven, but could not meet with any one body, that could instruct him in the way he pretended to make, whereat he was very much vexed, and greatly repent him for that without any kind of consideration, or taking advice of any one, he had rashly, and out of a capacious humour, undertaken this Voyage: Howbeit he dissembled this displeasure of his the best he could for fear lest his company should tax him with want of courage. In this Haven he discoursed again with Similau before every one concerning this our Navigation, which he told him was made but by guess; whereunto the Chinese answered, Signior Captain, If I had any thing I could engage to you of more value than my head, I protest unto you I would most willingly do it, for I am so sure of the course I hold, that I would not fear to give you my very children in Hostage of the promise I made you at Liampoo: Nevertheless I advertise you again, that if repenting the undertaking of this enterprise you fear to proceed any further, in regard of the tales your people are ever tattling in your ear, as I have often observed, do but command, and you shall find how ready I am to obey your pleasure: And whereas they would make you believe that I spin out this Voyage longer than I promised you at Liampoo, the reason thereof you know well enough, which seemed not amiss when I propounded it unto you, seeing then you once allowed of it, let me entreat you to set your heart at rest for that matter, and not to break off this design by returning back, whereby at length you shall find how profitable this patience of yours will prove. This speech somewhat quieted Antonio de Faria's mind, so that he bid him go on as he thought best, and never trouble himself with the murmuring of the Soldiers, whereof he complained, saying, that it was ever the manner of such as were idle, to find fault with other men's actions, but if they did not mend their error the sooner, he would take a course with them to make them to do it; wherewith Similau rested very well satisfied and contented. §. 2. After we were gone from this Haven, we sailed along the coast above thirteen days together, always in sight of land, and at length arrived at a Port, called Buxipalem, in the height of forty nine degrees. We found this Climate somewhat colder than the rest, here we saw an infinite company of Fishes and Serpents, of such strange forms, as I cannot speak of them without fear; Similau told Antonio de Faria incredible things concerning them, as well of what he had seen himself, having been there before, as of that had been reported unto him, especially in the full Moons of the months of November, December, and january, when the storms reign there most, as indeed this Chinese made it appear to our own eyes, whereby he justified unto us the most of that which he had affirmed. For in this place we saw Fishes in the shape of Thornbacks that were four fathoms about, and had a Muzzle like an Ox; likewise we saw others resembling great Lizards, spotted all over with green and black, having three rows of prickles on their backs, that were very sharp, and of the bigness of an arrow; their bodies also were full of the like, but they were neither so long, nor so great as the others: These Fishes would ever and anon bristle up themselves like Porcupines, which made them very dreadful to behold, they had Snouts that were very sharp and black, with two crooked teeth out of each jawbone, two spans long, like the tusks of a wild Boar. We also saw Fishes whose bodies were exceeding black, so prodigious and great, that their heads only were above six spans broad. I will pass over in silence many other Fishes of sundry sorts, which we beheld in this place, because I hold it not fit to stand upon things that are out of my discourse, let it suffice me to say, that during two nights we stayed here we did not think ourselves safe, by reason of the Lizards, Whales, Fishes and Serpents, which in great numbers showed themselves to us. Having left this Haven of Buxipalem, by us called the River of Serpents, which in great numbers showed themselves to us, Similau sailed fifteen leagues further to another Bay named Calindano, which was in form of a Crescent, six leagues in circuit, and environed with high Mountains, and very thick woods, amidst whereof divers Brooks of fresh waters descended, which made up four great Rivers that fell all into this Bay. There Similau told us, that all those prodigious creatures we had both seen and heard of, as well in this Bay, as in that where we were before, came thither to feed upon such Ordure and Carrion, as the overflowing of these Rivers brought to this place. Antonio de Faria demanding of him thereupon, whence those Rivers should proceed, he answered that he knew not, but it was said that the Annals of China affirmed, how two of those Rivers took their beginnings from a great L●ke, called Moscombia, and the other two from a Province, named Alimania, where there are high Mountains, that all the year long are covered with Snow, so that the Snow coming to dissolve, these Rivers swelled in that manner as we then beheld them, for now they were bigger, then at any other time of the year. Hereunto he added, that entering into the mouth of the River, before the which we road at anchor, we should continue our course, steering Eastward, for to find out the Port of Nanquin again, which we had left two hundred and threescore leagues behind us, by reason that in all this distance we had multiplied a greater height then that of the Island was, which we were in quest of. Now although this was exceeding grievous unto us, yet Similau desired Antonio de Faria to think the time we had passed well spent, because it was done for the best, and for the better securing of our lives; being asked then by Antonio de Faria how long we should be in passing through this River, he answered that we should be out of it in fourteen or fifteen days, and that in five days after he would promise to land him and his Soldiers in the Island of Calempluy, where he hoped fully to content his desire, and to make him think his pains well bestowed, whereof he now so complained. Antonio de Faria, having embraced him very lovingly thereupon; vowed to be his friend for ever, and reconciled him to his Soldiers, who were very much out with him before. Being thus reconfirmed by Similau● speeches, and certified of this new course we were to take, he encouraged his company, and put all things in order convenient for his design, to that end preparing his Ordnance which till then had never been charged; he caused also his Arms to be made ready, ordained Captains, and sentines to keep good watch, together with all besides that he thought necessary for our defence, in case of any attempt upon us. That done, he spoke unto Diego Lobato, who was the Priest that we carried along with us, and one that we much respected as a man of the Church, to make a Sermon unto his company for to animate them against all dangers that might happen, which he worthily performed, and by the efficacy of his words, full of sweetness, and excellent examples, he so revived our spirits, that before were much dejected through the apprehension of the dangers that menaced us, as there was not one amongst us, but presently took fresh heart, boldly to execute the enterprise we had undertaken: Whereupon with great devotion and zeal we sung a Salvo, before an Image of our Lady, every man promising without any future fear to finish the Voyage we had begun. That done, we joyfully hoist sail, and entering into the mouth of the River, steering directly East, and with tears in our eyes invoked from the bottom of our hearts, the assistance of that Sovereign Lord which sits at the right hand of the Father everlasting, to preserve us by his Almighty power. §. 3. Continuing on our course with the force of Oars and Sails, and steering divers ways, by reason of the many turnings of the River, the next day we arrived at a very high mountain called Botinafau, whence sundry Rivers of fresh water ran down. In this mountain were a number Tigers, Rhinocerots, Lions, Ounces, and such other creatures of several kinds, which running and roaring in their wild manner, made cruel war upon other weaker Beasts, as Stags, Boars, Apes, Monkeys, Baboons, Wolves, and Foxes, wherein we took much delight, spending a great deal of time in beholding them; and ever and anon we cried out from our Ships to fright them, but they were little moved with it, in regard they were not used to be hunted: We were about six days in passing this Mountain, it being some forty or fifty leagues long. Within a pretty while after we had left this Mountain we came to another, named Gangitanon, no less wild than the former, beyond the which all the Country was very stony, and almost inaccessible; moreover it was full of such thick Woods, as the Sun could not possibly pierce them with his beams: Similau told us, that in this mountain there were ninety leagues of desert land, altogether unfit for Tillage, and the bottom thereof only was inhabited by certain most deformed men, called Gigauhos, who lived after a most brutish fashion, and fed on nothing but what they got in hunting, or some Rice, that the Merchants of China brought them to Catan in exchange of Fu●●es; which the said Merchants carried from thence to Pocasser and Lantau, amounting yearly as by the Books of the Customs thereof appeared, to the number of twenty thousand Ca●es, each Ca●e, or pack, containing threescore skins, wherewith the people used in winter to line their Gowns, hang their Houses, and make cover for their Beds, to withstand the cold of the Climate, which is great there. Antonio de Faria wondering at the Relation this Chinese made of the deformity of these Gigauhos, desired him if it were possible to let him see one of them, whereby he said he should more content him then if he should give him the treasures of China; whereunto Similau made him this Answer, Signior Captain, since it it so much imports me, as well to maintain my credit with you, as to stop their mouths that murmur against me, and that jogging one another scoff at me, when I recount these things unto you, which they account as so many Fables, and to the end that by the truth of the one, they may be ascertained of the other, I will promise before Sunsetting yet to show you a couple of these people, and that you shall also speak with them, upon condition you do not go ashore, as you have still used to do hitherto, for fear some mischance should happen to you, as many times it doth to Merchants in like cases: For I assure you, that the Gigauhos are of so savage and brutish a nature, as they feed on nothing commonly but raw flesh and blood, like the wild Beasts that live in this Forest. So continuing our course all along the side of this Mountain, at length behind a little point of land, we discovered a young youth, without ere an hair on his face, driving six or seven Cows before him, that pastured there by. Similau making a sign to him with a napkin, he presently stayed, whereupon coming a little nearer to him, Similau showed him a piece of green Taffeta, which he told us was a stuff very acceptable to these brutish men, and withal by signs demanded of him whether he would buy it; this drew him to the bank of the River, were he answered with an hoarse voice, some words that we could not comprehend, because there was not one in all our Vessels that understood this barbarous language, so that of necessity this commerce was to be made by signs: Antonio de Faria commanded three or four yards of the said piece of Taffata to be given him, as also six Pourcelains, wherewith this Savage seemed to be very well pleased, for taking both the one and the other, transported with joy he said something to us, which we could understand no better than the former, then making a sign with his hand towards the place of his abode, he left his Cows, and ran away to the wood, clothed as he was with a Tiger's skin, his arms and legs naked, bareheaded, and a staff hardened at one end with the fi●e in his hand. For his person, he was well proportioned of his limbs, his hair red and curled hanging down on his shoulders; his stature by conjecture was above ten foot high, but we were amazed to see him return about a quarter of an hour to the very same place again, c●rrying a live Stag on his back, and having thirteen persons in his company, namely eight men and five women, leading three Cows ●yed together, and dancing as they went at the sound of a kind of Tabor, upon the which they beat five strokes at a time, and as often clapped their hands together singing to it, with a very hoarse voice in their language. Hereupon Antonio de Faria caused five or six pieces of silk stuff, and a great many of Pourcelains to be showed them, for to make them believe that we were Merchants, at the sight whereof they very much rejoiced. These persons, both men and women, were apparelled all after one and the same fashion, without any kind of difference, saving that the women wore great tinnen Bracelets about the middle of their arms, and their hair a great deal longer than the men's, stuck all about with flowers, resembling our Flower de luces; they had chains also of red Cockles about their necks, almost as big as Oyster-shels; as for the men they carried great staves in their hands, covered to the midst with the same skins wherewith they were clothed; moreover they had all of them fierce looks, great lips, flat noses, wide nostrils, and were of stature very tall, but yet not so high as we thought they had been; for Antonio de Faria having caused them to be measured, he found that the tallest of them exceeded not ten spans and an half, except one old man that reached to eleven. The women's stature was not fully ten spans: Their very countenances showed them to be very rude and blockish, and less rational, than all the other people which we had seen in our Conquests. Now Antonio de Faria being glad that we had not altogether lost our labour, bestowed on them threescore Pourcelains, a piece of green Taffeta, and a pannier full of Pepper, wherewith they seemed to be so contented, that prostrating themselves on the ground, and lifting up their hands to heaven, they fell to saying certain words which we took for a thanksgiving after their manner, because they fell down three several times on the earth, and gave us the three Cows and the Stag, as also a great many of Herbs: Having been talking about two hours with them by signs, and no less wondering at us, than we at them, they returned into the wood from whence they came, and we pursued our course up the River by the space of five days, during the which we saw more of them along by the water side; after we had past all this distance of land, which might be some forty leagues, or thereabouts, we navigated sixteen days more with the force of Oa●s and Sails, without seeing any person in that desert place, only for two nights together we discerned certain fires a good way off at land: In the end it pleased God that we arrived at the Gulf of Nanquin, as Similau had told us, with a hope in five or six days to see our desires accomplished. Being come into the gulf of Nanquin, Similau counselled Antonio de Faria, §. 4. that at any hand he should not suffer any Portugal to be seen, because if such a thing should happen he feared some uproar would follow amongst the Chinese, in regard no strangers had ever been seen in those quarters; adding withal, that it would be safer for them to keep still in the middle of the gulf, then by the shore, by reason of the great number of Lorches and Lanteaas, that incessantly sailed up and down; this advice was approved of every one, so that having continued our course some six day's East and East Northeast, we discovered a great Town, called Sileupamor, whither we directly went, and entered the Haven about two hours within night, where we found an infinite company of Vessels riding at anchor, to the number, according to our thinking, of three thousand at the least, which gave us such an alarm, as not daring scarce to wag we got out again with all the secrecy that might be; crossing over the whole breadth of the River then, which was some six or seven leagues, we prosecuted our course all the rest of that day, and coacted along by a great plain, with a resolution to accommodate ourselves with Victuals wheresoever we could first meet with any, for we were in such scarcity, as for thirteen days together, no man had more than three mouthfuls of boiled Rice allowance. Being in this extremity we arrived close to certain old buildings, there went ashore one morning before day, and fell upon a house, that stood a little way off from the rest, where we found a great quantity of Rice, some Beans, dive●s pots full of Honey, powdered Geese, Onions, Garlic, and Sugar Canes, wherewith we throughly furnished ourselves: Certain Chineses told us afterwards, that this was the storehouse of an Hospital, which was some two leagues off, where such were entertained, as past that way in Pilgrimage to the Sepulchers of the Kings of China; Being reimbarqued, and well provided of Victual, we continued on our voyage seven days more, which made up two months and an half, since we put out of Li●mpoo; Then Antonio de Faria began to mistrust the truth of what Similau had said, so that he repented the undertaking of this voyage, as he confessed publicly before us all, nevertheless in regard there was no other remedy for it but to recommend himself to God, and wisely to prepare for all that might happen, he courageously performed it. Hereupon it fell out that Antonio de Faria having one morning demanded of Similau in what part he thought they were, he answered him so far from the purpose, and like a man that had lost his judgement, or that knew not which way he had gone, as put Antonio de Faria into such choler, that he was going to st●b him with a Poniard that he wore, which without doubt he had done▪ had he not been diverted from i● by some, that counselled him to forbear, lest it should be the cause of his utter ruin, whereupon moderating his anger he yielded to the advice of his friends, nevertheless he was not for all that so contained, but that taking him by the Beard he swore, that if within three days at the farthest, he did not let him see, either the truth or the falsehood of what he had told him, he would Poniard him infallibly, wherewith Similau was so exceedingly terrified, that the night following as we were abiding by the shore he slid down from the Vessel into the River, and that so closely, as he was never discovered by the Sentinels or any other until the end of the first Watch, when as Antonio de Faria was thereof advertised: This news put him so far besides himself, as he lost all patience, the rather for that ●e feared some revolt upon it from his Soldiers, who he saw were too much disposed thereunto. But he presently went ashore with a great many of his company, and spent the most part of the night in seeking of Similau, without meeting him, or any other living soul that was able to tell any news of him, but the worst of it yet was, that upon his return into his Junk, of forty six Chinese Mariners, that he had aboard him, he found six and thirty fled away to prevent the danger they were afraid of, whereat Antonio de Faria and all his company were so amazed, that lifting up their hands and eyes to heaven, they stood a long time mute, their tears supplying the defect of their speech, thereby testifying the secret sorrow of their hearts, for considering well what had happened unto them, and the great peril they were in, the least that they could do in this confusion was to lose their courage and judgement, much more their speech. Howbeit falling at length to consult what we should do for the future, after much diversity of opinion, it was in the ●nd concluded, that we should pursue our design, and labour to take some body that might inform us how far it was from thence to the Island of Cal●●pl●y, and this to be done as secretly as possible might be for fear the Country should rise; likewise that if upon the report should be made us we found it would be 〈◊〉 t●ke●▪ ●s Similau had assured us, we should then proceed on, otherwise, that we should 〈◊〉 wi●h the current of the water, which would bring ●s directly to the Sea with its ordinary course. This resolution taken and approved of every one, we went on with no less confusion than fear, for in so manifest a danger we could not choose but be very much perplexed; the night following about break of day we discovered a little Bark ● he●d of us riding at 〈◊〉 in the midst of the River; her we boarded with as little noise as might be, and took five men asleep in her, whom Antonio de Faria questioned each one apart by himself, to see how they would agree in that they said: To his demands they answered all of them, that the Country wherein we were, was called Temquil●m, from whence the Island of Cal●mpl●y was distant but ten leagues, and ●o many other questions propounded 〈◊〉 ●he● for our common security, they answered likewise separately one from the other to very good purpose, wherewith Antonio de Faria and his whole company, were exceedingly well satisfied, but yet it grieved us not a little, to think what an inconvenience the lack of Similau would prove to us in this attempt; however Antonio de Faria causing the five Chinese to be arrested, and chained to oars, continued his course two days and an half more, at the end whereof it pleased God that doubling a cape of land, called Guimai Tar●●, we discovered this Island of Cal●mpluy, which we had been fourscore and three days seeking for with extreme confusion of pains and labour, as I have before related. CHAP. XXV. Our Arrival at C●lempluy, and the description thereof; what happened to Antonio de Faria in one of the Hermitages thereof, and how we were discovered. §. 1. HAving doubled the Cape of Cuimai Tar●●, two leagues beyond it, we discovered a goodly level of ground, situated in the midst of a River, which to our seeming was not above a league in circuit, whereunto Antonio de Faria approached with exceeding great joy, which yet was intermingled with much f●●r, because he knew not to what danger he and his were exposed; about twelve of the clock at night he anchored within a Canon shot of this Island, and the next morning as soon as it was day he sat in Council with such of his company as he had called to it, there it was concluded that it was not possible so great and magnificent a thing should be without some kind of guard, and therefore it was resolved that with the greatest silence that might be, it should be rounded all about, for to see what advenues it had, or what Obstacles we might meet with when there was question of landing, to the end that accordingly we might deliberate more amply on that we had to do: With this Resolution, which was approved by every one▪ Antonio de Faria weighed anchor, and without any noise got close to the Island, and compassing it about exactly observed every particular that presented itself to his sight. This Island was all enclosed with a platform of Jasper, six and twenty spans high, the stones whereof were so neatly wrought, and joined together, that the wall seemed to be all of one piece, at which every one greatly marvelled, as having never seen any thing till then, either in the Indias, or elsewhere, that merited comparison with it; this Wall was six and twenty spans deep from the bottom of the River to the Superficies of the water, so that the full height of it was two and fifty spans. Furthermore the top of the Platform was bordered with the same stone, cut into great Tower-work; Upon this wall, which environed the whole Island, was a Gallery of Balisters of turned Copper, that from six to six fathom joined to certain Pillars of the same Metal, upon each of the which was the figure of a Woman holding a bowl in her hand; within this gallery were divers Monsters cast in metal, standing all in a row, which holding one another by the hand in manner of a dance encompassed the whole Island, being as I have said, a league about: Amidst these monstrous Idols there was likewise another row of very rich Arches, made of sundry coloured pieces; a sumptuous work, and wherewith the eye might well be entertained and contented; Within was a little wood of Orange Trees, without any mixture of other plants, and in the midst an hundred and threescore Hermitages dedicated to the gods of the year, of whom these Gentiles recount many pleasant Fables in their Chronicles for the defence of their blindness in their f●l●● belief: A quarter of a league beyond these Hermitages, towards the East, divers goodly great Edifices were seen, separated the one from the other with seven forefronts of Houses, built after the manner of our Churches; from the top to the bottom as far as could be discerned, these buildings were gilded all over, and annexed to very high Towers, which in all likelihood were Steeples; their Edifices were environed with two great streets arched all along, like unto the Frontispieces of the Houses; these Arches were supported by very huge Pillars, on the top whereof, and between every arch was a dainty Prospective; now in regard these buildings, towers, pillars and their chapters, were so exceedingly gilded all over, as one could discern nothing but Gold, it persuaded us that this Temple must needs be wonderful sumptuous and rich, since such cost had been bestowed on the very Walls. After we had surrounded this whole Island, and observed the adven●es and entries thereof, notwithstanding it was somewhat late, yet would Antonio de Faria needs go ashore to see if he could get any Intelligence in one of those Hermitages, to the end he might thereupon resolve, either to prosecute his design, or return back: So having left a guard sufficient for his two Vessels, and Diego Lobato, his Chaplain, Captain of them, he landed with forty Soldiers, and twenty slaves, as well Pikes, as Harquebuses; He also carried with him four of the Chinese, which we took a while before, both for that they knew the pla●e well, as having been there at other times, and likewise that they might serve us for truthmen and guides: Being got to the shore unespied of any one▪ and without noise, we entered the Island by one of the eight Advenues that it had, and marching through the midst of the little wood of Orange-trees we arrived at the gate of the first Hermitage, which might be some two Musket-shot from the place we disimbarqued, where that happened unto us which I will deliver hereafter. Antonio de Faria went directly to the next Hermitage he saw before him with the greatest silence that might be, and with no little fear, §. 2. for that he knew not into what danger he was going to engage himself; which he found shut on the inside, he commanded one of the Chineses to knock at it, as he did two or three times, when at last he heard one speak in this manner, Praised be the Creator, who hath enamelled the beauty of the skies, let him that knocks at the gate go about, and he shall find it open on the other side, where let me know what he desires. The Chinese went presently about, and entering into the Hermitage by a back door, he opened the ●orega●e to Antonio de Faria, and let him in with all his followers; There he found an old man, that seemed to be an hundred years old; he was apparelled in a long violet coloured damask gown, and by his countenance appeared to be a man of quality, as we understood afterwards: Being amazed to see so many men, he fell to the ground, where he lay a good while without speaking a word, howbeit at length he began to be better confirmed, and beholding us with a serious look, he gravely demanded of us what we were, and what we would have; whereunto the Interpreter answered by the express commandment of Antonio de Faria, that he was a Captain stranger, a native of the Kingdom of Siam, and that sailing in a Junk of his, laden with merchandise, and bound for Liampoo, he had suffered shipwreck, whence he had miraculously escaped with all his company, and for that he had vowed to make a pilgrimage to this holy place, to praise God for preserving him from so great a peril, he was now come to perform his vow; also to crave somewhat of him by way of alms, whereby his poverty might be relieved, protesting within three years to render him twice as much as he should then take from him: whereupon the Hermit, named Hiticon, having mused a little on the matter, and fixing his eye on Antonio de Faria: Whoever thou art, said he unto him, know that I throughly understand what thou sayest, and that I perceive but too well thy damnable intention, wherewith out of the obscurity of thy blindness, like an infernal pilot, thou carriest both thyself, and these others, into the profound abism of the lake of night: for instead of rendering thanks to God for so great a favour, as thou confessest he hath showed thee, thou comest hither to rob this holy house: But let me ask thee, if thou executest thy mischievous design, what will the divine justice, thinkest thou, do with thee at the last gasp of thy life? Change then thy perverse inclination, and never suffer the imagination of so great a sin to enter thy thoughts; give credit unto me that tells thee nothing but the very truth, even as I hope to thrive by it all the rest of my life. Antonio de Faria seeming to approve of the counsel, which the old Hermit gave him, earnestly desired him not to be displeased, assuring him that he had no other means or way left to relieve him and his, but what he could find in that place: To which the Hermit wring his hands, and lifting up his eyes, said weeping, Praised be thou, O Lord, that permittest men to live on the earth, who offend thee under pretext of seeking means to live, and that vouchsafe not to serve thee one hour, although they know how assured thy glory is. After he had uttered these words, he remained very pensive and much troubled to see the great disorder we used in breaking up the coffins, and flinging them out of their places; at length looking upon Antonio de Faria, who stood leaning upon his sword, he entreated him to sit down by him, which he did with a great deal of compliment, not desisting for all that from making signs to his soldiers to persist as they had begun, that was to take the silver which was mingled amongst the bones of the dead in the tombs, that they broke up; whereat the Hermit was so grieved as he fell down twice in a swoon from his seat, but being come to himself, he spoke thus to Antonio de Faria, I will declare unto thee as to a man that seems discreet, the means whereby thou mayst obtain pardon for the sin, which thou and thy people now commit, to the end that thy soul may not perish eternally, when as the last breath of thy mouth shall go out of thy body: Seeing then, as thou sayest, that it is necessity constrains thee to offend in this grievous manner, and that thou hast a purpose to make restitution before thou diest, of that thou takest away from hence; if thou hast time and power, thou mayst do these three things: First, thou must render again what thou now carriest away, that the Sovereign Lord may not turn his mercy from thee: Secondly, thou must with tears ask him forgiveness for thy fault, which is so odious unto him, never ceasing to chastise thy flesh both day and night: And thirdly, thou must distribute thy goods to the poor, as liberally as to thyself, giving them alms with prudence and discretion, to the end the servant of the night may have nothing to accuse thee of at the last day. Now, for recompense of this counsel, I desire thee to command thy followers to gather together the bones of the Saints, that they may not be despised on the earth. Antonio de Faria promised him very courteously to perform his request, wherewith the Hermit was a little better at quiet then before, but yet not fully satisfied, howbeit he spoke him very fair, and assured him that after he had once seen him, he very much repent the undertaking of this enterprise, but his soldiers had threatened to kill him, if he returned without executing of it, and this he told him as a very great secret, God grant it be so, replied the Hermit, for that thou shalt not be so blame-worthy as these other monst●rs of the night, which are so greedy, like to famished dogs, that it seems all the silver in the world is not able to satiate them. § 3. After we had gathered all the silver together, that was in the graves amongst the dead men's bones, and carried it aboard our ships, we were all of opinion not to go any farther to the rest of the Hermitages, as well because we knew not the Country, as for that it was almost night, upon hope that the next day we might continue our enterprise more at leisure. Now before he reinba●qued himself, Antonio de Faria took leave of the Hermit, and giving him very good words, he desired him for God's sake not to be offended with that his followers had done, being constrained thereunto by mere necessity: for as his for particular he exceedingly abhorred such like actions, adding withal, that at the first sight of him, he would have returned back, out of the remover of conscience, and true repentance; but that his company had hindered him, saying, that if he did so, they would surely kill him; so that for to have his life he was compelled to yield and consent thereunto, though he plainly saw that it was a very great sin, in regard whereof he was resolved, as soon as he could rid his hands of them, to go up and down the world to perform such penance as was requisite for the purging of him from so enormous a crime. Hereunto the Hermit answered, Pleaseth the Lord, who living, reigneth above the beauty of the stars, that the knowledge, which by this discourse, thou showest to have, be not prejudicial unto thee; For I be assured, that he who knows these things, and doth them not, runs a far greater danger, than he that sins through ignorance. Then one of ours, named Nuno Coelho, who would needs have an oar in our talk, told him, that he was not to be angry for a matter of so small importance; whereunto the Hermit beholding him with so stern a countenance, answered, Certainly, the fear which thou hast of death is yet less, since thou imployest thyself in actions as infamous and black as the soul that is in thy body; and for my part, I cannot but be persuaded, that all thy ambition is wholly placed upon money, as but too well appears by the the thirst of thy insatiable avarice, whereby thou wilt make an end of heaping up the measure of thine infernal appetite: Continue then thy theeveries, for seeing then thou must go to hell for that which thou hast already taken out of this holy house, thou shalt also go thither for those things which thou shalt steal otherwise, so the heavier the burden shall be that thou bearest, the sooner shalt thou be precipitated into the bottom of hell, where already thy wicked works have prepared thee an everlasting abode. Hereupon Nuno de Coelho prayed him to take all things patiently, affirming that the Law of God commanded him so to do. Then the Hermit lift up his hand by way of admiration, and as it were smiling at what the soldier had said, Truly, answered he, I am come to see, that I never thought to see or hear, namely, evil actions disguised with a specious pretext of virtue, which makes me believe that thy blindness is exceeding great, since trusting to good words, thou spendest thy life so wickedly, wherefore it is not possible thou shouldest ever come to Heaven, or give any account to God at the last day, as of necessity they must do. Saying so, he turned him to Antonio de Faria, without attending further answer from him, and earnestly desired him not to suffer his company to spit upon and profane the altar, which he vowed was more grievous to him, than the enduring of a thousand deaths; whereupon to satisfy him, he presently commanded the forbearance of it; wherewith the Hermit was somewhat comforted; Now because it grew late, Antonio de Faria resolved to leave the place, but before he departed he held it necessary to inform himself of certain other particulars, whereof he stood in some doubt, so that he deserved of the Hermit how many persons there might be in all those Hermitages: whereunto Hiticon answered, that there were about three hundred and threescore Talagrepos, besides forty Menigrepos, appointed to furnish them with things requisite for their maintenance, and to attend them when they were sick: moreover he asked him, whether the King of China came not sometimes thither; he told him, No, for, said he, the King cannot be condemned by any body, he is the son of the Sun, but contrarily he had power to absolve every one. Then he enquired of him if there were any arms in their Hermitages? O no, answered the Hermit, for all such as pretend to go to heaven have more need of patience to endure injuries, then of arms to revenge themselves: Being also desirous to know of him the cause why so much silver was mingled with the bones of the dead. This silver, replied the Hermit, comes of the alms that the deceased carry with them out of this into the other life, for to serve them at their need in the heaven of the Moon, where they live eternally: In conclusion, having demanded of him whither they had any women, he said, That they which would maintain the life of their souls, ought not to taste the pleasures of the flesh, seeing experience made it apparent, that the Bee which nourisheth herself in an hony-comb, d●th often sting such as offer to meddle with that sweetness. After Antonio de Faria had propounded all these questions, he took his leave of him, and so went directly to his ships, with an intention to return again the next day, for to set upon the other Hermitages, where, as he had been told, was great abundance of silver, and certain Idols of gold, but our sins would not permit us to see the effect of a business, which we had been two months and an half a purchasing with so much labour and danger of our lives, as I will deliver hereafter. §. 4. At the clearing up of the day, Antonio de Faria, and all of us, being embarked, we went and anchored on the other side of the Island, about a falcon shot from it, with an intent, as I have before declared, to go a shore again the next morning, and set upon the Chapels where the Kings of China were interred, that so we might the more commodiously lad our two vessels with such treasures, which peradventure might have succeeded according to our desires, if the business had been well carried, and that Antonio de Faria had followed the counsel was given him, which was, that since we had not been as yet discovered, that he should have carried the Hermit away with him, to the end he might not acquaint the House of the Bonzos' with what we had done; howbeit he would never hearken to it, saying, that we were to fear nothing that way, by reason the Hermit was so old, and his legs so swollen with the gout, as he was not able to stand, much less to go: But it fell out clean contrary to his expectation, for the Hermit no sooner saw us embarked, as we understood afterwards, but he presently crawled as well as he could to the next Hermitage, which was not above a flight shoot from his, and giving intelligence of all that had passed, he bade his companion, because himself was not able, to go away with all speed to the Bonzo●s house to acquaint them with it, which the other instantly performed; so that about midnight we saw a great many of fires lighted on the top of the wall of the Temple, where the Kings were buried, being kindled to serve for a signal to the Country about, of some extraordinary danger towards: This made us ask of our Chinese, what they might mean, who answered, that assuredly, we were discovered, in regard whereof they advised us without any longer stay to set sail immediately; Herewith they acquainted Antonio de Faria, who was fast asleep, but he straightway arose, and leaving his anchor in the sea, rowed directly, afraid as he was, to the Island, for to learn what was done there: Being arrived near to the Key, he heard many bells ringing in each Hermitage, together with a noise of men talking, whereupon the Chineses that accompanied him, said, Sir, never stand to hear or see more, but retire, we beseech you, as fast as you may, and cause us not to be all miserably slain with your further stay; Howbeit little regarding, or afraid of their words, he went ashore only with six soldiers, having no other arms but swords and targots, and going up the stairs of the Key, whither it were that he was vexed for having lost so fair an occasion, or carried thereunto by his courage, he entered into the gallery, that environed the Island, and ran up and down in it like a mad man, without meeting any body; That done, and being returned aboard his vessel, much grieved and ashamed, he consulted with his company about what they should do, who were of opinion that the best course we could take, was to depart, and therefore they required him to put it accordingly in execution; Seeing them all so resolved, and fearing some tumults among the soldiers, he was fain to answer, that he was also of their mind, but first he thought it fit to know for what cause they should fly away in that manner, and therefore he desired them to stay for him a little in that place, because he would try whether he could learn by some means or other the truth of the matter, whereof they had but a bare suspicion; for which, he told them, he would ask but half an hour at the most, so that there would be time enough to take order for any thing before day; some would have alleged reasons against this, but he would not hear them, wherefore having caused them all to take their oaths, upon the holy Evangelists, that they would stay for him, he returned to land with the same soldiers, that had accompanied him before, and entering into the little wood, he heard the sound of a bell, which addressed him to another Hermitage, far richer than that wherein we were the day before: There he met with two men, apparaled like Monks, with large hoods, which made him think they were Hermits, of whom he presently laid hold, wherewith one of them was so terrified, as he was not able to speak a good while after: Hereupon four of the six soldiers passed into the Hermitage, and took an Idol of silver from the altar, having a crown of gold on its head, and a wheel in its hand; they also brought away three candlesticks of silver, with long chains of the same belonging to them: This performed, Antonio de Faria carrying the two Hermits along with him, went aboard again, and sailing away, he propounded divers questions to him, of the two, that was least afraid, threatening to use him in a strange fashion if he did not tell the truth. This Hermit seeing himself so menaced, answered, That an holy man, named Pilau Angiroo came about midnight to the house of the King's Sepultures, where knocking in haste at the gate, he cried out, saying; O miserable men, buried in the drunkenness of carnal sleep, who by a solemn vow, have professed yourselves to the honour of the Goddess Amida, the rich reward of our labours, hear, hear, hear, O the most wretched men that ever were born, There are strangers come into our Island, from the further end of the World, which have long beards, and bodies of Iron, these wicked creatures have entered into the Holy House of the seven and twenty Pillars, of whose sacred Temple an holy man is keeper, that hath told it me, where after they had ransacked the rich treasures of the Saints, they contemptedly threw their bones to the ground, which they profaned with their stinking and infectious spitting, and made a mockery of them like Devils, obstinate and hardened in their wretched sins, wherefore I advise you to look well to yourselves, for it is said, that they have sworn to kill us all as soon as it is day: Fly away then, or call some people to your succour, since being Religious men you are not permitted to meddle with any thing that may shed the blood of man. Herewith they presently arose and ran to the gate, where they found the Hermit laid on the ground, and half dead with grief and weariness through the imbecility of his age; whereupon the Grepos and Meingrepos made those fires that you saw, and withal sent in all haste to the Towns of Corpilem, and Fonbana, for to succour them speedily with the Forces of the Country, so that you may be assured it will not be long before they fall upon this place with all the fury that may be. Now this is all that I am able to say concerning the truth of this affair, wherefore I desire you to return us both unto our Hermitage with our lives saved, for if you do not so you will commit a greater sin, than you did yesterday: Remember also that God, in regard of the continual penance we perform, hath taken us so far into his protection, as he doth visit us almost every hour of the day, wherefore labour to save yourselves as much as you will, yet shall you hardly do it; For be sure, that the earth, the air, the winds, the waters, the beasts, the fishes, the fowls, the trees, the plants, and all things created will pursue and torment you so cruelly, as none but he that lives in heaven will be able to help you. Antonio de Faria being hereby certainly informed of the truth of the business sailed instantly away, tearing his hair and beard for very rage, to see that through his negligence and indiscretion he had lost the fairest occasion, that ever he should be able to meet withal. CHAP. XXVI. Our casting away in the Gulf of Nanquin, with all that befell us after this lamentable Shipwreck. WE had already sailed seven days in the Gulf of Nanquin, to the end that the force of the Current might carry us the more swiftly away, §. 1. as men whose safety consisted wholly in flight, for we were so desolate and sad, that we scarce spoke one to another; In the mean time we arrived at a Village, called Susequerim, where no news being come either of us, or what we had done, we furnished ourselves with some Victual, and getting Information very covertly of the course we were to hold, we departed within two hours after, and then with the greatest speed we could make we entered into a strait, named Xalingau, much less frequented than the gulf, that we had past; here we navigated nine days more, in which time we ran an hundred and forty leagues, then entering again into the said Gulf of Nanquin, which in that place was not above ten or eleven leagues broad, we sailed for the space of thirteen days from one side to another with a Westerly wind, exceedingly afflicted, both with the great labour we were fain to endure, and the cruel fear we were in, besides the want we began to feel of Victuals: In this case being come within sight of the mountains of Conxinacau, which are in the height of forty and one degrees, there arose so terrible a Southwind, called by the Chineses Tufaon, as it could not possibly be thought a natural thing, so that our Vessels being low built, weak, and without Mariners, we were reduced to such extremity, that out of all hope to escape we suffered ourselves to be driven along the coast, as the current of the water would carry us, for we held it more safeto venture ourselves amongst the Rocks, then to let us be swallowed up in the midst of the Sea, and though we had chosen this design, as the better and less painful, yet did it not succeed, for after dinner the wind turned to the Northwest, whereby the Waves became so high, that it was most dreadful to behold; Our fear then was so extreme, as we began to cast all that we had into the Sea, even to the Chests full of Silver: That done, we cut down our two Masts, and so without M●sts and Sails we floated along all the rest of the day; at length about midnight we heard them in Antonio de Faria's Vessel cry, Lord have mercy upon us, which persuaded us that they were cast away, the apprehension whereof put us in such a fright, as for an hour together no man spoke a word. Having past all this sad night in so miserable a plight, about an hour before day our Vessel opened about the Keel, so that it was instantly full of water eight spans high, whereupon perceiving ourselves to sink, we verily believed, it was the good pleasure of God that in this place we should finish both our lives and labours: As soon then as it was day we looked out to Sea, as far as possibly we could discern, but could no way discover Antonio de Faria, which put us quite out of heart, and so continuing in this great affliction till about ten of the clock, with so much terror and amazement, as words are not able to express, at last we ran against the coast, and even drowned as we were, the Waves rolled us towards a point of Rocks, that stood out into the Sea, where we were no sooner arrived but that all went to pieces, insomuch that of five and twenty Portugals, which we were, there were but fourteen saved, the other eleven being drowned, together with eighteen Christian Servants, and seven Chinese Mariners. This miserable disaster happened on a Monday, the fifth of August, in the year one thousand five hundred forty and two, for which the Lord be praised everlastingly. §. 2. We fourteen Portugals, having escaped out of this shipwreck by the mere mercy of God, spent all that day, and the night following, in bewailing our misfortune, and the wretched estate whereunto we were reduced, but in the end consulting together, what course to take for to give some remedy thereunto, we concluded to enter into the Country, hoping that far or near we should not fail to meet with some body, that taking us for slaves, would relieve us with meat, till such time as it should please Heaven to terminate our travels with the end of our lives. With this Resolution we went some six or seven leagues over rocks and hills, and on the other side discovered a great Marsh, so large and void, as it past the reach of our sight, there being no appearance of any land beyond it, which made us turn back again, towards the same place where we were cast away; being arrived there the day after about Sunset, we found upon the shore the bodies of our men, which the Sea had cast up, over whom we recomenced our sorrow and lamentations, and the next day we buried them in the sand, to keep them from being devoured by the Tigers, whereof that Country is full, which we performed with much labour and pain, in regard we had no other tools for that purpose but our hands and nails; After these poor bodies were interred we got us into a Marsh, where we spent all the night, as the safest place we could choose to preserve us from the Tigers: From thence we continued our journey towards the North, and that by such Precipes and thick woods, as we had much ado to pass through them. Having traveled in this manner three days, at length we arrived at a little strait, without meeting any body, over the which resolving to swim, by ill fortune the four first that entered into it, being three Portugals and a young youth, were miserably drowned, for being very feeble, and the strait somewhat broad, and the current of the water very strong, they were not able to hold out any longer when they came to the midst; so we eleven with three servants that remained, seeing the infortunate success of our companions, could do nothing but weep and lament, as men that hourly expected such or a worse end. Having spent all that dark night, exposed to the wind, cold, and rain, it pleased our Lord that the next morning before day we discovered a great fire towards the East, whereupon as soon as the day broke, we marched fair and softly that way, recomending ourselves to that Almighty God from whom alone we could hope for a remedy to our miseries, and so continuing our journey all along the River, the most part of that day, at last we came to a little wood, where we found five men making of coals, whom on our knees we besought for God's sake to direct us to some place where we might get some relief; I would, said one of them, beholding us with an eye of pity, it lay in our power to help you, but alas! all the comfort we can give you is to bestow some part of our Supper on you, which is a little rice, wherewith you may pass this night here with us if you will, though I hold it better for you to preceded on your way, and recover the place you see a little below, where you shall find an Hospital that serves to lodge such Pilgrims, as chance to come into these quarters. Having thanked him for his good address, we fell to the Rice they gave us, which came but to two mouthfuls a piece, and so took our leaves of them, going directly to the place they had showed us, as well as our weakness would permit. About an hour within night, we arrived at the Hospital, where we met with four men, §. 3. that had the charge of it, who received us very charitably: The next morning as soon as it was day they demanded of us, what we were, and from whence we came? Thereunto we answered, that we were strangers, natives of the Kingdom of Siam, and that coming from the Port of Liampoo to go to the fishing of Nanquin, we were cast away at sea by the violence of a storm, having saved nothing out of this shipwreck, but those our miserable and naked bodies. Whereupon demanding of us again, what we intended to do, and whither we would go; we replied, that we purposed to go to the City of Nanquin, there to embark ourselves as rowers in the first Lanteaa, that should put to sea, for to pass unto Cantan, where our countrymen by the permission of the Aito of Panquin, exercised their traffic under the protection of the son of the Sun, and Lion crowned in the throne of the world, wherefore we desired them for God's cause to let us stay in that Hospital, until we had recovered our healths, and to bestow any poor clothes of us to cover our nakednedness. After they had given good ear unto us; It was reason, answered they, to grant you that which you require with so much earnestness, and tears; but in regard the House is now very poor, we cannot so easily discharge our duties unto you as we should, howbeit we will do what we may with a very good will; Then quite naked, as we were, they lead us all about the Village, containing some forty or fifty fires, more or less; the inhabitants whereof were exceeding poor, having no other living but what they got by the labour of their hands, from whom they drew by way of alms some two Taeis in money, half a Sack of rice, a little meal, aricot beans, onions, and a few old rags, wherewith we made the best shift we could; over and above this they bestowed two Taeis more on us out of the Stock of the Hospital: But whereas we desired that we might be permitted to stay there, they excused themselves, saying, that no poor might remain there above three days, or five at the most, unless it were sick people, or women with child, of whom special care was to be had, because in their extremities they could not travel without endangering their lives, wherefore they could for no other persons whatsoever transgress that Ordinance, which had of ancient time been instituted by the advice of very learned and religious men; nevertheless, that three leagues from thence, we should in a great Town, called Sileyiacau, find a very rich hospital, where all sorts of poor people were entertained, and that there we should be far better looked unto then in their house, which was poor, and agreeable to the place of its situation, to which end they would give us a letter of recommendation, by means whereof we should incontinently be received. For these good offices we rendered them infinite thanks, and told them that God would reward them for it since they did it for his sake, whereupon an old man, one of those four, taking the Speech upon him, It is for that consideration alone we do it, answered he, and not in regard of the world; for God and the World are greatly different in matters of works, and of the intention which one mies have in the doing of them; For the world being poor and miserable as it is, can give nothing that is good, whereas God is infinitely rich, and a friend to the poor, that in the height of their afflictions praise him with patience and humility; The world is revengeful, but God is suffering; the world is wicked, God is all goodness; the world is gluttonous, God is a lover of abstinence; the world is mutinous and turbulent, God is quiet and peaceable; the world is a liar and full of dissimulation to them that belong to it, God is always true, free, and merciful to them that invoke him by prayer; the world is sensual and covetous, God is liberal, and purer than the light of the Sun, or stars, or then those other lamps which are far more excellent than they that appear to our eyes, and are always present before his most resplendent face; the world is full of irresolution and falsehood, wherewith it entertains itself in the smoke of its vain glory, whereas God is constant in his truth, to the end that thereby the humble may possess glory in all sincerity of heart; In a word, the world is full of folly and ignorance, contrarily God is the fountain of wisdom; wherefore my friends, although you be reduced to so pitiful an estate, do you not for all that distrust his promises; for be assured he will not fail you, if you do not render yourselves unworthy of his favours, in regard it was never found that he was at any time wanting to his; albeit they, that are blinded by the world, are of another opinion, when as they see themselves oppressed with poverty, and despised of every body. Having used this Speech to us, he gave us a letter of recommendation to the Brotherhood of the other Hospital, whither we were to go, and so we departed about noon, and arrived at the town an hour or two before sunset. The first thing we did, was to go to the house of the repose of the poor, for so the Chineses call the Hospitals; There we delivered our letters to the Masters of that Society, which they term Tanigories, whom we found altogether in a chamber, where they were assembled about the affairs of the poor; After they had received the letter with a kind of compliment, that seemed very strange to us, they commanded the Register to read it, whereupon he stood up and read thus to them that were sitting at the Table: We the poorest of the poor, unworthy to serve that Sovereign Lord, whose works are so admirable, as the Sun, and the stars that twinkle in the sky, during the darkness of the night do testify: Having been elected to the succession of this his house of Buatendoo, situated in this Village of Catihorau, with all manner of respect and honour, do beseech your humble persons, admitted to the service of the Lord, that out of a zeal of charity, you will lodge and favour these fourteen strangers, whereof three are tawny, the other eleven somewhat whiter, whose poverty will manifestly appear to your eyes, whereby you may judge how much reason we have to present this request unto you, for that 〈◊〉 have been cast away with all their merchandise in the impetuous waters of the sea, that with their accustomed fury have laid the execution of the Almighty hand upon them, which for a just punishment doth often permit such like things to happen; for to show us how dreadful his judgements are, from which may it please him to deliver us all at the day of death, to the end we may not see the indignation of his face. This letter being read, they caused us presently to be lodged in a very neat chamber, accommodated with a Table, and divers Chairs, where after we had been served with good meat, we rested ourselves that night: The next morning the Register came along with the rest of the officers, and demanded of us who we were, of what Nation, and whereabout we had suffered shipwreck, whereunto we answered as we had done before to those of the Village from whence we came, that we might not be found in two tales, and convinced of lying; whereupon having further enquired of us what we meant to do, we told them that our intention was to get ourselves cured in that house, if it pleased them to permit us, in regard we were so weak and sickly as we could scarce stand upon our legs: To which they replied, that they would very willingly see that performed for us, as a thing that was ordinarily done there for the service of God; for the which we thanked them weeping, with so much acknowledgement of their goodness and charity, as the tears stood in their eyes, so that presently sending for a Physician, they bid him look carefully to us, for that we were poor flocks, and had no other means but what we had from the house; That done he took our names in writing, and set them down in a great book, whereunto we all of us set our hands, saying, it was necessary it should be so, that an account might be rendered of the expense was to be made for us. Having spent eighteen days in this Hospital, where we were sufficiently provided for with all things necessary, §. 4. it pleased God that we throughly recovered our healths, so that feeling ourselves strong enough to travel, we departed from thence for to go to a place, called Zuzoangances, some five leagues from that Hospital, where we arrived about sunset; Now in regard we were very weary, we sat us down upon the side of a fountain, that stood at the entrance of that Village, being much perplexed and unresolved what way to take: In the mean time, they which came to fetch water, seeing us set there in so sad an equipage, returned with their pitchers empty, and advertising the inhabitants of it, the most of them came presently forth to us; Then wondering much, because they had never seen men like unto us, they gathered altogether, as if they would consult thereupon, and after they had a good while debated one with another, they sent an old woman to demand of us what people we were, and why we sat so about that fountain, from whence they drew all the water they used: Hereunto we answered, that we were poor strangers, natives of the Kingdom of Siam, who by a storm at sea were cast upon their Country, in that miserable plight wherein they beheld us. Tell me, replied she, what course would you have us to take for you, and what resolve you to do, for here is no house for the repose of the poor whereinto you may be received? To these words one of our company answered with tears in his eyes, and a gesture conformable to our design, that God, being that which he was, would never abandon us with his Almighty hand, but would touch their hearts to take compassion of us, and our poverty; and further, that we were resolved to travel in that miserable case we were in till we had the good fortune to arrive at the City of Nanquin, where we desired to put ourselves into the Lanteaas, there to serve for rowers to the Merchants that ordinarily went from thence to Cantano, and so to get to Comhay, where great store of our Country Junks usually lay, in which we would embark ourselves. Thereupon having somewhat a better opinion of us then before; Seeing you are, said she, such as you deliver, have a little patience till I come again, and tell you what these folks resolve to do with you; wherewith she returned to those country people, which were about some hundred persons, with whom she entered into a great contestation, but at length she came back with one of their Priests, attired in a long gown of red damask; which is an ornament of chiefest dignity among them, in this equipage he came to us with an handful of ears of corn in his hand; Then having commanded us to approach unto him, we presently obeyed him with all kind of respect, but he little regarded it, seeing us so poor; whereupon after he had thrown the ears of corn into the fountain, he willed us to put our hands upon them, which we accordingly having done: You are to confess, said he unto us, by this holy and solemn oath, that now you take in my presence upon these two substances of bread and water, which the high Creator of all things hath made by his holy will to sustain and nourish all that is born into the world, during the pilgrimage of this life, whether that which you told this woman but now be true, for upon that condition we will give you lodging in this village conformably to the charities we are bound to exercise towards God's poor people; whereas contrarily, if it be not so, I command you in his Name that you presently get you gone, upon pain of being bitten and destroyed by the teeth of the gluttonous Serpent, that makes his abode in the bottom of the house of smoke. Hereunto we answered, that we had said nothing but what was most true, wherewith the Priest remaining satisfied; since you are, said he, such as you say, come you along boldly with me, and rely on my word: Then returning with us to the inhabitants of the place, be told them that they might bestow their alms upon us without offence, and that he gave them permission so to do, whereupon we were presently conducted into the Village, and lodged in the porch of their Pagode, or Temple, where we were furnished with all that was needful for us, and had two mats given us to lie upon: The next morning as soon as it was day, we went up and down the street, begging from door to door, and got four Taeis in silver, wherewith we supplied our most pressing necessities. After this we went away to another place, called Xianguulea, that was not above two leagues from that, with a resolution to travel in that sort, as it were in pilgrimage, to the City of Nanquin, to which it was then some hundred and forty leagues; for we thought that from thence we might go to Cantano, where our ships traded at that time, and it may be our design had succeeded, had it not been for ill fortune. About evensong we arrived at that village, where we sat us down under the shadow of a great tree that stood by itself, but it was our ill hap to meet with three boys that kept certain cattle there, who no sooner perceived us, but betaking them to their heels, they cried our, Thiefs, thiefs, whereat the inhabitants came instantly running out, armed with lances and crossbows, crying out, stop the thiefs, stop the thiefs; and so perceiving us, that fled from them, they mauled us cruelly with stones and staves, in such manner as we were all of us grievously hurt, especially one of our boys that died upon it; Then seizing on us, they tied our arms behind us, and leading us like prisoners into the village, they so beat and buffeted us with their fists, as they had almost killed us, than they plunged us into a cistern of standing water, that reached up to our wastes, wherein were a great number of horseleeches; In this miserable place we remained two days, which seemed two hundred years to us, having neither rest, nor any thing to eat all that time: At last, it was our good fortune, that a man of Zuzoangance, from whence we came, passing by, chanced to understand how we had been used by those of the Village, and thereupon went and told them, that they did us great wrong to take us for thiefs, for that we were poor strangers, which had been cast away by a storm at sea, wherefore they had committed a great sin to imprison, and handle us in that sort; The report of this man wrought so effectually with them, that we were presently taken out of the cistern, being all gore blood with the sucking of the horseleeches, and I verily believe that if we had stayed there but one day longer, we had all of us been dead: So we departed from this place about evening, and bewailing our bad fortune, continuing on our voyage. After our departure from Xianguulea we arrived at a Village, inhabited by very poor people, where we met with three men that were pilling Flax, §. 5. who as soon as they saw us forsook their work, and fled hastily away into a wood of Fir trees, there they cried out to those that passed by to take heed of us for that we w●re thiefs, whereupon fearing to incur the same danger whence we so lately escaped, we got us away presently from that place, although it was almost night, and continued our journey, in the rain and the dark, without knowing whither we went, till we came to a gate where cattle were kept, and there we lay the rest of the night upon a little heap of dung; the next morning as soon as it was day we got again into the way which we had left, and not long after we discovered from the top of a little hill a great plain full of trees, and in the midst thereof a very fair House hard by a River, whither forthwith we went, and sat us down by a fountain that was before the outer gate, where we remained two or three hours without seeing any body, at length a young Gentleman about sixteen or seventeen years of age came riding upon a very good Horse, accompanied with four men on foot, whereof one carried two Hares, and another five Nivatores, which are Fowls resembling our Pheasants, with a Gos-Hawk on his fist, and three or four couple of Spaniels at their heels; when this Gentleman came at us he stayed his Horse, to ask us who we were, and whether we would have any thing with him. Hereunto we answered as well as we could, and made him an ample Relation of the whole event of our shipwreck, whereat he seemed to be very sorry, as we could gather by his countenance, so that ere he went, Stay there, said he unto us, for by and by I will send you what you have need of, and that for his sake that with a glory of great riches lives reigning in the highest of all the Heavens. A little after he sent an old woman for us, which was apparelled in a long garment, with a Chaplet hanging down on her neck, the good Dame coming to us, The son of him said she, whom me hold for Master in this house, and whose Rice we ea●, hath sent for you, follow me then with all humlity, to the end you may not seem idle fellows to those that shall see you, and such as beg only to be exempted from getting your living by the labour of your hands; This said, we entered with her into an outward court, all about environed with Galleries, as if it had been some Cloister of Religious persons, on the walls whereof were painted divers women on Horseback going on hunting with Hawks on their fists; over the gate of this Court was a great arch very richly engraven, in the midst whereof hung a Scutcheon of Arms, in the fashion of a shield, fastened to a silver chai●, within it was a man painted almost in the form of a Tortoise, with the feet up, and the head downwards, and round about it these words were read for a device, Ingualec finguau, potim aquarau, that is to say, So is it with all that appertains to me; We learned afterwards, that by this Monster the Figure of the world was represented, which the Chineses depaint in this manner to demonstrate that there is nothing in it but falsehood, and so to dis-abuse all them that make such account of it by making them to see how all things in it are turned upside down. Out of this Court we went up a broad pair of stairs, made of fair hewed stone, and entered into a great Hall, where a woman of about fifty years of age, was set upon a Tapestry Carpet, having two young Gentlewomen by her side, that were exceeding fair, and richly apparelled, with chains of Pearl about their necks, and hard by them was a reverend old man laid upon a little bed, whom one of the two Gentlewomen fanned with a V●ntiloe; at his Bed's head stood the young Gentleman that had sent for us, and a little further off upon another Carpet nine young maids, clothed in Crimson and white Damask, sat sowing; as soon as we came before the old man we fell on our knees, and asked an alms of him, beginning our speech with tears, and in the best terms that the time and our necessities could inspire us with, whereupon the old Lady beckoning to us with her hand, Come, weep no more, said she, for it grieves me much to see you shed so many tears, it is sufficient that I know you desire an alms of us; then the old man that lay in the bed spoke unto us, and demanded whether any of us knew what was good for a Fever? Whereat the young Gentlewoman that fanned him, not able to forbear smiling: Sir, said she, they have more need that you would be pleased to give order for the satisfying of their hunger, then to be questioned about a matter which it is likely they are ignorant of, wherefore me thinks it were better first to give them what they want, and afterwards to talk with them about that which concerns them less; For these words the Mother reprehending her, Go to, said she, you will ever be prating when you should not, but surely I shall make you leave this custom; whereunto the daughter smiling, replied, That you shall when you please, but in the mean time I beseech you, let these poor strangers have something to eat: For all this the old man would not give over questioning us, for he demanded of us who we were, of what country, and whither we were going, besides many other such like things? To which we answered as occasion required, and recounted unto him, how, wh●n, and in what place we had suffered shipwreck, as also how many of our company were drowned, and that thus wand'ring we traveled up and down not knowing whither to address ourselves. This answer rendered the old man pensive for a while, until at length turning him to his son, Well now, said he unto him, what thinkest thou of that which thou hast heard these strangers deliver? It were good for thee to imprint it well in thy memory, to the end it may teach thee to know God better, and give him thanks for that he hath given thee a Father, who to exempt thee from the labours and necessities of this life hath parted with three of the goodliest things in this Country, whereof the least is worth above a hundred thousand Taeis, and bestowed them on thee, but thou art of a humour more inclined to hunt a Hare, then to retain this which I now tell thee; The young Gentleman made no reply, but smiling looked upon his Sisters. Then the old man caused meat to be brought unto us before him, and commanded us to fall to it, as we most willingly did, whereat he took great pleasure, in regard his stomach was quite gone with his sickness, but his young daughters much more, who with their brother did nothing but laugh to see us feed ourselves with our hands, for that is contrary to the custom which is observed throughout the whole Empire of China, where the Inhabitants at their meat carry it to their mouths with two little sticks made like a pair of Cizers; After we had given God thanks, the old man that had well observed us, lifting up his hands to heaven, with tears in his eyes, Lord, said he, that livest reigning in the tranquillity of thy high wisdom, I laud thee in all humility for that thou permittest men that are strangers, come from the farthest end of the world, and without the knowledge of thy doctrine, to render thee thanks, and give thee praise according to their weak capacity, which makes me believe that thou wilt accept of them with as good a will, as if it were some great offering of melodious music agreeable to thine ears. Then he caused three pieces of linen cloth, and four Taeis of Silver to be given us, willing us withal to pass that night in his house, because it was somewhat too late for us to proceed on our journey; This offer we most gladly accepted, and with compliments, after the manner of the Country we testified our thankfulness to him, wherewith himself, his wife, and his son rested very well satisfied. CHAP. XXVII. Our arrival at the Town of Taypor, where we were made Prisoners, and so sent to the City of Nanquin. THe next morning by break of day parting from that place, we went to a Village called Einginilau▪ which was some four leagues from the old Gentleman's house, §. 1 where we remained three days, and then continuing travelling from one place to another, and from Village to Village, ever declining the great Towns, for fear lest the Justice of the country should call us in question in regard we were strangers; in this manner we spent almost two months without receiving the least damage from any body. Now there is no doubt but we might easily have got to the C●tie of Nanquin in that time if we had had a guide, but for w●nt of knowing the way we wandered we knew not whither, suffering much, and running many hazards; At length we arrived at a Village, named Chaucer, at such a time as they were a solemnising a sumptuous Funeral of a very rich woman, that had disinherited her kindred, and left her estate to the Pagod of this Village, where she was buried, as we understood by the Inhabitants; We were invited then to this Funeral, as other poor people were, and according to the custom of the Country we did eat on the grave of the deceased: At the end of three days that we stayed there, which was the time ●he funeral lasted, we had six Taeis given us for an Alms, conditionally that in all our Orisons we should pray unto God for the soul of the departed. Being gone from this place we continued on our journey to another Village, called Guinapalir, from whence we were almost two months travelling from country to country, until at last our ill fortune brought us to a Town, named Taypor, where by chance there was at that time a Chumbrin, that is to say, one of those Superintendents of Justice, that every three years are sent throughout the Provinces for to make report unto the King of all that passeth there: This naughty man seeing us go begging from door to door called to us from a window where he was, and would know of us who we were, and of what Nation, as also what obliged us to run up and down the World in that manner? Having asked us these questions in the presence of three Registers, and of many other persons, that were gathered together to behold us, we answered him, that we were strangers, Natives of the Kingdom of Siam, who being cast away by a storm at Sea went thus travelling and begging our living, to the end we might sustain ourselves with the charity of good people, until such time as we could arrive at Nanquin, whither we were going with an intent to embark ourselves there in some of the Merchants Lanteaas for Canton, where the shipping of our Nation lay. This answer we made unto the Chumbim, who questionless had been well enough contented with it, and would have let us go, had it been for one of his Clarks, for he told them that we were idle vagabonds, that spent our time in begging from door to door, and abusing the alms that were given us, and therefore he was at no hand to let us go free, for fear of incurring the punishment, ordained for such as offend in that sort, as is set forth in the seventh of the twelve books of the Statutes of the Realm; wherefore as his faithful servant he counselled him to lay us in good and sure hold, that we might be forthcoming to answer the Law: The Chumbim presently followed his Clarks advice, and carried himself toward us with as much barbarous cruelty, as could be expected from a Pagan, such as he was, that lived without God or religion; To which effect after he had heard a number of false witnesses, who charged us with many foul crimes, whereof we never so much as dreamt, he caused us to be put into a deep dungeon, with irons on our hands and feet, and great iron collars about our necks; In this miserable place we endured such hunger, and were so fearfully whipped, that we were in perpetual pain for six and twenty days together, at the end whereof we were by the sentence of the same Chumbim sent to the Parliament of the Cheam of Nanquin, because the Jurisdiction of this extended not to the condemnation of any prisoner to death. §. 2 We remained six and twenty days in that cruel prison, whereof I spoke before, and I vow we thought we had been six and twenty thousand years there, in regard of the great misery we suffered in it, which was such, as one of our companions called joano Roderiguez Bravo, died in our arms, being eaten up with louse, we being no way able to help him, and it was almost a miracle that the rest of us escaped alive from that filthy vermin; At length, one morning, when we thought of nothing less, laden with irons as we were, and so weak that we could hardly speak, we were drawn out of that prison, and then being chained one to another, we were embarked with many others, to the number of thirty or forty, that having been convicted for sundry heinous crimes, were also sent to the Parliament of Nanquin, wh●●e, as I have already declared, is always residing a Chaem of Justice, which is like to the Sovereign Title of the Viceroy of China: There is likewise a Parliament of some five and twenty Gerozemos and Ferucuas, which are as those we call Judges with us, and that determine all causes, as well civil as criminal: So as there is no appeal from their sentence, unless it be unto another Court, which hath power even over the King himself, whereunto if one appeals, it is as if he appealed to heaven: To understand this the better, you must know that although this Parliament, and others such like, which are in the principal Cities of the Realm, have an absolute power from the King, both over all criminal & civil causes, without any opposition or appeal whatsoever, yet there is another Court of Justice, which is called the Court of the Creator of all things, whereunto it is permitted to appeal in weighty and important matters: In this Court are ordinarily assisting four & twenty Menigrepos, which are certain religious men, very austere in their manner of living, such as the Capuchins are amongst the Papists, & verily if they were Christians, one might hope for great matters from them in regard of their marvellous abstinence, & sincerity: There are none admitted into this rank of Judges under seventy years of age, & are elected thereunto by the suffrages of their chiefest Prelates, most incorruptible men, & so just in all the causes, whereof there are appeals before them, as it is not possible to meet with more upright, for were it against the King himself, andagainst all the powers that may be imagined in the world, no consideration, how great soever, is able to make them swerve never so little from that they think to be justice. Having been embarked in the manner I spoke of, the same day at night we went & lay at a great tower, called Potinleu, in one of the prisons whereof were maimed nine days, by reason of the much rain that fell then upon the conjunction of the New-moon: There we happened to meet with a Russian prisoner, that received as very charitably, of whom demanding in the Chinese tongue, which he understood as well as we, what countryman he was, and what fortune had brought him thither; he told us, that he was of Moscovy, born in a town, named Hiquegens, and that some five years past, being accused for the death of a man, he had been condemned to a perpetual prison, but as a stranger he appealed from that sentence to the tribunal of the Aytau of Batampina, in the City of Pequin, who was the highest of the two and thirty Admirals, established in this Empire, that is, for every Kingdom one: He added further, that this Admiral by a particular Jurisdiction, had absolute power over all strangers, whereupon he hoped to find some relief from him, intending to go and die a Christian among the Christians, if he might have the good hap to be set at liberty. After we had passed those nine days in this prison, being reinbarqued, we sailed up a great river seven days together, at the end whereof we arrived at Nanquin. As this City is the second of all the Empire, so is it also the Capital of the three Kingdoms of Liampoo, Fanius, and Sambor: Here we lay six weeks in prison, and suffered so much pain and misery, as reduced to the last extremities, we died incensibly for want of succour, not able to do any thing, but look up to heaven with a pitiful eye; for it was our ill fortune to have all that we had stolen from us the first night we came thither: This prison was so great, that there were four thousand prisoners in it at that time, as we were credibly informed, so that one should hardly ●it down in any place without being robbed, and filled ●ull of louse▪ having lain there a month and an half, as I said, the Anchacy, who was one of the Judges before whom our cause was to be pleaded, pronounced our sentence at the Suit of the Attorney General, the tenor whereof was, That having seen and considered our process, which the Chumbin of Taypor had sent him, it appeared by the accusations laid to outcharge, that we were very heinous malefactor's, & though we denied many things, yet in justice no credit was to be given unto us, & therefore that we were to be publicly whipped, for to teach us to live better in time to come, and that withal our two thumbs should be cut off, wherewith it was evident by manifest suspicions, that we used to commit robberies, and other vile crimes; & furthermore, that for the remainder of the punishment we deserved, he referred us to the Aytau of Bataupina, unto whom it appertained to take cognisance of such causes, in regard of the Jurisdiction that he had of life and death. This Sentence was pronounced in the prison, where it had been better for us to have suffered death, than the stripes that we received, for all the ground round about us ran with blood upon our whipping, so that it was almost a miracle, that of the eleven which we were, nine escaped alive, for two of our company died three days after, besides one of our servants. After we had been whipped in that manner, I have declared, §. 3. we were carried into a great Chamber, that was in the prison, where were a number of sick, and diseased persons, lying upon beds, and otherways; There we had presently our stripes washed, and things applied unto them, whereby we were somewhat eased of our pain, and that by men, much like unto the fraternity of mercy among the Papists, which only out of charity, and for the honour of God, do tend those that are sick, and liberally furnish them with all things necessary. Hereafter some eleven or twelve days, we began to be prettily recovered, and as we were lamenting our ill fortune, for being so rigorously condemned to lose our thumbs, it pleased God one morning, when as we little dreamt ofit, that we espied two men come into the chamber, of a good aspect, clothed in long gowns of violet coloured satin, & carrying white rods in their hands; As soon as they arrived, all the sick persons in the Chamber cried out, Blessed be the Ministers of the works ofGod: whereunto they answered, holding up their rods, May it please God to give you patience in your adversity: whereupon having distributed clothes and money to those that were next to them, they came unto us, and after they had saluted us very courteously, with demonstration of being moved at our tears, they asked us who we were, and of what country, as also why we were imprisoned there: whereunto we answered weeping, that we were strangers, natives of the Kingdom of Siam, and of a country called Malaca, that being Merchants and well to live, we had embarked ourselves with our goods, and being bound for Liampoo, we had been cast away just against the Isles of Lamau, having lost all that we had, and nothing left us but our miserable bodies in the case they now saw us; moreover we added, that being thus evil entreated by fortune, arriving at the City of Taypor, the Chumbin of Justice had caused us to be apprehended without any cause, laying to our charge, that we were thiefs and vagabonds, who to avoid painstaking went begging from door to door, entertaining our idle laziness with the alms that were given us unjusty, whereof the Chumbin having made informations at his pleasure, as being both Judge and party, he had laid us in irons in the prison, where for two and forty days space, we had endured incredible pain and hunger, and no man would hear us in our justifications, as well because we had not wherewithal to give presents for to maintain our right, as for that we wanted the language of the Country. In conclusion, we told them, how in the mean time, without any cognisance of the cause, we had been condemned to be whipped, as also to have our thumbs cut off, like thiefs, so that we had already suffered the first punishment, with so much rigour and cruelty, that the marks thereof remained but two visibly upon our wretched bodies, and therefore we conjured them by the charge they had to serve God in assisting the afflicted, that they would not abandon us in this need, the rather for that our extreme poverty rendered as odious to all the world, and exposed us to the enduring of all affronts. These two men having heard us attentively, remained very pensive and amazed at our speech; at length lifting up their eyes, all bathed with tears, to heaven, and kneeling down on the ground, O almighty Lord, said they, that governest in the highest places, and whose patience is incomprehensible, be thou evermore blessed, for that thou art pleased to hearken unto the complaints of necessitous and miserable men, to the end that the great offences committed against thy divine goodness by the Ministers of justice may not rest unpunished, as we hope that by thy holy Law they will be chastised at one time or other. Whereupon they informed themselves more amply by those who were about us, of what we had told them, and presently sending for the Register, in whose hands our sentence was, they straight commanded him, that upon pain of grievous punishment he should forthwith bring them all the proceedings which had been used against us, as instantly he did; now the two Officers, seeing there was no remedy for the whipping that we had suffered, presented a Petition in our behalf unto the Chaem, whereunto this Answer was returned by the Court; Mercy hath no place, where justice looseth her name, in regard whereof your request cannot be granted. This Answer was subscribed by the Chaem, and eight Conchaces, that are like criminal Judges. This hard proceeding much astonished these two Proctors for the poor, so named from their office, wherefore carried with an extreme desire to draw us out of this misery, they presently preferred another Petition to the Sovereign Court of Justice, of which I spoke in the precedent Chapter, where the Menigr●pos and Talegrepos were Judges, an Assembly which in their language is called, The breath of the Creator of all things. In this Petition, as sinners, confessing all that we were accused of, we had recourse to mercy, which sorted well for us; for as soon as the Petition was presented unto them, they read the Process quite through, and finding that our right was overborne for want of succour, they instantly dispatched away two of their Court, who with an express Mandate under their hands and Seals, went and prohibited the Chaems Court from intermeddling with this cause, which they commanded away before them. In obedience to this Prohibition the Chaems Court made this Decree, We, that are assembled in this Court of justice of the Lion crowned in the throne of the world, having perused the Petition presented to the four and twenty judges of the austere life, do consent, that those nine strangers be sent by way of appeal to the Court of the Aytau of Aytaus in the City of Pequin, to the end that in mercy the sentence pronounced against them may be favourably moderated: Given the seventh day of the fourth Moon, in the three and twentieth year of the reign of the Son of the Sun. This Decree, being signed by the Chaem, and the eight Conchaces, was presently brought us by the two Proctors for the poor, upon the Receipt whereof we told them, that we could but pray unto God to reward them for the good they had done us for his sake; whereunto beholding us with an eye of pity, they answered, May his Celestial goodness direct you in the knowledge of his works, that thereby you may with patience gather the fruit of your labours, as they which fear to offend his holy Name. §. 4. After we had past all the adversities and miseries, whereof I have spoken before, we were embarked in the company of some other thirty or forty Prisoners, that were sent, as we were, from this Court of Justice to that other Sovereign one by way of appeal, there to be either acquitted or condemned, according to the crimes they had committed, and the punishment they had deserved. Now a day before our departure, being embarked in a Lanteaa, and chained three and three together, the two Proctors for the poor came to us, and first of all furnishing us with all things needful, as clothes, and Victuals, they asked us whether we wanted any thing else for our Voyage? Whereunto we answered, that all we could desire of them was, that they would be pleased to convert that further good they intended to us into a Letter of Recommendation unto ●he Officers of that holy Fraternity of the City of Pequin, thereby to oblige them to maintain the right of our cause, in regard (as they very well knew) they should otherwise be sure to be utterly abandoned of every one, by re●son they were strangers and altogether unknown. The Proctors hearing us speak in this manner: Say, not so, replied they, for though your ignorance discharges you before God, yet have you committed a great sin, because the more you are abased in the world through poverty, the more shall you be exalted before the eyes of his divine Majesty, if you patiently bear your crosses, whereunto the flesh indeed doth always oppose itself, being evermore rebellious against the Spirit, but as a Bird cannot fly without her wings, no more can the soul meditate without works: As for the Letter you require of us, we will give it you most willingly, knowing it will be very necessary for you, to the end that the favour of good people be not wanting to you in your need. This said they g●ve us a sack full of Rice, together with four Taeis in silver, and a Coverlet to lay upon us; Then having very much recommended us unto the Chifuu, who was the Officer of justice that conducted us, they took their leaves of us in most courteous manner; The next morning as soon as it was day they sent us the Letter, sealed with three Seals in green Wax, the Contents whereof were these; Ye servants of that high Lord, the resplendent mirror of an uncreated light, before whom our merits are nothing in comparison of his, we the least servants of that holy house of Tauhina●el, that was founded in favour of the fifth prison of Nanquin, with true words of respect, which we owe unto you, we give your most humble persons to understand, that these nine strangers, the bearers of this Letter, are men of a far country, whose bodies and goods have been so cruelly entreated by the fury of the sea, that according to their report, of ninety and five that they were, they only have escaped shipwreck, being cast by the tempest on the shore of the Isles of Taut●a, upon the coast of the Bay of Sumbor: In which piteous and lamentable case, as we have seen them with our own eyes, begging their living from place to place of such, as charity obliged to give them something after the manner of good folks, it was their ill fortune without all reason or justice to be apprehended by the Chumbin of Taypor, and sent to this fifth prison of Faniau, where they were condemned to be whipped, which was immediately executed upon them by the Ministers of the displeased arm, as by their Process better appeareth: But afterwards, when as through too much cruelty their thumbs were to be cut off, they with tears besought us, for that Sovereign Lords sake, in whose service we are employed, to be assisting unto them, which presently undertaken by us we preferred a Petition in their behalf, whereunto this Answer was made by the Court of the crowned Lion, That mercy had no place where justice lost her name; whereupon provoked by a true zeal to God's honour, we addressed ourselves to the Court of those four and twenty of the austere life, who carried by a blessed devotion instantly assembled in the Holy House of the remedy for the poor, and of an extreme desire they had to succour these miserable creatures, they interdicted that great Court from proceeding any further against them, and accordingly the success was agreeable to the mercy of so great a God, for these last judges revoking the others first Sentence, sent the cause by way of Appeal to your City of Pequin with amendment of the second punishment, as you may see more at large by the proceedings; In regard whereof, most reverend and humble Brethren, We beseech you all in the Name of God to be favourable unto them, and to assist them with whatsoever you shall think necessary for them, that they may not be oppressed in their right which is a very great sin, and an eternal infamy to us, who again entreat you to supply them with your Alms, and bestow on them means to cover their nakedness, to the end they may not perish for want of help, which if you do there is no doubt but that so pious a work will be most acceptable to that Lord above, to whom the poor of the earth do continually pray, and are heard in the Highest of Heavens, as we hold for an Article of Faith; On which earth may it please that divine Majesty, for whose sake we do this, to preserve us till death, and to render us worthy of his presence in the house of the Sun, where he i● seated with all his. Written in the Chamber of the zeal of God's honour, the ninth day of the seventh Moon, and the three and twentieth year of the Reign of the Lion crowned in the Throne of the World. CHAP. XXVIII. The Marvels of the City of Nanquin, our departure from thence towards Pequin, and that which happened unto us, till we arrived at the Town of Sempitay. THis Letter being brought to us very early the next morning, §. 1. we departed in the manner before declared, and continued our voyoge till Sunset, when as we anchored at a little Village, named Minhacutem, where the Chifuu, that conducted us▪ was born, and where his Wife and Children were at that time, which was the occasion that he remained there three days, at the end whereof he embarked himself with his family, and so we passed on in the company of divers other Vessels, that went upon this River unto divers parts of this Empire: Now though we were all tied together to the bank of the Lauteaa, where we rowed, yet did we not for all that lose the view of many Towns and Villages that were situated along this River, whereof I hold it not amiss to make some descriptions; To which effect, I will begin with the City of Nanquin from whence we last parted; This City is under the North in nine and thirty degrees, and three quarters, situated upon the river of Batampina, which signifies, The flower of fish. This river, as we were told then, and as I have seen since, comes from Tartary, out of a lake, called Fanistor, nine leagues from the City of Lancama, where Tamberlan, King of the Tartarians usually kept his Court; Out of the same lake, which is eight and twenty leagues long, twelve broad, and of a mighty depth, the greatest rivers, that ever I saw, take their source; The first is the same Batampina, that passing through the midst of this Empire of China three hundred and threescore leagues in length, disimb●ques into the sea at the bay of Nanquin in thirty six degrees; The second, named Lechuna, runs with great swiftness all along by the mountains of Pancruum, which separate the Country of Cauchim, and the State of Catebenan, in the height of sixteen degrees; The third is called Tauquida, signifying the Mother of waters, that going Northwest, traverseth the Kingdom of Nacataas, a Country where China was anciently seated, as I will declare hereafter, and enters into the sea in the Empire of Sornau, vulgarly styled Siam, by the mouth of Guy, one hundred and thirty leagues below Patana; The fourth, named Batobasoy, descends out of the Province of Sansim, which is the very same that was quite overwhelmed by the sea in the year 1556. as I purpose to show elsewhere, and renders it sel● into the sea at the mouth of Cosmim, in the Kingdom of Pegu; The fifth and last, called Leysacotay, crosseth the Country by East as far as to the Archipelago of Xinxipou, that borders upon Mocovye, and falls, as is thought, into a sea that is not navigable, by rea●on the climate there is in the height of seventy degrees. Now to return to my discourse, the City of Nanquin, as I said before, is seated by this river of Batampina, upon a reasonable high hill, so as it commands all the plains about it; The climate thereof is somewhat cold, but very healthy, and it is eight leagues about, which way soever it is considered, three leagues broad, and one long; The houses in it are not above two stories high, and all built of wood, only those of the Mandarins are made of hewed stone, and also environed with walls and ditches, over which are stone bridges, whereon they pass to the gates, that have rich and costly arches, with divers sorts of inventions upon the towers, all which put together, make a pleasing object to the eye, and represent a certain kind of I know not what Majesty. The houses of the Chaems, Anchacies, Ayta●s, Tutor's, and Chumbims, which are all Governors of Provinces or Kingdoms, have stately towers, six or seven stories high, and guilt all ●ver, wherein they have their magazines for arms, their Wardrobes, their treasuries, and a world of rich householdstuff, as also many other things of great value, together with an infinite of delicate and most fine porcelain, which amongst them is prised and esteemed as much as precious stone, for this sort of porcelain never goes out of the Kingdom, it being expressly forbidden by the laws of the Country, to be sold, upon pain of death to any stranger, unless to the Xatamaas, that is, the Sophies of the Persians, who by a particular permission buy of it at a very dear rate. The Chineses assured us, that in this City there are eight hundred thousand fires, fourscore thousand Mandarins houses, threescore and two great market places, an hundred and thirty butcher's shambles, each of them containing fourscore shops, and eight thousand streets, whereof six hundred that are fairer and larger than the rest, are compassed about with balisters of copper; we were further assured, that there are likewise two thousand and three hundred Pagodes, a thousand of which were Monasteries of religious persons, professed in their accursed Sect, whose buildings were exceeding rich and sumptuous, with very high steeples, wherein there were between sixty and seventy such mighty huge bells, that it was a dreadful thing to hear them rung; There are moreover in this City thirty great strong prisons, each whereof hath three or four thousand prisoners; and a charitable Hospital, expressly established to supply the necessities of the poor, with Proctors ordained for their defence, both in civil and criminal causes, as is before related; At the entrance into every principal street, there are arches and great gates, which for each man's security, are shut every night, and in most of the streets are goodly fountains whose water is excellent to drink; Besides, at every full ●nd new moon, open fayrs are kept in several places, whither Merchants resort from all parts, and where there is such abundance of all kind of victual, as cannot well be expressed, especially of fl●sh and fruit; It is not possible to deliver the great store of fish that is taken in this river, chiefly Soles and Mullets, which are all sold alive, besides a world of sea-fish, both fresh, salted, and dried; we were told by certain Chineses, that in this City there are ten thousand trades for the working of silks, which from thence are sent all over the Kingdom; The City itself is environed with a very strong wall, made of fair hewed stone; The gates of it are an hundred and thirty, at each of which there is a Porter, and two Halberdiers, who are bound to give an account every day of all that p●sses in and out; There are also twelve Forts or Citadels, like unto ours, with bulwarks and very high towers, but without any ordinance at all▪ The same Chineses also affirmed unto us, that the City yielded the King daily two thousand Taeis of silver, which amount to three thousand ducats, as I have delivered heretofore; I will not speak of the Palace royal, because I saw it but on the outside, howbeit the Chines●s tell such wonders of it, as would amaze a man, for it is my intent to relate nothing save what we beheld here with our own eyes, and that was so much as I am afraid to write it, not that it would seem strange to those that have seen and read the marvels of the Kingdom of China, but because I doubt, that they, which would compare those wondrous things that are in the countries, they have not seen with that little they have seen in their own will make some question of it, or it may be give no credit at all to these truth, because they are not conformable to their understanding, and small experience. Continuing our course up this river, §. 2. the first two days we saw not any remarkable town or place, but only a great number of Villages, and little hamlets of two or three hundred fires a piece, which by their buildings seemed to be houses of fisher men, and poor people, that live by the labour of their hands; For the rest, all that was within view in the country, was great woods of Fir, Groves, Forests, and Orange trees, as also plains full of wheat, rice, beans, pease, millet, panic, barley, rye, flax, cotton wool, with great enclosures of gardens, and goodly houses of pleasure, belonging to the Mandarins, and Lords of the Kingdom: There was likewise all along the river such an infinite number of cattle of all sorts, as I can assure you there is not more in Aethiopia, nor in all the dominions of Prester john; upon the top of the mountains many houses of their Sects of Gentiles were to be seen, adorned with high Steeples guilt all over, the glistering whereof was such, and so great, that to behold them a far off was an admirable sight: The fourth day of our voyage we arrived at a town, called Pocasser, twice as big as Cantano, compassed about with strong walls of hewed stone, and towers and bulwarks almost like ours, together with a key on the river side, twice as long as the shot of a falconet, and enclosed with two rows of iron grates, with very strong gates, where the Junks and vessels that arrived there were unladen; This place abounds with all kinds of merchandise, which from thence is transported over all the Kingdom, especially with copper, sugar, and alum, whereof there is very great store; Here also in the midst of a carrefour, that is almost at the end of the town, stands a mighty strong castle, having three bulwarks and five towers, in the highest of which the present King's Father, as the Chineses told us, kept a King of Tartary nine years' prisoner, at the end whereof he killed himself with poison, that his subjects sent him, because they would not be constrained to pay that ransom, which the King of China demanded for his deliverance: In this town the Chifuu gave three of us leave to go up and down for to crave the alms of good people, accompanied with four Hupes, that are as Sergeants, or Bailiffs amongst us, who led us, chained together, as we were, through six or seven streets, where we got in alms to the value of above twent● ducats, as well in clothes, as money, besides flesh, ricer meal, fruit, and other victuals, which was bestowed on us, whereof we gave the one half to the Hupes that conducted us, it being the custom so to do. Afterwards we were brought to a Pagode, whither the people flocked from all parts that day, in regard of a very solemn feast that was then celebrated there: This Temple, or Pagode, as we were told▪ had sometime been a Palace royal, where the King then reigning was born, now because the Queen his Mother died there in childbirth, she commanded herself to be buried in the very same chamber where she was brought to bed, wherefore to honour her death the better, this Temple was dedicated to the invocation of Tauhinaret, which is one of the principal Sects of the Pagans in the Kingdom of China, as I will more amply declare, when as I shall speak of the Labyrinth of the two and thirty laws that are in it; All the buildings of this Temple, together with all the gardens, and walks, that belong to it, are suspended in the air upon three hundred and threescore pillars, every one of the which is of one entire stone of a very great bigness; These three hundred and threescore pillars, are called by the names of three hundred and threescore days of the year, and in each of them is a particular feast kept there with many alms, gifts, and bloody sacaifices, accompanied with music, dancing, and other sports; Under this Pagode, namely between those pillars, are eight very fair streets, enclosed on every side with grates of copper, and gates for the passage of pilgrims, and others, that run continually to this feast, as it were to a Jubilee; The Chamber above, where the Queen lay, was made in the form of a Chapel, but round, and from the top to the bottom all garnished with silver, the workmanship whereof was of greater cost than the matter itself; In the midst of it stood a kind of Tribunal, framed round, like the Chamber, some fifteen steps high, compassed about with six gra●es of silver, on the top whereof was a great bowl, and upon that a Lion of silver, that with his head supported a shrine of gold, three hand-bredths square, wherein they said, the bones of the Queen were, which these blinded ignorants reverenced as a great relic; Below this Tribunal in equal proportion were four bars of silver, that traversed the Chamber, whereon hung three and forty lamps of the same metal, in memory of the three and forty years that this Queen lived, and seven lamps of gold in commamoration of seven sons that she had; moreover at the entry into the Chapel, just against the door, were eight other bars of iron, whereon also hung a very great number of silver lamps, which the Chineses told us were offered by some of the Wives of the Chaems, Aytaos, Tutoens, and Anchacies, who were assistant at the death of the Queen, so that in aknowledgment of that honour they sent those lamps thither afterwards; without the gates of the Temple, and round about six balisters of copper that environed it, were a great many Statues of Giants, fifteen foot high, cast in brass, all well proportioned with halberds or clubs in their hands, and some of them with battleaxes on their shoulders, which made so brave and majestical a show, as one could never be satisfied enough with looking on them; Amongst these Statues, which were in number twelve hundred, as the Chineses affirmed, there were four and twenty very great Serpents also of brass, and under every one of them a woman seated, with a sword in her hand, and a silver crown on her head; It was said, that those four and twenty women carried the Titles of Queens, because they sacrificed themselves to the death of this Queen, to the end their souls might serve hers in the other life, as in this their bodies had served her body, a matter which the Chineses, that draw their extraction from these women, hold for a very great honour, insomuch as they enrich the crests of their coats of arms with it; round about this row of Giants was another of triumphant arches, guilt all over, whereon a number of silver bells hung by chains of the same metal, which moved with the air kept such a continual ringing, as one could hardly hear one another for the noise they made; Without these arches there were likewise at the same distance two rows of copper grates, that enclosed all this huge work, and among them certain pillars of the same metal, which supported Lions rampant, mounted upon bowls, being the arms of the Kings of China, as I have related elsewhere. At each corner of the Carrefour was a monster of brass, of so strange and unmeasurable an height, and so deformed to behold, as it is not possible almost for a man to imagine, so that I think it best not to speak of them, the rather for that I confess I am not able in words to express the form wherein I saw their prodigies; Howbeit as it is reasonable to conceal these things without giving some knowledge of them, I will say, as much as my weak understanding is able to deliver. One of these Monsters which is on the right hand, as one comes into the Carrefour, whom the Chineses call, the Sergeant Gluttom of the hollow or profound house of smoke, and that by their histories is held to be Lucifer, is represented under the figure of a Serpent of an excessive height, with most hideous and deformed adders coming out of his stomach, covered all over with green and black scares, and a number of prickles on their backs above a span long, like unto Porcupins quills; each of these Adders had a woman between his jaws, with her hair all dishevelled, and standing an end, as one affrighted; The monster carried also in his mouth, which was unmeasurable great, a Vizard that was above thirty foot long, and as big as a tun, with his nostrils & chaps so full of blood, that all the rest of his body was besmeared with it, this Vizard held a great Elephant between his paws, and seemed to gripe him so hard, as his very guts came out of his throat, and all this was done so proportionably, and to the life, that it made a man tremble to behold such a deformed figure, and which was scarce possible for one to imagine: His tail might be some twenty fathom long, was entortilled about such another Monster, that was the second of the four, whereof I spoke, in the figure of a man, being an hundred foot high, and by the Chineses called Turcamparoo, who they say was the son of that Serpent; besides that he was very ugly, he stood with both his hands in his mouth, that was as big as a great gate, with a row of horrible teeth, and a foul black tongue, hanging out two fathom long, most dreadful to behold: As for the other two Monsters, one was in the form of a woman, named by the Chinese, Magdelgau, seventeen fathom high, and six thick; This same about the girdlesteed before had a face made proportionable to her body, above two fathom broad, and she breathed out of her mouth and nostrils great ●●akes, not of artificial, but true fire, which proceeded, as they told us, from her head, where fire was continually kept, that in like manner came out of the said face below. By this Figure these Idolaters would demonstrate that she was the Queen of the fiery sphere, which according to their belief is to burn the earth at the end of the World. The fourth Monster was a man, set stooping, which with great swollen cheeks, as big as the main sail of a Ship, seemed to blow extremely; this Monster was also of an unmeasurable height, an● of such an hideous and ghastly aspect, that a man could hardly endure the sight of it; the Chineses called it Vzanguenaboo, and said, that it was he which raised Tempests upon the Sea, and demolished Buildings, in regard whereof the people offered many things unto him, to the end he should do them no harm, and many presented him with a piece of money yearly, that he might not drown their Junks, nor do any of theirs hurt that went by Sea; I will omit many other abuses which their blindness makes them believe, and which they hold to be so true, as there is not one of them but would endure a thousand deaths for the maintenance thereof. The next day being gone from the Town of Pocasser we arrived at another fair and great Town, called Xinligau; there we saw many Buildings enclosed with walls of Brick, §. 3. and deep ditches about them, and at one end of the Town two Castles, very well fortified with Towers and Bulwarks after our fashion; at the gates were draw Bridges, suspended in the air with great Iron chains, and in the midst of them a Tower five Stories high, very curiously painted with several Pictures; the Chinese assured us, that in those two Castles there was as much Treasure, as amounted to fifteen thousand pieces of silver, which was the revenue of all this Archipelage, and laid up in this place by the King's Grandfather now reigning, in Memorial of a Son of his that was born here, and named Leuquinau, that is to say, The joy of all; those of the Country repute him for a Saint, because he ended his days in Religion, where also he was buried in a Temple, dedicated to Quiay Varatel, the God of all the Fishes of the Sea, of whom these miserable Ignorants recount a world of Fooleries, as also the Laws he invented, and the precepts which he left them, being able to astonish a man, as I will more amply declare when time shall serve. In this Town and in another five leagues higher the most part of the Silks of this Kingdom are died, because they hold that the waters of these places make the colours far more lively than those of any other part, and these Dyers, which are said to be thirteen thousand, pay unto the King yearly three hundred thousand Taeis. Continuing our course up the River the day after about evening we arrived at certain great plains, where were great store of Cattles, as Horses, Mares, Colts, and Cows, guarded by men on Horseback, that make sale of them to Butchers, who afterwards retail them indifferently as any other flesh: Having past these plains containing some ten or eleven Leagues, we came to a Town called junquileu, walled with Brick, but without Battlements, Bulwarks, or Towers, as others had, whereof I have spoken before; at the end of the Suburbs of this Town we saw divers houses built in the water upon great Piles, in the form of Magazines; Before the gate of a little street stood a Tomb made of stone, environed with an Iron grate, painted red and green, and over it a steeple framed of pieces of very fine Porcelain, sustained by four pillars of curious stone; upon the top of the Tomb were five Globes, and two others that seemed to be of cast iron, and on the one side thereof were graven in Letters of gold, and in the Chinese language, words of this substance. Here lies Trannocem Mudeliar, Uncle to the King of Malaca, whom death took out of the World before he could be revenged of Captain Alphonso Albuquerque, the Lion of the robberies of the Sea. We were much amazed to behold this Inscription there, wherefore enquiring what it might mean, a Chinese, that seemed more honourable than the rest, told us; that about some forty years before, this man which lay buried there, came thither as Ambassador from a Prince, that styled himself King of Malaca, to demand succour from the son of the Sun against men of a Country, that hath no name, which came by Sea from the end of the World, and had taken Malaca from him; this man recounted many other incredible things concerning this matter, whereof mention is made in a printed Book thereof, as also that this Ambassador having continued three years at the King's Court suing for this succour, just as it was granted him, and that preparations for it were a making, it was his ill fortune to be surprised one night at Supper with an Apoplexy, whereof he died at the end of nine days, so that extremely afflicted to see himself carried away by a sudden death before he had accomplished his business, he expressed his earnest desire of revenge by the Inscription which he caused to be graven on his tomb, that posterity might know wherefore he was come thither. Afterwards we departed from this place, and continued our voyage up the river, which thereabouts is not so large as towards the City of Nanquin, but the Country is here better peopled with Villages, Boroughs, and Gardens, than any other place, for every stones cast we met still with some Pagode, Mansion of pleasure, or Country house; Passing on about some two leagues further, we arrived at a place encompassed with great iron gates, in the midst whereof stood two mighty Statues of brass upright, sustained by pillars of cast metal of the bigness of a bushel, and seven fathom high, the one of a man, and the other of a woman, both of them seventy four spans in height, having their hands in their mouths, their cheeks horribly blown out, and their eyes so staring, as they affrighted all that looked on them. That which represented a man, was called Quiay Xingatalor, and the other in the form of a woman, was named Apancapatur; Having demanded of the Chinese the explication of these figures, they told us that the male was he, which with those mighty swollen cheeks blew the fire of hell for to torment all those miserable wretches, that would not liberally bestow alms in this life; and for the other monster, that she was Porter of hell gate, where she would take notice of those that did her good in this world, and letting them fly away into a river of very cold water, called Ochilenday, would keep them hid there from being tormented by the Devils, as other damned were: Upon this Speech one of our company could not forbear laughing at such a ridiculous and diabolical foolery, which three of their Priests, or Banzoes', then present observing, they were so exceedingly offended therewith, as they persuaded the Chifuu, which conducted us, that if he did not chastise us in such manner, as those gods might be well contented with the punishment inflicted on us for our mockery of them, both the one and the other would assuredly torment his soul, and never suffer it to go out of hell; which threatening so mightily terrified this dog, the Chifuu, that without further delay, or hearing us speak, he caused us all to be bound hand and foot, and commanded each of us to have an hundred lashes given him with a double cord, which was immediately executed with so much rigour, as we were all in a gore blood, whereby we were taught not to jeer afterwards at any thing we saw, or heard. At such time as we arrived here we found twelve Bonzoes' upon the place, who with silver censors full of perfumes of aloes and benjamin, censed those two devilish Monsters, and chanted out aloud, Help us, even as we serve thee; whereunto divers other Priests answered in the name of the Idol with a great noise, So I promise to do like a good Lord: In this sort they went as it were in procession round about the place, singing with an ill tuned voice to the sound of a great many bells, that were in Steeples thereabouts; In the mean time there were others, that with Drums and Basins made such a din, as I may truly say, put them all together, was most horrible to hear. CHAP. XXIX. Our Arrival at Sempitay, our encounter there with a Christian woman, together with the Original and Foundation of the Empire of China; and who they were that first peopled it. FRom this place we continued our voyage eleven days more up the river, which in those parts is so peopled with Cities, Towns, Villages, Boroughs, Forts and Castles, that commonly they are not a flight shot distant one from another, besides a world of houses of pleasure, and temples, where Steeples were all guilt, which made such a glorious show, as we were much amazed at it; In this manner we arrived at a Town, named Sempitay, where we abode five days, by reason the Chifuus wife, that conducted us, was not well: Here by his permission we landed, and chained together, as we were, we went up and down the streets craving of alms, which was very liberally given us by the Inhabitants, who wondering to see such men as we, demanded of us what kind of people we were, of what Kingdom, and how our country was called? Hereunto we answered conformably to that we had often said before, namely that we were natives of the Kingdom of of Siam, that going from Liampoo to Nanquin, we had lost all our goods by shipwreck, and that although they beheld us then in so poor a case, yet we had been formerly very rich; whereupon a woman who was come thither amongst the rest to see us; It is very likely, said she, speaking to them about her, that what these poor strangers have related is most true, for daily experience doth show how those that trade by sea, do oftentimes make it their grave, wherefore it is best and surest to travel upon the earth, and to esteem of it, as of that, whereof it hath pleased God to frame us; saying, so she gave us two mazes, which amounts to about sixteen pence of our money, advising us to make no more such long voyages, since our lives were so short: Hereupon she unbuttoned one of the sleeves of a red Satin Gown she had on, and bearing her left arm, she showed us a cross imprinted on it, like to the mark of a slave, saying, Do any of you know this sign, which amongst those, that follow the way of truth, is called a cross? or have any of you ever heard it named? To this falling down on our knees, we answered, with tears in our eyes, that we know exceeding well; Then lifting up her hands, she cried out, Our Father, which art in heaven, hallowed be thy Name, speaking these words in the Portugal tongue, and because she could speak no more of our language, she very earnestly desired us in Chinese to tell her whether we were Christians; we replied that we were, and for proof thereof, after we had kissed that arm, whereon the cross was, we repeated all the rest of the Lords prayer, which she had left unsaid, wherewith being assured that we were Christians indeed, she drew aside from the rest there present, and weeping said to us; Come along Christians of the other end of the world, with her that is your true Sister in the faith of Jesus Christ, or peradventure a kinswoman to one of you, by his side that begot me in this miserable exile, and so going to carry us to her house, the Hupes which guarded us, would not suffer her, saying, that if we would not continue our craving of alms, as the Chifuu had permitted us, they would return us back to the ship; but this they spoke in regard of their own interest, for that they were to have the moiety of what was given us, as I have before declared, and accordingly they made as though they would have lead us thither again, which the woman perceiving, I understand your meaning, said she, and indeed it is but reason you make the best of your places, for thereby you live, so opening her purse, she gave them two Taeis in silver, wherewith they were very well satisfied; whereupon with the leave of the Chifuu, she carried us home to her house, and there kept us all the while we remained in that place, making exceeding much of us, and using us very charitably; Here she showed us an Oratory, wherein she had a cross of wood guilt, as also candlesticks, and a lamp of silver: Furthermore she told us, that she was named, Inez de Leyria, and her Father Tom Pirez, who had been great Ambassador from Portugal to the King of China, and that in regard of an insurrection with a Portugal Captain, made at Canton, the Chineses taking him for a Spy, & not for an Ambassodor, as he termed himself, clapped him and all his followers up in prison, where by order of Justice five of them were put to torture, receiving so many, and such cruel stripes on their bodies, as they died instantly, and that the rest were all banished into several parts, together with her father into this place, where he married with her mother, that had some means, and how he made her a Christian, living so seven and twenty years together, and converting many Gentiles to the faith of Christ, whereof there were above three hundred then abiding in that Town; which every Sunday assembled in her house to say the Catechism: whereupon demanding of her what were their accustomed prayers, she answered, that she used no other but these, which on their knees, with their eyes and hands lift up to heaven, they pronounced in this manner, O Lord jesus Christ, as it is most true that thou art the very Son of God, conceived by the Holy Ghost in the womb of the Virgin Mary for the salvation of sinners, so thou wilt be pleased to forgive us our offence that thereby we may become worthy to behold thy face in the glory of thy Kingdom, where thou art sitting at the right hand of the Almighty. Our Father which art in heaven, hallowed be thy Name. In the Name of the Father, the Son, and the Holy Ghost, Amen. And so all of them kissing the Cross, embraced one another, and thereupon returned every one to his own home. Moreover she told us, that her Father had left her many other prayers, which the Chineses had stolen from her, so that she had none left but those before recited; whereunto we replied, that those we had heard from her were very good, but before we went away we would leave her divers other good and wholesome prayers; do so then, answered she, for the respect you owe to so good a God, as yours is, and that hath done such things for you, for me, and for all in general: Then causing the cloth to be laid, she gave us a very good and plentiful dinner, and treated us in like sort every meal, during the five days we continued in her house, which as I said before, was permitted by the Chifuu in regard of a present that this good woman sent his wife, whom she earnestly entreated so to deal with her husband, as we might be well entreated, for that we were men of whom God had a particular care, as the Chifuus wife promised her to do with many thanks to her for the present she had received; In the mean space, during the five days we remained in her House, we read the Catechism seven times to the Christians, wherewithal they were very much edified, beside, Christophoro Borhalho made them a little Book in the Chinese tongue, containing the Pater Noster, the Creed, the Ten Commandments, and many other good Prayers. After these things we to●k our leaves of Inez de Leyria, and the Christians who gave us fifty Taeis in Silver, which stood us since in good stead, ●s I shall declare hereafter, and withal Inez de Leyria gave us secretly fifty Taeis more, humbly desiring us to remember her in our Prayers to God. §. 2. After our departure from the Town of Sempitay we continued our course upon the River of Bataupina, unto a place, named Lequinpau, containing about eleven or twelve thousand fires, and very well built, at least we judged so by that we could discern, as also enclosed with good Walls, and Curtains round about it: Not far from it was an exceeding long House; having within it thirty Furnaces on each side, where a great quantity of Silver was melted, which was brought in carts from a Mountain, some five leagues off, called Tuxenguim: The Chineses assured us, that above a thousand men wrought continually in that Mine to draw out the Silver, and that the King of China had in yearly Revenue out of it about five thousand Picos; This place we left about Sunset, and the next day in the evening we arrived just between two little Towns, that stood opposite one to another, the River only between, the one named Pacau, and the other Nacau, which although they were little, yet were they fairly buil●, and well walled with great hewed stone, having a number of Temples, which they call Pagods, all guilt over, and enriched with Steeples and Fanes of great price, very pleasing and agreeable to the eye. Now in regard of that they recounted unto us here of these two Towns, I hold it not amiss to discourse it in this place, the rather for that I have heard it confirmed since, and that thereby one may come to know the Original and Foundation of this Empire of China, whereof ancient Writers have spoken little ●ill this present. It is written in the first Chronicle, of fourscore which have been made of the Kings of China, the thirteenth Chapter, as I have heard it many times delivered, That six hundred thirty and nine years, after the Deluge there was a Country called then Guantipocau, which as may be judged by the height of the Climate where it is situated, being in sixty two degrees to the Northward, abutts on the backside of our Germany; In this Country lived at that time a Prince, named Turbano, whose state was not very great: It is said of him, that being a youth he had three children by a Woman, called Nancaa whom he extremely affected, although the Queen his Mother then a Widow, was exceedingly displeased at it. This King being much importuned by the principal Persons of his Kingdom to marry, always excused himself alleging some Reasons for it, which they did not well allow of, but incited by his Mother, they pressed him so far, that at length they perceived he had no intent to condescend unto them, for indeed his mind was to legitimate the eldest Son he had by Nancaa, and to resign his Kingdom unto him; to which effect he not long after put himself into Religion in a Temple named Gison, which seems to have been the Idol of a certain Sect that the Rom●●s had in their time, and that is still at this present in the Kingdoms of China▪ jappon, Cauchenchina, Cambaya, and Siam, whereof I have seen many Pagods in those Countries: But first having declared his said ●on King, the Queen his Mother would by no means approve of it, saying, That since the King her Son would needs profess himself into that Religion, and leave the Kingdom without a lawful Heir, she would labour to remedy so great a disorder, as indeed she did by instantly marrying herself, being fifty years of age, to a Priest of hers, called Silau, that was but six and twenty, whom she proclaimed King, notwithstanding all opposition made to the contrary; whereof Turbano being presently advertised, and knowing that his Mother had done it of purpose to defeat his Son of the Crown, he got him forthwith out of his Religion for to repossess himself of it, and to that end used all the means and diligence he could, whereupon the Queen Mother, and Silau, fearing that which might follow thereof to both their destructions, if he were not in time, and that speedily prevented, they secretly assembled some of their partakers, to the number of thirty Horse, and fourscore Foot, who going one night where Turbano was, slew him, and all his Company; Howbeit Nancaa saved herself, with her three Sons, and accompanied with certain of her Domestical Servants, she embarked herself in a small Lanteaa, and fled away down the River to a place some seventy leagues from thence, where she landed with those few followers she had: There assisted with some others that resorted unto her, she fortified herself in a little Island, that was in the midst of the River, and which she named Pilaunere, that signifies, The retreat of the poor, with an intent there to end the rest of her days; now having lived five years in that poor and miserable estate, the Tyrant Silan, whom the People hated, doubting lest the three young Princes coming to age might expel him o●t of what he had injustly usurped upon them, or at leastwise disturb him with Wars, by reason of the right they pretended to the Kingdom, he sent a Fleet of thirty Iengas, wherein, as it is said, were sixteen hundred men, for to seek them out, and destroy them, whereof Nancaa receiving intelligence fell to consult what she should do, and at length resolved by no means to attend these Forces, in regard her Sons were but Infants, herself a weak Woman, her Men few in number, and unprovided of all that was necessary to make any defence against so great a number of Enemies, and so well furnished; whereupon taking a view of her People she found that they were but thirteen hundred in all, and of them only five hundred Men, the rest being Women and Children, for all which company there were but three little Lanteaas, and one jangaa, in the whole River, and they not able to carry an hundred persons; so that Nancaa seeing no means to transport them away, the History saith, She assembled all her People, and declaring the fear she was in, desired them to advise her what she should do; but excusing themselves, they ingenuously confessed, they knew not what counsel to give her in that extremity: Whereupon, according to their ancient custom, they resolved to cast Lots, to the end that on whom the Lot did fall to speak, he should freely deliver what God would be pleased to inspire him with; For which purpose they took three days time, wherein with fasting, cries, and tears, they would all with one voice crav● the favour and assistance of the Lord Almighty, in whose hands was all the hope of their deliverance; This advice being approved of all in general, Nancaa made it to be proclaimed, that upon pain of Death no person whatever should eat above once during those three days, to the end that by this abstinence of the Body, the Spirit might be carried with the greater attention towards God. The three days abstinence being expired, Lots were cast five times one after another, Sect. 3. and all those five times the Lot fell still on a little Boy of seven years of age, named, as the Tyrant was, Silau, whereat they were all exceedingly amazed, in regard that in the whole Troop there was not another of this same name: After that they had made their Sacrifices with all the accustomed Ceremonies of Music, Perfumes, and sweet Odours, to render thanks unto God, they commanded the little Boy to lift up his hands unto Heaven, and then to say what he thought was necessary for the remedying of so great an Affliction, as that wherein they were; Whereupon the little Boy, Silau, beholding Nancaa, the History affirms he said these words; O feeble and wretched Woman, now that sorrow and affliction makes thee more troubled and perplexed then ever thou wert, in regard of the small relief that humane understanding doth represent unto thee, submit thyself with humble sighs to the omnipotent hand of the Lord, Esloign then, or at leastwise labour to esloign, thy mind from the vanities of the Earth, lifting up thine eyes with Faith and Hope, and thou shalt see what the Prayers of an Innocent, afflicted and pursued before the justice of him that hath created thee, can do; For assoon as in all humility thou hast declared the weakness of thy power unto the Almighty, Victory will incontinently be given thee from above over the Tyrant Silau; wherefore I command thee in his Name to embark thyself, thy Children, and all thy Followers in thine Enemy's Vessels, wherein amidst the confused murmur of the Waters thou shalt wander so long, till thou arrivest at a placew here thou art to lay the Foundation of a House of that Reputation, as the Mercy of the most High shall be published there from Generation to Generation by the Voice of a strange People, whose Cries shall be as pleasing to him, as those of sucking Children that lie in the Cradle. This said, the little Boy, according to the History, fell down stark dead to the ground, which much astonished Nancaa, and all hers; The said History further delivers, and as I have often heard it read, that five days after the success the thirty jangaas were one morning seen coming down the River in very good equipage, but not so much as one man in them; the reason hereof, by the report of the History, which the Chineses hold to be most true, was, that all these Ships of War being joined together for to execute unmercifully upon Nancaa and her Children the cruel and damnable intentions of the Tyrant Silau, one night as this Fleet road at Anchor in a place, called Catebasoy, a huge dark Cloud came over them, whereout issued such horrible Thunder and Lightning, accompanied with mighty Rain, the Drops whereof were so hot, that falling upon them which were asleep in the Vessels, it made them leap into the River, so as within less, than an hour they perished all; And it is said that one drop of this Rain coming to fall upon a body it burned in such sort, as it penetrated to the very marrow of the bone with most insupportable pain, no clothes, nor arms, being able to resist it. Nancaa receiving this favour from the hand of the Lord, with abundance of tears and humble thanks, embarked herself, her children, and all her company, in the said thirty jangaas, and sailing down the River was carried by the strength of the current, which for her sake, the History saith, redoubled then, in seven and forty days to the very place where now the City of Pequin is built; There she, and all hers landed, and doubting lest the Tyrant Silau, whose cruelty she feared, might still pursue her, she fortified herself in this place the best she could. CHAP. XXX. The Foundation of the four chief Cities of China; together with which of the Kings of China it was that built the Wall between China and Tartary; and many things that we saw as we passed along. Sect. 1. THe said History delivers, that few days after the poor Nancaa, and her followers, were settled on shore, she caused them to swear fealty unto her eldest Son, and to acknowledge him for their lawful Prince; Now the very same day that he received the Oath o● Allegiance from these few Subjects of his, he made election of the place where the Fortress should be erected, together with the enclosure of the Wall; Afterwards, assoon as the first Foundations were laid, which was speedily done, he went out of his Tent, accompanied with his Mother, who governed all, together with his Brothers, and the chiefest of his company, attired in festival Robes, with a great stone carried before him by the noblest Personages, which he had caused to be wrought aforehand; and arriving at the said Foundations he laid his hand upon the Stone, and on his knees, with his eyes lifted up to Heaven, he said to all that were present, Brethren, and worthy Friends, know that I give mine own Name, that is, Pequin, to this Stone, upon which this new place is to be built, for I desire, that hereafter it should be so called; wherefore I pray you all, as Friends, and command you as your King, not to call it otherwise, to the end the memory thereof may remain immortal to those that shall come after us to the end of the World; By which means it shall be manifested to all men, that the thirteenth day of the eighth Moon, in the year one thousand six hundred thirty and nine, after the Lord of all things created had made those that lived upon the Earth, see how much he abhorred the sins of Men, for the which he drowned the whole World with Water, that he sent down from Heaven, in satisfaction of his divine justice, it shall, I say, be manifested to them, that the new Prince Pequin built this Fortress, whereunto he gave his Name; And so conformable to the Prophecy, which the dead child hath delivered, it shall be published over all, by the voice of strange People, in what manner the Lord is to be feared, and what Sacrifices are to be made, that they may be just and acceptable unto him. Now this was that which King Pequin said unto his Vassals, and which is at this day to be seen engraven on a silver Scutcheon, fastened to an Arch of one of the principal Gates of the City, called Pommicotay, where in memory of this Prophecy, there is ordinarily a Guard of forty Halberdiers, with their Captain, whereas there are but only four in all the rest, who are bound to render an account of all that pass in and out there daily; And because the Histories relate, that this new King laid the first foundation of this City on the 3 d of the month of August, the Kings of China do on that day usually show themselves to the People, and that with such Pomp and Majesty, that I profess I am not able to declare the least part of it, much less to describe the whole. Now in regard of this first King's words, which the Chineses hold for an infallible Prophecy, his Descendants do so fear the accomplishment thereof, that by a Law expressly made by them, the admittance of any Strangers into this Kingdom, saving Ambassadors and Slaves, is forbidden upon most grievous pains; So that when any do chance to arrive there, they banish them presently from one place to another, not permitting them to settle any where, as they practised it towards me, and my eight companions. And thus, as I have succinctly delivered, was this Empire of China founded, and peopled by the means of this Prince, named Pequin, the eldest of Nancaa's three Sons; As for the other two, called Pacan and Nacau, they afterwards founded the other two Towns aforesaid, and withal gave them their own Names. It is also the general opinion, that their Mother Nancaa founded the City of Nanquin, which took its denomination from her, continuing so to this day, and is the second City of this great Monarchy. The Histories further affirm, that from the time of this first Founder, the Empire of China augmented always from one King to another, by a just Succession till a certain Age, which according to our Computation, was in the Year of Lord, one thousand one hundred and thirty; After which a King that then reigned, named Xixipan, enclosed the City of Pequin, within the space of three and twenty years, in such manner as it is seen at this day, and that fourscore and two years after another King, his Grandchild, called jumbileytay, made the like, so that both together were sixty leagues in circuit, namely, each of them thirty, ten in length, and five in breadth: Now it is certain, and I have often times read it, that each of these Enclosures, or Walls, hath a thousand and threescore round Bulwarks, as also two hundred and forty Towers, very fair, strong, large, and high, with gilt Lions upon Globes, being the Arms of the Kings of China, which are very pleasing to the eye. Without the last Enclosure is an exceeding great Ditch round about it, ten fathom deep, and forty broad, continually replenished with many Barks and Boats, covered over head as if they were Houses, where both Provisions, and all sorts of Merchandise are sold. This City, according to the Chineses report, hath above three hundred and threescore Gates, in each of which, as I have before recited, there are always four Halberdiers, who are obliged to render an account of all that go in and out daily: There are also certain Chambers in it, whither it is the custom to bring such Children as wander and go astray, in the Town; to the end their Parents that lose them may be sure to hear of them there. I will refer my speaking more largely of the Magnificences of this goodly City to another place, for that which I have now delivered in haste, and as it were en passant, was but to make a brief Relation of the original of this Empire, and of the first Founder of the City of Pequin, (which may be truly said to be the chiefest of all the World for greatness, policy, riches, and abundance of all things that can be desired of man) as also of the Foundation of the second City of this mighty Kingdom, that is Nanquin, and of the other two. Pacan and Nacan, whereof I have heretofore spoken, and in which the Founders of them are buried in very stately and rich Temples, within Tombs of white and green Alabaster, all garnished with Gold, and erected upon Lions of Silver, with a world of Lamps, and perfuming Pans full of divers sorts of sweet Odours round about them. Now that I have spoken of the Original and Foundation of this Empire, Sect. 2. together with the circuit of the great City of Pequin, I hold it not amiss to entreat as succinctly as I may of another particular, which is no less admirable than those whereof I have made mention before: It is written in the fifth Book of the Situation of all the remarkable places of this Empire, or rather Monarchy, (for to speak truly, there is no appellation so great but may be well attributed unto it) that a King, named Crisnagol Dicotay, who according to the computation of that Book, reigned in the year of our Lord five hundred and eighteen, happened to make war with the Tartar, about some difference between them concerning the State of Xenxinapau, that borders on the Kingdom of Lauhos, and so valiantly demeaned himself in a Battle against him, that he defeated his Army, and remained Master of the Field; whereupon the Tartar confederating himself with other Kings, his Friends, did by their assistance assemble together greater Forces than the former, and therewith invaded the Kingdom of China, where (it is said) he took three and thirty very important Towns, of which the principal was Panquilor, insomuch that the Chinese fearing he should not be well able to defend himself, concluded a Peace with him upon condition to relinquish his right, which he pretended to that in question betwixt them, and to pay him two thousand Picos of Silver for to defray the Charges of those strangers the Tartar had entertained in this War; by this means China continued for a good while quiet, but the King doubting lest the Tartar might in time to come return to annoy him again, resolved to build a Wall, that might serve for a Bulwark to his Empire; and to that end calling all his Estates together, he declared his determination unto them, which was presently not only well approved of, but held most necessary; so that to enable him for the performance of a business so much concerning his state, they gave him ten thousand Picos of Silver, which amount, according to our account, unto fifteen Millions of Gold, after the rate of fifteen hundred Ducats each Pico; and moreover they entertained him two hundred and fifty thousand men to labour in the work, whereof thirty thousand were appointed for Officers, and all the rest for manual services; Order being taken then for whatsoever was thought fit for so prodigious an enterprise, they fell to it in such sort, as by the report of the History all that huge Wall was in seven and twenty years quite finished from one end to the other; which if credit may be given to the same Chronicle is seventy jaos in length, that is six hundred and fifteen miles after nine miles every jao; wherein that which seemed most wonderful and most exceeding the belief of man, was that seven hundred and fifty thousand men laboured incessantly for so long a time in that great work, whereof the Commonalty, as I delivered before, furnished one third part; the Priests, and Isles of Aynen, another third; and the King assisted by the Princes, Lords, Chaems, and Anchacies of the Kingdom, the rest of the building, which I have both seen and measured, being thirty foot in height, and ten foot in breadth, where it is thickest: It is made of Lime and Sand, and plastered on the outside with a kind of Bitumen, which renders it so strong, that no Cannon can demolish it: Instead of Bulwarks it hath Sentries, or Watchtowers, two stages high, flanked with Buttresses of Carpentry made of a certain black wood, which they call Caubesy, that is to say, Wood of Iron, because it is exceeding strong and hard, every Buttress being as thick as an Hogshead, and very high, so that these Sentries are far stronger than if they were made of Lime and Stone. Now this Wall, by them termed Chaufacan, which signifies, Strong resistance, extends in height equal to the Mountains, whereunto it is joined, and that those Mountains also may serve for a Wall they are cut down very smooth and s●eep, which renders them far stronger than the Wall itself; but you must know that in all this extent of land there is no Wall but in the void spaces from Hill to Hill, so that the Hills themselves make up the rest of the Wall and Fence: Further it is to be noted, that in this whole length of an hundred and fifteen leagues, which this Fortification contains, there are are but only 5 Entries whereby the Rivers of Tartary do pass, which are derived from the impetuous Torrents that descend from these Mountains, and running above five hundred leagues in the Country, render themselves into the Seas of China and Cauchenchina; howbeit one of these Rivers, being greater than the rest, disemboques by the Bay of Guy in the Kingdom of Sournau, commonly called Siam. Now in all these five Passages both the King of China, and the King of Tartary, keep Garrisons; the Chinese in each of them entertains seven thousand men giving them great pay, whereof six thousand are Horse, the rest Foot, being for the most part strangers, as Mogores, Pancrus, Champaas, Corosones, Gizares of Persia, and other different Nations, bordering upon this Empire, and which in consideration of the extraordinary pay they receive, serve the Chineses; who (to speak truth) are nothing courageous, as being but little used to the Wars, and ill provided of Arms and Artillery. In all this length of Wall there are three hundred and twenty Companies, each of them containing five hundred Soldiers; so that there are in all one hundred and threescore thousand men, besides Officers of Justice, Anchacis, Chaems, and other such like persons necessary for the Government, and entertainment of these Forces; so that all joined together make up the number of two hundred thousand, which are all maintained at the King's only charge, by reason the most of them are Malefactors condemned to the reparations and labour of the Wall, as I shall more amply declare when I come to speak of the Prison destined to this purpose, in the City of Pequin, which is also another Edifice, very remarkable, wherein there are continually above thirty thousand Prisoners, the most of them from eighteen to forty five years of age, appointed to work in this Wall. Being departed from those two Towns Pacau and Nacau, we continued our course up the River, Sect. 2. and arrived at another Town, called Mindoo, somewhat bigger than those from whence we parted, where about half a mile off was a great Lake of Salt-water, and a number of Salt-houses round about it; The Chinese assured us, that this Lake did ebb and flow like the Sea, and that it extended above two hundred leagues into the Country, rendering the King of China in yearly Revenue one hundred thousand Taeis, only for the third of the Salt that was drawn out of it; as also that the Town yielded him other one hundred thousand Taeis for the Silk alone that was made there, not speaking at all of the Camphire, Sugar, Porcelain, Vermilion, and Quicksilver, whereof there was very great plenty; moreover, that some two leagues from this Town were twelve exceeding long Houses, like unto Magazines, where a world of people laboured in casting and purifying of Copper, and the horrible din which the Hammers made there was such, and so strange, as if there were any thing on earth that could represent Hell this was it; wherefore being desirous to understand the cause of this extraordinary noise, we would needs go to see from whence it proceeded; and we found that there were in each of these Houses forty Fornaces, that is twenty of either side, with forty huge Anvils, upon every of which eight men beat in order, and so swiftly, as a man's eye could hardly discern the blows, so as three hundred and twenty men wrought in each of these twelve Houses, which in all the twelve Houses made up three thousand eight hundred and forty workmen, beside a great number of other persons that laboured in other particular things; whereupon we demanded how much Copper might be wrought every year in each of these Houses, and they told us, one hundred and ten, or sixscore thousand Picos, whereof the King had two thirds, because the Mines were his, and that the Mountain from whence it was drawn was called Corotum baga, which signifies a River of Copper, for that from the time since it was discovered, being above two hundred years, it never failed, but rather more and more was found. Having passed about a league beyond those twelve Ho●ses up the River, we came to a place enclosed with three ranks of Iron grates, where we beheld thirty Houses, divined into five rows, six in each row, which were very long and complete, with great Towers full of Bells of cast mettle, and much carved work, as also guilt Pillars, and the Frontispieces of fair hewed stone, whereupon many Inventious were engraved: At this place we went ashore by the Chif●us permission, that carried us, for that he had made a Vow to this Pagod, which was called Bigay potim, that is to say, God of an hundred and ten thousand Gods, Corchoo fungané ginaco ginaca, which according to their report signifies, strong and great above all others, for one of the Errors wherewith these wretched people are blinded is, that they believe every particular thing hath its God, who hath created it, and preserves its natural being, but th●t this Bigay potim brought them all forth from under his armpits, and that from him as a father, they derive their being, by a filial union, which they term Bi●● Porentasay; And in the Kingdom of Pegu, where I have often been, I have seen one like unto this, named by those of the country Ginocoginans, the God of all greatness, which Temple was in times past built by the Chinese, when as they commanded in the Indias, being according to their supputation from the year of our Lord jesus Christ 1013. to the year 1072. by which account it appears that the Indias were under the Empire of China but only fifty and nine years, for the successor of him that conquered it, called Exiragano, voluntarily abandoned it in regard of the great expense of money and blood that the unprofitable keeping of it cost him: In those thirty Houses, whereof I formerly spoke, were a great number of Idols of guilt Wood▪ and a like number of Tin, L●tten, and Porcelain, being indeed so many, as I should hardly be believed to declare them. Now we had not passed above five or six leagues from this place but we came to a great Town, about a league in circuit, quite destroyed and ruinated, so that ask the Chineses what might be the cause thereof, they told us, that this Town was anciently called Cohilouza, that is, The flower of the field, and had in former times been in very great prosperity, and that about one hundred forty and two years before, a certain stranger, in the company of some Merchants of the Port of Tanaçarim in the Kingdom of Siam, chanced to come thither, being as it seems an holy man, although the Bonzes said he was a Sorcerer, by reason of the wonders he did, having raised up five dead men, and wrought many other Miracles, whereat all men were exceedingly astonished; and that having divers times disputed with the Priests he had so shamed and confounded them, as fearing to deal any more with him, they incensed the Inhabitants against him, and persuaded them to put him to death, affirming that otherwise God would consume them with fire from Heaven, whereupon all the Townsmen went unto the House of a poor Weaver, where he lodged, and killing the Weaver, with his son and two sons in Law of his, that would have defended him, the Holy man came forth to them, and reprehending them for this uproar, he told them amongst other things, That the God of the Law, whereby they were to be saved was called jesus Christ, who came down from heaven to the earth for to become a man, and that it was needful he should die for men, and that with the price of his precious blood, which he shed for sinners upn the Cross, God was satisfied in his justice, and that giving him the charge of Heaven▪ and Earth, he had promised him, that whosoever professed his Law with Faith and good works should be saved, and have everlasting life; and withal, that the gods whom the Bonzes served and adored with sacrifices of blood, were false, and Idols, wherewith the Devil deceived them; Here at the Churchmen entered into so great fury, that they called unto the people saying, Cursed be he that brings not wood and fire for to burn him, which was presently put in execution by them, and the fire beginning exceedingly to rage the Holy man said certain Prayers, by virtue whereof the fire incontinently went out, wherewith the people being amazed cried out, saying, Doubtless the God of this man is most mighty, and worthy to be adored throughout the whole World, which one of the Bonzes hearing, who was ringleader of this mutiny, and seeing the Town-men retire away in consideration of that they had beheld, he threw a stone at the holy man, saying, They which do not as I do, may the Serpent of the night ingulf them into hell fire. At these words all the other Bonzes did the like, so that he was presently knocked down dead with the stones they fl●ng at him, whereupon they cast him into the river, which most prodigiously stayed its course from running down, and so continued for the space of five days together that the body lay in it; By means of this wonder many embraced the law of that holy man, whereof there are a great number yet remaining in that country: Whilst the Chineses were relating thishistory unto us, we arrived at a point of land, where going to double Cape, we descried a little place environed with trees, in the midst whereof was a great cross of stone very well made, which we no sooner espied, but transported with exceeding joy, we fell on our knees before our Conductor, humbly desiring him to give us leave to go on shore, but this Heathen dog refused us, saying, that they had a great way yet to the place where they were to lodge, whereat we were mightily grieved; Howbeit God of his mercy, even miraculously so ordered it, that being gone about a league further, his wife fell in labour, so as he was constrained to return to that place again, it being a Village of thirty or forty houses, hard by where the Cross stood: Here we went on land, and placed his wife in an house, where some nine days after she died in Childbed, during which time we went to the Cross, and prostrating ourselves before it with tears in our eyes; The people of the Village beholding us in this posture, came to us, and kneeling down also, with their hands lift up to heaven, they said, Christo jesu, jesu Christo, Maria micauvidau late impont model, which in our tongue signifies, jesus Christ, jesus Christ, Mary always a Virgin conceived him, a Virgin brought him forth, and a Virgin still remained; whereunto we weeping answered, that they spoke the very truth; Then they asked us if we were Christians, we told them we were, which as soon as they understood they carried us home to their houses, where they entertained us with great affection; Now all these were Christians, and descended of the Weaver, in whose house the holy man was lodged, of whom demanding whether that which the Chineses had told us was true; they showed us a book that contained the whole history thereof at large, with many other wonders wrought by that holy man, who they said was named Matthew Escandel, and that he was an Hermit of Mount Sinai, being an Hungarian by nation, and born in a place called Buda: The same book also related that nine days after this Saint was buried, the said Town of Cohilouzaa, where he was murdered, began to tremble in such sort, as all the people thereof in a mighty fright, ran out into the fields, and there continued in their tents, not daring to return unto their houses, for they cried out all with one common consent, The blood of this stranger craves vengeance for the unjust death the Bonzes hath given him, because he preached the truth unto us; But the Bonzes rebuked and told them, that they committed a great sin in saying so, Nevertheless, they willed them to be of good cheer, for they would go all to Quiay Tiguarem, God of the night, and request him to command the earth to be quiet, otherwise we would offer him no more sacrifices: Immediately whereupon all the Bonzes went accordingly in procession to the said Idol, which was the chiefest in the Town, but none of the people durst follow them, for fear of some earthquake, which the very next night, about eleven of the clock, as those devilish monsters were making their sacrifices, with odoriferous perfumes, and other ceremonies, accustomed amongst them, increased so terribly, that by the Lord's permission, and for a just punishment of their wickedness, it quite overthrew all the Temples, houses, and other edifices of the Town to the ground, wherewith all the Bonzes were killed, not so much as one escaped alive, being in number above four thousand, as the book delivereth, wherein it is further said, that afterwards the earth opening such abundance of water came forth, as it clean overwhelmed and drowned the whole Town, so that it became a great lake, and above an hundred fathom deep; moreover they recounted many other very strange particulars unto us, and also however since that time the place was named Fiunganorsee, that is, the chastisement of heaven, whereas before it was called Cohilouzaa, which signifies, §. 4. the flower of the field, as I have declared heretofore. After our Departure from the ruins of Fiunganorsee, we arrived at a great Town, called junquinilau, which is very rich, abounding with all kind of things, fortified with a strong Garrison of Horse and Foot, and having a number of Junks and Vessels riding before it: Here we remained five days to celebrate the Funeral of our Chifuus wife; for whose soul he gave us by way of alms both meat and clothes, and withal freeing us from the oar, permitted us to go ashore without irons, which was a very great ease unto us. Having le●t this place, we continued our course up the river, beholding still on either side a world of goodly great Towns environed with strong walls, as also many Fortresses and Castles all along the waters side; we saw likewise a great number of Temples, whose Steeples were all guilt, and in the fields such abundance of cattle that the ground was even covered over with them, so far as we could well discern: Moreover there were so many vessels upon this river, especially in some parts, where Fairs were kept, that at first sight one would have thought them to be populous Towns, besides other lesser companies of three hundred, five hundred, six hundred, and a thousand boats, which continually we met withal on both sides of the river, wherein all things that one could imagine were sold; Moreover the Chineses assured us, that in this Empire of China, the number of those which levied upon the rivers, was not less, than those that dwelled in the Towns, and that without the good order which is observed to make the common people work, and to constrain the meaner sort to supply themselves unto trades, for to get their living, they would eat up one another. Now it is to be noted, that every kind of traffic and commerce is divided among them into three or four forms, as followeth: They which trade in Ducks, whereof there are great quantities in this Country, proceed therein diversely; some cause their eggs to be hatched for to sell the Ducklings, others fat them when they are great for to sell them dead after they are salted; These traffic only with the eggs, others with the feathers, and some with the heads, feet, gizards, and entrails, no man being permitted to trench upon his companions sale, under the penalty of thirty lashes, which no privilege can exempt them from: In the same manner, concerning hogs, some sell them alive, and by whole sale, others dead, and by retail, some make bacon of them, others sell their pigs, and some again sell nothing but the chitterlings, the sweetbreads, the blood, and the haslets; which is also observed for fish, for such a one sells it fresh, that cannot sell it either salted or dried, and so of other Provisions, as flesh, fruit, fowls, venison, pulse, and other things, wherein such rigour is used, as there are chambers expressly established, whose officers have commission and power to see, that they which trade in one particular may not do it in another, if it be not for just and lawful couses, and that on pain of thirty lashes. There be others likewise that get their living by selling fish alive, which to that purpose they keep in great well-boats, and so carry them into divers countries, where they know there is no other but salt fish. There are likewise all along this river of Batampina, whereon we went from Nanquin to Pequin, which is distant one from the other one hundred and fourscore leagues, such a number of engines for sugar, and presses for wine and oil, made of divers sorts of pulse and fruit, as one could hardly ●ee any other thing on either side of the water. In many other places also there were an infinite company of Houses, and Magazines full of all kinds of provision, that one could imagine, where all sorts of flesh are salted, dried, smoked, and piled up in great high heaps, as gammons of Bacon, Pork, Lard, Geese, Ducks, Cranes, Bustards, Ostriches, Stags, Cows, Buffles, wild Goats, Rhinoceroses, Horses, Tigers, Dogs, Foxes, and almost all other creatures that one can name, so that we said many times amongst ourselves, that it was not possible for all the people of the world to eat up all those provisions. We saw likewise upon the same river, a number of Vessels, which they call Panouras, covered from the poup to the prow with nets, in manner of a cage, three inches high, full of ducks and geese, that were carried from place to place to be sold; when the Owners of those boats would have these fowl to feed, they approach to the Land, and where there are rich meadows, or marshes, they set forth Planks, penning the doors of those cages, they beat three or four times upon a Drum, which they have expressly for that purpose, whereupon all these fowl, being six or seven thousand at the least, go out of the boat with a mighty noise, & so fall to feeding all along the waters side; Now when the Owner perceives, that these fowl have ●ed sufficiently, and that it is time to return them, he beats the drum the second time, at the sound whereof they gather all together, and re-enter with the same noise, as they went out, wherein it is strange to observe, that they return all in again, not so much as one missing. That done, the Master of the boat parts from that place, and afterwards when he thinks it is time for them to lay, he repairs towards land, and where he finds the grounds dry, and good grass, he opens the doors, and beats the drum again, at which all the fowl of the boat come forth to lay, and then at such time as the Master judges that these fowl have laid, he beats his drum afresh, and suddenly in haste they all throng in to the boat, not so much as one remaining hehind; Thereupon two or three men get ashore, with baskets in their hands, whereinto they gather up the eggs, till they have gotten eleven or twelve baskets full, and so they proceed on their voyage to make sale of their war, which being almost spent, to store themselves anew, they go for to buy more unto them that breed them, whose trade it is to sell them young, for they are not suffered to keep them when they are great, as the others do, by reason, as I have said before, no man may deal in any commodity for which he hath not permission from the Governors of the Towns. They that get their living by breeding of Ducks have near to their Houses certain Ponds, where many times they keep ten or eleven thousand of these duckings, some bigger, some lesser. Now for to hatch the Eggs, they have in very long galleries twenty and thirty furnaces full of dung, wherein they bury two hundred, three hundred, and five hundred Eggs together, then stopping the mouth of each furnace that the dung may become the hotter, they leave the Eggs there till they think the young ones are disclosed, whereupon putting into every several furnace a Capon half pulled, and the skin stripped from off his breast, they leave him shut up therein for the space of two days, at the end whereof being all come out of the shell, they carry them into certain places under ground made for that purpose, setting them bran soaked in liquor, and so being left there loose some ten or eleven days, they go afterwards of themselves into the ponds, where they feed and bring them up for to sell them unto those former Merchants, who trade with them into divers parts, it being unlawful for one to trench upon another's traffic, as I have before related, so that in the Markets and public places, where provisions for the mouth are sold, if any that sell Goose Eggs do chance to be taken seized with Hen's Eggs and it is suspected that they sell of them, they are presently punished with thirty lashes on the bare Buttocks, without hearing any justification they can make for themselves, being as I have said, found seized of them, so that if they will have Hens Eggs for their own use, to avoid incurring the penalty of the Law they must be broken at one end, whereby it may appear that they keep them not to sell, but to eat. As for them that sell Fish alive, if any of their Fish chance to die, they cut them in pieces, and salting them sell them at the price of saltfish, which is less than that of fresh-fish, wherein they proceed so exactly, that no man dares pass the limits, which are prescribed and ordained by the Conchalis of the State, upon pain of most severe punishment, for in all this Country the King is so much respected, and Justice so feared, as no kind of person, how great soever, dares murmur, or look awry at an Officer, no not at the very Huppes, which are as the Bailiffs or Beadles amongst us. CHAP. XXXI. The order which is observed in the moving Towns that are made upon the Rivers, and that which further befell us. §. 1. We saw likewise all along this great River a number of Hogs both wild and domestic, that were kept by certain men on horseback, and many herds of ●ame red Deer, which were driven from place to place like Sheep, to feed, all lamed of their right legs, to hinder them from running away, and they are lamed so, when they are but Calves, to avoid the danger, that otherwise they might incur of their lives: We saw also divers Parks, wherein a world of Dogs were kept to be sold to the Butchers, for in these Countries they eat all manner of Flesh, whereof they know the price, and of what creatur●s they are, by the chopings they make of them; moreover we met with many small Barks, whereof some, were full of Pigs, others of Tortoises, Frogs, Otters, Adders, Eeeles, Snails, and Lizards, for as I have said, they buy there of all that is judged good to eat; now to the end that such provisions may pass at an easier rate, all that sell them are permitted to make traffic of them in several fashions; true it is, that in some things they have greater Franchises, then in others, to the end that by means thereof no Merchandise may want sale: And because the Subject I now treat of dispenses me to speak of all, I will relate that which we further observed there, and whereat we were much abashed, judging thereby how far men suffer themselves to be carried by their Interests, and extreme avarice; you must know then that in this Country there are a many of such as make a trade of buying and selling men's Excrements, which is not so mean a Commerce amongst them, but that there are many of them grow rich by it, and are held in good account; now these Excrements serve to manure grounds that are newly grubbed, which is found to be far better for that purpose then the ordinary dung: They which make a trade of buying it go up and down the streets with certain Clappers, like our spital men, whereby they give to understand what they desire without publishing of it otherwise to people, in regard the thing is filthy of itself; whereunto I will add thus m●ch, that this commodity is so much esteemed amongst them, and so great a trade driven of it, that into one sea port, sometimes there comes in one tide two or three hundred Sails laden with it: Oftentimes also there is such striving for it, as the Governors of the place are fain to interpose their authority for the distribution of this goodly commodity, and all for to manure their grounds, which soiled with it, bears three crops in one year. We saw many boats likewise laden with dried orange pills, wherewith in victualling houses they boil dogs flesh, for to take away the rank savour and humidity of it, as also to reader it more firm: In brief, we saw so many Vaucans', Lanteaas, and Barcasses, in this river, lad●n with all kinds of provision, that either the sea or land produces, and that in such abundance, as I must confess I am not able to express it in words; for it is not possible to imagine the infinite store of things that are in this Country, of each whereof you shall see two or three hundred Vessels together at a time, all full, especially at the Fairs, and Markets, that are kept upon the solemn festival days of their Pagodes, for then all the fairs are free, and the Pagodes for the most part are situated on the banks of rivers, to the end all commodities may the more commodiously be brought thither by water. Now when all these vessels come to join together, during these Fairs, they take such order, as they make as it were a great and fair Town of them, so that sometimes you shall have of them a league in length, and three quarters of a league in breadth, being composed of above twenty thousand vessels, besides Balons, Guedees', and Manchuas, which are small boats, whose number is infinite; For the Government hereof there are threescore Captains appointed, of which thirty are to see good order kept, and the other thirty are for the guard of the Merchants that come thither, to the end they may sail in safety; Moreover there is above them a Chaem, who hath absolute power both in civil, and criminal causes, without any appeal or opposition whatsoever, during the fifteen days, that this Fair lasts, which is from the new to the full Moon; And indeed more come to see the policy, order, and beauty of this kind of Town, than otherwise; for to speak the truth, the framing of it in that manner with vessels, makes it more to be admired then all the Edifices that can be seen upon the land; There are in this moving Town two thousand streets, exc●eding long, & very straight, enclosed on either side with ships, most of which are covered with silks, and adorned with a world of banners, flags, and streamers, wherein all kind of commodities that can be desired, are to be sold; In other streets are as many trades to be seen, as in any Town on the Land, amidst the which they that traffic, go up and down in little Manchuas, and that very quietly, and without any disorder▪ Now if by chance any one is taken stealing, he is instantly punished according to his offence; As soon as it is night, all these streets are shut up with cords athwart them, to the end none may pass after the retreat sounded; In each of these streets there are at least a d●zen of lanterns, with lights burning, fastened a good height on the Masts of the vessels, by means whereof all that go in and out are seen, so that it may be known who they are, from whence they come, and what they would have, to the end the Chaem may the next morning receive an account thereof; And truly to behold all these lights together in the night, is a ●ight scarce able to be imagined, neither is there a street without a Bell, and a Sentinel, so as when that of the Chaems ship is heard to ring, all the other bells answer it, with so great a noise of voices adjoined thereunto, that we were almost besides ourselves, at the hearing of a thing, which cannot be well conceived; and that was ruled with such good order: In every of these streets, even in the poorest of them, there is a Chapel to pray in, framed upon great Barcasses, like to Galleys, very neat, and so well accommodated, that for the most part they are enriched with silks, and cloth of gold; In these Chapels are their Idols, and Priests which administer their sacrifices, and receive the offerings that are made them, wherewith they are abundantly furnished for their living; Out of each street, one of the most account, or chiefest Merchant is chosen to wa●ch all night in his turn with those of his Squadron, besides the Captains of the government, who in Ballons, walk the round without, to the end no thief may escape by any avenue whatsoever, and for that purpose these guards cry as loud as they can that they may be heard. Amongst the most remarkable things, we saw one street, where there were above an hundred vessels, laden with Idols of guilt wood, of divers fashions, which were sold for to be offered to the Pagodes, together with a world of feet, thighs, arms, and heads, that sick folks bought to offer in devotion; There also we beheld other ships, covered with silk hangings, where Comedies, and other plays were represented to entertain the people withal, which in great numbers flocked thither; In other places, Bills of exchange for Heaven were sold, whereby these Priests of the Devil promised them many merits, with great interest, affirming that without these bills they could not possibly be saved, for that God, say they, is a mortal enemy to all such as do not some good to the Pagodes, whereupon they tell them such fables and lies, as these unhappy wretches do often times take the very bread from their mouths to give it them; There were also other vessels all laden with dead men's skulls, which dive●s men bought for to present as an offering, at the tombs of their friends, when they should happen to die; for, say they, as the deceased is laid in the grave in the company of these skulls, so shall his soul enter into Heaven, attended by those unto whom those skulls belonged, wherefore when the Porter of Paradise shall see such a Merchant, with many followers, he will do him honour, as to a man that in this life hath been a man of quality, for if he be poor, and without a train, the Porter will not open to him, whereas contrarily the more dead men's skulls he hath buried with him, the more happy he shall be esteemed; There were many boats likewise, where there were men that had a great many of Cages, full of live birds, who playing on divers instruments of music, exhorted the people with a loud voice, to deliver those poor creatures of God, that were there in captivity, whereupon many came and gave them money for the redemption of those prisoners, which presently they let out of the cages, and then as they flew away, the redeemers of them cried out to the birds, Pichau pitavel catan vacaxi, that is, Go, and tell God, how we serve him here below. In imitation of these, there are others also, who in their ships, kept a great many of little live fishes in great pots of water, and like the sellers of birds invite the people, for God's cause to free those poor innocent fishes, that had never sinned, so that divers bought many of them, and casting them into the river, said, Get ye gone, and tell there below, the good I have done you for God's sake. To conclude all, the vessels where these things are exposed to sale, are seldom less in number then two hundred, besides thousands of others, which sell such like wares in a far greater quantity. We saw likewise many Barcasses full of men and women; that played upon divers sorts of instruments, §. 2 and for money gave them music that desired it; There were other vessels laden with horns, which the Priests sold, therewith to make feasts in Heaven, for they say, that those were the horns of several beasts, which were offered in sacrifice to the Idols out of devotion, and for the performance of vows that men had made in divers kind of misfortunes, and sicknesses, wherein they had at others times been; And that as the flesh of those beasts, had been given here below for the honour of God to the poor, so the souls of them for whom those horns were offered, do in the other world eat the souls of of those beasts to whom those horns belonged, and thereunto invite the souls of their friends, as men use to invite others here on earth; Other vessels we saw covered with blacks, and full of tombs, torches, and great wax lights, as also women in them, that for money would be hired to weep and lament for the dead; others there were, called Pitaleus, that in great barks kept divers kinds of wild beasts to be showed for money, most dreadful to behold as Serpents, huge Adders, monstrous Lizards, Tigers, and many others such like; we saw in like sort a great number of Stationers, which sold all manner of books, that could be desired, as well concerning the creation of the world, whereof they tell a thousand lies, as touching the States, Kingdoms, Islands, and Provinces of the world, together with the Laws and Customs of Nations, but especially of the Kings of China, their number, brave acts, and of all things else that happened in each of their reigns, Moreover we saw a great many of the light, swift Foists, wherein were men very well armed, who cried out with a loud voice, that if any one had received an affront, whereof he desired to be avenged, let him come unto them, and they would cause satisfaction to be made him; In other vessels there were old women, that served for midwives, and that would bring women speedily and easily a bed, as also a many of Nurses, ready to be entertained for to give children suck; There were barks likewise very well adorned, and set ●orth, that had in them divers reverend old men, and grave matrons, whose profession was to make marriages, and to comfort widows, or such as had lost their children, or suffered any other misfortune; In others there were a number of young men and maids, that lacked Masters, and Mistresses, which offered themselves to any that would hire them; There were other vessels that had in them such as undertook to tell fortunes, and to help folks to things lost. In a word, not to dwell any longer upon every particular, that was to be seen in this moving Town, for than I should never have done, it shall suffice me to say, that nothing can be desired on land, which was not to be had in their vessels, and that in greater abundance than I have delivered, wherefore I will pass from it to show you that one of the principal causes why this Monarchy of China, that contains two and thirty Kingdoms, is so mighty, rich, and of so great commerce, is, because it is exceedingly replenished with rivers, and a world of Chanals that have been anciently made by the Kings, great Lords, and people thereof, for to render all the Country navigable, and so communicate their labours with one another: The narrowest of these Chanals have bridges, of hewed stone over them, that are very high, long and broad, whereof some are of one stone, eighty, ninety, nay, an hundred spans long, and fifteen, or twenty broad, which doubtless is very marvellous, for it is almost impossible to comprehend by what means so huge a mass of stone could be drawn out of the Quarry without breaking, and how it should be transported to the place where it was to be set. All the ways and passages, from Cities, Towns, and Villages, have very large causeys made of fair stone, at the ends whereof are costly pillars and arches, upon which are inscriptions with letters of gold, containing the pray sers of them that erected them; moreover there are handsome seats placed all along for poor passengers to rest themselves on: There are likewise innumerable Aqueducks and fountains every where, whose water is most wholesome and excellent to drink; And in divers parts there are certain Wenches of love, that out of charity prostitute themselves to travellers, which have no money, and although amongst us this is held for a great abuse and abomination, yet with them it is accounted a work of mercy, so that many on their deathbeds do by their testaments bequeath great revenues, for the maintenance of this wickedness, as a thing very meritorious for the salvation of their souls; moreover many others have left lands for the erecting and maintaining of houses, in deserts and habited places, where great fires are kept all the night to guide such as have strayed out of their way, as also water for men to drink, and seats to repose them in, and that there may be no default herein, there are divers persons entertained with very good means, to see these things carefully continued, according to the institution of him that founded them for the health of his soul. By these marvels which are found in the particular Towns of this Empire, may be concluded what the greatness thereof might be, were they joined all together; but for the better satisfaction of the Reader, I dare boldly say, if my testimony may be worthy of credit, that in one and twenty years' space, during which time, with a world of misfortune, labour and pain, I traversed the greatest part of Asia▪ as may appear by this my discourse, I had seen in some countries a wonderful abundance of several sorts of victuals, and provisions, which we have not in our Europe, yet without speaking what each of them might have in particular, I do not think there is in all Europe so much as there is in China alone; And the same may be said of all the rest, wherewith Heaven hath favoured this climate, as well for the temperature of the air, as for that which concerns the policy, and riches, the magnificence and greatness of their estate; Now that which gives the greatest lustre unto it, is, their exact observation of justice, for there is so well ruled a Government in this Country, as it may justly be envied of all others in the world; And to speak the truth, such as want this particular, have no gloss, be they otherways never so great & commendable. Verily, so often as I represent unto myself those great things which I have seen in this China, I am on the one side amazed to think how liberally it hath pleased God to heap up on this people, the goods of the earth, & on the other side I am exceedingly grieved to consider how ungrateful they are in acknowledging such extraordinary favours; for they commit amongst themselves an infinite of most enormous sins, wherewithal they incessantly offend the Divine Goodness, as well in their brutish and diabolical Idolatries, as in the abominable sin of Sodomy, which is not only permitted amongst them in public, but is also accounted for a great virtue according to the instructions of their Priests. CHAP. XXXII. Our Arrival at the City of Pequin; together with our imprisonment, and that which moreover happened unto us there; as also the great Majesty of the Officers of their Court of justice.. AFter we were departed from that rare and marvellous Town, whereof I have spoken, §. 1. we continued our course up the river, until at length on Tuesday, the nineteenth of October, in the year 1541. we arrived at the great City of Pequin, whither, as I have said before, we had been remitted by Appeal; In this manner chained three and three together, we were cast into a prison, called Gofaniauserca, where for our welcome we had at the first dash thirty lashes a piece given us, wherewith some of us became very sick: Now as soon as the Chifuu who conducted us thither, had presented the process of our sentence, sealed with twelve seals, to the Justice of the Aytao, which is their Parliament, the twelve Chonchalis of the criminal Chamber, unto whom the cognisance of our cause appertained, commanded us presently away to prison, whereupon one of those twelve, assisted by two Registers, and six or seven officers, whom they term Hupes, and are much like our Catchpoles here, terrified us not a little, as he was leading us thither, for giving us very threatening speeches▪ Come, said he unto us, By the power and authority, which I have from the Aytao of Batampina, chief Precedent of the two and thirty judges of strangers, within whose breast are the secrets of the Lion crowned on the throne of the world enclosed, I enjoin and command you to tell me, what people you are, as also of what country, and whether you have a King, who for the service of God, and for the discharge of his dignity, is inclined to do good to the poor, and to render them justice, to the end that with tears in their eyes, and hands lifted up, they may not address their complaints to that Sovereign Lord, which hath made the bright Enamel of the skies, and for whose holy feet all they that reign with him, serve but for sandals. To this demand we answered him, that we were poor strangers, natives of the Kingdom of Siam, who being embarked with our Merchandise for Liampoo, were cast away in a great storm at sea, from whence we escaped naked with the loss of all that we had, and how in that deplorable estate we were fain to get our living by begging from door to door till such time as at our arrival at the Town of Taypor, the Chumbim, then resident there, had arrested us for prisoners without cause, and so sent us to the City of Nanquin, where by his report we had been condemned to the whip, and to have our thumbs cut off, without so much as once deigning to hear us in our justifications, by reason whereof lifting up our eyes to Heaven, we had been advised to have recourse with our tears to the four and twenty Judges of aust●er life, that through their zeal to God, they might take our cause in hand, since by reason of our poverty we were altogether without support, and abandoned of all men, which with an holy zeal they incontinently effected by revoking the cause, and annulling the judgement that had been given against us, and that these things considered we most instantly besought him, that for the service of God he would be pleased to have regard to our misery, and the great injustice that was done us, for that we had no means in this Country, nor person that would speak one word for us. The Judge remained sometimes in suspense upon that we had said to him, at length he answered, that we need say no more to him, for it is sufficient that I know you are poor, to the end this affair may go another way then hitherto it hath done, neverthertheless to acquit me of my charge, I give you five days time, conformably to the Law of the third Book, that within the said term you may retain a Proctor to undertake your cause, but if you will be advised by me, you shall present your request to the Tanigores of the sacred Office, to the end that they carried by an holy zeal of the honour of God, may out of compassion of your miseries, take upon them to defend your right. Having spoken thus, he gave us a Taeis in way of alms, and said further to us, Beware of the prisoners that are here, for I assure you that they make it their trade, to steal all that they can from any one; whereupon entering into another chamber where there were a great number of prisoners, he continued there above three hours in giving them audience, at the end whereof he sent seven and twenty men, that the day before had received their judgement to execution, which was inflicted upon them by whipping to death, a spectacle so dreadful to us, and that put us in such a fright, as it almost set us besides ourselves: The next morning, as soon as it was day, the Jailers clapped irons on our feet, and manacles on ou● hands, and put us to exceeding great pain, but seven days after we had endured such misery, being laid on the ground one by another, and bewailing our disaster, for the extreme fear we were in, of suffering a most cruel death, if that which we had done at Calempluy should by any means chance to be discovered, it pleased God that we were visited by the Tanigores of the house of mercy, which is of the jurisdiction of this prison, who are called in their language Cofilem Gnaxy; At their arrival all the prisoners bowing themselves, said with a lamentable ton●, Blessed be the day wherein God doth visit us by the ministry of his servants; whereunto the Tanigories made answer with a grave and modest countenance, The Almighty and divine hand of him that hath form the beauty of the stars keep and preserve you; Then approaching to us, they very courteously demanded of us what people we were, and whence it proceeded that our imprisonment was more sensible to us then to others? To this speech we replied with tears in our eyes, that we were poor strangers, so abandoned of men, as in all that Country there was not one that knew our names, and that all we could in our poverty say to entreat them to think of us for God's sake, was contained in a letter, that we had brought them from the Chamber of the Society of the house of Quiay Hinarol, in the City of Nanquin; whereupon Christophoro Borralho, presenting them with the letter, they received it with a new ceremony, full of all courtesy, saying, Praised be he who hath created all things, for that he is pleased to serve himself of sinners here below, Whereby they may be recompensed at the last day of all days, by satisfying them double their labour with the riches of his holy treasures, which shall be done, as we believe in as great abundance, as the drops of rain fall from the clouds to the earth. After this, one of the four, putting up the Letter, said unto us, that as soon as the Chamber of Justice for the poor was open, they would all of them give an answer to our business, and see us furnished with all that we had need of, and so they departed from us: Three days after they returned to visit us in the prison, and in the next morning coming to us again, they asked us many questions answerable to a memorial which they had thereof, whereunto we replied in every point according as we were questioned by each of them, so as they remained very well satisfied with our answers; Then calling the Register to them, who had our papers in charge, they inquired very exactly of him, touching many things that concerned us, and withal required his advice about our affair; that done, having digested all that might make for the conversation of our right into certain heads, they took our process from him, saying, they would peruse it all of them together in their Chambers of Justice with the Proctors of the house, and the next day return it him again, that he might carry it to the Chaem, as he was resolved before to do. Not to trouble myself with recounting in particular all that occurred in this affair, until such time as it was fully concluded, wherein six months and an half were employed, §. 2. during the which we continued still prisoners in such misery, I will in few words relate all that befell us unto the end; when as our business was come before the twelve Conchalis of the criminal Court, the two Proctors of the house of mercy most willingly took upon them to cause the unjust sentence, which had been given against us, to be revoked; Having gotten then all the proceedings to be disannulled, they by petition remonstrated unto the Chaem, who was the Precedent of that Court, How we could not for any cause whatsoever be condemned to death, seeing there were no witnesses of any credit that could testify that we had robbed any man, or had ever seen us carry any offensive weapons contrary to the prohibition made against it by the Law of the first book, but that we were apprehended quite naked, like wretched men, wandering after a lamentable shipwreck, and that therefore our poverty and misery was worthy rather of a pitiful compassion, then of that rigour, wherewith the first Ministers of the arm of wrath had caused us to be whipped; moreover that God alone was the judge of our innocency, in whose name they required him once, twice, nay many times, to consider that he was mortal, and could not last long, for that God had given him a perishable life, at the end whereof he was to render an account of that which had been required of him, since by a solemn oath he was obliged to do all that should be manifest to his judgement, without any consideration of men of the world, whose custom it was to make the balance sway down, which God would have to be upright, according to the integrity of his divine justice.. To this petition the King's Proctor opposed himself, as he that was our adverse party, and that in certain articles, which he framed against us, set forth, how he would prove by ocular witnesses, as well of the Country, as strangers, that we were public thiefs, making a common practice of robbing, and not merchants, such as we pretended to be; whereunto he added, that if we had come to the Coast of China with a good design, and with an intent to pay the King his due in his Custom-houses, we would have repaired to the ports, where they were established by the Ordinance of the Aytan of the Government, but for a punishment, because we went from Isle to Isle, like Pirates, Almighty God, that detests sin and robber●, had permitted us to suffer shipwreck, that so falling into the hands of the Ministers of his justice, we might receive the guerdon of our wicked works, namely, the pains of death, whereof our crimes rendered us most worthy; In regard of all which, he desired we might be condemned according to the Law of the second book, that commanded it in express terms; And that if for other considerations, no way remarkable in us, we could ●y any law be exempted from death, ye● nevertheless for that we were strangers, and vagabonds, without either faith, or knowledge of God, that alone would suffice at leastwise to condemn us to have our hands and noses cut off, and so to be banished for ever into the Country of Ponxileytay, whither such people as we, were wont to be exiled, as might be verified by divers sentences given and executed in like cases, and to that effect, he desired the admittance of his articles, which he promised to prove within the time, that should be prescribed him. These articles were presently excepted against by the Proctor of the Court of Justice, established for the poor, who offered to make the contrary appear within a certain term, which to that end, and for many other reasons alleged by him in our favour, was granted him, wherefore he required that the said articles might not be admitted, especially for that they were infamous, and directly contrary to the Ordinances of Justice. Whereupon the Chaem ordered, that his articles should not be admitted, unless he did prove them by evident testimonies, and such as were conformable to the Divine Law, within six days next ensuing, and that upon pain in case of contravention not to be admitted to any demand of a longer delay. The said term of six days being prescribed the King's Proctor, he, in the mean time, producing no one proof against us, nor any person that so much as knew us, came and demanded a delay of other six days, which was flatly denied him, in regard it but too well appeared, that all he did was only to win time, and therefore he would by no means consent unto it, but contrarily he gave the Proctor for the poor five days respite to allege all that further he could in our defence; In the mean time, the King's Proctor declaimed against us in such foul and opprobrious terms, as the Chaem was much offended thereat, so that he condemned him to pay us twenty Taeis of silver, both for his want of charity, and for that he could not prove any one of the obligations which he had exhibited against us. Three days being spent herein, four Tanigores of the house of the poor, coming very early in the morning to the prison, sent for us into the Infirmirie, where they told us that our business went very well, and how we might hope that our sentence would have a good issue, whereupon we cast ourselves at their feet, and with abundance of tears desired God to reward them for the pains they had taken in our behalf. Thereunto one of them replied, And we also most humbly beseech him to keep you in the knowledge of his Law, wherein all the happiness of good m●n consists; and so they caused two coverlets to be given us, for to lay upon our beds in the night, because the weather was cold, and withal bid us, that we should not stick to ask any thing we wanted, for that God Almighty did not love a sparing hand in the distributing of alms for his sake. A little after their departure came the Register, and showing us the Chaems order, whereby the King's Proctor was condemned to pay us twenty Taeis, gave us the money, and took an acquittance under our hands for the receipt of it; For which giving him a world of thanks, we entreated him for his pains to take as much thereof as he pleased, but he would not touch a penny, saying, I will not for so small a matter lose the recompense which I hope to gain from God, for the consideration of you. §. 3. We passed nine days in great fear, still expecting to have our sentence pronounced, when as one Saturday morning two Chumbims of Justice came to the prison for us, accompanied with twenty officers, by them called Huppes, carrying Halberds, Portisans, and other arms, which made them very dreadful to the beholders; These men tying us all nine together in a long iron chain, lead us to the Caladigan, which was the place where audience was given, and where execution was done on delinquents; Now how we got thither, to confess the truth, I am not able to relate, for we were at that instant so far besides ourselves, as we knew not what we did, or which way we went, so as in that extremity all our thought was how to conform ourselves to the will of God, and beg of him with tears, that for the merit of his sacred passion, he would be pleased to receive the punishment, that should be inflicted on us for the satisfaction of our sins. At length after much pain, and many affronts, that were done us by many which followed after us, with loud cries, we arrived at the first Hall of the Caladigan, where were four and twenty Executioners, whom they call, The Ministers of the arm of justice, with a great many of other people, that were there about their affairs. Here we remained a long time, till at length upon the ringing of a bell, other doors were opened, that stood under a great A●ch of Architecture, very artificially wrought, and whereon were a number of rich figures; On the top a monstrous Lion of silver was seen, with his sore and hind feet upon a mighty great bowl, made of the same metal, whereby the arms of the King of China are represented, which are ordinarily placed on the Forefront of all the Sovereign Courts, where the Chaems precide, who are as Viceroys amongst us. Those doors being opened, as I said before, all that were there present entered into a very great Hall, like the Body of a Church, hung from the top to the bottom with divers pictures, wherein strange kinds of execution done upon p●rsons of all conditions, after a most dreadful manner were constrained, and under every picture was this inscription, Such a one was executed with this kind of death for committing such a crime; so that in beholding the diversity of these fearful portraitures one might see in it, as it were, a declaration of the kind of death that was ordained for each crime, as also the extreme rigour which the Justice there observed in such executions. From this Hall we went into another room far richer, and more costly, for it was gilded all over, so that one could not have a more pleasing object, at least wise, if we could have taken pleasure in any thing, considering the misery we were in. In the midst of this room there was a Tribunal, whereunto one ascended by seven steps, environed with three rows of balisters of iron, copper, and ebony; the tops whereof were beautified with Mother of Pearl: At the upper end of all was a cloth of State of white damask, frenged about with a deep cawl frenge of green silk and gold; Under this State sat the Chaem with a world of greatness and majesty, he was seated in a very rich Chair of silver, having before him a little table, and about him three boys on their knees, sumptuously apparelled, with chains of gold, one of the which (namely, he in the middle) served to give the Chaem the pen wherewithal he signed; The other two took the petitions that were preferred, and presented them on the Table, that they might be signed; On the right hand in another place somewhat higher, and almost equal with the Chaem, stood a boy, some ten or eleven years old, attired in a rich robe of white Satin, embroidered with roses of gold, having a chain of pearl three double about his neck, and hair as long as a woman's, most neatly plaited with a fillet of gold, all enameled with green, and powdered over with great seed pearl; In his hand he held, as a mark of that which he represented, a little branch of roses, made of silk, gold thread, and rich pearls, very curiously intermixed; And in this manner he appeared so gentile, handsome, and beaviful, as no woman, how fair soever, could overmatch him; this boy leaned on his elbow upon the Chaems chair, and figured mercy. In the like manner, on the left hand was another goodly boy, richly apparelled in a Coat of carnation Satin, all set with roses of gold, having his right arm bared up to the elbow, and died with a vermilion as red as blood, and in that hand holding a naked sword, which seemed also to be bloody: moreover, on his head he wore a crown, in fashion like to a Mitre, hung all with little razors, like unto lancets, wherewith Chirurgeons let men blood, being thus gallantly set forth, and of most beautiful presence, yet he struck all that beheld him with fear, in regard of that he represented, which was Justice. For they say, that the Judge, which holds the place of the King, who presents God on earth, ought necessarily to have those two qualities, justice, and Mercy; and that he which doth not use them is a Tyrant, acknowledging no Law, and usurping the power that he hath. The Chaem was apparelled in a long Gown of violet Satin, fringed with green silk and gold, with a kind of s●apulair about his neck, in the midst of which was a great plate of gold, wherein an hand holding a very even pair of balance was engraven, and the inscription about it; It is the nature of the Lord Almighty, to observe in his justice, weight, measure, and true account, therefore take heed to what thou dost, for if thou comest to sin thou shalt suffer for it eternally. Upon his head he had a kind of round bonnet, bordered about with small sprigs of gold, all enameled violet and green, and on the top of it was a little crowned Lion of gold, upon a round bowl of the same metal; by which Lion crowned, as I have delivered heretofore, is the King signified, and by the bowl, the world, as if by these devices, they would denote, that the King is the Lion crowned on the throne of the world; In his right hand he held a little rod of ivory, some three spans long, in manner of a Sceptre; upon the top of the three first steps of this Tribunal stood eight Ushers with silver maces on their shoulders, and below were threescore Mogors on their knees, disposed into three ranks, carrying halberds in their hands, that were neatly damasked with gold; In the vanguard of these same stood, like as if they had been, the Commanders or Captains of this Squadron, the Statues of two Giants, of a most gallant aspect, and very richly attired, with their swords hanging in scarves, and mighty great halberds in their hands, and these the Chinese in their language call Gigaos; on the two sides of this Tribunal below in the room were two very long tables, at each of which sat twelve men, whereof four were Precedents, or Judges, two, Registers, four, Solicitors, and two, Conchalis, which are as it were, Assistants to the Court, one of these Tables was for criminal, and the other for civil causes, and all the officers of both these Tables were apparelled in gowns of white Satin, that were very long, and had large slieves, thereby demonstrating the latitude and purity of justice; the Tables were covered with carpets of violet damask, and richly bordered about with gold, the Chaems table, because it was of silver, had no carpet on it, nor any thing else, but a cushion of cloth of gold, and a Standeth; Now all these things put together, as we saw them, carried a wonderful show of State and Majesty; But to proceed, upon the fourth ringing of a bell, one of the C●●chalis stood up, and after a low obeisance made to the Chaem, with a very loud voice, that he might be heard of every one, he said, Peace there, and with all submission hearken, on pain of incurring the punishment, ordained by the Chaems of the Government for those, that interrupt the silence of sacred justice.. Whereupon this same sitting down again, another arose, and with the like reverence, mounting up to the Tribunal, where the Chaem sat, he took the Sentences from him that held them in his hand, and published them aloud one after another, with so many ceremonies, and compliments, as he employed above an hour therein; At length coming to pronounce our judgement, they caused us to kneel down, with our eyes fixed on the ground, and our hands lifted up, as if we were praying unto Heaven, to the end that in all humility we might hear the publication thereof, which was thus; Bitau Dicabor, the new Chaem of this sacred Court, where justice is rendered to strangers, and that by the gracious pleasure of the Son of the Sun, the Lion crowned on the throne of the world, unto whom are subjected all the Sceptres and Crowns of the Kings that govern the earth; ye are subjected under his feet by the grace and will of the most High in Heaven, having viewed and considered the Appeal made to me by these nine strangers, whose cause was commanded hither by the City of Nanquin, by the four and twenty of austeer life, I say▪ by the oath I have taken upon my entry into the Charge, which I exercise for the Aytao of Batampina, the chief of two and thirty that govern all the people of this Empire, that the ninth day of the seventh Moon, in the fifteenth year of the reign of the Son of the Sun, I was presented with the accusations, which the Cumbim of Taypor, sent me against them, whereby he chargeth them to be thiefs, and robbers of other men's goods, affirming that they have long practised that trade, to the great offence of the Lord above, who hath created all things; and withal that without any fear of God they used to bathe themselves in the blood of those, that with reason resisted them, for which they have already been condemned to be whipped, and have their thumbs cut off, whereof the one hath been put in execution; but when they came to have their thumbs cut off, the Proctors for the poor, opposing it, alleged in their behalf, that they were wrongfully condemned, because there was no proof of that wherewith they were charged, in regard whereof they required for them, that in stead of judging them upon a bare show of uncertain suspicions, voluable testimonies might be produced, and such as were conformable to the divine Laws, and the justice of Heaven; whereunto answer was made by that Court, how justice was to give place to mercy, whereupon they that undertook their cause made their complaint to the four and twenty of austeer life, who both out of very just considerations, and the regard they had to the little support they could have, for that they were strangers, and of a Nation so far distant from us, as we never heard of the Country where they say they were born, mercifully inclining to their lamentable cries, sent them and their cause to be judged by thi● Court, wherefore omitting the prosecution thereof here by the King's Proctor, being able to prove nothing whereof he accused them, affirms only that they are worthy of death for the suspicion and jealousy they have given of themselves, but in regard sacred justice, that stands upon considerations which are pure and agreeable to God, admits of no reasons from an adverse party, if they be not made good by evident proofs, I thought it not fit to allow of the King's Proctor's accusations, since he could not prove what he had alleged, whereupon insisting on his demand, without showing either any just causes, or sufficient proof concerning that he concluded against those strangers, I condemned him in twenty Taeis of silver amends to his adverse parties, being altogether according to equity, because the reasons alleged by him were grounded upon a bad zeal, and such as were neither just, nor pleasing to God, whose mercy doth always incline to their side that are poor and feeble on the earth, when as they invoke him with tears in their eyes, ●s is daily and clearly manifested by the pitiful effects of his greatness; so that having thereupon expressly commanded the Tanigores of the house of mercy, to allege whatsoever they could say on their behalf, they accordingly did so, within the time that was prefixed them for that purpose; And so all proceedings having received their due course, th● cause is now come to a final judgement: wherefore every thing duly viewed and considered, without regard had to any humane respect, but only to the merit and equity of their cause, and according to the resolution of the Laws, accepted by the twelve Chaems of the Government in the fifth book of the will and pleasure of the Son of the Sun, who in such cases out of his greatness and goodness hath more regard to the complaints of the poor, then to the insolent clamours of the proud of the earth; I do ordain, and decree, that these nine strangers shall be clearly quit and absolved of all that, which the King's Proctor hath laid to their charge, as also of all the punishment belonging thereunto, condemning them only to a years exile, during which time they shall work for their living in the reparations of Quansy; and when at eight months of the said year shall be accomplished, than I expressly enjoin all the Chumbims, Conchalis, Monteos, and other Ministers of their government, that immediately upon their presenting of this my Decree unto them, they give them a passport and safe conduct, to the end they may freely and securely return into their Country, or to any other place they shall think fit. After this sentence was thus published in our hearing, we all cried out with a loud voice, The Sentence of thy clear judgement is confirmed in us, even as the purity of thy heart is agreeable to the son of the Sun. This said, one of the Conchalis, that sat at one of the tables, stood up, and having made a very low obeisance to the Chaem▪ he said aloud five times one after another, to all that press of people, which were there in great number; Is there any one in this Court, in this City, or in this Kingdom, that will oppose this Decree, or the deliverance of these nine prisoners? Whereunto no answer being made the two boys, that represented justice and mercy, touched the ensigns which they held in their hands together, and said aloud, Let them be freed and discharged according to the sentence very justly pronounced for it; whereupon one of those Ministers, whom they call Huppes, having rung a bell thrice, the two Chumbims of execution, that had formerly bound us, unlosed us from our chain, and withal took off our manacles, collars, and the other irons from our legs, so that we were quite delivered, for which we gave infinite thanks to our Lord Jesus Christ, because we always thought, that for the ill conceit men had of us, we should be condemned to death. From thence so delivered as we were, they led us back to the prison, where the two Chumhims signed our enlargement in the Jailor's book; nevertheless that we might be altogether discharged, we were to go two months after to serve a year according to our sentence, upon pain of becoming slaves for ever to the King, conformable to his Ordinances: Now because we would presently have gone about to demand the alms of good people in the City, the Chifun, who was as Grand Provost of that prison, persuaded us to stay till the next day, that he might first recommend us to the Tanigores of mercy, that they might do something for us. CHAP. XXXIII. What past betwixt us, and the Tanigores of mercy, with the great favours they did us; and a brief Relation of the City of Pequin, where the King of China kept his Court. THe next morning the four Tanigores of mercy came to visit the Infirmity of this prison, as they used to do; where they rejoiced with us for the good success of our Sentence, giving us great testimony, how well contented they were with it, for which we returned them many thanks, not without shedding abundance of tears, whereat they seemed to be not a little pleased, and willed us not to be troubled with the term we were condemned to serve in, for they told us that in stead of a year we should continue but eight months there, and that the other four months, which made the third part of our punishment, the King remitted it by way of alms for God's sake, in consideration that we were poor, for otherwise if we had been rich, and of ability, we should have had no favour at all, promising to cause this dimunition of punishment to be endorsed on our Sentence, and besides that they would go, and speak to a very honourable man for us, that was appointed to be the chief Marshal, or Monteo, of Quansy, the place where we were to serve, to the end he might show us favour, and cause us to be truly paid for the time we should remain there: Now because this man was naturally a friend to the poor, and inclined to do them good, they thought it would be fit to carry us along with them to his house, the rather for that it might be he would take us into his charge; we gave them all very humble thanks for this good offer of theirs, and told them that God would reward this charity, they showed us for his sake; whereupon we accompanied them to the Monteos house, who came forth to receive us in his outward Court, leading his wife by the hand, which he did, either out of a greater form of compliment, or to do the more honour to the Tanigores, and coming near them he prostrated himself at their feet, and said: It is now, my Lord, and holy brethren, that I have cause to rejoice, for that it hath pleased God to permit, that you his holy servants should come unto my house, being that which I could not hope for, in regard I held myself unworthy of such favour. After the Tanigores had used many compliments and cereremonies to him, as is usual in that Country, they answered him thus, May God, our Sovereign Lord, the infinite source of mercy, recompense the good thou dost for the poor with blessing in this life; for believe it, dear brother, the strongest staff whereon the soul doth lean to keep her from falling so often as she happens to stumble, is the charity, which we use towards our neighbour, when as the vain glory of this world doth not blind the good zeal whereunto his holy Law doth oblige us, and that thou mayst merit the blessed felicity of beholding his face, we have brought thee here these nine Portugals, who are so poor, as none in this Kingdom are like to them; wherefore we pray thee that in the place whither thou art going now, as Monteo, thou wilt do for them all that thou thinkest will be acceptable to the Lord above, in whose behalf we crave this of thee. To this Speech the Monteo, and his wife, replied in such courteous and remarkable terms, as we were almost besides ourselves to hear in what manner they attributed the success of their affairs, to the principal cause of all goodness, even as though they had the light of faith, or the knowledge of the Christian verity. Hereupon they withdrew into a Chamber, into which we went not, and continued there about half an hour; then as they were about to take leave of one another, they commanded us to come in to them, where the Tanigores spoke to them again about us, and recommending us unto them more than before, the Monteo caused our names to be written down in a book that lay before him, and said unto us, I do this, because I am not so good a man, as to give you something of mine own, nor so bad as to deprive you of the sweat of your labour, whereunto the King hath bound you, wherefore even at this instant you shall begin to get your living, although you do not serve as yet, for the desire I have that this may be accounted to me for an alms, so that now you have nothing to do, but to be merry in my house, where I will give order that you shall be provided of all that is necessary for you; Besides this, I will not promise you any thing, for the fear I am in of the showing some vanity by my promise, and so the Devil may make use thereof as of an advantage, to lay hold on me, a matter that often arrives through the weakness of our nature; wherefore let it suffice you for the present to know, that I will be mindful of you for the love of these holy brethren here, who have spoken to me for you. The four Tanigores thereupon taking their leave, gave us four Taeis, and said unto us, Forget not to render thanks unto God for the good success you have had in your business, for it would be a grievous sin in you not to acknowledge so great a grace. Thus were we very well entertained in the house of this Captain for the space of two months, that we remained there, at the end whereof we parted from thence, for to go to Quansy, where we were to make up our time, under the conduct of this Captain, who ever after used us very kindly, and showed us many favours, until that the Tartars entered into the Town, who did a world of mischief there, as I will more amply declare hereafter. §. 2. Before I recount that which happened unto us, after we were embarked with those Chineses that conducted us, and that gave us great hope of setting us at liberty, I think it not amiss to make a brief relation here of the City of Pequin, which may truly be termed the capital of the Monarchy of the world, as also of some particulars I observed there, as well for its arches and policy, as for that which concerns its extent, its government, the laws of the Country, and the admirable manner of providing for the good of the whole State, together in what sort they are paid, that serve in the time of war, according to the Ordinances of the Kingdom, and many other things like unto these, though I must needs confess that herein I shall want the best part, namely, wit, and capacity, to render a reason in what climate it is situated, and in the height of how many degrees, which is a matter the learned and curious most desire to be satisfied in; But my design having never been other (as I have said heretofore) then to leave this my book unto my children, that therein they may see the sufferings I have undergone, it little imports me to write otherwise then I do, that is, in a gross and rude manner; for I hold it better to treat of these things in such sort as nature hath taught me, then to use Hyperboles, and speeches from the purpose, whereby the weakness of my poor understanding may be made more evident. Howbeit since I am obliged to make mention of this matter, by the promise I have made of it heretofore, I say, that this City, which we call Pequin, and they of the Country Pequin, is situated in the height of forty and one degrees of Northerly latitude; the walls of it are in circuit (by the report of the Chinese themselves, and as I have read in a little book, treating of the greatness thereof, and entitled Aquisendan, which I brought since along with me into Portugal) thirty large leagues, namely ten long, and five broad; Some others hold, that it is fifty, namely seventeen in length, and eight in breadth: and forasmuch as they that entreat of it are of different opinions, in that the one make the extent of it thirty leagues, as I have said before, and others fifty, I will render a reason of this doubt, conformable to that which I have seen myself. It is true, that in the manner it is now built, it is thirty leagues in circuit, as they say, for it is environed with two rows of strong walls, where there are a number of towers and bulwarks after our fashion; But without this circuit, which is of the City itself, there is another far greater, both in length and breadth, that the Chineses affirm was anciently all inhabited, but at this present there are only some Boroughs and Villages, as also a many of fair houses, or castles about it, amongst the which there are sixteen hundred, that have great advantages over the rest, and are the houses of the Proctors of the sixteen hundred Cities, and most remarkable Towns of the two and thirty Kingdoms of this Monarchy, who repair unto this City at the general Assembly of the Estates, which is held every three years for the public good. Without this great enclosure, which (as I have said) is not comprehended in the City, there is in a distance of three leagues broad, and seven long, fourscore thousand Tombs of the Mandarins, which are little Chapels all guilded within, and compassed about with Balisters of iron and latin, the entries whereinto are through very rich and sumptuous arches: near to these Chapels there are also very great houses, with gardens and tufted woods of high trees, as also many inventions of ponds, fountains, and aqueducts; whereunto may be added, that the walls of the enclosure are on the inside covered with fine porcelain, and on the fanes above are many Lions portrayed in gold, as also in the squares of the steeples, which are likewise very high, and embellished with pictures. It hath also five hundred very great Palaces, which are called the houses of the Son of the Sun, whither all those retire, that have been hurt in the Wars for the service of the King, as also many other soldiers, who in regard of age or sickness are no longer able to bear arms, and to the end that during the rest of their days they may be exempted from incommodity, each of them receives monthly a certain pay to find himself withal, and to live upon. Now all these men of War, as we learned of the Chinese, are ordinarily an hundred thousand, there being in each of those houses two hundred men according to their report. We saw also another long street of low houses, where there were four and twenty thousand oar-men, belonging to the King Panoures; and another of the same structure a good league in length, where fourteen thousand Taverners that followed the Court dwelled▪ as also a third street like unto the other two, where live a great number of light women, exempted from the tribute, which they of the City pay, for that they are Courtesans, whereof the most part had quitted their husbands for to follow the wretched trade; and if for that cause they come to receive any hurt, their husbands are grievously punished for it, because they are there as in a place of freedom, and under the protection of the Tutan of the Court, Lord Steward of the King's house. In this enclosure do likewise remain all the Laundresses, by them called Maynates, which wash the linen of the City, who as we were told, are above an hundred thousand, and live in this quarter, for that there are divers rivers there, together with a number of wells, and deep pools of water, compassed about with good walls. Within this same enclosure, as the said Aquisendan relates, there are thirteen hundred gallant and very sumptuous houses of religious men and women, who make profession of the four principal Laws of those two and thirty which are in the Empire of China, and it is thought that in some of these houses there are above a thousand persons, besides the servants, that from abroad do furnish them with victuals, and other necessary provisions. We saw also a great many houses, which have fair buildings of a large extent, with spacious enclosures, wherein there are gardens, and very thick woods, full of any kind of game, either for hawking, or hunting, that may be desired; And these houses are as it were Inns, whither come continually in great number people of all ages, and sexed, as to see Comedies, Plays, Combats, Bull-baitings, wrestlings, and magnificent Feasts, with the Tutons, Chaems, Conchacies, Aytaos, Bracalons, Chumbims, Monteos, Lauteas, Lords, Gentlemen, Captains, Merchants, and other rich men, do make for to give content to their kindred and friends; These houses are bravely furnished with rich hangings, beds, chairs, and stools, as likewise with huge cupbards of plate, not only of silver, but of gold also; and the attendants that wait at the table, are maids ready to be married, very beautiful, and gallantly attired; howbeit all this is nothing in comparison of the sumptuousness, and other Magnificences that we saw there. Now the Chineses assured us, there were some feasts that lasted ten days after the Carachina, or Chinese manner, which in regard of the state, pomp, and charge thereof, as well in the attendance of servants and waiters, as in the costly fare of all kind of flesh, fowl, fish, and all delicacies in music, in sports of hunting, and hawking, in plays, comedies, tilts, turnayes, and in shows both of horse and foot, fighting and skirmishing together, do cost above twenty thousand Taeis. These Inns do stand in at least a million of gold, and are maintained by certain Companies of very rich Merchants, who in way of commerce and traffic employ their money therein, where by it is thought they gain far more, then if they should venture it to sea. It is said also, that there is so good and exact an order observed there, that whensoever any one will be at a charge that way, he goes to the Xipaton of the house, who is the superintendent thereof, and declares unto him what his design is, whereupon he shows him a book, all divided into chapters, which treats of the ordering and sumptuousness of Feasts, as also the rates of them, and how they shall be served in, to the end, that he who will be at the charge, may choose which he pleases; This book, called Pinetoreu, I have seen, and heard it read, so that I remember how in the three first Chapters thereof, it speaks of the feasts, whereunto God is to be invited, and of what price they are; and than it descends to the King of China, of whom it says, That by a special grace of Heaven, and right of Sovereignty, he hath the Government of the whole earth, and of all the Kings that inhabit it. After it hath done with the King of China, it speaks of the feasts of the Tutons, which are the ten Sovereign dignities, that command over the forty Chaems, who are as the Viceroys of the State. These Tutons also are termed the beams of the Sun, for, say they, as the King of China is the Son of the Sun, so the Tutons, who represent him, may rightly be termed his beams, for that they proceed from him, even as the rays do from the Sun; But setting aside the bruitishness of these Gentiles, I will only speak of the Feast, whereunto God is to be invited, which I have seen some to make with much devotion, though for want of faith, their works can do them little good. CHAP. XXXIV. The Order which is observed in the Feasts, that are made in certain Inns; and the State, which the Chaem of the two and thirty Universities keeps; with certain remarkable things in the City of Pequin. THe first thing whereof mention is made in the Preface of that Book, which treats of Feasts, as I have said before, is the Feast, that is to be made unto God here upon earth, of which it is spoken in this manner: Every Feast, how sumptuous soever it be, may be paid for with a price, more or less, conformable to the bounty of him that makes it, who for all his charge bestowed on it reaps no other recompense, than the praise of flatterers and idle persons; wherefore, O my Brother, saith the Preface of the said Book, I counsel thee to employ thy goods in feasting of God in his poor, that is to say, secretly to supply the necessities of good folks, so that they may not perish for want of that which thou hast more than thou needest. Call to mind also the vile matter wherewith thy father engendered thee, and that too, which is far more abject, wherewith thy mother conceived thee, and so thou wilt see how much inferior thou art, even to the bruit beasts, which without distinction of reason apply themselves to that whereunto they are carried by the flesh; and seeing that in the quality of a man thou wilt invite thy friends, who possibly by to morrow may not be, to show that thou art good and faithful, invite the poor creatures of God, of whose groans and necessities he like a pitiful Father taketh compassion, and promiseth to him that doth them good infinite satisfaction in the house of the Sun, where as an Article of faith we hold, that his servants shall abide for evermore in eternal happiness, After these words, and other such like, worthy to be observed, the Xipaton, who, as I told you, is the chief of them that govern this great Labyrinth, shows him all the Chapters of the Book, from one end to the other, and bids him look what manner of men, or Lords he will invite, what number of guests, and how many days he will have the feast to last; for addeth he, the Kings, and Tutons, at the feasts that are made for them, have so many Messes of meat, so many Attendants, such Furniture, such Chambers, such vessel, such plate, such sports, and so many days of hawking, and hunting, all which amounts to such a sum of money: Then if he will not bestow so much, the Xipaton shows him in another Chapter, the feasts which are ordinarily made for the Chaems, Ayta●s, Ponchacis, Bracalons, Anchacis, Conchalaas, Lanteas, or for Captains, and rich men, whereas other kind of persons of meaner condition have nothing else to do, but to sit down, and fall to on free cost, so that there are usually fifty or threescore rooms full of men and women of all sorts; There are also in other rooms most excellent and melodious consorts of music, namely of Harps, Viols, Lutes, Bando●es, Cornets, Sackbuts, and other Instruments, which are not in use amongst us. If it be a feast of women, as it often falls out to be, then are the waiters on the table likewise women, or young Damosels, richly attired, who for that they are maids, and endued with singular beauty, it happens many times that men of extraordinary quality fall in love with them, and do marry them. Now for a conclusion of that which I have to say of these Inns, of all the money, which is spent upon such feasts, four in the hundred, whereof the Xipaton pays the one half, and they that make the feasts the other, is set apart for the entertainment of the table of the poor, whereunto for God's sake all manner of people are admitted that will come to it; Moreover, they are allowed a Chamber, and a good bed but that only for the space of three days, unless they be women with child, or sick persons, which are not able to travel; for in that case they are entertained a longer time, because regard is had unto the people according to the need they are in. We saw also in this outward enclosure, which, as I have delivered, environs all the other City, two and thirty great Edifices, or Colleges, distant about a ●light shoot the one from the other, where such, as apply themselves to the study of the two and thirty Laws, which are professed in the two and thirty Kingdoms of this Empire, do reside. Now in each of these Colleges, according as we could guests by the great number of persons that we saw there, there should be above ten thousand Scholars; and indeed the Aquesendoo, which is the Book that treats of these things, makes them amount in the whole to four hundred thousand: There is likewise somewhat apart from the rest, another far greater and fairer Edifice, of almost a league in circuit, where all those that have taken degrees, as well in their Theology, as in the Laws of the government of this Monarchy, do live. In this University there is a Chaem, who commands over all the Heads of the Colleges, and is called, by a title of eminent dignity, Xileyxitapou, that is to say, Lord of all the Nobles. This Chaem, for that he is more honourable, and of an higher quality than all the rest, keeps as great a Court as any Tuton; for he hath ordinarily a guard of three hundred Mogores, four and twenty Loshers that go with silver Maces before him, and six and thirty women, which mounted on white ambling Nags, trapped with silk and silver, ride playing on certain very harmonious instruments of music, and singing to the tune thereof, make a pleasing Consort after their manner. There are also led before him twenty very handsome spare horses, without any other furniture than their clothes of silver tinsel, and with headstals full of little silver bells, every horse being waited on by six Halberdiers, and four footmen very well apparelled; Before all this train goes four hundred Huppes, with a number of great long chains, which trailing on the ground, make such a dreadful rattling and noise, as does not a lit le terrify all that are within hearing; Then next to them marches twelve men on horseback, called Peretandas, each of them carrying an Umbrello of carnation Satin, and other twelve that follow them with banners of white damask, deeply indented, and edged about with golden frenge; Now after all this pomp comes the Chaem sitting in a triumphant Chariot, attended by threescore Conchalas, Chumbims, and Monteos, such as amongst us are the Chancellors, Judges, and Councillors of the Courts of Justice, and these go all on foot, carrying upon their shoulders Cymiters rightly garnished with gold. Last of all follow lesser officers, that are like unto our Registers, Examiner's, Auditors, Clarks Attorneys, and Solicitors, all likewise on foot, and crying out unto the people with a loud voice for to retire themselves into their houses, and clear the streets, so as there may be nothing to hinder or trouble the passage of this magnificnce. But the most observable thing herein is, that close to the Person of the Chaem, march two little boys on horseback, one on the right hand, the other on the left, richly attired, with their ensigns in their hands, signifying justice, and Mercy, whereof I have spoken heretofore; That on the right side representing mercy, is clothed in white, and that on the left representing justice is apparelled in red; The horses whereon these little boys are mounted, have on them foot-cloths of the same colour their garments are, and all their furniture and trappings are of gold, with a kind of network over them, made of silver thread; After each of these children march six young youths, about fifteen years of age, with silver Maces in their hands, so that all these things together are so remarkable, as there is no man that beholds them, but on the one side trembles for fear, and on the other side remains astonished at the sight of so much greatness, and majesty. Now that I may not longer dwell on that which concerns this great enclosure, I will pass over in silence many other marvels that we saw there, consisting in rich & fair buildings in magnificent Pagodes, in bridges placed upon great pillars of stone, on either side whereof are rails or grates of iron finely wrought, and in high ways, that are strait, broad, and all very well paved, whereof I think fit not to speak, for by that which I have already said, one may easily judge of what I have omitted, in regard of the resemblance and conformity that is between them; wherefore I will only entreat, and that as succinctly as I can, of certain buildings, which I saw in this City, chiefly of four, that I observed more curiously than the rest, as also of some other particularities, that well deserve to be insisted upon. §. 2. This City of Pequin, whereof I have promised to speak more amply than yet I have done, is so prodigious, and the things therein remarkable, as I do almost repent me for undertaking to discourse of it, because to speak the truth, I know not where to begin, that I may be as good as my word; for one must not imagine it to be, either as the City of Rome, or Constantinople, or Venice, or Paris, or London, or Sevill, or Lisbon, or that any of the Cities of Europe are comparable unto it, how famous or populous soever they be: Nay I will say further, that one must not think it to be like to Grand Cairo in Egypt, Tauris in Persia, Amadaba in Cambaya, Bisnagar in Narsingua, Goura in Bengala, Ava in Chaleu, Timplan in Calaminhan, Martaban and Bagou in Pegu, Guimpel and Tinlau in Siammon, Odia in the Kingdom of Sornau, Passarvan and Dema in the Island of jaoa, Pangor in the Country of the Lequiens, Vsangea in the Grand Cauchin, Lancama in Tartary, and Meaco in jappun, all which Cities are the Capitals of many great Kingdoms; for I dare well affirm, that all those same are not to be compared to the least part of the wonderful City of Pequin, much less to the greatness and magnificence of that which is most excellent in it, whereby I understand her stately buildings, her inward riches, her excessive abundance of all that is necessary for the entertaining of life, also the world of people, the infinite number of Barks and Vessels that are there, the Commerce, the Courts of Justice, the Government and the State of the Tutons, Chaems, Anchacies, Aytaos, Puchancies, and Bracanons, who rule whole Kingdoms, and very spacious Provinces, with great pentions, and are ordinarily resident in this City, or others for them, when as by the Kings command they are sent about affairs of consequence. But setting these things aside, whereof yet I intent to speak more amply, when time shall serve, I say that this City, (according to that which is written of it, both in the Aquesendoo before mentioned, and all the Chronicles of the Kingdom of China) is thirty leagues in circuit, not comprehending therein the buildings of the other enclosure that is without it, and is environed with a double wall, made of good strong freestone, having three hundred and threescore gates, each of which hath a small For●, composed of two high towers, with its ditches, and draw-bridges; and at every gate is a Register, & four Porters with halberds in their hands, who are bound to give account of all that goes in and out. These gates by the Ordinance of the Tuton, are divided according to the three hundred and threescore days of the year, so that every day in his turn hath the feast of the invocation of the Idol, whereof each gate bears the name, celebrated with much solemnity. This great City hath also within that large enclosure of her walls, as the Chineses assured us, three thousand and three hundred Pagodes or Temples, wherein are continually sacrificed a great number of birds and wild beasts, which they hold to be more agreeable unto God, than such as are kept tame in houses, whereof their Priests render divers reasons to the people, therewith persuading them to believe so great an abuse for an article of faith. The structures of these Pagodes, whereof I speak, are very sumptuous, especially those of the orders of the Menegrepos, Conquiays, and Talagrepos, who are the Priests of the four Sects of Xaca, Amida, Gizom, and Canom, which surpass in antipuity the other two and thirty of that Labyrinth of the Devil, who appears to them many times in divers forms, for to make them give more credit to his impostures and lies. The principal streets of this City are all very long and broad, with fair houses of two or three stories high, and enclosed at both ends with balisters of iron and latin; the entrance into them is through lanes, that cross these great streets, at the ends whereof are great arches, with strong gates, which are shut in the night, and on the top of the arches, there are watch-bels; Each of these streets hath its Captain, and officers, who walk the round in their turns, and are bound every ten days to make report into the Townhouse of all that passeth in their quarters, to the end that the Punchacies, or Chaems of the Government, may take such order therein, as reason requires. Moreover this great City (if credit may be given to that which the said book, so often before mentioned by me, records) hath an hundred and twenty Canals, made by the Kings and people in former times, which are three fathom deep, and twelve broad, crossing through the whole length and breadth of the City, by the means of a great number of bridges, built upon arches of strong freestone, at the end whereof there are pillars, with chains, that reach from the one to the other, and resting places for passengers to repose themselves in: It is said that the bridges of these hundred & twenty Canals, or Aqueducts, are in number eighteen hundred, and that if one of them is fair and rich, the other is yet more, as well for the fashion, as for the rest of the workmanship thereof. The said Book affirms, That in this City there are sixscore Piatzues, or public places, in each of the which is a Fair kept every month. Now during the two months' time that we were at liberty in this City, we saw eleven or twelve of these Fairs, where were an infinite company of people, both on horseback, and on foot, that out of boxes hanging about their necks sold all things that well near can be named, as the Haberdashers of small wares do amongst us, besides the ordinary shops of rich Merchants, which were ranged very orderly in the particular streets, where was to be seen a world of silk stuffs, tinsels, cloth of gold, linen, and cotton-cloth, sables, ermyns, musk, aloes, fine porcelain, gold and silver plate, pearl, seed pearl, gold in powder, and lingots, and such other things of value, whereat we nine Portugals were exceedingly astonished; But if I should speak in particular of all the other commodities, that were to be sold there, as of iron, steel, lead, copper, tin, latin, coral, cornalin, crystal, quicksilver, vermilion, ivory, cloves, nutmegs, mace, ginger, tamarinds, cinnamon, pepper, cardamone, borax, honey, wax, sanders, sugar, conserveses, acates, fruit, meal, rice, flesh, venison, fish, pulse, and herbs; there was such abundance of them, as it is scarce possible to express it in words. The Chineses also assured us, that this City hath an hundred and threescore Butcher's shambles, and in each of them an hundred stalls, full of all kinds of flesh that the earth produceth, for that these people feed on all, as Veal, Mutton, Pork, Goat, the flesh of Horses, Buffles, Rhinocerets, Tigers, Lions, Dogs, Mules, Asses, Otters, Chamois, Bodgers, and finally of all other beasts whatsoever. Furthermore, besides the weights which are particularly in every shambles, there is not a gate in the City that hath not its scales, wherein the meat is weighed again, for to see if they have their due weight that have bought it, to the end that by this means the people may not be deceived. Besides those ordinary Shambles, there is not scarce a street but hath five or six Butcher's shops in it, where the choicest meat is sold; there are withal many Taverns, where excellent fare is always to be had, and cellars full of gammons of bacon, dried tongues, powdered geese, and other savoury viands, for to relish one's drink, all in so great abundance, that it would be very superfluous to say more of it; but what I speak is to show how liberally God hath imparted to these miserable blinded wretches the good things which he hath created on the earth, to the end that his holy Name may therefore be blessed for evermore. CHAP. XXXV. The Prison of Xinanguibaleu, wherein those are kept, which have been condemned to serve at the reparations of the wall of Tartary; and another enclosure, called the Treasure of the dead, with the revenues whereof this prison is maintained. DEsisting now from speaking in particular of the great number of the rich and magnificent buildings, which we saw in this City of Pequin, I will only insist on some of the Edifices thereof, that seemed more remarkable to me then the rest, whence it may be easy to infer, what all those might be, whereof I will not make any mention here to avoid prolixity; And of these neither would I speak, were it not that our Lord may one day permit, that the Portugal Nation, full of valour, and of lofty courage, may make use of this relation for the glory of our great God, to the end that by these humane means, and the assistance of his divine favour, it may make those barbarous people understand the verity of our holy Catholic faith, from which their sins have so far esloigned them, as they mock at all that we say to them thereof: Hereunto I will add, that they are extravagant, and senseless, as they dare boldly affirm, that only with beholding the face of the Son of the Sun, which is their King, a soul would be more happy then with all other things of the world besides, which persuades me that if God of his infinite mercy and goodness would grant, that the King of the people might become a Christian, it would be an easy matter to convert all his Subjects, whereas otherwise I hold it difficult for so much as one to change his belief, and all by reason of the great awe they are in of the Law, which they fear and reverence a like, and whereof it is not to be believed how much they cherish the Ministers. But to return to my discourse, the first building which I saw of those that were most remarkable, was a prison, which they call Xinanguibaleu, that is to say, The enclosure of the Epiles; the circuit of this prison is two leagues square, or little less, both in length and breadth: It is enclosed with a very high wall without any battlements; the wall on the outside is environed with a great deep ditch full of water, over the which are a many of draw-bridges, that are drawn up in the night with certain iron chains, and so hang suspended on huge cast pillars; In this prison is an arch of strong hewed stone, abutting in two towers, in the tops whereof are six great sentinel bells, which are never rung but all the rest within the said enclosure do answer them, which the Chineses affirm to be above an hundred, and indeed they make a most horrible din. In this place there are ordinarily three hundred thousand prisoners, between seventeen and fifty, whereat we were much amazed, and indeed we had good cause, in regard it is a thing so unusual and extraordinary. Now desiring to know of the Chinese the occasion of so marvellous a building, and of the great number of prisoners that were in it; they answered us, that after the King of China, named Crisnago Docotay, had finished a wall of three hundred leagues space betwixt this Kingdom of China, and that of Tartary, as I have declared other where, he ordained by the advice of his people, (for to that effect he caused an Assembly of his Estates to be held) that all those which should be condemned to banishment, should be sent to work in the repairing of this wall, and that after they had served six years together therein, they might freely depart, though they were sentenced to serve for a longer time, because the King pardoned them the remainder of the term by way of charity and alms; but if during those years, they should happen to perform any remarkable act, or other thing, wherein it appeared they had advantage over others, or if they were three times wounded in the Sallies they should make, or if they killed some of their enemies, they were then to be dispensed with for all the rest of their time, and that the Chaem should grant them a certificate thereof, where it should be declared why he had delivered them, and how he had thereby satisfied the Ordinances of War. Two hundred and ten thousand men are to be continually entertained in the work of the wall, by the first institution, whereof defalcation is made of a third part, for such are dead, maimed, and delivered, either for their notable actions, or for that they had accomplished their time: And likewise when as the Chaem, who is as the chief of all those, sent to the Pitaucamay, which is the highest Court of Justice, to furnish him with that number of men, they could not assemble them together so soon as was necessary, for that they were divided in so many several places of that Empire, which is prodigiously great, as I have delivered before, and that withal a long time was required for the assembling them together, another King, named Gopiley Aparau, who succeeded to that Crisnago Dacotay, ordained that the great enclosure should be made in the City of Pequin, to the end that as soon as any were condemned to the work of this wall, they should be carried to Xinanguibaleu for to be there altogether, by which means they might be sent away without any delay, as now is done. So soon as the Court of Justice hath committed the prisoners to this prison, whereof he that brings them hath a Certificate, they are immediately left at liberty, so that they may walk at their pleasure within this great enclosure, having nothing but a little plate of a span long, and four fingers broad, wherein these words are engraven, Such a one of such a place hath been condemned to the general exile for such a cause, he entered such a day, such a month, such a year. Now the reason why they make every prisoner to carry this plate for a testimony of their evil actions, is, to manifest for what crime he was condemned, and at what time he entered, because every one goes forth conformably to the length of time that shall be since he entered in. These prisoners are held for duly delivered when they are drawn out of captivity for to go and work at the wall, for they cannot upon any cause whatsoever be exempted from the prison of Xinanguibaleu, and the time they are there is counted to them for nothing, in regard they have no hope of liberty but at that instant when their turn permits them to work in the reparations, for than they may be sure to be delivered, according to the ordinance whereof I have made mention before. Having now delivered the occasion whereof so great a prison was made▪ before I leave it I hold it not amiss to speak of a Fair, which we saw there, of two that are usually kept every year, which those of the Country call, Gunxinem, Apparau, Xinanguibaleu, that is to say, The rich Fair of the prison of the condemned; These Fairs are kept in the months of july, and january, with very magnificent feasts, solemnised for the invocation of their Idols; And even, there they have their plenory indulgences, by means whereof great riches of gold and silver are promised them in the other world. They are both of them frank and free, so as the Merchants pay no duties, which is the cause that they flock thither in such great number, as they assured us that there were three millions of persons there; And forasmuch as I said before, that the three hundred thousand that are imprisoned there, are at liberty, as well as those that go in and out, you shall see what course they hold to keep the prisoners from getting forth amongst others. Every one that is free and comes in hath a mark set on the wrist of his right arm with a certain Confection made of Oil, Bitumen, Lacre, Rhubarb, and Alum, which being once dry cannot be any ways defaced, but by the means of vinegar and salt mingled together very hot; And to the end that so great a number of people may be marked, on both sides of the gates stand a many of Chainpatoens, who with stamps of lead, dipped in this Bitumen, imprints a mark on every one that presents himself unto them, and so they let him enter; which is only practised on men, not upon women, because none of that Sex are ever condemned to the labour of the wall. When therefore they come to go out of the gates, they must all have their arms bared where this mark is, that the said Chaintapo●ns, who are the Porters and Ministers of this affair, may know them, and let them pass; and if by chance any one be so unhappy as to have that mark defaced by any accident, must even have patience, and remain with the other prisoners, in regard there is no way to get him out of this place if he be found without that mark. Now those Chaintapoens are so dextrous and well versed in it, that an hundred thousand men may in an hour go in and out without trouble, so that by this means the three hundred thousand prisoners continue in their captivity, and none of them can slip away amongst others to get out. There are in this prison three great enclosures like great towns, where there are a number of houses, and very long streets, without any lanes; and at the entrance into each street there are good gates, with their sentinel bells aloft, together with a Chumbim, and twenty men for a Guard; within a flight shoot of those enclosures are the lodgings of the Chaem, who commands all this prison, and those lodgings are composed of a number of fair houses, wherein are many out-Courts, Gardens, Ponds, Halls, and Chambers, enriched with excellent inventions, able to lodge a King at his ease, how great a Court soever he have. In the two principal of these Towns there are two streets, each of them about a flight shoot long, which about upon the Chaems lodgings, arched all along with stone, and covered over head like the Hospital at Lisbon, but that they far surpass it. Here are all things to be sold that one can desire, as well for victual, and other kind of provisions, as for all sorts of Merchandise, and rich wares. In those arched streets, which are very spacious and long, are these two Fairs kept every year, whither such an infinite multitude of people resort, as I have declared before. Moreover within the enclosure of this prison are divers woods of tall and high trees, with many small streams, and ponds of clear sweet water for the use of the prisoners, and to wash their linen, as also sundry Hermitages, and Hospitals, together with twelve very sumptuous and rich Monasteries, so that whatsoever is to be had in a great Town, may in great abundance be found within the enclosure, and with advantage in many things, because the most part of these prisoners have their wives and children there, to whom the King gives a lodging answerable to the household, or family, which each one hath. The second of those things, which I have undertaken to relate, is another enclosure we saw almost as big as the former, compassed about with strong walls, and great ditches. §. 2. This place is called Muxiparan, which signifies The treasure of the dead, where are many towers of hewed carved stone, and steeples diversely painted. The walls on the top are in stead of battlements environed with iron grates, where there are a number of idols of different figures, as of Men, Serpents, Horses, Oxen, Elephants, Fishes, Adders, and many other monstrous forms of creatures, which were never seen, some of Brass, and Iron, and others of Tin, and Copper; so that this infinite company of several figures joined together is one of the most remarkable and pleasantest things that can be imagined. Having passed over the bridge of the ditch we arrived at a great Court that was at the first entrance, enclosed round about with huge gates, and paved all over with white and black stones in checquer work, so polished and bright, as one might see himself in them as in a looking glass; In the midst of this Court was a pillar of Jasper six and thirty spans high, and as it seemed all of one piece, on the top whereof was an idol of silver in the figure of a woman, which with her hands strangled a Serpent, that was excellently enam●lled with black and green. A little further at the entrance of another gate, which stood between two very high towers, and accompanied with four and twenty pillars of huge great stone, there were two figures of men, each of them with an iron club in his hand, as if they had served to guard that passage, being an hundred and forty spans high, with such hideous and ugly visages, as makes them even to tremble that behold them; The Chineses called them Xixipatau Xalican, that is to say, The blowers of the house of smoke. At the entering into this gate there were twelve men with halberds, and two Registers, set at a table, who enrolled all that entered t●ere, unto whom every one paid a matter of a groat: when we were entered within this gate, we met with a very large street, closed on both sides with goodly arches, as well in regard of the workmanship, as the rest, round about the which hung an infinite company of little bells of latin by chains of the same metal, that moved by the air, made such a noise as one could with much ado hear one another: This street might be about half a league long, and within these arches, on both sides of the way, were two rows of low houses, like unto great Churches, with steeples all guilt, and divers inventions of painting: Of these houses the Chinese assured us there was in that place three thousand, all which from the very top to the bottom were full of dead m●ns skulls, a thing so strange, that in every man's judgement a thousand great shops could hardly contain them. Behind these houses, both on the one side and the other, were two great Mounts of dead men's bones, reaching far above the ridges of the houses, full as long as the street, and of a mighty breadth. These bones were ordered and disposed one upon another so curiously and aptly, that they seemed to grow there; Having demanded of the Chineses whether any register was kept of these bones, they answered, there was, for the Talagrepos, unto whose charge the administration of these three thousond houses was committed, enroled them all; and that none of these houses yielded less than two thousand Taeis revenue out of such lands, as the owners of these bones had bequeathed to them for their souls health; and that the rent of all these three thousand houses together amounted unto five millions of gold yearly, whereof the King had four, and the Talagrepos the other for to defray the expenses of this Fabric; and that the four appertained to the King, as their Support, who dispensed them in the maintenance of the three hundred thousand prisoners of Xinanguibaleu. Being amazed at this marvel, we began to go along this street, in the midst whereof we found a great Piazza, compassed about with two huge grates of latin, and within it was an Adder of brass enfolded into I know not how many boughts, and so big that it contained thirty fathom in circuit, being withal so ugly and dreadful, as no words are able to describe it. Some of us would estimate the weight of it, and the least opinions reached to a thousand quintals, were it hollow within, as I believe it was. Now although it was of an unmeasurable greatness, yet was it in every part so well proportioned, as nothing can be amended, whereunto also the workmanship thereof is so correspondent, that all the perfection which can be desired from a good workman is observed in it. This monstrous Serpent, which the Chinese call, The gluttonous Serpent of the house of smoke, had on the top of his head a bowl of iron, two and fifty foot in circumference, as if it had been thrown at him from some other place; Twenty paces further was the figure of a man of the same brass in the form of a Giant, in like manner very strange and extraordinary, as well for the greatness of the body, as the hugeness of the limbs: This Monster held an iron bowl just as big as the other aloft in both his hands, and beholding the Serpent with a frowning and angry countenance, he seemed as though he would throw this bowl at him. Round about this figure was a number of little idols all guilt on their knees, with their hands lifted up to him, as if they would adore him. All this great edifice was consecrated to the honour of this Idol, called Mucluparon, whom the Chineses affirmed to be the treasurer of all the dead men's bones, and that when the gluttonous Serpent before mentioned came to steal them away, he made at him with that bowl which he held in his hands, whereupon the Serpent in great fear fled immediately away to the bottom of the profound house of smoke, whither God had precipitated him for his great wickedness; and further that he had maintained a combat with him three thousand years already, and was to continue the same three thousand years more, so that from three thousand to three thousand years he was to employ five bowls, wherewith he was to make an end of killing him; Hereunto they added, that as soon as this Serpent should be dead, the bones that were there assembled, would return into the bodies, to which they appertained formerly, and so should go and remain for ever in the house of the Moon; To these brutish opinions they join many others such like, unto which they give so much faith, that nothing can be able to remove them from it, for it is the doctrine that is preached unto them by their Bonzes, who also tell them that the true way to make a soul happy, is to gather these bones together into this place, by means whereof there is not a day passes but that a thousand or two of these wretches bones are brought thither. Now if some for their far distance cannot bring all the bones whole thither, they will at leastwise bring a tooth or two, and so they say that by way of an alms they make as good satisfaction as if they brought all ●he rest; which is the reason that in all these chunel houses there is such an infinite multitude of these teeth, that one might lad many ships with them. We saw in a great Plain without the walls of this City another building, §. 3 very sumptuous and rich, which they call Nacapirau, that is to say, the Queen of Heaven, for it is the opinion of these blinded wretches, that our Lord above is married like the Kings here below, and that the children which he hath had by the Nacapirau, are the Stars we see twinkling in the Firmament by night, and that when any exhalation comes to dissolve in the air, they say that it is one of his children that is dead, whereof his other brothers are so grieved, that they shed such abundance of tears, as the earth is watered therewith, by which means God provides us of our living, as it were in manner of alms bestowed for the souls of the deceased. But letting pass these and other such like fooleries, I will only entreat of such particulars, as we observed in this great Edifice, whereof the first was one hundred and forty Convents of this accursed Religion, both of men and women, in each of which there are four hundred persons, amounting in all to six and fifty thousand, besides an infinite number of religious servants, that are not obliged to their vow of profession that are within, who for a mark of their Priestly dignity are clothed in violet, with green stars on them, having their head, beard, and eyebrows shaved, and wearing beads about their necks to pray with, but for all that they crave no alms, by reason they have revenue enough to live on. The next was an enclosure within this huge building, a league in circuit, the walls whereof were built upon arches, vaults, of strong hewed stone, and underneath them were Galleries, environed all about with balisters of latin; within this enclosure at a gate, through which we passed, we saw under most deformed figures the two porters of hell, at least they believe so, calling the one Bacharon, and the other Quagifau, both of them with iron clubs in their hands, and so hideous and horrible to see to, that it is impossible to behold them without fear. Having past this gate under a chain, that went a cross from the breast of one of these devils to the other, we entered into a very fair street, both for breadth and length, enclosed at either end with many arches, diversely painted, on the top whereof were all along two rows of idols to the number of five thousand; Now we could not well judge of what matter these idols were made, howsoever they were gilded all over, and upon their heads they wore mitres of sundry inventions. At the end of this street was a great square place, paved with black and white stone, and compassed about with four rows of giants in brass, each of them fifteen foot high, with halberds in their hands, and their hair and beards all guilt, which was not only a very pleasing object to the eye, but also represented a kind of majestical greatness. At the end of this place was Quiay Huyan, the god of rain, which idol was so huge, that with his head he touched the battlements of the tower, being above twelve fathom high; he was likewise of brass, and both from his mouth, head, and breast, at six and twenty several places came out streams of water: Having passed between his legs, which stood straddling at a great distance, one from another, we entered into a large room, as long as a Church, where there were three ships set upon very big and high pillars of Jasper; all along the walls thereof on both sides were a many of idols, great and little in divers forms all guilt, fitted and disposed in such order, as they took up all the breadth and length of the walls, and seemed at first sight to be all gold: At the end of this room or temple upon a round Tribunal, whereunto one ascended by fifteen winding stairs, was an altar, proportionable to the same Tribunal, whereon stood the image of Nacapirau, in the likeness of a very fair woman, with her hair hanging upon her shoulders, and her hands lifted up to Heaven. Now for that she was guilt all over with fine gold, and that with a great deal of art and care, she glisteren in that manner as it was impossible to continue looking on her, so dazzled were a man's eyes with the rays that darted from her. Round about this Tribunal on the first four stairs were the Statues of twelve Kings of China in silver, with crowns on their heads, and maces on their shoulders; a little lower were three rows of idols guilt, kneeling on their knees, and holding up their hands, and all about hung a number of silver candlesticks with seven branches apiece. When we were out of this, we went through another street all arched like that by which we entered in, and from this we p●ssed through two other streets full of very stately buildings, and so came to a gate, that stood between four high towers, where there was a Chifuu, with thirty Halberdiers, and two Registers, which wrote down the names of all that went in and out, as they did ours, and so we gave them about a groat for our passage out. CHAP. XXXVI. Of an Edifice, situated in the midst of the river, wherein were the hundred and thirteen Chapels of the Kings of China; with the public Granaries established for the relief of the poor. TO give an end to the matter, whereof I entreat, which would be infinite if I should recount every thing in particular, amongst the great number of marvellous buildings, which we saw, the most remarkable to my seeming was an enclosure, seated in the midst of the river of Batampina, containing some league in circuit in an Island, and environed with fair hewed stone, which on the outside was about eight and thirty foot high above the water, and on the inside even with the ground, being encompassed with two rows of balisters of latin, whereof the outermost were but six foot high, for the commodity of such as would rest themselves there, and the innermost were nine foot high, having six Lions of silver standing upon huge bowls, which are the arms of the King of China, as I have said elsewhere. Within the enclosure of these balisters stood in very goodly order an hundred and thirteen Chapels after the fashion of Bulwarks all round, in each of which was a rich Tomb of Alabaster, placed with much art upon the heads of two silver Serpents, which in regard of the many boughts wherein they were entertained seemed to be snakes, though they had the visages of women, and three horns on their heads, the explication whereof we could not possibly learn. In each of these Chapels were thirteen branched Candlesticks with seven great lights a piece in them, so that to compute the whole, the candlesticks of these hundred and thirteen Chapels amount to a thousand, four hundred, thirty and nine. In the midst of a great place, environed round about with three rows of winding stairs, and two ranks of idols, was a very high tower, with five steeples diversely painted, and silver Lions on the top of all: Here the Chineses told us were the bones of those hundred and thirteen Kings, that had been transported thither from these Chapels below: And it is the opinion of these brutish people, that these bones, which they hold for great relics, do feast one another at every new Moon; in regard whereof these Barbarians use on that day to offer unto them a great Charger full of all kind of fowl, as also Rice, Beef, Pork, Sugar, Hony, and all other sorts of victual that one can name; wherein their blindness is such, as in recompense of these meats, which the Priests take unto themselves, they imagine that all their sins are forgiven them, by way as it were of a plenory indulgence. In this tower likewise we saw an exceeding rich Chamber, covered on the inside all over from the top to the bottom with plates of silver. In this Chamber were the Statues of those hundred and thirteen Kings of China all of silver, where in each of them were the bones of each several King enclosed; Now they hold, according as they are made to believe by their priests, that these Kings thus assembled together converse every night one with another, and pass away the time in sundry sports, which none is worthy to see, but certain Bonzes, whom they term Cabizundes, a title amongst them of the most eminent dignity, such it may be as the Cardinals of Rome. To this beastly ignorance the wretches add many other blind tales, which they are assuredly persuaded are very clear and manifest truths: Within this great enclosure we counted in seventeen places three hundred and forty bells of cast metal, namely twenty in each place, which are all rung together on those days of the Moon, wherein they say these Kings do visit and feast one another. Near to this tower in a very rich Chapel, built upon seven and thirty pillars of fair hewed stone, was the image of the goddess Amida, made of silver, having her hair of gold, and seated upon a Tribunal fourteen steps high, that was all overlaid with fine gold; Her face was very beautiful, and her hands were heaved up towards Heaven, at her armpits hung a many of little idols not above half a finger long filled together, whereupon demanding of the Chinese what those meant, they answered us, That after the waters of Heaven had overflowed the earth, so that all mankind was drowned by an universal Deluge, God seeing that the world would be desolate, and no body to inhabit it, he sent the goddess Amida, the chief Lady of honour to his wife Nacapirau from the Heaven of the Moon, that she might repair the loss of drowned mankind, and that then the goddess having set her feet on a Land, from which the waters were withdrawn, called Calemphuy, (which was the same Island, whereof I have spoken heretofore, in the straight of Nanquin, whereof Antonio de Faria went on land) she was changed all into gold, and in that manner standing upright with her face looking up unto Heaven, she sweat out at her armpits a great number of children, namely males out of the right, and females out of the left, having no other place about her body whence she might bring them forth, as other women of the world have, who have sinned, and that for a chastisement of their sin, God by the order of nature hath subjected them to a misery full of corruption and filthiness, for to show how odious unto him the sin was that had been committed against him. The goddess Amida having thus brought forth these creatures, which they affirm were thirty three thousand, three hundred, thirty and three, two parts of them females, and the other males, for so say they the world was to be repaired, she remained so feeble and faint with this delivery, having no body to assist her at her need, that she fell down dead in the place, for which cause the Moon at that time in memory of this death of hers, whereat she was infinitely grieved, put herself into mourning, which mourning they affirm to be those black spots we ordinarily behold in her face, occasioned indeed by the shadow of the earth, and that when there shall be so many years ran out, as the goddess Amida brought forth children, which were, as I have delivered, thirty three thousand, three hundred, thirty and three, than the Moon will put off her mourning, and afterwards be as clear as the day. With these and such like fopperies did the Chineses so turmoil us, as we could not choose but grieve to consider how much those people, which otherwise are quick of apprehension, and of good understanding, are abused in matter of Religion with such evident and manifest untruths. After we were come out of this great place, where we saw all these things, we went unto another Temple of religious Votaries, very sumptuous and rich, where they told us the Mother of the then reigning King, named Nhay Camisama, did abide, but thereunto we were not permitted to enter, because we were strangers; From this place through a street, arched all along, we arrived at a Key, called Hichario Topileu, where lay a great number of vessels, full of pilgrims from divers Kingdoms, which came incessantly on pilgrimage to this Temple, for to gain, as they believe, plenary indulgences, which the King of China, and the Chaems of the Government, do grant unto them, besides many privileges and franchises throughout the whole Country, where victuals are given them abundantly, and for nothing. I will not speak of many other Temples, or Pagodes, which we saw in this City whilst we were at liberty, for I should never have done to make report of them all, howbeit I may not omit some other particulars, that I hold very fit to be related before I break off this discourse; whereof the first were certain houses, in several parts of this City, called Laginampurs, that is to say, The School of the poor, wherein fatherless and motherless children, that are found in the streets, are taught to write and read, as also some trade, whereby they may get their living, and of these houses, or schools, there are about some five hundred in this City; Now if it happen that any of them through some defect of nature cannot learn a trade, then have they recourse to some means for to make them get their living according to each one's incommodity; As for example, if they be blind they make them labour in turning of handmils; if they be lame of their feet, they cause them to make laces, ribbon, and such like manufactures; if they be lame of their hands, than they make them earn their living by carrying of burdens; but if they be lame both of feet and hands, so that nature hath wholly deprived them of means to get their living, than they shut them up in great Convents, where there are a number of persons that pray for the dead, amongst whom they place them, and so they have their share of half the offerings that are made there, the Priests having the other half; if they be dumb, than they are shut up in a great house, where they are maintained with the amerciaments that the common sort of women, as oyster-wives, and such like, are condemned in for their scolding and fight one with another; As for old queans, that are past the trade, and such of the younger sort as by the lewd exercise thereof are become diseased with the pox, or other filthy sickness, they are put into other houses, where they are very well looked unto, and furnished abundantly with all things necessary, at the charge of the other women that are of the same trade, who thereunto pay a certain sum monthly, and that not unwillingly, because they know that they shall come to be so provided for themselves by others, and for the collecting of this money there are Commissioners expressly deputed in several parts of the City. There are also other houses, much like unto Monasteries, where a great many of young maids, that are Orphan's, are bred up, and these houses are maintained at the charge of such women as are convicted of adultery; for say they it is most just, that if there be one which hath lost herself by her dishonesty, there should be another, that should be maintained by her virtue. Other places there are also, where decayed old people are kept at the charge of Lawyers, that plead unjust causes, where the parties have no right; and of Judges, that for favouring one more th●n another, and corrupted with bribes, do not execute justice as they ought to do; whereby one may see with how much order and policy these people govern all things. §. 2 In the prosecution of my discourse it will not be amiss here to deliver the marvellous order and policy, which the Kings of China observe in furnishing their States abundantly with provisions and victuals, for the relief of the poor people, which may very well serve for an example of charity, and good government, to Christian Kingdoms and Commonwealths. Their Chronicles report, that a certain King, great Grandfather to him that then reigned in China, named Chausi-Zarao Panagor, very much beloved of his people for his good disposition and virtues, having lost his sight by an accident of sickness, resolved to do some pious work, that might be acceptable to God, to which effect he assembled his Estates, where he ordained, that for the relief of the poor there should be Granaries established in all the Towns of his Kingdom for wheat and rice, that in the time of dearth (which many times happened) the people might have wherewithal to nourish themselves that year, and to that purpose he gave the tenth part of the Duties of his Kingdom by a Grant under his hand, which when he came to sign accordingly with a golden stamp, that he ordinarily used because he was blind, it pleased God to restore him perfectly to his sight again, which he enjoyed still as long as he lived; By this example, if it were true, it seemed that our Lord Jesus Christ would demonstrate, how acceptable the charity that good men exercise towards the poor is to him, even though they be Gentiles, and without the knowledge of the true Religion; Ever since there have been always a great many of Granaries in this Monarchy, and that to the number of an hundred and fourteen thousand. As for the order which the Magistrates observe in furnishing them continually with corn, is such as followeth; A little before reaping time all the old corn is distributed ●orth to the inhabitants, as it were by way of love, and that for the term of two months, after this time is expired, they unto whom the old corn was lent, return in as much new, and withal six in the hundred over and above for waste, to the end that this store may never fail: But when it falls out to be a dear year, in that case the corn is distributed to the people without taking any gain or interest for it, and that which is given to the poorer sort, who are not able to repay what hath been lent to them, is made good out of the Rents, which the Countries pay to the King, as an alms bestowed on them by his special grace. Touching the King's Revenues, which are paid in silver Picos, they are divided into three parts, whereof the first is for the maintenance of the King, and his State, the second for the defence of the Provinces, as also for the provisions of Magazines, and Armies, and the third to be laid up and reserved in a Treasury, that is in this City of Pequin, which the King himself may not touch, unless it be upon occasion for defence of the Kingdom, and to oppose the Tartars, Cauchins, and other Neighbouring Princes, who many times make grievous war upon him. This Treasure is by them called Chidampur, that is to say, The wall of the Kingdom, for they say, that by means of this treasure, being well employed and carefully managed, the King needs lay no impositions upon the people, so that they shall not be any ways vexed and oppressed, as it happens in other Kingdoms for want of this providence. Now by this that I have related one may see, how in all the great Monarchy the Government is so excellent, the Laws so exactly observed, and every one so ready and careful to put the Prince's Ordinances in execution, that Father Navier, having well noted it, was wont to say, that if ever God would grant him the grace to return into Portugal, he would become a Suitor to the King for to peruse over the rules and ordinances of those people, and the manner how they govern both in time of war and peace; adding withal that he did not think the Romans ever ruled so wisely in all the time of their greatest prosperity, and that in matter of policy the Chineses surpassed all other Nations of whom the Ancients have written. CHAP. XXXVII. The great number of Officers, and other people, which are in the King of China's Palace; with our going to Quincay to accomplish the time of our Exile; and what befell us there. OUt of the fear I am in left coming to relate in particular all those things which we saw within the large enclosure of this City of Pequin, they that shall chance to read them may call them in question, and not to give occasion also unto detractors, who judging of things according to the little world they have seen, may hold those truths for fables, which mine own eyes have beheld, I will forbear the delivery of many matters, that possibly might bring much contentment to more worthy spirits, who not judging of the riches and prosperity of other Countries by the poverty and misery of their own, would be well pleased with the relation thereof. Howbeit on the other side I have no great cause to blame those, who shall not give credit to that which I say, or make any doubt of it, because I must acknowledge, that many times when I call to mind the things that mine eyes have seen, I remain confounded therewith, whither it be the Grandeurs of this City of Pequin, or the magnificence wherewith this Gentile King is served, or the pomp of the Chaems, and Anchacies of the Government, or the dread and awe wherein all men are of these Ministers, or the sumptuousness of their Temples and Pagodes, together with all the rest that may be there, for within the only enclosure of the King's Palace there are above a thousand Eunuches, three thousand women, and 12 thousand men of his Guard, unto whom the King gives great entertainment and pentions: also twelve Tutons, dignities that are Sovereign above all others, whom, as I have already declared, the vulgar call, The beams of the Sun; Under these twelve Tutons, there are forty Chaems, or Viceroys, besides many other inferior dignities, as Judges, Majors, Governors, Treasurers, Admirals, and Generals, which they term, Anchacies, Aytaos, Ponchacy, Lauteas, and Chumbims, whereof there are above five hundred always residing at the Court, each of them having at the least two hundred men in his train, which for the most part to strike the greater terror are of divers Nations, namely, Megores, Persians, Curazens, Moems, Calaminhams, Tartars, Cauchins, and some Braamas of Chaleu, and Tanguu; for in regard of valour▪ they make no account of the Natives, who are of a weak and effeminate complexion, though otherwise I must confess they are exceeding able and ingenious in whatsoever concerneth Mechanic Trade's Tillage, and Husband●y; they have withal a great vivacity of spirit, and are exceeding proper and apt for the inventing of very subtle & industrious things. The women are fair and chaste, and more inclined to labour then the men, The Country is fertile in victual, and so rich & abounding in all kind of good things, as I cannot sufficiently express it, & such is their blindness as they attribute all those blessings to the only merit of their King, and not to the Divine Providence, and to the goodness of that Sovereign Lord, who hath created all things. From this blindness and incredulity of these people are these great abuses, and confused superstitions derived, which are ordinary amongst them, and wherein they observe a world of diabolical ceremonies; For they are so brutish and wicked as to sacrifice humane blood, offering it up with divers sorts of perfumes, and sweet savours; Moreover they present their Priests with many gifts, upon assurance from these profane wretches, of great blessings in this life, and infinite riches and treasure in the other; To which effects the same Priests grant them I know not what Certificates, as it were Bills of Exchange, which the common people call Couchinnoces, that after their death they may serve above in Heaven to procure for them a recompense of an hundred for one; wherein these miserable creatures are so blinded, that they save the very meat & drink from their own mouths to furnish those accursed priests of Satan with all things necessary, believing that these goodly ●ills they have from them, will assuredly return them that benefit. There are also Priests of another Sect, called Naustolins, who contrary to those others preach, and affirm with great oaths, that reasonable creatures live and die like beasts, & therefore that they are to make merry▪ & spend their goods jovially while life shall last, there being no other after this, as all but fools & ignorants are to believe. There is another Sect, named Trimechau, who are of opinion that so long time as a man shall live in this world, so long shall he remain under ground, until at length by the prayers of their priests his soul shall reassume the body of a child of seven days old, wherein he shall live again till he shall grow so strong, as to re-enter into the old body, which he head left in the grave, and so be transported into the Heaven of the Moon, where they say he shall live many years, & in the end be converted into a star, which shall remain fixed above in the Firmament for ever. Another Sect there is called Gyson, who believe that only the beasts in regard of their sufferings, and the labour which they endure in this life, shall possess Heaven after their death, & not man, that leadeth his life according to the lusts of the flesh, robbing, kill, and committing a world of other offences, by reason whereof, say they, it is not possible for him to be saved, unless at the hour of death he leave all his estate to the Pagodes, and to the Priests, that they may pray for him; whereby one may see that all the intentions of their diabolical Sects is not founded but upon a very tyranny, and upon the interests of the Bonzes, who are they that preach this pernitions doctrine to the people, and persuaded them with many fables to believe it; In the mean time these things seem so true to these wretches that hear them, as they very willingly give them all their goods, imagining that thereby only they can be saved, and freed from those punishments and fears, wherewithal they threaten them if they do otherwise. I have spoken here of no more than these three Sects, omitting the rest of the two and thirty, which are followed in this great Empire of China, as well because I should never have done (as I have said heretofore) if I would relate them all at large, as for that by these it may be known what the others are, which are nothing better, but in a manner even the very same; wherefore leaving the remedy of such evils, and great blindness to the mercy and providence of God, unto whom only it appertains; I will pass on to the declarations of the miseries we endured during our exille in the Town of Quancy, until such time as we were made slaves by the Tartars, which happened in the year, 1544. §. 2. We had been now two months and an half in this City of Pequin, when as on Saturday, the thirteenth of july, 1554. we were carried away to the Town of Quansy, there to serve all the time that we were condemned unto: Now as soon as we arrived there, the Chaem caused us to be brought before him, and after he had asked us some questions, he appointed us to be of the number of fourscore Halberdiers, which the King assigned him for his Guard; This we took as a special favour from God, both in regard this employment was not very painful, as also because the entertainment was good, and the pay of it better, being assured besides that at the time we should recover our liberty. Thus lived we almost a month very peaceably▪ and well contented for that we met with a better fortune than we expected, when as the devil, seeing how well all we nine agreed together (for all that we had was in common amongst us, and whatsoever misery any one had we shared it with him like true brothers,) he so wrought that two of our company tell into a quarrel, which proved very prejudicial to us all; This division sprung from a certain vanity too familiar with the Portugal Nation, whereof I can render no other reason, but that they are naturally sensible of any thing that touches upon honour's Now see what the difference was, two of us nine falling by chance in contest about the extraction of the Madureyras and the Fonsecas, for to know which of these two houses was in most esteem at the King of Portugal's Court, the matter went so far, that from one word to another they came at length to terms of oyster-wives, saying one to the other, Who are you? and again, who are you? so that thereupon they suffered themselves to be so transported with choler, that one of them gave the other a great box on the ear, who instantly returned him a blow with his sword, which cut away almost half his cheek, this same feeling himself hurt caught up an halberd, and therewith ran the other through the arm; this disaster begot such partaking amongst us, as of nine that we were seven of us found ourselves grievously wounded; In the mean time the Chaem came running in person to this tumult with all the Anchacies of Justice, who laying hold of us gave us presently thirty lashes a piece, which drew more blood from us than our hurts; This done, they shut us up in a dungeon under ground, where they kept us six and forty days with heavy iron collars about our necks, manacles on our hands, and irons on our legs, so that we suffered exceedingly in this deplorable estate. This while our business was brought before the King's Attorney, who having seen our accusations, and that one of the articles made faith, that there were sixteen witnesses against us, he stuck not to say, That we were people without the fear or knowledge of God, who did not confess him otherwise with our mouths, then as any wild beast might do if he could speak; that these things presupposed it was to be believed, that we were men of blood, of a Language, of a Law, of a Nation, of a Country, and of a Kingdom, the inhabitants whereof wounded and killed one another most cruelly, without any reason or cause, and therefore no other judgement could be made of us, but that we were the servants of the most gluttonous Serpent of the profound pit of smoke, as appeared by our work, since they were no better than such as that accursed Serpent had accustomed to do, so that according to the Law of the third Book of the will of the Son of the Sun, called Mileterau, we were to be condemned to a banishment from all commerce of people, as a venomous and contagious plague; so that we deserved to be confined to the Mountains of Chabaguay, Sumbor, or Lamau, whither such as we were use to be exiled, to the end they might in that place hear the wild beasts howl in the night, which were of as vile a breed and nature as we. From this prison we were one morning led to a place, called by them Pitau Calidan, whe●e the Anchacy sat in judgement with a majestical and dreadful greatness; He was accompanied by divers Chumbims, Vppes, Lanteas, and Cypatons, besides a number of other persons; there each of us had thirty lashes a piece more given us, and then by public sentence we were removed to another prison, where we were in better case yet then in that out of which we came, howbeit for all that we did not a little detest amongst ourselves both the Fonsecas, and the Madureyras, but much more the devil, that wrought us this mischief. In this prison we continued almost two months, during which time our stripes were throughly healed, howbeit we were exceedingly afflicted with hunger, and thirst. At length it pleased God that the Chaem took compassion of us; for on a certain day, wherein they use to do works of charity for the dead, coming to review our sentence he ordained, That in regard we were strangers, and of a Country so far distant from theirs, as no man had any knowledge of us, nor that there was any book, or writing which made mention of our name, and that none understood our language; as also that we were accustomed, and even hardened to misery and poverty, which many times puts the best and most peaceable persons into disorder, and therefore might well trouble such, as made no profession of patience in their adversities, whence it followed, that our discord proceeded rather from the effects of our misery, then from any inclination unto mutiny and tumult, wherewith the King's Attorney charged us; and furthermore representing unto himself what great need there was of men for the ordinary service of the State, and of the Officers of justice, for which provision necessarily was to be made, he thought fit, that the punishment for the crimes we had committed, should in the way of an alms bestowed in the King's name be moderated, and reduced to the whipping which we had twice already had, upon condition nevertheless that we should be detained there as slaves for ever, unless it should please the Tuton otherwise to ordain of us. This sentence was pronounced against us, and though we shed a many of tears to see ourselves reduced unto this miserable condition, wherein we were, yet this seemed not so bad unto us as the former. After the publication of this Decree we were presently drawn out of prison, and tied three and three together, then led to certain iron Forges, where we passed six whole months in strange labours, and great necessities, being in a manner quite naked, without any bed to lie on, and almost famished. At last after the enduring of so many evils, we fell sick of a Lethargy, which was the cause, in regard it was a contagious disease, that they turned us out of doors for to go and seek our living, until we became well again. Being thus set at liberty we continued four months sick, and begging the alms of good people from door to door, which was given us but sparingly, by reason of the great dearth that then reigned over all the Country, so as we were constrained to agree better together, and to promise one another by a solemn oath, that we took, to live lovingly for the future, as good Christians should do, and that every month one should be chosen from amongst us to be as it were a kind of Chief, whom, by the oath we had taken, all the rest of us were to obey, as their Superior, so that none of us was to dispose of himself, nor do any thing, without his command, or appointment; and those rules were put into writing by us, that they might be the better observed; As indeed God gave us the grace to live ever afterward in good peace and concord, though it were in great pain, and extreme necessity of all things. We had continued a good while living in peace and tranquillity, according to our forementioned agreement, when as he, whose lot it was to be our Chief that month, §. 3 named Christovano Boralho, considering how necessary it was to seek out some relief for our miseries by all the ways that possibly we could, appointed us to serve weekly two and two together, some in begging up and down the Town, some in getting water and dressing our meat, and others in fetching wood from the Forest, both for our own use, & to sell. Now one day myself & one Gaspar de Meyrelez being enjoined to go to the Forest, we rose betimes in the morning, & went forth to perform our charge; And because this Gaspar de Meyrelez was a pretty Musician, playing well on a Cittern, whereunto he accorded his voice, which was not bad, being parts that are very agreeable to those people, in regard they employ the most part of their times in the delights of the flesh, they took great pleasure in hearing of him, so as for that purpose they invited him very often to their sports, from whence he never returned without some reward, wherewith we were not a little assisted: As he and I then were going to the wood, and before we were out of the Town, we met by fortune in one of the streets with a great many of people, who full of jollity were carrying a dead corpse to the grave with divers banners, and other funeral pomp, in the midst whereof was a Consort of music and voices; Now he, that had the chief ordering of the Funeral, knowing Gaspar de Meyrelez, made him stay, and putting a Cittern into his hands, he said unto him, Oblige me, I pray thee, by singing as loud as thou canst, so as thou mayst be heard by this dead man whom we are carrying to burial, for I swear unto thee, that he went away very sad for that he was separated from his wife and children, whom he dearly loved all his life time. Gaspar de Meyrelez would fain have excused himself, alleging many reasons thereupon to that end, but so far was the Governor of the Funeral from accepting them, that contrarily he answered him very angrily. Truly, if thou wilt not deign to benefit this defunct with the gift, that God hath given thee, of singing, and playing on this instrument, I will no longer say, that thou art an holy man, as we all believed hitherto, but that the excellency of that voice which thou hast comes from the inhabitants of the house of smoke, whose nature it was at first to sing very harmoniously, though now they weep and wail in the profound lake of the night, like hungerstarved dogs, that gnashing their teeth, and foaming with rage against men discharge the froth of their malice by the offences, which they commit against him, that lives in the highest of the Heavens. After this ten or eleven of them were so earnest with Gaspar de Meyrelez, as they made him play almost by force, and led him to the place, where the deceased was to be burnt, according to the custom of those Gentiles. In the mean time seeing myself left alone without my comrade I went along to the Forest for to get some wood according to my Commission, and about evening returning back with my load on my back I met with an old man in a black damask Gown furred clean through with white Lamb, who being all alone, as soon as he espied me, he turned a little out of the way, but perceiving me to pass on without regarding him, he cried so loud to me, that I might hear him, which I no sooner did, but casting my eye that way, I observed that he beckoned to me with his hand, as if he called me, whereupon imagining there was something more than ordinary, herein I said unto him in the Chinese Language, Potauquinay, which is, Dost thou call me? whereunto returning no answer, he gave me to understand by signs that in effect he called me; conjecturing then that there might be some thiefs thereabouts, which would bereave me of my load of wood, I threw it on the ground to be the better able to defend myself, and with my staff in my hand, I went fair and softly after him, who seeing me follow him began to double his pace athwart a little path, which confirmed me in the belief I had before that he was some thief, so that turning back to the place where I left my load, I got it up again on my back as speedily as I could, with a purpose to get into the great high way, that led unto the City; But the man guessing at my intention, began to cry out louder to me then before, which making me turn my look towards him, I presently perceived him on his knees, and showing me afar off a silver cross about a span long, or thereabout, lifting up withal both his hands unto Heaven; whereat being much amazed, I could not imagine what this man should be, in the mean time he with a very pitiful gesture ceased not to make signs unto me to come to him; whereupon somewhat recollecting myself, I resolved to go and see who he was, and what he would have, to which end with my staff in my hand I walked towards him, where he stayed for me; when as then I came near him, having always thought him before to be a Chinese, I wondered to see him cast himself at my feet, and with tears and sighs to say thus unto me, Blessed and praised be the sweet Name of our Lord jesus Christ, after so long an exile hath showed me so much grace, as to let me see a Christian man, that professeth the Law of my God fixed on the Cross. I must confess that when I heard so extraordinary a matter, and so far beyond my expectation, I was therewith so surprised, that scarcely knowing what I said, I conjure thee, answered I unto him, in the Name of our Lord jesus to tell me who thou art? At these words this unknown man redoubling his tears, Dear Brother, replied he, I am a poor Christian, by Nation a Portugal, and named Vasco Calvo, brother to Diego Calvo, who was sometime Captain of Don Nuna Manoel his ship, and made a Slave here in this Country about seven and twenty years since, together with one Tome Perez, who Loppo Soarez sent as Ambassador into this Kingdom of China, and that since died miserably by the occasion of a Portugal Captain. Whereupon coming throughly to myself again, I lifted him up from the ground where he lay weeping like a child; and shedding no fewer tears than he, I entreated him that we might sit down together, which he would hardly grant, so desirous he was to have me go presently with him to his house, but sitting down by me he began to discourse the whole success of his travels, and all that had befallen him since his departure from Portugal, till that very time, as also the death of the Ambassador Tom Perez, and of all the rest, whom Fernand Perez d' Amdrada had left at Canton to go to the King of China, which he recounted in another manner than our Historians have delivered it. After we had spent the remainder of the day in entertaining one another with our passed adventures, we went to the City, where having showed me his house, he desired me that I would instantly go and fetch the rest of my fellows, which accordingly I did, and found them all together in the poor lodging where we lay, and having declared unto them what had befallen me, they were much abashed at it, as indeed they had cause, considering the stratagems of the accident, so they went presently along with me to Vasco Calvoes house, who waiting for us, gave us such hearty welcome, as we could not choose but weep for joy; Then he carried us into a Chamber where was his wife, with two little boys, and two girls of his; she entertained us very kindly, and with as much demonstration of love, as if she had been the mother or daughter to either of us; After this we sat down at the table, which he had caused to be covered, and made a very good meal of many several dishes provided for us: Supper done, his wife arose very courteously from the table, and taking a key which hung at her girdle, she opened the door of an Oratory, where there was an altar, with a silver cross, as also two candlesticks, and a lamp of the same, and then she and her four children falling down on their knees, with their hands lift up to Heaven, began to pronounce these words very distinctly in the Portugal tongue: O thou true God, we wretched sinners do confess before thy Cross, like good Christians, as we are, the most sacred Trinity, Father, Son, and Holy Ghost, three Persons, and one God; and also we promise to live and die in thy most Holy Catholic Faith, like good and true Christians, confessing and believing so much of thy holy truth, as is held and believed by thy Church; In like manner we offer up unto thee our souls, which thou hast redeemed with thy most precious blood, for to be wholly employed in thy service all the time of our lives, and then to be yielded unto thee at the hour of our death, as to our Lord and God, unto whom we acknowledge they appertain both by Creation and Redemption. After this Confession they said the Lords Prayer, and the Creed, which they pronounced very distinctly, whereat we could not choose but shed a world of tears to see these innocents', born in a Country, so far remote from ours, and where there was no knowledge of the true God, thus to confess his Law in such religious terms. This being done, we returned because it was three of the clock in the morning to our lodging, exceedingly astonished at that we had seen, as at a thing which we had great reason to admire. CHAP. XXXVIII. A Tartar Commander enters with his Army into the Town of Quincay, and that which followed thereupon; with the Nauticors besieging the Castle of Nixiamcoo, and the taking of it by the means of some of us Portugals. WE had been now eight months and an half in this captivity, §. 1. wherein we endured much misery, and many incommodities, for that we had nothing to live upon but what we got by begging up and down the Town, when as one Wednesday, the third of july, in the year 1544. a little after midnight there was such a hurly burly amongst the people, that to hear the noise and cries which was made in every part, one would have thought the earth would have come over and over, which caused us to go in haste to Vasco Calvo his house, of whom we demanded the occasion of so great a tumult, whereunto with tears in his eyes he answered us, that certain news were come how the King of Tartary was fallen upon the City of Pequin with so great an Army, as the like had never been seen since Adam's time▪ In this army, according to report, were seven and twenty Kings, under whom marched eighteen hundred thousand men, whereof six hundred thousand were horse, which were come by land from the Cities of Luançama, Famstir, and Mecuy, with fourscore thousand Rhinocerots, that draw the wagons, wherein was all the Baggage of the Army; as for the other twelve hundred thousand, which were foot, it was said that they arrived by Sea in seventeen thousand vessels, down through the river of Batampina; By reason whereof the King of China finding himself too weak for the resisting of such great forces, had with a few retired himself to the City of Nanquin. And that also it was reported for a certain, that a Nauticor, one of the chiefest Tartar Commanders, was come to the Forest of Malincataran, not above a league and an half from Quinçay, with an Army of threescore and two thousand Horse, wherewith he marched against the Town, that in all likelihood he would be there within two hours at the furthest. These news so troubled us, that we did nothing but look one upon another, without being able to speak a word to any purpose, howbeit desiring to save ourselves, we prayed Vasco Calvo to show us what means he thought we might use to effect it, who sad and full of grief thus answered us; O that we were in our Country between Laura and Carncha, where I have often been, and should be there now in safety, but since it cannot be so, all that we can do for the present, is to recommend ourselves to God, and to pray unto him to assist us; for I assure you that an hour ago I would have given a thousand Taeis in silver to any one, that could have got me from hence, and saved me with my wife and children, but there was no possibility for it, because the gates were then all shut up, and the walls round about environed with armed men, which the Chaem hath placed there to withstand the enemy. So my fellows and I, that were nine in number, past the rest of the night there in much affliction and unquietness, without any means of counselling one another, or resolving on what we were to do, continually weeping for the extreme fear we were in of what should become of us. The next morning a little before Sunrising the enemy appeared in a most dreadful manner, they were divided into seven very great Battalions, having their Ensigns quartered with green and white, which are the colours of the King of Tartary; marching in this order to the sound of their Trumpets, they arrived at a Pagode, called Petilau Nam●ioo, a place of good receipt, in regard of the many lodgings it had, which was not much distant from the walls. In their Vanguard they had a number of Light-horse, who ran confusedly up and down with their Lances in their Rests. Being in this sort come to the Pagode, they stayed there about half an hour, and then marching on till they were within an harquebuse shot of the walls, they suddenly ran to them with such hideous cries, as one would have thought that Heaven and Earth would have come together, and rearing up above two thousand Ladders, which for that purpose they had brought along with them, they assaulted the Town on every side with a most invincible courage. Now though the besieged at the beginning made some resistance, yet was it not able to hinder the enemy from effecting his design, for by the means of certain iron rams broking up the four principal gates, they rendered themselves Masters of the Town after they had slain the Chaem, together with a great number of Mandarins, and Gentlemen, that were run thither to keep them from entering; Thus did these Barbarians possess themselves of this miserable Town, whereof they put all the inhabitants they could meet withal to the sword, without sparing any; and it was said that the number of the slain amounted to threescore thousand persons, amongst whom were many women and maids of very great beauty, which appertained to the chiefest Lords of the place. After the bloody Massacre of so much people, and that the Town was fired, the principal houses overthrown, and the most sumptuous Temples laid level with the ground, nothing remaining on foot during the disorder, the Tartars continued there seven days, at the end whereof they returned towards Pequin, where their King was, and from whence he had sent them to this execution, carrying with them a world of gold and silver only, having burnt all the Merchandise they found there, as well because they knew not how to transport it away, as for that the Chineses should not make any benefit of it: Two days after their departure they arrived at a Castle, named Nixianicoo, where the Nauticor of Luançama, their General, pitched his Camp, and entrenched himself on all sides with an intention to take it by assault the next day to be revenged on the Chineses there, for that upon his passing by them towards Quinçay, they had cut off an hundred of his men by an Ambuscado. §. 2 After the Army was encamped, and entrenched, and that the General had placed sure Guards and Sentinels in all places, he retired to his Tent, whither he sent for the seventy Captains that commanded his Army, unto whom upon their arrival he discovered his resolution, which being well approved of they fell into deliberation in what manner the Castle should be assaulted the day following, which concluded on, the next morning as soon as it was light the soldiers began to march towards the Castle, divided into fourteen Bataillions; being come within a flight shoot of it with the sound of trumpets, and most hideous cries, they reared up their Ladders against the walls, and courageously mounted up; but in the heat of this assault, where every one showed his valour, the one in bravely attempting, and the other in well defending, the Tartar in less than two hours lost above three thousand of his men, which made him found a retreat in great disorder, and he passed the rest of that day in burying the dead, and curing of the wounded, whereof, there being a great number, the most part died not long after, for that the arrows wherewith they were hurt had been smeared by the Chinese with so strange and deadly poison, as there was no remedy to be found for it. In the mean time the Tartar Commanders seeing the ill success of this assault, and fearing the King would be offended at so great a loss for so small an occasion, persuaded the General to call another Council, wherein it might be considered, whether it would be most expedient for the King's honour to persist in the Siege of that place, or to give it over, whereupon this affair coming accordingly into deliberation it was a long time debated with such diversity of opinions, as they were not able to conclude upon any thing, so that it was thought fit, in regard it was then late to put off the Assembly till the next day; This resolution taken, every man retired to his quarter. Now we being led away amidst a great many of other slaves, with whom we had escaped out of the fire of the Town, it fell out, whether for our good, or for our greater misfortune, we could not then tell, that we were under the Guard, as prisoners of war, of one of that Assembly, a rich and honourable man, who returning to his tent with three other persons, of like quality to himself, whom he had invited to Supper, it chanced after they were risen from table that one of them espied us, where we stood chained in a corner of the tent, and perceiving us to weep was so moved, that he demanded of us what people we were? what the name of our Country was? and how we came to be slaves to the Chinese? whereunto we gave such an answer, as the Tartar engaging himself further in this discourse, enquired of us whether our King was inclined to the wars, and whether we did use to fight in our Country? to whom one of our companions, named jorge Mendez, replied that we did, and that we had been trained up from our infancy in a military course of life; which so pleased the Tartar, that calling his two friends unto him, Come hither, said he, and have the patience to hear what these prisoners can say; for believe me they seem to be men of understanding; whereupon the other two came near, and hearing us relate some part of our misfortunes, it begat a desire in them to ask us other questions, wherein having satisfied them the best that we could, one of them that seemed more curious than the rest, addressing himself to jorge Mendez, spoke thus; Since you have seen so much of the world, as you say, if there were ere a one amongst you that could find out any device, or stratagem of war, whereby the Mitaquer (for so was the Nauticor called) might take this Castle, I vow to you that he would become your prisoner, whereas you are his. Then jorge Mendez, never considering with what imprudence he spoke, nor understanding what he said, nor into what danger he was putting himself, boldly answered him; If my Lord Mitaquer will in the name of the King g●ve it us under his hand, that we shall have a safe conduct to convey us by Sea to the Isle of Ainan, from whence we may freely return into our Country, possibly I may be the man that will show him how he shall take the Castle with little ado. This Speech being heard, and maturely considered by one of the three, a man in years, and of great authority, as having the honour to be much esteemed and beloved of the Mitaquer, Think well of what thou sayest, replied he to Jorge Mendez, for I assure thee if thou dost it, that whatsoever thou demandest shall be granted thee, I, and more too. Hereupon the rest of us seeing what jorge Mendez was going to undertake, as also how far he engaged himself in his promise, and that the Tartars began already to ground some hope thereupon, we thought fit to reprehend him for it, and to tell him, that he was not to hazard himself so at random by promising a thing that might bring us into the danger of our lives. I fear nothing less, said he unto us, for as for my life, in the estate where now I am, I make so little account of it, that if any of these Barbarians would play for it at Primero, I would with three of the worst cards in the pack venture it upon the first encounter, for I am confident that all the benefit they can expect from us will never oblige them to grant us either life or liberty, so that for my particular I had as lief die to day as to morrow, judge you only by that which you saw them do at Quincay, whether you are likely to be better dealt withal now. The Tartars were much abashed to see us thus in contestation one with another, and to hear us talk so loud, which is not usual amongst them, wherefore they reprehended us very seriously, saying, That it was for women to speak aloud, who could not put a bridle to their tongue, nor a key to their mouths, and not for men, that carry a sword, and are made for the wars: Howbeit if it were so that Jorge Mendez could execute what he had propounded, the Mitaquer could not refuse him any thing he could demand. This said, the Tartars retired every one to his lodging, for that it was eleven of the clock at night, the first watch being newly passed, and the Captains of the Guard beginning then to walk the round about the camp at the sound of divers instruments, as is the custom in semblable occasions. The same of the three Tartar Commanders, & sect;. 1. which I said before was so esteemed of by the Mitaquer, had no sooner learned of jorge Mendez, that he could tell how to take the Castle of Nixiamcoo, but that he went presently to acquaint the General with it, and making the matter greater than it was, he told him, that he could do no less than send for him to hear his reasons, which peradventure would persuade him to give credit unto him, and in case it proved not so, yet was there nothing lost thereby. The Mitaquer being well pleased with this advice, sent incontinently a Command to Tileymay, which was the Captain under whose Guard we were, for to bring us unto him, as presently he did. Being then arrived, chained as we were, at the Mitaquers Tent, we found him set in Council with the seventy Commanders of the Army about two hours after midnight; At our coming he received us with an affable countenance, yet grave and severe, and causing us to approach nearer unto him, he commanded part of our chains to be undone, then asked us if we would eat, whereunto we answered most willingly, for that in three days together we had not so much as tasted a bit of any thing, whereat the Mitaquer was very much offended, and sharply reproving the Tileymay for it, willed two great platters of sodden rice, and Ducks cut in small pieces to be set before us, whereto we fell with such an appetite, like men that were almost famished, as those of the company, who took great pleasure to see us feed so, said to the Mitaquer, When as you had nothing else, my Lord, but cause these to come before you for to flack their hunger, verily you had done very much for them, by saving them from a languishing death, which otherwise they could not have avoided, and so you might have lost these slaves, of whom the service or sale might have been some way profitable unto you, for if you will not make use of them at Lancama, you may sell them for a thousand Taeis at least. Hereat some began to laugh, but the Mitaquer commanded more rice to be given us, together with some apples, and other things, conjuring us again to eat, as a thing which he took pleasure to see us do, wherein we most willingly gave him satisfaction. After we had fed well, he began to talk with jorge Mendez about that which had been told him of him, and of the means that were to be used for taking the Castle, making him many great promises of honours, pentions, ●avour with the King, and liberty for all the rest of his fellows, with other such offers, as passed all measure: For he swore unto him that if by his means God should give him the victory, whereby he sought nothing but to be revenged on his enemies for the blood which they had shed of his men, he should every way be like unto himself, or at least to any of his children which soever; Herewith jorge Mendez found himself somewhat perplexed, because he held it almost impossible for him to bring it to effect, howsoever he told him, that not to hold him longer in hand, he did not think but if he might view the Castle with his own eyes, he might then peradventure let him know how it might be taken, wherefore if his Lordship pleased, he would the next morning consider it all about, and thereupon render him an account what course was to be taken therein. The Mitaquer, & all the rest, allowed very well of his answer, and greatly commending him for it sent us to be lodged in a Tent not far from his, where we spent the rest of the night under a sure Guard; you may judge now in what fear we were, knowing that if the business did not succeed according to the desire of these Barbarians, they would cut us all in pieces, for that they were a people which for never so small a matter would not stick to kill twenty or thirty men, without any regard either of God, or any thing else. The next morning about eight of the clock, jorge Mendez, and two of us, that were appointed to accompany him, went to survey the place with thirty horse for our safeguard; when as jorge Mendez h●d well observed the situation thereof, as also that part whereby it might most commodiously be assaulted, he returned to the Mitaquer, that expected him with impatience, to whom he gave an acount of what he had seen, and facilitated the taking of the Castle with little hazard, whereat the Mitaquer was so overjoyed, that he presently caused the rest of our irons, and the chains, wherewith we were fastened by the neck and feet to be taken off, swearing to us by the rice he did eat, that as soon as he came to P●quin, he would present us to the King, and infallibly accomplish all that he had promised us, for the more assurance whereof he confirmed it by a Deed under his hand, that was written in letters of gold, to make it more authentical. That done, he sent for us to dinner, and would needs have us to sit with him at table, doing us many other honours according to their manner, which greatly contented us, but on the other side we were in no little fear, lest this affair should not for our sins have a success answerable to that hope the Mitaquer had already conceived of it. The rest of this day the Commanders spent in resolving upon the order that was to be observed for assaulting the Castle, wherein jorge Mendez was the sole Director: First of all then an infinite company of B●vins & Faggots was gotten together for to fill up the ditches; there were also three hundred Ladders made, very strong, and so large, that three men might easily mount up on them a front without incombring one another; likewise there was a world of Paniers, Dossers, and Baskets provided, together with a great multitude of Mattocks, and Spades, that were found in the Villages and Burroughs thereabout, which the inhabitants had deserted upon the bruit of this war, and all the soldiers of the Army made preparation of such things as they should need the next day when the assault was to be given a In the mean time jorge Mendez road always by the Mitaquers side, who showed him many great favours, which we perceived had begotten in him a stately carriage, far different from that he was wont to have, whereat we wondering, some of us (who envious of another's good fortune, and out of an ill nature) could not choose but murmur, saying one to another, as it were in disdain, and in a kind of jeering, What think you of this dog? verily he will be the cause that either to morrow morning we shall be all cut in pieces, or if the business he hath undertaken succeed as we desire, it is probable that he will be in such credit with these Barbarians, that we shall account it for a happiness to be his servants; and this was the talk which we had amongst us. The next day all the Army was put into order, and divided into twelve battalions, whereof they made twelve Files, and one Counterfile in the Vanguard, that encompassed the whole Camp in manner of an half moon: upon the wings were the foremost with all that Mass of Bavins, Ladders, Baskets, Mattocks, Spades, and other materials to fill up the ditch, and make it equal with the rest of the ground. Marching in this manner they arrived at the Castle, which they found strongly manned, and with a number of Flags and Streamers waving upon the Battlements. The first Salutation between the besiegers and the besieged was with arrows, darts, stones, and pots of wildfire, which continued about half an hour, than the Tartars presently filled the ditch with bavins and earth, and so reared up their ladders against the wall, that now by reason of the filling up of the ditch was not very high; The first that mounted up was jorge Mendez, accompanied with two of ours, who as men resolved had set up their rest, either to die there, or to render their valour remarkable by some memorable act, as in effect it pleased our Lord that their resolution had a good success, for they not only entered fi●st, but also planted the first colours upon the wall, whereat the Mitaquer, and all that were with him, were so amazed, as they said one to another, Doubtless if these people did besiege Pequin, as we do, the Chinese, which defend that City, would sooner lose their honour, than we shall make them to do it with all the forces we have; in the mean time all the Tartars, that were at the foot of the ladders, followed the three Portugals, and carried themselv●s so valiantly, what with the example of a Captain that had showed them the way, as out of their own natural disposition, almost as resolute as those of japan, that in a very sh●rt space above 5000 of them were got upon the walls from whence with great violence they made the Chineses to retire, whereupon so furious and bloody a fight ensued between either party, that in less than half an hour the business was fully decided, and the Castle taken, with the death of two thousand Chineses and Mogores that were in it, there being not above sixscore of the Tartars slain. That done the gates being opened, the Mitaquer with great acclamations of joy entered, and causing the Chineses colours to be taken down, and his own to be advanced in their places, he with a new ceremony of rejoicing at the sound of many instruments of war after the the manner of the Tartars gave rewards to the wounded, and made divers of the most valiant of his followers Knights, by putting bracelets of gold about their right arms; and then about noon he with the chief Commanders of his Army, for the greater triumph dined in the Castle, where he also bestowed bracelets of gold upon jorge Mendez, and the other Portugals, whom he made to sit down at table with him; After the cloth was taken away, he went out of the Castle with all his company, and then causing all the walls of it to be dismantelled, ●e razed the place quite to the ground, setting on fire all that remained with a number of ceremonies, which was performed with great cries and acclamations to the sound of dive●s instruments of war; Moreover he commanded the ruins of this Castle to be sprinkled with the blood of his enemies, and the heads of all of them that lay dead there to be cut off; as for his own soldiers that were slain, he caused them to be triumphantly buried, and such as were hurt to be carefully looked unto; this done, he retired with a huge train, and in great pomp to his tent, having jorge Mendez close by him on horseback; As for the other eight of us, together with many brave Noblemen and Captains, we followed him on foot. Being arrived at his tent, which was richly hung, he sent jorge Mendez a thousand Taeis for a reward, and to us but an hundred a piece, whereat some of us, that thought themselves to be better qualified, were very much discontented, for that he was more respected than they, by whose means, as well as his, the enterprise had been so happily achieved, though by the good success thereof we had all obtained honour and liberty. CHAP. XXXIX. The Mitaquer departs from the Castle of Nixiamcoo, and goes to the King of Tartary his Camp before Pequin; with that which we saw till we arrived there; and the Mitaquers presenting us unto the King. THe next day the Mitaquer having nothing more to do where he was, resolved to take his way towards the City of Pequin, §. 1 before which the King lay, as I have delivered before; To this effect having put his Army into battle array, he departed from thence at eight of the clock in the morning, and marching leisurely to the sound of his warlike instruments, he made his first station about noon upon the bank of a river, whose situation was very pleasant, being all about environed with a world of fruit trees, and a many goodly houses, but wholly deserted, and bereft of all things which the Barbarians might any way have made booty of. Having past the greatest heat of the day there, he arose and marched on until about an hour in the night that he took up his lodging at a pretty good Town, called Lantimay, which likewise we found deserted, for all this whole Country was quite dispeopled for fear of the Barbarians, who spared no kind of person, but wheresoever they came put all to fire and sword, as the next day they did by this place, and many other along this river, which they burned down to the ground; and that which yet was more lamentable, they set on fire, and clean consumed to ashes a great large plain, being above six leagues about, and full of corn ready to be reaped. This cruelty executed, the Army began again to move, composed as it was of some threescore and five thousand horse, (for as touching the rest they were all slain, as well at the taking of Quinçay, as in that of the Castle of Nixiamcoo,) and went on to a mountain, named Pommitay, where they remained that night; The next morning dislodging from thence, they marched on somewhat faster than before, that they might arrive by day at the City of Pequin, which was distant about seven leagues from that mountain: At three of the clock in the afternoon we came to the river of Palamxitan, where a Tartar Captain, accompanied with an hundred horse, came to receive us, having waited there two days for that purpose; The first thing that he did, was the delivering of a letter from the King to our General, who received it with a great deal of ceremony; From this river to the King's quarter, which might be some two leagues, the Army marched without order, as being unable to do otherwise, partly as well in regard of the great concourse of people, wherewith the ways were full incoming to see the General's arrival, as for the great train which the Lords brought along with them, that overspread all the fields; In this order, or rather disorder, we arrived at the Castle of Lautir, which was the first Fort of, nine that the Camp had for the retreat of the Spies, there we found a young Prince, whom the Tartar had sent thither to accompany the General, who alighting from his horse, took his Scymitar from his side, and on his knees offered it unto him, after he had kissed the ground five times, being the ceremony or compliment ordinarily used amongst them; The Prince was exceedingly pleased with this honour done unto him, which with a smiling countenance, and much acknowledgement of words he testified unto him; This past, the Prince with a new ceremony stepped two or three paces back, and lifting up his voice with more gravity than before, as he that represented the Person of the King, in whose name he came, said unto him, He, the border of whose rich vesture my mouth kisseth, and that out of an incredible greatness mastereth the Sceptres of the earth, and of the Isles of the Sea, sends thee word by me, who am his slave, that thy honourable arrival is no less agreeable unto him, than the Summer's sweet morning is to the ground, when as the dew doth comfort and refresh our bodies, and therefore would have thee without further delay to come and hear his voice mounted on his horse, whose trappings are garnished with jewels taken out of his Treasury, to the end, that riding by my side, thou mayest be made equal in honour to the greatest of his Court, and that they which behold thee marching in this sort, may acknowledge that the right hand of him is mighty and valiant unto whom the labours of war giveth this recompense. Hereupon the Mitaquer prostrating himself on the earth, with his hands lifted up, answered him thus, Let my head be an hundred times trampled on by the sole of his feet, that all those of my race may be sensible of so great a favour, and that my eldest Son may ever carry it for a mark of honour. Then mounting on the horse, which the Prince had given him, trapped with gold and precious stones, being one of those that the King used to ride on himself, they marched on with a great deal of State and Majesty. In this pomp were many spare horses led richly harnessed; there were also a number of Ushers, carrying silver Maces on their shoulders, and six hundred Halberdiers on horseback, together with fifteen Chariots, full of silver Cymbals, and many other ill tuned barbarous instruments, that made so great a din, as it was not possible to hear one another. Moreover in all this distance of way, which was a league and an half, there were so many men on horseback, as one could hardly pass through the crowd in any part thereof. The Mitaquer being thus in triumph arrived at the first trenches of the Camp, he sent us by one of his Servants to his quarter, where we were very well received, and abundantly furnished with all things necessary for us. Fourteen days after we arrived at ●his Camp, the Mitaquer, our General, §. 2 sent for us to his Tent, where in the presence of some of his Gentlemen, he said unto us; To morrow morning about this time be you ready, that I may make good my word unto you, which is to let you see the face of him, whom we hold for our Sovereign Lord, a grace that is done you out of a particular respect to me; And this his Majesty doth not only grant unto you, but your liberty also, which I have obtained of him for you, and which in truth I am no less glad of, then of the taking of Mixiancoo, the particulars whereof you may relate unto him, if you come to be so happy as to be questioned by him about it. Withal I assure you that I shall take it for a great satisfaction, if when you shall return into your Country, you will remember that I have kept my word with you, and that therein I have showed myself so punctual, as it may be I would not for that consideration demand of the King some other thing more profitable for me, that you may know this was that which I only desired: Also the King hath done me the honour to grant it me presently, and that with such exceeding demonstration of favour, as I must confess I am thereby more obliged unto you, than you are to me. Having spoken thus unto as we prostrated ourselves upon the ground, and in this sort answered him. My Lord, the good which you have pleased to do us is so great, that to go about to thank you with words (as the world useth to do) in the state we now are in, would rather be an ingratitude, than a true and due acknowledgement; so that we think it better to pass it by in silence within the secret of that soul which God hath put into us; And therefore since our tongues are of no use to us herein, and that they cannot frame words, capable to satisfy so great an obligation, as this is, wherein all of us stand for ever so infinitely engaged unto you, we must with continual tears and sighs beg of the Lord which made Heaven and earth, that he will reward you for it; for it is he that out of his infinite mercy and goodness, hath taken upon him to pay that for the poor, which they of themselves are not able to discharge; It is he then, that will throughly recompense you and your children for this good office you have done us, and whereby you merit to have a share in his promises, and to live long and happily in this world. Amongst those which accompanied the Mitaquer at that time, there was one named Bonquinuda, a man in years, and of the principalest Lords of the Kingdom, who in this Army commanded over the strangers and Rhinocerots, that served for the Guard of the Camp; This same, unto whom more respect was born then to all the rest that were present, had no sooner heard our answer, but lifting up his eyes to Heaven he said, O! who could be so happy, as to be able to ask of God the explication of so high a secret, whereunto the weakness of our poor understanding cannot arrive; for I would fain know from whence it comes, that he permits people so for esloigned from the knowledge ●f our truth, to answer on the sudden in terms so agreeable to our ears, that I dare well say, nay, I will venture my head on it, that concerning things of God, and Heaven, they know more sleeping, than we do broad awake, whence it may be inferred that there are Priests amongst them that understand the course of the Stars, and the motions of the Heavens, far better than o●● Bonzes of the house of Lechuna. Whereupon all that were about him answered, Your Greatness hath so much reason for it, that we were obliged to behold it as an Article of our faith, wherefore we think it were fit, that these strangers should not be suffered to go out of our Country, where, as our Masters and Doctors, they might teach us such things they know of the world. That which you advise, replied the Mitaquer, is not much amiss, and yet the King would never permit it for all the treasures of China, because if he should, he would then violate the truth of his word, and so lose all the reputation of his greatness, wherefore you must excuse me if I do not propound things unto him that cannot be; whereupon turning himself towards us, Go, get you gone, said he unto us, and to morrow morning fail not to be ready for to come again when I shall send for you. These words exceedingly contented us, as there was great cause they should; and accordingly the next day he sent us nine horses very well furnished, upon which we mounted, and so went to his Tent; He in the mean time had put himself into a Piambre (that is somewhat like to a Litter) drawn with two horses richly harnessed; round about him for his Guard marched threescore Halberdiers, six pages apparelled in his Livery mounted on white Curtals, and we nine on horseback a little more behind. In this manner he went on towards the place where the King was, whom he ●ound lodged in the great and sumptuous Edifice of the Goddess Nacapirau, by the Chineses called the Queen of Heaven, whereof I have spoken at large in the thirty forth Chapter. Being arrived at the first trenches of the King's Tent, he alighted out of his Litter, and all the rest likewise off ●rom their horses, for to speak to the Nautaran, of whom with a ki●d of ceremony, after the fashion of the Gentiles, he craved leave to enter, which was presently granted him. Thereupon the Mitaqu●r being returned into his Litter, passed through the gates in the same manner as be●ore, only, we and the rest of his followers waited upon him on foot. When he came to a low and very long Gallery, where there was a great number of Gentlemen, he alighted again out of his Litter, and told us that we were to attend him there, for that he would go and know whether it were a fit time to speak with the King, or no. We stayed there then about an hour, during the which some of the Gentlemen that were in the Gallery observing us to be strangers, and such kind of people as they had never seen the like, they called us, and very courteously bid us to sit down by them, where having spent some time in beholding certain tumblers showing ●eats of activity, we perceived the Mitaquer coming forth with four very beautiful boys, attired in long coats after the Turkish fashion▪ guarded all over with green and white, and wearing about the small of their legs little hoops of gold in the fo●m of irons and shackle●. The Gentlemen that were present, as soon as they saw them rose up on their feet, and drawing out their Cour●elasses, which they wore by their sides, they laid them on the ground with a new kind of ceremony, saying three times, Let the Lord of our heads live an hundred thousand years. In the mean while as ●e lay with our heads bending to the ground, one of those boys said aloud unto us; You men of the other end of the world, rejoice now, for that the hour is come, wherein your desire is to be accomplished, and that you are to have the liberty, which the Mitaquer promised you at the Castle of Nixiamcoo, wherefore arise from off the earth, and lift up your hands to Heaven, rendering thanks unto the Lord, who during the night of our peaceable rest, enammels the Firmament with Stars, seeing that of himself alone, without the merit of any flesh, he hath made you to encounter in your exile with a man that delivers your persons. To this Speech, prostrated as we were on the ground, we returned him this answer by our truchman, May Heavens grant us so much happiness, as that his foot may trample on our heads; whereunto he replied, Your wish is not small, and may it please God to accord you this gift of riches. §. 3. These four boys, and the Mitaquer, whom we followed, passed through a Gallery, erected upon five and twenty pillars of br●ss, and entered into a great room, where there were a number of Gentlemen, and amongst them many strangers, Mogores, Persians, Bordies, Calami●hams, and Bramaas. After we were out of this room, we came unto another, where there were many armed men, ranged into five Files all along the room, with Courtelasses on their shoulders, that were garnished with gold. T●ese stayed the Mitaquer a little, and with great compliments asked him some questions, and took his oath upon the Maces the boys carried, which he performed on his knees, kissing the ground three several times, whereupon he was admitted to pass on into a great place, like a quadrangle; there we saw four ranks of Statues of brass, in the form of wild men, with clubs and crow●s of the same metal guilt: These Idols or Giants, were each of them six and twenty spans high, and six broad, as well on the bre●t, as on the shoulders; their countenances were hideous and deformed, and their hair curled like to Negroes. The desire we had to know what these figures signified, made us to demand it of the Tartars, who answered us, that they were the three hundred and threescore gods, which framed the days of the year, being placed there expressly, to the end that in their effigies they might be continually adored, ●or having created the fruits which the earth produceth; and withal that the King of Tartary had caused them to be transported thither from a great Temple, called Angicamoy, which he had taken in the City of Xipaton, out of the Chapel of the Tombs of the Kings of China, for to triumph over them, when as he should happily return into his Country, that the whole world might know how in despite of the King of China he had captivated his gods. Within this place, whereof I speak, and amidst a plantation of Orange-trees, that was environed within a fence of Ivy, Roses, Rosemary, and many other sort of flowers, which we have not in Europe, was a Tent pi●ched upon twelve Balisters of the wood of Champhire, each of them wreathed about with silver in the fashion of knotted card-work, bigger than ones arm. In this Tent was a low Throne in the form of an Altar, garnished with branched work of fine gold, and over it was a cloth of State, set thick with silver Stars; where also the Sun and Moon were to be seen, as also certain clouds, some of them white, and others of the colour of which appear in the time of rain, all enammelled so to the life, and with such art, that they beguiled all those that beheld them, for they seemed to rain indeed, so as it was impossible to see a thing more complete, either for the proportions or colours. In the midst of this Throne upon a bed lay a great Statue of silver called Abicau Nilancor, which signifies, the God of the health of Kings, that had been also taken in the Temple of Angicamoy. Now round about the same Statue were four and thirty Idols of the height of a child of five or six years old, ranged in two Files, and set on the●r knees, with their hands lifted up towards this Idol, as if they would adore him. At the entry into this Tent there were four young Gentlemen richly clad, who with each of them a Cen●er in his hand, went two and two about, then at the sound of a bell prostrated themselves on the ground, and censed one another, saying with a loud voice, Let our cry come unto thee as a sweet perfume, to the end thou mayest hear us. For the Guard of of this Tent, there were three●core Halberdiers, who at a little distance environed it all about. They were clothed with guilt leather, and had Murrians on their heads curiously engraven; all which were very agreeable and majestical objects. Out of this place we entered into another division, where there were four Chambers very rich and well furnished, in the which were m●ny Gentlemen, as well strangers as Tartars. From thence passing on whither the Mitaquer, and the young boys conducted us, we arrived at the door of a great ●ow room, in form like to a Church, where stood six Ushers with their Maces, who with a new compliment to the Mitaquer caused us ●o ●nter, but kept out all others. In this room was the King of Tartary, accompanied with many Princes, Lords, and Captains, amongst whom were the Kings of Pafua, Mecuy, Capinper Raina Benan, Anchesacotay, and others to the number of fourteen, who in rich attire were all seated some three or four paces from the foot of the Tribunal. A little more on the one side were two and thirty very fair women, who playing upon divers instruments of music, made a wonderful sweet Consort. The King was set on his Throne under a rich Cloth of State, and had about him twelve young b●ys kneeling on their knees, with little Maces of gold like Sceptres, which they carried on their shoulders; close behind him was a young Lady extremely beautiful, and wonderfully richly attired, with a Ventiloe in her hand, wherewith she ever and anon fanned him. This same was the sister of the Mitaquer our General, and infinitely beloved of the King, for whose sake therefore it was that he was in such credit and reputation throughout the whole Army: The King was much about forty years of age, full stature, somewhat ●●an and of a good aspect; His beard was very short, his Moustaches after the Turkish manner, his eyes like to the Chinese, and his countenance severe and majestical; As for his vesture, it was violet colour, in fashion like to a Turkish Roak embroidered with pearl, upon his feet he had green Sandals wrought all over with gold pearl, and great purls among it, and on his head a satin cap of the colour of his habit, with a rich band of diamonds and rubies intermingled together: Before we passed any farther, after we had gone ten or eleven steps in the room, we made our compliment by kissing of the ground three several times, and performing other ceremonies, which the Truchmen taught us: In the mean time the King commanded the music to cease, and addressing himself to the Mitaquer; Ask these men of the other end of the world said he unto him, whether they have a King, what is the name of their Country, and how far distant it is from this Kingdom of China where now I am? Thereupon one of ours speaking for all the rest, answered; That our Country was called Portugal, that the King thereof was exceeding rich and mighty, and that from thence to the City of Pequin was at the le●st three years' voyage. This answer much amazed the King, because he did not think the world had been so large, so that striking his thigh with a wand that he had in his hand, and lifting up his eyes to Heaven, as though he would render thanks unto God; he said aloud, so as every one might hear him: O Creator of all things; are we able to comprehend the marvels of thy greatness, we that at the best are but poor worms of the earth? Fuxiquidane, fuxiquidane, let them approach, let them approach. Thereupon beckening to us with his hand, he caused us to come even to the first degree of the Throne, where the fourteen Kings sat, and demanded of him again, as a man astonished, Pucau, pucau, that is to say, how far, how far? whereunto he answered as before, that we should be at least three years in returning to our Country. Then he asked why we came not rather by Land, then by Sea, where so many labours and dangers were to be undergon? Thereunto he replied, that there was too great an extent of land, through which we were not assured to pass, for that it was commanded by Kings of several nations. What come you to seek for then, added the King, and wherefore do you expose yourselves to such dangers? Then having rendered him a reason to this last demand with all the submission that might be, he stayed a pretty while without speaking, and then shaking his head three or four times, he addressed himself to an old man that was not far from him, and said, Certainly we must needs conclude, that there is either much ambition, or little justice in the Country of these people, seeing they come so far to conquer other Lands. To this Speech the old man, named Raia Benan, made no other answer but that it must ●eeds be so, for men, said he, who have recourse unto their industry and invention to run over the Sea for to get that which God hath not given them, are necessarily carried thereunto, either by extreme poverty, or by an excess of blindness and vanity, derived from much covetousness, which is the cause why they renounce God, and those that brought them into the world. This reply of the old man was seconded with many jeering words by the other Courtiers, who made great sport upon this occasion, that very much pleased the King, in the mean time the women fell to their music again, and so continued, till the King withdrew into another Chamber in the company of these fair Musicians, and that young Lady which fanned him, not so much as one of those great Personages, daring to enter besides: Not long after one of those twelve boys, that carried the Sceptres before mentioned, came to the Mitaquer, and told him from his sister, that the King commanded him not to depart away, which he held for a singular favour, by reason this message was delivered to him in the presence of those Kings and Lords that were in the room, so that he stirred not, but sent us word, that we should go unto out tent with this assurance, that he would take care the Son of the Sun should be mindful of us. CHAP. XL. The King of Tartaria's raising of his Siege from before Pequin, for to return into his Country, and that which passed until his Arrival there. §. 1. WE had been now full three and forty days in this Camp, during which time there past many fights and skirmishes between the besiegers and the besieged, as also two assaults in the open day which were resisted by them within with an invincible courage like resolute men as they were; In the mean time the King of Tartary, seeing how contrary to his hope so great an enterprise had been, wherein h● had consumed so much treasure, caused his Council of War to be assembled, in the which were present the seven and twenty Kings that accompanied him, and likewise many Princes, and Lords, and the most part of the chief Commanders of the Army: In this Council it was resolved, that in regard Winter was at hand, and that the rivers had already overflowed their banks with such force and violence, as they had ravaged and carried away m●st of the Trenches and Pallisadoes of the Camp, and that moreover great numbers of the soldiers died daily of sickness, and for want of victuals, that therefore the King could not do better then to raise his Siege, and be gone before Winter came, for fear lest staying longer, he should run the hazard of losing himself, and his Army: All these reasons seemed so good to the King, that without further delay he resolved to follow this counsel, and to obey the present necessity, though it were to his great grief. so that incontinently he caused all his Infantry and Ammunition to be embarked, then having commanded his Camp to be set on fire, he himself went away by Land with three hundred thousand Horse, and twenty thousand Rhinocerots: Now after they had taken an account of all the dead, they appeared to be four hundred and fifty thousand, the most of whom died of sickness, as also an hundred thousand Horses, and threescore thousand Rhinocerots, which were eaten in the space of two months and an half, wherein they wanted victual, so that of eighteen hundred thousand men wherewith the King of Tartary came out of his Country to besiege the City of Pequin, before the which he lay six months and an half, he carried home some seven hundred and fifty thousand less than he brought forth, whereof four and fifty thousand died of sickness, famine, and war, and three hundred thousand went and rendered themselves unto the Chineses, drawn thereunto by the great pay which they gave them,, and other advantages of honour and presents which they continually bestowed on them; whereat we are not to marvel, seeing experience doth show, how that alone is of far more power to oblige men, than all other things in the world. After the King of Tartary was gone from this City of Pequin, upon a Monday, the seven●eenth of October, with three hundred thousand horse, as I have related before, the same day about evening he went and lodged near to a river, called Quaytragun, and the next morning an hour before day the A●my began to m●rch at the sou●d of the Drums, Fifes, and other instruments of war, according to the order prescribed them; In this manner he arrived a little before night at a Town, named Guiiamp●a, which he found altogether depopulated: After his Army had reposed thereabout an hour and an half, he set forth again, and marching somewhat fast he came to lodge at the foot of a great mountain, called Liampeu, from whence he departed towards morning. Thus marched he eight leagues a day for fourteen days together, at the end whereof he arrived at a good Town, named Guauxitim, which might contain about eleven or twelve thousand fires; There he was counselled to furnish himself with victuals, whereof he had great need, for which purpose therefore he begird it round, and scaling it in the open day, he quickly m●de himself Master of it, and put it to the sack with so cruel a Massacre of the inhabitants, as my fellows and I were ready to swoon for very astonishment: Now after that the wood and fire had consumed all things, and that the Army was abundantly provided of ammunition and victual, he dep●rted at the break of day; and though he passed the next morning in the view of Caixiloo, yet would not he attaque it▪ for that it was a great and strong Town, and by situation impregnable, having heard besides that there were fifty thousand men within it, whereof ten thousand were Mogors, Cauchins, and Champaas, resolute soldiers, and much more warlike than the Chinese. From thence passing on he arrived at the walls of Singrachirau, which are the very same, that, as I have said heretofore, do divide those two Empires of China and Tartary; There meeting with no resistance he went an● lodged on the further side of it at Panquinor, which was the first of his own Towns, and s●ated some three leagues from the said wall, and the next day he marched to Psipator, where he dismissed the most part of his people. In this place he stayed not above seven days, which he spent in providing pay for his soldiers, and in the execution of certain prisoners he had taken in that war, and brought along with him: These things thus expedited, he, as a man not very well pleased, embarked himself for Lanç●me, in sixscore Lanlees, with no more than ten or eleven thousand men: So in six days after his embarking, he arrived at Lançame, where not permitting any reception to be made him he landed about two hours within night. The King abode in this City of Lançame until such time as all his forces, as well horse as foot, §. 2 were arrived there, which was within six and twenty days, then having all his Army together, he went on to another City far greater and fairer, called Tuymicoa, where he was visited by some Princes his Neighbours, and by the Ambassadors of many other Kings and Sovereigns of more remoter Countries, of which the chiefest were six great and mighty Monarches, namely Xataanas the Sophy of Persia; Siamon Emperor of the Gueos, whose Country borders on that of Bramaa, and Tanguu; the Calami●ham, Lord of the indomptable force of the Elephant of the Earth, as I shall deliver hereafter, when I come to treat of him and his State; the Sourna● of Odiaa, that names himself the King of Siam, whose dominion r●ns seven hundred leagues along the coast with that of Tanauserin, and on Champaa side with the Malayos, Berdios, and Patanes, and through the heart of the Country with Passioloqua, Capioper, and Chiammay, as also with the Lauhos, and Gueos, so that this Prince alone hath seventeen Kingdoms within his State, by reason whereof, for to make himself the more redoubted amongst the Gentiles, he causeth himself to be styled, The Lord of the white Elephant; the fifth was the great Mogor, whose State is within the heart of the Country, near to the Corazones, a Province bordering upon Persiu, and the Kingdom of Dely, and Chitor; and the last an Emperor of a Country, named Caran, as we were informed there, the bounds of whose Sovereignty are at the Mountains of Goncalidau▪ sixty degrees further on, where a certain people live, whom they of the Country call Moscovites, whereof we have some in this City, which were fair of complexion, well shapen, and apparelled with Breeches, Cassocks, and Hats, like to the Flemings which we see in Europe, the chiefest of them wearing Gowns lined with Sables, and the rest with ordinary furs. The Ambassador of this Emperor of Caran, was more remarkable in his entry, than all the rest: He had for his Guard about sixscore men, armed with ●●rows, and Partisans damasked with gold and silver, and all attired alike in violet and green; After them marched on horseback twelve Ushers, carrying silver Maces, before whom twelve horses were led, that had carnation clothes on them, bordered about with gold and silver; They were followed by twelve huge tall men, that seemed to be Giants, clothed with Tiger's skins as wild men are used to be painted of them holding in his hand a great Greyhound by a silver chain; Then appeared twelve little Pages, mounted on white Hackneys, having green velvet Saddles, trimmed with silver lace and frenge, they were all apparelled alike in crimson satin Cassocks, lined with martens, breeches, and hats of the same, and great chains of gold scarf-wise about them; These twelve boys were all of one equal stature, so fair of face, so well favoured, and of so sweet a proportion of body, as I believe there have never been any seen more accomplished: For himself, he was seated in a Chariot with three wheels on each side, garnished all over with silver; Round about this Pirange, (for so was this Chariot called) there were forty footmen in jerkins, and breeches of green and red cloth, laced all over with carnation silk lace, having swords by their side above three fingers broad, with the hilts, handles, and chaps of silver, and hunting horns hanging in silver chains, bandrick-wise about th●m, and on their heads they wore caps, with feathers in them full of silver spangles: Thus was the equipage of this Ambassador so sumptuous and stately, that one might very well conclude he belonged to some very rich and mighty Prince. Now going one day as attendants on the Mitaqu●r, who went to visit him from the King, amongst other things that we saw in his lodging, we observed there for one of the greatest rarities in that Country, five Chambers hung all with very rich Arras, such as we have in Christendom; and no question brought from thence: In each of these Chambers was a Cloth of State of gold or silver tinsel, and under it a Table with a Basin and Ewer of silver of a very costly fashion; also a Chair of State of rich violet stuff trimmed with gold frenge, and at the foot of it a Cushion of the same, all upon an exceeding large footpace of tapestry; There was also a cha●ingdish of silver, with a perfuming pot of the same, out of the wh●ch proceeded a most delicate odour; At the door of each of those five Chambers stood two Halberdiers, who permitted persons of quality to enter that came thither to see them; In another very great room in form like to a Gallery, there was upon a very high and large footpace a little table placed, covered with a damask tablecloth, edged about with gold-frenge, and upon a silver plate a napkin with a fork and a spoon of gold, as also two little saltseller's of the same metal: Now about ten or eleven paces on the one side from this table were two cupbards of plate of all kind of fashions, and other vessels of great value; Moreover at the four corners of this table were four cisterns about the bigness of a bushel, with their kettles fastened to them with chains all of silver, as also two very great candlesticks of the same with white wax candles in them but not lighted; There were also at the door of the room twelve handsome Halberdiers, clothed in mantles like to Irish rug, with Scymitars by their sides, all covered over with plates of silver, which Guard (as ordinarily it is with them) were very haughty and rude in their answers to all that speak to them. Although this Ambassador was come thither in the way of visit as the r●st, yet the principal subject of his Embassy was to treat of a marriage between the Emperor of Caran, and a sister of the Tartar, named Meica vidau, that is to say, a rich Saphir, a Lady about some thirty years of age, but very handsome, and exceeding charitable to the poor, whom we saw divers times in this City at the chiefest Feasts, which these people use to solemnize at certain times of the year, after the manner of the Gentiles. Howbeit setting aside all this, whereof I had not spoken but that it seemed more remarkable unto me then all the rest, I will return to my former discourse, as well concerning our liberty, as the voyage that we made even to the Islands of the Sea of China, whether the Emperor of Tartary caused us to be conveyed, to the end that such as shall come after us may attain to the knowledge of a part of those things, whereof it may be they have never heard spoken until this present. CHAP. XLI. In what manner we were brought again before the King of Tartary; with our departure from that Kingdom; and all that we saw, and befell us in our voyage, till our arrival at the Court of the King of Cauchinchina. §. 1. AFter some time had been spent in the Celebrations of certain remarkable Feasts, that were made for joy of the conclusion of a marriage betwixt the Princess Meica vidau, the King's sister, and the Emperor of Caran, the Tartar by the advice of his Captains resolved to return anew to the Siege of Pequin, which he had formerly quitted, taking the ill success that he had there as a great affront to his person; To this effect than he caused all the Estates of his Kingdom to be assembled, and also made a league with all the Kings and Princes bordering in his Dominions: whereupon considering with ourselves how prejudicial this might prove to the promise had been made us for the setting of us at liberty, we repaired to the Mitaquer, and represented unto him many things that made for our purpose, and obliged him to keep his word with us; To the which he returned us this answer: Certainly you have a great deal of reason for that you say, and I have yet more not to refuse you that which you demand of me with so much justice; wherefore I resolve to put the King in mind of you, that you may enjoy your liberty, and the sooner you shall be gone from hence, the sooner you shall be freed from the labours which the time begins to prepare for us in the enterprise that his Majesty hath newly undertaken by the counsel of some particulars, who for that they know not how to govern themselves have more need to be counselled, than the earth hath need of water to produce the fruits that are sowed in her; but to morrow morning I shall put the King in mind of you, and your poverty, and withal I shall present unto him how you have poor fatherless child ren, as you have heretofore told me, to the end he may be thereby incited to cast his eyes upon you, as he is accustomed to do in like cases, which is none of the least marks of his greatness. Hereupon he dismissed us for that day, and the next morning he went to Pontiveu, which is a place where the King useth to give audience to all such as have any suit to him; There beseeching his Majesty to think of us, he answered him, that as soon as he dispatched away an Ambassador to the King of Cauchenchina, he would send us along with him, for so he had resolved to do: With this answer the Mitaquer returned to his house, where we were ready attending his coming, and told us what the King had promised him, wherewithal not a little contented we went back to our lodging; There in the expectation of the good success of this promise we continued ten days with some impatience, at the end whereof the Mitaquer by the Kings express command carried us with him to the Court, where causing us to approach near to his Majesty, with those ceremonies of greatness which are observed in coming before him, being the same we used at Pequin, after he had beheld us with a gentle eye, he bid the Mitaquer ask of us whether we would serve him, and in case we would, he should not only be very well pleased with it, but he would also give us better entertainment, and more advantageous conditions than all the strangers that should follow him in this war. To this demand the Mitaquer answered very favourably for us, how he had often heard us say, that we were married in our Country▪ ●nd had a great charge of children, who had no other means to maintain them, but what we got with our labour, which was poorly enough God knows: The King heard this speech with some demonstration of pity, so that looking on the Mitaquer; I am glad, said he, to know that they have such good cause to return home as they speak of, that I may with the more contentmant acquit me of that which thou hast promised them in my name. At these words the Mitaquer, and all we that were with him, lifting up our hands, ●s to a testimony of our thankfulness unto him, we kissed the ground three times, and said, May thy feet rest themselves upon a thousand generations, to the end that thou mayst be Lord of the inhabitants of the earth. Hereat the King began to smile, and said to a Prince that was near him, These men speak as if they had been bred amongst us; Then casting his eyes on jorge Mendez, who stood before all us next to the Mitaquer, And thou, said he unto him, in what condition art thou, wilt thou go, or stay? whereupon Mendez, who had long before premeditated his answer, Sir, replied he, for me, that have neither wife, nor children to bewail my absence, the thing I most desire in the world is to serve your Majesty, since you are pleased therewith, whereunto I have more affection then to be Cha●m of Pequim one thousand years together. At this the King smiled again, and then dismissed us, so that we returned very well satisfied to our lodging, where we continued three days in a readiness to depart, at the end of which by the mediation of the Mitaquer, and means of his sister, who, as I have said before, was wonderfully beloved of the King, his Majesty sent us for the eight that we were two thousand Taeis, and gave us in charge to his Ambassador, whom he sent to the City of Vzamguee in Cauchenchina, in the company of the same King of Cauchenchina's Ambassador: With him we departed from thence five days after, being embarked in the vessel wherein he went himself: But before our departure jorge Mendez gave us a thousand Ducats, which was easy for him to do, for that he had already six thousand of yearly rent, withal he kept us company all that day, and at length took his leave of us, not without shedding many a tear for grief that he had so exposed himself to a voluntary exile. §. 2 Being departed from this City of Tuymican on the ninth day of May, in the year one thousand, five hundred, forty and four, we came to lodge that night at a University in a Pagode called Guatipanior, where the two Ambassadors were very well entertained by the Tuyxivau of the house, which is as the Rector thereof, and the next morning when it was broad day, both of them continued their course down the river, each one in his own ship; besides other two wherein their stuff was; About two hours in the night we arrived at a little Town, named Puxanguim, well fortified with Towers and bulwarks after our manner, as also with very broad ditches, and strong bridges of hewed stone; there was likewise great store of Artillery, or Cannons of wood, made like unto the pumps of ships, behind the which they put boxes of iron, that held their charge, and were fastened unto them with iron bands; as for the bullets which they shot, they were like unto those of Falconets, and half black: Being much amazed to see this, we demanded of the Ambassador who it was that had invented those kind of guns? whereunto they answered, that it was certain men, called Almains, and of a Country named Muscovy, who by a very great lake of salt-water, came down to this Town in nine vessels rowed with oars, in the company of a widow woman, Lady of a place, called Gaytor, who they said was chased out of her Country by a King of Denmark, so that flying for refuge with three sons of her, the great Grandfather of this King of Tartary made them all great Lords, and gave them certain kinswoman of his in marriage, from whom are extracted the chiefest families of this Empire. The next morning we parted from this Town, and that night lay at another more nobler, named Euxcau: Five days after we continued our voyage down this river, and then we arrived at a great Temple, called Singuafatur, where we saw an enclosure of above a league in circuit, in which were builded an hundred, threescore, and four houses, very long and broad, after the fashion of Arcenals, all full up to the very tiles of dead men's heads, whereof there was so great a number, that I am afraid to speak it, for that it will hardly be credited. Without each of these houses were also great piles of the bones of these heads, which were three fathom higher than the ridges of them, so that the house seemed to be buried, no other part of them appearing but the frontispiece where the gate stood; not far from thence upon a little hill on the Southside of them was a kind of a platform, whereunto one went up by certain winding-stairs of iron, and through four several doors; Upon this platform was the tallest, the most deformed, and dreadful Monster that possibly can be imagined, standing upon his feet, and leaning against a mighty tower of hewed stone; he was made of cast iron, and of so great and prodigious a stature, that by guess he seemed to be above thirty fathom high, and more than six broad, notwithstanding the which deformity he was exceedingly well proportioned in all his limbs, only his head was somewhat too little for so great a body. This monster held in both his hands a bowl of the same iron, being six and thirty spans about. Beholding so strange and monstrous a thing, we demanded of the Tartar Ambassador the explication thereof, who willing to satisfy our curiosity, If you knew, answered he, what the power of this God is, and how needful it is for you to have him to friend, certainly you would think it well employed if you presented him with all your means, how great soever they might be, and give them to him rather than to your own children; for you must know that this great Saint, which you see there, is the Treasurer of the bones of all those that are born into the world, to the end that at the last day, when men come to be born again he may give to every one the same bones which he had upon earth, for he knows them all, and can tell in particular to what body each of those bones belong: whereupon you are further to understand, that he, who in this life shall be so unadvised as not to honour him, nor present him with something, will be but in an ill case in the other world, for this Saint will then give him some of the rottenest bones he can meet withal, and one or two less than he should have, by means whereof he will become deformed, lame, or crooked, and therefore if you will follow my counsel, you shall make yourselves of his fraternity, by offering something unto him, and you will find by experience the good that will redound to you thereof hereafter. We desired also to know of him what the bowl which this Monster held in his hand, signified, whereunto he answered us, That he held it to fling it at the head of the gluttonous Serpent, that lived in the profound Obism of the house of smoke, when he should come thither to steal away any of those bones. After this we enquired of him how this Monster was called, and he told us that his name was, Pachinavau du beculem Prinaufaque, and that it was threescore and fourteen thousand years since he was begotten on a Tortoise, called Migama, by a Sea-horse, that was an hundred and thirty fathom long, named Tybrem vucam, who had been King of the Giants of Fanius; he told us likewise many other brutish fooleries and absurdities, which those of that Country believe as their Creed, and wherewith the Devil precipitates them all into hell; Moreover this Ambassador assured us, that the gifts which were presented to this Idol, amounted to above two hundred thousand Taeis of yearly rent, without comprising therein what came from Chapels, and other foundations of obits from the principal Lords of the Country, the Revenue whereof was far greater than that of the gifts; For a conclusion he told us, that this same Idol had ordinarily twelve thousand priests attending on his service, who were maintained with m●at, drink, and clothing, only to pray for the dead, that is to say, for those unto whom these bones appertained; we were also assured, that these priests never went out of this enclosure without the permission of their Superiors, but that there was still without six hundred servants, who took care for the providing of all things necessary for them; And further that it was not lawful for these priests, save once a year, to break within this enclosure the vow which they had made of chastity, but without the same they might whore their pleasure with whomsoever they would, without committing any sin; There was also a Seraglio there, wherein many women, appointed for that purpose were shut up, whom their Governesses permitted to have to do with the priests of this beastly and diabolical Sect. Continuing our voyage from this Pagode, or Monastery of Gentiles, whereof we have spoken, the next day we arrived at a very fair Town, called Quanginau, §. 3 which stands on the bank of the river; In this place the Ambassadors stayed three whole days for to furnish themselves with certain things they wanted, as also for to see the feast and joy that was made at that time upon the entry of the Tal●picor of Echuna, which is their Pope, who was going then unto the King for to comfort him about the ill success he had in China. Amongst other graces, which this Tolapicor bestowed on the inhabitants of this Town, in recompense of the charge they had been at for his reception, he granted unto them, that they might be all Priests, and administer their sacrifices in what places soever they were, and likewise that they might therefore receive the same entertainment and gifts, that were accustomed to be given unto our Priests, without any difference between them and those that upon examination had been promoted to that dignity; Moreover he gave them power to grant Bills of Exchange for Heaven unto all such as should do them good here b●low. To the Ambassador of Cauchinchina he granted as a most singular favour, that he might legitimate any that would pay him for it, & also confer on the Lords of the Court titles, and marks of honour, as far forth as if he had been King, whereof the foolish Ambassador was so proud, as setting aside covetousness, though it were a vice he was naturally inclined unto, he employed all that ever he had there in gifts upon those Priests, and besides not contented therewith, he for that end borrowed of us the two thousand Taeis the King had given us, which aferwards he paid us again with interest after fifteen in the hundred. After these matters the two Ambassadors resolved to continue their voyage, but before their departure they went to visit the Talapicor in a Pagode where he was lodged, for in regard of his greatness, and that he was held for a Saint, he might not abide with any man, but with the King only. Now as soon as he understood of the Ambassadors coming to him he sent them word not to go away that day, because he was to preach at the Church of certain religious women of the Invocation of Pontimaqueu; this they took for a great honour, and incontinently went to the Pagode, where the Sermon was to be: At their arrival they found such a concourse of people, that they were constrained to remove the Pulpit to another very great place, which in less than an hour was environed with Scaffolds, hung about with silk stuff, whereon the one side were the Ladies, richly apparelled, and on the other the Princess, called Vanguenarau, with all the Menigregues, or religious women of the Pagode, being in number above three hundred. After the Talapicor was gone up into the Pulpit, and that he had made an exterior show of much holiness, ever and anon lifting up his hands and eyes to Heaven, he began his Sermon in this manner, Like as it is the property of water to cleanse all things, and of the Sun to warm all creatures, so it is the property of God through a celestial and divine nature to do good unto all; wherefore we are all bound, as well in general and particular, to imitate this our Lord, who hath created, and doth nourish us, by doing that unto those, who stand in need of the good of this world, as we would that they should do unto us, for that by this work we are more pleasing unto him, then by any other whatsoever. For as the good Father of a Family rejoiceth to see his children made much of, and presents given to them, so our Heavenly Lord, who is the true Father of us all, rejoiceth at such time as with a zeal of charity we communicate one with another; whereby it is evident, that the covetous man, who shuts his hand, when the poor ask something of him which they want, constrained thereunto by necessity, and that turns him another way without assisting them, shall be treated in the same manner by a just judgement of God, and driven down into the bottom of the sink of the night, where like a frog he shall croak without ceasing, being tormented by the hunger of his covetousness: This being so, I do advise and enjoin you all, since you have ears to hear me, that you do that which the Law of the Lord obligeth you to do, which is, that you give of that whereof you have too much, to the poor, who have not wherewith to feed themselves, to the end God may not be wanting to you when you shall be at the last gasp of your life: Go to then, let this charity be so remarkable and universal in you, that the very fowls of the air may taste of your liberality; And this you ought to do to keep the poor, having need of what you possess in excess, from being forced by their necessity to rob other men of their goods, whereof you would be no less unblamable, then if you killed an infant in the cradle; I commend also unto your remembrance that which is written in the Book of our truth, touching the good you are bound to do unto the Priests, that pray for you, to the end they may not perish for want of the good you ought to do unto them, which would be as great a sin before God, as if you should cut the throat of a little white heifer when she is sucking of her Dam, by the death of whom a thousand souls would die, which are buried in her as in a golden Tomb, in expectation of the day, which is to accomplish the promise, that was made unto them, wherein they shall be transformed into white pearls for to dance in Heaven, like unto the moats which are in the beams of the Sun. Having uttered these things, he added many others thereunto, and delivering a world of extravagancies and fooleries, he bestirred himself in such manner, as was a wonder to behold, so that we eight Portugals were exceedingly amazed at the extreme devotion of these people, and how that in lifting up their hands to Hands to Heaven, they ever and anon repeated this word Taiximida, that is to say, So we believe; In the mean time one of our fellows, named Vincent Morosa, hearing the auditors so often use that word Taiximida, said in imitation of them, Such may thy life be; and that with such a grace, and so settled a countenance, not seeming any way to jeer him, that not one in the Assembly could forbear laughing: He in the mean while continued still firm, and more and more confirmed, seeming even to weep out of an excess of devotion; Now his eyes being always fixed on the Talapicor, he whensoever he chanced to look on him could not choose but do as the rest did, so that upon the conclusion of his Sermon all that heard him fell to laughing outright: The Prioress herself, and all the Menigregues of her Monastery could not contain themselves in their serious humour, imagining that the faces which the Portugal made, and his actions, were so many effects of his devotion, and good meaning; For if one had thought it to be otherwise, and that he had not done it out of derision, no question but he had been so chastised, as he should never have been able to mock again. When the Sermon was ended, the Talapicor returned to the Pagod where he lodged, being accompanied with the most honourable of all the Assembly, together with the Ambassadors, unto whom all the way as he went he ceased not to commend the devotion of the Portugal, Look, said he, there is not so much as these people, who live like beasts, and without the knowledge of our truth, but see well enough that there is nothing but what is godly in that I have preached; whereunto all answered that it was as he said. §. 4 The day after we parted from the Town of Quanginau, and continued our voyage down the river for the space of fourteen days, during the which we saw a number of Towns, and great Boroughs on either side of us, at the end whereof we arrived at a City, called Lechuna, the chiefest of the Religion of these Gentiles, and such it may be, as Rome is amongst us. In this City was a very sumptuous Temple, where there were many remarkable edifices, in the which seven and twenty Kings or Emperors of this Monarchy of Tartary have been buried. Their Tomb● are in Chapels, wonderful rich, as well for the excellency of their workmanship, which is of an infinite cost, as for that they are within covered all over with plates of silver, wherein there are divers Idols of different forms made also of silver. On the North side a little part from the Temple was an enclosure worthy the observation, both for its extent, and the fortification thereof; within it were two hundred and fourscore Monasteries, as well of men, as of women, dedicated to certain Idols, and for the service of all these Pagodes, or Temples there are ordinarily, as we were assured, two and forty thousand Priests and Menigrepes, not comprising therein those which were lodged without the enclosure for the service of these false priests. We observed that in these two hundred and fourscore houses there was an infinite company of pillars of brass, and upon the top of each pillar are idols of the same metal guilt, besides thos● which likewise were there all of silver: These Idols are the Statues of them, whom in their false Sect they hold for Saints, and of whom they recount such fopperies, as would make a man wonder to hear them; For they give unto each of them a Statue, more or less rich, and guilded, according to the degrees of virtue which they have exercised in this life: And this they do expressly, that the living may be incited to imitate them, to the end there may be as much done unto them when they are dead. In one of these Monasteries of the Invocation of Quiay Frigau, that is to say, The God of the moats of the Sun, was a sister of the Kings, the widow of Rai● Benan, Prince of Pafua, whom the death of her husband had made resolve to shut herself up in this Monastery, with six thousand women that had followed her thither, and she had taken upon her, as the most honourable Title she could think on, the name of, the broom of the House of God. The Ambassadors went to see this Lady, and kissed her feet as a Saint; she received them very courteously, and demanded many things of them with great discretion, whereunto they rendered such answers as became them; but coming to cast her eye upon us, who stood somewhat far off, and understanding that never any of our Nation was seen in those parts before, she enquired of the Ambassadors of what Country we were? They answered, that we were come from a place at the other end of the world, whereof no man there knew the name. At those words she stood much amazed, and causing us to come nearer, she questioned us about many things, whereof we gave her such an account as greatly contented her, and all that were present; In the mean time the Princess wondering at the answers, which one of ours made her, They speak, said she, like men that have been brought up amongst people, who have seen more of the world than we have. So after she had heard us talk a while of some matters, that sh● had propounded unto us, she dismissed us with very good words, and caused an hundred Taeis to be given us in way of an alms. The Ambassadors having taken their leave of her, continued their voyage down along the river, so that at the end of five days we arrived at a great Town, called Rendacal●m, situated on the uttermost Confines of the Kingdom of Tartary: Out of this place we entered upon the State of the Xinal●ygrau, and therein we proceeded on four days together, until such time as we came to a Town, named Voulem, where the Ambassadors were very well entertained by the Lord of the Country, and abundantly furnished with all things necessary for their voyage, as also with Pilots to guide them in those rivers. From thence we pursued our course for seven days together, during the which we saw not any thing worthy of note, and at length came to a strait, called Caten●ur, whereinto the Pilots entered, as well to abridge their voyage, as to avoid the encounter of a famous Pirot, who had robbed those parts of most of their wealth. Through this strait running East, as also East, North-east; and sometimes East, and by East, according to the windings of the water we arrived at the Lake of Singapamor, called by them of the Country Cunebetea, which was, as our Pilots affirmed, six and thirty leagues in extent, where we saw so many several sorts of birds, that I am not able to recount them. Out of this Lake of Singapamor (which as an admirable Masterpiece nature hath opened in the heart of this Country) do four very large and deep rivers proceed, whereof the first is named Ventrau, that runneth Eastward through all the Kingdoms of Sorna●▪ and Siam, entering into the Sea by the B●● of Chiamtabuu, in six and twenty degrees; The second, jangumaa, that going South, and Southeast, traverseth also the greatest part of this Country, as likewise the Kingdom of Chiammay, the Laos, Gueos, and another part of Danbambur, disimboking into the Sea by the Bar of Martabano, in the Kingdom of Pegu, and there is in distance from the one to the other by the degrees of this Climate, above seven hundred leagues; The third, called Pamphileu, passeth in the same manner through all the Countries of Capimper and Sacotay, and turning above that second river runs quite through the Empire of Monginoco, and a part of Meleytay, and Sovady, rendering itself into the Sea by the Bar of Cosmim, near to Arraca●; The fourth, which in all likelihood is as great as the rest, is not known by any name, neither could the Ambassadors give us any reason for it: but it is probable, according to the opinion of divers, that it is Ganges in the Kingdom of Bengala, so that by all the discoveries which have been made in these Oriental Countries it is conceived, that there is not a greater river than it: Having crossed this Lake we continued our course for the space of seven days, till we came to a place named Caleyputa, the inhabitants whereof would by no means permit us to land, for the Ambassadors endeavouring to do so, they entertained us with such store of darts and stones from the shore, as we thought us not a little happy in that we could save ourselves from the danger of it. After we had gotten out of this place, much vexed with the bad entreaty we had received there, that which most afflicted us was to s●t ourselves unprovided of things we were greatly in need of, but by the counsel of our Pilots we sailed by another river far larger than the strait which we had left, and that by the sp●ce of nine days, at the end whereof we arrived at a very good Town, called Tarem, the Lord of which was subject to the Cauchin, who received the Ambassadors with great Demonstrations of love, and furnished them abundantly with all that they wanted. The next day we departed from thence about Surset, and continuing our voyage down the river about seven days after we came to an Anchor in the Port of Xolor, which is a very fair Town, where all the enammelled purcelain, which is carried to China, is made. There the Ambassadors stayed five days, during which time they caused their ships, that were very heavy, to be haled ashore by the force of boats: That done, and provision made of all things necessary, they went to see certain Mines, which the King of Cauchin hath in that place, from whence great store of silver is drawn, and the Ambassadors being desirous to know how much silver those Mines yielded every year, they were answered, that the whole amounted to some six thousand Picos, which make eight thousand Quintals of our weight. §. 5. After our departure from the Town of Xolor we still continued our course for five days together down that great river, and saw all along that while a many of great Boroughs, and goodly Towns; for in that Climate the Land is better than other where, very well peopled, and full of riches; withal the rivers are frequented with a world of vessels, and the fields very well tilled, and replenished with abundance of wheat, rice, all kind of pulse, and exceeding great Sugarcanes, whereof there is marvellous store in all that Country. The Gentlemen there are ordinarily clothed in silk, and mounted on horses handsomely furnished; as for the women, they are exceeding white and fair. Now it was not without much labour, pain, and danger, that we passed those two Channels▪ as also the river of Ventinau, by reason of the Pirates that usually are encountered there, nevertheless we at the length arrived at the Town of Manaquileu, which is situated at the foot of the Mountains of Chomay, upon the Frontiers of the two Kingdoms of China, and Cauchenchina, where the Ambassadors were both well received by the Governor thereof. The next morning departing from that place, they went and lay in a Town, named Quinancaxi, which appertained to an Aunt of the Kings, whom they went to visit; she gave them a very kind reception, and withal told them for news, that the King her Nephew, was newly returned from the War of the Tinocouhos, and wonderfully well pleased with his good success therein; whereunto she added many particularities, which they were glad to hear, especially when she assured them, that the King, after he had dismissed the forces that he had carried out with him, was gone with a small Train to the City of Fanaugrem, where he intended to spend some time in hunting & fishing, & then to go & winter at Vsamgue●, the capital City of this Empire of Cauchim. When as they had consulted a while upon these news, they resolved to send their four vessels away to Vsamguee, and themselves to travel by land to Fanaugrem, where they understood the King was. This deliberation taken they put incontinently into execution & that by the advice of this Princess, who for that purpose caused them to be furnished with horses for themselves, & their people, as also with eight Rhinocerots for the transportation of their baggage. They began their journey then about three days after, and having travelled fourscore & six leagues, in the space of thirteen days, and that with much toil & labour, by reason of certain mountains which they were to pass, that were of a long extent, and very rough and stony, in the end they arrived at a great lodging, called Taraudachit, seated upon the bank of a river; There they passed the night, and the next morning they parted thence for to go to a Town, named Lindau Panoo, where they were very well received by the Captain thereof, a kinsman of the Ambassadors of Cauchenchina; who was come not about six days before from Fanaugrem, where the King remained still, being not more than fifteen leagues from that place. After that this Captain hath told this Ambassador his kinsman some other news of the Court, and of the success of the war, he further advertised him that a Son in law of his was dead, for the love of whom his daughter the wife of the deceased, had cast herself into a pile of flaming fire, where with her husband's body she was consumed to ashes, at which all her kindred exceedingly rejoiced, for that by so generous an end she had given proof of what she had ever been. The Ambassador himself, her father, testified also no little content for the same, saying; Now it is, O my daughter, that I know assuredly thou art a Saint, and that thou servest thy husband in Heaven, wherefore I promise and swear to thee, that for so memorable an end, wherein thou hast given an infallible proof of the Royal blood whereof thou art descended, I will in memory of thy goodness ●uild thee such a magnificent and honourable house, as shall make thee desi●● to come from were thou art, for to recreate thyself in it, in imitation of those blessed souls, which we hold have heretofore done the like. This said, he fell fla● down with his face on the ground, and in that posture continued till the day following, when as he was visited by all the religious men of the place, who comforted him with full assurance that his daughter was a Saint, so that all of them granted him permission to erect a Statue of silver unto her. These speeches of the Priests greatly pleased the Ambassador, who very much acknowledged the same unto them, giving money both to them, and to all the poor that were thereabout; At this place we spent nine days in celebrating the Funerals of the Defunct, and then departing we went the next day to a certain Monastery, called Latiparau, that is to say, The remedy of the poor, where the two Ambassadors remained three days in expectation of news from the King, whom they had already advertised of their arrival; Now his answer to them was, that they should go to a Town, named Agimpur, three leagues from the place where they were, and but one from Fanaugrem, whither he would send for them when time served. CHAP. XLII. The reception of the Tartarian Ambassador by the King of Cauchenchina, with the said Kings going from thence to the City of Uzamguee, and his triumphal Entry thereinto. THe King being advertised by his Ambassador, §. 1 that he brought another along with him from the King of Tartary, sent for him not long after from Agimpur by the Brother of the Queen his wife, a very valiant and rich Prince: He was mounted on a Chariot with three wheels on a side, adorned all within with plates of silver, and drawn by four white Horses, whose furniture was all embroidered with gold; This Chariot, which they of the Country call Piamber, was waited on by threescore footmen, half on the one side, and half on the other, clothed in green leather, with Scymiters by their sides, whose Scabbards were garnished with gold, and before them went twelve Ushers bearing their Maces on their shoulders; After the footmen followed certain others carrying Halberds trimmed with silver, in gowns and breeches of green and white silk, and with Scymiters by their sides; These fellows se●med very haughty and proud, so that by their outward behaviours, which in all their actions appeared to be like unto their surly dispositions, they rendered themselves somewhat terrible to others; Thirty paces after this Guard marched fourscore Elephants exceeding well furnished, with chairs and castles adorned with silver which they carried on their backs, and on their teeth their Panores, or warlike Defences, together with many little bells of the same metal hanging about their necks; Before these Elephants, which were said to be the King's Guard, road a number of men at Arms in very good Equipage, and in the Vanguard of all this train went twelve Chariots with Cymbals of silver, and covered with silk. When this Prince was come in this stately manner to the Ambassador of Tartary, who attended him, and that they had performed all such compliments one to another, as are usual amongst them, the Prince gave the Ambassador the Chariot wherein he came thither, and mounting on a gallant Courser, he placed himself on the right hand of him, and the King's Ambassador on the left: In this pomp, and with the same order as before, as also with the sound of divers instruments of music, they arrived at the first Court of the King's house, where the Broquem, Captain of the Guard of the Palace attended them, being accompanied with many Noblemen, besides a number on horseback, wh●●h stood ranked in two files all along the Court. After they had with a new ceremony been complemented withal, they went on foot to the Palace-gate, where they encountered with an old man, above fourscore years of age, who was said to be the King's Uncle; This same, being waited upon by divers great Lords, was no sooner perceived by the Ambassadors, but with a new kind of compliment they kissed the Scymiter that hung by his side, whereupon he returned them the like, together with an honour, which is of no little estimation amongst them, that was to hold his hand upon their heads, so long as they were prostrated on the ground before him. Then having caused the Tartar to rise, and to march even check by jowl with him, he led him through a very long Hall to a door which was at the end thereof, where after he had knocked three times, one demanded of him, who he was, and what he would have? whereunto answering very soberly, Here is come, said he, out of an ancient custom of true amity, an Ambassador from the great Xinarau of Tartary, to demand audience of P●echau Guimian, whom we all hold for the Lord of our heads. This answer being returned, the door was opened, into which they presently entered; the Prince marched fore-most with the Ambassador of Tartary, whom the held by the hand, and a little behind them went the other belonging to the King, with the Captain of the Guard, than followed all the company by three and three. Having gone through that room, where there was none but certain of the Guard on their knees with Halberds in their hands, we went into another room far more spacious and fair then the former, in the which we saw threescore and four Statues of brass, and nineteen of silver, all tied by the neck with iron chains; At so extraordinary a thing as this being much abashed, we demanded of one of their Grepes, or priests, the reason of it, who answered us. That the Statues which we beheld there were the fourscore and three gods of the Tinocouhos, whom the King in the late war had taken from them out of a Temple, where they were placed; for, added he, there is nothing in the world held in more esteem, or for a greater honour by the King, then to triumph over the gods of his enemies, which he hath led away captive in despite of them▪ whereupon enquiring further of him, why they were set there, he replied, that it was to have them in a readiness against the time that the King should make his entry in●o Vzamguee, whither he purposed shortly to go, for to make a show of them so chained in his triumph as a special mark of the victory he had gained. After we were at the end of this room, where the Idols were, we entered into another very great one, where we saw a number of very fair women, who were set all along, some employed in curious needle-works, and others singing and playing upon certain instruments of music, very pleasing to hear. Passing on we arrived at the door of the King's Chamber, where we found six women, which were as it were porters there, and carried silver Maces; In this room was the King, in the company of a few ancient men, and a great number of young women, to the tune of whose music certain little girls sung very harmoniously: The King was set on a Throne of eight steps high in the manner of an Altar, over the which was a cloth of State supported by pillars, all covered over with gold engraven; near to him were six little children upon their knees with Sceptres in their hands, and a little further off stood a woman reasonably well in years, which fanned him ever and anon, and had a great Garland about her neck. This Prince was about some five and thirty years of age, and of a goodly presence: He had full eyes, auborn hair and beard, a grave look, and in all points the countenance of a generous King. As soon as the Ambassadors came into the room they prostrated themselves three times on the ground, and at the third time the Kings lay still flat all along, whilst the Tartar passed on; who being come near to the first step of the Throne where the King sat, he said unto him with so loud a voice as all there present might hear him, O thou the Prop of all the Forces of the Earth, and the breath of the High God which hath created all things, may the Majestical Being of thy greatness prosper for ever and ever, so that thy Sandals may serve for hairs to the heads of Kings, making thee like to the bones and flesh of the great Prince of the silver mountains, by whose commandment I come to visit thee, as thou mayst perceive by this his Letter sealed with his Royal arms. When he had made an end of speaking thus, the Cauchin beholding him with a smiling countenance, May the Sun, answered he, put a conformity between the desires of the King thy Master, and mine, and that by the sweet heat of his amorous rays, to the end that the great amity, which is betwixt us, may endure and continue firm till the last noise the Sea shall make, that so the Lord may be eternally praised in his peace. At these words all the Lords that were in the room answered with one voice, So grant it may be O Lord Almighty, that givest a being to the night and the day. Then the same women, which played before, beginning their music again, the King used no further speech, but only in kindly entertaining the Ambassador, I will, said he, read my brother Xinarau's Letter, and return an answer thereunto according to thy desire, to the end thou mayst go from me contented. The Ambassador made him no reply, but prostrated himself again at the foot of the Royal Throne, laying his head three times on the uppermost step where the King's feet stood. That done the Captain of the Guard took him by the hand, and led him to his house, where he lodged during the three days that he abode there, at the end whereof the King departed thence for to go to Vzamguee. §. 2. In regard of the King's journey to Vzamguee, the Tartar Ambassador had audience but once by the way, in the which he moved him about our particular, according to the express commandment he had received from his M●ster for that purpose, and it was said that the King heard him very willingly, answering, that he would do what he desired, and therefore willed him to put him in mind of it, when the time should serve, to the end we might not lose the opportunity of the season for our voyage. With this good news the Ambassador acquainted us at his return, and demanded of us for this good office he had done us, that we would write him out some of those prayers which we made to our God, whose slave, he said, he infinitely desired to be, in regard of the great excellencies which he had heard us deliver of him; This we not only granted him very readily, but also gave him infinite thanks besides for this his great favour showed unto us, which we made more account of then all the benefits that had been propounded unto us by the King of Tartary, if we would have continued in his service. After the King was departed from the City of Fanaugrem, he proceeded on in his journey travelling but only six leagues a day, by reason of the great number of persons that he carried along with him; The first day he dined at a little Town, called Benau, where he stayed until the evening, and then went to lodge at a Monastery, named Pamgatur; The next morning he departed from thence, and so with not above three thousand horse in his Train, he prosecuted his journey for nine days together, passing by many goodly Towns, at least they seemed to be so, without permitting any reception to be made him by any of them; In this manner he arrived at the City of Lingator, sea●ed on a river of fresh water, which for the breadth and deepness of it is frequented with much shipping; There he abode five days, for that he found himself somewhat indisposod with the tediousness of the journey: From this place he departed before day, taking no greater company with him then thirty horse, and so withdrawing himself from the communication of so much people, as continually importuned him, he spent most part of the time as he went by the way in hawking and hunting; those of the Countries by which he passed providing game always ready for him. In this sort going on he slept most commonly amidst very thick woods in Tents pitched for him to that purpose. Being arrived at the river of Baguetor, he passed down the same in certain vessels, called Laulees and jangoas, which were there ready for him, till he came to a Town, named Natibasoy, where about evening he landed without any kind of pomp▪ The rest of his journey he made by land, so that at the end of thirteen days he arrived at Vzamguee, where he had a most magnificent reception. At his entry thereinto there marched before him, as it were in triumph, all the spoils which he had taken in the wars, whereof the principal, and those which he made most reckoning of, were twelve Chariots laden with the Idols, of whom I have spoken heretofore, and whereof the forms were different, as they use to have them in their Pagod●. Of these Idols there were threescore and four of brass, which seemed to be Giants, and nineteen of silver of the same Stature, for, as I hav● delivered before, these people glory in nothing so ●uch, as to triumph over those idols, that so they may say, That in despite of their enemies he had made their gods his slaves; Round about these twelve Chariots went divers Priests by three and three weeping, and bound with iron chains; After them followed forty other Chariots, each of them being drawn by two Rhinocerots, and full from the bottom to the top of an infinite company of Arms, and trailed Colours; In the tail of them there were twenty more, carrying each of them a very great Chest, barred with iron, and wherein, as we were told, was the treasure of the T●nocouhos; In the same order marched all other things, which are used to be most esteemed of in such triumphant entries, as two hundred Elephants armed with Castles, and warlike Panoures, which are certain swords that are fastened to their teeth when they fight, and a great number of horses laden with sacks full of dead men's heads and bones; so that in this entry this King of Cauchin presented to the view of his people all that he had gained from his enemies in the battle he had given them. After we had been a full month in this City, during which time we had seen a world of stately shows, sports, and several sorts of rejoicings, accompanied with most costly feasts and banquets, set forth and made not only by the greater persons, but by the common people also, the Tartar Ambassador, that had brought us thither, moved the King again about our voyage, whereunto he gave us so gracious an ear, that he presently commanded we should be furnished with a Vessel for to carry us to the Coast of China, where we hoped to mee● with some Portugal ship, that might transport us to Malaca, and from thence to the Indias, which accordingly was done, whereupon without further delay we prepared all things necessary for our departure. CHAP. XLIII. Our Departure from the City of Uzamguee, and our adventures till our arrival at the Isle of Tanixumaa, which is the first Land of Jappon; with our going ashore there. UPon the twelfth of january we departed from the City of Vzamguee, exceedingly rejoicing at our escape from so many labours and crosses, §. 1 which we before had sustained, and embarked ourselves upon a river, that was above a league broad, down the which we went seven days together, beholding in the mean time on either side thereof many fair Towns, and goodly Boroughs, which by the outward appearance we believed were inhabited by very rich people, in regard of the sumptuousness of the buildings, not only of particular houses, but much more of the Temples, whose steeples were all covered over with gold, as likewise in regard of the great number of Barks and Vessels, that were on this river, abundantly fraught with all sorts of provisions and merchandise. Now when we were come to a very fair Town, called Qua●geparun, containing some eighteen or twenty thousand fires, the Naudelum, who was he that conducted us by the express commandment from the King, stayed there twelve days ●o trade in exchange of silver and pearl; whereby he confessed to us that he had gained fourteen for one, and that if he had been so advised as to have brought salt thither, he had doubled his money above thirty times: we were assured that in this Town the King had yearly out of the silver Min●s above fifteen hundred Picos, which are forty thousand Quintals of our weight, besides the huge revenue, that he drew out of many other different things: This Town hath no other fortification than a weak brick wall, eight foot high, and a shallow ditch some thirty foot broad; The inhabitants are weak and una●med, having neither Artillery, nor any thing for their defence, so that five hundred resolute soldiers might easily take it. We parted from this place on Tuesday morning, and continued our course thirteen days, at the end whereof we got to the Port of Sanchan, in the Kingdom of China. Now because there was no shipping of Malaca there, for they were gone from thence nine days before, we went seven leagues further to another Port, named Lampacau, where we found two Juncks of Malaya, one of Patana, and another of Lugor; And whereas it is the quality of us Portugals to abound in our own sense, and to be obstinate in our opinions, there arose amongst us eight so great a contrariety of judgement about a thing, wherein nothing was so necessary for us, as to maintain ourselves in peace and unity, that we were even upon the point of killing one another; But because the matter would be too shameful to recount in the manner as it passed, I will say no more but that the Necoda of the Lorche, which had brought us thither from Vzamguee, amazed at this so great barbarousness of ours, separated himself from us in such displeasure, that he would not charge himself either with our messages or letters, saying, that he had rather the King should command his head to be cut off, then to offend God in carrying with him any thing whatsoever that belonged to us. Thus different as we were in opinions, and in very bad terms amongst ourselves, we lingered above nine days in this little Island, during which time the three Juncks departed without vouchsafing to take us in, so that we were constrained to remain in these solitud●s, exposed to many great dangers, out of which I did not think that ever we could have escaped, if God had not been extraordinarily merciful unto us; for having been there seventeen days in great misery and want; it happened that a Pirate, named Samipocheca, arrived in this place, who having been defeated, went flying from the Fleet of Aytao of Chincheo, that of eight and twenty Sail, which this Pirate had, had t●ken six and twenty of them from him, so that he had with much ado escaped with those only two remaining, wherein the most part of his men were hurt, for which cause he was constrained to stay there seven days to have them cured: Now the present necessity enforcing us to take some course whatsoever it were, we were glad to agree for to serve under him until such time as we might meet with some good opportunity to get unto Malaca. Those twenty days ended, wherein yet there was no manner of reconciliation between us, but still continuing in discord we embarked ourselves with this Pirate, namely three in the Junk where he himself was, and five in the other, whereof he had made a Nephew of his Captain. Having left this Island with an intent to sail unto a Port, called Lailoo, some seven leagues from Chincheo, we continued our voyage with a good wind all along the Coast of Lamau for the 〈◊〉 of nine days, until that one mo●ning when we were near to the river of salt, which is about five leagues from Chabaquea, it was our ill fortune to be assailed by a Pirate, who with seven great Juncks fell to fight with us from six in the morning till ten of the clock before noon, in which conflict we were so entertained with sho●, and pots full of artificial fire, that at last th●re were three S●il burnt, to wit, two of the Pirates, and one of ours, which was the Junck wherein the five Portugals were, whom we could by no means succour, for that then most of our men were hurt; But at length towards night being well refreshed by the afternoons gale, it pleased our Lord that we escaped out of this Pirate's hands. In this ill equipage wherein we were we continued our course for three days together, at the end whereof we were environed by so great and impetuous a Tempest, that the same night in which it seized us we lost the Coast, and because the violence of the Storm would never suffer us after to recover it again, we were forced to make with full Sail towards the Islands of the Lequios, where the Pirate, with whom we went, was well known, both to the King, and those of the Country; with this resolution we set ourselves to ●ail through the Archipelage of these Islands, where not withstanding we could not make land, as well for that we wanted a Pilot to steer the vessel, ours being slain in the last fight, as also because the wind and tide was against us; Amidst so m●ny crosses we beat up and down with labour enough from one ●homb to another for three and twenty days together, at the end whereof it pleased God that we discovered land, whereunto approaching to see if we could descry any appearance of a Port, or good anchorage, we perceived on the South-coast near to the Horizon of the Sea a great fire, which persuaded us that there we might peradventure find some Borough, where we might furnish ourselves with fresh water, whereof we had very great need. So we went and road just before the Island in seventy fathom, and presently we beheld two Almedias' come towards us from the Land with six men in them, who being come close to the side of our Junck, and having complemented with us according to their manner, demanded of us from whence we c●me? whereunto having answered, that we came from China with merchandise intending to trade in this place if we might be suffered, one of the six replied; That the Nautaquim, Lord of that Island, called Tanixumaa, would very willingly permit it upon payment of such customs as are usual in japan, which is, continued he, this great Country that you see here before you: At these news, and many other things, which they told us, we were exceeding glad, so that after they had showed us the Port, we weighed anchor, and went and put ourselves under the lee-shore of a creek, which was on the Southside, and where stood a great Town, named Miaygimaa, from whence there came instantly aboard of us divers Paraoos with refreshments, which we bought. We had not been two hours in this Creek of Miaygimaa, when as the Nautaquim, §. 2. Prince of this Island of Tanixumaa came directly to our Junck, attended by divers Gentlemen and Merchants, who had brought with them many Chests full of silver Ingots, therewith to barter for our commodities; so after ordinary compliments passed on either side, and that we had given our word for his easiest coming aboard of us; he no sooner perceived us three Portugals, but he demanded what people we were, saying, that by our beards and faces we could not be Chineses: Hereunto the Pirate answered, That we were of a Country called Malaca, whither many years before we were come from another Lend, named Portugal, which was at the further end of the world; At these words the Nautaquim remained much amazed, and turning himself to his followers; Let me not live, said he unto them, if these men here be not the Chenchicogis, of whom it is written in our books, that flying on the top of the waters they shall from thence subdue the inhabitants of the earth, where God hath created the riches of the world, wherefore it will be a good fortune for us if they come into our Country as good friends. Thereupon having called a woman of Lequia, whom he had brought to serve as an interpreter between him and the Chinese, Captain of the Junck; Ask the Necoda, said he unto h●r, where he met with these men, and upon what occasion he hath brought them hither with him into our Country of Jappon? The Captain thereunto replied, That we were honest men and Merchants, and that having found us at Lampacau, where we had been cast away, he had out of charity taken us in, as he used to do unto all such as he met withal in the like case, to the end that God might out of his gracious goodness be thereby moved to deliver him from the danger of such violent Tempests, as commonly they that sail on the Sea are subject to perish in. This saying of the Pirate seemed so reasonable to the Nautaquim, that he presently came aboard of us, and because those of his Train were very many, he commanded that none but such 〈◊〉 he named should enter in. After he had seen all the commodities in the Junck, he sat him down in a Chair upon the Deck, and began to question us about certain things which he desired to know, to the which we answered him in such sort, as we thought would be most agreeable to his humour, so that he seemed ●o be exceedingly satisfied therewith▪ In this manner he entertained us a good while together, making it apparent by his demands that he was a man very curious, and much inclined to hear of novelties, and rare things. That done he took his leave of us, and the Necoda, little regarding the rest, saying, Come and see me at my house to morrow, and for a present bring me an ample relation of the strange things of that great world through which you have traveled, as also of the Countries that you have seen, and withal remember to tell me how they are called, for I swear unto you that I would far more willingly buy this commodity than any that you can sell me. This said, he returned to Land, and the next morning as soon as it was day he sent us to our Junck a great Parao, full of divers sorts of refreshments, as Reasons, Pears, Melons, and other kinds of fruits of that Country; In exchange of this present the Necoda returned him by the same messenger divers rich pieces of stuff, together with certain knacks and rarities of China, and withal sent him word, that as soon as his Junck should be at anchor, and out of danger of the weather, he would come and wait on him ashore, and bring him some patterns of the commodities which we had to sell; as indeed the next mor●ing he went on land, and carried us three along with him, as also some ten or eleven of the chiefest of the Chinese of his Company, to the end that at this first sight he might settle a good opinion of himself in this people for the better satisfaction o● that vanity whereunto they are naturally inclined; we went then to the Nautaquims house, where we were very well entertained, and the Necoda having given him a rich present, showed him the patterns of all the commodities he had, wherewith he rested so contented, that he sent presently for the principal Merchants of the place, with whom ●he Necoda having agreed upon a price for his commodities, it was resolved that the next day they should be transported from the Junck unto a certain house, which was appointed for the Necoda and his people to remain in till such time as he should set sail for China: After all this was concluded, the Nautaquim fell again to questioning of us about many several matters, whereunto we rendered him such answers as might rather fit his humour, then agree with the truth indeed, which yet we did not observe but in some certain demands that he made us, where we thought it necessary to make use of certain particulars altogether feigned by us, that so we might not derogate from the great opinion he had conceived of our Country. The first thing he propounded was, how he had learned from the Chineses and Lequios, that Portugal was far richer, and of a larger extent, than the whole Empire of China, which we confirmed unto him. The second, how he had likewise been assured, that our King had upon the Sea conquered the greatest part of the world, which also we averred to be so; The third, that our King was so rich in gold and silver, as it was held for most certain, that he had above two thovand houses full of it even to the very tops; but thereunto we answered, that we could not truly say the number of the houses, because the Kingdom of Portugal was so spacious, so abounding with treasure, and so populous, a● it was impossible to specify the same. So after the Nautaquim had entertained us above two hours with such and the like discourse, he turned him to those of his Train, and said, Assuredly not one of those Kings, which at this present we know to be on the earth, is to be esteemed happy, if he be not the vassal of so great a Monarch as the Emperor of this people here. Whereupon having dismissed the Necoda and his Company, he entreated us to pass that night on shore with him, for to satisfy the extreme desire that he had to be informed from us of many things of the world, whereunto he was exceedingly carried by his own inclination; withal he told us, that the next day he would assign us a lodging next to his own Palace, which wa● in the most commodious place of the Town, and for that instant he sent us to lie at a very rich Merchant's house, who entertained us very bountifully that night. CHAP. XLIV. The great honour which the Nautaquim, Lord of the Isle, did to one of us for having seen him shoot with an Harquebuse; and his sending me to the King of Bungo; and that which passed till my arrival at his Court. §. 1 THe next day the Chinese Necoda disimbarqued all his commodities, as the Nautaquim had enjoined him, and put them into sure rooms, which were given him for that purpose, and in three days he sold them all, as well for that he had not many, as because his good fortune was such that the Country was at that time utterly unfurnished thereof, by which means this Pirate profited so much, that by this Sale he wholly recovered himself of the loss of the six & twenty Sail which the Chinese Pirate had taken from him; for they gave him any price he demanded, so that he confessed unto us, that of the value of some five and twenty hundred Taeis which he might have in goods, he made above thirty thousand. Now as for us three Portugals, having nothing to sell, we employed our time either in fishing, hunting, or seeing the Temples of these Gentiles, which were very sumptuous and rich, whereinto the Bonzes, who are their priests, received us very courteously, for indeed it is the custom of th●se of jappon to be exceeding kind and courteous. Thus we having little to do, one of us, called Diego Zeimoto, went many times a shooting for his pleasure in an Harquebuse that he h●d, wherein he was very expert, so that going one day by chance to a certain M●rsh, where there was great store of fowl, he killed at that time about six and twenty wild Ducks; In the mean time these people beholding this manner of shooting, which they had never seen before, were much amazed at it, insomuch that it came to the notice of the Nautaquim, who was at that instant riding of horses, and not knowing what to think of this novelty sent presently for Zeimoto, just as he was shooting in the Marsh, but when he saw him come with his Harquebuse on his shoulder and two Chinese with him carrying the fowl, he wasso mightily taken with the matter, as he could not sufficiently admire it: for whereas they had never seen any Gun before in that Country, they could not comprehend what it might be, so that for want of understanding the secret of the powder, they all concluded that of necessity it must be some Sorcery; Thereupon Zeimoto seeing them so astonished, and the Nautaquim so contented, made three shoots before them, whereof the effect was such▪ that he killed one Kite, and two Turtle Doves; In a word then, and not to lose time, by endearing the matter with much Speech, I will say no more, but that the Nautaquim caused Zeimoto to get up on the horses croupper behind him, and so accompanied with a great crowd of people, and four Hushers, who with Battouns headed with iron went before him, crying a●l along the streets, Know all men, that the Nautaquim, Prince of this Island of Tanixuma●, and Lord of our heads, enjoins and expressly commands▪ That all persons whatsoever, which inhabit the Land that lies between the two Seas, do honour thi● Chenchicogim, of the further end of the world, for even at this present and for hereafter he makes him his kinsman, in such manner as the Jacharons' are, who sit next his Person; and whosoever shall not do so willingly, he shall be sure to lose his head. Whereunto all the people answered with a great noise; We will do so for ever. In this pomp Zeimoto being come to the Palace gate, the Nautaquim alighted from his horse, and taking him by the hand, whilst we two followed on foot a pretty way after, he led him into his Court, where he made him sit with him at his own table, and to honour him the more, he would needs have him lodge there that night, showing many other favours to him afterwards, and to us also for his sake. Now Zeimoto conceiving, that he could not better acknowledge the honour which the Nautaquim did him, then by giving him his Harquebuse, which he thought would be a most acceptable present unto him; on a day when he came home from shooting, he ●endred it unto him with a number of Pigeons and Turtle-doves, which he received very kindly, as a thing of great value, assuring him that he esteemed of it more, then of all the treasures of China, and giving him withal in recompense thereof a thousand Taeis in silver, he desired him to teach him how to make the powder, saying, that without that the Harquebuse would be of no use to him, as being but a piece of unprofitable iron, which Zeimoto promised him to do, and accordingly performed the same. Now the Nautaquim taking pleasure in nothing so much as shooting in this Harquebuse, and his Subjects perceiving that they could not content him better in any thing, then in this, wherewith he was so much delighted, they took a pattern of the said Harquebuse to make others by it, & the effect thereof was such, that before our departure (whichwas five months & an half after) there was six hundred of them made in the Country; nay I will say more, that afterwards, namely▪ the l●st time that the Viceroy Don Alphonso de Noro●ha sent me thither with a present to the K●ng of Bungo, which happened in the year 1556. those of jappon affirmed, that in the City of Fucheo, being the chief of that Kingdom, there were above thirty thousand; whereat finding myself to be much amazed, for that it seemed impossible unto me, that this invention should multiply in such sort, certain Merchants of good credit assured me that in the whole Island of jappon there were above three hundred thousand Harquebuses, and that they alone had transported of them in the way of trade to the Country of the Lequios, at ●ix several times, to the number of five and twenty hundred; so that by the means of that one, which Zeimoto presented to the Nautaquim in acknowledgement of the honour and good offices that he had done h●m, as I have declared be●ore, the Country was filled with such abundance of them, as at this day there is not so small an hamlet but ●ath an hundred at the least; for as for Cities and great Towns they have them by thousands, whereby one may perceive what the inclination of this people is, and how much they are naturally addicted to the wars, wherein they take more delight, than any other Nation that we know. §. 2. We had been now three and twenty days in the Island of Tanixumaa, where very contentedly we passed away the time, either in fishing, fowling, or hunting, whereunto these people of jappon are much addicted, when as a vessel belonging to the King of Bungo a 〈◊〉 in that Port, in the which were divers men of quality, and certain Merchants, who●as ●oon as ●h●y were landed went to wait upon the Nautaquim with their presents, according to the usual▪ 〈◊〉 of the Country: Amongst them there was an ancient man, very well attended, and unto whom the rest carried much respect, that falling on his knees before the Nautaquim, presented him with a letter, and a rich Court●lass garnished with gold, together with a box full of ve●●iloes, which the Nautaquim received with a great deal of ceremony: Then having spent some time with him in ask of certain questions, he read the letter to himself, and thereupon having remained a pretty while as it were in suspense, and dismissed the bearer thereof from his presence, with an express charge unto those about him to see him honourably entertained, he called us unto him, and commanded the Truchman that was there by, to use these words unto us, My good Friends, I entreat you that you will hear this letter read, which is sent me from my Lord and Uncle, and then I will let you know what I desire of you; So giving it to a Treasurer of his, he commanded him to read it, which instantly he did, and these were the contents of it, Thou right eye of my face, Hyascarangoxo, Nautaquim of Tanixuma, I Orgemdoo, who am your Father in the true love of my bowels, as he from whom you have taken the name and being of your Person, King of Bungo and Facataa, Lord of the great House of Fiancima, Tosa, and Bandou, Chief Sovereign of the petty Kings of the Islands of Goto, and Xamanaxequa, I give you to understand, my Son, by the words of my mouth, which are spoken of your person, that some days since certain men, coming from your Country, have assured me, that you have in your Town three Chenchicogims of the other end of the world, men that accommodate themselves very well with those of Japan, are clothed in silk, and usually wear swords by their sides, not like Merchants that use traffic, but in the quality of persons that make profession of honour, and which by that only mean pretend to render their names immortal; Moreover I have heard for a truth, that these same men have entertained you at large with all matters of the whole Universe, and have affirmed unto you on their faith that there is another world greater than ours, inhabited with black and tawny people, of whom they have told you things most incredible to our judgement, for which cause I infinitely desire you, as if you were my Son, that by Fiangeandono, whom I have dispatched from hence to visit my daughter, you will send me one of those three strangers, which I am told you have in your house; the rather for that you know my long indisposition, accompanied with so much pain and grief, hath great need of some diversion: Now if it should happen that they would not be willing thereunto, you may then assure them, as well on your own faith, as on mine, that I will not fail to return them back in all safety; whereupon, like a good Son that desires to please his Father, so order the matter that I may rejoice myself in the sight if them, and so have my desire accomplished. What I have further to say unto you, my Ambassador Fingeandono shall acquaint you with, by whom I pray you liberally import to me the good news of your person, and that of my daughter, seeing she is as you know the apple of my right eye, whereof the sight is all the joy of my face. From the house of Fucheo the seventh Mamoque of the Moon. After that the Nautaquim had heard this letter read; The King of Bungo, said he unto us, is my Lord, and my Uncle, the brother of my mother, and above all he is my good Father, for I call him by that name, because he is so to my wife, which is the reason that he loves me no less than his own children, wherefore I count myself exceedingly bound unto him, and do so much desire to please him, that I could now find in my heart to give the best part of my Estate for to be transformed into one of you, as well for to go unto him, as to give him the content of seeing you, which out of the knowledge I have of his disposition, I am assured he will value more than all the treasures of China; Now having thus acquainted you with his desire, I earnestly entreat you to render yourselves conformable thereunto, and that one of you two will take the pains to go to Bungo, there to see that King whom I hold for my Father, and my Lord, for as for this other to whom I have given the name and being of a kinsman, I am not willing to part with him till he hath taught me to shoot as well as himself. Hereupon Christovano Borralho, and I, greatly satisfied with the Nautaquim's courtesy, answered him, that we kissed his Highness' hands for the exceeding honour he did us in vouchsafing to make use of us, and seeing it was his pleasure so to do, that he should for that effect make choice of which of us two he thought best, and he should not fail to be suddenly ready for the voyage. At these words standing a while in musing to himself, he looked on me, and said, I am resolved to send him there, because he seems not so solemn, but is of a more lively humou●, wherewith those of japon are infinitely delighted, and may thereby cheer up the sick man, whereas the too serious gravity of this other, said he, turning him to Borralho, though very commendable for more important matters, would serve but to entertain his melancholy in stead of diverting it. Thereupon falling into merry discourse and jesting with those about him, whereunto the people of japon are much inclined, the Fingeandono arrived, unto whom he presented me, with a special and particular recommendation touching the assurance of my person, wherewith I was not only well satisfied, but had my mind also cleared from certain doubts, which out of the little knowledge I had of these people's humours, had formerly troubled me. This done, the Nautaquim commanded two hundred Taeis to be given me for the expense of my voyage, whereupon the Fingeandono and I embarked ourselves in a vessel with O●rs, called a Funce, and in one night having traversed all this Island of Tanixumaa, the next morning we c●st anchor in an Haven, named Hiamangoo, from whence we went to a good Town, called Quanquixumaa, and so continuing our course afore the wind, with a very fair gale, we arrived the day ensuing at a very sweet place, named Tanora, whence the morrow after we went to Minato, and so forward to a Fortress of the King of Bungoes, cal●ed Osquy, where the Fingeandono stayed some time, by reason that the Captain of the place (who was his Brother in law) found himself much indisposed in his health. There we left the vessel in which we came, and so went by land directly to the City, where being arrived about noon, the Fingeandono, because it was not a time fit to wait upon the King, went to his own house. After dinner having rested a little, and shifted himself into a better habit, he mounted on horseback, and with certain of his friends rode to the Court, carrying me along with him, where the King was no sooner advertised of his coming, but he sent a Son of his about nine or ten years of age to receive him, who accompanied with a number of Noblemen, richly apparelled, and his Ushers with their Maces going before him, took the Fingeandono by the hand, and beholding him with a smiling countenance; May thy entrance, said he unto him, into this house of the King my Lord, bring thee as much content and honour as thy children deserve, and are worthy, being thine, to sit at table with me in the solemn Feasts. At these words the Fingeandono prostrating himself on the ground; My Lord, answered he, I most humbly beseech them that are in Heaven above, which have taught thee to be so courteous and so good, either to answer for me, or to give me a tongue so voluble, as may express my thankfulness in terms agreeable to thy ears for the great honour thou art pleased to do me at this present, for in doing otherwise I should offend no less, than those ingrateful wretches, which inhabit the lowest pit of the profound and obscure house of smoke: This said, he offered to kiss the Curtelass which the young Prince wore by his side, which he would by no means permit, but taking him by the hand, he led him to the King his Father, unto whom, lying sick in his bed, he delivered a letter from the Nautaquim, which after he had read, he commanded him to call me in from the next room where I stayed attending, which instantly he did, and presented me to the King, who entertaining me very graciously. Thy arrival, said he unto me, in this my Country is no less pleasing to me, than the rain which falls from Heaven is profitable to our fields that are sowed with Rice. Finding myself somewhat perplexed with the novelty of these terms, and this manner of salutation, I made him no answer for the instant, which made the King say to the Lords that were about him, I imagine that this str●nger is daunted with seeing so much company here, for that peradventure he hath not been accustomed unto it, wherefore I hold it fit to remit him unto some other time, when as he may be better acquainted, and not be so abashed at the sight of people. Upon this Speech of the Kings I answered by my Truchman, that whereas his Highness had said that I was daunted, I confessed that it was true, not in regard of so many folks as were about me, because I had seen far many more, but that my amazement proceeded from the consideration that I was now before th● feet of so great a King, which was sufficient to make me mute an hundred thous●nd years, if I could live so long▪ I added further, that those which were present there seemed to me but men, as I myself was, but as for his Highness, that God had given him such great advantages above all, as it was his pleasure that he should be Lord, and that others should be mere servants, yea, and that I myself was but a silly Ant, in comparison of his greatness, so that his Majesty could not see me in regard of my smallness, nor I in respect thereof be able to answer unto his demands. All the Assistants made such account of this mad answer of mine, as clapping their hands by way of astonishment, they said unto the King, Mark I beseech your Highness how he speaks to purpose; verily it seems that this man is not a Merchant, which meddles with base things as buying and selling, but rather a Bonzo, that offers sacrifices for the people, or if not so, surely he is some great Captain that hath a long time scoured the Seas. Truly, said the King, I am of the same opinion, now that I see him so resolute; but let every man be silent, because I purpose that none shall speak to him but myself alone, for I assure you that I take so much delight in hearing him talk, that at this instant I feel no pain. At those words the Queen and her daughters, which were set by him, were not a little glad, and falling on their knees, with their hands li●●ed up to Heaven, they thanked God for this his great goodness unto him. CHAP. XLV. The great mishap that befell the King of Bungoes Son, with the extreme danger that I was in for the same; and what followed thereupon. A Little after the King caused me to approach unto his bed, where he lay sick of the Gout, when I was near him, §. 1 I pray thee, said he unto me, be not unwilling to stay here by me, for it does me much good to look on thee, and talk with thee; thou shalt also oblige me to let me know whether in thy Country, which is at the further end of the world, thou hast not learned any remedy for this disease wherewith I am tormented, or for the lack of appetite, which hath continued with me now almost these two months without eating any thing to speak of. Hereunto I answered, that I made no profession of physic, for that I had never learned that art, but that in the Junck, wherein I came from China, there was a certain wood, which infused in water healed far greater sicknesses then that whereof he complained, and that if he took of it, it would assuredly help him; To hear of this he was very glad, insomuch that transported with an extreme desire to be healed, he sent away for it in all haste to Tanixumaa, where the Junck lay, and having used of it thirty days together, he perfectly recovered of this disease, which had held him so for two years together, as he was not able to stir from one place to another. Now during the time that I remained with much content in this City of Fuchea, being some twenty days, I wanted not occasions to entertain myself withal; for sometimes I was employed in answering the questions, which the King, Queen, Princes, and Lords asked of me, wherein I easily satisfied them, for that the matters they demanded of me, were of very little consequence. Otherwhiles I bestowed myself in beholding their Solemnities, the Temples, where they offered up their prayers, their warlike Exercises, their naval Fleets, as also their fishing and hunting, wherein they greatly delight, especially in the high flying of Falcons, and Vultures. Oftentimes I passed away the time with my Harquebuse in killing of Turtles, and Quails, whereof there is great abundance in the Country. In the mean season this new manner of shooting seemed no less marvellous and strange to the inhabitants of this Land, then to them of Tanixumaa, so that beholding a thing which they had n●ver seen before, they made more reckoning of it then I am able to express, which was the cause that the King's second Son, named Arichaudono, of the age of sixteen or seventeen years, and whom the King wonderfully loved, entreated me one day to teach him to shoot, but I put him off, by saying that there needed a far longer time for it then he imagined, wherewith not well pleased, he complained to his Father of me, who to content the Prince desired me to give him a couple of charges for the satisfying of his mind; whereunto I answered, that I would give him as many as his Highness would be pleased to command me. Now because he was that day to dine with his Father, the matter was referred to the afternoon, howbeit then too there was nothing done, for th●t he waited on his Mother to a Village adjoining, whither they came from all parts on pilgrimage by reason of a certain feast, which was celebrated there for the health of the King: The next day this young Prince came with only two young Gentlemen waiting on him to my lodging, where finding me asleep on a Mat, and my Harquebuse hanging on a hook by, he would not wake me till he had shot off a couple of charges, intending, as he told me afterwards himself, that these two shoots should not be comprised in them I had promised him: H●ving then commanded one of the young Gentlemen, that attended him, to go softly and kindle the Match, he took down the Harquebuse from the place where it hung, and going to charge it, as he had seen me do, not knowing how much powder he should put in, he charged the Piece almost two spans deep, then putting in the bullet, he set himself with it to shoot at an Orange tree that was not far off, but fire being given, it was his ill hap that the Harquebuse broke into three pieces, and gave him two hurts, by one of the which his right hand thumb was in a manner lost, instantly whereupon the Prince fell down as one dead, which the two Gentlemen perceiving, they ran away towards the Court, crying along in the streets that the strangers Harquebuse had killed the Prince; At these sad news the people flocked in all haste with weapons and great cries to the house where I was; Now God knows whether I was not a little amazed when coming to awake I saw this tumult, as also the young Prince lying along upon the floor by me weltering in his own blood without stirring either hand or foot; All that I could do then was to embrace him in my arms, so besides myself, as I knew not where I was. In the mean time, behold the King comes in a Chair carried upon four men's shoulders, and so sad and pale, as he seemed more dead than alive; after him followed the Queen on foot leaning upon two Ladies, with her two daughters, and a many of women all weeping. As soon as they were entered into the Chamber, and beheld the young Prince extended on the ground, as if he had been dead, embraced in my arms, and both of us wallowing in blood, they all concluded that I had killed him, so that two of the Company drawing out their Scymitars, would have slain me; which the King perceiving, Stay, stay, cried he, let us know first how the matter goes, for I fear it comes further off, and that this fellow here hath been corrupted by some of those Traitor's kindred, whom I caused to be last executed. Thereupon commanding the two young Gentlemen to be called which had accompanied the Prince, his Son, thither, he questioned them very exactly; Their answer was, that my Harquebuse with the enchantments in it had killed him: This deposition served but to incense the Assistants the more, who in a rage addressing themselves to the King; What need, Sir, have you to hear more, cried they? here is but too much, let him be put to a cruel death: Therewith they sent in all haste for the jarabuca, who was my Interpreter, to them; now for that upon the arrival of this disaster he was out of extreme fear fled away, they brought him straightly bound to the King, but before they fell to examining of him, they mightily threatened him, in case he did not confess the truth; whereunto he answered trembling, and with tears in his eyes, that he would reveal all that he knew. In the mean time being on my knees, with my hands bound, a Bonzo, that was Precedent of their Justice, having his arms bared up to his shoulders, and a Poniard in his hand dipped in the blood of the young Prince, said thus unto me, I conjure thee, thou Son of some Devil, and culpable of the same crime, for which they are damned that inhabit in the house of smoke, where they lie buried in the obscure and deep pit of the Centre of the earth, that thou confess unto me with a voice so loud, that every one may hear thee, for what cause thou hast with these sorceries and enchantments killed this young innocent, whom we hold for the hairs, and principal ornament of our heads. To this demand I knew not what to answer upon the sudden, for that I was so far besides myself, as if one had taken away my life, I believe I should not have felt it; which the Precedent perceiving, and beholding me with a terrible countenance, Seest thou not, continued he, that if thou dost not answer to the questions I ask thee, that thou mayst hold thyself for condemned to a death of blood, of fire, of water, and of the blasts of the wind; for thou shalt be dismembered into the air, like the feathers of dead fowl, which the wind carries from one place to another, separated from the body with which they were joined whilst they lived. This said, he gave me a great kick with his foo● for to rouse up my spirits, and cried out again, Speak, confess who they are that have corrupted thee? What sum of money have they given thee? how are they called? and where are they at this present? At these words being somewhat come again to myself, I answered him, that God knew my innocence, and that I took him for witness thereof▪ But he not contented with what he had done began to menace me more than before, and set before my eyes an infinite of torments and terrible things; wherein a long time being spent, it pleased God at length that the young Prince came to himself, who no sooner saw the King his Father, as also his Mother and Sisters dissolved into tears, but that he desired them not to weep, and that if he chanced to die, they would attribute his death to none but himself, who was the only cause thereof, conjuring them moreover by the blood, wherein they beheld him weltering, to cause me to be unbound without all delay, if they desired not to make him die anew: The King much amazed with this language, commanded the Manacles to be taken off which they had put upon me; whereupon came in four Bonzoes' to apply remedies unto him, but when they saw in what manner he was wounded, & that his thumb hung in a sort but by the skin, they were so troubled a● it, as they knew not what to do; which the poor Prince observing, Away, away, said he, send hence these devils, and let others come that have more heart to judge of my hurt, since it hath pleased God to send it me; Therewith the four Bonzoes' were sent away, and other four came in their stead, who likewise wanted the courage to dress him, which the King perceiving was so much troubled as he knew not what to do, howbeit he resolved at length to be advised therein by them that were about him, who counselled him to send for a Bonzo, called Teix●andono, a man of great reputation amongst them, and that lived then at the City of Facataa, some seventy leagues from that place; but the wounded Prince not able to brook these delays; I kn●w not, answered he, what you mean by this counsel which you give my Father, seeing me in the deplorable estate wherein I am, for whereas I ought to have been dr●st already, you would have me stay for an old rotten man, who cannot be here until one hath made a journey of an hundred and forty leagues, both in going and coming, so that it must be a month at least before he can arrive, wherefore speak no more of it, but if you desire to do me a pleasure, free this Stranger a little from the fear you have put him in, and clear the room of all this throng, he that you believe hath hurt me will help me as he may, for I had rather die under the hands of this poor wretch, that hath wept so much for me, then be touched by the Bonzo of Faca●a●, who at the age he is of, of ninety and two years, can see no further than his nose. CHAP. XLVI. My curing the young Prince of Bungo; with my return to Tanixu●●a, and embarking there for Liampoo; and also that which happened to us on land, after the shipwreck we suffered by the way. §. 1. THe King of Bungo being extremely grieved to see the disaster of his Son, turned himself to me, and beholding me with a very gentle countenance; Stranger, said he unto me, try I pray thee if thou canst assist my Son in this peril of his life, for I swore unto thee if thou canst do it, I will make no less esteem of thee, then of him himself, and will give thee whatsoever thou wilt demand of me: Hereunto I answered the King, that I desired his Majesty to command all those people away, because the coil that they kept confounded me, and that then I would see whether his hurts were dangerous, for if I found that I was able to cure them, I would do it most willingly: Presently the King willed every one to be gone, whereupon approaching unto the Prince, I perceived that he had but two hurts; one on the top of his forehead, which was no great matter, and the other on his right hand thumb, that was almost cut off: So that our Lord inspiring me, as it were, with new courage, I besought the King not to be grieved, for I hoped in les● then a month to render him his Son perfectly recovered. Having comforted him in this manner, I began to prepare myself for the dressing of the Prince, but in the mean time the King was very much reprehended by the Bon●oes, who told him, that his Son would assuredly die that night, and therefore it was better for him to put me to death presently, then to suffer me to kill the Prince outright, adding further, that if it should happen to prove so, as it was very likely, it would not only be a great scandal unto him, but also much alienate his people's affections from him. To these speeches of the Bonzoes' the King replied, that he thought they had reason for that they said, and therefore he desired them to let him know how he should govern himself in this extremity; You must, said they, stay the coming of the Bonzo Teix●andono, and never think of any other course, for we assure you in regard he is the holiest man living he will no sooner lay his hand on him but he will heal him strait, as he hath healed many oth●rs in our ●ight: As the King was even resolved to follow the cursed counsel of th●se servants of the Devil, the Prince complained that his wounds pained 〈◊〉 in such sort a● he was no●●ble to endure it, and therefore prayed any handsome remedy might▪ be instantly applied to them, whereupon the King, much distracted between the opinion of the Bonzoes', and the danger that his Son was in of his life, together with the extreme pain that he suffered, desired those about him to advice him what he should resolve on, in that exigent; not one of them but was of the mind, that it was far more expedient to have the Prince dressed out of hand, then to stay the time which the Bonzoes' spoke of. This counsel being approved of the King, he came again to me, and making very much of me, he promised me mighty matters if I could recover his Son; I answered him with tears in my eyes, that by the help of God I would do it, and that he himself should be witness of my care therein: So recommending myself to God, and taking a good heart unto me, for I saw there was no other way to save my life, but that, I prepared all things necessary to perform the cure. Now because the hurt of the right hand thumb was most dangerous, I begun with that, and give it seven stitches, whereas peradventure if a Chirurgeon had dressed him, he would have given it fewer; as for that of the forehead, I gave it but four, in regard it was much slighter than the other; that done, I applied to them tow wet in the whites of eggs, and so bound them up very close, as I had seen others done in the Indias: Five days after I cut the stitches, and continued dressing him as before, until that at the end of twenty days it plea●●d God he was throughly cured, without any other inconvenience remaining to him, than a little weakness in his thumb; For this cause after that time the K●ng and all his Lords did me much honour; the Queen also, and the Princesses her daughters presented me with a great many Suits of silks, and the chiefest of the Court with Scimitars, and other things, besides all which the King gave me six hundred Taeis, so that after this sort I received in recompense of this my cure above fifteen hundred Ducats, that I carried with me from this place. After things were passed in this manner, being advertised by letters from my two Companions at Tanixumaa, that the Chinese Pirate, with whom we came thither, was preparing for his return to China, I besought the King of Bungo to give me leave to go back, which he readily granted me, and with much acknowledgement of the curing of his Son he willed a Funce to be made ready for me, furnished with all things necessary, wherein commanded a man of quality, that was attended by twenty of the King's servants, with whom I departed one Saturday morning from the City of Fucheo, and the Friday following about Sunset I arrived at Tanixumaa, where I found my two Comrades, who received me with much joy. Here we continued fifteen days longer, till such time as the Junck was quite ready, and then we set Sail for Liampoo, which is a Seaport of the Kingdom of China, whereof I have spoken at large heretofore, and where at that time the Portugals traded. Having continued our voyage with a prosperous wind, it pleased God that we arrived safe at our desired Port, where it is not to be believed how much we were welcome by the Inhabitants of the place. Now because it seemed strange unto them, that we had voluntarily submitted ourselves in that sort to the bad faith of the Chinese, they asked of us from what Country we came, and where it was that we embarked ourselves with them? whereupon we freely declared unto them the truth of all, and gave them an account of our Voyage, as also of the new Land of japon that we had discovered, the great abundance of silver that was there, and the exceeding profit that might be made by carrying the commodities of China thither; wherewith they were wonderfully contented, and instantly ordained a general Procession to be made by way of thanksgiving unto God for so great a blessing: But withal covetousness began in such sort to seize upon the hearts of most of the Inhabitants, every one striving to be the foremost in this voyage, as they came to divide themselves into troops, and to make several parties, so that even with weapons in their hands they went thronging to buy up the commodities of that Country, which made the Chinese Merchants, upon the sight of our unruly avarice, set so high a price upon their wares, that whereas a Pico of silk was at first not worth forty Taeis, it rose before the end of eight days to an hundred and threescore, at which rate too the Merchants seemed to part with it very willingly. Thus by the means of this unreasonable desire of gain nine Juncks, which were then in the Port, were in fifteen days ready to set Sail, though to say the truth they were all in such disorder, and so unprovided, that some amongst them had no other Pilots than the Masters themselves, who had but little underst●anding in Navigation. In this bad order they departed all in company together one Sunday morning, notwithstanding that they had the wind, the season, the sea, and all things else contrary, not suffering themselves to be guided by reason, or the consideration of the dangers which they are subject unto that commit themselves to this Element; For they were so obstinate and so blinded as they would not represent any inconvenience to themselves, and I myself was so infortunate, that I went along with them in one of their Vessels. In this manner they sailed all that same day as it were groping between the Islands and the firm Land, but about midnight there arose in the dark so mighty a Storm, accompanied with such horrible rain, that suffering themselves to be carried at the mercy of the wind, they ran upon the Sands of Gotom, whereof the nine Juncks two only, as it were by miracle, were saved, so that the other seven were lost out of which not so much as one man escaped. This loss was thought to amount unto above three hundred thousand Crowns in commodities, besides the greater, which was of six hundred persons that left their lives there, whereof there were an hundred and forty Portugals, all rich men, and of quality. As for the other two Juncks in one of the which by good hap I was, joining in con●ort together, they followed the course they had begun, until such time as they arrived at the Island of the Lequios; There we were beaten with so furious a North-east wind, which increased by the conjunction of the new Moon, that our vessels were separated in such sort as we could never see one another again: After dinner the wind turned to West Northwest, whereby the Sea was so moved, and the waves rose with such fury, as it was a most dreadful thing to behold; whereupon our Captain, named Gaspar Melo, a very courageous Gentleman, seeing the greatest part of the prow of the Junck to be half open, and that there was ni●e spans water in the bottom of her, he resolved by the advice of all the Officers to cut down the two Masts, whose weight was the cause of the opening of the Junck, howbeit this could not be done with such care, but that the main Mast in its ●all overwhelmed fourteen persons, whereof five were Portugals, which were all crushed in pieces, a spectacle so lamentable to behold that it exceedingly grieved every man's heart. Now forasmuch as the Storm increased more and more, we were constrained to let ourselves be carried at the mercy of the Sea even until Sunset, at which time the Junck made an end of splitting quite asunder, whereupon our Captain and every one of us, seeing the deplorable estate whereunto our sins had reduced us, fell to preparing ourselves for our last end. Having in this sort passed away half of the night, about the first quarter of the watch we struck upon a Shel●, where at the first blow the Junck broke all to pieces, the event whereof was so lamentable that threescore and two men left their lives there, some of which were drowned, and the rest squeezed to death under the Keel of the Vessel. §. 2. There were but four and twenty of us, besides some women, that escaped from this miserable Shipwreck; Now as soon as it was day we perceived by the sight of the Island of fire, and of the Mountain of Taydacano, that the Land where we were was the great Lequio, whereupon wi●h tears in our eyes recommending ourselves ●o God, and marching up to the breast in water, we swum over certain deeper places, and so went five days together in great pain, not finding in all that time any thing to eat but the slime which the Sea cast up on the mud; Howbeit a● length by the mercy of God we got to land, where going into the woods we sustained ourselves with a certain herb like unto Sorrel, whereof there was great plenty along these Coasts, which was all the nourishment that we had for three days space that we were there, until at last we were espied by a boy that was keeping of cattle, who as soon as he had discovered us, ran to the next Village, which was some quarter of a league off, for to give notice of it to the inhabitants there; who presently thereupon with the sound of Drums and Cornets assembled all their Neighbours round about them, so that within three or four hours they w●re a Company of about two hundred men, whereof there were fourteen on horseback. As soon as they descried us a far off, they made directly towards us, whereupon our Captain, seeing the wretched estate whereunto we were reduced, fell down upon his knees, and began to encourage us with many good words, desiring us to remember, That nothing in the world could fall out without the Providence of God, and therefore like good Christians we should assure ourselves it was his pleasure, that this should be the last hour of our lives, so that we could not do better then to conform ourselves to his holy will, and with patience embrace this pitiful end, which came from his Almighty hand, craving pardon from the botto● of our hearts for all our sins past; and that for himself he had such confidence in his mercy, that we duly repenting us according as we were obliged by his holy Commandments, he would not forget us in this our extremity. Having made us this Exhortation, and lifted up his hands to Heaven, he cried out three times together with abundance of tears, Lord have mercy upon us, which words were reiterated by all the rest, but with such sighs and groans of true Christians, and so full of devotion and zeal, that I may truly say, the thing which then we feared lest was that which naturally is most abhorred. As we were in this grievous agony six horsemen came unto us, and beholding us in a manner naked, without arms, on the ground upon ou● knees, and two women lying as it were dead before us, they were so moved with compassion, that four of them turning back to the footmen, which were coming on, made them all to stay, not suffering them to approach us; Howbeit a little after they came to us again, bringing with them six footmen, which seemed to b● some of the Officers of Justice, who by the commandment of the horsemen tied us, three and three together, and with some show of pity bid us, That we should not be afraid, for that the King of the Lequios was a man greatly fearing God, and very well inclined to the poor, upon whom he continually bestowed much alms: Moreover they swore unto us by their Law, that we should receive no hurt, yet could we not by any means be persuaded thereunto, for at that time we had so little hope of life, that if persons worthy of credit had assured us of it we should hardly have believed them, much les● those cruel and detestable Gentiles, who neither had Religion, nor any knowledge of God: When they had tied us together, the footmen placed us in the midst of them, whilst those on horseback coursed up and down on every side, as though they had gone the round; now we no sooner began to march, but that the three wom●n, which were with us more dead than alive, fell down on the place in a swoon, partly through their natural weakness, and partly through the fear they were in, so that the footmen were forced to take them up in their arms, and each one to carry them in his turn, howbeit for all that before we could arrive at the place whither they were leading us, two of the three died, and were left in the Wood for a prey to the Wolves, Foxes, and other Wild-beasts, whereof we saw great plenty thereabout. At length after we had marched a good while we arrived about Sunset at a great Borough where we were presently put into a Pagode or Temple of theirs, which was environed with very high walls, and yet for the more security they placed an hundred men about it to guard us all that night, who with their cries and beating of their Drums, kept us waking till the next morning, for the noise thereof, and the consideration of our present misery, would not suffer us to take any rest. CHAP. XLVII. The carrying of us to the Town of Pungor, and presenting us to the Broquen, Governor of the Kingdom; with that which ensued upon it. AS soon as it was morning the next day the chiefest women of the Town came to visit us, §. 1 and in way of charity brought us a quantity of Rice, boiled fish, and certain fruits of the Country for us to eat, she wing themselves to be much moved with our misery, as well by their words, as by their tears; and seeing the extreme need we stood in of clothes, for that we had little, or scarce any upon our bodies, six amongst them, which for that purpose were chosen by the rest, went a begging for us through all the streets of the Town, saying; O good folks, good folks, which make profession of the Law of the Lord, whose property it is, if one may say so, to show himself prodigal towards us by communicating his benefits unto us, come forth of your houses to behold the flesh of our flesh, which the wrath of the hand of the Lord Almighty hath touched, and succour them with your alms, to the end the mercy of his greatness may not abandon you, as it hath done them. These words were of such force to stir up their charity, as within less than an hour we were abundantly furnished with all things necessary for us: But about three of the clock in the afternoon came a Post to this Borough with letters to the Xivalon of the place, that is the Captain thereof, who had no sooner read them, but he caused two Drums to beat an Alarm, at the sound whereof all the people assembled together in ● great Pagode or Temple, where out of a window he spoke unto them, and gave them to understand that the Broquen, the Governor of the Kingdom, had commanded us to be brought to the Town of Pung●r, which was some seven leagues from thence. The most part of them at first refused to obey this command, so that there was great contention about it, in such sort that nothing could be agreed upon all that day, by means whereof the Post was returned to the Broquen with a relation of that which had passed, and so we were left there till eight of the clock the next morning, at which time two Peretanda●s, who are as it were Judges, came accompanied with divers Burgesses, and some twenty horsemen unto us, and after many writings drawn up by certain public Registers concerning us, they sent us away the same day to a Town, called Gond●xilau, where we were put into a dungeon, made in the fashion of a Ci●ter●, remaining there till the next day up to the middle in filthy standing water, that was full of ho●sleeches, which made us all gore blood▪ As soon as it was morning they carried us towards Pungor, where we arrived about four of the clock in the afternoon, now because it was late the Broquen would not see us till the day following, and then bound together as we were, he caused us to be led through ●our of the principal streets of the City, where the people thronging from all parts to behold us, seemed much to pity our misery, chiefly the women; In this manner we were brought to a Court of Justice, where there was a great many of Officers, amongst whom we continued a long time waiting for the coming of the Judge, at length upon the thrice striking of a clock, a door that stood just against the place where we attended, was presently opened, by which we entered into a very spacious Hall, where the Governor sat upon a Throne all adorned with rich tapestry, and under a Cloth of State of silver tinsel; round about him were six Ushers upon their knees, carrying Maces on their shoulders, and all along the room stood a Guard with Halberds in their hands, damasked with gold and silver; All the rest of the Hall was full of people of div●rs Nations, the like whereof we had not seen in those Countries. After silence was imposed on ●l● that were present, we prostrated ourselves before the Throne of the Broquen, and weeping said unto him, Sir, we beseech thee by that God which hath made Heaven and Earth, and on whose power we all of us depend, to take pity of our miserable fortune, for since the waves of the Sea hath brought us to the lamentable estate, and wretched condition wherein thou seest us, we most humbly desire thee that thy goodness will be pleased to put us into a better before the King, to the end he may be incited to have compassion on us poor strangers, that are destitute of all succour and favour of the world, for so it hath pleased God to have it in regard of our sins. At these words the Broquen looking on them that were abou● him, and shaking his head, What think you of these people, said he unto them, verily here is one of them that speaks of God as a man which hath the knowledge of his truth, so that we may conclude without all doubt, that there is another great world whereof we have no notice, wherefore since these men know the Source of all good, it is reasonable that we should proceed with them according to the request they have made unto us with so many tears. Whereupon turning him towards us, who all this while lay prostrated on the ground, with our hands lifted up, as if we were worshipping God; I must confess, said he unto us, that I have so great compassion of your misery, and am so grieved to see you so poor as you are, as I assure you in all verity, that I had rather, if it were the good pleasure of the King, be like unto one of you, as wretched as you are, then to see myself in this office, which questionless was conferred on me for my sins: wherefore I would be loath to offend you, but the duty of my place obliging me thereunto, I must desire you as friends not to be troubled, if I ask you some questions, which are necessary for the good of justice; and as touching your deliverance, if God affords me life, be assured you shall have it, for I am most confident that the King my Master's inclination to the poor is truly Royal. These promises exceedingly contented us, and to thank him for them we had recourse to our tears, which we shed in abundance, for our hearts were so full, as we could not possibly bring forth a word to answer him. §. 2. The Broquen caused four Registers, the two Peretandaos of the Court aforesaid, and some eleven or twelve other Officers of Justice, to come immediately before him; Then rising on his feet, he began with a severe countenance, and a naked Scymitar in his hand, to examine us, speaking so loud as every one might hear him; I Pinaquila, said he, Broquen of this City of Pungor by the good pleasure of him whom we all hold for the hairs of our heads, King of the Nation of the Lequios, and of all this Country of the two Seas, where the fresh and salted waters divide the Ours of his treasures, do advise and command you by the rigour and force of my words, to tell me clearly, and with a clean heart, what people, and of what Nation you are, as also where your Country is, and how it is called? To this demand we answered according to the truth, that we were Portugals, Natives of Malaca. It is well, added he, but what adventure brought you into this Country, and whither did you intend to go when as you suffered shipwreck? We replied thereunto, That being Merchants, who make no other profession then of traffic, we had embarked ourselves in the Kingdom of China, for to go from the Port of Liampoo to Tanixumaa, where we had formerly been, but that arriving near to the Island of Fire we were surprised by a mighty tempest, so that not able to oppose the violence of the Sea, we were constrained to lie at the mercy of the winds for the space of three days and three nights together; and that at the end thereof our Junck ran herself upon the Sands of Taydican, where, of ninety and two persons that we were, threescore and eight were drowned, no more escaping of that great number but these four and twenty of us which stood before him all covered over with wounds, that were saved as it were by miracle through the sp●cial grace of God. At these words standing a little in suspense, By what title, replied he, did you possess so much riches, and so many pieces of silk which were in your junck, and that were worth above an hundred Taeis, as I am informed? Truly, it is not credible that you could get so much wealth any other way then by thieving, which being a great offence against God, is a thing proper to the servants of the Serpent of the house of smoke, and not to those of the house of the Sun, where they that are just, and of a pure heart, do bathe themselves amidst perfumes in the great Pool of the most Almighty: We answered hereunto, that assuredly we were Merchants, and not thiefs, as he was pleased to charge us, because the God in whom we believed forbade us by his holy Law, either to kill or to rob. Hereupon the Broquen beholding them which were about him; Doubtless, continued he, if that which these men affirm be true, we may well say that they are like unto us, and that their God is much better than all others, as me thinks may be inferred from the truth of their words. Then turning himself towards us, he examined us as before with a stern countenance, and the behaviour of a Judge that exerciseth his charge with integrity: In this examination he bestowed almost an hour, and in the last place said unto us; I would fain know why those of your Country, when as heretofore they took Malaca, carried thereunto by extreme avarice, did kill our men with so little pity? which is still made good by divers widows who in these Countries have survived their husbands. To this we made answer, how that happened rather by the chance of war, than out of any desire of robbing, which we had never used to do in any place wheresoever we came; What is this you say, replied he, can you maintain that he that conquers, doth not rob? that he which useth force, doth not kill? that he which shows himself covetous, is not a thief? that which he oppresseth, performs not the action of a Tyrant? and lo, all these are the goodly qualities which are given to you, and whereof you are said to be culpable, and that by the affirmation of verity itself: whence it is manifest, that Gods abandoning of you, and permitting the waves of the Sea to swallow you up, is rather a pure ●ffect of his justice, than any injury that is done to you. This said he arose out of the Chair where he was set, and commanded the Officers to return us back to prison, promising to give us audience according to the grace which it should please the King to show us, and the compassion that he would have of us; wherewith we were very much afflicted, and in great despair of our lives. The next day the King was advertised, as well of our imprisonment, as of the answers we had made, by the Broquens letters, wherein he had intermingled something in favour of us, by means whereof he did not cause us to be executed, as it was said he had resolved to have done upon certain false reports which the Chineses had made to him of us. In this prison we continued very near two months with much pain, never hearing in all that time so much as any word spoken of that first proceeding against us. Now forasmuch as the King desired to be more amply informed concerning us by other more particular inquiries than the letters of the Broquen, he sen● a certain man unto us, named Randinaa, for to come secretly to the prison where we were, to the end that under the pretext of being a Merchant's stranger, he might exactly learn the cause of ou● arrival in that place, and that upon the report he should make thereof to the King, he might proceed to do that which should seem just unto him. Howbeit though this was closely carried, yet was it our good fortune to be advertised of it the day before his coming to us, so that we had time enough to arm ourselves outwardly with all the appearances of misery and affliction we could possibly devise, and counterfeit; which expedient next to God's assistance stood us in more stead than any other we could have thought upon. This man than came one morning well accompanied to the prison, and after he had viewed us all one after another, he called to him the jurabaca, who served to interpret for him; Ask these men, said he, what is the cause that the mighty hand of God hath so abandoned them, as to permit their lives through an effect of his Divine justice to be subjected to the judgement of men, without having so much remorse of conscience, as to set before their eyes the terror of that dreadful vision, which doth use to fright the soul at the last gasp of a man's life, for it is to be believed that they, who have done that which I observe in them, have heaped sin upon sin. We answered him thereunto, that he had a great deal of reason for what he spoke, in regard it was very probable that the sins of men were the principal cause of their sufferings, howbeit that God, as the Sovereign Lord of all, did nevertheless in that case accustom to take pity of them, with sobs and tears continually called upon him, and that it was also his bounty wherein all our hope was placed, to the end he would be pleased to inspire the King's heart with a will to do as justice according to our works, for that we were poor strangers destitute of all favour, a thing whereof men make most account in this wo●ld. That which you say, replied he, is very well, provided that your hearts be conformable to your words, and then you are not to be found fault with, for it is most certain, that he, which enammels all that our eyes do behold for the beautifying ●f the night, and that hath likewise made whatsoever the day doth sh●w us for the sustenance of man, who are but worms of the earth, will not refuse you your deliverance, seeing you beg of him with so many sighs and tears; wherefore I entreat you not to dissemble with me, but truly to confess what I desire to understand from you at this present; namely, what people you are? of what Nation? in what part of the world you live in, and how the Kingdom of your King is named? whereunto you shall add the cause that hath brought you hither, and to what place you were going with so much riches, which the Sea hath cast up on the shores of Taydican, whereat all the Inhabitants have so wondered, as they were persuaded that you were Masters of all the Trade of China. To these, and other like questions, which this Spy asked of us, we returned him such answers, as was most behooveful for us to give him, wherewith he was so contented, that making us many offers, he promised to move the King for our deliverance. In the mean time he spoke not a word to us of the occasion for which he was sent, but still feigned himself to be a stranger, and a Merchant like one of us. Howbeit when he went away, he carefully recommended us to the Jailor, and willed him not to let us want any thing, promising to satisfy him for it to his content; In acknowledgement whereof we gave him many humble thanks with tears in our eyes, whereby he was greatly moved to compassion, so that he gave us a Bracelet of gold, that weighed thirty ducats, and also six sacks of Rice, and withal desired us to excuse h●m for the smallness of the present he had given us. After this he returned back to the King, unto whom he rendered an account of all that had passed with us, assuring him that we were not such as the Chineses had made him to believe, and offered for proof thereof to pawn his life an hundred times, if need were, which was the cause that the King abated much of the suspicion wherewithal they had inveighed him about our manner of lying. But as he was resolving to give order for our enlargement, as well upon the report of this man, as in regard of the letter which the Broquen had written him, there arrived at the Port a Chinese Pirate with four Juncks, unto whom the King gave his Country for a place of Retreat, upon condition that he should share with him the moiety of the booty which he should take, by means whereof he was in great favour with the King, and all them of the Country. Now forasmuch as our sins would have it, that this Pirate was one of the greatest enemies the Portugals had at that time, by reason of a fight that we had had with him a little before in the Port of Lamau, where La●cerote Pareyra, born at Lyma, commanded in chief, and in which he had two Juncks burnt, and three hundred of his men slain; this dog was no sooner advertised of our imprisonment, and how the King was resolved to free us, but that he embroiled the business in a strange manner, and told him so many lies of us, that he lacked but little of persuading him, that ere long we would be the cause of the loss of his Kingdom: For he assured him that it was our custom to play the Spies in a Country under pretence of trading, and then to make ourselves Masters of it like robbers as we were, putting all to the sword that we met withal in it; which wrought so powerfully with the King, that he revoked all that he had resolved to have done, and changing his mind he ordained that in regard of what had been told him, we should each of us be dismembered into four quarters, and the same set up in the public streets, that all the world might know we had deserved to be used so. CHAP. XLVIII. The King of the Lequios sending a cruel Sentence against us to the Broquen of the Town, where we were prisoners, to the end he should put it in execution; and that which happened unto us, till our arrival at Liampoo. §. 1. AFter that this ●ruel Sentence of death had been pronounced against us, the King sent a Peretanda to the Broquen of the City, where we were prisoners, to the end that within four days it should be executed upon our persons. This Peretanda departed presently away, and upon his arrival at the City, he went and lodged himself at a certain widows house, that was his sister, a very honourable woman, and from whom we had received much alms; This same man having secretly imparted unto her the cause of his coming▪ & how he was not to return but with a good Certificate unto the King of the performance of this execution, she went straightway, and acquainted a Niece of hers with it, who was daughter to the Broquen of the City, in whose house lay a Portugal woman, the wife of a Pilot who was a prisoner with us, and two children of hers, desiring then to comfort her, she discovered unto her all that she had learned, which she had no sooner understood, but that extremely afflicted at so sad a news, she fell instantly to the ground in a swoon, wherein she continued a long time speechless; At length being come to herself again, she fell to tearing of her cheeks so cruelly with her nails, that all her face was nothing but gore blood, which, for that it was a new and extraordinary thing in that Country, was incontinently spread abroad throughout all the City, insomuch that all the women being frighted with it, the most part of them went forth with their children in their hands to the Broquens daughters house, where th● Portugal woman was, more ready to die, then to answer to the questions one or another of them asked her, & being exceedingly moved with pi●y to behold her, so lamentably taking on, drowned all in tears and blood, which passion & grief had drawn from her, they all resolved to write a letter in favour of us to the old Queen, the King's Mother, as accordingly they did, and the contents of it were these; Sacred pearl, congealed in the greatest shell of the profoundest depth of the waters; thou Star, enammelled with rays of fire; thou tress of golden hair, intermixed with a Garland of roses, whose feet are so replenished with greatness that they rest upon the top of our heads, like to rubies enchased in gold, whereof the price is inestimable: We that are no other than the least and poorest of thy creatures, the daughters and kinswomen of the Broquens wife, together with the rest of thy captives that have set their hands to these presents, do make our moan unto thee concerning a thing which we have seen with our eyes, that is a poor woman, a stranger, who seems to have neither flesh nor face, drowned as she is in a pool of blood, beating her breast with such cruelty, as would stir up even wild-beasts in the Forest to compassion, and strike fear into every one; Moreover we have heard her cry so loud, as we assure thee by the Law of all verity, that if God should lend an ear unto her, as we believe he will, because he doth usually assist the poor, that are despised of the world, it is to be feared that some great chastisement of famine and fire will fall upon us; wherefore the extreme apprehension, which we have of these things, causeth us to join all our voices together, like little children hungry after their mothers, and humbly beseech thee, that casting thine eyes upon the soul of the deceased King, thy Husbband, for whose sake we beg this of thee, thou wilt vouchsafe to make thyself like the Saints, setting aside all respect of the flesh; For the more thou shalt do for God, the greater thou shalt be in his house, where we verily believe thou shalt find the King thy Husband, singing to the sound of the harp of those children, that have never sinned, the song of this charitable alms, which for God's sake, and his, we pray thee to obtain of the King, thy Son: And this we hope shall be a means to move him, both for the love of God, and of thyself, as also by the force of our tears and cries, to take pity on these strangers, and freely pardon them all the faults, wherewith they are unjustly charged, since, as thou knowest, they are not the Saints of Heaven that use to accuse us, but men, that are infamous, and of an evil life, to whom we are forbidden to lend an ear. Conchenilau, the fair Gentlewoman, and well born, but above all more honourable than all those of this City, for having been bred up in thy service ●y her Aunt, shall represent unto thee on the behalf of God, and the King thy Husband, for the love of whom we prefer this request unto thee, all the other particularities of this affair, as also the grievous tears and groa●s of these poor folks, and the extreme sadness▪ and fear of all the inhabitants of this place, who most earnestly beseech thee to present their humble Suit to the King, thy Son, cherished above all others, on whom may it please the Lord of all good to bestow so much thereof, as with that, which only shall be resting to him, all these people, that inhabit the Land, and Islands of the Sea, may be replenished. This letter, signed by above an hundred of the chiefest women of the City, was sent by a Gentlewoman, the daughter of the Mandarin Comanilau, Governor of the Island of Bancaa, which is on the the Southside of that of the Lequios, and good luck would have it that this young Damosel came thither, but three days before the Sentence of death was to be put into execution upon us, in the company of two of her brothers, and ten or eleven Gentlemen, her kinsmen. This Gentlewoman being arrived at the City of Bintor, §. 2. where the King and the Queen his Mother were, she went to the house of an Aunt of hers, the chief Lady of honour to the Queen, and that infinitely loved her, to whom she rendered an account of the occasion of her coming, and withal represented unto her how much it imported both her honour and credit, seeing all the rest had made choice of her for this affair, that her Highness should grant her the grace which all of them together made such suit unto her for: The Lady having given her Niece the best welcome that possibly she could by all demonstrations of her affection, she said unto her, that since she perceived this business so much concerned her honour, she would labour by all the means she could that she should not return discontented, and frustrated of the hope of her request, the rather for that the thing was just in itself, and so earnestly sought for by so many great Ladies; whereupon the Gentlewoman, having given her very humble thanks, besought her to dispatch the business with as much speed as might be, in regard we had but two days more to live, according to the tenor of our Sentence, after which time all help would be in vain. Since it is so, answered her Aunt, and that for want of requisite diligence the poor wretches are like to suffer the punishment, whereunto the King hath destined them upon the Chinese report, I will go and lay myself at the Queen's feet, as soon as she awakes, which will be within an hour at the furthest, to the end that this novelty, not having done so these six years by reason of my indisposition, may draw her to demand of me the cause of it. Having said this, she left her Niece behind her, and went and opened a Gallery door, whereof she alone had the key, and so entered into the Chamber where the Queen lay; A while after the Queen awaking, found her lying at her feet, whereupon she said unto her; How now Nhay Meicamur, (for so was this Lady called) what is it hath brought you hither at this time? certainly it is some extraordinary matter. Madam, answered she, that which your Majesty says, is very true, and I assure myself that it will seem no less strange in your ears, than it was to me to see my Niece arrive here lately with so much sorrow and grief, that I am not able to express it in words. The Queen having then commanded her to call her in, she presently fetched her; The first thing that this young Gentlewoman did, was to prostrate herself before the Queen, who was in her bed, and so told her weeping the occasion that brought her thither, and therewithal presented her with the letter, which the Queen commanded her to read, as accordingly she did; and it is said the Queen was so moved with compassion at it, that not enduring to have her make an end of reading it, she said many times unto her with tears in her eyes; Enough, enough, I will hear no more of it at this time, and since the business stands in the terms you speak of, God, and the Soul of the King my Husband, for whose sake all these Ladies beg this boon of me, forbid, that these poor wretches should lose their lives so unjustly: The false reports which the Chineses have made of them, together with the miseries they have endured at Sea, may serve them in stead of great punishments; Wherefore rely upon me for your request, and in the mean space withdraw yourselves till to morrow morning betimes, when we will go all three to the King my Son before it be day, and then you shall read this letter to him, as you have read it to me, that being incited to pity he may make no difficulty to grant us that which we demand of him with so much reason. This resolution taken, the Queen was no sooner up the next day, but carrying along with her only her chief Lady, and the Gentlewoman her Niece, she passed through a Gallery to the Chamber of the King her Son, whom she found still in bed, and having rendered him an account of the occasion of her coming, she commanded the Gentlewoman to read the letter, as also to tell by word of mouth all that had happened in that affair, which the Gentlewoman performed very exactly, but not without mingling her tears with those of her Aunts, as we knew afterwards: In the mean time the King looking on his Mother, Madam, answered he unto her, I must needs confess, that I dreamed this night how I saw myself before a very angry judge, who carrying his hand three times to his face, as if he had threatened me, I promise thee, said he unto me, that if the blood of these strangers doth cry unto me for vengeance, thou and thine shall satisfy my justice, which makes me believe, that assuredly this vision comes from God, for whose sake I will do this alms to his praise, giving them both life and liberty, that so they may go where they will, and moreover I will cause a vessel to be provided for them, furnished with all things they shall need, all at mine own charge. The Queen gave th● King her Son thanks for this his great grace unto them, and withal commanded her Lady and the Gentlewoman to kiss his feet, as instantly they did, and so the Queen retired to her own lodging. Hereupon the King sent for the Chumbim to command him that the Sentence against us might be revoked, telling him all that had passed, as well concerning his dream, as the request the Queen his Mother had made unto him, which he had granted her. Then the Officers of Justice commending the King much for this action, revoking the former, drew up another Sentence in favour of us, which contained words to this effect, Broquen of my City of Pungor, ay, the Lord of seven Generations, and of the hairs of thy head, do send thee the smiles of my mouth, that thy reputation may be thereby augmented. Considering the information which the Chineses had given me of the pernicious manner of living of th●se strangers, assuring me by a solemn oath, and upon the faith they owe unto their Gods, that infallibly they were Pirates and robbers, who used no other trade then to steal away othermen's goods, and bathke heir hands in the blood of those that would defend their own according to reason, as they said was manifest to all the world, which they have run over, not leaving any Island, Port of the Sea, River, nor Land, that they have not invaded with fire and sword, committing such enormous and horrible crimes, as for fear of offending God, I may not mention. All which things have at first sight seemed unto me most worthy to be punished in justice according to the Laws of my Kingdom; wherefore I sent their Process to the principal officers of my Crown, who all with one common consent swore unto me that these strangers deserved not only one, but many death's, if it were possible, so that relying upon their advice, I wrote unto Nhay Peretanda, that he should enjoin thee from me not to fail within four days to put that Sentence of mine in execution. Now forasmuch as the chiefest Dames of your City, whom I hold for my kinswomen, have been Suitors unto me since, that I would be pleased to bestow their lives upon them by way of an alms, alleging many reasons in their letters to that purpose, whereby I might be induced not to deny, but rather to accord them that grace; the fear which I have lest their cries should in case of refusal arrive at the highest of the Heavens, where that Lord liveth reigning, whose property it is to have pity on the tears, which are truly shed by those that have a right zeal to his holy Law, hath wrought so with me, that freeing myself from that blind passion, whereunto the flesh rendered me inclined, I would not let my choler prevail over the blood of those wretches. For which reasons I command thee, that as soon as this fair Gentlewoman, who is of noble extraction, and my kinswoman, shall present thee these letters, signed with my hand, wherewith I confess, I am well contented, in regard of the persons that have made this Suit unto me, thou go unto the prison, whither thou hast committed these strangers, and that without all delay thou set them at liberty, as also that thou furnish them with a vessel at my charge, giving them moreover such alms as the Law of the Lord commandeth thee to bestow on them, and that too with a liberal hand; whereupon thou shalt tell them, that they may go away without seeing my Person, for which I will dispense with them, as well because that labour would be to no purpose, as for that, performing as I do the Office of a King, it is not fit for me to behold men, who have a great knowledge of God, and yet seem to make little account of his Law, in that they accustom themselves to rob others of their goods. Given at Bintor in the third Chavequa of the first Mamoquo of the Moon, in the presence of the Queen my Mother, the Source of my right eye, and Lady of all my Kingdom. And signed a little below, Hira Pitau, Xinancor, Ambulec, the firm prop of all justice.. As soon as the Gentlewoman had this Letter of the Kings in her hands, she was never at quiet, till she had left her Aunt, and put herself upon her journey, which she continued with such diligence, that in a short space she arrived at the City, and delivered the Letter to the Broquen, who presently upon the reading of it caused all the Peretandas, Chumbims, and other Officers of Justice to assemble together, and then went with them directly to the Prison, where we were at that instant under a sure guard; we no sooner saw them enter, but all of us cried out three or four times together, Lord have mercy upon us, wherewith the Broquen, and all that accompanied him, whereof the prison was full, were so moved, as some of them could not forbear weeping, out of the compassion they had of us: In the mean time the Broquen fell to comforting us in such kind and loving terms, as well expressed the greatness of his charity: Withal he commanded the irons to be taken off from our hands and feet, and drawing us into an outward Court, he recounted unto us all that had passed in our business, whereof we had not any knowledge at all, in regard of the strict watch that was set upon us all the while; Then having caused the King's Letters to be published: My friends, said he unto us, now that God hath showed you so much grace, to deliver you as you see, I have one request to make unto you, which is, that for my sake, you will thank him from the bottom of your heart, and praise him for it; for if you make this acknowledgement unto him, he will communicate to you from above, whence all good doth proceed, an agreeable repose, which is a thing far more convenient for us then to live three or four days in the miseries of this world, where there is nothing but labour, grief, great affliction, and above all poverty, which is the accomplishment of all evils, and whereby ordinarily our souls are wholly consumed in the deep abyss of the house of smoke. §. 3. The Broquen moreover caused two Paniers full of clothes to be brought to that place, and distributed to them amongst us according to each one's need; That done he carried us home to his house, where all the Ladies of the Town came to see us, testifying by their countenances that they greatly rejoiced at the good success of our deliverance: They comforted us also with great demonstration of pity, which is an effect of the good nature of the women of this Country, that is common to them all; and not contented therewith they entertained us in their houses, one after another during all the time we were there until our departure, for we continued in this City afterwards the space of forty six days, in which time we were furnished with all things necessary for us, and that in such abundance, as there was not one of us but carried above an hundred Ducats away with him. As for the Portugal woman, of whom I spoke before, she had above a thousand, as well in money, as in other gifts which were given her, by which means her husband in less than an year recovered himself of all the losses he had sustained. After we had with a great deal of contentment past those forty six days there, the season proper for our voyage being come, the Broquen procured us passage in the Junck of a Chinese, which was bound for the Port of Liampoo in the Kingdom of China, according to the commandment that he had received of the King for that purpose, bu● first he caused the Captain of the Junck to put in good security for the safety of our persons during all the time of the voyage. In this manner we departed from Pungor the capital City of the Island of Lequios, of which I will here make a brief relation, to the end that if it shall one day please God to inspire the Portugal Nation, principally for the exaltation and increase of the Catholic faith, and next for the great benefit that may redound thereof, to undertake the Conquest of this Island, they may know where first to begin, as also the commodities of it, and the easiness of this Conquest. We must understand then that this Island of Lequios, situated in nine and twenty degrees, is two hundred leagues in circuit, threescore in length, and thirty in breadth. The Country is almost like that of japon, saving that it is a little more mountainous in certain parts, but in the middle it is plainer and more fertile. It is rendered very agreeable by many large Plains, that are watered with divers rivers of fresh water, and from whence are gathered great provisions, especially of Rice and Wheat. It hath Mountains out of which is drawn such quantity of copper, as in regard of the abundance thereof it is so common among those people, that whole Ships are laden with it from thence in way of traffic to all the Ports of China, Lamau, Sumbor, Chabaquea, Tosa, Miacoo, and japon, as likewise to all the other Islands on the Southside thereof, as those of Sesirau, Goto, Fucanxi, and Pollem: Moreover in all this Country of the Lequios, there is also great store of iron, steel, lead, tin, alum, saltpetre, brimstone, honey, wax, sugar, and ginger, far better than that which comes from the Indias. It hath withal a world of Angelin-wood, Chestnuts, Trees, Oak, and Cedar, wherewith thousands of Ships may be made. On the East-side it hath five very great Islands, where many Ours of Silver are found, as also Pearls, Amber, Frankincense, Silk, Ebony, Brasil, and a great abundance of a certain wood fit for Carpentry, called Poytan; It is true that there is not such store of Silk there, as in China. The Inhabitants of all this Country do as the Chineses cloth themselves, with Linen, Cotten, Silk, and a kind of Damask-stuff, which comes to them from Nanquin; They are great eaters, very much addicted to the delights of the flesh, little inclined to arms, and altogether unfurnished of them; which induceth me to believe that they might be easily conquered, and the rather for that in the year, a thousand, five hundred, fi●ty and six, a Portugal arrived at Malaca, named Pero Gomez o' Almeyda, servant to the Grand Master of Santiago, with a rich Present, and Letters from the Nautaquim, Prince of the Island of Tanixumaa, directed to King john the third; the Substance and Contents of his request was, to have five hundred Portugals granted to him, to the end that with them, and his own Forces, he might conquer the Island of Lequio, for which he would remain tributary to him at five thousand Kintals of Copper, and a thousand of Latin yearly; which Embassy came to no effect, because the Messenger was lost in the Gallion, where Manael de Souzad▪ Sepulveda, also perished. A little further to the Northward of this Island of Lequio, there is a great Archipelago of small Islands, from whence is drawn a great quantity of silver, which in my opinion, & by what I gathered out of a petition which Ray Lopez de Vilhalobos General of the castilians presented to jorge de Castro, at that time Captain of Ternate, should be those whereof the Inhabitants had some knowledge, and which they called the Islands of Silver; and yet I cannot see with what reason that may be, because both by what I have observed, and read, as well in the writings of Ptolemy, as other Geographers, not any one of them hath pierced into the Kingdom of Siam, and the Island of Sumatra, only our Cosmographers, since the time of Alphonso d' Albuquerque have passed a little further, and treated of the Selebres, Pasuaas, Mindanaus, Champas, as also of China, and japon, but not of the Lequios, or other Archipelagos, which are to be discovered within the vast extent of that Sea. From this brief relation which I have made of the Island of Lequios, may be inferred, both out of what I have heard and ●een, that with two thousand men only this Island might be taken, together with all the rest of these Archipelagos, whence more profit might be drawn then from the Indias, and they might be conserved with less charge, as well in regard of men, as otherwise; for we spoke there with Merchants, who assured us, that the sole Revenue of three Custom houses, and of the Island of Lequios, amounted unto one million and an half of gold, not comprising therein either the Mass of the whole Kingdom, or the Ours of Silver, Copper, Iron, Steel, Led, and Tin, which are of a far greater revenue, than the Customs. I will not speak further of other particularities of this Island, which I might here insert, for that I hold this sufficient to awaken the courages of the Portugals, and incite them to an Enterprise, of so much service for our King, and profit for themselves. CHAP. XLIX. My sailing from Liampoo to Malaca, from whence the Captain of the Fortress, sent me to the Chaubainhaa at Martabano; and all that bef●l us in our voyage thither. BEing arrived at Liampoo, we were very well received by the Portugals, that lived there, § 1 From whence within a while after I embarked myself in the Ship of a Portugal, named Tristano de Gaa, for to return unto Malaca, with an intention once more to try my fortune, which had so often been contrary to me, as may appear by that which I have delivered before. This Ship being safely arrived at Malaca, I went presently unto Pedro de Faria, Governor of the Fortress, who desiring to benefit me somewhat before the time of his Government was expired, he caused me to undertake the voyage of Martaban, which was usually very profitable, and that in the Junck of a Mahometan, named Necoda Mamude, who had wife and children at Malaca. Now the principal design of this voyage was, to conclude a peace with the Chaubainhaa, King of Martabano, as also to continue the commerce of those of that Country with us, because their Juncks did greatly serve for the provisions of our Fortress, which at that time was unfurnished thereof by reason of the success of the Wars of jaoa. Besides I had a design in this my voyage of no less consequence, than the res●, which was to get one, called Lancarote Gu●rreyro, to come thither, who was then on the Coast of Tanaucarim with an hundred men in four Foists, under the name of a Rebel or Mutineer; I was to require him to come to the succour of the Fortress, in regard it was held for certain, that the King of Achem was suddenly to fall upon it; so that Pedro de Faria, seeing himself destitute of all that was necessary for him to sustain a Siege, and of men likewise; found it fit to make use of these hundred men, the rather for that they were nearest, and so might be the sooner with him. In the third place he sent me upon another important occasion, namely to give advice to the Ships of Bengala, that they should come all carefully in consort together, left their negligence in their Navigation should be the cause of some disaster. This voyage than I undertook very unwillingly, and parted from Malaca upon a Wednesday, the ninth day of january, in the year, one thousand, five hundred, forty and five; being under Sail I continued my course with a good wind to Pullo Pracelar, where the Pilot was a little retarded by means of the Shelves, which cross all that Channel of the firm Land, even unto the Island of Sumetra; When we were got forth with much labour we passed on to the Islands of Pullo Sambillam, where I put myself into a Manchua, which I had very well equipped, and sailing in it the space of twelve days, I observed, according to the order Pedro de Faria had given me for it, all the Coast of that Country of Malaya, which unto juncalan contains an hundred and thirty leagues, entering by all the Rivers of Bartuhaas, Salangor, Panaagim, Qued●m, Parles, Pendan, and Sambilan, Siam, without so much as hearing any news at all of his enemies in any of them: So continuing the same course nine days more, being the three and twentieth of our voyage, we went and cast anchor at a little Island, called Pisandur●a, where the Necoda, the Mahometan Captain of the Junck, was of necessity to make a cable, and furnish himself with wood and water; With this resolution going on shore every man applied himself so the labour he was appointed unto, and therein spent most part of the day; Now whilst they were thus at work the Son of this Mahometan Captain came and asked me whither I would go with him, and see if we could kill a Stag, whereof there was great plenty in that Island; I answered him that I would accompany him with all my heart, so that having taken my Harquebuse, I went along with him athwart the wood, where we had not walked above an hundred spaces, but that we espied a many of wild boars, that were rooting in the earth near to a pond; Having discovered this game, we got as near to them as we could, and discharging amongst them, we carried two of them to the ground: Being very glad of this good success we presently gave a great shout, and ran strait to the place we had seen them rooting. But so dreadful to behold, in this place we found above a dozen bodies of men digged out of the earth, and some nine or ten others half eaten. B●ing much amazed at this object, we withdrew a little aside by reason of the great staunch, which proceeded from these dead bodies. Hereupon the Sarrazin told me, that he thought we should do well to advertise his father of this, to the end we might instantly surround this Island all about for to see whether we could discover any vessels with Pirates; for, said he, there may be some lie hidden behind yonder point, whereby we may very well run the hazard of our lives, as it hath often befallen other ships, where m●ny m●n have been lost by the carelessness of their Captains. This advice of the Sarrazin seemed so good unto me, that we presently returned back unto the Road, where he gave an account to his father of that we had seen. Now for that the Necoda was a very prudent man, and scalded (as one may say) with the like inconveniences, he strait way gave order to have the Island surrounded, then causing the women, children, and linen, although it were but half washed, to be embarked, he himself being followed by forty men, armed with Harquebuses and Lances, went directly to the place where we had discovered those bodies, and viewing them one after another, with stopping our noses by reason of the st●nch, which was insupportable, he was so moved to compassion, that he commanded the Mariners to dig a great pit for to bury them in; But as they were about to render them this last duty, and looking over them again, there was found upon some of them little daggers garnished with gold, and on others bracelets: Whereupon the Necoda, understanding well this mystery, wished me with all speed to dispatch away the roving vessel that I had to the Captain of Malaca, for that, as he assured me, those dead men, which they saw there, were Achems, who had been defeated near to Tanauçarim, whither their Armies ordinarily retired because of the war which they had with the King of Siam. The reason he alleged to us for this was, that those which we saw there lying dead, having golden bracelets about them, were Captains of Achem, who had caused themselves to be buried without permitting them to be taken away, and that he would lose his head if it were not so. For a greater proof whereof, he further added, that he would make some more of them to be disinterred, as incontinently he did, and having digged some seven and thirty of them out of the earth, there was found about them sixteen bracelets of gold, twelve very rich daggers, and many jewels, so that thinking of no other but hunting, we got a booty worth above a thousand ducats, which the Necoda had, besides what was concealed; but the truth is, this was not altogether to our advantage, for the most part of our men became sick with the extreme stench of those bodies. At the very instant I dispatched away the towing vessel that we had to Malaca, and advertised Pedro de Faria of the whole success of our voyage; Withal I certified him▪ what course we had held, as also into what Ports, and into what Rivers we had entered, without hearing any other news of his enemies, then that it was suspected they had been at Tanauçarim, where by the appearances of those dead bodies, it was to be believed that they had been defeated, whereunto I added for a conclusion, that if I could light on any more assured news concerning them, I would presently acquaint him with it, in what part soever I were. §. 2. After I had dispatched away the rowing Vessel to Malaca, with the Letters which I had directed to Pedro de Faria, and that our Junck was furnished with all things necessary for her, we sailed towards the Coast of Tanauçarim, where, as I said before, I had order to land for to treat with Lancerote Guerreyro, that he, and the rest of the Portugals of his Company might come to the succour of Malaca, which the Achems intended to besiege, according to the report that went of it. Being under Sail than we arrived at a little Island, a league in circuit, called Pulho Hinhor, where a Parao came unto us, in the which were six tawny Moors, poorly clad, with red Bonnets on their heads; their Boat being come close to our Junck, which was then under Sail, they saluted us in a way of peace, whereunto we answered in the like m●nner; That done they demanded of us if there were any Portugals amongst us? we told them that there were, but mistrusting it, they desired to see one or two of them upon the hatches, because, added they, it imports much that it should be so. Whereupon the Necoda prayed me to come up, which incontinently I did, though at that time I was shut up in my cabin below somewhat indisposed in my health; when I was on the deck I called to them that were in the Parao, who had no sooner seen me, and known me to be a Portugal, but they gave a great shout, and clapping their hands for joy they came aboard our Junck. Then one of them, who by his countenance seemed to have more Authority than the rest, began to say unto me; Signior, Before I crave leave of thee to speak, I desire thee to read this Letter, to the end it may induce thee the more readily to believe that which I am to say unto thee. Thereupon out of an old filthy clout he took a Letter, wherein after I had opened it, I found this written: Signiors Portugals, which are true Christians, this honourable man, that shall show you this Letter, is King of this Island, newly converted to the Faith, and called Dom Lancerote; He hath rendered many good Offices, not only to them, who have subscribed this writing, but to us also that have navigated on these Coasts: For he hath given us very important advertisements of the treasons, which the Achems and Turks have plotted against us, so that by the means of this honest man we have discovered all their designs: withal God hath made use of him for to give us not long since a great victory against them, wherein we have taken from them one Galley, four Galliots, and five Foists, with the death of above a thousand Sarrazins. Wherefore we entreat you, by the wounds of our Lord jesus Christ, and by the merits of his holy passion, not only to keep him from all wrong, but to assist him with all your power, as the manner is of all good Portugals, that it may serve for an example to those which shall know this, to do the like in imitation of you; And so we kiss your hands this thirteenth day of November, 1544. This Letter was signed by more than fifty Portugals, amongst whom were the four Captains that I sought for, namely, Lançerote Guerreyra, Antonio Gomez, Pedro Ferreyra, and Cosmo Bernaldes. When I had read this Letter, I made a tender of my person to this petty King, for otherways my power was so small, as it could not reach further than to the giving him a bad dinner, and a red Bonnet I had on, which all worn as it was, was yet better than his own. Now after this poor King had made some Declaration to me of himself, and of his miseries, lifting up his hands to Heaven, and shedding abundance of tears; Our Lord jesus Christ, said he unto me, whose slave I am, doth know what great need I have now of the favour and succour of some Christians, for because I am a Christian, as they are, a Mahometan slave of mine about four months ago, reduced me to that extremity, wherein I behold myself at this instant, being not able in the state I am in to do any other then cast up mine eyes to Heaven, and lament my misfortune, with much sorrow, and little remedy. And I assure thee by the verity of that holy and new Law, whereof I now make profession, that only for being a Christian, and a friend to the Portugals, I am persecuted in this sort. Now for that being alone, as thou art, it is not possible for thee to assist me; I beseech thee, Signior, to take me along with thee, to the end that this Soul which God hath put into me may not perish, and in recompense thereof I promise to serve thee as a slave all the days of my life. Lo this is that which this poor King said with so many tears, as it was great pity to behold it, in the mean time the Necoda, who was of a good disposition, and charitably inclined, was very much moved with the disaster of this unfortunate King, so that he gave him a little Rice, and some linen to cover himself withal, for he was so ragged, that one might see his naked skin every where about him. After he had informed himself from him of certain particulars, the knowledge whereof concerned him, he demanded him where his enemy was, and what force's he had? Whereunto he answered. That he was a quarter of a league from thence, in a cabin covered with straw, having not above thirty fishermen with him, who were most of them without Arms. Hereupon the Necoda cast his eye upon me, and seeing me sad, for that I was not able of myself to succour this poor Christian▪ thinking withal that he should much oblige me thereby, Signior, said he unto me, if thou wer● now Captain of this junck, as I am, what remedy wouldst thou give to the tears of this poor man, wherewith also thy eyes do participate? I knew not what reply to make him, for that I was greatly moved to behold my Neighbour, a Christian like myself, to suffer in that manner, which the Necodas son perceiving, who was, as I have said, ● young man of a good spirit, and brought up amongst the Portugals, and guessing at the shame and sorrow I was in, he desired his father to lend him twenty Mariners of his Junck, that by their means he might re-establish this poor King, and chase the Thief out of the Island; To this the Necoda answered, That if I would demand so much of him, he would do it very willingly; whereupon casting myself at his feet and embracing him, which is the humblest compliment used amongst them, I told him with tears in my eyes, that if he would do me this favour I would be his slave whilst I lived, and that both he and his children should find how ready I would be always to acknowledge the same; He presently granted my request, so that causing the Junck to approach near the shoa●, he prepared himself in three Boats with one Falcon, three Bases, and threescore Men, jaos and Lesons, all well armed, for thirty of them carried Harquebuses, the rest Lances, and Bows and Arrows, besides Grenadoes, and other such like Fireworks, as we thought were convenient for our design. §. 3. It was about two of the clock in the afternoon when we landed, and so we went directly to the Trench where the Enemies were. The Necodas son led the Vanguard, consisting of forty men, whereof twenty were armed with Harquebuses, and the rest with Bows and Arrows; The Necoda himself brought on the Rear, wherein were thirty Soldiers, carrying a Banner, which Pedro de Faria had given him at his parting from Malaca, with a cross painted in it, ●o the end he might be known for a Vassal to our King, in case he should encounter any of our Ships. Marching in this order by the guiding of this petty King, we arrived where the Rebel was with his men set in order, who by their shouting and cries seemed in show not to make any reckoning of us. They were in number about fifty, but weak, unarmed, and utterly destitute of all things necessary for their defence, having for all their Arms but Staves, ten or eleven Lances, and one Harquebuse. As soon as we had discovered them we gave fire to the Falcon and Bases, discharging withal twenty Harquebuses, whereupon the Thiefs betook themselves presently to flight, being in great disorder, and most of them hurt; We pursued them then so close, that we overtook them on the top of a little hill, where they were defeated in the space of two credoes, not one of them escaping with life save only three, whom we spared for that they said they were Christians. That done, we went to a Village, where there were not above twenty poor low Cabins, covered with straw, in it we found some threescore and four women, with a many of little children, who no sooner perceived us, but all of them with tears fell a cried out, Christian, Christian, jesus, jesus. At these words being fully persuaded that they were Christians, I desired the Necoda that he would cause his son to retire, and not suffer any of them to be killed because they were not Gentiles, which he presently yielded unto, and yet for all that he could not keep the Cabins from sacking, though in them all there was not found the value of five Ducats. For the people of this Island are so poor, that scarce one of them is worth a groat; they feed on nothing but a little fish, which they take with angling, and eat it broiled on the coals without salt, yet are they so vain and presumptuous, that not one almost amongst them but terms himself a King of some vile piece of ground, whereon there is little more than one poor cabin; besides, neither the men nor the women have wherewithal to cover their nakedness. After the slaughter of the rebellious Sarrazin and his followers, and the re-establishment of the poor Christian King, putting him in possession of his wife and children, whom his Enemy had made slaves, together with above threescore and three Christian Souls, we ordained a kind of Church amongst them, for the instruction of those that were newly converted; And then returning to our Junck, we presently set sail, and continued our course towards Tanauçarim, where I was persuaded I should find Lancerote Guerreyra, and his companions, for to treat with them about the business, whereof I have formerly spoken: But for as much as in the Letter, which the petty King showed me, the Portugals made mention of a Victory which God had given them against the Turks and Achems of this Coast, I hold it not amiss to relate here how that happened, as well for the content the Reader may take therein, as to show that there is no enterprise which valiant Soldiers at a need may not bring to pass, in regard whereof it imports much to cherish, and make esteem of them. For eight months and more our hundred Portugals had scoured up and down this Coast in four well rig'd Foists, wherewith they had taken three and twenty rich Ships, and many other lesser Vessels, so that they which used to sail in those parts were so terrified with the sole name of the Portugals, as they quitted their Commerce without making any further use of their shipping: By this surcease of Trade the Custom-houses of the Ports of Tanauçarim, junçalan, Merguim, Vagaruu, and Tavay, fell much in their Revenue, in so much that those people were constrained to give notice of it to the Emperor of Sornan, King of Siam, and sovereign Lord of all that Country, beseeching him to give a remedy to this mischief, whereof every one complained. Instantly whereupon, being then at the City of Odiaa, he sent with all speed to the Frontier of La●hos for a Turkish Captain of his, named Heredrin Mahomet, the same who in the year one thousand five hundred thirty and eight came from Suez to the Army of Soliman the Bashaw, Viceroy of Cairo, when as the great Turk sent him to invade the Indias; but it fell out that this man slipping from the body of the Army arrived in a Galley on the Coast of Tanauçarim, where he was entertained by the Sornau King of Siam, and for a Pension of twelve thousand Ducats by the year served him as a General of that Frontier. Now for that the King held this Turk for invincible, and made more account of him then of all others, he commanded him from the place where he was, with three hundred janissaries that he had with him, and giving him a great sum of money he made him General of all the Coast of this Sea, to the end he might free those people from our incursions, withal he promised to make him Duke of Banchaa, which is an estate of great extent, if he could bring him the heads of four Portugal Captains. This proud Turk, becoming more insolent by the reward and promises which the King made him posted presently away to Tanauçarim, where being arrived he rigged forth a Fleet of ten Sails for to fight with us, being so confident of vanquishing us, as in answer of certain Letters, which the Sornau had written unto him from Odiaa, these words was found in one of them. From the time that my head was esloigned from the feet of your Highness for to execute this small enterprise, wherein it seems you are pleased I should serve you, I continued my Voyage till at the end of nine days I arrived at Tanaucarim, where I presently provided myself of such Vessels as were necessary for me, and indeed would have had but only two, for I hold it most infallible that those would suffice to chase away these petty Thiefs; howbeit not to disobey the Commission, which Combracalon the Governor of the Empire hath given me under your great Seal, I have made ready the great Galley, as also the four little ones, and the five Foists, with which I purpose to set forth with all speed; For I fear left these Dogs should have news of my coming, and that for my sins God should be so much their friend, as to give them leisure to fly, which would be so great a grief unto me, that the very imagination thereof might be my death, or through an excess of despair render me like unto them; but I hope that the Prophet Mahomet, of whose Law I have made profession from mine infancy, will not permit that it should so happen for my sins. This Heredrin Mahomet being arrived at Tanauçarim, as I have delivered before, presently made ready his Fleet, which was composed of five Foists, four Galliots, and one Galley Royal: Within these Vessels he embarked eight hundred Mahometans, men of combat (besides the Mariners.) amongst the which were three hundred janissaries, as for the rest they were Turks, Greeks, Malabares, Achems, and Mogores, all choice men, and so disciplined, that their Captain held the Victory already for most assured; Assisted with these Forces he parted from the Port of Tanauçarim for to go in the quest of our men, who at that time were in this Island of Pul●o Hinhor, whereof the foresaid Christian was King. Now during those levies of men of War, this petty King going to the Town for to sell some dried fish there, as soon as he perceived what was intended against us, he left all his Commodities behind him, and in all haste returned to this Island of his; where finding our men in great security, as little dreaming of that which was in hand against us, he related it all unto them, whereat they remained so much amazed, as the importance of the matter did require; In so much that the same night and the next day having well caulked their Vessels which they had drawn ashore, they launched them into the Sea, after they had embarked their provisions, their water, their artillery, and ammunition. So falling to their oars, with a purpose (as I have heard them say since) to get to Bengala, or to Racan, for that they durst not withstand so great an Army; but as they were unresolved thereupon, and divided in opinion, behold they saw all the ten Sails appearing together, and behind them five great Ships of Guzarates, whose Masters had given Heredrin Mahomet thirty thousand Ducats for to secure them against our Portugals. The sight of these fifteen Sails put our men into a very great confusion, and because they were not able at that time to make to Sea for that the wind was contrary, they put themselves into a Creek, which was on the South side of the Island, and invironned by a Down, or Hill, where they resolved to attend what God would send them: In the mean time the five Guzarat Ships showed themselves with full sails at Sea, and the ten Sails▪ with oars went directly to the Island, where they arrived about Sunset. Presently thereupon the Turkish Captain sent out Spies to the Ports, where he was advertised that they had been, and entered by little and little into the mouth of the Haven, that so he might render himself more assured of the prize which he pretended to make▪ with hope that as soon as it was day he should take them all, and so bound hand and foot present them to the Sornau of Siam, who in recompense thereof had promised him the State of Banchaa, as I have said before. The Manchua, which had been at the Port to spy them out, returned to the Fleet about two hours within night, and told H●redrin for news, that they were fled and gone, wherewith it is said this Barbarian was so afflicted, that teering his hair, I always feared, said he weeping, my sins would be the cause that in the execution of this enterprise God would sh●w himself more a Christian, than a Sarazin, and that Mahomet would be like to these Dogs, of whom I go in quest. This said, he fell down all along in the place, and so continued a good while without speaking a word. Nevertheless being come again to himself he gave order, like a good Captain, to all that was necessary. First of all than he sent the four Galliots in quest of them to an Island, called Ta●basoy, distant from that of Pulho Hinhor about seven leagues, for he was persuaded that our men were retired thither, because this was a better Harbour than that of the Island from whence they were gone. As for the five Foists he divided them into three, whereof he sent two to another Island, named Sambilan, and other two to those which were nearest to the firm Land, for that all these places were very proper to shelter one in; As for the filth Foist, in regard she was fleeter than the rest, he sent her along with the four Galliots, that she might before it was day bring him news of that which should happen, with promise of great reward for the same; but during these things our men, who had always a watchful eye, seeing the Turk had rid himself of his greatest Forces, and that there was no more remaining with him but the Galley wherein he was, they resolved to fight with him, and so sallying out of the Creek, where they had shrouded themselves, they rowed directly to her. Now in regard it was past midnight, and that the Enemies had but weak Sentinels, for that they thought themselves most secure, and never dreamt of any body lying in wait to attaque them there, our four Foists had the opportunity to board her all together, and threescore of their lustiest men leaping suddenly into her, in less than a quarter of an hour, and before the Enemies knew where they were for to make use of their Arms, they killed above fourscore Turks, as for the rest they cast themselves all into the Sea, not one man remaining alive: The dog H●redrin Mahomet was slain amongst the rest, and in this great action God was so gracious to our men, and gave them this Victory at so cheap a rate, that they had but one young man killed, and nine Portugals hurt. They assured me since, that in this Galley in so short a time, what by water, and the sword, above three hundred Mahometans lost their lives, whereof the most part were janissaries of the Gold Chain, which among the Turks is a mark of honour. Our Portugals having past the rest of the night with much contentment, and always keeping good watch, it pleased God that the next morning the two Foists arrived from the Island whither they had been sent▪ who altogether ignorant of that which had passed, came carelessly doubling the point of the Haven, where the Galley lay, so that the four Foists made themselves Masters of them in a little space, and with the loss of but a few men. After so good a success they fell diligently to work in fortifying the Galley and the two Foists, which they had taken, and then flanked the Southside of the Island with five great Pieces of Ordnance to defend the entry into the Haven. Now about evening the other two Foists arrived, making to Land with the same indiscretion as the others, and although they had much ado to reach them, yet were they constrained at length to render themselves, with the loss only of two Portugals. Hereupon our men resolved to attend the four Galliots that remained, and which had been sent to the next Island, but the next day so great a wind arose from the North, that two of them were cast away upon the Coast, not one that was in them escaping. As for the other two about evening they discovered them very much in disorder, destitute of oars, and separated above three leagues the one from the other; But at last about Sunset one of them came to the Port, and ran the same fortune as the former, without saving any one of the Saracens lives. The next morning an hour before day, the wind being very calm, our men discovered the other Galliot, which for want of oars was not able to recover the Port, in regard whereof our men resolved to go and fetch her in, as accordingly they did, and coming somewhat near her with two Cannon shot, they killed the most part of them that were in her, and so boarding her took her very easily; Now because all her men were either slain, or hurt, they drew her to land by force of other Boats; so that of the ●en Sail of this Fleet, our men had the Galley, two Galliots, and four Foists; as for the other two Galliots, they were cast away on the Isle of Taubasoy, as I have delivered before, and touching the fifth Foist, no news could be heard of her, which made it credible that she also suffered shipwreck, or that the wind had cast her upon some of the other Islands. This glorious victory, which it pleased God to give us, was obtained in the month of September, one thousand, five hundred, forty and four, on Michaelmas Eve, which rendered the name of the Portugals so famous through all those Coasts, that for three years after there was nothing else spoken of, so that the Chaubainhaa, King of Martabano hearing of it, sent presently to seek them out, and promised them great advantages if they would succour him against the King of Bramaa, who at that time was making preparation in his City of Pegu, for to go and besiege Martabano, with an Army of seven hundred thousand men. CHAP. L. The Continuance of our voyage to the Bar of Martabano; and certain memorable particularities hapening there. BEing departed, as I said, from the Island of Pulho Hinhor, we continued our course towards the Port of Tarnassery for the affair, of which I have spoken, §. 1. but upon the approach of the night, the Pilot desiring to avoid certain sands that were to the Prow-ward of him, put forth to Sea, with an intention as soon as it was day to return towards land with the Westerly wind, which at that instant blue from the Indias by reason of the Season▪ We had now held this course five days, running with much labour by many different roombs, when as it pleased God that we accidentally discovered a little vessel, and for as much as we thought it to be a Fisherboat, we made to it, for to be informed from them in her whereabouts we were, and how many leagues it was from thence to Tarnassery, but having passed close by her, and haled her without receiving any answer, we sent off a Shallop well furnished with men for to compel her to come aboard us: Our Boat then going directly to the vessel, we entered her, but were much amazed to find in her only five Portugals, two dead, and three alive, with a Coffer, and a sack full of Tangues, and Larius, which is the money of that Country, and a fardel, wherein there were Basins and Ewers of silver, and two other very great Basins. Having laid up all this safely, I caused the Portugals to be brought into our Junck, where looking very carefully unto them, yet could I not in two days get one word from them; But at length by the means of yolks of eggs, and good broths, which I made them take, they came again to themselves, so that in six or seven days they were able to render me a reason of their accident. One of those Portugals was called Christovano Doria, who was since sent into this Country for a Captain to Saint Tomés; the other Lewis Tabo●da, and the third Simano de Brito, all men of credit, and rich Merchants. These same recounted unto us, that coming from the Indias in a vessel belonging to jorge Manhoz, that was married at Goa, with a purpose to go to the Port of Charingan, in the Kingdom of Bengala, they were cast away in the sands of Rucano for want of taking heed, so that of four●core persons, that they were in the vessel, only seventeen being saved, they had continued their course all along by the Coast for five days together, intending if possibly they could to recover the river of Cosmira in the Kingdom of Pegu, there to sh●p themselves for the Indias in some v●ss●l or other tha● they should meet with in the Port; but whilst they were in this resolution, th●y were so driven by a most impetuous Westerly wind, that in one day and a night they lost the sight of Land, finding themselves in the ma●n Sea without Oars, without Sails, and all knowledge of the winds, they continued in that State sixteen da●s together, at the end whereof their water coming to sail, all died but those three he saw before him. Upon the finishing of this relation we proceeded on in our course, and within four days after we met with five Portugal vessels, which were sailing from Bengala to Malaca. Having showed them Pedro de Faria's Order, I desired them to keep in consort together for fear of the Achems Army, that ranged all over the Coast, lest through their imprudence they should fall into any mischief, and thereof I demanded a Certificate from them, which they willingly granted, as also furnished me very plentifully with all things necessary. Having made this dispatch we continued our course, and nine days after we arrived at the Bar of Martabano, on a Friday, the seven and twentieth of March, one thousand, five hundred, forty and five, having passed by Tarnassery, Tovay, M●rguin, juncay, Pullo, Camuda, and Vagaruu, without hearing any tidings of those hundred Portugals, in search of whom I went, b●cause before that they had taken pay in the service of the Chaubainhaa, King of Martabano, who, according to report, had sent for them to assist him against the King of Bramaa, that held him besieged with an Army of seven hundred thousand men, as I have declared before; howbeit they were not at this time in his Service, as we shall see presently. §. 2. It was almost two hours within night, when we arrived at the mouth of the River, where we cast anchor with a resolution to go up the next day to the City; Having continued some time very quiet, we ●ver and anon heard many Cannon shot, whereat we were so troubled, as we knew not what to resolve on; As soon as the Sun rose, the N●coda assembled his men to Council, for in Semblable occasions he always used so to do, and told them, that as sure as they were all to have a share in the peril, so it was fit that every one should give his advice about it; Then he made them a Speech, wherein he represented unto them that which they had heard that night, and how in regard thereof he feared to go unto the City. Their opinions upon it were very different, howbeit at length they concluded, that their eyes were to be witnesses of that whereof they stood in such doubt: To this end we set Sail, having both wind and tide, and doubled a po●nt, called Mounay, from whence we discovered the City, environed with a world of men, and upon the River almost as many vessels, and although we suspected what this might be, because we had heard something of it, yet left we not off from sailing to the Port, where we arrrived with a great deal of care, and having discharged our Ordnance according to the usual manner in sign of peace, we perceived a vessel very well furnished, came directly to us from the shore, wherein there was six Portugals, at which we exceedingly rejoiced; These presently came aboard our Junck, where they were very well entertained, & having declared unto us what we were to do for the safety of our persons, they counselled us not to budge from thence for any thing in the world, as we had told them our resolution was to have fled that night to Bengala, because if we had followed that design, we had 〈◊〉 been lost, and taken by the Fleet which the King of Bramaa had in that place, consisting 〈◊〉 seventeen hundred Sails, wherein were comprised an hundred Galleys very well furnished with strangers. They added withal, that they were of opinion I should go ashore with them to joano Cay●yro, who was Captain of the Portugals, for to give him an account of the cause that brought me thither, the rather for that he was a man of a sweet disposition, and a great friend of Pedro de Faria's, to whom they had often heard him give much commendation, as well for his noble extraction, as for the goodly qualities that were in him; besides they told me that I should find Lançarote Gueyreyro, and the rest of the Captains with him, unto whom my aforesaid Letters were directed, and that I should do nothing therein prejudicial to the Service of God, and the King. This counsel seeming good unto me, I went presently to land with the Portugals to wait on joano Cayeyro, to whom I was exceeding welcome, as likewise to all the rest that were in his quarters, to the number of seven hundred Portugals, all rich men, and of good esteem. Then I showed joano Cayeyro my Letters, and the Order that Pedro de Faria had given me; Moreover I treated with him about the affair that led me thither: whereupon I observed that he was very instant with the Captains, to whom I was addressed, who answered him that they were ready to serve the King in all occasions that should be presented, howbeit since the Letter of Pedro de Faria, Governor of Malaca, was grounded on the fear that he was in of the Army of the Achems, composed of an hundred and thirty Sail, whereof Bijaya Sora King of Pedir, was General, and it having fallen out, that his Admiral had been defeated at Tarnasery by those of the Country, with the loss of seventy Lanchares, and six thousand men, it was not needful they should stir for that occasion; for according to what they had seen with their own eyes, the Forces of that enemy were so mightily weakened, as they did not think he could in ten years' space recover again the loss he had sustained. To this they added many other reasons, which made them all to agree, that it was not necessary they should go to Malaca. After these things I desired joano Cayeyro to make me a Declaration of all that had passed in this business, that it might serve me as it were for a Certificate at my return to our Fortress, determining as soon as I had it to get me from this place, for that I had nothing more to do there. With this resolution I stayed there with joano Cayeyro, in continual expectation to be gone when the Season should serve for the Junck to depart, and remained with him at this Siege the space of six and forty days, which was the chief time of the King of Bramaa his abode there, of whom I will say something here in a few words, because I conceive the curious would be well content to know what success the Chaubainhaa, King of Martabano, had in this war. This Siege had lasted now six months and thirteen days, in which space the City had been assaulted five times in plain-day, but the besieged defended themselves always very valiantly, and like men of great courage: Howbeit in regard they were insensibly consumed with length of time, and the success of war, and that no succour came to them from any part, their enemies were without comparison far more in number than they, in such sort as the Chaubainhaa found himself so destitute of men, as it was thought he had not above five thousand soldiers left in the City, the hundred and thirty thousand which were said to be there at the beginning of the Siege, being consumed by Famine, or the Sword, by reason whereof the Council assembling for to deliberate what was to be done thereupon, it was resolved that the King should sound his enemy by his Interest, which he presently put in execution: For that effect he sent to tell him, that if he would raise the Siege he would give him thirty thousand Bisses of silver, which is in value a million of gold, and would become his Tributary at threescore thousand Ducats by the year. The answer made by the King of Bramaa hereunto was, that he could accept of no conditions from him, if he did not first yield himself to his mercy. The second time he propounded unto him, that if he would suffer him to depart away with two ships, in one of the which should be his Treasure, and in the other his Wife and Children, that then he would deliver him the City, and all that was in it. But the King of Bramaa would hearken no more to that then the former. The third Proposition which he made him was this, That he should retire with his Army to Tagalaa, some six leagues off, that so he might have liberty to go away freely with all his, and thereupon he would deliver him the City, and the Kingdom, together with all the Treasure belonging to the King his Predecessor, or that in lieu thereof he would give him three millions of gold: But he also refused this last offer, insomuch that the Chaubainhaa utterly despairing of ever making his peace with so cruel an enemy, began to meditate with himself what means he might use to save himself from him; Having long thought upon it he found no better an expedient then therein to serve himself of the succour of the Portugals, for he was persuaded that by their means he might escape the present danger. He sent then secretly to tell joano Cayeyro, that if he would embark himself in the night in his four ships, and take him in, with his wife, and children, and so save them, he would give him half his treasure. In this affair he very closely employed a certain Portugal, named Paulo de Seixas, born in the Town of Obidos, who at that time was with him in the City; This same having disguised himself in a Pegu habit, that he might not be known, stole one night to Cayeyro's Tent, and delivered him a Letter from the Chaubainhaa, wherein this was contained: Valiant and faithful Commander of the Portugals, through the Grace of the great King of the other end of the world, the strong and mighty Lion, dreadfully roaring, with a Crown of Majesty in the House of the Sun, I the unhappy Chaubainhaa, heretofore a Prince, but now no longer so, finding myself besieged in this wretched and infortunate City, do give thee to understand by the words pronounced out of my mouth, with an assurance no less faithful than true, that I now render myself the Vassel of the great King of Portugal, Sovereign Lord of me, and my children, with an acknowledgement of homage, and such tribute as he at his pleasure shall impose on me: wherefore I require thee on his behalf, that as soon as Paulo Seixas shall present this my Letter unto thee, thou come speedily with thy Ships to the Bulwark of the Chappel-key, where thou shalt find me ready attending thee, and then without taking further counsel, I will deliver myself up to thy mercy, with all the treasures that I have in gold, and precious stones, whereof I will most willingly give the one half to the King of Portugal, upon condition that he shall permit me with the remainder to levy in his Kingdom, or in the Fortresses which he hath in the Indias, two thousand Portugals, to whom I will give extraordinary great pay that by their means I may be reestablished in this State, which now I am constrained to abandon; since my ill fortune will have it so. As for that which concerns thee, and thy men, I do promise them by the faith of my verity, that in case they do help to save me, I will divide my treasure so liberally among them, that all of them shall be very well satisfied and contented; And for that, time will not suffer me to enlarge any further; Paulo de Seixas, by whom I send this unto thee, shall assure thee both of that which he hath seen, and of the rest which I have communicated unto him. joano Cayeyro had no sooner received this Letter, but he presently caused the chief of his followers secretly to assemble together in Council. Having showed them the Letter, he represented unto them how important and profitable it would be for the service of God and the King to accept of the offer, which the Chaubainhaa had made them; Whereupon causing an Oath to be given to Paulo de Seixas, he willed him freely to declare all his knowledge of the matter, and whether it were true that the Chaubainhaa his Treasure was so great, as it was reported to be. Thereunto he answered by the Oath that he had taken, That he knew not certainly how great his Treasure was, but that he was well assured how he had often seen with his own eyes, an house in form of a Church, and of a reasonable bigness, all ●ull up to the very tiles of bars and wedges of Gold, which might very well lad two great Ships: He further said, That he had moreover seen six and twenty Chests bound about with strong cords, wherein according to the Chaubainhaa his own report was the Treasure of the deceased Bresaguean King of Pegu, which said Treasure containing an hundred and thirty thousand Bisses, and every Biss in value five hundred Ducats, made up all together the sum of threescore Millions of Gold: He said also, That he knew not certainly the number of the wedges of Gold which he had seen in the Temple of the God of Thunder, but he was most assured notwithstanding that they would fully lad four good Vessels: And for a conclusion he told them, That the same Chaubainhaa had showed him the golden Image of Quiay Frigau, which was taken at Degum, all full of such rich and resplendent stones, as it was thought the like again were not in the whole world; So that this Declaration which this man made upon Oath astonished them so that heard it, as they could not possibly believe it to be true. Howbeit after they had sent him out of the Tent, they entered into consultation about this affair, wherein nothing was resolved, of which I verily believe our sins were the cause, for there were in this Assembly as many different opinions, as Babel had diversities of Languages, which proceeded especially from the envy of six or seven men there present, who would needs persuade the rest, that if this affair should happen to have such success, as was hoped for, joano Cayeyro (unto whom they all bore no good will) would go then into Portugal with so much honour and reputation, as it would be a small matter for the King to make him an Earl, or a Marquis, or at least recompense him with the Government of the Indias; so that after these Ministers of the Devil had alleged many reasons wherefore it might not be done, which I think was but the mask of their weakness and ill nature, though it may be they did it out of the fear they were in of losing both their goods and lives if this matter should come to be discovered to the King of Bramaa; howsoever they would not agree to accept of this offer, but chose they threatened joano Cayeyro, that if he desisted not from his purpose, which was to comply with the Chaubainhaa, they would disclose it to the Bramaa, so that Cayeyro was constrained to abandon this business, lest if he should persist therein the Portugals themselves would discover him, as they threatened to do, without either fear of God, or regard of men. §. 3. joana Cayeyro, seeing he could not possibly bring his desi●e to pass, wrote a Letter to the Caubainhaa, wherein he used many weak excuses for not performing that which he demanded of him, and giving it to Paulo de Seixas, he speedily dispatched him away with it, so that departing about three hours after midnight he arrived safe at the City, where he found the Caubainhaa attending him in the same place which he had named in his Letter, unto whom he delivered the Answer he had brought; After he had read it, and thereby found that he could not be succoured by our men, as he always thought he should, it is said that he remained so confounded, that for very grief and sorrow he sunk down to the ground like a dead man, and continuing a pretty while in that manner, at length he came again to himself, and then beating his breast, and bewailing his miserable fortune, Ah Portugals, said he with tears in his eyes, how ill do you acknowledge that which I have done for you, imagining that thereby I should make acquisition of your friendship, as of a treasure, to the end that like faithful men you would be assisting to me in so great a necessity as this is which now I am in, whereby I desired no other thing then to save my children's lives, enrich your King, and state you in the number of my chiefest friends? And would it had pleased him, who reigns in the beauty of these stars, that you had merited before him the doing me this good office, which only for my sins you have refused me, for in so doing you had by my means augmented his Law, and I been saved in the promises of his truth. Thereupon sending away Paulo de Seixas, with a young Wench, by whom he had had two sons, he gave him a pair of Bracelets, and said unto him, I desire thee not to think of this little which now I give thee, but of the great love I have always born thee; above all, forget not to tell the Portugals, with how much cause and grief I complain of their extreme ingratitude, whereof I will render them culpaple before God at the last and dreadful day of judgement. The night following Paul de Seixas came back to the Portugals, with two children, and a very fair young Damosal their Mother, with whom he married afterwards at Coromandel, and showed to Simon de Binto, and Pedro de Bruges▪ Lapidares, the Bracelets which the Chaubainhaa had given him, who buying them of him paid six and thirty thousand Ducats for them, and had afterwards fourscore thousand for them of Trimira Raia Governor of Narsingua. Five days after Paulo de Seixas coming to the Camp, where he recounted all that I have related before, the Chaubainhaa, seeing himself destitute of all humane remedy, advised with his Council what course he should take in so many misfortunes, that daily in the neck of one another fell upon him, and it was resolved by them to put to the sword all things living that were not able to fight, and with the blood of them to make a Sacrifice to Q●iay Nivandel, God of Battles, then to cast all the treasure into the Sea, that their Enemies might make no benefit of it, afterward to set the whole City on fire, and lastly that all those which were able to beat arms should make themselves Amoucos, that is to say, men resolved either to die, or vanquish, in fight with the Bramaas. The Chaubainhaa very much approved this counsel, and concluding of it accordingly they fell presently to the demolishing of houses, and were preparing all other things for the effecting of their design, when as one of the three principal Commanders of the City, apprehending that which was to follow the next day, fled the night ensuing to the Enemy's Camp, and there rendered himself with four thousand men under his leading to the Bramaa; Hereupon the courages of all the rest were so abated by such a strange infidelity and flight, that not one of them cared afterwards either to keep watch, maintain the breathes, or do any other service whatsoever, but contrarily all that remained stuck not to say publicly, that if the Chaubainhaa would not suddenly resolve to yield himself to the Bramaa, they would open the gates and let him in, for that it would be better for them to ●ye so, then to languish and consume away like rotten beasts as they did▪ The Chaubainhaa seeing them stiffly bend thereunto for to appease them answered, that he would perform their desire, howbeit withal he caused a review to be made of those that would fight, but he ●ound them to be not above two thousand in all, and they too so destitute of courage, as they ●ould hardly have resisted feeble women: Beholding himself then reduced to the last cast, he communicated his mind to the Queen only, as having no other at that time by whom he may be advised, or that indeed could advise him; The only expedient then that he could rest on, was to render himself into the hands of his Enemy, and to stand to his mercy, or his rigour. Wherefore the next day about six of the clock in the morning he c●u●ed a white flag to be hung out over the wall in sign of peace, whereunto they of the Camp answered with another like banner; Hereupon the Xenimbrum, who was as it were Marshal of the Camp, sent an horseman to the bulwark, where the flag stood, unto whom it was delivered from the top of the wall, That the Chaubainhaa desired to send a Letter to the King, so as he might have a safe-conduct for it, which being signified to the Xenimbrum, he instantly dispatched away two of good quality in the Army with a safe-conduct, and so these two Bramaa● remaining for hostages in the City, the Chaubainhaa sent the King a Letter by one of his Priests, that was fourscore years of age, and reputed for a Saint amongst them. The contents of this Letter were these: The love of children hath so much power in this house of our weakness, that amongst us, who are fathers, there is not so much as one that for their sakes would not be well contented to descend a thousand times into the deep pit of the house of the Serpent, much more would expose his life for them, and put himself into the hands of one that useth so much clemency towards them that shall do so: For which reason I resolved this night with my wife and children, contrary to the opinions that would dissuade me from this good, which I hold the greatest of all others, to render myself unto your Highness, that you may do with me as you think fit, and as shall be most agreeable to your good pleasure. As for the fault, wherewith I may be charged, and which I submit at your feet, I humbly beseech you not to regard it, that so the merit of the mercy, which you shall show me, may be the greater before God and men. May your Highness therefore be pleased to send some presently for to take possession of my person, of my wife, of my children, of the City, of the Treasure, and of all the Kingdom; all which I do even now yield up unto you, as to my Sovereign Lord, and lawful King. All the request that I have to make unto you thereupon with my knees on the ground, i●, that we may all of us with your permission finish our days in a Cloister, where I have already vowed continually to bewail and repent my fault past; For as touching the honours and estates of the world, wherewith your Highness might enrich me, as Lord of the most part of the Earth, and of the Isles of the Sea, they are things which I utterly renounce for evermore. In a word, I do solemnly swear unto you before the greatest of all the Gods, who with the gentle touch of his Almighty hand makes the Clouds of Heaven to move, never to leave that Religion which by your pleasure I shall be commanded to profess, where being freed from the vain hopes of the world, my repentance may be the more pleasing to him that pardoneth all things. This holy Grepo, Dean of the golden House of Saint Quiay, who for his goodness and austerity of life hath all power over me, will make a more ample relation unto you of what I have omitted, and can more particularly tell you that which concerns the offer I make you of rendering myself, that so relying on the reality of his Speech, the unquietness wherewith my soul is incessantly troubled may be appeased. The King of Bramaa having read this Letter instantly returned another in answer thereunto full of promises and oaths to this effect, That he would forget all that was past, and that for the future he would provide him an estate of so great a Revenue, as should very well content him: Which he but badly accomplished, as I shall declare hereafter. These news was published throughout all the Camp with a great deal of joy, and the next morning all the Equipage and Train that the King had in his quarter was set forth to view: First of all there were to be seen fourscore and six Field-Tents, wonderful rich, each of them being environed with thirty Elephants, ranked in two Files, as if they had been ready to fight, with Castles on their backs full of Banners, and their Panores fastened to their Trunks, the whole number of them amounted unto two thousand, five hundred, and fourscore: Not far from them were twelve thousand and five hundred Bramaas, all mounted on horses, very richly accoutred; with the order, which they kept, they enclosed all the King's quarter in four Files, and were all armed in Corslets, or Coats of mail, with Lances, Scimitars, and guilded Bucklers. After these Horse followed four Files of Foot, all Bramaas, being in number above twenty thousand. For all the other Soldiers of the Camp there were so many as they could not be counted, and they marched all in order after their Captains. In this public Muster were to be seen● world of Banners, & rich colours, & such a number of Instruments of war sounded, that the noise thereof, together with that which the Soldiers made, was most dreadful, and so great as it was not possible to hear one another. Now for that the King of Bramaa would this day make show of his greatness in the reddition of the Chaubainhaa, he gave express Command, that all the Captains which were strangers, with their men, should put on their best clothes, and Arms, and so ranged in two Files, they should make as it were a kind of street, through which the Chaubainhaa might pass; this accordingly was put in execution; and this street took beginning from the City gate, and reached as far as to the King's Tent, being in length about three quarters of a League, or better: In this street there were six and thirty thousand strangers of two and forty different Nations, namely Portugals, Grecians, Venetians, Turks, janissaries, jews, armenians, Tartars, Mogores, Abyssins', Raizbutos, Nobins, Coracones, Persians, Tuparaas, Gizares, Tanacoes, Malabares, jaos, Achems, Moens, Siams, Lussons of the Island Borneo, Chacomas, Arracons, Predins, Papuaas, S●lebres, Mindanoas', Pegus, Bramaas, and many others whose names I know not. All these Nations were ranked according to the Xemimbrums order, whereby the Portugals were placed in the Vanguard, which was next to the gate of the City where the Chabainhaa was to come; After them followed the armenians, than the janissaries and Turks, and so the rest. CHAP. LI. In what manner the Chaubainhaa rendered himself to the King of Bramaa, and the cruel proceeding against the Queen of Martabano, and the Ladies, her Attendants. ABout one of the clock in the afternoon a Cannon was shot off, which was the Signal for the instant opening of the gates of the City, §. 1 whereupon first of all issued out the Soldiers, whom the King had sent thither for the guard of it, being four thousand Siams and Bramaas, all Harquebusiers, Halberdiers, and Pikemen, with above three hundred armed Elephants; all which were commanded by a Bramaa, Uncle to the King, named Monpocasser, Bainba of the City of Melietay; Ten or eleven paces after this Guard of Elephants marched divers Princes, and great Lords, whom the King had sent to receive the Chaubainhaa, all mounted on Elephants, richly harnessed, with Chairs upon their backs, plated over with gold, and Collars of precious stones about their necks; Then followed at some eight or nine paces distance the Rolim of Monnay, Sovereign Talapoy of all the Priests of the Kingdom, and held in the reputation of a Saint, who went alone with the Chaubainhaa, as a Mediator between the King and him; immediately after them came in a close Chair, carried upon men's shoulders, Nhay Canatoo, the daughter of the King of Pegu, from whom this Bramaa had taken his Kingdom, and wife to the Chaubainhaa, having with her four small children, namely, two boys, and two girls, whereof the eldest was not seven years old; round about her and them went some thirty or forty young women of noble extraction, and wonderful fair, with cast down looks, and tears in their eyes, leaning upon other women: After them marched in order certain Talagrepos, which are amongst them as the Capuchins with us, who barefoot and bareheaded went along praying, holding beads in their hands, and ever and anon comforting those Ladies the best they could, and casting water in their faces for to bring them to themselves again, when as they fainted, which they did very often; A spectacle so lamentable, as it was not possible to behold it without shedding of tears: This desolate Company was attended by another Guard of Foot, and five hundred Bramaas on Horseback. The Chaubainhaa was mounted on a little Elephant, in sign of poverty and contempt of the world, conformable to the Religion which he intended to enter into, being simply apparelled in a long Cassock of black velvet, as a mark of his mourning, having his beard, head, and eyebrows shaved, with an old cord about his neck, so to render himself to the King; In this Equipage he appeared so sad and afflicted, that one could not forbear weeping to behold him; As for his age, he was about some threescore and two years old, tall of Stature, with a grave and severe look, and the countenance of a generous Prince. As soon as he was arrived at a place, which was near to the gate of the City, where a great throng of women, children, and old men waited for him, when they saw him in so deplorable an estate, they all made seven times one after another so loud and dreadful a cry, as if Heaven and earth would have come together. Now these lamentations and complaints were presently seconded with such terrible blows, that they gave themselves without pity on their faces with stones, as they were most of them all of a gore blood; In the mean time things so horrible to behold, and mournful to hear, so much afflicted all the Assistants, that the very Bramaas of the Guard, though men of war, and consequently but little inclined to compassion, being also enemies to the Chaubainhaa, could not forbear weeping. It was likewise in this place, where Nhay Cavatoo, and all the other Ladies that attended on her, fainted twice, by reason whereof they were fain to let the Chaubainhaa alight from his Elephant for to go and comfort her; whereupon seeing her lying upon the ground in a swoon with her four children in her arms, he kneeled down on both his knees, and looking up to Heaven with his eyes full of tears. O mighty Power of God, cried he, who is able to comprehend the righteous judgements of thy divine justice, in that thou, having no regard to the innocency of these little creatures, givest way to thy wrath, which passeth far beyond the reach of our weak capacities! but remember; O Lord, who thou art, and not what I am: This said, he fell with his face on the ground, near to the Queen his wife, which caused all the Assembly, who were without number, to make another such loud and horrible cry, as my words are not able to express it; The Chaubainhaa then took water in his mouth, and spurted it on his wife, by which means he brought her to herself again▪ and so taking her up in his arms, he fell a comforting her with speeches so full of zeal and devotion, as any one that heard him would have taken him rather for a Christian, than a Gentile. After he had employed about half an hours time therein, and that they had remounted him on his Elephant, they proceeded on their way in the same orderas they held before, and as soon as the Chaubainhaa was out of the City gate, and came to the streets which was form of the several Companies of the strangers, ranked in two Files, he by chance cast his eye on that side, where the seven hundred Portugals were, all of them in their best clothes, with their buffe-coats, great feathers in their Caps, and their Harquebuses on their shoulders, as also joano Cayeyro ●n the midst of them, in a Carnation Satin Suit, and a guilt Partisan in his hand, wherewith he made room; the afflicted Prince no sooner knew him, but he presently fell down on the Elephant, and there standing still without passing on, he said with tears in his eyes, to those that were about him; My brethren, and good friends, I protest unto you, that it is a less grief unto me to make this sacrifice of myself, which the divine justice of God permits me to make him this day, then to look upon men so wicked and ingrateful as these same here are; either kill me then, or send these away, for otherwise I will not stir a foot further. Having said so he turned away his face three times that he might not behold us, thereby showing the great spleen that he bore us; and indeed all things well considered there was a great deal of reason that he should carry himself in that sort towards us in regard of that which I have related before: In the mean time the Captain of the Guard seeing the stay which the Chaubainhaa had made, and understanding the cause why he would not go on, though he could not imagine wherefore he complained so of the Portugals, yet he hastily turned his Elephant towards Cayeyro, and giving him a scurvy look: Ge● you gone, said he, and that instantly, for such wicked men as you are do not deserve to stand on any ground that bears fruit, and I pray God to pardon him which hath put it in the King's head that you can be any ways profitable unto him; It were fitter for you therefore to shave away your beards that you may not deceive the world as you do, and we will have women in your places that shall serve us for our money. Whereupon the Bramaas of the Guard, being incensed against us, drove us away from thence with a great deal of shame and contumely. And truly, not to lie, never was I so sensible of any thing as this in respect of the honour of my Countrymen. After this, the Chaubainhaa went on till he came to the Tent of the King, who attended him with a Royal Pomp: for he was accompanied with a great number of Lords, amongst the which there were fifteen Bainhaas, who are as Dukes with us, and of six or seven others, that were of greater dignity than they: As soon as the Chaubainhaa came near him, he threw himself at his feet, and so prostrated on the ground he lay there a good while, as it were in a swoon, without speaking a word, but the Rolim of Mounay, that was close by him, supplied that defect, and like a religious man, as he was, spoke for him to the King, saying; Sir, Here is a Spectacle able to move thy heart to pity, though the crime be such as it is; Remember then that the thing most pleasing to God in this world, and whereunto the effects of his mercy is soon communicated, is such an action, and voluntary submission, as this is, which here thou behold●st: It is for thee now to imitate his clemency, and so to do thou art most humbly entreated by the hearts of all them that are mollified by so great a misfortune as this is; Now if thou grantest them this their request, which with so much instance they beg of thee, be assured that God will take it in good part, and that at the hour of thy death he will stretch forth his mighty hand over thee, to the end thou mayst be exempted from all manner of faults. Hereunto he added many other speeches, whereby he persuaded the King to pardon him; at leastwise he promised so to do, wherewith the Rolim, and all the Lords there present, showed themselves very well contented, and commended him exceedingly for it, imagining that the effect should be answerable to that which he had engaged himself for before all. Now because it began to be night, he commanded the most of them that were about him to retire, as for the Chaubainhaa, he committed him into the hands of a Bramaa Commander, named Xemin Comm●dau, and the Queen his wife, with his children, and the other Ladies were put into the custody of Xemin Ansedaa, as well because he had his wife there, as for that he was an honourable old man, in whom the King of Bramaa much confided. §. 2. The fear which the King of Bramaa was in left the men of war should enter into the City of Martabano, and should pillage it now that it was night before he had done all that, which I am hereafter to relate, was the cause that he sent to all the gates of the City, being four and twenty, Bramaa Captains for to guard them, with express Commandment, that upon pain of death no man should be suffered to enter in at any of them, before he had taken order for the performance of the promise, which he had made to the strangers to give them the spoil of it; howbeit he took not that care, and used such diligence for the consideration he sp●ke of, but only that he might preserve the Chaubainhaas treasure, to which effect he spent two whole days in conveying it away, it being so great that a thousand men were for that space altogether employed therein; At the end of these two days the King went very early in the morning to an hill, called Beidao, distant from his quarters some two or three flight shoot, and then caused the Captains that were at the Guard of the gates to leave them, and retire away; whereupon the miserable City of Martabono was delivered to the mercy of the Soldiers, who at the shooting off of a Cannon, which was the signal thereof, entered presently into it pellmell, and so thronging together, that at the entering into the gates, it is said above three hundred were stifled, for as there was there an infinite company of men of War of different Nations, the most of them without King, without Law, and without the fear and knowledge of God, they went all to the Spoil with closed eyes, and therein showed themselves so cruel minded, that the thing they made least reckoning of was to kill an hundred men for a crown; And truly the disorder was such in the City, as the King himself was fain to go thither six or seven times in Person for to appease it. The Sack of this City endured three days and an half, with so much avarice and cruelty of these barbarous enemies▪ as it was wholly pillaged, without any thing left that might give an eye-cause to covet it. That done, the King with a new ceremony of Proclamations caused the Chaubainhaas Palaces, together with thirty or forty very fair rich Houses of his principal Lords, and all the Pagods and Temples of the City to be demolished, so that according to the opinion of many, it was thought that the loss of those magnificent Edifices amounted to above ten millions of gold: wherewith not yet contented he commanded all the buildings of the City that were still a foot, to be set on fire, which by the violence of the wind kindled in such manner, as in that only night there remained nothing unburnt, yea the very Walls, Towers, and Bulwarks were consumed even to the foundations. The number of them that were killed in this Sack was threescore thousand persons, nor was that of the prisoners much less. There were an hundred and forty thousand houses, and seventeen hundred Temples burnt, wherein also were consumed threescore thousand Statues, or Idols of divers metals, during this Siege they of the City had eaten three thousand Elephants. There was found in this City six thousand pieces of Artillery, what of brass and iron, an hundred thousand Quintals of Pepper, and as much of Sanders, Benjamin, Lacre, Lignum Aloes, Camphire, Silk, and many other kinds of rich Merchandise, but above all an infinite number of commodities, which were come thither from the Indias in above an hundred vessels of Cambaya, Achem, Melinda, Ceilam, and of all the Straight of Mecqua, of the Lequios, and of China. As for the gold, silver, precious stones, and jewels, that were found there, one knows not truly what they were, for those things are ordinarily concealed; wherefore it shall suffice me to say, that so much as the King of Bramaa had for certain of the Chaubainhaas Treasure, amounted to an hundred Millions of gold, whereof, as I have said before, our King lost the Moiety, as well for our sins, as through the malice and envy of wicked dispositions. The next day after the City was pillaged, demolished, and burnt, there was seen in the morning upon the hill where the King was, one and twenty pair of Gallows, twenty of the which were of an equal height, and the other a little lower erected on pillars of stone, and guarded by an hundred Bramaa Horsemen; There were also round about the place very large Trenches, where a great many Banners spotted with drops of bloods were planted. As this Novelty promised somewhat which no man had heard of before, six of us Portugals ran thither to learn what the matter might be, and as we were going along we heard a great noise made by the men of War from the Camp, whereupon we saw come out of the King's Quarter a number of Horsemen, who with Lances in their hands prepared a great Street, and cried out aloud; Let no man upon pain of death appear in Arms, nor utter that with his mouth which he thinks in his heart. A pretty way off from these Horse was the Xemimbrum, with an hundred armed Elephants, and a good many Foot; after them went fifteen hundred Bramaas on Horseback, cast into four Orders of Files, each of them six in a rank, whereof the Talanagybras, Viceroy of Tangu, was Commander: Then marched the Chauseroo Siammon with three thousand Siammes, armed with Harquebuses and Lances, all in one Battalion: In the midst of these was an hundred and twenty women tied and bound four and four together, and accompanied with Talagrepos, men of great Austerity, and are such as the Capachins amongst us, who laboured all they might to comfort them in this last act of life; Behind them were twelve Ushers with Maces, that went before Nhay Canatoo, Daughter to the King of Pegu, from whom this Bramaa Tyrant had usurped his Kingdom, and wife to the Chaubainhaa, with four children of hers, which were carried by so many Horsemen: all these sufferers were the wives or daughters of the principal Commanders that the Chaubainhaa had with him in the City, upon whom in the way of a strange revenge this Bramaa Tyrant desired to wreak his spite, and the hatred that he had always born unto women. The most of these poor wretches were between seventeen and five and twenty years of age, all of them very white and fair, with bright auborn hair, but so weak in body, that oftentimes they fell down in a swoon, out of which certain women upon whom they leaned, endeavoured still to bring them again, presenting them Comfits, and other such things fit for that purpose, but they would take none of them, for that they were, as I have said, so feeble and benumbed, as they could scarce hear what the Talegr●pes spoke unto them, only they now and then lifted up their hands to Heaven. After this Princess marched threescore Grepos, in two Files, praying with their looks fixed on the ground, and their eyes watered with tears, saying ever and anon in a doleful tone; Thou which holdest thy Being of none but thyself, so justify our works, that they may be agreeable to thy justice.. Whereunto others answered weeping; Grant, Lord, that it may be so, that through our fault we lose not the rich gifts of thy promises. After these Grepos followed a procession of three or four hundred little children, quite naked from the Girdle-sted downwards, having in their hands great white wax lights, and cords about their necks; These, like the others, with a sad and lamentable voice, which moved every one to compassion, uttered these words: We most humbly beseech thee, O Lord, to give ear unto our cries and groans, and show mercy to these thy Captives, that with a full rejoicing they may have a part of the graces and benefits of thy rich treasures; and much more they said to that purpose in ●avour of these poor sufferers: Behind this Procession was another Guard of Footmen, all Bramaas, and armed with Lances, Arrows, and some Harquebuses. As for the Rear-ward, it consisted of an hundred Elephants, like to them that marched first of all, so that the number of the men of War that assisted at this Execution, as well for the Guard, as for the Pomp thereof, was ten thousand Foot, and two thousand Horse, besides the two hundred Elephants, and a world of other people, both Strangers and Natives, that came thither to behold the end of so mournful and lamentable and action. CHAP. LII. In what sort the sentence of Death was executed on the person of the Chaubainhaa, King of Martaban, Nhay Canatoo his wife, and an hundred and forty women; with that which the King of Bramaa did after his return to Pegu. THese poor sufferers having been led in the order before mentioned clean through the Camp, they came at last to the place of Execution, § 1. where the six Ushers with a loud voice made this Proclamation: Let all manner of people see and observe the bloody justice, which is here to be done by the living God, Lord of all truth, and our King the Sovereign of our Heads, who of his absolute power doth command that these hundred and forty Women be put to death, and thrown into the air, for that by their counsel and incitement their Fathers and Husbands stood out against us in this City, and at times killed twelve thousand Bramaas of the Kingdom of Tangu. Then at the ringing of a Bell all the Officers and Ministers of Justice pelmell together with the guards, made such a cry, as was most dreadful to hear; whereupon the cruel Hangmen being ready to put the sentence of Death in execution, those poor wretches embraced one another, and shedding abundance of tears they addressed themselves to Nhay Canatoo, who lay at that time almost dead in the lap of an old Lady, and with their last compliments one of them spoke for all the rest unto her in this manner; Excellent Lady, that art as a crown of Roses upon our Heads, now that we thy humble servants are entering into those mournful Mansions where Death doth reside, comfort us we beseech thee with thy dear sight, that so we may with less grief quit these bodies full of anguish for to present ourselves before that Almighty just judge, of whom we will for ever implore his justice for a perpetual vengeance of the wrong that is done us. Then Nhay Canatoo beholding them with a countenance more dead than alive, answered them with a feeble voice, that could scarce be heard, Go not away so soon, my Sisters, but help me to sustain these little children. That said, she leaned down again on the bosom of that Lady, without speaking a word more, whereupon the Ministers of the Arm of Vengeance, so they term the Hangmen, laid hold on those poor women, and hanged them up all by the feet, with their heads downwards, upon twenty Gibbets, namely seven on each one: now so painful a death as this was, made them give strange and fearful groans and sobs, until at length the blood stifled them all in less than an hour. In the mean time Nhay Canatoo was conducted by the four women, upon whom she leaned, directly to the Gallows whereon she and her four children were to be hanged, and there the Rolim of Mounay, who was held amongst them for a holy man, used some speeches unto her for to encourage her the better to suffer death, whereupon she desired them to give her a little water, which being brought unto her, she filled he mouth with it, and so spurted it upon her four children, whom she held in her arms; then having kissed them many times, she said unto them weeping, O my Children, my Children, whom I have conceived anew within the interior of my Soul, how happy would I think myself if I might redeem your lives with the loss of mine own a thousand times over if it were possible! for in regard of the fear and anguish wherein I see you at this present, and wherein every one sees me also, I should receive Death with as good an heart from the hand of this cruel Enemy, as I willingly desire to see myself in the presence of the Sovereign Lord of all things, within the repose of his celestial Habitation. Then turning her to the Hangman, who was going to bind her two little boys, Good Friend, said she, be not I pray thee so void of pity, as to make me see my children die, for in so doing thou wouldst commit a great sin; wherefore put me first to death, and refuse me not this boon which I crave of thee for God's sake. After she had thus spoken she took her children again in her arms, and kissing them over and over in giving them her last farewell, she yielded up the ghost in the Lady's lap upon whom she leaned, not so much as once stirring ever after, which the Hangman perceiving, ran presently unto her and hanged her as he had done the rest, together with her four little children, two of each side of her, and she in the middle. At this cruel and pitiful spectacle there arose from amongst all this people so great and hideous a cry, that the Earth seemed to tremble under the feet of them that stood upon it, and withal there followed such a Mutiny throughout the whole Camp, as the King was constrained to fortify himself in his quarter with six thousand Bramaa Horse, and thirty thousand Foot, and yet for all that be thought not himself secure enough from it, had not the night come, which only was able to calm the furious motions of these men of war; For of seven hundred thousand which were in the Camp, six hundred thousand were by Nation Pegu's, whose King was the Father of this Queen, that was thus put to death; but this Tyrant of Bramaa had so disarmed and subjected them, as they durst not so much as quich upon any occasion. Behold in what an infamous manner Nhay Canatoo finished her days, a Princess every way accomplished, wife to the Chaubainhaa King of Martabano, and the daughter of the King of Pegu, Emperor of nine Kingdoms, whose yearly Revenue amounted unto three millions of Gold. As for the infortunate King her Husband, he was the same night cast into the River with a great stone tied about his neck, together with fifty or threescore of his chiefest Lords, who were either the Fathers, Husbands or Brothers of those hundred and forty Ladies, that were most unjustly put to such an ignominious death, amongst the which there were three, whom this King of Bramaa had demanded in marriage at such time as he was but a simple Earl, but not one of their Fathers would condescend unto it, whereby one may see how great the revolutions of time and fortune are. §. 2. After the Tyrant of Bramaa had caused this rigorous Justice to be done, he stayed there nine whole days, during the which many of the Inhabitants of the City were also execued; At last he departed for to go to Pegu, leaving behind him Bainhaa Chaque, Lord Steward of his House, to take order for all things that might conduce to the pacifying of that Kingdom, and to provide for the repairing of what the fire had consumed, to which purpose he placed a good Garrison there, and carried with him the rest of his Army; joano Cayeyro followed him also with seven hundred Portugals, not above three or four remaining behind in the ruins of Martabano, and those too not very considerable, except it were one, named Gonçalo Falcan, a Gentleman well born, and whom these Gentiles commonly called Crisna Pacan, that is to say, Flower of Flowers, a very honourable Title amongst them, which the King of Bramaa had given him in recompense of his services: Now for as much as at my departure from Malaca, Pedro de Faria had given me a Letter directed unto him, whereby he desired him to assist me with his favour, in case I had need of it in the affair for which he sent me thither, as well for the service of the King, as for his own particular; as soon as I arrived at Martabano, where I found him resident, I delivered him this Letter, and withal gave him an account of the occasion that brought me thither, which was to confirm the ancient league of Peace that the Chaubainhaa had made by his Ambassadors with them of Malaca, at such time as Pedro de Faria was first Governor of it, and whereof he could not choose but have some knowledge; adding moreover, how to that effect I had brought the Chaubainhaa Letters full of great protestations of amity, and a Present of certain very rich Pieces of China. Hereupon this Gonçalo Falcan imagining that by means hereof he might insinuate himself much more into the good grace of the King of Bramaa, to whose side he turned at the siege of Martabano, quitting that of the Chaubainhaa, whom formerly he served, he went three days after the King's departure to his said Governor, and told him that I was come thither, as Ambassador from the Captain of Malaca to treat with the Chaubainhaa, unto whom the Captain sent an offer of great Forces against the King of Bramaa, in so much that they of the Country were upon the point of fortifying themselves in Martabano, and chase away the Bramaas out of the Kingdom; whereunto he added so many other such like matters, that the Governor sent presently to apprehend me, and after he had put me into safe custody, he went directly to the Junck, in which I came from Malaca, and seized upon all the goods that were in her, which were worth above an hundred thousand ducats, committing the Necoda, Captain and Master of the Junck, to prison, as also all the rest that were in her, to the number of an hundred threescore and four persons, wherein comprised forty rich Merchants, Malayes, Menancabo's, Mahumetans, and Gentiles, Natives of Malaca. All these were incontinently condemned to a confiscation of their goods, and to remain the King's prisoners, as well as I, for being complices in the Treason, which the Captain of Malaca had plotted in secret with the Chaubainhaa against the King of Bramaa. Having thus caused them to be put into a deep Dungeon, he made them to be so cruelly scourged, that within a month after their imprisonment, of an hundred sixty four of them, which they were, there died nineteen, either of a Lethargy, or of hunger, or thirst. As for the rest, they were put into a miserable Shallop without Sails or Oars, wherein they were exposed down the River: Being delivered in this sort to the mercy of Fortune, they were cast by the wind into a desert Island, called Pulho Canuida, seated twenty leagues within the Sea of this Bar, where they furnished themselves with some Sea-fish, and such fruits as they found in the woods, and in this necessity making a kind of sail of the clothes they had, and with two Oars, which it may be they met withal there, or made themselves, they took their course all along by the Coast of junçalan, and from thence to another place, wherein they employed the space of two months, arriving at length at the River of Parles in the Kingdom of Qu●da, where they all died of certain Impostumes, which rose in their throats like unto Carbuncles, two only excepted, who came to Malaca, and recounted to Pedro de Faria the whole success of this sad Voyage, and how that I was condemned to die, as indeed I expected every hour to be led to execution, when as it pleased God to deliver me miraculously; for as soon as the Necoda and the Merchants were banished in the manner that I have declared, I was committed to another prison farther off, where I remained six and thirty days laden with chains and irons in a most cruel and insupportable manner; During all that time the Traitor Gonçalo exhibited against me daily new and false allegations, wherein he charged me with a world of things, which I never so much as thought of, and that to no other intent but to procure my death, that so he might rob me, as he had done all the rest that were in the Junck: To which end, having questioned me three several times in Judgement, I never answered any thing to his Interrogatories that was to purpose, whereat he and other of my Enemies were much enraged, saying, that I did it out of pride, and in contempt of Justice, so that for a punishment thereof they caused me to be openly whipped, and a great deal of lacre, which is like unto hard wax, to be dropped scalding hot upon me, whereof the pain was such, as it had almost killed me, and indeed all that were by, held me for a dead man. Now because for the most part I knew not what I spoke, but talked like a desperate man, I happened three or four times to say, that for to rob me of my goods I had all these false accusations put upon me, but that Captain joano Cayeyro, who was at Pegu, would ere it were long acquaint the King with this cruel usage of me, which was the cause of saving my life; for even as this wicked Governor was going to have the sentence executed, which was given against me, some of his friends counselled him to forbear, saying, that if he put me to death, no doubt but that all the Portugals, which were at Pegu, would complain of him to the King, and tell him, that for to rob me of an hundred thousand ducats, which I had there in Commodities, appertaining to the Captain of Malaca, he had most unjustly taken away my life: And that this being so, the King would demand an account of him of all those Commodities, or of the Money for them, and that if he rendered him even all that he had taken from me, yet would not that content him, imagining still there was somewhat more, whereby he would so put himself out of the good grace of the King, as he would never recover it again, which would be the cause of the utter overthrown both of himself and his children, besides the dishonour that would redound to him over and above. This dog the Governor Bainbaa Chaque, fearing lest that should come to pass which they ●ad said, desisted from his former obstinacy, and correcting the sentence he had given, he ordained, That I should not die, but that my goods should be confiscated, and myself arrested for the King's prisoner; As indeed so soon as I was healed of the hurts, which the burning of the lacre, and the stripes of the whips had made upon me, I was conducted in chains to Pegu, and there as a prisoner was put into the hands of a Bramaa, Treasurer to the King, named Diosoray, who had also in his custody eight other Portugals, whose sins had procured them the same misfortune, which mine had caused unto me; for it was now full six months since these poor wretches had been in his power, being taken in the ship of Don Anrique Deca of Cananor, which by a tempest was cast on that Coast. Now seeing that hitherto I have discoursed of the success of my Voyage to Martabano, and of the benefit that redounded to me by my going thither for the service of the King, which was no other than the loss of my goods, and the imprisonment of my person; before I engage myself further in these relations, I am resolved to entreat of the divers Fortunes, which I ran in that Kingdom for the space of two years and an half that I traveled therein, being the time of my Captivity, as also of the several Country's through which I was carried by my crosses and mishaps, as holding it altogether necessary for the declaration of that which I am going on withal. I say then, that after this King of Bramaa was departed from the City of Martabano, as I have related before, he journeyed so long that at length he came to Pegu, where, before he dismissed his Commanders, he caused a Muster to be made of his Army, and found that of seven hundred thousand men, which he had carried along with him to the besieging of the Chaubainhaa, there was fourscore and six thousand of them wanting: And for as much as he had about that time some inkling how the King of Avaa, confederated with the Savadis and Chaleus, would give entry unto the Sianmon (whose Country borders on the West and Northwest side on the Calaminban, Emperor of the indomptable Forces of the Elephants of the Earth, as I will show hereafter when I speak of him) to the end he might win from this Bramaa the chiefest strengths of his Kingdom, he like a good Captain as he was, and very cunning in matter of War, before he passed on further, caused men to be levied, with whom, as also with all other necessary things he furnished those principal Fortresses from whence his greatest fear proceeded. Then having resolved to go and besiege the City of Prom, he retained the Army, which he had already a foot, and made new and great preparations throughout the Kingdom, using such diligence therein, as in six months' time he had got together the number of nine hundred thousand men, whom he embarked in twelve thousand rowing Vessels, whereof two thousand were Seroos, Laulers, Caturos, and Foists. Now all this great Fleet set forth from Pegu the ninth day of March, 1545. and going up the River of Ansedaa, it went to Danapluu, where it was furnished with all such provisions as was necessary. From this place following on their way through a great River of fresh water, called Picau Malacou, which was above a league broad, at length upon the thirteenth of April they came within view of Prom. There, by some whom they took that night, they learned, that the King was dead, and how he had left for his successor to the Kingdom a son of his of thirteen years of age, whom the King his Father before he died had married to his wife's sister, the Aunt of the said young Prince, and Daughter to the King of Avaa. This young King was no sooner advertised of the King of Bramaa his coming to besiege him in his City of Prom, but he sent presently away to the King his Father-in-law for succour, which he instantly granted, and to that end speedily raised an Army of 30000 Mons, Tarces, and Chalems', choice men and trained up in the Wars, of whom he made a son of his, and brother to the Queen, General. In the mean time the Bramaa, having intelligence thereof, used all possible diligence for to besiege the City before so great a succour might arrive. To which purpose, having landed his Army in a plain, called Meigavotau, some two leagues below the City, he continued there five days in making ready such preparations as were needful; Having given order for all things, he caused his Army to march one morning before day directly to the City, with the sound of Drums, Fifes, and other such instruments of War; where being arrived about noon without any opposition, he began presently to settle his Camp, so that before it was night, the whole City was environed with Trenches▪ and very great Ditches, as also with six rows of Cannons, and other Pieces of Ordnance. CHAP. LIII. That which passed between the Queen of Prom, and the King of Bramaa, together with the first Assault that was given to the City and the Success thereof. THe King of Bramaa had been now five days before the City of Prom, §. 1. when as the Queen that governed the State in the place of her Husband, seeing herself thus besieged, sent to visit this her enemy with a rich jewel of precious stones, which was presented unto him by a Talagrepo, or religious man, of above an hundred years old, who was held amongst them for a Saint, together with a Letter, wherein this was written; Great and mighty Lord, more favoured in the House of fortune than all the Kings of the earth, the force of an extreme power, an increasing of the Salt-seas, whereinto all lesser rivers do render themselvos a Shield full of very fair devices, Processor of the greatest States, upon the Throne whereof thy feet do repose with a marvellous Majesty: I Nhay Nivolau, a poor woman, Governess, and Tutoress of my Son, an Orphan, do prostrate myself before thee with tears in mine eyes, and with the respect which ought to be rendered unto thee; I beseech thee not to draw thy Sword against my weakness, for thou knowest that I am but a silly woman, which can but only cry unto God for the wrong that it done me, whose property also it is to succour with mercy, and to chastise with justice the States of the world be they never so great, trampling them under his feet with so redoubted a power, that the very Inhabitants of the profound house of smoke do fear and tremble before this Almighty Lord: I pray and conjure thee not to take from me that which is mine, seeing it is so small a thing, as thou shalt not be the greater for it when thou hast it, nor yet the less if thou hast it not; whereas contrarily, if thou, my Lord, wilt show thyself pitiful to me, that act of clemency will bring thee such reputation, as the very Infants themselves will cease from sucking the white breasts of their Mothers for to praise thee with the pure lips of their innocency, and likewise all they of my Country, and Strangers will ever remember such thy charity towards me, and I myself will cause it to be graven on the Tombs of the dead, that both they and the living may give thee thanks for a thing, which I do beg of thee with so much instance from the bottom of my heart. This holy man, Avenlachim, from whom thou shalt receive this Letter, written with mine own hand, hath Power and Authority to treat with thee in the Name of my Fatherless Son, concerning all that shall be judged reasonable touching the tribute and homage which thou shalt think fit to have rendered unto thee, upon condition that thou wilt be pleased to let us enjoy our houses, so that under a true assurance thereof we may bring up our children, and gather the fruit of our labours for the nourishment of the poor Inhabitants of this paltry Town, who will all serve thee, and I to with a most humble respect in all things, wherein thou shalt think good to employ us at thy pleasure. The Bramaa received this Letter and Ambassage with a great deal of authority, and entertained the Religious man, that delivered it to him, with much honour, as well in regard of his age, as for that he was held as a Saint amongst th●m; with all he granted him certain things which were at first demanded, as a Cessation of Arms till such time as Articles should be agreed on, as also a permission for the Besieged to converse with the Besiegers, and other such things of little consequence; In the mean time judging with himself that all those offers, which this poor Queen made him, and the humble submissions of her Letter proceeded from weakness and fear, he would never answer the Ambassador clearly, or to purpose: Contrarily he caused all the places there abouts that were weak▪ and unarmed, to be secretly ransacked, and the poor Inhabitants thereof to be unmercifully butchered by their barbarous enemies, whose cruelty was so great, that in five days, according to report, they killed fourteen thousand persons, the most part whereof, were women, children, and old men, that were not able to bear Arms. Hereupon the Rolim, who brought this Letter, relying no longer on the false promises of this Tyrant, and discontented with the little respect he used towards him, demanded leave of him to return to the City, which the B●amaa gave him, together with this answer; That if the Queen would deliver up herself, her Treasure, her Kingdom, and her Vassals to him, he would recompense her another way for the loss of her State: but withal that she was to return him a peremptory answer to this proposition of his the very same day, which was all the time I could give her, that so he might upon the knowledge of her resolution determine upon what he had to do. The Rolim went herewith back to the City, where he gave the Queen an account of all things, saying, That this Tyrant was a man without faith, and replete with damnable intentions, for proof whereof he represented unto her the Siege of Martabano, the usage of the Chaubainhaa after he rendered himself unto him upon his word, and how he had put him, his wife, his children, and the chiefest Nobility of his Kingdom to a most shameful death. These things considered it was instantly concluded, as well by the Queen, as by all those of her Council, that she should defend the City, till such time as succour came from her Father, which would be within fifteen days at the furthest: This resolution taken, she being of a great courage without further delay took order for all things, that were thought necessary for the defence of the City, animating to that end her people with great prudence, and a manlike Spirit, though she was but a woman; Moreover, as she liberally imparted to them of her Treasure, so she promised every one throughly to acknowledge their services with all manner of recompenses and honours, whereby they were mightily encouraged to fight: In the mean space the King of Bramaa, seeing that the Rolim returned him no answer within the time prefixed, began the next day to fortify all the Quarters of his Camp with double rows of Cannon, for to batter the City on every side; and for assaulting of the walls he caused a great number of Ladders to be made, publishing withal throughout his whole Army, that all Soldiers upon pain of death should be ready within three days to go to the Assault; The time then being come, which was the third of May, 1545. About an hour before day the King went out of his Quarter, where he was at anchor upon the river with two thousand vessels of choice men, and giving the Signal to the Commanders which were on Land, to prepare themselves, they altogether in one Body assailed the walls, with so great a cry, as if Heaven and earth would have come together, so that both sides falling to encounter pellmell with one another, there was such a conflict betwixt them, as within a little while the air was seen all on fire, and the earth all bloody, whereunto being added the clashing of weapons, and noise of guns, it was a spectacle so dreadful, that we few Portugals, who beheld these things, remained astonished, and almost besides ourselves: This fight endured full five hours, at the end whereof the Tyrant of Bramaa seeing those within defend themselves so valiantly, and the most part of his Forces to grow faint, he went to land with ten or eleven thousand of his best men, and with all diligence reinforcing the Companies, that were fight, the Bickering renewing in such sort, as one would have said it did but then begin, so great was the fury of it. The second trial continued till night, yet would not th● K●ng desist from the fight, what counsel soever was given him to retire, but contrarily he swore not to give over the Enterprise begun, and that he would lie that night within the enclosure of the City walls, or cut off the heads of all those Commanders that were not wounded at their coming off; In the mean time this obstinacy was very pejudicial to him, for continuing the Assault till the Moon was gone down, which was two hours past midnight, he was then forced to sound a Retreat, after he had lost in this Assault, as was the next day found upon a Muster, fourscore thousand of his men, besides those which were hurt, which were thirty thousand at the least, whereof many died for want of dressing, whence issued such a plague in the Camp, as well through the corruption of the air, as the water of the river, that was all tainted with blood and dead bodies, that thereby about fourscore thousand more perished, amongst whom were five hundred Portugals, having no other burial than the bellies of Vultures, Crows, and such like birds of prey, which devoured them all along the Coast where they lay. The King of Bramaa, having considered that this first Assault having cost him so dear, would no more hazard his men in that manner, §. 2. but he caused a great Terrace to be made with Bavins, and above ten thousand Date-trees, which he commanded to be cut down, and on that he raised up a platform so high, as it overtopped the walls of the City two fathom, and more, where he placed fourscore pieces of Ordnance, and with them continually battering the City for the space of nine days together, it was for the most part demolished with the death of fourteen thousand persons, which quite abated the poor Queen's courage, especially when she came to understand that she had but six thousand fight men left, all the rest, which consisted of women, chidrens, & old men, being unfit and unable to bear Arms. The miserable besieged seeing themselves reduced to such extremity, assembled together in Council, and there by the advice of the chiefest of them, it was concluded, That all in general should anoint themselves with the Oil of the Lamps of the Chapel of Quiay Nivandel, God of Battle of the field Vitan, and so offering themselves up in sacrifice to him, set upon the platform, with a determination either to die, or to vanquish, in vowing themselves all for the defence of their young King, to whom they had so lately done homage, and sworn to be true and faithful Subjects. This resolution taken, which the Queen and all her Nobility approved of for the best and most assured, in a time wherein all things were wanting to them for the longer defending themselves, they promised to accomplish it in the manner aforesaid by a solemn O●th, which they all took; Now there being no further question but to see how they should carry themselves in this affair, they first of all made an Uncle of the Queens the Captains of this resolute Band, who assembling these six thousand together, the same night, about the first quarter of the watch, made a sally out of the two gates that were nearest to the Terrace and platform, and so taking courage from their despair, and resolution to die, they fought so valiantly, that in less than half an hour the whole Camp was put in disorder, the Terrace gained, the fourscore pieces of Cannon taken, the King himself hurt, the palisado burnt, the Trenches broken, and the Xenimbrum, General of the Army, slain, with above fifteen thousand ●en more, amongst the which were five hundred Turks; there we●e moreover forty Elephants taken, besides those that were killed, and eight hundred Bramaas made prisoners, so that these six thousand resolute men did that, which an hundred thousand, though valiant enough, could hardly have effected. After this they retreated an hour before day, and upon a review they found, that of six thousand which they were, there was but seven hundred slain. This bad success so grieved and incensed the King of Bramaa, as attributing the cause thereof to the negligence of some of his Cap●ains in the ●ll guarding of the Terrace, that the day following he caused two thousand Pegus to be beheaded, which had stood sentinel that night. This adventure rendered things quiet for the space of twelve days, during which the besieged stirred not; in the mean time one of the four principal Captain of the City, named Xemim Meleytay, fearing that which all others in general misdoubted, namely, that they could not escape from falling into the hands of so cruel an Enemy, treated secretly with the Tyrant, and upon condition that he would continue him in his charge, not meddle with any of the houses of his friends, and make him Xemin of Ansedaa in the Kingdom of Pegu, with all the Revenue which the Bainhaa of Malacou had there, being thirty thousand ducats a year, he would deliver him up the City by giving him entrance into it through the gate which he commanded: The King of Bramaa accepted hereof, and for a gage of performance on his part, he sent him a rich Ring from off his finger. This Treason so concluded, was effected on the three and twentieth of August, in the year 1545. wherein this Tyrant of Bramaa carried himself with all the barbarousness and cruelty that he used to practise in the like cases. And for as much as I conceive that I should never have done, if I should recount here at large how this affair past, I will say no more, but that the gate was opened, the City delivered up, the Inhabitants all cut in pieces, without so much as sparing one; the King and Queen made prisoners, their Treasurers taken, the Buildings and Temples demolished, and many other inhumanities' exercised with such outragiousness, the belief whereof is beyond the imagination and thought of man, and truly I never represent unto myself in what manner it was done, as having seen it with mine own eyes, but that I remain as it were astonished and besides myself at it. For as this Tyrant was touched to the quick with the affront he had lately received, so he executed all the cruelties he could imagine against thos● miserable Inhabitants, for to be revenged of the ill success he had had in the siege, which could not proceed from any other but a base mind and vile extraction, for it ordinarily falls out, that barbarousness finds place in such kind of people, rather than in generous and valiant hearts; Whereunto may be added, that he was a man without faith, and of an effeminate disposition, though he was nevertheless an Enemy to women, albeit there were in that Kingdom, and in all the others whereof he was Lord, those that were very white and fair. After the bloody ruin of that wretched City, the Tyrant entered into it in great pomp, and and as it were in triumph, through a breach that was made of purpose in the wall, and by his express commandment. When he was arrived at the young King's palace, he caused himself to be crowned King of Prom, and during the Ceremony of this Coronation, he made that poor Prince, whom he had deprived of his Kingdom, to continue kneeling before him, with his hands held up, as if he adored some God, and ever and anon they constrained him to stoop down and kiss the Tyrant's feet, who in the mean time made show as if he were not pleased therewith. This done, he went into a Balcone, which looked on a great Market place, whither he commanded all the dead children, that lay up and down the streets, to be brought, and then causing them to be hacked very small, he gave them, mingled with Bran, Rice, and Herbs, to his Elephants to eat. Afterward, with a strange kind of ceremony, at the sound of Trumpets, Drums, and other such like Instruments, there was above an hundred Horses led in, loaden with the quarters of men and women, which also he commanded to be cut small, and then cast into a great fire, kindled expressly for it. These things so done, the Queen was brought before him, that was wife to the poor little King, who, as I said before, was but thirteen years of age, and she thirty and six, a woman very white, and well-favored, Aunt to her own Husband, Sister to his Mother, and Daughter to the King of Avaa, which is the Country from whence the Rubies, Saphires, and Emeralds do come to Pegu; and it was the same Lady, whom this Bramaa had sent to demand in marriage of her Father, as it was then spoken, but that he refused him, saying to his Ambassador for an answer, That the thoughts of his Daughter soared a pitch higher than to be the wife of the Xemim of Tanguu, which was the family whence this Tyrant was issued: But now that she was fallen into his hands as his slave, whether he used her so, either out of a revenge of that affront, or out of scorn and contempt, so it was that he made her to be publicly stripped stark naked, and to be torn and mangled with whipping, and then in that manner to be led up and down all the City, where amidst the cries and hooting of the people, he exposed her to other cruel torments, wherewith she was tortured till she gave up the ghost; When she was dead, he made her to be bound to the little King her Husband, who was yet living, and having commanded a great stone to be tied about their necks, they were cast into the River, which was a kind of cruelty very dreadful to all that beheld it. To these barbarous parts he added many others so inhuman, as it is not likely that any other but he could imagine the like; And for a conclusion of his cruelties, the next day he caused all the Gentlemen that were taken alive, being some three hundred, to be impaled, and so spitted like roasted Pigs, to be also thrown into the River, whereby may be seen how great and unheard of the injustice of this Tyrant was, which he exercised on these miserable wretches. CHAP. LIV. The King of Bramaa his besieging of the Fortress of Meleytay, with his going from thence to Avaa; and that which passed there. §. 1. FOurteen days were past since the doing of these things, during the which the Tyrant employed himself in fortifying the City with a great deal of diligence and care, when as his spies, whom he had sent out, brought him word, that from the City of Avaa a Fleet of four hundred rowing Vessels was come down the River of Queitor, wherein there were thirty thousand Siamon Soldiers, besides the Mariners, of which the King of Avaas son, and brother to the poor Queen, was General; for this Prince having received advertisement of the taking of the City of Prom, and of the death of his sister and brother-in-law, went and lodged in the Fortress of Meleytay, which was some twelve leagues up the River from Prom. This news much troubled the Tyrant, howbeit he resolved to go himself in person against his Enemies before that other succours came to join with them, as indeed the report went, that fourscore thousand, all Mons by Nation, and led by the King of Avaa, were on their way thither: With this resolution the Tyrant of Bramaa set forth towards Meleytay with an Army of three hundred thousand men, namely two hundred thousand by Land alongst the River's side, whereof the Chaumigrem his Foster-brother was Commander in chief, and the other hundred thousand under his own conduct, being all choice men, and embarked in two thousand Seroos; Being come within sight of Meleytay, the Avaas desiring to show that the resolution wherewith they were come thither, was of far more power with them, than any fear they could have, and that also their Enemies might not receive any benefit by their Fleet which lay on the River, and do them an affront besides by taking of it, they set all the●● Vessels on fire, and burned them every one; Then, without any dread of that which the flesh doth naturally most fear, they got all into the field, and ranged themselves into four Battalions, in three of which, whereof each one made ten thousand men, were the thirty thousand Mons; and in the the other, that were somewhat bigger, were all the Mariners of the four hundred Vessels they had burnt: These same they placed in the Vanguard, with an intention that they should weary the Enemies, with whom they made a cruel fight, which lasted about half an hour, wherein all these Mariners were cut in pieces; presently after them the thirty thousand Mons, close compacted together in three Battalions, presented themselves, and with wonderful violence set upon their Enemies, between whom and them followed so extraordinary and cruel a battle, as not longer to insist upon it, nor to recount in particular how things past, which also I cannot well do, it shall suffice me to say, that of the thirty thousand Mons, eight hundred only escaped out of it, who being routed, made their retreat into the Fortress of Meleytay; but that which was most memorable herein was that of the King of Bramaas two hundred thousand men, an hundred and fifteen thousand lay dead in field, and all the rest for the most part were wounded. In the mean time the Tyrant, which came along on the River in the two thousand Seroos, arrived at the place of Battle, where beholding the strange massacre which the Mons had made of his people, he became so enraged at it, that dis-imbarquing his Forces, he instantly laid siege unto the Fortress, with a purpose, as he said, to take all those eight hundred that were in it alive. This siege continued seven whole days together, during the which those without gave five assaults to it, and the besieged defended themselves always very valiantly, howbeit seeing that the last hour of their life was come, and that they could no longer hold that place for their King, as they had hoped they might, by reason of the fresh Forces which the King of Bramaa had landed, like courageous men as they were they resolved to die in the field, as their companions had done, and valiantly revenge their deaths with that of their Enemies, whereunto they were the more willingly carried, because they perceived well that if they continued still in the place, they should never make use of their valour, as they desired to do, for that the Tyrant's Ordnance would by little and little consume them: This resolution taken, they under the favour of a very dark and rainy night sallied forth, and first of all fell upon the two first Courts of guard that were on the Lands side, cutting all in pieces that they met withal▪ Than following their design they passed on like desperate men, and whether they did it, either to show that they regarded not death which threatened them, or for the desire they had to gain honour, so it was that they behaved themselves so courageously, and pressed the Tyrant so near, as they forced him to leap into the River, and swim for his life, in so much that all the Camp was in disorder, and broken through in I know not how many places, with the death of above twelve thousand men, amongst whom were fifteen hundred Bramaas, two thousand strangers of divers Nations, and all the rest Pegu's. This ●ight last not above half an hour, in which time the eight hundred Mons were all slain, there being not so much as one of them that would yield upon any composition whatsoever. Hereupon the Tyrant of Bramaa seeing the fight ended, and all things quiet, went and reassembled his Forces together, and so entered into the Fortress of Meleytay, where he presently commanded the Xemims head to be cut off, saying, that he was the sole cause of that disaster, and that he who had been a Traitor to his King, could not be faithful unto him: behold the recompense which this Tyrant made him for delivering up the City of Prom unto him, howsoever it justly belonged unto him for a punishment of his perfidiousness, that carried him to betray his King and his own Country into the power of his Enemies: After this they fell to dressing of the hurt men, which were in very great number. We p●st all this night with much apprehension, always keeping good watch, §. 2. and the next morning as soon as it was day, the first thing that we did was to rid away the dead bodies, which were in so great number all over the Camp, that the ground was quite covered with them; After this we took a view of those that were killed, as well on the one, as the other party, and we found that on the Bramaas side there were an hundred and fourscore thousand, and on the Prince of Avaas forty and two thousand, wherein were comprised the thirty thousand Mons. That done, after the Tyrant had fortified the City of Prom, as also the Fort of Meleytay, and made two other Forts upon the bank of the River, in such places as he judged to be most important for the safety of that Kingdom, he went up the River of Queitor in a thousand rowing Ser●os, wherein were embarked seventy thousand men. In this Voyage his intention was to go in his own person, for to observe the Kingdom of Avaa, and to see the City himself, the better to consider the strength of it, and thereby judge what Forces he should bring for to take it; So he proceeded still on for the space of eight and twenty days, and during that time passed by many goodly places, which within the Kingdom of Chaleu and jacuçalaon were upon the bank of the River: At length he arrived at the City of Avaa the thirteenth of October the same year, a thousand five hundred forty and five; Being come to the Port, he remained there thirteen days, and that while burned between two and three thousand Vessels that he found there; Moreover he set fire on many Villages thereabout, which cost him not so little but that he lost in all these degasts eight thousand of his men, amongst the which were threescore and two Portugals. Now whereas this City was very strong, as well in regard of the situation of it, as of the Fortifications which were newly made there, it had besides within it twenty thousand Mons, who it was said were come thither some five days before from the Mountains of Pondal●u, where the King of Avaa, by the permission of the Siamon, Emperor of that Monarchy, was levying above fourscore thousand men for to go and regain the City of Prom: for as soon as that King had received certain news of the death of his daughter and son-in-law, perceiving that he was not strong enough of himself to revenge the wrongs this Tyrant had done him, or to secure himself from those which he feared to receive of him in time to come, namely the depriving him of his Kingdom, as he was threatened, he went in person with his wife and children and cast himself at the Siamons' feet, and acquainting him with the great affronts he had received, and what his desire was, he made himself his Tributary at threescore thousand Bisses by the year, which amount to an hundred thousand Ducats of our money, and a gueta of Rubies, being a measure like to our pint, therewith to make a jewel for his wife, of which Tribute it was said, that he advanced the payment for ten years beforehand, besides many other precious stones, and very rich Plate, which he presented him with, estimated in all at two millions, in recompense whereof the Siamon obliged himself to take him into his protection, yea and to march into the field for him as often as need should require, and to re-establish him within a year in the Kingdom of Prom, so as for that effect he granted him those thirty thousand men of succour, which the Bramaa defeated at Meleytay, as also the twenty thousand that were then in the City, and the fourscore thousand which were to come to him, over whom the said King of Avaa was to be the General. The Tyrant having intelligence thereof, and apprehending that this, above all other things he could fear, might be the cause of his ruin, he gave present order for the fortifying of Prom with much more care and diligence then formerly: howbeit before his departure from this River where he lay at anchor, being about some league from the City of Avaa, he sent his Treasurer, named Dioçory (with whom we eight Portugals, as I have related before, remained prisoners) Ambassador to the Calaminhan, a Prince of mighty power, who is seated in the midst of this region in a great and spacious extent of Country, and of whom I shall say something when I come to speak of him. The subject of this Embassage was to make him his Brother in Arms by a League and Contract of new amity, offering for that effect to give him a certain quantity of Gold and precious stones, as also to render unto him certain Frontier Lands of his Kingdom, upon condition that the Spring following he should keep the Siamon in war for to divert him from succouring the King of Avaa, and thereby give him means the more easily to take his City from him, without fear of that assistance which that King hoped should serve for an obstacle to his design. This Ambassador departed then after he had embarked himself in a Laulea, that was attended on by twelve Seroos, wherein there were three hundred men of service, and his guard, besides the Watermen and Mariners, whose number was little less. The Presents which he carried to the Calaminhan were very great, and consisted in divers rich pieces, as well of Gold as of precious stones, but above all in the Harness of an Elephant, which according to reports was worth above six hundred thousand Ducats, and it was thought that all the Presents put together amounted to a Million of Gold. At his departure, amongst other favours, which the King his Master conferred on him, this same was not the least for us, that he gave us eight unto him for to be his perpetual slaves; Having clothed us then very well, and furnished us abundantly with all things necessary, he seemed to be exceedingly contented with having us along with him in this Voyage, and ever after he made more account of us, then of all the rest that followed him. CHAP. LV. Our going with the King of B●am●a's Ambassador to the Calaminham, with the Course which we held until we arrived at the Temple or Pagod of Timagoogoo, and a Description thereof. IT seems fit unto me, §. 1▪ and conformable to that which I am rela●ing▪ to leave for a while this Tyrant of Bramaa, to whom I will return again when time shall serve, for to entreat here of the way we held for to go into Timplan, the capital City of the Empire of the Calaminham, which signifies, Lord of the world▪ for in their language Cala is Lord, and Minhan the world; This Prince also entitles himself, The absolute Lord of the indomptable force of the Elephants of the Earth; And indeed I do not think that in all the world there is a greater Lord than he, as I shall declare hereafter. This Ambassador then departing from Avaa in the month of October, a thousand, five hundred, forty and five, took his course up the r●ver of Queitor, steering West, Southeast, and in many places Eastward by reason of the winding of the water, and so in this diversity of rhombus we continued our voyage seven days together, at the end whereof we arrived at a Channel, called Guampanoo, through which the Rhobamo, who was our Pilot, took his course, that he might decline the Siamons' Country, being so commanded to do by the express Order of the King: A while after we came to a great Town, named Gataldy, where the Ambassador stayed three days to make provision of certain things necessary for his voyage. Having left this place we w●nt on still, rowing up through his Channel eleven days longer, during which time we met not with any place that was remarkable, only we saw some small villages, the houses whereof were covered with thatch, and peopled with very poor folks, and yet for all that the fields are full of cattle, which seemed to have no Master, for we killed twenty and thirty of them in a day in the sight of those of the Country, no man so much as finding fault with it, but contrarily they brought them in courtesy to us, as if they were glad to see us kill them in that sort. At our going out of this Channel of Guampanoo we entered into a very great river, called Angegumaa, that was above three Leagues broad, and in some places six and twenty fathom deep, with such impetuous currents as they drove us oftentimes from our course; This river we coasted above seven days together, and at length arrived at a pretty little walled Town, named Gumbim, in the Kingdom of jangromaa, environed on the Lands side for five or six ●●agues space with Forests of B●njamin, as al●o with Plains of Lacre, wherewith they ordinarily traded to Mar●aban●, and do also lad there many vessels with those commodities for to transport them into d●vers Countries of the Indias, as to the Straight of Mecqua, to Alcoçer, a●d judaa. There is also in this Town great store of Musk, far better than that of China, which from thence is carried to Mart●bano and Pegu, where those of our Nation buy of it therewith to traffic at Nar●ingua, Orixaa, and Masulepatan. The women of this Country are all very white and well-favoured; They apparel themselves with Stuffs made of Silk and Cotten-wool, wear links of gold and silver about their legs, and rich Carcanets about their necks; The ground there is of ●t self exceeding fertile in Wheat, Rice, Millets, Sugar, Wax, and cattle: This Town with ten leagues of circuit about it, yields every year to the King of jangomaa threescore Altars of gold, which are seven hundred thousand Ducats of our money. From thence we coasted the river Southward, for the space of above seven days, and arrived at a great Town named Catamm●●, which in our language signifies, the golden Crevice, being the Patrimony of Raud●av●a Tinhau, the Calaminhams second Son. The Naugator of this Town gave good entertainment to the Ambassador, and sent him many sorts of refreshments for his followers; withal he gave him to understand that the Calaminham was at the City of T●mplan. We d●parted from this place on a Sunday morning, and the day after about evening we came to a Fortress, called Campalagor, built in the midst of the river in the form of an Island upon a rock, and environed with good freestone, having three Bulwarks and two Towers seven stories high▪ wherein, they told the Ambassador, was one of the four and twenty Treasures, which the Calaminham had in this Kingdom, the most part whereof con●●sted ●n L●ng●ts of silver, of the weight of six thousand Caudins, which are four and twenty thousand Quintals, and it was said, that all this silver was buried in wells under ground. After this we still continued our course for the space of thirteen days, during the which we saw on both sides of the river many very goodly places, whereof the most were fair Towns, and the rest stately high Trees, delicate Gardens, and great Plains full of Corn, as also much cattle, red Deer, Shamoises, and Rhinocerots, under the keeping of certain men on horseback who looked to them whilst they ●ed. On the river there were a great number of vessels, where in much abundance was all things to be sold which the earth produceth, wherewith it hath pleased God to enrich these Countries more than any other in the world. Now forasmuch as the Ambassador fell sick here of an Impostume in his stomach, he was counselled to proceed no further till he was healed, so that he resolved to go with some of his Train for to be cured to a famous Hospital, some twelve Leagues from thence, in a Pagode, named Tinagoogoo, which signifies the God of thousand Gods, and so departing at the same instant he arrived there on Saturday about night. §. 2. The Ambassador being set on shore was the next day led to an Hospital, called Chipanocan, whither the greatest Lords used to repair when they were sick, and where there were two and forty several Lodgings very neat and convenient, in one of the which he was placed by the express command of the Puitaleu, who was as it were Governor of the Hospital: There care was taken that he wanted for nothing, but was furnished in abundance with all that was necessary for him: I will omit the odours, the neatness, the care of attendance, the vessels, the robes, the exquisite meats, the delicacies, and all the delights that may be imagined, which were to be had there with as much perfection and curiosity, as more cannot be desired. Thither likewise came twice a day to him exceeding fair women, who sung to the Tune of Instruments of Music, and at certain hours represented Plays, or Comedies before him, that were very pleasant, and finely set forth. Now that I may not trouble myself in recounting here at length the infinite number of things, which I could speak of concerning this Subject, I will pass over many of them in silence, whereof, other persons that could better express them then myself, would peradventure make great esteem. After we had been eight and twenty days there, by which time the Ambassador was perfectly cured, we departed from thence for to go to a Town, named Meidur, twelve leagues further up the river of Angeguma; But that I may not be blamed for failing in the promise which I made heretofore of speaking of this Pagods of Tinagoogoo, I will here leave the Ambassador to his Voyage, and return me to the Pagode, that of so many things which we saw there I may deliver some one, for to show how little we Christians do to save our souls, in comparison of that much these wretches do to lose theirs. During the eight and twenty days which the Ambassador employed in recovering his health, we nine Portugals that waited on him not knowing what to do, or how to bestow our time in the mean while, no more than the rest, we passed it away in divers things, according to each one's fancy and delight, for to that purpose we wanted no commodities. Thus some applied themselves to the hunting of Stags and Wild-boars, whereof there is great store in that Country; Some to the pursuing of Tigers, Rhinocerots, Ounces, Zeores, Lions, Buffles, Wild-bulls, and of many other such kind of beasts which we have not heard spoken of in our Europe; some to shooting at Wild-ducks, Geese, and such like Waterfowl; some to hawking with Vultures and Falcons; and some to fishing for Trout, Mackarels, Chevins, Mullets, Soles, and many other sorts of fish, whereof there is great abundance in all the rivers of this Empire. In this manner we bestowed our time, now in one thing, and then in another, but that which we gave ourselves most unto was to hear, and see, as also to inquire after the Laws of the Country, the Pagodes, and Sacrifices which we beheld there with much terror and astonishment: Howbeit I purpose not to make any relation here more than of a few of them, which I conceive may suffice to draw out the consequences of those that I shall not discourse of. I say then that one of those sacrifices was made on the day of the new Moon of December, namely on the ninth of that Month, which is a time wherein these blinded people are accustomed to celebrate a Feast, called by those of the Country Massunterivoo; by those of jappon, Ferioo; by the Chi●eses Man●ioo; by the Lequios Champas, and Cauchins, Ampatilor; by the Siamen, Bramaas, P●fuas, and Sacotays, Sansaporau; so that though all these names through the diversity of those languages are different, yet do they in our tongue signify all one thing, that is, The memorial of all the dead. This was then the Feast which we saw celebrated here with so much diversity of things that we never dreamt of, as I know not where to begin; for such a multitude of people of all the Nations of these Countries came flocking to this place, as is not to be expressed, howbeit the chiefest cause of their repair thither in such numbers, is a Fair, which is kept all the time of the Feast, being fifteen days, namely from the new to the full Moon. In this Fair are all things to be sold, which Nature hath created on the earth, or in the Se●▪ and that in so high a degree of abundance, as there is not any one kind of thing, whereof there are not whole Streets of Houses, Cabins, or Tents, so long that one can hardly see from one end to the other. All these streets are replenished with very rich Merchants, besides an infinite company of other people, who are lodged all along the River, which is above two Leagues broad, and planted about with several sorts of Trees, as Walnuts, Chestnuts, Cocos, and Dates, whereof every one takes what he pleaseth, because it doth all belong to the Pagode. The Temple of this Idol is a very sumptuous Edifice, situated in the midst of a Plain upon a little round hill, more than half a league in circuit: It is built all slope fifteen fathom high, and from thence upward it hath a wall of freestone of some three fathom, with its Bulwarks, and Towers, after the fashion of ours. Within the enclosure of this wall there is a platform made level with Battlements, a stones cast in breadth, which together with the wall extends round about the hill, so that at first sight one would take it for a Gallery. There are likewise all along an hundred and threescore Hospitals, in each whereof are above an hundred houses, which are low, but very neat and convenient, where the Pilgrims, Fucatous, and Daroezes are entertained, which come thither in troops, like the Gipsies in our Europe, with their Captains, each company of them having two or three thousand persons, some more, some less, according as the Kingdoms from whence they resort are nearer or further off; now it is known of what Country they are by the devices which they carry in their Banners. From the top to the bottom it is all environed with Cypress-trees, and Cedars, where many fountains of most excellent water do continually flow forth, and on the highest part of this hill, almost a quarter of a league in circuit, there are four Convents, and in them very sumptuous and rich Temples, namely two of men, and as many of women, in each of which, as we were assured, were very near five hundred persons. In the midst of these four Monasteries there is a Garden, compassed about with three enclosures of Balisters of Latin, having very fair Arches, of curious Masons-work▪ and Steeples guilt all over, with a number of little silver bells in them, which ●ing continually with the moving of the air. This Chapel of the Idol Tinagoogoo is of a round form, all overlaid on the inside with plates of silver wrought in flowers, and garnished with a great many Branches for lights of the same metal. This Monster, of whom we could not judge, whether he were gold, wood, or copper guilt, stood upright on his feet, with his hands lifted up to Heaven, and a rich Crown on his head; round about him were many other little Idols on their knees, and beholding him as it were amazed: Below were two men made of brass, in the fashion of Giants, seven and thirty spans high, and very ugly and deformed, whom they held for the Gods of the twelve months of the year. Without this place also there were an hundred and forty Giants, who ranked in two Files enclosed it round about, and were made of cast iron, holding Halberds in their hands, as if they had been the Guard of it; so that all the Marvels of this Edifice put together made it appear so stately, that looking upon it one could not sufficiently esteem the riches ●nd sumptuousness thereof. But setting aside for this present the relation I could make of the buildings of this Pagode, because that which I have said of it may, me thinks, suffice for the understanding of the rest, I will entreat here of the Sacrifices which we saw to be made there on a festival day, called by them, Xipatil●●, signifying, The refreshing of good people. CHAP. LVI. The great and sumptuous Procession made in this Pagode, together with their Sacrifices; and other particularities. §. 1. Whilst this Feast of these Gentiles, as also the Fair, which was kept all the time thereof, endured for the space of fifteen days, with an infinite concourse of Merchants and Pilgrims, that came flocking thither from all parts, as I have declared before, there were many Sacrifices made there with different ceremonies, not a day passing without some new thing or other. For amongst many of great charge, and very worthy of observation, one of the chiefest was a jubilee after their manner, which was published the fifth day of the Moon, together with a Procession, that was above three leagues in length, as we could guests; It was the common opinion of all, that in this Procession there were forty thousand Priests of the four and twenty Sects, which are in this Empire, most of them were of different dignities, and called Grepos, Talagrepos, Roolims, Neepois, Bicos, Sacareus, and Chanfarauhos; Now by the ornaments they wear, as also by the devices and ensigns which they carry in their hands, they may be distinguished, and so every of them is respected according to his dignity; Howbeit these went not on foot as the other ordinary Priests, for that they were as this day forbidden upon pain of great sin to ●read upon the ground, so that they caused themselves to be born in Pallaquins, or Arm-chairs, upon the shoulders of other Priests their inferiors, apparelled in green Satin, with their Stoles of Carnation Damask. In the midst of the ranks of this Procession were all the inventions of their Sacrifices to be seen, as also the rich Custodes of their Idols, for the which each of them had a particular Devotion; They that carried them were clothed in yellow, having each of them a big wax candle in his hand, and between every fifteen of those Custodes went a triumphant Chariot, all which Charets put together were in number an hundred twenty and six: All these Charets were four, and some five stories high, with as many wheels on either side; In each of them there were at the least two hundred persons, what with the Priests and the Guards, and on the top of all an Idol of Silver, with a Mitre of Gold on its head, and all of them had rich chains of Pearl and precious stones about their necks; round about every Chariot went little Boys, carrying Silver Maces on their shoulders, and behind them were a many of Caskets full of exquisite perfumes, as also divers persons with Censors in their hands, who ever and anon censed the Idol to the tune of certain Instruments of Music, saying three times with a lamentable voice, Lord, assuage the pains of the dead, to the end they may praise thee peaceably; whereunto all the people answered with a strange noise, Such may thy pleasure be, and so may it come to pass every day wherein thou showest us the Sun. Each of these Charets was drawn by above three thousand persons, who for that purpose made use of very long coards, covered with silk, and thereby gained to themselves plenary remission of their sins, without restitution to be made of any thing at all: Now that many might participate of this absolution by drawing the cord, they set their hands to it one after and close to another, continuing doing so to the very end, in such sort that the whole cord was covered with hands, and nothing else to be seen; but that they also which were without might gain this indulgence, they helped those that had their hands on the cord by putting theirs about their shoulders, than they that were behind them did the like, and so consequently all the rest: In this manner throughout the whole length of the cord there were six or seven Ranks or Files, and in each of them above five hundred persons. This Procession was environed with a great number of Horsemen, that carried staves with pikes at both ends, who riding all about, went crying to the people, which were infinite in number, that they should make way, and not interrupt the Priests in their prayers: Many times also they struck those so rudely whom they first met withal, as they brat down three or four together, or hurt them grievously, no man daring to find fault with, or so much as speak a word against it. In this order this mervelous Procession passed through above an hundred streets, which to that end were all adorned with boughs of Palms and Myrtle, amongst the which were many Standarts and Banners of Silk planted; There were also many Tables set up in divers places, where all that desired it for God's sake were admitted to eat of free cost, yea and in other parts they had clothes and money given them; There likewise Enemies reconciled themselves one to another, and the rich men forgave them their debts which were not able to pay. In a word, so many good works were done there, more proper for Cristians, then for Gentiles, as I must needs conclude, that if they had been done with Faith and Baptism for the love of our Lord Jesus Christ, and without any mixture of the things of this world, assuredly they would have been acceptable to him. But 〈◊〉 the best was wanting to them, and that both for theirs and our sins. Whilst this Procession, together with the Charets wherein the Idols were, passed along in this manner, and that with a dreadful noise of Drums, and other such instruments, behold where out of certain wooden Sheds made expressly for that purpose, six, seven, eight, or ten men, all besmeared with odours, and wrapped up in silk, wearing Gold Bracelets about their wrists, start forth all at once, and room being instantly made them by the people, after they had saluted the Idol which was on the top of the Chariot, they went and laid themselves down athwart on the ground, so that the wheels coming to go over them crushed them all to pieces, which the assistants beholding, cried out aloud together, My Soul be with thine: Presently whereupon nine or ten of the Priests descending from the Chariot took up these blessed, or rather accursed, creatures, that sacrificed themselves in this sort, and putting the head, bowels, and all the other members so crushed in pieces into great bowls made for that purpose, they showed them to the people from the highest part of the Chariot where the Idol stood, saying with a pitiful voice, Miserable sinners, fall ye to praying, that God may make you worthy to be a Saint, as this here is, who hath now offered himself up as a sweet smelling Sacrifice. Whereunto all the people prostrated on the ground answered with a fearful noise, We hope that the God of a thousand Gods will permit to be so. In this manner many other of these wretches sacrificed themselves, to the number, as we were told by certain Merchants worthy of credit, of six hundred and more. After these followed other Martyrs of the Devil, whom they called Xixaporaus, which sacrificed themselves before the said Charets, by most mercilessly sl●shing themselves with sharp Razors, that to behold them how they did it, one could not think but that they were altogether insensible; for they cut off great gobbets of their flesh, and holding them on high at the end of Arrows, as if they would shoot them up to Heaven, they said, That they made a Present thereof to God for the Souls of their Fathers, of their Wives, of their Children, or of such a one, for whose sake they did this wicked work. Now wheresoever this gobbet of flesh chanced to fall, there ran so much people to catch it up, as oftentimes many were stifled in the press, for they held it as a very great relic. In this sort these miserable wretches stood upon their feet, all bathed in their own blood, without Noses, without Ears, and without any resemblance at all of man, until at length they fell down stark dead on the Earth, than came the Grepos in all haste down from the top of the Chariot, and cutting off their heads, showed them to all the people, who kneeling on the ground, and lifting up their hands to Heaven cried out with a loud voice, Let us, O Lord, live to that time, wherein for thy service we may do as this same here hath done. There were others also whom the Devil drew thither after another manner; Those same craving an Alms, said, Give me an Alms for God's sake, or if thou dost it not, I will kill myself. So that if they were not presently contented, they would instantly cut their own throats with Razors which they held in their hands, or stab themselves in to the belly, and so drop down stark dead; whereupon the Grepos ran suddenly to them, and having cut off their heads, showed them, as before, to the people, who reverenced them prostrated on the ground. We likewise saw some, named Nucaramons', men of a very ill look, clothed with Tiger's skins, and carrying in their hands certain pots of Copper full of excrements, and filthy corrupted urine, the stench whereof was so horrible and insupportable, as it was not possible for any nostril to endure it; These craving an Alms of the people, said; Give me an Alms, and that instantly, otherwise I will ●at this ordure which the Devil eats, and bespatter thee with it, that so thou mayst be accursed as he is. They no sooner uttered these words, but that all ran hastily to give them an Alms, for if they stayed never so little, they straightway set the pot to their mouths, and taking a great sup of that stinking stuff, they there with all to bedashed such as they pleased; in the mean time all others that beheld them so dressed, holding them accursed, fell upon them, and entreated them in such a strange fashion, as the poor wretches knew not which way to turn themselves, for there was not a man of the company that drove them not away with blows, and that railed not at them, saying; That they were accursed for having been the cause that this holy man had eaten of that beastly filth which the Devil feeds upon, and therefore was become stinking before God, so that he could neither go into Paradise, nor live amongst men. Behold how strange the blindness of this people is, who otherwise have judgement and wit enough. I will pass by much other beastliness committed by them, which is so far esloigned from all reason, as they serve for a great motive unto us, to render thanks without ceasing unto God for the infinite mercy and goodness that he shows us, in giving us the light of true Faith for the saving of our Souls. §. 2. Of the fifteen days that this Feast was to last, nine being past, all the people, which were there assembled, feigning that the gluttonous Serpent of the House of Smoke (who is their Lucifer, as I have said elsewhere) was come for to steal away the ashes of them that were dead in these several Sacrifices, and so to keep their Souls from going into Heaven, there arose among them so great and dreadful a noise, as words are not able to express it; for to the confused voices that were heard from every part, there was adjoined such a ringing of Bells and Basins, beating of Drums, and winding of Horns, as it was not possible to hear one another, and all this was done to fright away the Devil. Now this noise endured from one of the clock in the afternoon till the next morning, and it is not to be believed what a world of lights and Torches were spent that night, besides the infinite number of fires that were kindled every where; the reason hereof was, as they said, For that Tinagoogoo, the God of thousand Gods, was gone in quest of the gluttonous Serpent, for to kill him with a Sword which had been given him from Heaven. After the night had been past thus amidst this infernal noise and tumult, as soon as it was day the whole Hill, whereon the Temple was built, appeared full of white Banners, which the people beholding, they fell strait to giving thanks unto God, and to that end they prostrated themselves on the ground with great demonstrations of joy, and then began to send presents one to another for the good news they received from the Priests by the show of those white Banners, an assured sign that the gluttonous Serpent was killed. So all the people, transported with incredible gladness, fell to going up the hill, whereon the Temple stood, by four and twenty several accesses that there were unto it, for to give thanks unto the Idol, and chant his praises for the victory he had the night passed obtained over the gluttonous Serpent, and cutting off his head: This throng of people continued three days, and three nights, so that during that time it was not possible to break through the press on the way, but with much pain. Now we Portugal's having little to do, resolved to go thither also for to see those abuses, wherefore we went to ask leave of the Ambassador, but he denied us for the present, willing us to stay till the next day, and that then we should wait on him thither, for in his last sickness he had vowed to visit it; hereat we were very glad, because we thought that by this means we should the more easily see all that we desired: The morrow after, which was the third day of this Assembly, the greatest crowd being over, we went along with him to the Temple of Tinagoogoo, and at length arrived, though with much ado, at the Hill whereon it was built. There we saw six very fair long streets, all full of Scales hanging on great Rods of Brass; In these Scales a number of people weighed themselves, as well for the accomplishment of the vows they had made in their adversities and sickness, as for the remission of all the sins they had committed till that present, and the weight which each of them laid in the other Scale was answerable to the quality of the fault they had done: So they that found themselves culpable of gluttony, and had not all that year used any abstinence, weighed themselves with Honey, Sugar, Eggs, and Butter, which were things not displeasing to the Priests, from whom they were to receive absolution; They that were addicted to sensuality weighed themselves with Cotton wool, Feathers, Cloth, Apparel, Wine, and sweet Odours, because, say they, those things incite a man to that sin: They that were uncharitable to the poor weighed themselves with Coin of Copper, Tin, and Silver, or with pieces of Gold; The slothful with Wood, Rice, Coals, Pork, and Fruit; and the envious, because they reap no benefit by their maligning the prosperity of others, expiated their sin by confessing it publicly, and suffering a dozen boxes on the ear to be given them in the memory and praise of the twelve Moons of the year: As for the sin of pride, it was satisfied with dried fish, Brooms, and Cowdung, as being the basest of things; And touching them that had spoken ill of their Neighbours, without ask them forgiveness, they put for that a Cow into the Scale, or else an Hog, a Sheep, or a Stag: so that infinite was the number of those which weighed themselves in the Scales that were in those six streets, from whom the Priests received so much Alms, as there were great piles of all sorts of things made up all along. Now for the poor that had nothing to give for the remission of their sins, they offered their own hair, which was presently cut off by above an hundred Priests, who for that effect sat in order one by another on low stools, with Scissors in their hands; There also we saw great heaps of that hair, whereof other Grepos, which were a thousand at least, and ranked also in order, made Wreaths, Tresses, Rings, and Bracelets, which one or another bought for to carry home to their houses, even as our Pilgrims use to do, that come from Santiago de Compostella, or other such places. Our Ambassador, being amazed at the sight of these things, enquired further of the Priests concerning them, who besides other particulars told him, that all those alms, and other offerings which were given there during the fifteen days of this Assembly, amounted to a great Revenue, and that even of the hair of the poor alone there was raised every year above an hundred thousand pardanis of Gold, which are fourscore and ten thousand Ducats of our Money, whereby one may judge what a world of wealth was made of all the rest. After that the Ambassador had stayed sometime in the streets of the Scales, he passed on through all the other quarters, where were Comedies, dancing, wrestling, and excellent consorts of all kinds of music, till at length we arrived at Tinagoogoo, but with much labour and pain, because the throng was so great, as one could hardly break through it. This Temple had but one ●sle, that was very long and spacious, and full of great wax lights, each of them having ten or eleven week in it, set up all about in Silver Candlesticks; there was also great store of perfumes of Aloes and Benjamin: As for the Image of Tinagoogoo, it was placed in the midst of the Temple upon a stately Tribunal in the form of an Altar, environed with a number of Silver Candlesticks, and a many of Children attired in purple, which did nothing but cense it at the sound of Instruments of music, whereon the Priests played reasonable well: Before this Idol danced, to the tune of the said Instrument, 〈◊〉 in Ladies, which were wonderful fair, and richly clad, to whom the people presented their alms and offerings, which the Priests received for them, and th●n laid them before the Tribunal of the Idol with a great deal of ceremony and compliment, ever and anon prostrating themselves on the ground. The Status of this Monster was seven and twenty spans high, having the face of a Giant, the hair of a Negro, wide distorted nostrils, mighty great lips, and a very sour and ill-favoured countenance; He had in his hand an Hatchet in the form of a Cooper's Addis, but with a far longer handle: With this Addis, as the Priests made the people believe, this Monster the night before killed the gluttonous Serpent of the House of Smoke, for that he would have stolen away the ashes of those that sacrificed themselves. There also we saw the Serpent amidst the place before the Tribunal in the form of an Adder, more horrible to behold then the wit of man can imagine, and done so to the life, as all that looked on it trembled for fear; It was laid all along, with the head cut off, being eight fathom long, and the neck of it as thick as a Bushel, so lively represented, that though we knew it to be an artificial thing, yet could we not choose but be afraid of it. In the mean time all the assistants ran thronging about it, some pricking it with the points of their Halberds, and some with their Daggers, every one with railing speeches cursing, and calling it, Proud, presumptuous, accursed, infernal Manor, Pool of Damnation, envious of God's goodness, hungerstarved Dragon, in the midst of the night, and many other names, which they delivered in such extraordinary terms, and so fitted to the effects of this Serpent, as we could not but admire them. That done, they put into Basins which stood at the foot of the Idols Tribunal a world of alms, of Gold, Silver, Jewels, pieces of Silk, fine Calicoes, Money, and hundred other things in very great abundance. After we had seen all these things, we continued following the Ambassador, who went to see the Grots of the Hermits or Penitents, which were at the utmost end of the Wood, all cut out of the hard Rock, and in such order, as one would have thought that Nature, rather than the hand of man, had laboured in it. There were an hundred forty and two of them, in some of the which remained divers men, whom they held for Saints, and that did very great and austere penance; They in the first Grots wore long Robes like the Bonzes of japan, and followed the Law of an Idol, that had sometimes been a man, called Situmpor michay, who during his life enjoined those of his Sect to lead their lives in great austerity, assuring them that the only and true way to gain Heaven, was to subdue the flesh, and that the more they laboured to afflict themselves, the more liberally God would grant them all they could demand of him. They which accompanied us thither, told us, that they seldom eat any thing bu● herbs boiled a few Beans of Aricot roasted, and wild fruit, which were provided for them by other Priests, who as the Purveyors of a Cloister took care to furnish these Peniten●s with such things as were confortmable to the Law whereof they made profession. After these we saw in a Grot others of a Sect of one of their Saints, or rather of a Devil, named Ang●macur, these lived in deep holes, made in the midst of the Rock, according to the Rule of their wretched order, eating nothing but Flies, Ants, Scorpions, and Spiders, with the juice of a certain Herb growing in abundance thereabout, much like to sorrel; These spent their time in meditating day and night, with their eyes lifted up to Heaven▪ and their hands closed one within another, for a testimony that they desired nothing of this world, and in that manner died like beasts, but they are accounted greater Saints than all the rest, and as such, after they are dead, they burn them in fires, whereinto they cast great quantities of most precious perfumes; the Funeral pomp being celebrated with great state, and very rich offerings, they have sumptuous Temples erected unto them, thereby to draw the living to do as they had done, for to obtain this vain glory, which is all the recompense that the world gives them for their excessive penance. We likewise saw others of a Sect altogether diabolical, invented by a certain Gileu Mitray; These have sundry orders of penance, and are not much different in their Opinions from the Abissins' of Ethiopia; Now that their abstinence may be the more agreeable to their Idol, some of them eat nothing but filthy thick ●pitings and snot, with Grasshoppers and Hens dung; others clots of blood drawn from other men, with bitter fruits and herbs brought to them from the wood, by reason whereof they live but a short time, and have so bad a look and colour, as they fright those that behold them. I will pass by them of the Sect of Godomem, who spend their whole life in crying day and night on those mountains, Godomem, Godomem, and desist not from it until they fall down stark dead to the ground for want of breath: Neither will I speak of them which they call Taxilacons, who die more brutishly than the rest, for they shut themselves up in certain Grots made of purposefor it, that are very little and close, stopped on all 〈◊〉, and then burning green ●histles and thorns in them, they choke themselves with the smoke thereof; Whereby one may see how by such rude and different ways of living these miserable creatures render themselves the Devil's Martyrs, who in reward thereof gives them everlasting Hell-fire; and verily it is a pititiful thing to behold the great pains which these wretches take to lose themselves, and the little that we do to be saved. CHAP. LVII. What we saw in the continuing of our voyage, until we arrived at the City of Timplan. AFter we had seen all these things with wonder enough, §. 1. we departed from this Pagod of Tinagoogoo, and continued on our way for thirteen days together, at the end whereof we arrived at two great Towns, situated on the Bank of the river, just opposite the one against the other, about the distance of a stones cast, one of the which was called Manavedéa, and the other Singilapau; in the midst of this same river, which was there somewhat narrow, there was an Island by nature form round, and in it a rock six and thirty fathom high, and a Crossbow shoot broad; upon this rock was a Fort built, with nine Bulwarks and five Towers; without the rampire of the wall it was environed with two rows of great iron gates, and from the Bulwarks to the other side of the river ran a huge Chain of iron, to keep vessels from passing along, so that nothing could possibly enter there: At one of these two Towns, which was called Singilapau, the Ambassador landed, where he was exceedingly well entertained by the Xemimbrum, or Governor of it, who likewise furnished all his Train with great store of refreshments. The next morning we left this place, accompanied with twenty Laulês, wherein there were a thousand men and better, and about evening we arrived at the Custom-houses of the Kingdom, which are two strong places, and from the one to the other run five mighty great chains of Latin all atwart the whole breadth of the river, so that nothing can pass in and out without leave; Hither came a man in a swift Seroo to the Ambassador, and told him that he was to go ashore at Campalagro, which was one of the two Castles on the Southside, for to show the Letter which this King had sent by him to the Calaminham, to see if it were written in the form that was required in speaking to him, as was usually observed. The Ambassador presently obeyed, and being come to land he was led into a great Hall, where were three men 〈◊〉 a table, with a great many Gentlemen, who gave him good entertainment, and demanded of him the occasion of his coming thither, as they that knew nothing of it; Whereunto the Ambassador answered; That he came thither from the King of Bramaa, Lord of Tanguu, and that he had a message to deliver unto the holy Calaminham concerning matters greatly importing his Estate. Then having made further answer to other questions, which were put to him in a way of ceremony by the three principal persons that were at the Table, he showed them the letter, wherein they corrected some words, which were not of the style wherewith they were accustomed to speak to the Calaminham; together with this letter the Ambassador showed them the present which he had brought for him, whereat they very much wondered, especially when they saw the Chair for an Elephant of gold and precious stones, which in the judgements of divers Lapidaries was worth above six hundred thousand Ducats, besides the other rich pieces that he carried him also, as I have before related. After we had our dispatch from this first Custom-house, we went to the other, where we found more venerable men than the former, who with another new Ceremony looked likewise on the Letter, and the present, and put to all the several parcels of it strings of wreathed carnation silk, with three Seals in Lacre, which was as the conclusion of the receiving of the Embassy by the Calaminham. The same day there came a man from the next Town of Questor, sent by the Governor of the Kingdom to visit the Ambassador with a present of refreshments of flesh, fruit, and other such things after their manner. During nine days that the Ambassador stayed in this place he was abundantly furnished with all things necessary, both for his own Person, and his Train, and withal was entertained with sundry sports of hunting and fishing▪ as also with Feasts, accompaied with music and Comedies represented by very beautiful women, and richly attired: In the mean time we Portugal's went with the permission of the Ambassador to see certain things, which they of the Country had much commended un●o us▪ namely ve●y antique buildings, rich and sumptuous Temples, very fair Gardens, House's and Castles, that were all along the side of this river, made after a strange fashion, well ●ortified, and of great charge, amongst the which there was an Hospital for to lodge pilgrims in▪ called Manicafaran, signifying in our tongue, The Prison of the Gods, which was above a L●ague in breadth; Here we saw twelve streets, all vaulted over, and in every one of them two hundred and forty houses, namely, sixscore on each side, which made in all two thousand, eight hundred, and fourscore, all full of pilgrims, who the whole year throughout came thither in pilgrimage from divers Countries; for, as they hold, this pilgrimage ought to be of far greater merit than all others, because that these Idols imprisoned by strangers have need of company. All these pilgrims, which, as they of the Country say, are all the year long without discontinuing above six thousand, have meat given them the whole time of their abode there, at the charge, and out of the revenue of the house: They are served by four thousand Priests of Manicafaran, who with many others reside within the same enclosure in sixscore religious houses, where there are also as many women that serve in the like manner. The Temple of this Hospital was very great, with three Isles after the fashion of ours, in the midst whereof was a remarkable Chapel built round, and environed with three very big Balisters of Latin; within it there were fourscore Idols of men and women, besides many other little gods, that lay prostrated on the ground, for the fourscore great Idols only stood upright, and were all tied together with chains of iron; As for the little ones, they were, as I said, laid along on the pavement, as the children of these greater, and tied six to six by the middle with other slighter chains: Moreover without the Balisters in two Files there stood two hundred, forty and four Giants of brass, six and twenty spans high, with their Halberds and Clubs upon their shoulders, as if they had been set there for the Guard of the captive Gods. There was overhead upon iron rods, that traversed the Isles of the Temple, great store of Lamps hanging, having seven or eight Matches apiece in them, in the fashion of Candlesticks, like to them of the Indias, all varnished without, as also the walls were, and every thing else that we saw there, in token of mourning, by reason of the captivity of these Gods. Being amazed as well at that which I have recounted, as at many other things which I pass over in silence, and not able to comprehend what they meant by the imprisonment of these gods, we demanded the signification of it of the Priests, whereunto one amongst them, that seemed of more authority than the rest, made us this answer; Since I see that being Strangers, you desire to learn of me that which I know very well, and which you have never heard spoken, nor read of in your Books, I will declare the matter unto you as it passed, according as it is truly delivered by our Histories. Know then, that it now seven thousand, three hundred, and twenty Moons, which make six hundred and ten years after the supputation of other Nations, since the time that an holy Calaminham, named Xixivarem Melentay, commanding over the Monarchy of the six and twenty Kingdoms of this Crown, waged wars with the Siamon, Emperor of the Mountains of the Earth, insomuch that there assembled what on the one part and the other threescore and two Kings, who putting themselves into the Field, fought so cruel and bloody a battle, as it endured from an hour before day till night, and there was slain on both sides sixteen Laquesaas of men, each of which makes an hundred thousand; At length the victory remaining to our Calaminham, without any more resting alive of his Forces then two hundred and thirty thousand, he ru●ned in four months' space all the enemies Countries, with such a destruction of people, as if credit may be given to our Histories, or to what any other besides have assured, there died fifty Laquesaas of persons. This battle was fought in the first of the said seven thousand, three hundred, and twenty Moons, in the renowned Field Vitau, where Quiay Nivandel appeared to the Calaminham, sitting in a Chair of wood, who acquired unto himself in this place a greater and more famous Title of honour, than all the other Gods of the Mons and Siammes, in regard whereof so often as they that inhabit the earth desire to make oath of things which pass the belief of men, they use for the more authorising thereof to swear by the holy Quiay Nivandel God of Battles of the field Vitau. Now in a great City named Sarocatam, where five hundred thousand persons were slain, all these Gods, which here you see before you, were made prisoners in despite of the Kings that believed in them, and the Priests that served them with perfumes in their sacrifices. Thus by reason of so glorious a victory all those people became subject to us, and tributaries to the Crown of the Calaminham, who at this day holds the Sceptre of this Monarchy, whereunto he was not raised but with much labour, and the shedding of a world of blood, during the threescore and four rebellions made by the said people since that time until this present; who not able to endure the captivity of their gods, for that, to say the truth, it is a mighty affront unto them, they do still in memory of so unhappy a success continue making great demonstrations of sorrow for it, renewing every year the vow they have made not to celebrate any Feast, nor to rejoice in any kind of sort whatsoever, until they have provided for the deliverance of these prisoners; which also is the cause that no Lamps are seen in their Temples, and that they are resolved to light up none during the captivity of their Idols. Some of us seeming to doubt the verity hereof, because it seemed strange unto them, the Grepo swore that it was most true, and that also there had been killed at sundry times about the deliverance of these Gods, whom there we saw captive, above three millions of men, besides those that fell in precedent Battles; whereby one may clearly see in what a strange manner the Devil keeps these poor blinded wretches subjected unto him, and with how much abuse and extravagancy he precipitates them into hell. When we had well observed all the singularities of this Temple, we went to see another, called Vrpanesendoo, to speak of which I desire to be excused, that I may not be forced to treat of infamous and abominable matters, wherefore omitting the great abundance of riches, and other things which we saw there; it shall suffice me to say, that this Temple is served by none but women, who are all of them the daughters of Princes, and of the principal Lords of the Kingdom, which dedicates them from their infancy to offer up their honour in sacrifice there; Now this filthy and sensual sacrifice is performed with so great charge, that many of them bestow above ten thousand Ducats in it, besides the offerings which are made to this Idol Vrpanesendoo, to whom they sacrifice their honour. This Idol is in a Chapel that is round, and guilt all over; it is made of silver, and set upon a Tribunal in form of an Altar, environed overhead with a great number of Candlesticks, which are all of silver likewise, every light in them having six week: Round about this Tribunal are many other Idols guilded over, of very comely and well-favoured women, who with their knees on the ground, and hands lifted up, adore this Idol; These same, as the Priests told us, are the holy souls of certain young Ladies, which finished their days there to the great honour of their parents, who made more esteem of that then of all the King could give them. They assured us that the Revenue belonging to the Idol, was three hundred thousand Ducats by the year, besides the offerings and rich ornaments of their abominable sacrifices, which was yet worth more. In this Diabolical Temple were shut up within many religious houses that we saw above five thousand women, being all of them old, and for the most part exceeding rich, so that coming to die, they make a donation of all their wealth to the Pagode, wherefore it is no marvel, if it have the revenue I spoke of. From this place we went to see the companies of the strangers, which came thither in pilgrimage in the manner that I have declared. These Companies were forty and six in number, every one of an hundred, two hundred, three hundred, four hundred, or five hundred persons; nay, some of them were more, and were all lodged along by the river, as if it had been a Camp. Amidst these troops of strangers we met by chance with a Portugal woman, whereat we wondered more than at all we had seen before, so that desiring to know of her the reason of so strange an accident, she told us with tears, who she was, what occasion had brought her thither, and how she was at that instant the wife of one of those Pilgrims, to whom she had been married three or four and twenty years; whereunto she further added, that not daring to go and live amongst Christians because of her sin, she continued still in her wickedness, but that she hoped God would at length be pleased to bring her into some Country, where before she ended her days, she might repent her of her life past; and that although we found her in the company of people devoted to the service of the Devil, yet she left not for all that to be still a true Christian: we remained much amazed at so strange a relation, and not a little sorrowful also to see and understand to what a point of misfortune this poor woman was reduced, so that we told her our opinion, and what we thought was fit for her to do, whereupon she concluded to go along with us to Timplam, and so to Pegu, and from thence to set sail for Coromandel, there to finish her days in the Island of St Thomés. Having vowed unto us to do thus we quitted her, not doubting that she would lose so good an opportunity to retire herself out of the errors wherein she was, and to restore herself to an estate wherein she might be saved, since it had pleased God to permit her to meet with us in a Country so far distant from that which she could hope for: Howbeit she performed nothing, for we could never see nor hear of her afterwards, which made us to believe, that either some thing was befallen her that kept her from coming to us, or that through the obstinacy of her sins, she deserved not to make her profit of the grace which our Lord had offered to her out of his infinite goodness and mercy. CHAP. LVIII. The Magnificent Reception of the King of Bramaa his Ambassador, at the City of Timplam; and that which passed betwixt the Calaminham, and him. §. 1. NIne days after the King of Bramaa his Ambassador had reposed himself there by way of ceremony, according to the fashion of the Country, for the more honour of his Ambassage, one of the Governors of the City, called Quampanogrem, came to fetch him, accompanied with fourscore Seroos and Laulees, very well eqipped, and full of lusty able men: Throughout this Fleet they played on so many barbarous and ill accorded instruments, as Bel●, Cymbals, Drums, and Sea-corners, that the din thereof coming to join with the noise, which the Rowers made, terrified all those that heard it; and indeed one would have thought it at first to be some enchantment, or to say better, a music of hell, if there be any there. Amidst this stir we drew near to the City, where we arrived about noon; Being come to the first Key, that was named Campalarraia, we saw a great many men, both Horse and Foot, all richly accoutred, as also a number of fight Elephants, very well harnessed, having their chairs and forehead pieces garnished with silver, and their warlike Panores fastened to their teeth, which rendered them very terrible. The Ambassador was no sooner come on shore, but the Campanogrem took him by the hand, and falling on his knees, presented him to another great man that attended for him at the Key in great pomp; This same was called Patedacan, one of the chiefest of the Kingdom, as we were told; After he had with a new compliment of courtesy received the Ambassador, he offered him an Elephant furnished with a Chair and harness of gold, but whatsoever the Mandarin could do to make the Ambassador accept of it, he could by no means draw him thereunto, whereupon he caused another almost as well furnished to be brought, and gave it to him. As for us nine Portugals, and fifty or threescore Bramaas they provided Horses, on which we mounted: In this manner we departed from that place, having his Chariots before us full of men, that amidst the acclamations of the people played upon divers kinds of instruments; namely on silver Cymbals, Bells, and Drums; Thus we were conducted through many long Streets, whereof nine were environed with Balisters of Latin, and at the entrance into them, there were Arches very richly wrought, as also many Chapters of pillars guilt, and great Bells, which like unto clocks struck the hours, nay the quarters of the hour of the day, whereby the people were ordinarily directed. After that with much ado, by reason of the great press of people that was in the streets, we were come to the outward Court of the Calaminham's Palace, which was as long, or little less, as a Falcon's shot, and broad proportionable thereunto, we saw in it above six thousand Horses, all trapped with silver and silk, and those that were mounted on them were armed with Croslets of Latin and Copper, headpieces of silver, carrying Ensigns in their hands of divers Colours, and Targets at their Saddle-bow●. The Commander of th●se Troops was the Quietor of Justice, who is as the Superintendent over all the other Civil and Criminal Ministers, which is a Jurisdiction separate by itself, from whence there is no appeal. The Ambassador being come near unto him, who was also advanced to receive him, and the two Governors, they all prostrated themselves on the ground three times, which is amongst them a new kind of Compliment, whereupon the Queitor spoke not a word to the Ambassador, but only laid his hand on his head, and then gave him a rich Scymitar that he wore by his side, which the Ambassador accepted of very thankfully, and kissed it thrice; That done the Quieor set the Ambassador on his right hand, and leaving the two Mandarins a little behind, they passed along through two ranks of Elephants▪ which made a kind of Street of the length of the outward Court, they being fifteen hundred in number, all furnished with Castles, and rich Chairs of divers inventions, as also with a great many of silk Banners, and gorgeous Cover; round abou● were a great Company of Halberdiers, and many other shows of Greatness and Majesty, which made us believe that this Prince was one of the mightiest of the Country. When we were come to a great Gate, that stood between two high Towers, two hundred men which guarded it no sooner saw the Quietor, but they all fell down on their knees. Through this Gate, we entered into another very long outward Court, where the Kings second Guard was, composed of a thousand men, who were all in guilt Arms, their Swords by their sides, and on their heads Helmets wrought with gold and silver, wherein stuck gallant plums of several colours. After we had passed through the middle of all this Guard we arrived at a great Hall, where there was a Mandarim, Uncle to the King, called the Monvagaruu, a man of above seventy years of age, accompanied with a great number of Nobity, as also with many Captains and Officers of the Kingdom; About him were twelve little boys richly clad, with great Chains of gold three or four times double about their necks, and each of them a silver Mace upon his shoulder: As soon as the Ambassador was come near him, he touched him on the head with a Ventiloo that he held in his hand, and beholding him, May thy entrance, said he, into this Palace of the Lord of the world, be as agreeable to his eyes, as the rain is to our fields of Rice, for so shall he grant thee all that thy King demands of him. From thence we went up an high pair of stairs, and entered into a very long room, wherein there were many great Lords, who seeing the Monvagaruu stood up on their feet, as acknowledging him for their Superior; Out of this room we entered into another, where there were four Altars, very well accommodated with Idols of silver; upon one of these Altars we saw the Statue of a woman as big as a Giant, being eighteen spans high, and with her arms all abroad looking up to Heaven: This Idol was of silver, and her hair of gold, which was very long, and spread over her shoulders; There also we saw a great Throne, encompassed round about with thirty Giants of brass, who had guilded Clubs upon their shoulders, and faces as deformed as those they paint for the Devil. From this room we passed into a manner of a Gallery, adorned from the top to the bottom with a number of little Tables of Ebony, inlaid with Ivory, and full of men's heads, under every one of the which the name of him to whom it belonged was written in letters of gold; At the end of this Gallery there were a dozen of iron Rods guilt, whereon hung a great many silver Candlesticks of great value, and a number of persuming Pans, from whence breathed forth a most excellent odour of Amber, and Calambuco, or Lignum Aloes, but such as we have none in Christendom. There on an Altar environed all about with three rows of Balisters of silver, we saw thirteen Kings vissages of the same metal, with golden Mitars upon their heads, and under each of them a dead man's head, and below many Candlesticks of silver, with great white wax lights in them, which were stuffed ever and anon by little boys, who accorded their voices to those of the Grepos that sung in form of a Litany, answering one another. The Grepos told us that those thirteen dead men's heads which were under the vissages were the skulls of thirteen Calaminhams, which in times past gained this Empire from certain strangers, called Roparons, who by Arms had usurped the same upon them of the Country: As for the other dead men's heads which we saw there, they were the sk●ls of such Commanders, as by their Heroic deeds had honourably ended their days in helping to recover this Empire, in regard whereof it was most reasonable, that though death had deprived them of the recompense which they had merited by their action, yet their memory should not be abolished out of the world. When we were gone out of this Gallery, we proceeded on upon a great Bridg, that was in the form of a Street, railed on either side with Balisters of Latin, and beautified with a many of Arches curiously wrought, upon which were Scutcheons of Arms, charged with several devices in gold, and the Cr●●ts over them were silver Globes, five spans in circumferences, all very stately and majestical to behold. At the end of this bridge was another building, the doors whereof we found shut, whereupon we knocked four times, they within not deigning to answer us, which is a ceremony observed by them in such occasions; At the length after we had rung a bell four times more as it were in haste, out comes a woman of about fifty years of age, accompanied with six little girls, richly attired, and Scymitars upon their shoulders garnished with ●lowers wrought in gold: This ancient woman having demanded of the Monvagaruu why he had rung the bell, and what he would have, he answered her with a great deal of respect, That he had there an Ambassador from the King of Bramaa, the Lord of Tanguu, who was come thither to treat at the feet of the Calaminham about certain matters much importing his service. By reason of the great authority which this woman was in she seemed little to regard this answer, whereat we wondered much, because he that spoke to her was one of the chiefest Lords of the Kingdom, and Uncle to the Calaminham, as it was said; Nevertheless one of the six girls that accompanied her, spoke thus in her behalf to the Monvagaruu, My Lord, may it please your Greatness to have a little patience till we may know whether, the time be fit for the kissing of the foot of the Throne of this Lord of the World, and advertising him of the coming of this stranger, and so according to the grace which our Lord will show him therein, his heart may rejoice, and we with him. That said, the door was shut again for the space of three or four Credoes, and then the six Girls came and opened it, but the anciant woman that at first came along with them, we saw no more, howbeit in stead of her there came a Boy of about nine years of age, richly apparelled, and having on his head an hurfangua of Gold, which is a kind of Myter, but that it is somewhat more closed all about, and without any overture, he had also a Mace of Gold, much like a Sceptre, which he carried upon his shoulder: this same, without making much reckoning of the Monvagaruu, or of any of the other Lords there present, took the Ambassador by the hand, and said unto him, The news of thy arrival is come unto the feet of Binaigaa the Calaminhan, and Sceptre of the Kings that govern the Earth, and is so agreeable to his ears, that with a smiling look he now sends for thee to give thee audience concerning that which is desired of him by thy King, whom he newly receives into the number of his brethren, with a love of the son of his entrails, that so he may remain powerful and victorious over his Enemies: Thereupon he caused him, together with the King's Uncle, and the other Governors that accompanied him, to come in, leaving all the rest without; the Ambassador then seeing none of his Train follow him, looked three or four times back, seeming by his countenance to be somewhat discontented, which the Monvagaruu perceiving, spoke to the Queitor, who was a little behind, that he should cause the strangers to be let in, and none else; the doors being then opened again, we Portugal's began to go in with the Bramaas, but such a number of others came thrusting in amongst us, as the Gentlemen Ushers, who were above twenty, had much ado to keep the doors, striking many with Battouns which they had in their hands, and of those some that were persons of quality, and yet could they not therewith, neither with their cries, nor menaces, stop them all from entering: Thus being come in, we passed along through the midst of a great garden, made with such art, and where appeared so many goodly things, so divers, and so pleasing to the eye, as words are not able to express them: For there were there many Alleys environed with Balisters of Silver, and many Arbours of extraordinary scent, which we were told had so much sympathy with the Moons of the year, that in all seasons whatsoever they bare flowers and fruits; withal there was such abundance and variety of Roses and other flowers, as almost passeth belief. In the midst of this Garden we saw a great many young women, very fair, and well clad, whereof some past away their time in dancing, and others in playing on sundry sorts of Instruments much after our manner, which they performed with so much harmony, as we were not a little delighted therewith: some also bestowed themselves in making of curious Needle-works and Gold-strings, some in other things, whilst their companions gathered fruit to eat; and all this was done so quietly, and with such order and good behaviour, as made us admire it. At our going out of this Garden, where the Monvagaruu would needs have the Ambassador to stay awhile, that he might there observe something worthy to entertain his King with at his return to Pegu, we went into a very great Antichamber, where many Commanders and Lords were sitting, as also some great Princes, who received the Ambassador with new ceremonies, and compliments, and yet not one of them stirred from his place; Through this Antichamber we came to a door, where there were six Gentlemen Ushers with Silver Maces, by which we entered into another room very richly furnished: in this was the Calaminhan seated on a most majestical Throne, encompassed with three rows of Balisters of Silver; At the foot of the degrees of his Throne sat twelve women that were exceeding beautiful, and most richly apparelled, playing on divers sorts of Instruments, whereunto they accorded their voices; On the top of the Throne, and not far from his person, were twelve young Damsels about nine or ten years old, all of them on their knees round about him, and carrying Maces of Gold in the fashion of Sceptres; amongst them there was also another that stood on her feet, and fanned him. Below, all along the whole length of the room, were a great many of old men, wearing Mitres of Gold on their heads, and long Robes of Satin and Damask, curiously embroidered, every one having Silver Maces on their shoulders, and ranked in order on either side against the walls: Over all the rest of the room were sitting, upon rich Persian Carpets, about two hundred young Ladies, as we could guests, that were wonderful fair, and exceeding well favoured. Thus did this room, both for the marvellous structure of it, and for the excellent order that was observed therein, represent so great and extraordinary a Majesty, as we heard the Ambassador say afterwards talking of it, that if God would grant him the grace to return to Pegu, he would never speak of it to the King, as well for fear of grieving him, as of being taken for a man that reports things which seem altogether incredible. As soon as the Ambassador was ent●red into the room where the Calaminhan was, §. 2. accompanied with the four Princes that conducted him, he prostrated himself five times on the ground, without so much as daring to behold the Calaminhan, in sign of the great respect he carried towards him, which the Monvagaruu perceiving, willed him to advance forward, so that being arrived near to the first degree of his Throne, with his face still bending downward, he said to the Calaminhan, with so loud a voice as every one might hear him; The Clouds of the Air, which recreate the fruits whereof we eat, have published over the whole Monarchy of the World the great Majesty of thy Power, which hath caused my King, desiring to be honoured with thy amity, as with a rich pearl, to send me for that purpose, and to tell thee from him, that thou shalt much oblige him, if thou pleasest to accept of him for thy true Brother, with the honourable obedience which he will always render to thee, as to him that is the elder, as thou art: And for that end it is, that he sends thee this Letter, which is the jewel of all his treasure that he prizes most, and wherein his eyes take more pleasure, for the honour and contentment they receive by it, then in being Lord of the Kings of Avaa, and of all the precious stone of the mountain of Falent, of Jatir, and Pontau. Hereunto the Calaminhan made him this answer following, and that with a grave and severe countenance; For my part I accept of this new amity, thereby to give full satisfaction to thy King, as to a son newly born of my entrails. Then began the women to play on Instruments of Music, and six of them danced with little children for the space of three or four credo●s; After that, other six little girls danced with six of the oldest men that were in the room, which seemed to us a very pretty fantasticalness. This dance ended, there was a very fine Comedy represented by twelve Ladies, exceeding beautiful, and gorgeously attired, wherein appeared on the Stage a great Sea-monster, holding in his mouth the daughter of a King, whom the fish swallowed up before them all, which the twelve Ladies seeing, went in all haste weeping to an Hermitage, that was at the foot of a Mountain, from whence they returned with an Hermit, who made earnest supplications to Quiay Patureu, God of the Sea, that he would bring this Monster to the shore, so as they might come to bury the Damsel according to her quality; The Hermit was answered by Quiay Patureu, That the twelve Ladies should change their lamentations and complaints into so many consorts of music, that were agreeable to his ears, and he would then command the Sea to cast the fish upon the strand to be done withal as they thought good; whereupon comes on the Stage six little Boys with wings and crowns of Gold upon their heads, in the same manner as we use to paint Angels, and naked all over, who falling on their knees before the Ladies, presented them with three Harps and three Viols, saying, that Quiay Patureu s●nt them these Instruments from the Heaven of the Moon, therewith to cast the Monster of the Sea into a sleep, that so they might have their desire on him, whereupon the twelve Ladies took them out of the hands of the little Boys, and began to play upon them, tuning them unto their voices with so lamentable and sad a tone, and such abundance of tears, that it drew some from the eyes of divers Lords that were in the room; Having continued their music about half a quarter of an hour, they saw the Monster coming out of the Sea, and by little and little as it were astonished, making to the shore where these fair Musicians were; all which was performed so properly, and to the li●e, that the Assistants could hardly imagine it to be a Fable, and a matter devised for pleasure, but a very truth, besides the Scene was set forth with a world of state and riches. Then one of the twelve Ladies drawing out a Poignard, all set with precious stones, which she wore by her side, ripped up the fish, and out of the belly of it drew the Infanta alive, which presently went and danced to the tune of their Instruments, and so went and kissed the Calaminhans' hand, who received her very graciously, and made her sit down by him; It was said, that this young Lady was his Niepce, the Daughter of a Brother of his; as for the other twelve, they were all the Daughters of Princes, and of the greatest Lords of the Country, whose Fathers and Brothers were there present. There were also three or four Comedies more like this, acted by other young Ladies of great quality, and set forth with so much pomp and magnificence, as more could not be desired. About evening the Calaminhan retired into another room, accompanied with women only, for all the rest they went along with the Monvagaruu, who took the Ambassador by the hand, and led him back to the outermost room of all, where with many compliments after their manner, he took his leave of him, and so committed him to the Queitor, who straightway carried him to his House, where he lodged all the while that he was there, being two and thirty days, during which time he was feasted by the principal Lords of the Court in a splendid and sumptuous manner, and continually entertained with several sports of fishing, hunting, hawking, and other such like recreations; As for us Portugals, we took a singular content in observing, over all the City and about it, the excellent structure of very sumptuous and magnificent edifices, of stately Pagodes or Temples, and of houses adorned with goodly workmanship, and of inestimable value. Now amongst all these Buildings there was not in the wh●le City a more majestical one then that which was dedicated to Quiay Pimpocau, who is The God of the Sick: In it serve continually a number of Priests, apparelled in grey Gowns, who being of greater knowledge than all the rest of the four and twenty Sects of this Empire, do distinguish themselves from the others by certain yellow strings, which serve them for girdles; they are also by the vulgar people in a sovereign degree of honour called ordinarily, Perfect men. The Ambassador himself went five times to their Temple, as well to see very marvellous things, as to hear the doctrine of those▪ that preached there, of which, and of all that concerns the extravagancies of their Religion, he brought a great volume to the King of Bramaa, which was so pleasing to him, as he afterward commanded the said Doctrine to be preached in all the Temples of that Kingdom, which is to this day exactly observed in all his states. Of this Book I brought a Translation into the Kingdom of Portugal, which a Florentine borrowed of me, and when I asked him for it again, he told me that it was lost, but I found afterward that he had carried it to Florence, and presented it to the Duke of Tuscany, who commanded it to be printed under this Title, The new Belief of the Pagans of the other end of the World. Upon a day as the Ambassador was talking in this Pagode with one of the Grepos, who professed much kindness unto him, for indeed they are all of a good nature, easy of access, and communicating themselves to strangers freely enough, he demanded of him, how long it was since the Creation of the World, or whether those things had a beginning which God doth show so clearly to our eyes, such as the Night, the Day, the Sun, the Moon, the Stars, and other Creatures that have neither Father nor Mother, and of whom no reason can be rendered in Nature how they began: The Grep● relying more on his own knowledge, then on the others that were about him made this answer to his Question; Nature, said he, had no other Creation but that which proceeded from the Will of the Creator, who in a certain time, determined in his divine Counsel, manifested it to the Inhabitants of Heaven, created before by his sovereign power, and according to that which is written thereof, it was fourscore and two thousand Moons, since the Earth was discovered from under the Waters, when as God created therein a very fair Garden, where he placed the first man, whom he named Adaa, together with his wife Bazagon, them he expressly commanded, for to reduce th●m under the yoke of obedience, that they should not touch a certain fruit of a tree, called Hil●for●n, for that he reserved the same for himself; and in case they came to eat thereof, they should for a chastisement of their fault prove the rigour of his justice, whereof they and their descendants should feel the dire effects: This being known to the great Lupantoo, who is the gluttonous Serpent of the profound House of Smoke, and perceiving how by this commandment, God would for man's obedience on Earth give him Heaven for a reward, he went to Adaas wife and bid her eat of that fruit, and that she should also make her Husband eat thereof, for he assured her that in so doing they should both of them be more excellent in knowledge then all other creatures, and free from that heavy nature whereof he had composed them, so that in a moment their bodies should mount to Heaven. Then Bazagon, hearing what Lupantoo had said unto her, was so taken with a desire of enjoying that excellent prerogative of knowledge which he promised her, 〈◊〉 to attain thereunto she eat of the fruit, and made her Husband likewise to eat of it, whence it ensued, that they were both of them by that unhappy morsel subjected to the pains of death of sorrow, and of poverty. For God seeing the disobedience of these two first creatures, made them feel the ●igor of his justice, by chase them out of the Garden where he had placed them, and confirming the punishments upon them wherewith he had threatened them before; Wherefore Ada●, fearing lest the divine justice should proceed further against him, gave himself up for a long time to continual tears; whereupon God sent him word, that if he continued in his repentance he would forgive him his sin. Whilst the Grepo was speaking thus, the Ambassador wondering at his discourse, which was a great novelty to him, Certainly, said he unto him, I am well assured that the King my Master hath never heard the like of this from the Priests of our Temples, for they in recompense of our works propound no other thing unto us but the possession of riches in this life; for, as they say, there is no guerdon after death, and that we must finish our lives a● all the beasts of the field do, except the Cows, which for a reward of the milk they have given us, are converted into other Sea-cows, of the apples of whose eyes are pearls engendered. At these words the Grepo, puffed up with vanity for that which he had said to the Ambassador; Think not, answered he unto him, that there is any one in all this Country can let thee understand so much as I have done, unless it be one Grepo, who is as learned as myself: With this ●ume of presumption he chanced to cast his eye on us Portugal●, that were behind the Ambassador, and as the Minister of the Devil, believing that we esteemed him as much as he did himself, Verily, said he unto us, I should be glad, that you, who as strangers have no knowledge of this truth, would come more often to hear me, for to understand how God hath created all these things, and how much we are bound to him for the benefit of this Creation: Then one of our company, named Gaspar de Meyrelez, showing himself therein more curious than the rest, after he had thanked the Grepo in the name of us all, he prayed him to give him leave to ask him something which he desired to know of him; Whereunto the Grepo made answer, that he was very well contented; For, added he, it is as well the property of a wise and curious man to inquire for to learn, as of an ignorant to hear, and not be able to answer: whereupon Gaspar de Meyrelez demanded of him, whether God, after he had created all these things whereof he spoke, had not done some heroical works upon Earth, either by his Justice, or by his Mercy. To this the Grepo replied, that he had, it being evident, that as long as man lived in this flesh, he could not choose but commit sins which would render him punishable, nor God be without a great desire to pardon him; and he added further, That the sins of men coming to be multiplied on Earth, God had overwhelmed the whole World, by commanding the Clouds of Heaven to rain upon it, and to drown all living things, except one just man with his Family, which God put into a great House of wood, from whom issued afterwards all the Inhabitants of the Earth. The Portugal again enquired, whether God after this chastisement had not sent some other. God did not, answered he, send any, which taken in general, was like unto that; but it is true, that in particular he chastiseth Kingdoms and People with Wars, and other scourges which he sendeth them, as we see that he punisheth men with infinite afflictions, labours, diseases, and above all with extreme poverty, which is the last and extremest of all evils. The Portugal continuing in his demands, desired him to tell him, whether he had any hope that God would one day be appeased, so as men might have entrance into Heaven; Whereunto the Grepo replied, That he knew nothing thereof, but that it was an evident thing, and to be believed as an Article of Faith, that even as God was an infinite good, so he would have regard to the good which men did upon Earth for his sake. Hereupon he demanded of him, whether he had not heard it said, or found written, That after all those things, whereof he spoke, a man was come into the World, who dying on the Cross, had satisfied God for all men; or whether there was not among them some knowledge thereof: Whereunto the Grepo answered, None can make satisfaction to God but God himself, although there be in the World holy and virtuous men, which satisfy for themselves, and for some of their friends, such as are the Gods of our Temples, as the Grepos do assure us; But to say, that one alone hath satisfied for all, is a thing which we have never heard of till now, besides, on Earth, which is so base of itself, a Ruby of so high a price cannot be engendered: It is true nevertheless, that in times passed so much was certified to the Inhabitants of this Country by a man, named John, who came into this City, and was held for an holy man, having been the Disciple of another, called Tomés Modeliar, the Servant of God, whom those of the Country put to death, because he went publicly preaching, That God was made man, and that he had suffered death for mankind; which at first wrought such a Division amongst the people of this Nation, as many believed it for a very truth, and others opposed it, and form a contrary party against it, incited thereunto by the Grepoes' of the Law of Quiay Figrau, God of the Atoms of the Sun; so that they reproved all that this stranger said, by reason whereof He was banished from this City to the Kingdom of Brama●, and from thence for the same cause to the Town of Digan, where he was put to death for preaching publicly, as I said before, That God became man, and was crucified for men. Upon these speeches Gaspar de Meyrelez and we, said, that this man had preached nothing in this Country which was not most true; wherewith the Grepo was so taken, that he fell down on his knees before all that were present, and lifting up his hands and eyes to Heaven, he said with tears in his eyes, Lord, of whose beauty and goodness the Heavens and the Stars do give testimony, I with all my heart do beseech thee to permit, that in our times the hour may come, wherein the People of the other end of the World may give thee thanks for so great a Grace. After that these matters were passed in this manner, and many others besides, which well deserved to be related, if my gross wit were able to describe them, the Ambassador took his leave of the Grepo with many compliments and words of courtesy, whereof they are nothing sparing, as being much accustomed to practise them one with another. CHAP. XLIX. An ample relation of this Empire of the Calaminham, and of the Kingdoms of Pegu, and Bramaa, with the continuance of our voyage, and what we saw among the same. A Month after our arrival at this City of Timphan, where the Court then was, the Ambassador demanded an answer to his Embassy, and it was immediately granted him by the Calaminham, with whom he spoke himself, and being graciously entertained by him, he referred him for his dispatch to the Monuagaruu, that was, as I have heretofore delivered, the chief man in governing the Kingdom, who gave him an answer on the behalf of the Calaminham▪ as also a present in exchange of that which the King of Bramaa had sent him, withal he wrote him a Letter, that contained these words, Thou arm of a clear Ruby, which God hath newly enchased into my body, and whose flesh is fitly fastened to me, as that of my brother, by that new league and amity now accorded unto thee, by me Prechau Guimiam, Lord of the seven and twenty Crowns of the Montaignes of the earth, inherited by a lawful succession from him, who these two and twenty months hath not set his feet upon my head; for so long it is since he left me, never to set me again, by reason of the sanctification which his soul doth now enjoy in feeling the sweet heat of the beams of the Sun. I have seen thy Letter, dated the fifth cha●eca of the eighth moon of the year, whereunto I have given the true credit of a brother, and as such a one I accept of the party thou dost present me with, obliging myself to render thee the two passages of Savady free, that so thou mayest without fear of the Siamon be King of Avaa, as thou desirest me by thy Letter: And as for the other conditions, whereof thy Ambassador hath made some mention unto me, I will make answer thereunto by one of mine own, whom will send unto thee from hence ere it be long, to the end thou mayest have a good success in the pleasure thou seemest to take in making war upon thine enemies. The Ambassador having received this Letter, departed from the Court the third day of November, in the year one thousand five hundred forty and six, accompanied with certain Lords, who by the express commandment of the Calaminham went along with him to Bidor, where they took their leave of him, after they had made him a great feast, & presented him with divers gifts. But before I entreat of the way which we held from this place till we came to Pegu, where the King of Bramaa was, I think it convenient and necessary to make a relation here of certain things which we saw in this country, wherein I will acquit myself as succinctly as I can, as I have done in all other matters whereof 〈◊〉 have spoken heretofore; for if I would discourse in particular of all that I have seen, and of that which hath past as well in this Empire, as in other Kingdoms, where I have been during my painful voyages, I had then need to make another volume far bigger than this same, and be endued with a wit much above that I have: howbeit that I may not wholly conceal things so remarkable, I am contented to say so much thereof as my gross stile will permit me to deliver. The Kingdom of Pegu hath in circuit an hundred and forty leagues, is situate on the South side in sixteen degrees, and in the hear● of the Country towards the rhomb of the East it hath an hundred forty leagues, being environed all above with an high ground, named Pangavirau, where the Nation of the Bramaas doth inhabit, whose country is fourscore leagues broad, and two hundred long. This Monarchy was in times past one sole Kingdom, which now it is not, but is divided into thirteen estates of Sovereigns, who made themselves masters of it by poisoning their King in a banquet which they made him in the City of Chaleu, as their histories relate: of these thirteen estates, there are eleven that are commanded by other Nations, who by a tract of another great country are joined to all the bounds of the Bramaas, where two great Emperors abide, of which the one is called the Siamon, and the other the Calaminham, who is the same I purpose only to treat of. According to report, the Empire of the Prince is above three hundred leagues breadth, and as much in length, and it is said that anciently it contained seven and twenty Kingdoms, the inhabitants whereof spoke all one language: within this Empire we saw many goodly Cities, exceedingly well peopled, and abounding with all provisions necessary for man's life, as flesh, fresh water, fish, corn, pulse, rice, pastures, vines, and fruits; the chief of all these Cities is Tymphan, where this Emperor, the Calaminham, with his Court commonly resides: it is seated along by a great river, named Pit●y, and environed all about with two broad walls of earth, made up with strong stone on either side, having very broad ditches, and at each gate a Castle with high Towers; certain Merchants affirmed unto us, that this City had within it some four hundred thousand fires, and albeit the houses are for the most part not above two stories high, yet in recompense thereof they are built very stately, and with great charge, especially those of the Nobility, and of the Merchants, not speaking of the great Lords, which are separated by great enclosures, where are spacious outward Courts, and at the entering into them arches after the manner of China, as also gardens, and walks planted with trees, and great ponds, all very handsomely accommodated to the pleasures and delights of this life, whereunto these people are very much inclined: We were also certified, that both within the enclosure of the City, and a league about it, there were six and twenty hundred Pagodes, some of which, wherein we had been, were very sumptuous and rich, indeed for the rest the most of them were but petty houses in the fashion of Hermitages: These people follow four and twenty Sects, all different one from another, amongst the which there is so great a confusion of errors, and diabolical precepts, principally in that which concerns their bloody Sacrifices, as ●abhor to speak of them; but the Idol which is most in vogue amongst them, and most frequented, is that whereof I have already made mention, called Qui●y Frigau, that is to say, The God of the Meats of the Sun, for it is in this false God that the Calaminham believes, and does adore him, and so do all the chiefest Lords of the Kingdom, wherefore the Grepos, Menigrepos, and Talagrepos of this false god are honoured far more than all others, and held in the retation of holy personages; their superiors, who by an eminent title are called Cabizondos, never know women, as they say, but to content their brutish and sensual appetites they want not diabolical inventions, which are more worthy of tears than recital: during the ordinary Fairs of this City, called by them Chandu●●s, we saw all things there that nature hath created, as iron, steel, lead, tin, copper, latin, saltpetre, brimstone, oil, vermilion, honey, wax, sugar, lacre, benjamin, divers sorts of stuffs and garments of silk, pepper, ginger, cinnamon, linen cloth, cotton wool, alum, borax, cor●alines, crystal, camphire, musk, ivory, cassia, rhubarbe, turbith, scamony, azure, woad, incense, cochenill, saffron, myr●he, rich porcelain, gold, silver, rubies, diamonds, emerauds, saphires, and generally all other kind of things that can be named, and that in so great abundance, as it is not possible for me to speak that which I have seen, and be believed; women there are ordinarily very white and fair, but that which most commends them is, that they are of a good nature, chaste, charitable, and much inclined to compassion: The Priests of all these four and twenty Sects, whereof there are a very great number in this Empire, are clothed in yellow, like the Roolims of Pegu, they have no money either of gold or silver, but all their commerce is made with the weight of cates, casis, maazes, and conderins. The Court of the Calaminham is very rich, the Nobility exceeding gallant, and the revenue of the Lords and Princes very great, the King is feared and respected in a marvellous manner; he hath in his Court many Commanders that are strangers, unto whom he giveth great pensions to serve him for the safety of his person, our Ambassador was assured, that in the City of Timphan, where most commonly the Court is, there are above threescore thousand horse, and ten thousand Elephants: the gentlemen of the country live very hand somely, and are served in vessels of silver, and sometimes of gold, but as for the common people they use porcelain & latin; in summer they are apparelled in satin, damask, and wrought taffeties, which come from Persia, & in winter in gowns furred with martens; there is no going to Law amongst them, no● does any man enter into bond there, but if there be any difference among the common people, certain Magistrates, like to our Aldermen of Wards, do decide it, and if contention happens to arise between persons of an higher quality, than they submit to the judgement of certain religious men, who are expressly deputed for that purpose, and from them matters pas●e on in manner of appeal to the Queitor of Justice, which is as the superintendent thereof, from whose sentence there is no appeal, how great and important soever the business be: The Monarchy of these seven and twenty Kingdoms hath seven hundred Provinces, that is six and twenty in every Kingdom; and in the capital town of each of those Provinces doth a Governor preside, all of them being of like and equal power. Now on every new Moon, each Captain is bound to muster the soldiers that are under his charge, which ordinarily are two thousand foot, five hundred horse, and fourscore fight Elephants, one of the which is called by the name of the capital town of the same Province, so that if one should make a just computation of all those men of war that are in those seven hundred companies of those Provinces, they would appear to be seventeen hundred and fifty thousand, whereof there are three hundred and fifty thousand horse, and five and fifty thousand Elephants; for in regard of the great number that there are of those beasts in that country, this Emperor styles himself in his titles, Lord of the indomptable force of Elephants. The revenue which the Monarch draws from his Royal Prerogatives, by them called, the price of the Sceptre, as also from his Mines, amounts to twenty millions of gold, without comprising therein the presents which are given him by the Princes, Lords and Captains, and a great quantity of money that is distributed amongst the men of war, according to every on●● merit, which are not of that account. In all this country, pearl, amber, and salt are very much esteemed of, because they are things that come from the Sea, which is far distant from the City of Timpla●, but of all other commodities they have infinite store: The Country of itself is very healthy, the air very good, and likewise the waters. When they sneeze they use to say, the God of truth is three and one, whereby one may judge that these people have had some knowledge of the Christian Religion. Being departed from the town of Bidor, we held on our course down the great river of Pit●y, and the same day at night we went and lodged at a certain Abbey of the land of Quiay jareno, the God of married folks; this Abbey is seated on the bank of the river in a plain, where are a great many of trees planted, and very rich buildings, here the Ambassador was well entertained by the Cabizondo and the Talagrepos; then continuing our voyage seven days longer, we arrived at a town named Pavel, where we stayed three days to furnish our vessels with some provisions which we needed; in this place the Ambassador bought divers knacks of China, and other commodities that were sold there at a very cheap rate, as musk, fine porcelains, wrought silks, Ermines, and many other sorts of furs, which are much used in that country, because it is extreme cold there; these wares were brought thither by great troops of Elephants and Rhinocero's from a certain far distant Province, as the Merchants told us, called Friou●araniaa, beyond the which, they said, was a kind of people called Calog●●s and Funcaos, tawny men, and great Archers, having their feet like unto Oxen, but hands like unto other men, save that they are exceeding hairy, they are naturally inclined to cruelty, and have below at the end of the backbone a lump of flesh as big as ones two fists, their dwelling is in mountains that are very high and rough on some parts, where there are mighty deep pits or caves, from whence are heard in winter nights most dreadful cries, and doleful lamentations: We were told likewise, that not far from these people there were others, called Calouhos, Timpates, and Bugems, and a good way beyond them some, named Oquens and Magores, who feed on wild beasts which they catch in hunting, and eat raw, as also on all kind of contagious creatures, as lizards, serpents, and adders; they hunt those wild beasts mounted on certain animals, as big as horses, which have three horns in the midst of their foreheads, with thick short legs, and on the middle of their backs a row of prickles, wherewith they prick when they are angry, and all the rest of the body is like ● great lizard; besides they have on their necks, instead of hair, other prickles far longer and bigger than those on their backs, and on the joints of their shoulders short wings like to the sins of fishes, wherewith they fly, as it were, leaping the length of five or six and twenty paces at a jump: These creatures are called Banazes, upon which these savage ride into the country of their enemies, with whom they hold continual war, and whereof some pay them tribute in salt, which is the thing they make most account of, in regard of the need they have of it, for that they are very far distant from the Sea. We spoke also with other men called Bumioens, who live on high mountains, where there are Mines of Alum and Lacre, and great store of wood; of this Nation, we saw a troop conducting of above two thousand oxen, on whom they had put packsaddles, and so made them to carry their Merchandise; these men were very tall, and had eyes and beards like the Chinese: We saw others likewise, that had reasonable long beards, their faces full of freckles, and their ears and nostrils pierced, and in the holes thereof small threads of gold made into clasps, these were called Ginaphogaas, and the Province whereof they were Natives Surobosay, which within the mountains of the La●hos are bounded with the lake of Chiammay, and are clothed with hairy skins, going barefoot and bareheaded, certain Merchants told us that these had great riche●, and that all their traffic was in silver, whereof they had great store. We spoke also with another sort of men, call d Tuparo●ns, who are tawny, great eaters, and much addicted to the pleasures of the flesh; these gave us better entertainment than all the rest, and oftentimes feasted us. Now because in a certain banquet, where we nine Portugals were with the Ambassador; one of us, named Francisco Temuda, challenged them to drink, they taking it for a great affront, caused the feast to continue the longer for the recovery of their honour, but the Portugal set on them so lustily, twenty that they were, as he laid them all along drunk on the ground, himself remaining still sober; when they were out of their drink, the Sapiton, that was their Captain, and in whose house the feast had been made, called his company together, which were above three hundred, and whether the Portugal would or no made him to mount upon an Elephant, and so lead him through all the town, accompanied with a great multitude of people that followed him at the sound of trumpets, drum's, and other such instruments; the Captain himself, as also the Ambassador, and the rest of us, together with all the Bramaas, marching on foot after him, with boughs in our hands, and two men before him on horseback, that road crying, O all ye people, praise with gladness the beams which proceed from the midst of the Sun, who is the God that makes our rice to grow, for that you have lived to see a man so holy, that knowing how to drink better than all the men of the world, hath laid on the ground twenty of the principal drinkers of our troop, to the end his renown may be daily more and more augmented. Whereunto all the crowd of people that accompanied him, answered with such cries and acclamations, as the very noise thereof frighted all that heard it. In this equipage they lead the Portugal to the Ambassadors house, where they set him down with a great deal of respect and many compliments, then on their knees they rendered him to the Ambassador, desiring him to have a care of him as of an holy man, or the son of some great King, for, said they, it cannot be otherwise, seeing God hath bestowed so great a gift on him, as to know how to drink so well. Whereupon having made a gathering for him, they got together above two hundred lingots of silver, which they gave him, and until the time that we departed he was continually visited by the inhabitants, whereof many presented him with rich pieces of silk, and other gifts, as if they had made an offering to some Saint upon a solemn day of his invocation. After these we saw other men that were very white, named Pavilens, great archers, and good horsemen, apparelled in caslocks of silk like those of japon, and that carried their meat to their mouths with little sticks, after the manner of the Chinese; these same told us that their Coyntry was called Binagorem, and that it was distant from thence about two hundred leagues up the river, their merchandise was store of gold in powder, like to that of Menancab●, of the Island of Su●atra, as also lacre, aloes, musk, tin, copper, silk, and wax, which they exchanged for pepper, ginger, salt; wine, and rice: the wives of these men which we saw there are very white, of better conversation than all the rest of those countries, well natured, and exceeding charitable, demanding of them what was their Law, and what was the divinity that they adored they answered us, That their Gods were the Sun, the heaven, and the stars, for that from them they received by an holy communication all the good that they enjoyed upon earth; and furthermore, that the soul of man was but a breath which ended in the death of the body, and that afterwards tumbling up and down in the air she mingled herself with the clouds, until such time as coming to be dissolved into water, she died again upon the earth, as the body had done before. I omit an infinite many of such extravagances which were told us, and that gave us good cause to wonder at the blindness and confusion of these wretches, and doth also oblige us to render thanks continually unto God for delivering us from these errors, and this false belief. Now from the diversity of these unknown Nations, which we saw in these parts, it is easy to infer, that in this Monarchy of the world there are many countries yet undivided, and unknown to us. CHAP. LX. Our arrival at Pegu, with the death of the Roolim of Mounay. COntinuing our course from this town of Pavel, §. 1. we came the next day to a village, called Luncor, environed about the space of three leagues, with a great number of trees of Benjamin, which from this place is transported into the Kingdoms of Pegu, and Siam. From thence we sailed for nine days together down that great river, all alongst the which we saw many goodly towns, and then we arrived at another river, called Ventrau through the which we continued our voyage to Penauchin, the first Borough of the Kingdom of jangumaa, where the Ambassador registered his vessels, and all that were within them, because such was the custom of the country. Being departed from thence, we went and lay that night at the Rauditens, which are two strong places belonging to the Prince of Poncanor. Five days after we came to a great town, called Magdaleu, which is the country from whence lacre is brought to Martabano; the Prince thereof, during the time that we stayed there, showed the Ambassador a general muster of all the men of war that he had levied against the King of the Lau●os, with whom he was at difference, because he had repudiated a daughter of his, which he had married three years before, intending to espouse a gentlewoman by whom he had had a son that he had legitimated, and made choice of for heir of his Kingdom, thereby frustrating his Nephew (by his daughter) of his right. Passing on then through the straight of Madur, wherein we sailed five days, we arrived at a village called Mouchell, the first place of the Kingdom of Pegu; there one Chalag●ni●, a famous Pirate, that went up and down robbing in this place with thirty Ceroos, well equipped, and full of warlike men, assailed us one night, and fight with us till it was almost day, he handled us in such sort, as it was the great grace of God that we escaped out of his hands, nevertheless it was not without the loss of five of the twelve vessels that we had, together with an hundred and fourscore of our men▪ whereof two were Portugals: The Ambassador himself had a cut on one of his arms, and two wounds besides with arrow shot, which had almost cost him his life; all of us likewise were cruelly hurt, and the Present which the Calaminham sent to the King of Bramaa, being worth above an hundred thousand ducats, was taken by the Pirate, together with a great deal of rich merchandise that was in the five vessels, whereof he had made himself master. In this sad equipage we arrived three days after at the City of Martabano, from whence the Ambassador wrote the King a letter, wherein he rendered him an account of all that had happened to him in his voyage, as also in his disaster. Whereupon the King sent presently away a Fleet of sixscore Ceroos, with a number of choice men, amongst which were an hundred Portugals in quest of this Pirate. This Fleet having by good fortune discovered him, found that he had put on shore his thirty Ceroos, wherewith he had assailed us, and was with all his forces retired into a fortress, which was full of divers prizes that he had taken in several parts thereabout; our men immediately attacked the place, and carried it easily at the very first assault, only with the loss of some few Bramaas and one Portugal, howbeit many were hurt with arrows, but they recovered in a short time without the ma●●ing of any one. As soon as the fortress was gained, all that were found within it were put to the sword, not sparing the life of any, but that of the Pirate, and sixscore others of his company which were led alive to the King of Bramaa, who caused them to be cast to his Elephants, that instantly dismembered them. In the mean time the taking of this fortress was so advantageous to the Portugals that were sent thither, as they returned from thence all very rich; and it was thought that five or six of them got each of them the value of five and twenty, or thirty thousand ducats a piece, and that he which had least, had the worth of two or three thousand for his share: After that the Ambassador was cured at Martaban● of the hurts which he had received in the fight, he went directly to the City of Pegu, where, as I have declared, the King of Bramaas Court was at that time, who being advertised of his arrival, and of the letter which he brought him from the Calaminham, whereby he accepted of his amity, and allied himself with him, he sent the Chaumigrem, his foster-brother, and brother-in-law, to receive him; to which end he set forth, accompanied with all the Grandees of the Kingdom, and four battalions of strangers, amongst the which were a thousand Portugals commanded by Antonio Ferreira, born in Braguenca, a man of great understanding, and to whom this King gave twelve thousand ducats a year pension, besides the Presents which he bestowed on him in particular, that came to little less. Hereupon the King of Bramaa seeing that by this new league God had contented his desire, he resolved to show himself thankful for so great a favour, wherefore he caused great feasts to be made amongst these people, and a number of Sacrifices to be offered in their Temples, where there was no spare of perfumes, and wherein it was thought there were killed above a thousand, stags, cows, and hogs, which were bestowed for an alms among the poor, besides many other works of charity, as the clothing of five thousand poor folks, and employing great sums of money in the releasing of a thousand prisoners which were detained for debt. After that these feasts had continued seven whole days together, with a most ardent zeal, and at the incredible charge of the King, Lords, and people, news came to the City of the death of the Aixquendoo, Roolim of Mounay, who was as it were their Sovereign Bishop, which caused all rejoicings to cease in an instant, and every one to fall into mourning, with great expressions of sorrow: The King himself retired, the fairs were given over, the windows, doors, and shops were shut up, so that no living thing was seen to stir in the City, withal their Temples and Pagods were full of penitents of all sorts, who with incessant shedding of tears, exercised such an excess of repentance, as some of them died therewith. In the mean time the King departed away the same night for to go to Mounay, which was some twenty leagues from thence, for that he was necessarily to be assistant at this funeral pomp, according to the ancient custom of the Kings of Pegu; he arrived there the next day somewhat late, and then gave order for all that was necessary for his funerals, so that the next day every thing being in a readiness; the body of the deceased was about evening brought from the place where he died, and laid on a Scaffold that was erected in the midst of a great place, hung all about with white velvet, and covered over head with three clothes of Estate of gold and silver tinsel: in the middle of it was a Throne of twelve steps ascent unto it, and an hearse almost like unto ours, set forth with divers rich works of gold and precious stones; round about hung a number of silver candlesticks, and perfuming pots, wherein great quantities of sweet odours were burnt, by reason of the corruption of the body, which already began to have an ill savour. In this manner they kept it all that night, during the which was no little ado, and such a tumult of cries and lamentations made by the people, as words are not able to express; for the only number of the Bicos; Grepos, Menigrepos, Talagrepos, Guimons, and Roolims, who are the chiefest of their Priests, amounted to above thirty thousand, that were assembled together there, besides a world of others which came thither every hour. When divers inventions of sorrow, that were well accommodated to the subject of this mourning, had been shown, there came some two hours after midnight out of a Temple, called Quiay Figrau, god of the Motes of the Sun, a procession, wherein were seen five hundred little boys stark naked, and bound about the neck and the middle with cords, and chains of iron; upon their heads they carried bundles of wood, and in their hands knives, singing in two Quires with a tone, so lamentable and sad, as few that heard them could hardly forbear crying: In the mean time one amongst them went, saying in this manner, Thou that art going to enjoy the contentments of heaven, leave us not prisoners in this exile; whereunto another Choir answered, To the end we may rejoice with thee in the blessings of the Lord: then continuing their song in manner of a Litany, they said many otherthings with the same tone. After that, when they were all fallen on their knees before the Scaffold where the body lay, a Grepo above an hundred years old, prostrated on the ground with his hands lifted up on high, made a speech to him in the name of these little boys▪ whereunto another Grepo, who was near the hearse, as if he had spoken in the person of the deceased, came to answer thus, Since it hath pleased God by his holy will to form me of earth, it hath pleased him also to resolve me into earth, I recommend unto you, my children, the fear of that hour, wherein the hand of the Lord shall put us into the balance of his justice; whereupon all the rest with a great cry replied in this sort, May it please the most Almighty high Lord that reigns in the Sun, to have no regard to our works, that so we may be delivered from the pains of death: These little boys being retired, there came others about the age of ten or eleven years, apparelled in white Satin robes, with chains of gold on their feet, and about their necks many rich jewels and pearls: After they had with much ceremony done a great deal of reverence to the dead body, they went and flourished naked scymitars which they had in their hands all about the hearse, as if they would chase away the devil, saying aloud, Get thee gone, accursed as thou art, into the bottom of the house of smoke, where dying with a perpetual pain, without making an end of dying, thou shalt pay, without making an end also of paying the rigorous justice of the Lord above. This said, they withdrew, as if they would show that by this action they had left the body of the deceased exempt from the power of the devil, which besieged it before; In the place of these same came in six and twenty of their principal Talagrepos, being fourscore years old and upwards, apparelled in robes of violet coloured damask, and carrying silver censors in their hands, before whom for the greater gracing of them marched twelve gentlemen Ushers with Maces of the same metal; as soon as these Priests had censed the hearse four several times with many ceremonies, they all prostrated themselves with their faces on the ground, and then one of them began to say, as if he had spoken to the dead man, If the clouds of heaven were able to tell our grief unto the beasts of the fiel●▪ they would forsake their pasture for to help us to wail thy death, and the great extremity whereunto we are reduced; or else they would beseech thee Lord, to embark us with thee into this deadly house, where thou seest not us, because we are not worthy of so great a favour▪ but that all this people may be comforted in thee before the tomb shall hide thy body from us, show us, Lord, by figures of earth▪ the peaceable joy, and sweet contentment of thy repose, that we may be all awaked out of the heavy sleep, wherein the obscurities of the flesh doth wrap us, and that we miserable wretches may be incited to imitate thee, and follow thy steps, for to behold thee in the joyful house of the Sun at the last gasp of our lives. To these words, the people having made a very dreadful cry, answered incontinently, The Lord grant us this grace. Then the twelve gentlemen Ushers that carried the Maces, going on afore to make way through the press, though with much ado, because the people would not withdraw, there came forth of an house on the right side of the Scaffold four and twenty little boys richly apparelled, with chains of gold and precious stones about their necks, who playing after their manner on divers instruments of music, and falling down on their knees in two ranks before the hearse, they continued playing on their instruments, to the tune whereof there were only two of them that sung, whereunto five others answered from time to time in such a doleful manner, as made all the assistants shed abundance of tears, yea some of them were so sensible of it, as they could not forbear plucking of their hair, and knocking their heads against the steps of the Throne where the hearse stood. During this and many other ceremonies there performed, six young gentlemen Grepos sacrificed themselves, by drinking out of a golden cup a certain yellow liquor, so venomous, that before they had made an end of their draught, they fell down stark dead on the ground; this action of theirs brought these Martyrs of the devil into the number of their Saints, so as they were envied by every one for it, and presently their bodies were carried with a solemn procession to be burnt in a great fire, that was made of Sanders, Aloes, and Benjamin, where they were quickly reduced unto ashes. The next morning the Scaffold was disgarnished of all the richest pieces about it, and the hearse, but the clothes of estate, the hangings and banners, as also many other moveables of great worth were not stirred, and so with divers ceremonies, fearful cries and lamentations, and a strange noise of several sorts of instruments, they set fire on the Scaffold, and all that was upon it, anointing it often with odoriferous liquors, and confections of great price. Thus was the body consumed to ashes in a very short time, but whilst it was burning, the King and all the Grandees of his Court which were then present, cast in by way of alms many pieces of gold, pre●ious stones, jewels, and chains of pearl of exceeding great value, all which so ill employed were instantly consumed by the fire, together with the body and bones of that wretched dead man, so as we were certainly informed afterward, that this funeral pomp cost above an hundred thousand ducats, besides the garments which the King and the Grandees of the country gave to thirty thousand Priests that were assisting at it, wherein was employed an incredible quantity of stuffs of several sorts, witness the Portugals, who mightily profited by so lucky an occasion, because they sold at what price they would such as they brought from B●ngala, for which they were paid in lingots of gold and silver. CHAP. LXI. The election of the new Roolim of Mounay, the grand Talagrepo of these Gentiles of the Kingdom of Pegu. THe next day between seven and eight in the morning, §. 1. which was the time when the ashes of the deceased began to be cold, the King and all the great Lords of the Court came unto the place where the body had been burnt, marching all in order after the manner of a stately procession, and assisted by all the Grepos, amongst whom there were an hundred and thirty with silver censors, and fourteen with mitres of gold on their heads; they were apparelled in long robes of yellow satin, as for all the rest, to the number of ten thousand, they were clothed with taffata of the same colour, and with a kind of surpliss of fine linen, which was not done without a very great charge, by reason of the number of them. Being arrived at the place where the Roolim had been burnt, after some ceremonies performed, as is usual with them, according to the time and sense that every one had of it, a Talagrepo of the Bramaa Nation, and Uncle to the King, as Brother to his Father, whom the people held for the ablest of them all, having been chosen to preach that day, went up into the Pulpit for that effect: The beginning of his Sermon was an Elegy touching the defunct, whose life he commended with many speeches that made for his purpose, wherein he grew so earnest and hot, as turning himself to the King with tears in his eyes, and lifting up his voice somewhat louder, to the end he might hear him the better, he said unto him, If the Kings in these times wherein we live do consider how little a time they have to live, and with what rigour of justice they shall be chastised by the Almighty hand of the most high God for the crimes of their tyrannical lives, possibly it would be better for them to feed in the open fields like bruit beasts, then to be so absolute in their will, and to use it with so little reason, even as to be cruel to the good, and slack in punishing the wicked, whom by their sovereign power they have put into greatness and authority; and truly they are much to be lamented, whose good fortune hath raised them up to an estate so dangerous, as is that of Kings at this day, by reason of the insolence and liberty wherein they continually live, without so much as the least apprehension of any fear or shame. But you must know, O ye blinded of the world, that God hath made you Kings to use clemency towards men, to give them audience, to content, to chastise them, but not to kill them tyrannically: Nevertheless, O ye bad Kings, in the condition whereunto you are raised, you oppose yourselves to the nature which God hath endued you with, and take upon you many other different forms, in appareling yourselves every hour with some such livery as ●●●ms best unto you, to the end you may be to the one very bloodsuckers, that incessantly suck from them their goods and their lives, never leaving them so long as they have one drop of blood in their veins; and to others you are dreadful roaring Lions, who to give a ●a●k and a colour to your ambition and avarice, cause supreme Laws of death to be published for the least faults, and all for to confiscate other men's goods, which is the main end of your pretensions. Contrarily if there be any that you love, and unto whom you, or the world, or I know not what, have given the name of Grandees, you are so negligent in chastising their proud humours, and so prodigal in enriching them with the spoils and undoing of the poor, whom you have left naked, and even flayed to the very quick, as you cannot doubt but that they will one day accuse you before God for all these things, when you will have no excuse to make, so that there will be nothing left you but a dreadful confusion to trouble you, and to put you into an horrible disorder. To these he added so many other remonstrances in favour of the poor subjects, cried out so mainly, and shed so many tears in their behalf, as the King remained almost besides himself, and was touched ●o nearly therewith, that he instantly called Brazagaran, the Governor of Pegu, unto him, and commanded him without all delay to dismiss all the Deputies of the Provinces of the Kingdom, whom he had caused to be assembled in the Town of Cosmin, for to demand of them a great sum of money, that he might set upon the Kingdom of Savady, on which he had newly resolved to make war. Withal he swore publicly on the ashes of the defunct, that during his reign he would never charge his subjects with imposts, nor would make them to serve by force, as he had formerly done; yea, and that for the future he would have a most special care to hear the poor, and to do them justice against the misdemeanours of the great ones, conformable to the merit of every one, together with many other things very just and good, which might well serve for a lesson to us that are Christians. This Sermon being finished, the ashes of the defunct, which had been gathered up, was distributed as a relic into fourteen golden basons, whereof the King himself took up one on his head, and the Grepos of chiefest quality carried the rest; so the Procession going from thence in the same order as it came thither, those ashes were conveyed into a very rich Temple, which might be some flight shot from that place, and named Quiay D●cco, that is, the god of the afflicted of the earth, there they were put into a shallow grave, without other pomp or vanity, for so had Aixequendoo, the late Roolim, commanded. This grave than was environed about with three iron grates, and with two of silver, and one of latten, and upon three iron rods that crossed the whole breadth of the chapel, hung seventy and two lamps of silver, namely four and twenty on each of them, all of great value, and fastened together with great silver chains. Furthermore, there were placed about the steps, whereby one descended into the grave, thirty and six little perfuming pots, with Benjamin, Aloes, and other confections, wherein was great store of Ambergris, all which was not finished till it was almost night, by reason of the many ceremonies used in this funeral; all that day long they freed an infinite number of birds which had been brought thither in above an hundred cages, these Gentiles being of the opinion that they were so many souls of deceased persons, which before times had passed out of this life, and that were deposited as it were in the bodies of those birds, till the day of their deliverance should come, at which time they were in all liberty to accompany the soul of the defunct: The like they did with a great many of little fishes which had been transported thither also in certain vessels full of water, so that to set them at liberty, they cast them into the river with another new ceremony, to the end they might serve the soul of him whose ashes were then buried: There was also brought thither all kind of venison and foul, which was distributed as an alms to all the poor that were present there, whereof the number was almost infinite. These ceremonies, and other such like which were performed in this action being finished, the King in regard it was near night retired into his quarter, where he had caused tents to be pitched for to lodge in, and that in sign of mourning, the like did all the great ones, so that all the Assembly by little and little withdrew. The next morning as soon as it was day, the King made it to be proclaimed, that all persons of what condition soever they were, should upon pain of death dislodge speedily out of the Island, and that they which were Priests should return to the attendance of their cures, with this penalty, in care of contravention to be degraded from their dignity. Whereupon all the Priests went presently out of the Island, ninety of them excepted, who were deputed for the election of him that was to succeed in the place of the defunct. These same then assembled in the house of Gangsparo to acquit themselves of their charge, and for that in the two first days, which was the term limited to make this election, it could not succeed by reason of the diversity of opinions, and great contrariety that was found amongst them, which were to give their votes; the King thought fit, that out of those deputed ninety, there should nine be chosen, who alone should make the election. This resolution being taken, these nine continued five days, and as many nights together in continual prayer; in the mean time a world of offerings were made, and alms given; a great number of poor people were also clothed, and tables prepared, where all men that would might eat of free cost, and all this was accompanied with processions in every quarter. At last these nine being agreed in conformity of votes, elected for Roolim one Manichae Mouchan, who at that time was a Capizondo, or Prelate in the town of Digum of a Pagode, called Quiay Figrau, that is to say, god of the atoms of the Sun, of whom I have oftentimes spoken; he was a man of about threescore and eight years of age, accounted amongst them for an holy personage, very knowing in the customs and laws of those Sects of the Gentiles, and above all exceeding charitable to the poor: With this election the King and all the great ones of the Court remained very well satisfied: The King then speedily dispatched away the Chaumigrem his foster-brother, to whom he gave thereupon the title of Coutalanhaa, which signifies, the King's brother, to the end he might be the more honourably qualified with an hundred Lauleas, wherein was the Flower of all the Brama● Nobility, together with the nine Electors, for to go and fetch him which had been newly chosen to the dignity of Roolim: And having brought him nine days after with a great deal of respect and honour to a place called Tagalaa, some five leagues from the Isle of Mounay, the King met him with all the great men of the Court, besides a world of other people, and above two thousand vessels with oars. When he was come in this equipage where the new Roolim was, he prostrated himself before him, and kissing the ground three times, O thou holy pearl, said he unto him, which art in the midst of the Sun, breath forth upon me by an agreeable inspiration of the Lord of uncreated power, that I may not dread upon earth the insupportable yoke of mine enemies: At these words the new Roolim putting forth his hand to raise him from the ground, spoke thus unto him, Labour my Son that thy works may be pleasing to God, and I will pray for thee without ceasing. Hereupon the King rising up, the Roolim made him sit down by him, and stroked him three times with his hand on the head, which the King took for the greatest honour he could do him; then having said something unto him whi●h we could not hear, for that we were a little too far off, he blowed three times on the King's head▪ whilst he was on his knees again before him, and all the people laid flat on the earth. This done, he parted from that place amidst the applauses that were given him from all parts, and the sound of bells and instruments of music, and embarked himself in the Kings Laulea, where he was seated in a rich chair of gold, set with precious stones, and the King at his feet, which was also taken for a great honour done him by the Roolim; round about, and a little distant from him were twelve little boys attired in yellow satin, with scarves of silver Tinsel, golden Maces, and Sceptres in their hands: All along the sides of the vessel, instead of Mariners, stood the Lords of the Kingdom with guilt oars by them; and as well in the Poop as the Prow were two Quires of young striplings, apparelled in carnation satin, and having divers sorts of instruments in their hands, to the tune whereof they sung the praises of God. Some of our company observed, that one of their songs said thus; Children of a pure heart, praise this admirable and divine Lord, for as ●or me being a sinner I am not worthy to do it; and if that too be not permitted unto you let your eyes weep before his feet, that so you may render yourselves agreeable unto him. In the same manner they sung many other songs to the tune of their instruments, and with so much ardour and zeal, as if they had been Christians; it would have been able to have stirred up the devotion of them that heard them. After that the Rooli● was in this sumptuous ●ort arrived at the City of Martabano, he did not go to Land, as it had been resolved, because it was night, for it was not lawful for him at any hand to touch the ground with his feet, in regard of the great dignity of his person, but stayed till the next morning, at which time the King disimbarqued him first of all upon his own shoulders, and so too did the Princes and great Lordsof the Kingdom carry him alternatively to the Pagod● of Quiay Ponuedea, as being the greatest and most sumptuous of the whole City, in the midst whereof was a Theatre richly set forth of yellow satin, which is the livery of that sovereign dignity. There, out of a new ceremony, being laid all along upon a ●ittle bed of gold, he made as though he were dead, and then at the sound of a bell which gave three tolls, the Bonzes prostrated themselves all with their faces on the ground for the space of half an hour, during which time, all the assistants for a sign of sadness held their hands before their eyes, in saying aloud, Lord recall this thy servant to a new life, to the end we may have one to pray for us. Instantly thereupon they took him from thence, and put him into a Tomb adorned with the same livery, then chanting out certain, I know not what, very sorrowful words with tears in their eyes, they left him, after they had surrounded the Temple thrice, in a grave made expressly for that purpose, covered over with a cloth of black velvet, and environed about with dead men's heads. This done, they said certain prayers after their manner, weeping, which very much moved the King; and then all the throng of people that made a strange noise, being commanded to silence, they gave three tolls with a great bell, for a sign to all the rest of the bells in the City to answer them, as they did with so horrible and dreadful a din, that the earth even trembled therewith: After the ceasing of this noise, two Talagrepos, men of great reputation amongst them, and very well versed in their Laws, went up into two Pulpits, prepared expressly for them, and that were hung with rich Turkey Carpets, where they entertained their Auditors with the subject of this ceremony, and gave them the explication of every thing, making an ample relation unto them of the life and death of the deceased Roolim, and of the election of this same, together with the excellent qualities with which he was endued for to be raised to so high a charge whereunto he was called by a particular grace of God; to this they added many other things wherewith the people were exceedingly satisfied and contented; then the same bell having tolled three times more, the two Priests descended from their Pulpits, which together with all their furniture were presently burned with another new kind of ceremony, whereof I will forbear here making a relation, because it seems unnecessary to me to lose time in these superfluities, having said but too much already thereof. After all things were peaceable and quiet, and that for the space of five or six Credoes nothing had been spoken, there appeared coming from the next Temple, which was about a flight shot off, a very rich and sumptuous Procession of little children, attired all in white taffets, for a mark of their innocency and pureness; they had about their necks a number of jewels, chains of gold upon their legs in form of bracelets, white wax lights in their hands, and upon their heads bonnets embroidered with silk and gold, and set with Pearls, Rubies, and Saphires; in the middle of this Procession was a rich Canopy of cloth of gold, which twelve of those little children carried, environed round about with perfuming pans and censors of silver, from whence breathed forth excellent odours most pleasing to the sent. These little children played on divers instruments of music, and went on singing praises to God, and praying him to resuscitate this defunct to a new life. When they were arrived at the place where the Roolim lay, they drew to the shrine, and taking away the cloth wherewith it was covered, there came out of it a little child, which could not be above three or four years old, and although he was naked, yet was not his nakedness seen, because he was all covered over with gold and precious stones, and appeared in the same fashion as we are accustomed to paint Angels; he had also golden wings, and a very rich Crown upon his head: Whenas he was come from out the shrine, the Assistants being prostrated on the ground, fell to saying aloud with a voice that made those to tremble which heard them, Thou Angel of God, sent from heaven for our salvation, pray for us when thou returnest thither again. The King went instantly to this child, and having taken him in his arms with a great deal of respect, and a strange ceremony, as if he would show that he was not worthy to touch him, in regard he was an Angel sent from heaven, he set him on the brink of the grave, where after the child had taken away the cloth of black Velvet that covered him, whilst all were on their knees, with their hands and eyes lift up to heaven, he said aloud, as if he had spoken to him, Thou which hast been conceived in sin, amidst the misery and filthiness of the flesh, God commands thee by me, who am the least of his servants, that thou do resuscitate to a new life which may be agreeable unto him, always dreading the chastisement of his mighty hand, to the end that as the last gasp of thy life thou mayest not stumble like the children of the world; and that from this place where thou art extended stark dead, thou do rise up presently, because it hath been so decreed by the greatest of the greatest in the Temple of the earth, and come after me, and come after me, and come after me. The King thereupon took this child again in his arms, and then the Roolim rising up in the grave where he was, as it were amazed with this vision, fell on his knees before the child whom the King held, and said, I accept of this new grace from the hand of th● Lord, conformably to that which thou hast told me from him, obliging myself to be even till death an example of humility, and the least of all his, to the end the toads of the earth may not lose themselves in the abundance of the world. This said, the child rid himself again out of the King's arms, and going directly to the grave, he lent the Roolim his hand to help him out of it. Now he was scarce come forth, whenas they gave five tolls with a Bell, which was a sign for all the people to prostrate themselves on the ground the second time, saying, Blessed be thou, O Lord, for so great a grace; whereupon all the bells in the City began to ring, and all the Ordnance that were on the land to shoot of, as also those of above two thousand vessels that road at Anchor in the Port, from whence proceeded so strange a noise, as was most insupportable to the ears of them that heard it. CHAP. LXII. In what manner the Roolim was conducted to the Isle of Mounay, and put into possession of his dignity. THe new Roolim was conducted from that place in a chair of gold exceeding rich, and set with Precious Stones, which the principal Lords of the Kingdom carried upon their shoulders; the King in the mean time marched on foot before him, bearing a rich S●ymitar upright in his hand. In this equipage he accompanied him to his Palace, which was gorgeously furnished, and where he was lodged three days, during which time the preparations necessary for his entry was made in the Isle of Mounay. Now whilst he abode in the City of Martabano there were many sorts of inventions of great charge made by the Princes, Lord●, and Inhabitants; In two of those feasts the King himself was present in person, with a most sumptuous entertainment, which I shall not describe, because to say the truth I do not know how it did pass. The day being arrived, wherein the new Roolim, who is (as I have already declared) their Sovereign High Priest, was to make his entry into the Isle of Mounay, the whole Fleet of Seroos, jangoas, Lauleas, and such other vessels of divers sorts which were upon the river, to the number of two thousand and better, were ranked in two files, some a league and half in length, being the space between the City & the Island; so that of all those vessels joined together was form a street, the fairest that possibly could be seen, for every vessel was covered with boughs full of several dainty fruits, together with all kind of flowers, Tangets, Standards, and banners of silk, each one striving in emulation of another to gain their pretended Jubilee, and a plenary indulgence and absolution of all the robberies they had formerly committed, without being subject to the restitution of any thing whatsoever. This they did also to be absolved from an infinite of other abuses of their abominable lives, which I pass by in silence, as a matter unfit for devout ears, but conformable to their diabolical Sects, and the damnable intentions of those which have instituted them, for their whole manner of living is nothing but dissolution and excess in the lasciviousness of the flesh, as in like manner are all other infidels, and arch-heretiques. In the Roolims' company there were not above thirty Lauleas; who were replenished with a great number of the Nobility; as for him he was in a rich Seroo, seated in a Throne of silver, under a cloth of State of cloth of gold, and the King at his feet, as not being worthy to sit in a more eminent place; round about him were thirty children on their knees attired in Crimson Satin, with silver Maces on their shoulders, and twelve standing on their feet clothed with white Damask, having censors in their hands, from whence breathed forth most delicate perfumes. In the rest of the shipping followed two hundred of the most honourable Talagrepos, such as Archbishops and other Prelates may be amongst us, in the number of whom were also six or seven young Princes, all the Sons of Kings, comprehended. Now because these Vessels were so full of people as one could not row, they had fifteen Lauleas, or little skiffs, wherein the Supreme religious men of those nine Sects did row, to bring them the sooner to land. In this equipage, and in this order the new Roolim parted from the City of Martabano two hours before day, and continued his course amidst these Vessell●, which made, as I have delivered, a kind of street, and forasmuch as it was not yet day, there were a great number of Lanterns of different fashions placed amongst the boughs. As soon as he began to set forth, a Canon was shot off three times, at which sign there was such a noise of Bells, and great Ordnance, as also of divers sorts of very strange Instruments intermingled with the cries and acclamations of the people, as one would have thought that heaven and earth would have come together. When he was arrived at the Key, where he was to land, he was received with a solemn Procession by certain religious men that live in solitary places, and are called Menigr●pos, which are like to the Capucins in France, whom these Gentiles infinitely respect, by reason of their manner of living, for according to the rule which they observe, they use more abstinence by far then all the rest; These same, being some six or seven thousand in number, were all bare foot, and clothed with black Mat, to show their contempt of the world: upon their heads they wore the sculls and bones of dead men, and great cords about their necks, having all their faces daubed over with dirt, and a writing hanging upon them which contained these words, Mire, mire, do not cast thine eye on thy baseness, but on the recompenses which God hath promised to those that vilify themselves to serve him. When as they were very near to the Roolim, who received them very affably, they prostrated themselves with their faces down to the ground, and after they had continued so some time, the chiefest amongst them looking on the Roolim, May it please him▪ said he, from whose hand thou hast newly received so great a blessing, as to be the Head of all on the earth, to tender thee so good and so holy a man, that all thy works may be as pleasing unto him, as the innocency of children which hold their peace when their mother gives them the dug. Whereunto all the rest answered with a great noise of confused voices, Permit O Lord Almighty that it may be so. Passing on then, accompanied with this Procession, which the King for the greater honour governed himself, together with some of the principal personages, whom he called unto him for that purpose, he went directly to the place where the dead Roolim lay buried, and being arrived at his Tomb, he fell down flat with his face upon it, then having shed a great many tears, he said with a sad and doleful voice, as if he had spoken to the deceased, May it please him, who reigns in the beauty of the Stars, to make me deserve the honour to be thy Slave, to the end, that in the house of the Sun, where now thou recreatest thyself, I may serve as a broom to thy feet, for so shall I be made a Diamond of so high a price, as the world, and all the riches thereof together, shall not be able to equal the value of it: whereunto the Grepos answered, God grant it. Thereupon taking a pair of Beads which had belonged to the deceased, and that was upon the Tomb, he put it about his neck as a relic of great worth, giving as an Alms, six Lamps of silver, two Censors, and six or seven pieces of violet coloured Damask. This done, he retired unto his Palace, accompanied still with the King, the Princes, and great Lords of the Kingdom, as also with the Priests that were there assistant, from whom he presently rid himself, and then from out of the window he threw down upon the Assembly handfuls of Rice, as amongst the Papists they use to cast Holy Water, which all the people received upon their knees, with their hands lifted up. This Ceremony ended, which lasted very near three hours, they gave three tolls with a Bell, upon which Signal the Roolim retired for altogether, and so did the Vessels, and they that came in them, wherein all that day was wholly bestowed. About evening the King took his leave of the Roolim, and returned to the City, making directly the next morning towards Pegu, which was some eighteen leagues from thence, where he arrived the day following two hours within night, without making any entry or show, to testify the extreme grief he was in for the death of the late Roolim, whom it was said, he greatly affected. CHAP. LXIII. That which the King of Bramaa did after his arrival at the City of Pegu, together with his besieging of Savady. TWo and twenty days after the King of Bramaa arrived at the City of Pegu, he perceived by the Letter which his Ambassador brought him from the Calaminham, that he had concluded the League with him against the Siamon, yet in regard the season was not fit for him, either to commence that war, or to assail the Kingdom of Avaa, as he desired, he resolved to send his Foster-brother, unto whom, as I have already declared, he had given the title of lawful Brother, to the siege of Savady, which was some hundred and thirty Leagues from thence to the North-East. Having assembled an Army then of an hundred and fifty thousand men, amongst whom were thirty thousand strangers of divers Nations, and five thousand fight Elephants, besides three thousand others that carried the baggage, and the victuals, the Chaumigrem departed from Pegu with a Fleet of thirteen hundred rowing Vessels, the fifteenth of the month of March. Fourteen days after he arrived in the sight of Savady, and having cast Anchor near to a great Plain, called G●mpalaor, he remained there six days in attending the five thousand Elephants which were to come to him by land, who were no sooner arrived, but he began to besiege the Town, so that having begirt it round, he assaulted it three times in the open day, and retreated still with very great loss, as well in regard of the notable resistance which they within made against him, as of the extreme trouble his people were at in planting their ladders against the walls, by reason of their bad situation, which was all of Slate; whereupon consulting with his Commanders about what he should do, they were all of opinion to have it battered with the Canon on the weakest side, until that by the overthrow of some part of the wall, a breach might be made, whereby they might enter with more ease and less danger. This resolution was as soon executed as taken, so that the Ingineers fell to making of two manner of bulwarks on the outside upon a great Platform, composed of great beams and bavins, which in five days they raised up to such an height, as it surpassed the wall two fathom at the least. This done, they planted on each bulwark twenty great pieces of Ordnance, wherewith they began to batter the Town so violently, that in a little time they beat down a pane of the wall; and besides those pieces of battery, there were above three hundred Falcons that shot incessantly, with an intention only to kill those that were in the streets, as indeed they made a great havoc, which was the cause that seeing themselves so ill-intreated, and their people slain in that manner, they resolved, like valiant men as they were, to sell their lives as dearly as they could, so that one morning having sallied forth by the same breach of the wall which the Canon had made, they gave so valiantly upon those of the Camp, that in less than an hour they almost routed the Bramaas whole Army. Now because it began to be day, the Savadis thought it fit to re-enter into the Town, leaving eight thousand of their enemies dead on the place. After this they repaired the breach in a very little time by the means of a rampire of earth, which they made up with bavins and other materials, that was strong enough to resist the Canon. Hereupon the Chaumigrem seeing the bad success he had had, resolved to make war, both upon the places near about, as also upon the frontiers that were furthest off from the Town, for which purpose he sent Diosa●ay, high Treasurer of the Kingdom, whose Slaves we Portugal's were, Colonel of five thousand men to spoil a certain Borough, called Valentay, which furnished the besieged Town with provisions; but this voyage was so infortunate unto him, that before his arrival at the designed place, his forces were by two thousand Savadis, whom he encountered by the way, all cut in pieces in less than half an hour, not one escaping with life that fell into the enemy's hands. Nevertheless it pleased our Lord that amidst this defeat we saved ourselves by the favour of the night, and without knowing whither we went, we took the way of a very craggy mountain, where we marched in exceeding great pain three days and an half, at the end whereof we entered into certain Moorish Plains, where we could meet with no path or way, nor having other company than Tigers, Serpents, and other savage beasts, which put us into a mighty fear. But as our God, whom incessantly we invoked with tears in our eyes is the true guide of travellers, he out of his infinite mercy permitted, that at length we perceived one evening a certain fire towards the East, so that continuing our course towards that place where we saw this light, we found ourselves the next morning near to a great Lake, where there were some Cottages, which in all likelihood were inhabited by very poor people; howbeit not daring to discover ourselves as yet, we hid us all that day in certain hanging precipices that were very boggy, and full of Horseleeches, which made us all gore blood. As soon as it was night we fell to marching again until the next morning, whenas we arrived near to a great river, all alongst the which we continued going for five days together. At last with much pain we got to another Lake, that was far greater than the former, upon the bank whereof was a little Temple in the form of an Hermitage, and there we found an old Hermit, who gave us the best entertainment that possibly he could: This old man permitted us to repose ourselves two days with him, during which time we demanded many things of him that made for our purpose; whereunto he always answered according to the truth, and told us, that we were still within the Territories of the King of Savady, that this Lake was called Oreg●ant●r, that is to say, the opening of the night, and the Hermitage, the God of succour. Whereupon being desirous to know of him the signification of this abuse, he laid his hand on an horse of brass, that stood for the Idol upon the Altar, and said that he often read in a book, which entreated of the foundation of the Kingdom, that some two hundred, thirty, and seven years before, this Lake being a great Town, called O●umhaleu, a King that was named Ava● had taken it in war, that in acknowledgement of this victory, his Priests, by whom he was wholly governed, counselled him to sacrifice unto Quiay Gua●or, the God of war, all the young male children which had been made captives; and in case he did not so, they would when they became men regain the Kingdom from him. The King apprehending the event of this threatening, caused all these children, being fourscore and five thousand in number, to be brought all into one place, and so upon a day that was kept very solemn amongst them, he made them to be put most inhumanely to the edge of the sword, with an intent to have them burned the next morning in Sacrifice; but the night following there came a great earthquake, and such lightning and fire fell from heaven upon the Town, as within less than half an hour it was quite demolished, and all that was in it reduced to nothing, so that by this just judgement of God, the King, together with all his were strucken dead, not so much as one escaping, and besides them thirty thousand Priests in like manner, who ever since during all the New Moons are heard to cry and roar so dreadfully, that all the inhabitants thereabouts were ready to go besides themselves with fear, by reason whereof the Country was utterly depopulated, no other habitation remaining therein, save only fourscore and five Hermitages, which were erected in memory of the fourscore and five thousand children, whom the King had caused to be butchered through the evil counsel of his Priests. CHAP. LXIIII A continuation of the success which we had in this voyage, with my departure from Goa to Zunda, and what passed during my abode there. WE passed two days in this Hermitage, where, as I declared before, we were very well entertained by the Hermit; §. 1. the third day after betimes in the morning we took our leave of him, and departed from thence not a little afflicted with that which we had heard, and so all the same day and the night following we continued on our way along by the river; the next morning we arrived at a place where were a great many of sugar canes, of which we took some, for that we had nothing else to nourish us withal. In this manner we marched still along by this river, which we kept for a guide of our voyage, because we judged that how long soever it were, yet would it at last ingulfe itself in the Sea, where we hoped that our Lord would raise us up some remedy for our miseries. The day ensuing we arrived at a village called Pommiseray, where we hid ourselves in a very thick wood from being descried by passengers, and two hours within night we continued our design in following the current of this river, being resolved to take our death in good part, if it should please God to send it us, for to put an end to so many sufferings as we had undergone day and night; and without lying, the apprehension and visions of this last end troubled us more than death itself, wherewith we imagined ourselves to be already ensnared. At the end of seventeen days, that this painful and sad voyage had lasted, God showed us so much grace, that during the obscurity of a very rainy night, we discovered a certain light little more than a Falcon shot before us, the fear we were in at the first that we were near some Town, made us to stand still for a good space, without knowing what to resolve upon, until we observed that this light seemed to move, whereby we conjectured that it was some Vessel which went from one port to another; as indeed half an hour after we perceived one, wherein there were nine persons, who approaching to the bank of the river, near to the place where we were, landed all in a Creek that was there in the form of an Haven, and presently making a fire, they began to prepare their supper, which was no sooner ready, but they fell to eating with great demonstrations of mirth, wherein they bestowed a pretty good time. At length when they were well replenished with meat and drink, it happened that all nine of them, amongst whom there were three women, fell fast asleep; whereupon seeing that we could not find a more favourable occasion to make our benefit of this adventure, we went all eight of us very softly into the barque, that stuck half in the Ouze, and was tied fast to a great stake, which pushing forth with our shoulders we set afloat, and then embarking ourselves in it with all speed, we began to row down the river with as little noise as possibly we could make. Now in regard the current of the water and the wind were both very favourable unto us, we found ourselves the next morning above ten leagues from the place whence we parted, namely near to a Pagode, called Quiay Hinarel, that is to say, the God of Rice, where we met but only with one man and seven and thirty women, the most of them old, and Religionaries of this Temple, who received us with a great deal of charity, although in my opinion they did it rather out of fear of us, than any will that they had to do ●s good. Having questioned them about many things which served for our purpose, they could give us no pertinent answer thereunto, alleging still, that they were but poor women, who upon a solemn vow had renounced all things in the world, and confined themselves into this enclosure, where they bestowed all their time in continual prayer to Quiay Ponuedea, which moves the clouds of heaven, that he would be pleased to give them rain, whereby their grounds might be made fruitful to produce them abandance of Rice. In this place we spent all the day in caulking our barque, and furnishing ourselves at these religious woman's cost, with Rice, Sugar, French Beans, Onions, and some smoak-dried flesh, wherewith they were sufficiently provided. Being parted from hence about an hour within night, we continued our course with our Oars and Sails for seven whole days together, without so much as once daring to touch the Land, so much were we in fear of some disaster that might easily arrive to us from those places which we see all alongst the river: But as it is impossible to avoid that here below which is determined there above, just at the instant, as we were continuing on our course, all confused as we were, and in a perpetual alarm, by reason of the danger that was always present before our eyes, as well for that which we see, as for that we were in doubt of, our ill hap would have it, that an hour before day, as we passed through the mouth of a Channel, three Paraos of Pirates assaulted us with such violence, and with so many different sorts of Darts, which they showered upon us, that within less than two Credoes they had killed three of our companions; as for us five that remained, we cast ourselves into the Sea all bloody as we were with the wounds which we had received, whereof two others died a little after: When as we were got ashore we hid ourselves in the woods, where we passed all that day in lamenting our present mishap after so many fortunes as we had run thorough before time. Thus wounded as we were, parting from thence in more hope of death than life, we proceeded on our way by Land, with so much pain and irresolution concerning what we were to do, as we fell many times a weeping, without being able to comfort one another, in regard of the small likelihood there was of saving our lives by any humane means. As we were reduced to this deplorable estate, with two of our companions ready to die, it pleased our Lord (whose succour doth ordinarily supply our defects) that in a place where we found ourselves upon the bank of the water, there chanced to pass by a Vessel, wherein there was a Christian woman, named Violenta, who was married to a Pagan, to whom this Vessel appertained, which he had laden with Cotton Wool to sell off at Cosmin; this woman no sooner perceived us, but moved with pity at the sight of us, jesus, cried she, these are Christians which I behold! that said, she caused the Vessel wherein she was to come to the shore, and leaping on Land, together with her husband, they fell both of them to embracing us with tears in their eyes, and then made us to be embarked with them; presently whereupon this virtuous Dame took a care to have our wounds dressed, and provided us of clothes the best that she could, rendering us many other good offices of a true and charitable Christian: Then setting aside all fear, we parted from this place with all speed, & five days after through God's grace we arrived safely at the Town of Cosmin, which is a part of the Sea in the Kingdom of P●gu, where in the house of this good Christian woman we were as well looked unto, that in a short time we found ourselves thoroughly cured of all our hurts. Now whereas there is never any want in the grace which God doth to his creatures, it pleased him that at that very time we met in this Port with a ship, whereof Luis de Montorrayo was Master, who was upon the point of setting sail for Bengala, so that after we had taken our leave of our Hostess, to whom we rendered many thanks for all the benefits which we had received of her, we embarked ourselves with the said Luis de Montarroyo, who likewise entreated us exceeding well, and furnished us abundantly with all that was necessary for us. At our arrival at the Port of Cha●igan in the Kingdom of Bengala, where there was at that time many Portugals, I instantly embarked myself in the foist of a certain Merchant, called F●rnando Caldeyra, who was bound for Goa, where it pleased God I arrived in good health. There I found Pedro de Faria, who had been Captain of Malaca, and by whom I had been sent as Ambassador to the Chaiubanbaa of Mar●abano, as I have declared heretofore. To him I rendered an exact account of all that had passed, for which he showed himself very sorrowful, and accommodated me with divers things, whereunto his conscience and generosity obliged him, in regard of the goods which I had lost for his occasion. A little after, that I might not lose the opportunity of the season, I embarked myself with an intention to go to the Southward, and once more to try my fortune in the Kingdoms of China and japan, to see if in those countries where I had so many times lost my coat, I could not find a better than that I had on. Being embarked at Goa in a Junck that belonged to Pedro de Faria, §. 2. which was bound in way of trade for Zunda, I arrived at Malaca the same day that Ruy vas Pereyra, termed Marramaque died, who was then Captain of the fortress there. Being departed from that place to go to Zunda, at the end of seventeen days I arrived at Banta, where the Portugals are accustomed to traffic. And because there was at that time great scarcity of pepper over all the country, and that we came thither of purpose for it, we were constrained to pass the winter there, with a resolution to go for China the year following. We had been almost two months in this Port, where we exercised our commerce very peaceably, whenas from the King of Demaa, Emperor of all the Islands of jaoa, Angenia, B●la, Madura, and of the rest of the Islands of that Archipelago, there landed in this country a widow woman, named Nhay Pombaya, about the age of threescore years, who came as Ambassador to Tagaril▪ King of Zu●da, that was also his Vassal as well as all the rest of that Monarchy, for to tell him that he was within the term of six weeks to be in person at the town of japara, where he was then making preparation to invade the Kingdom of Passaruan. When this woman arrived in this Port, the King went in person to the Vessel where she was, from whence he carried her to his Palace with great pomp, and put her into the company of his wife for her better entertainment, whilst he himself retired to another lodging farther off to do her the more honour. Now that one may know the reason wherefore this ambassage was executed rather by a woman then a man, you must note, that it hath always been the custom of the Kings of this Kingdom to treat of the most important matters of their State by the mediation of women, especially when it concerns peace, which they observe not only in particular messages that are sent by the Lords to their Vassals, such as this was, but also in matter of public and general affairs, which is performed by ambassage from one King to another, and all the reason they give for it, is; That God hath given more gentleness and inclination to courtesy, yea and more authority to women then to men, who are severe, as they say, and by consequent less agreeable to those unto whom they are sent. Now it is their opinion, that every one of those women which the Kings are accustomed to send about affairs of importance, aught to have certain qualities for well executing of an ambassage, and worthily discharging the Commission which is granted to them: for first of all, they say, That she must not be a Maid▪ for fear she chance to lose her honour in going out of her house, because that even as with her beauty she contents every one, so by the same reason she may be a motive of discord and unquietness in matters where unity is required, rather than an access to concord, and the peace which is pretended unto. To this they add, that she must be married, or at leastwise a widow after a lawful marriage; that if she have had children, she must have a Certificate how she hath given them all suck with her own breasts, alleging thereupon, that she who hath borne children, and doth not nourish them if she can, is rather a carnal, voluptuous, corrupted, and dishonest woman, than a true mother. And this custom is observed so exactly over all this country, principally amongst persons of quality, that if a mother hath a child which she cannot give suck unto for some valuable consideration, she must make an attestation thereof, as of a thing very serious, and much importing her honour. That if being young too she happens to lose her husband, and becomes a widow, she must for the better testifying of her virtue enter into Religion, to the end she may thereby show, that she did not formerly marry for the pleasure which she expected from her marriage, but to have children, according to the pure and honest intention, wherewith God joined together the first married couple in the terrestrial Paradise. Furthermore, that there might be nothing to be found fault with in the purity of their marriage, and that it might be altogether conformable to the Law of God, they say, that after a woman is with-child, she ought no longer to have the company of her husband, because the same could not then be but dishonest and sensual. To these conditions they add many others which I will pass over in silence, for that I think it unreasonable to use prolixity in matters that I hold worthy of excuse, if I do not relate them at length. In the mean time after that Nhay Pombaya had delivered her Embassage to the King of Zunda, as I have declared before, and treated with him about the occasion which brought her thither, she presently departed from this Town of Ba●ta; whereupon the King having speedily prepared all things in readiness, he set sail with a Fleet of thirty Calaluzes, and ten Iuripang●es, well furnished with ammunition and victual, in which forty vessels there were seven thousand fight men, besides the Mariners and Rowers. Amongst this number were forty portugals, of six and forty that we were in all, in regard whereof they did us many particular favours in the business of our Merchandise, and publicly confessed, that they were much obliged to us for following them as we did, so that we should have had little reason to have excused ourselves from accompanying them in this war. CHAP. XLIV. The expedition of the Pangueyran, Emperor of Jaoa, and King of Demaa, against the King of Passeruan, and all that which passed in this war. §. 1. THe King of Zunda being departed from the Port of Banta the fifth day of january, in the year one thousand five hundred forty and six, arrived on the nineteenth of the same at the Town of japura, where the King of Demaa, Emperor of this Island of jaoa, was then making his preparatives, having an army on foot of eight hundred thousand men. This Prince being advertised of the King of Zundaes' coming, who was his brother-in-law and vassal, he sent the King of Panaruca, Admiral of the Fleet, to receive him, who brought along with him an hundred and threescore Calaluzes, and ninety Lanchares, full of Luffons from the Isle of Borneo: With all this company he arrived where the King of Zunda was, who entertained him very courteously, and with a great deal of honour. Fourteen days after our coming to this Town of japara, the King of Demaa went and embarked himself for the Kingdom of Passar●an in a Fleet of two thousand and seven hundred sails, amongst the which were a thousand high-built Juncks, and all the rest were Vessels with oars. The eleventh of February he arrived at the river of Hicandurea, which is at the entrance of the bar; and because the King of Panaruca, Admiral of the Fleet, perceived that the great Vessels could not pass unto the Port, which was two leagues off, by reason of certain shelves of sand that were in divers parts of the river, he caused all those that were in them to be disimbarqued, and the other V●ssells with oars to go and anchor in the road before the Town, with an intention to burn the Ships that were in the Port, which indeed was accordingly executed. In this Army was the Emperor Pangu●yran in person, accompanied with all the grandees of the Kingdom; the King of Zunda, his brother-in-law who was General of the Army, went by land with a great part of the forces, and being all arrived at the place where they meant to pitch their Camp, they took care in the first place for the fortifying thereof, and for placing the Canon in the most commodious places to batter the Town, in which labour they bestowed the most part of the day. As for the night ensuing it was spent in rejoicings, and keeping good watch until such time as it was day, whenas each Captain applied himself to that whereunto his duty obliged him, all in general employing themselves according to the ingineers directions, so that by the second day the whole Town was environed with high Pallisadoes, and their Platforms fortified with great beams, whereupon they planted divers great pieces of Ordnance, amongst the which were Eagles and Lions of metal, that the Achens and Turks had cast by the invention of a certain Renegado, born in the Kingdom of Algar●es, appertaining to the Crown of Portugal, and by reason this wicked wretch had changed his belief, he called himself Coia Geinal, for as for the name which he had before when he was a Christian, I am contented to pass it over in silence for the honour of his Family, being indeed of no mean extraction. In the mean time the besieged having taken notice how ill-advised they had been in suffering the enemies to labour two whole days together peaceably in fortifying of their Camp, without any impeachment of theirs; and taking the same for a great affront, they desired their King to permit them to fall upon them the night following, alleging how it was probable that men wearied with labour could not make any great use of their arms, nor be able to resist this first impetuosity. The King, who at that time commanded the Kingdom of Passaruan, was young, & endued with many excellent qualities which made him to be exceedingly beloved of all his subjects, for as it was reported of him, he was very liberal, no manner of Tyrant, exceedingly affable to the common people, a friend to the poor, and so charitable towards Widows, that if they acquainted him with their necessities, he relieved them instantly, and did them more good than they asked of him. Besides these perfections that were so recommendable, he possessed some others so conformable to men's desires, as there was not any one that would not have exposed his life a thousand times for his service if need ●ad been. Furthermore he had none but choice men with him, even the flower of all his Kingdom, besides many strangers, upon whom he conferred much wealth, honour, and many graces, which he accompanied with good words, that being indeed the means whereby the minds both of great and small are so strongly gained, that they make them Lions of sheep, whereas carrying ones self other ways, of generous Lions, they are made fearful hares. This King then examining the request wh●ch his people made unto him, and referring himself to the advice of the ancientest and most prudent Councillors of his State which were with him, there was a great contention about the success that the affairs might have, but in the end, by the counsel of all in general, it was concluded That in case ●ortune should be altogether adverse unto them in this sally which they m●ant to make against their enemies, yet would it be a much less evil, and less considerable affront, then to see the King so besieged by vile people, who against all reason would reduce them by force to quit their belief, wherein they had been bred by their Fathers, to embrace another new one by the suscitation of the Farazes, who place their salvation in washing their parts behind, in not eating of swine's flesh, and marrying of seven wives, whereby the best advised may easily judge▪ that God was so much their enemy, as he would not assist them in any thing, seeing that with so great offence they would under pretext of Religion, and with reasons so full of contradiction, compel their King to become a Mahometan, and render himself tributary to them To these reasons they added many others, which the King, and they that were with him found to be so good, as they all with one common consent agreed thereunto, which is en evident mark, that it is a thing no less natural for a good Subject to expose his life for his King, then for a virtuous wife to conserve her chastity for the husband which God hath given her: This being so, said they, a matter of so great importance was no longer to be deferred, but we all in general, and each one in particular, are by this sally to make demonstration of the extreme affection which we bear to our good King, who we are assured will never be unmindful of them that shall fight best for his defence, which is all the inheritance we desire to leave to our children Whereupon it was resolved that the night following they should make a sally upon their enemies. Whereas the joy, §. 1. which this designed sally brought to all the inhabitants of the Town was general, they never stayed till they were called, but two hours after midnight, and before the time which the King had appointed, they assembled all in a great place, which was not far from the Royal Palace, and where they of the country had accustomed to keep their Fairs and to solemnize their most remarkable feasts on those principal days which were destined to the invocation of their Pagodes. The King in the mean time, wonderfully content to see such heat of courage in them, of seventy thousand inhabitants which were in the Town, drew out twelve thousand only for this enterprise, and divided them into four companies, each of them containing three thousand, whereof an Uncle of the Kings was General, a man whom experience had rendered very knowing in such undertake, and that marched in the head of the first company. Of the second was Captain another of the principal Ma●dacins; Of the third a stranger, a Champaa by Nation, and born in the Island of Barneo; and of the fourth one called Panbacaluio; all of them good Commanders, very valiant, and exceeding expert in matters of war. When they were all ready, the King made them a Speech, whereby he succinctly represented unto them the confidence which he had in them touching this enterprise. After which, the better to encourage them, and assure them of his love, he took a cup of gold and drunk to them all, causing the chiefest of them to pledge him, and craving pardon of the rest, for that the time would not permit them to do the like. This gracious carriage of his so encouraged the soldiers, that without further delay the most part of them went and anointed themselves with Mi●hamundi, which is a certain confection of an odoriferous oil, wherewith these people are accustomed to frote themselves with, when they have taken a full resolution to die, and these same are ordinarily called A●acos. The hour being come wherein this sally was to be made, four of twelve gates that were in the Town were opened, through each of the which sallied forth one of the four Captains with his company, having first sent out for Spies into the Camp six Orobalons, of the most valiant that were about the King, whom he had honoured with new titles, and with such special favours, as use to give courage to them that want it, and to increase it in them that are endued with some resolution. The four Captains marched a little after the six Spies, and went and joined all together in a certain place, where they were to fight with the enemies: whereupon falling into the midst of them with a marvellous impetuosity, they fought so valiantly, that in less than an hour's time, which the fight endured, the twelve thousand Passaruans left above thirty thousand enemies upon the place, besides those that were wounded, which were in a far greater number, and whereof many died afterwards. Furthermore they took prisoner three Kings, and eight Pates, which are as the Dukes amongst us, the King of Zunda too, with whom we forty portugals were, could not so save himself, but that he was hurt with a Lance in three places, a number being killed in defending him. Thus was the Camp put in so great disorder, as it was almost destroyed, the Pa●gueyran himself being wounded with a dart, and constrained to leap into the water, where little lacked but that he had been drowned. Whereby one may see what the force of a number of resolute and fearless men is against such as are surprised when least they think of it; for before that the enemies could know what they did, or the Commanders could put their soldiers into order, they were twice routed. The next morning, as soon as the day gave them leave to know the truth of the business, the Passeruans retired into the Town, where they found that they had not lost above nine hundred of their men, nor more than two or three thousand hurt. It is scarcely to be believed how much the King of Demaa was grieved with the disaster of the former day, §. 3. as well for the affront which he received from those within by the loss of his people, as for the bad success of the beginning of this siege, whereof he seemed in some sort to impute the fault unto our King of Zunda, saying that this fortune had happened by the bad directions he had given to the Sentinels. Now after he had commanded that the wounded should be dressed, and the dead buried, he called to Council all the Kings, Princes, and Captains of the forces that he had, both by Land and Water, unto whom he said, That he had made a solemn vow, and oath upon the M●zapho of Mahomet, which is their Alcoran, or the book of their Law, never to raise the siege from before this Town, until he had utterly destroyed it, or lost his own State therein. Whereunto he added, That he protested he would put to death whomsoever should oppose this resolution of his, what reason soever he could allege thereupon; which begot so great a terror in the minds of all that heard him, as there was not one that dared contradict his will, but contrarily they infinitely approved and commended it. He used then all kind of diligence for the new fortifying of the Camp with good ditches, strong Pallisadoes, & divers Bulworks made of stone and timber, garnished on the inside with their Platforms, where he caused a great many of Canons to be planted, so that by this means the Camp was stronger than the Town itself, in regard whereof the besieged did often times jeer the Sentinels without, telling them, That it must needs be concluded they were notorious cowards, since instead of besieging their enemies like valiant men, they besieged themselves like feeble women, wherefore they bid them returns home to their houses, where it was fitter for them to fall to spinning, then to make war. These were the jeers which they ordinarily put upon the besiegers, who were greatly offended with them. This Town had been almost three months besieged, and yet had the enemies advanced but little, for during all that time, wherein there had been five batteries, and three assaults given to it, with above a thousand ladders planted against the walls, the besieged defended themselves still like valiant and courageous men, fortifying themselves with counter-mires which they opposed to the breaches, which they made with pieces of timber taken from the houses; so that all the power of the Pangueyran, which (as I have declared) was about eight hundred thousand men, whereof the number was much diminished, was not able to give him entrance into it. Hereupon the principal Engineer of the Camp, who was a Renegado of Maillorque, seeing that this affair had not a success answerable to what he had promised the King, he resolved to take another far different course. To that effect, with a great amass of earth and bavins he framed a kind of a Platform, which he fortified with six rows of beams, and wrought so, that in nine days he raised it a fathom higher than the wall▪ that done, he planted forty great pieces of Canon upon it, together with a number of Bases and Faulconets, wherewith he fell to battering the Town in such sort, as the besieged were therewith mightily damnified, so that the King perceiving that this invention of the enemy was the only thing in the world that could most incommodate him in the Town, he resolved by the means of ten thousand Volunteers, who had offered themselves unto him for that purpose, and to whom for ● mark of honour he gave the title of Tigers of the world, to attack this Fort, and they that were upon it; this matter was no sooner resolved upon, but was presently put in execution, and for the better encouragement of them, the King himself would be their Captain, albeit this whole enterprise was governed by the four Panari●ons, which had formerly commanded in the first sally. Having put themselves into the field then with the rising of the Sun, they fought so valiantly without any fear at all of the dreadful Ordnance; which were planted on the Platform, as in less than two Credoes they got to the top of it, and there setting on the enemies, who were thirty thousand in number, they defeated them all in a very short time. The Pangueyran of Pate seeing his forces thus routed, ran thither in person with twenty thousand choice soldiers, intending to beat the Passeruans from the place which they had gained, but they defended it so courageously, as is not possible to express it in words. This bloody battle having endured till evening, the Passeruan, who had lost the most part of his men, made his retreat into the Town by the gate that was next to the Platform, whereunto having first set fire in six or seven places, it took hold of some barrels of powder, whereof there was great store there, which inflamed it so terribly in several parts, as it was not possible to approach unto it by the space of a flight shoot; this accident was very favourable to the besieged, because the enemies were thereby kept from joining together, and so the Town was for this time preserved from the great danger wherewithal it was threatened; howbeit the Passeruans scap't not so scot-free, but that of the ten thousand Volunteers employed in this service, six thousand remained dead on the top of the Platform. True it is, that in the Pangueyran part there was above forty thousand killed, amongst the whhich were three thousand strangers of divers Nations, the most part Achems, Turks, and Malabares, as also twelve Pates, or Dukes, five Kings, with many other Commanders, and men of quality. All this night was spent on both sides in lamentations and complaints, as also in dressing the wounded, and casting the dead into the river. §. 4. The next morning as soon as it was day the Pangueyran of Pata seeing the bad success which his enterprise had had until that present, could not for all that be drawn to desist from it, so that he caused all his soldiers to prepare themselves for a new assaulting of the Town, being persuaded that the besieged had no great force lef● to defend them withal, considering their walls were overthrown in many places, their ammunition spent, the most part of their people slain, and their King dangerously hurt, at leastwise it was so reported. Now the better to be assured thereof, he caused some of his forces to be laid in ambush in certain avenues, by which he had been advertised, that divers of the frontizing inhabitants would pass, to bring unto the Town Eggs, Pullen, and other such like things necessary for the recovery of sick persons. Now they, whom he had sent for that purpose, arrived at the Camp a little before day, and brought nine prisoners with them, amongst the which there was one Portugal. After than that they had racked and tortured the other eight, & were come to do as much to the Portugal, who was the last, he imagined that it may be they would show him some favour if he declared unto them what he was, so that upon the first torment he cried out, That he was a Portugal, he not knowing hitherto any thing of us, nor we of him: Our King of Zunda no sooner heard this Declaration of his, but he commanded him to be taken from the rack, and instantly sent for us to know whether that which this wretch delivered was true; whereupon six of us that were the least hurt went unto him, and at the first sight we judged him by his countenance to be a Portugal, so that prostrating ourselves before the King, we besought him to give us this man, representing unto him, that in regard he was of our Nation we were bound to make this suit for him, which he very willingly granted us, and so we in way of thankfulness kissed his feet. After we had received him, we carried him to the place where our companions lay wounded, and then we would needs understand of him whether he were a Portugal indeed, because he looked so strangely as we could not well know him, no not by his speech; but after he was a little come to himself, and that he had shed a many of tears, My Masters, said he unto us, I assure you that I am a Christian, and a Portugal, both by father and mother, although as you see I do not wear the habit of one; my country is Penamocor, and my name Nuno Rodriguez Taborda; I went out of Portugal in the year one thousand five hundred and thirteen, after I had enrolled myself in the Marshals Army, and in the Ship called the S. Joano, whereof Ruy Diaz Pereyra was Captain. Now because in those first beginnings I showed myself in all occasions a worthy man, Alphonso d'Albuquerque made me Captain of the four brigandines which he had in the Indias at that time; afterwards I was present with him at the taking of Goa and Malaca; withal I laboured in the foundations of Ormuz and Calcutta, never failing in any of the services performed in those times by that famous Commander, to whom so many different Nations do at this day give the title of Great. I continued the same proof of my courage during the Governments of Lopo, Suarez, of Diego, Lopez de Siqueyra, and of other Governors of the Indias, even unto Don An●iaque de Menesez, who succeeded to that charge by the death of the Vice Roy Vasco de Gama; who at the entrance into his Government made Francisco de Sa General of a Fleet of twelve Vessels, wherein were three hundred men which he was to make use of for the building of a Fort at Zunda, in regard of the fear they were then in of the Spaniards, who at that time went to the Molucca●s by the new way which Magellan ●ad discovered unto them; in this Fleet I was made Captain of a Brigandine, called the S. Jorge, where I commanded over six and twenty very courageous and valiant men. We departed then from the bar of Bintan, whenas Pedro de Mascarenhas destroyed it; but when we arrived at the Isle of Lingua, we were beaten with so furious a tempest, that unable to resist it, we were forced to make towards Jaoa, where of seven rowing Vessels that we were, six were lost, and my sins would have it that mine was one of that number; besides for my greater infortune, the tempest cast my Brigandine upon the coast of this Country, where I have now remained these three and twenty years, not one of all that were in the Vessel escaping save three of my companions, who are every one dead but myself, and would to God it had pleased him to show me the grace that I had been so too, that so I might not have offended him as I have done since, for seeing myself continually pressed by th●se Gentiles to follow their pernicious errors, I withstood them a long time, but whereas the flesh is frail, being very poor, far from my country, and without hope of liberty, my sins made me at their entreaties to yield to that which they desired of me with so much importunity; by reason whereof this King's Father did me many great favours; and being sent for yesterday from a place where I was to look unto two of the chiefest Gentlemen of this country, it pleased God that I fell into the hands of these dogs, to the end I should no longer be one, for which the Lord be blessed for evermore. This man's discourse exceedingly astonished us, and as much as the novelty of so strange an accident required, so that having comforted him as well as we could in such terms as we thought were necessaty for the time wherein we were, we asked him whether he would go with us to Zunda, and from thence to Malaca, where God might show him the grace to die in his service like a good Christian. Whereunto having made answer, that he desired nothing more, and that he had never had other design, we gave him another habit, because he was clothed like a Pagan, and kept him always with us as long as the siege lasted. CHAP. XLV. The death of the King of Demaa by a very strange accident, and that which arrived thereupon. TO come again now to our history, you are to understand, that the Pangueyran of Pata, King of Demaa, being certified by some of the enemies, §. 1. whom his men had taken prisoners, of the piteous estate whereunto the besieged were reduced, the most part of them dead, their ammunition failing, and their King dangerously hurt; all these things together carried him more ardently than ever to the assault, which he had purposed with himself to give to the besieged Town. He resolved then to scale it in plain day, and to assault it with more violence than before, so that instantly great preparations were made over all the Camp, where divers Sergeants at Arms, on horseback, and carrying Maces on their shoulders, went proclaiming aloud after the men of war had been made to assemble together with the sound of trumpets, The Pangueyran of Pata by the power of him who hath created all things, Lord of the Lands which environ the Seas, being willing to discover unto all in general the secret of his soul▪ doth let you know, that nine days hence he will have you be in a readiness, to the end that with the courages of Tigers, and redoubled forces, you assist him in the assault which he intends to give unto the Town, for a recompense whereof he liberally promiseth to do great favours, as well in money, as in honourable and remarkable titles, those to the five soldiers▪ which fi●st of all shall plant colours on the enemy's walls, or that shall perform actions which shall be agreeable to him. Whereas contrarily, they which do not carry themselves valiantly in this enterprise, conformably to his pleasure, shall be executed by the way of justice, without any regard had to their condition. This Ordinance of the Kings, full of menaces, being published over every part of the Camp, put them into such an alarm, as the Commanders began incontinently to make themselves ready, and to provide all things necessary for this assault, without scarce taking any rest either day or night, making withal so great a noise, by intermingling their hues and cries with the sounds of drums, and other instruments of war, as it could not be heard without much terror. In the mean time, whereas of the nine days, destined for the purpose aforesaid, seven were already p●st, so as there rested no more but two, at the end whereof an assault was to be given to the Town, one morning as the Pangueyran sat in Council, to resolve of the affairs of this siege with the principal Lords of his Army, as also of the means, of the time, and places, whereby they were to assault the Town, and of other necessary things, it was said, that from the diversity of opinions, which the one and the other had, there arose so great a contention amongst them, as the King was constrained to take every one's advice in writing. During this time, whereas he had always near about him a young Page, who carried Bethel, an herb whose leaves are like unto Plantain, which these Pagans are accustomed to chaw, because it makes them have a sweet breath, and also purges the humours of the stomach; he asked this Page then for some of it, who at first seemed not to hear him, being much about twelve or thirteen years old, for I hold it fit to make mention of his age, in regard of that I am to say of him hereafter. Now to return to the Pangueyran, as he was continuing his discourse with his Council of War; through much speaking, and somewhat in choler, his mouth became dry, so that he asked the Page again for some Bethel, which he ordinarily carried in a little box of gold, but he heard him no more this second time, than he had done the first; insomuch as the King having asked him for some the third time, one of the Lords that was near to the Page pulled him by the sleeve, and bid him give the King some Bethel, which immediately he did, and falling on his knees he presented him with the box which he had in his hands; the King then took two or three leaves of it, as he used to do, and without being otherwise angry, giving him a light touch with his hand on the head, art thou deaf, said he unto him, that thou couldst not hear me? and thereupon reentered into discourse with them of his Council. Now because these jaoas are the most punctilious and perfidious Nation of the world, and that withal they of this country hold it for the greatest affront that can be done thena, when one gives them a touch on the head, this young Page imagining that the King had touched him so out of a mark of so great a contempt, as he should thereby be made infamous for ever, though indeed none of the company took notice of it, he went aside weeping and sobbing by himself, and in the end resolved to revenge the injury which the King had done him, so that drawing out a little knife which he wore at his girdle, he stabbed the King with it into the midst of the left pap, and so because the blow was mortal, the King fell instantly down on the ground, not able to say any more than these two or three words, I am dead: wherewithal those of the Council were so frighted, as it is not possible to express it. After that this emotion was a little calmed, they fell first unto looking to the King, to see if some remedy might not be applied to his wound; but because he was hurt just in the heart there was no hope of recovery, so that he died within a very short time after: Presently they seized on the Page, whom they put to torture, by reason of some suspicions which they had upon this accident, but he never confessed any thing, and said nought else, save▪ That he had done it of his own free will, and to be revenged of the blow which the King had given him on his head by way of contempt, as if he had struck some dog that was barking up and down the streets in the night, without considering that he was the son of the Pate Pondan, Lord of Surebayaa. The Page then was impaled alive, with a good big stake, which was thrust in at his Fundament, and came out at the nape of his neck. As much was done to his Father, to three of his brothers, and to threescore and twelve of his kinsmen, so that his whole Race was exterminated, upon which so cruel and rigorous an execution, many great troubles ensued afterwards in all the country of jaoa, and in all the Islands of ●ale, Tymor, and Madura, which are very great, and whereof the Governors are Sovereigns by their Laws, and from all antiquity. After the end of this execution, question was made what should be done with the King's body, whereupon there were many different opinions amongst them, for some said, that to bury him in that place was as much as to leave him in the power of the Passeruans; and others, that if he were transported to Demaa, where his Tomb was, it was not possible but that it would be corrupted before it arrived there; whereunto was added, that if they interred him so putrified and corrupted, his soul could not be received into Paradis●, according to the Law of the country, which is that of Mahomet, wherein he died. After many contestations thereupon, in the end they followed the counsel which one of our Portugals gave them, that was so profitable to him afterwards, as it was worth him above ten thousand ducats, wherewith the Lords rewarded him as it were in vie of one another for a recompense of the good service which he did then to the deceased. This counsel was, that they should put the body into a Coffin full of Lime and Camphire, and so bury it in a Junck also full of earth; so that albeit the thing was not so marvellous of itself, yet left it not to be very profitable to the Portugals, because they all found it very good, and well invented, as indeed the success of it was such, as by means thereof the King's body was carried to Demaa, without any kind of corruption or ill savour. As soon as the King's body was put into the junck appointed for it, the King of Zunda, §. 2. General of the Army, caused the great Ordinance and the ammunition to be embarked, and with the least noise that might be, committed to safe custody the most precious things the King had, together with all the treasures of the Tents. But whatsoever care and silence was used therein, the enemy could not be kept from having some inkling of it, and from understanding how things went in the Camp, so that instantly the King marched out of the Town in person, with only three thousand soldiers of the past confederacy, who by a solemn vow caused themselves to be anointed with the oil which they call Minhamundi, as men resolved, and that had vowed themselves to death. Thus fully determined as they were, they went and fell upon the enemies, whom finding busy in trussing up their baggage, they entreated so ill, as in less than half an hours space, for no longer lasted the heat of the fight, they cut twelve thousand of them in pieces. Withal they took two Kings, and five Pates, or Duke's prisoners, together with above three hundred Turks, Abyssines, and Achems, yea and their Ca●ismoubana, the Sovereign dignity amongst the Mahometans, by whose counsel the Pangueyran was come thither. There were also four hundred ships burnt, wherein were the hurt men, so that by this means all the Camp was near lost. After this the King retreated into the Town with his men, whereof he lost but four hundred. In the mean time the King of Zunda having caused the remainder of the Army to be reimbarqued with all speed the same day, being the nineth of March, they set sail directly for the City of Demaa, bringing along with them the body of the Pangueyran, which upon the arrival thereof was received by the people with great cries, and strange demonstrations of a universal mourning. The day after a review was taken of all the men of war, for to know how many were dead, and there was found missing an hundred and thirty thousand; whereas the Passeruans, according to report, had lost but five and twenty thousand; but be it as it will, and let fortune make the best market that she can of these things, yet they never arrive, but the field is died with the blood of the vanquishers, and by a stronger reason with that of the vanguished, to whom these events do always cost far dearer, then to the others. The same day there was question of creating a new Pangueyran, who, as I have said heretofore, is Emperor over all the Pates and Kings of that great Archipelago, which the Chineses, Tartar, japon, and Lequio, Historians are want to call Raterra Vendau, that is to say, the eyelid of the world, as one may see in the Card, if the elevation of the heights prove true. Now because that after the death of the Pangueyran, there was not a lawful successor to be found that might inherit this Crown, it was resolved that one should be made by election; for which effect by the common consent of all, eight men were chosen, as heads of all the people, to create a Pangueyran. These same assembled then together in a house, and after order had been taken for the pacifying of all things in the City, they continued seven whole days together without being able to come to any agreement about this election; for whereas there were eight pretendents of the principal Lords of the Kingdom, there were found amongst these Electors many different opinions, which proceeded from this, that the most part, or all of them, were merely allied to these ●ight, or to their kinsmen, so that each one laboured to make him Pangueyran, which was most to his mind. Whereupon the inhabitants of the City, and the soldiers of the Army, making use of this delay to their advantage, as men who imagined that this affair would never be terminated, and that there would be no chastisement for them, they began shamelessly to break out into all kind of actions full of insolency and malice. And forasmuch as there was a great number of Merchant's Ships in the Port, they got aboard them, and fell pellmell to rifling both of strangers, and those of the country, with so much licentiousness, as it was said, that in four days they took an hundred Juncks, wherein they killed above six thousand men; whereof notice being given to the King of Panaruca, Prince of Balambuam, and Admiral of the Sea of this Empire, he ran thither with all speed, and of the number of those which were convicted of manifest robbery, he caused fourscore to be hanged all along the shore, to the terror of those that should behold them. After this action, Quiay Ansedeaa, Pate or Duke of Cherbom, who was Governor of the Town, and greatly in authority, taking this which the King of Panaruca had done for a manifest contempt, because he had, said he, little respected his charge of Governor, was so mightily offended ●t it, as having instantly got together about six or seven thousand men, he went and 〈…〉 this King's Palace, with an intent to seize upon his person; but the Panaruca resisted him with his followers, and as it was said▪ he endeavoured with many compliments to justify himself to him all that ever he could; whereunto Quiay Ans●d●aa was so far from having any regard, as contrarily entering by force into his house he flew thirty or forty of his men; in the mean time so many people ran to this mutiny as it was a dreadful thing to behold. For whereas these two heads were great Lords, one Admiral of the Fleet, the other Governor of the Town, and both of them allied to the principal families of the Country, the devil sowed so great a division amongst them, as if night had not separated the fight, it is credible that not one of them had escaped; nevertheless the difference went yet much farther, and ended not so; for the men of war, who were at that time above six hundred thousand in number, coming to consider the great affront which Quiay Ansedeaa, Governor of the Town, had done to their Admiral, they to be revenged thereof went all ashore the same night, the Pa●aruca not being of power enough to keep them from it, notwithstanding he laboured all that he could to do it. Thus all of them animated and transported with wrath, and a desire of revenge, went and set upon Quiay Ansedeaas house, where they slew him, and ten thousand men; wherewith not contented, they assaulted the Town in ten or eleven places, and fell to killing and plundering all that ever they met with, so that they carried themselves therein with so much violence, as in three days alone, which was as long as the siege of this Town last●d, nothing remained that was not an insupportable object to the sight. There was withal so great a confusion of howling, weeping, and heavy lamentation, as all that heard it could think no other but that the earth was going to turn topsie turvy. In a word, and not to lose time in aggravating this with superfluous speeches, the Town was all on fire, which burned to the very foundations, so that according to report there were above an hundred thousand houses consumed, above three hundred thousand persons cut in pieces, and almost as many made prisoners, which were led away slaves, and sold in divers countries. Besides, there was an infinite of riches stolen, whereof the value, as it was said, only in silver and gold, amounted even to forty millions, and all put together, to an hundred millions of gold. As for the number of prisoners, and of such as were slain, it was near five hundred thousand persons; and all these things arrived by the evil counsel of a young King, bred up amongst young people like himself, who did every thing at his own pleasure, without any body contradicting him. CHAP. LXVI. That which befell us, until our departure towards the Port of Zunda, from whence we s●● sail for China, and what afterwards happened unto us. §. 1. THree days after so cruel and horrible a mutiny, whenas all things were peaceable, the principal Heads of this commotion fearing as soon as a Pangueyran should be elected, that they should be punished according to the enormity of their crime, they all of them set sail without longer attending the danger which threatened them. They departed away then in the same Vessels wherein they came, the King of Panaruca, their Admiral, being not possibly able to stay them, but contrarily was twice in jeopardy of losing himself in endeavouring to do it with those few men that were of his party. Thus in the space of two days only, the two thousand sails which were in the Port went away, leaving the Town still burning, which was the cause that those few Lords, which remained, being joined together, resolved to pas● unto the Town of japara, some five leagues from thence towards the Coast of the Mediterranean Sea. This resolution being taken, they put it presently in execution, to the end that with the more tranquillity (for the popular commotion was not yet well appeased) they might make election of the Pangu●yran, which properly signifies Emperor; As indeed they created one, called Pat● Suday●, Prince of S●rubayaa, who had been none of those eight Pretendents of whom we have spoken; but this election they made, because it seemed to them necessary for their common good, and the qui●t of the Country: All the inhabitant●●o were exceedingly satisfied with it, and they immediately sent th● Panarut● for 〈◊〉 to a place some dozen leagues from thence, called Pisammenes, where he at that time lived. Nine days after he was sent for, he failed not to come, accompanied with above two hundred thousand men, embarked in fifteen hundred Calaluz●s and juripangos. He was received by all the people with great demonstrations of j●y, and a little after he was crowned with the accustomed ceremonies, as Pangueyran of all the countries of Ia●a, Bala, and Mad●ra, which is a Monarchy that is very populous, and exceeding rich and mighty. That done, he returned to the Town of Demaa, with an intent to have it rebuilt anew, and to restore it to its former estate. At his arrival in that place, the first thing he did was to give order for the punishing of those which were found attainted and convicted of the sacking of the Town, who proved not to be above five thousand, though the number of them was far greater, for all the rest were fled away, some here, some there. Th●se wretches suffered only two kinds of death, some were impaled alive, and the rest were burned in the very same ships wherein they were apprehended; and of four days, wherein this justice was executed, there passed not one without the putting to death of a great number, which so mightily terrified us Portugal's that were there present, as seeing the commotion very great still over the whole country, and no likelihood that things would of a long time be peaceable, we humbly desired the King of Zunda to give us leave to go to our ship which lay in the Port of Bant●, in regard the season for the voyage to China was already come. This King having easily granted our request, with an exemption of the customs of our Merchandise, presented every one of us besides with an hundred ducats, and to each of the heirs of fourteen of ours, which were slain in the war, he gave three hundred, which we accepted of as a very honourable reward, and worthy of a most liberal, and good natured Prince. Thus went we presently away very well satisfied of him to the Port of Banta, and there we remained twelve whole days together, during the which we made an end of preparing ourselves for our voyage. After this, we set sail for China in the company of other four ships, who were bound for the same place, and we took along with us the same Ioan● Rodriguez, whom we encountered at Passeruan, as I have before declared, that had made himself a Brachman of Pagode, called Quiay Nacorel, and as for him he had named himself Gauxita● Facal●m, which is as much to say as, the Council of the Saint. The same joan Rodriguez no sooner arrived at China, but he embarked himself for Malaca, where (through the grace of God) he was reconciled anew to the Catholic faith, and after he had continued a year there, he died with great demonstrations of a good and true Christian, whereby it seems we may believe that our Lord received him to mercy, since after so many years' profession of an infidel, he reserved him to come and die in his service, for which be he praised for evermore. Our five ships then, with which we parted from Zunda, being arrived at Chinche●, where the Portugals at that time traded, we abode three months and an half there with travel and danger enough of our persons; for we were in a country, where nothing but revolts and mutinies were spoken of. Withal, there were great armies afoot all alongst the Coast, by reason of many robberies which the Pirates of japon had committed thereabout, so that in this disorder there was no means to exercise any commerce, for the Merchants durst not leave their houses to go to Sea. By reason of all this we were constrained to pass unto the Port of Chabaqu●a, where we found at anchor sixscore juneks▪ who having set upon us, took three of our five Vessels, wherein four hundred Christians were killed, of which fourscore and two were Portugals. As for the other two Vessels, in one of the which I was, they escaped as it were by miracle. But because we could not make to Land, by reason of the Easterly winds which were contrary to us all that same month, we were constrained (though to our great grief) to regain the Coast of jaoa. At length after we had continued our course by the space of two and twenty days with a great deal of travel and danger, we discovered an Island called Pullo Condor, distant eight degrees, and one third of height from the bar of the Kingdom of Camboya. Whereupon as we were even ready to reach it, so furious a storm came from the South Coast, as we were all in jeopardy to be cast away. Nevertheless driving along we got to the Isle of Lingua, where a tempest surprised us at West and South-West, with so impetuous a wind, as struggling against the billow, it kept us from making use of our sails: so that being in fear of rocks and shelves of sand, which were on the Prow side, we steered the other way, until that after some time the Forekeel of our Poup opened within nine hand-bredths of the water, which was the cause, seeing ourselves so near unto death, that we were enforced to cut down our two masts, and to cast all our Merchandises into the Sea, whereby our Ship was somewhat eased. This done, whereas we had left our ship the rest of the day, and a good part of the night to the mercy of the Sea, it pleased our Lord out of an effect of his divine justice, that without knowing how, or without seeing any thing, our ship ran herself against a rock, with the death of seventy and two persons. This miserable success so deprived us of all our understanding and forces, that not so much as one of us ever thought of any way saving himself, as the Chineses, whom we had for Mariners in our Junck had done, for they had so bestirred themselves all the night long, that before it was day they had made a raft of such planks and beams as came to their hands, tying them together in such sort with the cordage of their sails, that forty persons might abide upon it with ease. Now whereas we were all in an imminent danger, and in a time wherein (as they say) the father does nothing for the son, nor the son for the father, no man took care but for himself alone, whereof we had a fair example in our Chinese-Mariners, whom we accounted but as our slaves; for Martin Estevez, the Captain and Master of the Junck, having entreated his own servants, who were upon the raft, to receive him amongst them, they answered him, that they could not do it at any hand, which coming to the ears of one of ours called Ruy de Moura, whereas he could not endure that these perfidious villains should use us with so much discourtesy and ingratitude, he got him up on his feet from a place where he lay hurt, ●nd made unto us a short speech, whereby he represented unto us, That we were to remember how odious a thing cowardice was; and withal, how absolutely it imported us to seize upon this raf● for the saving of our lives. To these words he added many other such like, which so encouraged us, that with one accord, and with one and the same resolution, whereunto the present necessity obliged us, being but eight and twenty Portugals, we set upon the forty Chinese which were upon the raft. We opposed our swords then to their iron hatchets, and fought so lustily with them, as we killed them all in the space of two or three Credoes. It is true indeed, that of us eight and twenty Portugals, sixteen were slain, and twelve escaped, but so wounded, that four of them died the next day. This was an accident, whereof no doubt the like hath seldom been heard of▪ or seen, whereby one may clearly perceive how great the misery of humane life is, for it was not twelve hours before, when as we all embraced each other in the ship, and behaved ourselves like right brethren, intending to die for one another, and so soon after our sins carried us to such great extremity, as hardly sustaining ourselves upon four scurvy planks, tied together with two ropes, we kissed one another with as much barbarism, as if we had been mortal enemies, or something worse. It is true, that the excuse which may be alleged thereupon is, that necessity, which hath no law, compelled us thereunto. §. 2. Whenas we were were Masters of this raft, which had cost us and the Chineses so much blood, we set upon it eight and thirty persons of us that we were, of which there were twelve Portugals, some of their children, our servants, and the remainder of those that were hurt, whereof the most part died afterwards. Now forasmuch as we were so great a number upon a very little raft, where we floated at the mercy of the waves of the Sea, the water came up to our middles, and in this fashion we escaped from that dangerous and infortunate rock, one Saturday, being Christmas day, one thousand five hundred forty and seven, with one only piece of an old counterpoint, which served us for a ●ail, having neither needle no● compass to guide us: True it is, that we supplied this defect with the great hope which we had in our Lord, whom we invoked incessantly with groans and sighs, that were accompanied with abundance of tears. In this pitiful equipage we navigated four whole days without eating any thing, so that upon the fifth day necessity constrained us to feed on a Cap●a● which died amongst us, with whose body we sustained ourselves five days longer, which made up the nineth of our voyage, so that during other four, wherein we continued in this case, we had nothing else to eat but the foam and sl●me of the Sea; for we resolved to die with hunger rather than feed on any of those four Portugals which lay dead by us. After we had wandered thus at the mercy of the Sea, it pleased our Lord out of his infinite goodness to let us discover land on the twelfth day, which was so agreeable a sight to us, as the joy of it proved mortal to some of ours, for of fifteen of us that were still alive, four died suddenly, whereof three were Portugals; so that of eight and thirty persons which had been embarked on the raft, there was but eleven that escaped, namely seven Portugals, and f●ur of our boys. In the end having got to land, we found ourselves in a shallow road, fashioned much like to an Haven, where we began to render infinite thanks to God for having thus delivered us from the perils of the Sea, promising ourselves also, that through his infinite mercy he would draw us out of those of the land. Having then made provision of certain shellfish, as oysters, and sea-crabs to nourish ourselves withal, because we had observed how all this country was very desert, and full of Elephants and Tigers, we got up into certain trees, to the end we might avoid the fury of these beasts, and some others which we saw there; then when as we thought that we might proceed on our way with less danger, we gathered us together, & went on through a wood, where to secure our lives, we had recourse to loud cries, and hollow. In the mean time, as it is the property of the divine mercy never to forsake the poor sufferers that are upon the earth, it permitted us to see coming along in a channel of fresh water, that ran ingulphing itself into the Sea, a little barque, laden with timber and other wood, wherein were nine Negroes, jaoas, and Papua●. As soon as these men see us, imagining that we were some devils, as they confessed to us afterwards; they leapt into the water, and quite left the Vessel, not so much as one of them abiding in her But when they perceived what we were, they abandoned the fear they were in before, and coming unto us they questioned us about many particulars, whereunto we answered according to the truth, and withal, desired them for God's sake to lead us whithersoever they would, and there to sell us as slaves to some that would carry us to Malaca; adding that we were Merchants, and that in acknowledgement of so good an office, they should get a great deal of money for us, or as much in commodities as they would require. Now whereas these jaoas are naturally inclined to avarice, when they heard us talk of their interest, they began to be more tractable, and gave us better words, with hope of doing that which we desired of them, but these courtesies lasted no longer but till such time as they could get again into their barque, which they had quitted; for as soon as they saw themselves aboard her, they put off from the land, and making as though they would part without taking us in, they told us, that to be assured of what we had said to them, they would have us before they proceeded any further, to yield up our arms to them, whereas otherwise they would never take us in, no not though they saw us eaten up with Lions. Seeing ourselves thus constrained by necessity, and by a certain despair of finding any other remedy to our present extremity, we were enforced to do all that these men required of us; so that having brought their barque a little nearer, they bid us swim to them, because they had never a boat to fetch us from the shore, which we presently resolved to do. Whereupon two boys and one Portugal, leapt into the Sea to take hold of a rope, which they had thrown out to us from of the poup of the barque; but before they could reach it, they were devoured by three great Lizards, nothing of the bodies of all these three appearing to us, but only the blood, wherewith the Sea was all died. Whilst this passed so, we the other eight that remained on the shore were so seized with fear and terror, as we were not ourselves a long time after, wherewith those dogs which were in the barque were not awhit moved; but contra●●l●●l●pping their hands together in sign of joy, they said in a way of jeering, O how happy are these three, for that they have ended their days without pain! Then whenas they saw that we were half sunk up into the Ouze, without so much strength as to get ourselves out of it, five of them leapt ashore, and tying us by the middle, drew us into their barque, with a thousand injuries and affronts. After this setting sail they carried us to a village called Che●bom, which was some dozen leagues from thence, where they sold all eight of us, namely six Portugals, one Chinese boy, and a Caphar, for the sum of thirteen Pardains, which are in value three hundred reals of our money. He that bought us was a Pagan Merchant of the Isle of Zel●bres, in whose power we continued five or six and twenty days, and without lying, we had no lack with him, either of clothes or meat. The same Merchant sold us afterwards for twelve Pistols to the King of Calapa, who used so great a magnificence towards us, as he sent us freely to the Port of Zunda, where there were three Portugal Vessels, whereof jeronimo Gomez Sarmento was General, who gave us a very good reception; and furnished us abundantly with all that was necessary for us, until such time as he put to Sea from the Port, to sail to China. CHAP. XLVII. My passing from Zunda to Siam, where in the company of the Portugals I went to the War of Chiammay; and that which the King of Siam did, until he returned into his Kingdom, where his Queen poisoned him. AFter we had been very near a month in this Port of Zunda, where a good number of Portugals were assembled together, §. 1. so soon as the season to go to China was come, the three Vessels set sail for Chincheo, no more Portugals remaining ashore, but only two, who went to Siam in a Junck of Patana with their Merchandise. I bethought me then to lay hold on this occasion, and put myself into their company, because they offered to bear my charges in this voyage, yea and to lend me some money for to try fortune once more, and see whether by the force of importuning her, she would not use me better than formerly she had done. Being departed then from this place, in six and twenty days we arrived at the City of Odiaa, the Capital of this Empire of Sarnau, which they of this country do ordinarily call Siam, where we were wonderfully well received and entreated by the Portugals, which we found there. Now having been a month and better in this City, attending the season for the voyage to China, that so I might pass to japon in the company of six or seven Portugals, who had embarked themselves for that purpose, I made account to employ in commodities some hundred ducats, which those two, with whom I came from Zunda, had lent me. In the mean time very certain news came to the King of Siam, who was at that time with all his Court at the said City of Odiaa, that the King of Chiammay, allied with the Timocouhos, Laaos, and Gueos, people which on the North East hold the most part of that country above Capimp●r and Passil●●o, and are all Sovereigns, exceeding rich and mighty in Estates, had laid siege to the Town of Quiteruan, with the death of above thirty thousand men, and of Oyaa Capimper, Governor and Lieutenant General of all that Frontier. The King remained so much appalled with this news, that without further temporizing, he passed over the very same day to the other side of the river, and never standing to lodge in houses, he went and encamped under Tents in the open field, thereby to draw others to do the like in imitation of him: Withal he caused Proclamation to be made over all the City, That all such as were neither old nor lame, and so could not be dispensed with for going to this war, should be ready to march within twelve days at the uttermost, upon pain of being burned alive, with perpetual infamy for themselves, and their descendants, and confiscation of their Estates to the Crown: To the which he added many other such great and dreadful penalties, as the only recital of them struck terror, not into them of the country, but into the very strangers, whom the King would not exempt from this war, of what Nation soever they were; for if they would not serve, they were very expressly enjoined to depart out of his Kingdom within three days. In the mean time so rigorous an Edict terrified every one in such sort, as they knew not what counsel to take, or what resolution to follow. As for us Portugals, in regard that more respect had always been carried in that country to them, then to all other Nations, this King sent to desire them that they would accompany him in this voyage, wherein they should do him a pleasure, because he would trust them only with the guard of his person, as judging them more proper for it then any other that he could make choice of; and to oblige them the more thereunto, the message was accompanied with many fair promises, and very great hopes of pensions, graces, benefits, favours, and honours, but above all, with a permission which should be granted them to build Churches in his Kingdom, which so obliged us, that of an hundred and thirty Portugals which we were, there were sixscore of us that agreed together to go to this war. The twelve days limited being past, the King put himself into the field with an Army of four hundred thousand men, whereof seventy thousand were strangers of divers Nations: They embarked all in three hundred S●roos, Lauleas, and Iang●s, so that on the nineth day of this voyage the King arrived at a Frontier Town, named Suropis●●, some twelve or thirteen leagues from Quitiruan, which the enemies had besieged. There he abode above seven days to attend four thousand Elephants which came to him by Land. During that time, he was certified that the Town was greatly pressed, both on the river's side, which the enemies had seized upon with two thousand Vessels, as also towards the Land, where there were so many men, as the number of them was not truly known, but as it was judged by conjecture, they might be some three hundred thousand, whereof forty thousand were horse, but no Elephants at all. This news made the King h●sten the more, so that instantly he made a review of his forces, and found that he had five hundred thousand men, for since his coming forth many had joined with him by the way, as also four thousand Elephants, and two hundred carts with field pieces. With this Army he parted from Suropisem, and drew towards Quitiruan, marching not above four or five leagues a day. At the end of the the third, than he arrived at a valley called Siputay, a league and an half from the place where the enemies lay. Then all these men of War, with the Elephants, being set in battle array by the three Masters of the Camp, whereof two were Turks by Nation, and the third a Portugal, named Doming●s de S●ixas, they proceeded on in their way towards Quitiruan, where they arrived before the Sun appeared. Now whereas the enemies were already prepared, in regard they had been advertised by their Spies of the King of Sia●s forces, and of the design which he had, they attended him resolutely in the plain field, relying much on their forty thousand horse. As soon as they discovered him, they presently advanced, and with their vanguard, which were the said forty thousand horse, they so charged the King of Siams' rearward, composed of threescore thousand foot, as they defeated them in less than a quarter of an hour, with the loss of three Princes that were slain upon the place. The King of Siam seeing his men thus routed, resolved not to follow the order which he had formerly appointed, but to fall on with the whole body of his Army, and the four thousand Elephants joined together. With these forces he gave upon the battalion of the enemies with so much impetuosity, as at this first shock they were wholly discomfited, from whence ensued the death of an infinite company of men; for whereas their prince's ●ll strength consisted in their horse, as soon as the Elephants, sustained by the harquebuses, and the field pieces, fell upon them, they were defeated in less than an half hour, so that after the routing of these same, all the rest began instantly to retreat. In the mean time the King of Siam, following the honour of the victory, pursued them to the rivers side, which the enemies perceiving, they form a new Squadron of all those that remained of them, wherein there were above an hundred thousand men, as well sound as hurt, and so past all the same day there, joined together in one entire body of an Army, the King not daring to fight with them, by reason he saw them fortified with two thousand ships, wherein there were great numbers of men. Nevertheless as soon as it was dark night the enemies began to march away with all speed all along by the river, wherewith the King was nothing displeased, because the most part of his soldiers being hurt, they were necessarily to be dressed, as indeed that was presently executed, and the most part of the day and the night following employed therein. After the King of Siam had obtained so happy a victory, §. 2. the first thing that he did was to provide with all diligence for the fortifications of the town, and whatsoever else he thought to be necessary for the security thereof. After that he commanded a general muster to be made of all his men of war, that he might know how many he had lost in this battle; whereupon he found that some fifty thousand were wanting, all men of little reckoning, whom the rigour of the King's Edict had compelled to serve in this war, ill provided, and without defensive arms: As for the enemies, it was known the next day that an hundred and thirty thousand of them had been slain. As soon as the hurt men were recovered, the King, having put into the principal places of this frontier such guards as seemed requisite to him, was counselled by his Lords to make war upon the Kingdom of Guibem, which was not above fifteen leagues from thence on the North side, to be revenged on the Queen of Guibem, for having given free passage through her dominions to those of Chiammay, in regard whereof he attributed to her the loss of Oyaa Capimper, and the thirty thousand men that had been killed with him. The King approving of this advice, parted from this town with an army of four hundred thousand men, and went and fell upon one of this Queen's towns, called Fumbacor, which was easily taken, and all the inhabitants put to the sword, not one excepted. This done, he continued his voyage till he came to Guitor, the capital town of the Kingdom of Guibem, where the Queen then was, who being a widow governed the State under the title of Regent, during the minority of her son, that was about the age of nine years: At his arrival he laid siege to the Town, and forasmuch a● the Queen found not herself strong enough to resist the King of Siams' power, she fell to accord with him to pay him an annual tribute of five thousand Turmes of silver, which are threescore thousand ducats of our money, whereof she paid him five years advance in hand. Besides that, the young Prince her son did him homage as his vassal, and the King led him away with him to Siam. Hereupon he raised his siege from before the Town, and passed on towards the North-East to the Town of Taysiran, where he had news that the King of Chiammay was fallen off from the league aforesaid. In the mean time, whereas he had been six days march in the enemy's territories, he sacked as many places as he met withal, not permitting the life of any male whatsoever to be saved. So proceeding onward, he arrived at the Lake of Singipamor, which ordinarily is called Chiammay, where he stayed six and twenty days, during the which he took twelve goodly places, environed with ditches and bulwarks after our fashion, all of brick and mortar, without any stone or lime in them, because in the country it is not the custom to build so; but they had no other Artillery than some Faulconets, and certain muskets of brass. Now forasmuch as winter began to approach, and that it was very rainy weather, the King too feeling himself not very well, he retired back again to the Town of Quitiruan, where he tarried three and twenty days and better, in which space he made an end of fortifying it with walls, and many broad and deep ditches, so that having put this Town into an estate of being able to defend itself against any attempt, he embarked his Army in the three thousand vessels which brought him thither, and so returned towards Siam. Nine days after he arrived at Odiaa, the chief City of his whole Kingdom, where for the most part he kept his Court. At his arrival the inhabitants gave him a stately reception, wherein they bestowed a 〈◊〉 of money upon divers inventions, which were made against his entry. Now whereas during the six months of the King's absence, the Queen his wife had committed adultery with a Purveyor of her house, named Vquu●che●iraa, and that at the Kings return she found herself gone four months with-child by him, the fear she was in left it should be discovered, made her, for the saving of herself from the danger that threatened her, resolve to poison the King her husband, as indeed without further delaying her pernicious intention, she gave him in a mess of milk, which wrought that effect, as he died of it within five days after; during which time he took order by his Testament for the most important affairs of his Kingdom, and discharged himself of the obligation wherein he stood engaged to the strangers which had served him in this war of Chiammay. In this Testament, whenas he came to make mention of us Portugals, he would needs have this clause added thereunto, It is my intent that the sixscore Portugals, which have always so faithfully watched upon the gu●rd ●f my person, shall ●eceive for a recompense of their good services, half a years tribute which the Queen of Gu●bem gives me; and that in my custom houses, their Merchandise shall pay no custom fo● the space of three years: Moreover my intent is, that their Priests may throughout all the Towns of my Kingdom publish the Law whereof they m●ke profession namely of a God made man for the salvation of mankind, as they have many times assured me. To these things he added many others such like, which well deserve to be reported here, though I pass them under silence, because I hope to make a more ample mention of them hereafter. Furthermore, he desired all the Grandees of his Court which were present with him, that they would give him the consolation before he died, to make his eldest Son be declared King, which was incontinently executed. For which effect, after that all the Oyaas, Conchalis, and Mont●os, which are Sovereign dignities over all the rest of the Kingdom, had taken the oath of Allegiance to this young Prince, they showed him out at a window to all the people, who were in a great place below, and they set upon his head a rich Crown of gold in the form of a Mitre, and put a sword into his right hand, and a pair of balances into his left, a custom which they always observe in such a like ceremony. Then Oya Passilico, who was the highest in dignity in the Kingdom, falling on his knees before this new King, said unto him with tears in his eyes, and so loud that every one might hear him, Blessed child, that in so tender an age dost hold from the good influence of thy Star the happiness to be chosen by heaven there above for Governor of this E●pire of Sornau; see how God puts it into thy hand by me who am thy vassal, to the end thou mayest take thy first oath, whereby thou dost protest to hold it with obedience from his divine will, as also to observe justice equally to all the people, without having any regard to persons, whether it be in chastising or recompensing the great or small, the mighty or the humble, that so in time to come thou mayest not be reproached for not having accomplished that which thou hast sworn in this solemn action. For if it shall happen, that humane considerations shall make thee swarve from that which for thy justification thou art obliged to do before so just a Lord, thou shalt be greatly punished for it in the profound pit of the house of smoke, the burning lake of insupportable stench, where the wicked and damned howl continually with a sadness of obscure night in their entrails. And to the end thou mayest oblige thyself to the charge which thou takest upon thee▪ say now Xamxaimpom, which is as much as to say amongst us, Amen. The Passilico having finished his speech, the young Prince said weeping Xamxaimpom, which so mightily moved all the Assembly of the people, as there was nothing heard for a good while together, but sighing and wailing. At length, after that this noise was appeased, the Passilico proceeding on with his discourse in looking on the young King; This Sword, said he unto him, which thou holdest naked in thy hand, is given thee as a Sceptre of Sovereign power upon earth for the subduing of the rebellious, which is also to say that thou art truly obliged to be the support of the feeble and poor, to the end that they which grow lofty with their power, may not overthrow them with the puff of their pride, which the Lord doth as much abhor, as he doth the mouth of him that blasphemeth against a little infant which hath never sinned: And that thou mayest in all things satisfy the fair enamelling of the stars of heaven, which is the perfect, just, and good God, whose power is admirable over all things of the world, say once again Xamxaimpom; whereunto the Prince answered twice weeping, Maxinau, Maxinau, that is to say, I promise so to do. After this, the Passilico having instructed him in divers other such like things, the young Prince answered seven times Xamxaimpom, and so the ceremony of his Coronation was finished; only there came first a Talagrepo, of a sovereign dignity above all the other Priests, named Quiay Ponuedea, who it was said was above an hundred years old: This same prostrating himself at the feet of the Prince, gave him an oath upon a golden basin full of rice, and that done, they put him into it, after they had created him thus anew, for time would not permit them to hold him there longer, in regard the King his Father was at the point of death, besides there was so universal a mourning amongst the people, that in every place there was nothing heard but lamentations and wailing. CHAP. XLVIII. The lamentable death of the King of Siam, with certain illustrious and memorable things done by him during his life, 〈◊〉 many other accidents that arrived in this Kingdom. WHenas the day and the night following had been spent in the manner that I have related, §. 1. the next morning about eight of the clock the infortunate King yielded up the Ghost in the presence of the most part of the Lords of his Kingdom, for the which all the people made so great demonstrations of mourning, as every where there was nothing but wailing and weeping. Now forasmuch as this Prince had lived in the reputation of being charitable to the poor, liberal in his benefits and recompenses, pitiful and gentle toward every one, and above all incorrupt in doing of justice, and chastising the wicked; his subjects spoke so amply thereof in their lamentations, as if all that they said of it was true, we are to believe, that there was never a better King than he, either amongst these Pagans, or in all the countries of the world. Howbeit, whereas I cannot assure, that those things which they affirmed in their complaints were true, because I did not see them, I will only insist upon those which past concerning him, in the time whilst I was trading in this Kingdom, whereof I will report three or four amongst many others, which I have seen him do, from the year 1540 until 1545. The first was, that in the year 1540 Pedro de Faria, being Governor of Malaca, King Ioan● the john, the third of glorious memory wrote him a letter, whereby above all things he recommended unto him his using all possible means for the redeeming of a certain Domingos de Seixas, who for the space of three and twenty years had been a slave in the Kingdom of Siam, adding that the doing thereof would be very important for God's service and his, in regard he was informed, that from him, rather than from any other he might be certified of the great things which were recounted to him of this Kingdom; and in case he could redeem this Christian, that he should send him incontinently to Don Garcia, the Viceroy of the Indias, to whom he had also written, that he should embark him in the ship which was to part that year for to return into Portugal. Pedro de Faria had no sooner received this letter, but seeing with how much care the King his Master recommended this affair unto him, he sent us his Ambassador to Siam one Francisco de Crasto, a noble and very rich man, to the end he should treat about the ransom of this Domingos de Seixas, and other sixteen Portugals, which were also slaves there as well as he. According to this Commission Francisco de Castro came to the City of Odiaa, whilst I was there, where he delivered his letter to the King of Siam, who gave him a very good reception, and after he had read it, and questioned him concerning many new and curious things, he answered him presently, which was a thing he did not usually do to any Ambassador, his answer contained this much, As for Domingos de Seixas, whom the Captain of Malaca sends to me for, advertising me that I shall do the King of Portugal a great pleasure in releasing him, I do most willingly grant to do it, as also to deliver all the rest that are with him. Whereupon Francisco de Crasto, having had this dispatch from the King, gave him most humble thanks for it, and prostrated himself three several times before him, with his head bowed down to the ground, as the custom was to do unto this King, in regard he was more absolute than others. Whenas then the season permitted Francisco de Castro to return to Malaca, the King sent to fetch Domingos de Seixas from the Town of Goutaleu, where he was at that time General of the Frontier, having under his charge thirty thousand foot, five thousand horse, and eighteen thousand ducats pension by the year: With him also he caused to be brought the other sixteen Portugals, and consigned them all into the hands of Francisco de Castro, who gave him thanks again for the grace which he did him. A little after, whenas Domingos de Seixas and his companions went to take their leave of this King, he caused a thousand turmes of silver to be given to them, which are in value twelve thousand ducats of our money, and desired them to pardon him for giving them so little. Another time, which was in the year a thousand five hundred forty and five, Simano de Melo, being Captain of the same fortress of Malaca, one Lewis de Montarroyo coming from China to go to Patana, it happened that the ship wherein he was, being beaten with a furious tempest, was cast away in the Port of Charir, some five leagues from Lugor, where all his good● were seized upon by the Xabandar of the country, after that the Sea had cast him ashore, and withal, he himself was made a prisoner, together with all the rest which were saved, to the number of four and twenty Portugal, and fifty boys, which made in all seventy and four persons; the goods too that were saved out of this Shipwreck, amounted at least to fifteen thousand ducats. Now the reason which the Xabandar alleged for this same was, that by the ancient custom of the Kingdom all these goods belonged unto him▪ whereof Luis de Montarrayo having advertised certain Portugal's which were at that instant in the City, they concluded amongst themselves to make an Odiaa, or present of some rich pieces, to the value of a thousand ducats, and therewith to go unto the King, upon the day which was named of the white Elephant, that was ten days after, and on the which, in regard it was a very solemn feast, this Prince was accustomed to do many graces to such as were suitors to him for them. So on the solemnity of this day, which they call O●idaypileu, that is to say, the rejoicing of goodmen, all the Portugals, who were threescore and odd, placed themselves in a certain passage of one of the three principal streets, through which the King was to pass with a great deal of pomp and Majesty, and whenas they see the King come by, they prostrated themselves all upon the ground, as the inhabitants of Siam use to do, and one of them, being deputed thereunto, recounted unto the King the whole business of Luis de Montarrayo and his companions, just as it had past, beseeching him he would do them so much grace, as to command the releasement of those poor prisoners, without speaking of the goods which the Xabandar had seized upon, because it seemed not reasonable unto them. But the King, who presently understood their demand, was so moved with the tears which he see some of them shed, as he caused the white Elephant whereon he was mounted to stay, then casting his eye on the Portugals, and the Present that some of them held out in their hands, which he known they intended to offer unto him; My friends, said he unto him, I take that for received which you would present me with▪ and do thank you for it; for in so solemn a day as this is I do not use to take any thing of any body, but to give, and oblige every one with benefits; wherefore I desire you for the love of your God, whose servant I am, and ever will be, to bestow this Present upon such of your company as are in most need of it; for you shall do far better in gaining thereby therecompence of this Alms, which you shall give for his sake than you could get by all that which I should confer on you in acknowledgement of this Present, it being most certain that before him I am but a poor worm of the earth. As for the prisoners which you demand of me, it is my pleasure to bestow them as an Alms upon you, that so in all liberty they may return unto Malaca; and further, I command that all the goods which they say have been ●aken from them, be restored to them again; for things which are done for God's sake, aught to be accomplished with much more liberality than the need of the poor requires, especially when they crave it with tears in their eyes. Hereupon the Portugals prostrated themselves all before him, and the next day the King by his Letter's Patents ordained, That within the term of ten days the prisoners should be brought to the City, together with all that which had been taken from them; which incontinently was executed very exactly, for there were restored unto them all the goods which had been saved out of the ship, amounting, as I have already said, to fifteen thousand ducats, which the King freely gave them. Two or three months after, in the same year one thousand five hundred forty and five, it greatly importing this King of Siam to go in person and repulse the King of T●parahos, who on Passilica●s side had invaded his country, and sacked some of the weakest places, with an intent to besiege the fortress of Xinan and Laut●●, whereon depended the whole safety of this state, he resolved to go against him in person. Wherefore he sent certain Colonels over all the Kingdom to levy men, with an express Commission to return within twenty days with their men of war to the City of Odiaa, for it was his intention to set forth from thence about that time. Withal he enjoined his Commanders upon pain of a rigorous chastisement not to dispense with a man that could fight, from this war, except it were such as were any way impotent▪ and above threescore years of age, whereupon each of these Colonels was assigned the Province wherein he should make his levies: It happened then that one Quiay Raudivaa, a man of quality, and one that the King made oftentimes use of, had for his lot the frontier of Blan●haa, where the most part of the inhabitants being very rich, as well in money, as other ways, gave themselves to the delights of the flesh, and spent the most part of their time in feasts, in sports, and other such like pleasures of this life, so that when they saw that Quiay Raudivaa would compel them to go to this war, as he was enjoined to do, they took it for too heavy a yoke, and too insupportable a burden, and that did not well agree with the manner of life which they were wont to lead, and therefore the richest of the country assembled together, and resolved to get a dispensation from this voyage by the means of a great sum of money which they made up amongst themselves, and carried to the Colonel. Now whereas there is no place where money is not powerful enough to overthrow all things, and from which a man can hardly defend himself, the Colonel Raudivaa suffered himself to be overcome with such a mass of coin as these men presented him with, and consented that they should not budge from their homes. In this sort he was constrained to take up in their steads most of the poor impotent, and old men of the country, without any regard had to the King's express Injunction to the contrary. Being arrived with this goodly company of soldiers at the City of Odiaa, he was commanded to make a show of them before the King, as all the Colonels did of theirs; as soon as this Prince cast his eye from a window where he was, upon men so wretched, old, and poorly clad, he caused one file of them to come before him; then having asked of them how old they were, and why they presented themselves before him in so bad an equipage; one amongst them speaking for the rest, recounted unto him the whole business as it had past, which put the King into such choler, that having presently commanded Quiay Raudivaa to be brought before him, and reviled him publicly for his villainy and baseness, he caused him to be bound hand and foot, and having given order for the melting of five Turmes of silver, he made it to be poured into his mouth in his presence, whereof he died instantly. Whereupon beholding him lie dead before him; If it be so, said he unto him, that there needed but five Turmes of silver to kill thee, how couldst thou imagine that the threescore thousand ducats which thou tookest of the cowards of Banchaa for to dispense with them from the war, should not be capable of sending th●● into the other world? God forgive thee thy avarice, and ●e the little punishment I have inflicted on thee for the same. After this, he sent presently to search his house, where the five thousand Turmes he had taken were found, which were immediately brought to the King, who caused this money to be distributed in his presence to those old and impotent poor wretches which Raudivaa had brought thither, being in number above three thousand; that done he sent them home to their houses, willing them to pray unto God for him. As for those effeminate men, who to be exempted from going to the war had given the five thousand Turmes to the Colonel, he commanded them to be attired like women, and so banished them into an Island called Pulho Caton; wherewith yet not contented, he confiscated all their estates, which he ordered should be bestowed on such as behaved themselves best in the war. And not long after, observing that one of the hundred and threescore Portugals, which went along with him in this expedition, hung back in a certain attempt, which the rest of his fellows went upon, where they carried themselves so valiantly, and with such courage, as they regained the principal Fort which the enemy had taken in the Town of Lautor, he commanded him to return to Siam, seeing he was not like his other companions, and that as long as he continued there, he should neither offer to go out of the house where he was, nor take upon him the name of a Portugal, on pain of having his beard shaved off, and used like those of Banchaa, since he was as cowardly as they; whereas contrarily to all the rest of the Portugals he sent treble pay, and exempted them from all duties that were to be paid for their Merchandise, as also gave them power to build Churches in any part of his Kingdom for the adoring of the name of the God of the Portugals. By these and many other examples which I could produce here, it is manifest how great and commendable the inclinations of this Prince were, who notwithstanding that he was a Gentile, was of a wonderful good nature, and exceedingly addicted to virtuous actions. §. 2. It is not to be believed with what infinite sorrow, both all the great Lords, and generally all the subjects of this Kingdom bewailed the death of their good King; but at length an Assembly was made of all the Priests of this City, who as it was said, were twenty thousand in number, by whose direction the principal persons of the Kingdom concluded upon the funeral pomp, and ceremonies which were to be used thereabout, according to the custom of the country: whereupon a mighty great pile was forthwith erected, ●●●ade of Sandal, Aloes Calembaa, and Benjamin, on the which the body of the deceased King being laid, fire was put to it, with a strange ceremony: during all the time that the body was a burning, the people did nothing but wail and lament beyond all expression▪ but in the end, it being consumed to ashes, they put them into a silver shrine, which they embarked in a Laulea very richly equipped, that was accompanied with forty Seroos full of Talagrepos, which are the highest dignity of their Gentile Priests, and a great number of other Vessels, wherein there was a world of people; after them followed an hundred small barks laden with divers figures of Idols, under the forms of Adders, Lizards, Tigers, Lions, Toads, Serpents, Bats, Geese, Bucks, Dogs, Elephants, Cats, Vultures, Kites, Crows, and other such like creatures, whose figures were so well represented to the life, as they seemed to be living In another very great ship was the King of all these Idols, which they called, The gluttonous Serpent of the profound pit of the house of smoke. This Idol had the figure of a monstrous Adder, was as big about as an hogshead▪ and writhed into nine circles, so that whenas it was extended▪ it was above ●n hundred spans long, it had the neck standing upright, and out of the eyes, throat, and breast issued flames of artificial fire, which rendered this monster so dreadful and furious, as all that beheld it trembled for fear. Now upon a Theatre three fathom high, and richly guilt, was a very beautiful little boy, about four or five years old, covered all over with pearls, and chains, and bracelets of precious stones, having wings, and a bush of hair of fine gold, much after the manner as we use to paint Angels. This child held a rich Curtelas in his hand, by which invention these Pagans would give to understand, That it was an Angel of heaven sent from God to imprison all those many devils, to the end they should not steal away the King's soul, before it should arrive at the place of rest, which was prepared for it there above in glory, for a recompense of the good works which he had done below in the world. In this order all these Vessels got to land at a Pagode, called Quiay Pouter, where after that the silver shrine, in which the King's ashes were, was placed, and the little boy taken from thence, fire was put to all that infinite number of Idols, just in the manner as they stood in the Barks; and this was accompanied with so horrible a din of cries, great Ordnance, Harquebuzes, Drums, Bells, Cornets, and other different kinds of noise, as it was impossible to hear it without trembling. This ceremony lasted not above an hour, for whereas all these figures were made of combustible stuff, and the Vessels filled with pitch and resin, so dreadful a flame ensued presently thereupon, as one might well have said that it was a very portraiture of hell; so that in an instant the Vessels, and all that were in them were seen to be reduced to nothing. Whenas this, and many other very lively inventions, which had cost a great deal of money, were finished, all the inhabitants, which were come thronging thither, and whereof the number seemed to be infinite, retired back to their houses, where they remained with their doors and windows shut, not one appearing in the streets for the space of ten days, during which time all places were unfrequented, and none were seen stirring but some poor people, who in the night went up and down begging with strange lamentations. At the end of the ten days wherein they had shut themselves up so, they opened their doors and windows, and their Pagodes, or Temples, were adorned with many Ensigns of rejoicing, together with a world of hangings, standards, and banners of silk. Hereupon there went through all the streets certain men on horseback, apparelled in white Damask, who at the sound of very harmonious instruments, cried aloud with tears in their eyes, Ye sad inhabitants of this Kingdoms of Siam, harken, harken to that which is made known to you from God, and with humble and pure hearts praise ye all his holy name, for the effects of his divine justice are great; withal laying aside your mourning, come forth of your a●odes wherein you are shut up, and sing the praises of the goodness of your God, since he hath been pleased to give you a new King, who fears him, and is a friend of the poor. This Proclamation being made, all the Assistants, with their faces prostrated on the ground, and their hands lifted up, as people that rendered thanks to God, answered aloud weeping; We make the Angels of heaven our Attorneys, to the end they may continually praise the Lord for us. After this, all the inhabitants of the City coming out of their houses, and thinking of nothing but dancing and rejoicing, went to the Temple of Quiay Fanarel, that is to say, the God of the joyful, where they offered sweet perfumes, and the poorest sort, fruits, pullen, and rice, for the entertainment of the Priests. The same day the new King showed himself over all the City with a great deal of pomp and Majesty, in regard whereof the people made great demonstrations of joy and gladness. And forasmuch as the King was but nine years old, it was ordained by the four and twenty Bracàlo●s of the Government, that the Queen his mother should be the Protector or Regent of him, and that she should bear rule over all the Officers of the Crown. Things passed thus for the space of four months and an half, during the which there was no manner of disorder, but all was peaceable in the Kingdom; howbeit at the end of that time, the Queen coming to be delivered of a Son which she had had by her Purveyor, being displeased with the bad report that went of her, she resolved with herself to satisfy her desire, which was to marry with the Father of this new Son, for that she was desperately in love with him: And further, she wickedly enterprised to make away the new King, her lawful child, to the end that by this means the Crown might pass to the bastard by right of inheritance. Now to execute this horrible design of hers, she made show that the excess of her affection to the young King her Son, kept her always in fear, left some attempt should be made upon his life; so that one day having caused all the Council of the State to be assembled, the represented unto them, that having but this only pearl enchased in her heart, she desired to keep it from being plucked from thence by some disaster; for which effect she thought it requisite, as well to secure her from her apprehensions, as to prevent the great mischiefs which carelessness is wont to bring in such like cases, that there should be a guard set about the Palace, and the person of the King. This affair was immediately debated in the Council, and accorded to the Queen, in regard the matter seemed good of itself. The Queen seeing then that her design had succeeded so well, took instantly for the guard of the Palace, and the person of her Son, such as she judged were proper for the executing of her damnable enterprise, and in whom she most confided. She ordained a guard then of two thousand foot, and five hundred horse, besides the ordinary guard of her house, which were six hundred Cavehins and Lequios, and thereof she made Captain one called Tileubacus, the cousin of the same Purveyor, by whom she had had a child, to the end that by this man's favour she might dispose of things as she pleased, and the more easily bring to pass her pernicious design. Whereupon relying on the great forces which she had already on her party, she began to revenge herself upon some of the great ones of the Kingdom, because she knew they despised her, and held her not in that esteem she desired, The two first whom she caused to be laid hands on were two Deputies of the Government, making use of this pretext, that they held secret intelligence with the King of Chiamway, and were to give him an entry into the Kingdom through their lands, so that under colour of justice she caused them to be both executed, and confiscated their estates, whereof she gave the one to her Favourite, and the other to a brother-in-law of his, who (it was said) had been a Smith: But in regard this execution had been done precipitously, and without any proof, the greatest part of the Lords of the Kingdom murmured against the Queen for it, representing unto her the merit of them whom she had put to death, the services they had rendered to the Crown, the quality of the persons, and the nobility and antiquity of their extractions, as being of the blood royal, and lineally descended from the Kings of Siam, howbeit she made no reckoning thereof, but contrarily a little after making show as if she had not been well, she in a full Council renounced her regency, and conferred it on Vquumcheviraa, her Favourite, to the end that by this means bearing rule over all others, he might dispose of the affairs of the kingdom at his pleasure, and give the most important charges thereof to such as would be of his party, which he thought to be the most assured way for him to usurp this Crown, and make himself absolute Lord of the Empire of S●rna●, whereof the revenue was twelve millions of gold, besides other come in, which amounted to as much more. With all these inventions this Queen used so great diligence for the contenting of the desire which she had to raise her Favourite to the Royalty, to marry herself to him, and to make the illegitimate son, which she had bad by him, successor of the Crown, as within the space of eight months, fortune favouring her designs, and hoping more fully to execute her wicked plot, she caused most of the great men of the kingdom to be put to death, and confiscated all their lands, goods and treasures, which she distributed amongst such of her creatures as she daily drew to her party. Now forasmuch as the young King her son served for the principal obstacle to her intentions, this young Prince could not escape her abominable fury, for she herself poisoned him even as she had poisoned the King his father. That done, she married with Vquumcheniraa, who had been one of the Purveyors of her house, and caused him to be crowned King in the city of Odiaa, the eleventh of November in the year one thousand five hundred forty five. But whereas Heaven never leaves wicked actions unpunished, the year after, one thousand five hundred forty and six, and on the fifteenth day of January, they were both of them slain by Oyaa Passilico, and the King of Cambaya, at a certain banquet which these Princes made in a Temple, that was called Quiay Figrau, that is to say, the god of the atoms of the Sun, whose solemnity was that day celebrated: So that, as well by the death of these two persons, as of all the rest of their party, whom these Princes also killed with them, all things became very peaceable, without any further prejudice to the people of the kingdom; only it is true, that it was despoiled of the most part of the Nobility, which formerly it had, by the wicked inventions, and pernicious practices, whereof I have spoken before. CHAP. LXIX. The King of Bramaa's enterprise upon the Kingdom of Siam; and that which passed until hi● arrival at the city of Odiaa, with his besieging of it, and all that ensued thereupon. §. 1. THe Empire of Siam remaining without a lawful successor, those two great Lords of the Kingdom, namely, Oyaa Passili●●, and the King of Cambaia, together with four or five more of the trustiest that were left, and which had been confederate with them, thought fit to choose for King, a certain religious man, named Preti●m, in regard he was the natural brother of the deceased Prince, husband to that wicked Queen of whom I have spoken; whereupon this religious man, who was Talagrepo of a Pagod●, called Quiay Mitrau, from whence he had not budged for the space of thirty years, was the day after drawn forth of it by Oyaa Passilico, who brought him on the seventeenth day of January into the city of Odiaa, where on the nineteenth he was crowned King with a new kind of ceremony, and a world of magnificence, which (to avoid prolixity) I will not make mention of here, having formerly treated of such like things. Withal passing by all that further arrived in this Kingdom of Siam, I will content myself with reporting such things as I imagine will be most agreeable to the curious. It happened then that the King of Bramaa, who at that time reigned tyrannically in Pegu, being advertised of the deplorable estate whereinto the Empire of S●rnau was reduced; and of the death of the greatest Lords of the Country, as also that the new King of this Monarchy was a religious man, who had no knowledge either of arms or war, and withal of a cowardly disposition, a tyrant, and ill beloved of his subjects, he fell to consult thereupon with his Lords in the town of Anapleu, where at that time he kept his Court. Desiring their advice then upon so important an enterprise, they all of them told him, that by no means he should desist from it, in regard this Kingdom was one of the best of the world, as well in riches, as in abundance of all things; thereunto they added, that the season which was then so favourable for him, promised it to him at so good a rate, as it was likely it would not cost him above the revenue of one only year, what expense soever he should make of his treasure; besides, if he chanced to get it, he should remain Monarch of all the Emperors of the world, and therewithal he should be honoured with the sovereign title of Lord of the whi●e Elephant, by which means the seventeen Kings of Capimper, who made profession of his Law, must of necessity render him obedience. They told him moreover, that having made so great a conquest, he might, through the same territories, and with the succour of the Princes his Allies, pass into China, where was that great City of Pequin, the incomparable pearl of all the world, and against which the great Cham of Tartary, the Siamon, and the Calaminham, had brought such prodigious Armies into the field. The King of Bramaa, having heard all these reasons, and many others which his great Lords alleged unto him, wherein his interest was especially concerned, which always works powerfully on every man, was persuaded by them, and resolved to undertake this enterprise. For this effect he went directly to Martabano, where in less than two months and an half, he raised an Army of eight hundred thousand men, wherein there were an hundred thousand strangers, and amongst them a thousand Portugals, which were commanded by Diego Suar●z d' Albergaria, called Galego by way of nick name. This Diego Suarez departed out of the Kingdom of Portugal in the year one thousand five hundred thirty and eight, and went into the Indias with the Fleet of the Viceroy, Don Garcia de Noronha, in a Junck, whereof joano de Sepulveda of the town of Euora was Captain; but in the time of which I speak, namely in the year one thousand five hundred forty and eight, he had of this King of Bramaa two hundred thousand ducats a year, with the title of his brother, and Governor of the Kingdom of Pegu. The King departed then from the Town of Mar●abano the Sunday after Easter, being the seventh of April 1548. His Army, as I have already said, was eight hundred thousand men, whereof only forty thousand were horse, and all the rest forth, threescore thousand of them being Harquebuziers; there were moreover five thousand warlike Elephants; with whom they fight in those countries, and also a world of baggage, together with a thousand pieces of Canon, which were drawn by a thousand couple of Buffles and Rhinocerots; withal, there was a like number of yoke of oxen for the carriage of the victuals. Having taken the field then with these forces, he caused his Army to march still on, until at length he entered into the Territories of the King of Siam, where after five days he came to a fortress called Tapurau, containing some two thousand fires, commanded by a certain Mogor, a valiant man, and well versed in matters of war. The King of Bramaa having invested it, gave three assaults to it in the open day, and laboured to s●ale it with a world of ladders which he had caused to be brought thither for that purpose; but not being able to carry it, in regard of the great resistance of them within, he retreated for that time. But having by the counsel of Diego Suarez, who was General of the Camp, and by whom he was wholly governed, caused forty great pieces of Ordnance, whereof the most of them shot bullets of iron, to be planted against it, he fell to battering it with so much fury, as having made a breach in the wall twelve fathom wide, he assaulted it with ten thousand strangers, Turks, Abyssin●, Moors, Malavares, Ac●ems, jaaos, and Malayes; whereupon ensued so terrible a conflict between the one and the other, that in less than half an hour, the besieged, which were six thousand Siamites, were all cut in pieces, for not so much as one of them would render himself. As for the King of Bramaa, he lost above three thousand of his men, whereat he was enraged, as to be revenged for this loss he caused all the women to be put to the sword, which no doubt was a strange kind of cruelty: After this execution, he drawn directly towards the Town of Saco●ay, which was nine leagues beyond, desiring to make himself master of that, as well as of the other. He arrived in the sight of this Town one Saturday about Sunset, and encamped all along the river of Lebrau, which is one of the three that issue out of the Lake of Chiammay, whereof I have formerly made mention, with a design to march through it directly to Odiaa, the Capital City of the Empire of Sornau; for he had already been advertised that the King was there in person, and that he was making preparation to fight with him in the field; he no sooner received this advice, but his Lords counselled him to make no tarrying in any place, as well that he might not lose time, as that he might keep himself from insensibly consuming his forces, in lying before places which he pretended to take, that were so well fortified, as they would cost him dear if he amused himself about them, so that at his arrival at Odiaa he would find the most part of his men wanting, and his victuals quite spent. The King having approved of this advice, caused his Army to march away the next day through woods that were cut down by threescore thousand pioneers, whom he had sent before to plane the passages and ways; which with much ado they performed. When he was come to a place, called Tila●, which is besides Iuncala●, on the Southeast Coast, near to the Kingdom of Quedea, an hundred and forty leagues from Malaca, he took guides that were very well acquainted with the way, by whose means in nine day's journey he arrived in the sight of Odiaa, where he pitched his Camp, which he environed with trenches and strong Pallisadoes. §. 2. During the first five days that the King of Bramaa had been before the City of Odiaa, he had bestowed labour and pains enough, as well in making of trenches and Pallisadoes, as in providing all things necessary for this siege, in all which time the besieged never offered to stir, whereof Diego Suarez, the Marshal of the Camp being aware, as also of the little reckoning which the Siamites made of so great a power as was there assembled, and not knowing whereunto he should attribute the cause of it, he resolved to execute the design for which he came, to which effect, of the most part of the men which he had under his command, he made two separated Squadrons, in each of which there were six battalions of six thousand a piece. After this manner he marched in battle array, at the sound of many instruments, towards the two points which the City made on the Southside, because the entrance there seemed more facile to him then any other where. So upon the nineteenth day of june, in the year one thousand five hundred forty and eight, an hour before day, all these men of war, having set up above a thousand ladders against the walls, endeavoured to mount up on them; but the besieged opposed them so valiantly, that in less than half an hour there remained dead on the place above ten thousand on either part. In the mean time the King, who encouraged his soldiers, seeing the ill success of this fight, commanded these to retreat, and then made the wall to be assaulted afresh, making use for that effect of five thousand Elephants of war which he had brought thither, and divided into twenty troops, of two hundred and fifty apiece, upon whom there were twenty thousand Moe●s and Chaleys, choice men, and that had double pay. The wall then was assaulted by these forces with so terrible an impetuosity, as I want words to express it. For whereas all the Elephants carried wooden Castles on their backs, from whence they shot with muskets, brass culverins, and a great number of harquzes a crock, each of them ten or twelve spans long, these guns made such an havoc of the besieged, that in less than a quarter of an hour the most of them were beaten down; the Elephants withal setting their trunks to the target fences, which served as battlements, and wherewith they within defended themselves, tore them down in such sort, as not one of them remained entire, so that by this means the wall was abandoned of all defence, no man daring to show himself above. In this sort was the entry into the City very easy to the Assailants, who being invited by so good success to make their profit of so favourable an occasion, set up their ladders again which they had quitted, and mounting up by them to the top of the wall, with a world of cries and acclamations, they planted thereon in sign of victory a number of Banners and Ensigns. Now because the Turks desired to have therein a better share than the rest, they besought the King to do them so much favour as to give them the vanguard, which the King easily granted them, and that by the counsel of Diego Suarez, who desired nothing more than to see their number lessened, always gave them the most dangerous employments. They in the mean time extraordinarily contented, and proud to see themselves preferred before so many other Nations as were in the Camp, resolved to come off with honour from this service which they had undertaken. For which purpose having form a Squadron of twelve hundred men, wherein some Abyssius and janizaries were comprised, they mounted with great cries by those ladders up to the top of the wall, which as I have declared, was at that time in the power of the King of Bramaaes' people. These Turks then, whither more ●ash, or more infortunate than the rest, sliding down by a pane of the wall, descended through a bullwork into a place which was below, with an intent to open a gate, and give an entrance unto the King, to the end they might rightly boast, that they all alone had delivered to him the Capital City of the Kingdom of Siam, and so might gain the recompense which they might well expect for so brave an action; for the King had before promised to give unto whomsoever should deliver up the City unto him, a thousand bisses of gold, which in value are five hundred thousand ducats of our money. These Turks being gotten down, as I have said, laboured to break open a gate with two rams which they had brought with them for that purpose; but as they were occupied about it, upon a confidence that they alone should gain the thousand bisses of gold, which the King had promised to whomsoever should open him the gates, they saw themselves suddenly charged by three thousand Ia●s, all resolute soldiers, who fell upon them with such fury, as little more than a quarter of an hour, there was not so much as one Turk left alive in the place, wherewith not contented, they mounted up immediately to the top of the wall with a wonderful courage, and so fleshed as they were, and covered over with the blood of the Turks, whom they had newly cut in pieces, they set upon the Bramaaes' men which they found there, and fought with them so valiantly, that they durst not make head against them, so that most of them were there slain, and the rest tumbled down over the brickwall. The King of Bramaa redoubling his courage more than before, would not for all that give over this assault, but contrarily resolved to undertake it anew, so as imagining that those Elephants alone would be able to give him an entry into the City, he caused them once again to approach unto the wall. At the noise hereof, Oyaa Passilico, Captain General of the City, ran in all haste to this part of the wall, accompanied with fifteen thousand men, whereof the most part were Luzons, B●rn●●s, and Champaa●s, with some Menancabos among, and caused the gate to be presently opened, through which the Bramaa pretended to enter, and then sent him word, that whereas he was given to understand how his Highness had promised to give a thousand biss●s of gold to whomsoever should open him the gates, ●hat so he might thereby enter into the City, he had now performed it, so that h● might enter if he would, provided that like a great King as he was, he would ma●● good his word, and send him the thousand bisses of gold which he stayed there to rec●●ve. The King of Bramaa having received this jeer, would not vouchsafe to return an answer, thereby to show his contempt of Oya● Passilico; but instantly he commanded the City to be assaulted, which was presently executed with a great deal of fury; for the fight became so terrible, as it was a dreadful thing to behold, the rather for that the violence of it lasted above three whole hours, during the which time the gate was twice forced open, and twice the Assailants got an entrance into the City, which the King of Siam no sooner perceived, and that all was in danger to be lost, but he ran speedily to oppose them with his followers, which were about thirty thousand in number, and the best soldiers that were in all the City; whereupon the conflict grew much better than before, and continued half an hour and better, during the which I do not know what past, nor can say any other thing, save that we see streams of blood running every where, and the air all of a light fire; there was also on either part such a tumult and noise, as one would have said the earth had been tottering; for it was a most dreadful thing to hear the discord and jarring of those barbarous instruments, as bells, drums, and trumpets, intermingled with the noise of the great Ordnance and smaller shot, and the dreadful yelling of six thousand Elephants, whence ensued so great a terror, that it took from them that heard it both courage and sense; withal, that place at the City gate, whereof the Bramaa had been Master, was all covered over with bodies drowned in blood, a spectacle so horrible, that the very sight of it put us almost besides ourselves. Diego Suarez then, seeing their forces quite repulsed out of the City, the most part of the Elephant's hurt, and the rest so scared with the noise of the great Ordnance, as it was impossible to make them return unto the brickwall; as also that the best men of those that had fought at the gate were slain, and that the Sun was almost down, came to the King, and counselled him to sound a retreat, whereunto the King yielded, though much against his will, because he observed, that both he and the most part of the Portugals were wounded, but it was with a purpose to return to the same enterprise again the next morning. §. 2. The King being retired to his quarter, found himself wounded with the shot of an arrow which he received in that day's conflict, and which he felt not until then, by reason of the heat of the fight. This accident hindered the executing of the resolution he had taken to give another assault to the City the next day; for he was constrained to keep his bed twelve days together, but at seventeen days end, when he was fully cured of his hurt, he undertook again the prosecution of his design, and to effect that which he had so resolved upon, namely, not to raise his siege from before the City until he had made himself Master of it, though it cost him both his life and his whole State. He gave then a second assault unto the City, which proved like unto the former, for he lost a world of men in it, so that he was forced to retreat; but his wilfulness was such, as nothing daunted with the great slaughter of his men, he gave five assaults more to it in the open day, wherein he made use of many warlike stratagems, which a Greek Engineer daily invented for him; but whatsoever he could do, he was always fain to retire with loss, whereat he was greatly troubled. In the mean time, whereas the siege of this City had already endured four months and an half, he commanded a general muster of his soldiers to be made, and he found that an hundred and forty thousand of them were wanting. Whereupon seeing to what estate he was reduced, for the putting of an end to the business, he resolved to assault the City again with another new invention, and this assault was the eighth he had already given to it, during the siege, which he enterprised by the Council of war, and that under the favour of the night; for they alleged unto him, that darkness would make the assault less dangerous, and the scaling of the walls more facile. This resolution taken, he instantly commanded all preparations necessary for this design to be made, so that in seventeen days they built up six and twenty Castles of strong pieces of timber, whereof each one was set upon six and twenty wheels of iron, which facilitated the motion of so great a frame. Every Castle was fifty foot broad, threescore and five long, and five and twenty high, and all of them were reinforced with double beams, covered over with sheets of lead: Moreover each of them was full of wood, and had fastened to them before great iron chains, and that were very long in regard of the fire. Things thus prepared, one Friday about midnight, being very dark and rainy, the King of Bramaa caused three times one after another all the great Ordnance of the Camp to be discharged, which, as I remember, I have already said, consisted of an hundred and threescore great pieces, whereof the most part shot iron bullets, besides a many of Falconets, bases, and muskets, to the number of fifteen hundred, so that from all these guns shot off together three times one after another, proceeded so horrible and dreadful a noise, as I cannot think that any where but in hell the like could be; for on whatsoever the imagination can be fixed, it cannot meet with any thing that may be rightly compared thereunto. At this time, it was not only the great pieces of Ordnance, whereof I have spoken before, and the small ones too, which were shot off, but the like was done by all the guns which were both within the City, and without in the Camp, of what bigness soever they were, being at least an hundred thousand in all, for whereas there were, as I have already said, threescore thousand Harquebuziers in the King of Bramaaes' Army, there were thirty thousand also in the City, besides seven or eight thousand Falconets and Bases; so that to hear all these shot off continually for the space of three hours together, and intermingled with thunder, lightning, and the tempest of the night, was, to say the truth, a thing which was never seen, read of, or imagined, and such indeed as put every one almost besides himself; for some fell flat on the ground, some crept behind walls, and others got into walls. During the greatest violence of this horrible and furious tempest, they set fire on the six and twenty Castles which they had before brought close to the walls, so that by the force of the wind, which was at that time very great, and by the means of barrels of pitch that had been put into them, they fell a flaming in such a strange manner, as there was anew to be seen so dreadful a picture of hell (for it is the only name that can be given it, because there is nothing upon earth that may rightly he resembled unto it) that if even those which were without trembled at it, I leave you to think with how much more reason were they to fear it whom necessity constrained to abide the violence of it. Hereupon began a most bloody conflict on either part, they without falling to scale the walls, and the besieged, who took no less care for all things than they, valiantly to defend themselves, so that no advantage was to be found on either side, but rather both of them were in a condition to be utterly destroyed; for whereas the one and other reinforced themselves continually with fresh supplies, and that the King of Bramaaes' obstinacy was such, as he went himself in person amongst his soldiers, encouraging them with his speeches, and the great promises that he made them, the fight proceeded so far, and increased so mightily, as being unable to deliver the least part of that which passed therein, ● leave it to the understanding of every one to imagine what it might be. Four hours after midnight, the six and twenty Castles being quite burned to the ground, with so terrible a blaze, as no man durst come within a stones cast of it, the King of Bramaa caused a retreat to be sounded, at the request of the Captains of the strangers, for there were so many hurt men amongst them, as all the day, and most part of the night following was employed in dressing of them. CHAP. LXX. The King of Bramaaes' raising his siege from before the City of Odia●; with a description of the Kingdom of Siam; and the fertility thereof. THe King of Bramaa, §. 1. seeing that neither the great Ordnance wherewith he had battered the City, nor the assaults which he had given unto it, nor his inventions of Castles, accompanied with so many artifices of fire, whereon he had so much relied, had served him to any purpose for the execution of that which he had so mightily desired, and being resolved not to desist from the enterprise which he had begun, he called a Council of War, wherein all the Princes, Dukes, Lords, and Commanders that were in the Army were present. Having then propounded his desire and intention unto them, he required them to give him their advice thereupon; immediately the affair being put into deliberation, and thoroughly debated on either part, they concluded in ●he end, that the King was by no means to raise this siege, in regard this enterprise was the most glorious, and most profitable of all that ever might be offered unto him; they represented moreover unto him the world of treasure that he had employed therein, and that if he continued battering the City without desisting from his assaults, at length the enemies would be spent, because it was apparent (as they were informed) that they were no longer able to withstand the least attempt that should be made against them. The King being exceedingly contented, for that their opinions proved to be conformable to his desire, testified the great satisfaction that he received thereby, so that he gave them many recompenses in money, and vowed to them, that if they could take the City, he would confer upon them the greatest commands of the Kingdom, with very honourable titles and revenues. This resolution being taken, there was no further question but of considering in what manner the business should be carried; whereupon by the counsel of Diego Suarez, and of the Engineer, it was concluded, that with bavins and green turf a kind of Platform should be erected higher than the walls, and that there on should be mounted good store of great Ordnance, wherewith the principal fortifications of the City should be battered, since that in them alone consisted all the enemy's defence. Order then was presently given for all that was judged necessary thereunto, and the threescore thousand pioneers which were in the Camp were employed about it, who in twelve days brought the Fort or Platform into the estate which the King desired. There were already planted on it then forty pieces of Canon for the battering of the City the day ensuing, whenas a Post arrived with Letters to the King, whereby he was advertised, That the Zemindoo being risen up in the Kingdom of Pegu, had cut fifteen thousand Bramaaes there in pieces, and had withal seized on the principal places of the country. At these news the King was so troubled, that without further delay he raised the siege, and embarked himself on a river, called Paca●au, where he stayed but that night, and the day following, which he employed in retiring his great Ordnance and ammunition. Then having set fire on all the Pallisadoes, and lodgings of the Camp, he parted away one Tuesday, the fifteenth day of October, in the year a thousand five hundred forty and eight, for to go to the Town of Mar●abano. Having used all possible speed in his voyage, at seventeen days end he came thither, and there was amply informed by the Chalagonim, his Captain of all the Zemindoos proceedings, in making himself King, and seizing on his treasure; by killing fifteen thousand Bramaaes, and that in divers places he had lodged five hundred thousand men, with an intention to stop his passage into the Kingdom. This news very much perplexed the King of Bramaa, so that he fell to thinking with himself what course he should take for the remedying of so great a mischief as he was threatened with: In the end he resolved to tarry a while at Martabano, to attend some of his forces that were still behind, and then to go and fight a battle with his enemy; but it was his ill luck, that in the space of fourteen days only which he abode there, of four hundred thousand men which he had, fifty thousand quitted him: For whereas they were all Peg●es, and consequently desirous to shake off the Bramaaes' yoke, they thought it best to side with the new King the Zemindoo, who was a Pegu as well as they; and they were the rather induced thereunto, by understanding, that this Prince was of an eminent condition, liberal, and so affable to every one, that he thereby won most men to be of his party. In the mean time the King of Bramaa, fearing lest the defection of his soldiers should daily more and more increase, was advised by his Council to stay no longer there, in regard the longer he should tarry, the more his forces would diminish, for that a great part of his Army was Pegues, which were not likely to be very faithful unto him. This counsel was approved of by the King, who presently marched away towards Pegu, near unto which he was no sooner arrived, but he was certified that the Zemindoo, being advertised of his coming, was attending ready to receive him. So these two Kings being in the view of one another, encamped in a great ●laine, some two leagues from the City of Pegu, the Zemindoo with six hundred thousand men, and the Bramaa with three hundred and fifty thousand. The next day these two Armies being put into battle array, came to join together one Friday the sixteenth of November, the same year, a thousand five hundred forty and eight. It was about six of the clock in the morning when first they began their encounter, which was performed with so much violence, as a general defeat ensued thereupon, yet fought they with an invincible courage on either part; but the Zemindoo had the worse, for in less than three hours his whole Army was routed, with the slaughter of three hundred thousand of his men, so that in this extremity he was forced to save himself only with six horse in a fortress, called Battelor, where he stayed but one hour, during the which, he furnished himself with a little Vessel, wherein he fled the night ensuing up the river to C●daa. Let us leave him now flying, until we shall come to him again whenas time shall serve, and return to the King of Bramaa, who exceedingly contented with the victory which he had gotten, marched the next morning against the City of Pegu; where as soon as he arrived, the inhabitants rendered themselves unto him, on condition to have their lives and goods saved. Whereupon he took order for the dressing of them that were hurt; as for those that he lost in this battle, they were found to be threescore thousand in number, amongst the which were two hundred and fourscore Portugals, all the rest of them being grievously wounded. §. 2. Having already entreated of the success which the King of Bramaas voyage had in the kingdom of Siam, and of the rebellion of the Kingdom of Pegu, me thinks it will not be amiss for me to speak here succinctly of the situation, extent, abundance, riches, and fertility which I saw in this kingdom of Siam, and in this Empire of Sorna●, to show that the conquest thereof would have been far more utile unto us, than all the estates which now we have in the India's, and that we might obtain it with a great deal less charge. This kingdom, as may be seen in the Map, is seven hundred leagues in length, and a hundred and threescore in breadth; the most part of it consists in great plains, where are a world of corn grounds, and rivers of fresh water, by reason whereof the Country is exceeding fertile, and abundantly stored with cattle and victuals. In the most eminent parts of it are thick Forests of Angelin wood, whereof thousands of ships might be made; there are also many mines of Silver, Iron, Steel, Led, Tin, Saltpetre, and Brimstone; likewise great abundance of Silk, Aloes, Benjamin, Lacre, Indigo, Cotton wool, Rubies, Saphires, Ivory and gold; There is moreover in the woods marvelous store of Brasill and Ebony, wherewith an hundred Juncks are every year laden, to be transported to China, Hainan, the Lequios, Camboya and Camp●aa; besides Wax, Honey, and Sugar, which divers places there do yield very plentifully. The King's yearly revenue is ordinarily twelve millions of gold, over and above the presents which the great Lords make him, that comes to a great matter. In the jurisdiction of his territories there are six and twenty hundred populations, which they call Prodou, as cities and towns amongst us, besides villages and small hamlets, whereof I have no reckoning. The most part of those populations have no other fortifications or walls, than palisadoes of wood, so that it would be easy for any that should attaque them to make themselves masters thereof; the rather for that the inhabitants of those places are naturally effeminate, and destitute of arms offensive and defensive. This coast of this kingdom joins upon the two North and South Seas; on that of the Indias by junçalo and Tanauçarius, and on that of China by Monpolocata, Guy, Lugor, Chintabu, and Berdio. The capital City of all this Empire is Odiaa, whereof I have spoken heretofore; it is fortified with walls of brick and mortar, and contains, according to some, four hundred thousand fires, whereof an hundred thousand are strangers of divers countries of the world: for whereas the country is very rich of itself, and of great traffic, there passes not a year whereunto from the Provinces and Islands of jaoa, Bale, Madoura, Augenio, B●rneo, and Solor, there sails at the least a thousand juncks, besides other smaller vessels wherewith all the rivers and all the harbours are full. The King naturally is no way given to tyranny. The customs of all the Kingdom are charitably destinated for the maintenance of certain Pagodes, where the duties that are paid are very easy; for whereas the religious men are forbidden to trade with money, they take no more of Merchants then what they will give them out of alms. There are in this Country twelve Sects of Gentiles, as in the Kingdom of Pegu; and the King for a sovereign title causeth himself to be called Prechau Saliu, which in our tongue signifies, A holy member of God. He shows not himself to the people save only twice in the year, but then with so much riches and majesty, as he hath power and greatness, and yet for all this that I say, he less not to acknowledge himself the vassal and tributary to the King of China, to the end that by means thereof his subjects Juncks may be admitted into the port of Combay, where ordinarily they exercise their commerce. There is also in this Kingdom a great quantity of Pepper, Ginger, Cinnamon, Camphire, Allume, Cassia, Tamarinds and Cardamon; so as one may truly affirm that, which I have often heard say in those parts, namely, that this Kingdom is one of the best countries in the world, and easier to be subdued then any other Province, how little soever, I could here report likewise many more particularities of things which I have seen only in the city of Odiaa, but I am not minded to make mention of them, that I may not beget in them that shall read this the same grief which I have for the loss which we made of it through our sins, and the gain we might make in conquering this Kingdom. CHAP. LXXI. A continuation of that which happened in the Kingdom of Pegu, as well during the life, as after the death of the King of Bramaa. TO return now unto the history which heretofore I have left, you must know, that after the King of Bramaa had obtained that memorable victory near to Pegu, §. 1. as I have declared heretofore, by means whereof he remained peaceable possessor of the whole Kingdom, the first thing he employed himself in was to punish the offenders, which had formerly rebelled; for which effect he cut off the heads of a great many of the Nobility, and Commanders, all whose estates were confiscated to the Crown, which (according to report) amounted unto ten millions of gold, besides plate and jewels, whereby that common Proverb, which was common in the mouths of all, was verified, namely, That one man's offence cost many men very dear. Whilst the King continued more and more in his cruelties, and injustice, which he executed against divers persons during the space of two months and a half, certain news came to him, that the city of Martabano was revolted, with the death of two thousand Bramaas, and that the Chalogomin, Governor of the same city, had declared himself for the Xemindoo. But that the cause of this revolt may be the better understood by such as are curious, I will (before I proceed any further) succinctly relate, how this Xemindoo had been of a religious order in Pegu, a man of noble extraction, and (as some affirmed) near of kin to the precedent King, whom this Bramaa had put to death twelve years before, as I have already declared. This Xemindoo had formerly to name Xoripam Xay, a man of about forty five years of age, of a great understanding, and held by every one for a Saint: he was withal very well versed in the Laws of their Sects & false Religion, and had many excellent parts, which rendered him so agreeable unto all that heard him preach, as he was no sooner in the Pulpit, but all the assistants prostrated themselves on the ground, saying at every word that he uttered, Assuredly God speaks in thee. This Xemindoo, seeing himself then in such great credit with the people, spurred on by the generosity of his nature, and the occasion which was then so favourable unto him, resolved to try his fortune, and see to what degree it might arrive. To this end, at such time as the King of Bramaa was fallen upon the kingdom of Siam, and had laid siege to the city of Odiaa, the Xemindoo preaching in the temple of Conquiay at Pegu, which is as it were the Cathedral of all the rest, where there was a very great assembly of people, he discoursed at large of the loss of this Kingdom, of the death of their lawful King, as also of the great extortions, cruel punishments, and many other mischiefs which the Bramaas had done to their Nation; with so many insolences, and with so many offences against God, as even the very houses which had been founded by the charity of good people, to serve for Temples wherein the Divine Word might be preached, were all desolated and demolished; or if any were found still standing, they were made use of, either for stables, lay-stalls, or other such places accustomed to lay filth or dung in. These, and many other such like things, which the X●mindoo delivered, accompanied with many sighs and tears, made so great an impression in the minds of the people, as from thenceforward they acknowledged him for their lawful King, and swore allegiance unto him; so that instead of calling him, as they did before, Xoripam Xay, they named him Xemindoo, as a sovereign title which they gave him above all others. Seeing himself raised then to the dignity of King, the first thing during the heat and fury of this people, was to go to the King of Bramaas palace, where having found five thousand Bramaas, he cut them all in pieces, not sparing the life of one of them; the like did he afterwards to all the rest of them that were abiding in the most important places of the State, and withal he seized on the King's treasure, which was not small. In this manner he slew all the Bramaas that were in the Kingdom, which were fifteen thousand, besides the women of that Nation of what age soever, and seized on the places where they resided, which were instantly demolished; so that in the space of three and twenty days only he became absolute possessor of the Kingdom, and prepared a great Army to fight with the King of Bramaa, if he should chance to return upon the bruit of this rebellion, as indeed he fought with him to his great damage, being defeated by him, as I have heretofore declared. And thus having methinks said enough for the intelligence of that which I am to recount, I will come again to my first discourse. This King of Bra●aa being advertised of the revolt of the Town of Martabano, and of the death of those two thousand Bramaaes, gave order immediately to all the Lords of the Kingdom for their repair unto him with as many men as they could levy, and that within the te●m of fifteen days at the furthest, in regard the present necessity would not endure a longer delay. This done, he parted the day following with a small train from the City of Pegu, to give example to others to do the like, and wept and lodged at a Town called Mouchan, with an intention to tarry there those fifteen days he had limited the Lords to come unto him. Now whenas six or seven of them were already past, he was advertised that Xemin de Satan, Governor of a Town so named, had secretly sent a great sum of gold to the Zemindoo, and had withal done him homage for the same Town where he commanded. This news somewhat troubled the King of Bramaa, who devising with himself of the means which he might use to meet with the mischief that threatened him, he sent for Xemin de Satan, who was then in the said Town of his Government, with a purpose to cut off his head; but he, betaking himself to his bed, and making show of being sick, answered, that he would wait upon the King as soon as he was able to rise. Now in regard he found himself to be guilty, and misdoubting the cause wherefore he was sent for, he communicated this affair to a dozen of his kinsmen that were there present with him, who all of them concluded together, how since there was no better way to save himself then in killing the King, that without further delay it was to be put in execution, so that all of them offering secretly to assist him in this enterprise, they speedily assembled all their Confidents, without declaring unto them at first the occasion wherefore they did it; and withal, drawing others unto them with many fair promises, they made up of all being joined together a company of six hundred men. Whereupon being informed that the King was lodged in a certain Pagode, they fell upon it with great violence, and fortune was so favourable unto them that finding him almost alone in his chamber, they slew him without incurring any danger. That done, they retired into an outward Court, where the King's Guard having had some notice of this treason, set upon them, and the conflict was so hot between them, that in half an hours space, or thereabout, eight hundred men lay dead in the place, whereof the most part were Bramaaes. After this Xemin de Satan making away with four hundred of his followers, went to a place of a large extent, called Poutel, whither all those of the country round about resorted unto him, who being advertised of the death of the King of Bramaa, whom they mortally hated, made up a body of five thousand men, and went to seek out the three thousand Bramaaes which the King had brought thither with him: And forasmuch as these same were dispersed in several places, they were all of them easily slain, not scarce so much as one escaping. With them also were killed fourscore of three hundred Portugals that Diego Suarez had with him, who, together with all the rest which remained with their lives saved, rendered themselves upon composition, and were received to mercy, upon condition that for the future they should faithfully serve Xemin de Satan, as their proper King, which they easily promised to do. Nine days after this mutiny, the Rebel seeing himself favoured by fortune, and such a multitude of people at his devotion, which were come to him out of this Province, to the number of thirty thousand men, caused himself to be declared King of Pegu, promising great recompenses to such as should follow and accompany him, until he had wholly gained the Kingdom, and driven the Bramaaes out of the country. With this design he retired to a fortress called Tagalaa, and resolved to fortify himself there out of the fear he was in of the forces which were to come to the succour of the deceased King, thinking to find him alive, having been advertised that many were already set forth from the City of Pegu for that purpose. Now of those Bramaaes which Xemin de Satan had slain, one by chance escaped, and cast himself all wounde● as he was into the river, and swimming over, never left travelling all that night, and the day following, for fear of the Pegues, until he arrived at a place, called Coutasarem, where he encountered with the Chaumigrem, the deceased King's Foster-brother, who was encamped there with an army of an hundred and ●ourscore thousand men, whereof there were but only thirty thousand Bramaaes, all the rest Pegues; finding him then upon the point of parting from thence, in regard of the heat that would be within two hours after, he acquainted him with the death of the King, and all that had passed besides. Now though this news greatly troubled the Chaumigrem, yet he dissembled it for the present with so much courage and prudence, as not one of his followers perceived any alteration in him: But contrarily, putting on a rich habit of Carnation Satin, embroidered with gold, and a chain of precious stones about his neck, he caused all the Lords and Commanders of his Army to assemble before him, and then speaking to them with the semblance of a joyful man, Gentlemen, said he, this fellow which you saw come to me but now in such haste, hath brought me this Letter, which I have here in my hand, from the King, my Lord and yours; and although by the contents thereof he seemeth to blame us for our careless●ness in linger thus, yet I hope e'er long to render him such an account of it, as his Highness shall give us all thanks for the service we have done him. By this letter too he certifies me, that he hath very certain intelligence, how the Zemindoo hath raised an army, with an intent to fall upon the Towns of Cosmin and Dal●● and to gain all along the rivers of Digon and Me●doo, the whole Province of Danapl●● even to Ansedaa; wherefore he hath expressly enjoined me, that as soon as possibly I may, I put into those places (as the most important) such forces as shall be able to resist the enemy; and that I take heed nothing be lost through my negligence, because in that case ●e will admit of no excuse. This being so, it seems to me very important and necessary for his service, that you my Lord Xemi●brum go instantly without all delay, and put yourself with your forces into the Town of D●laa; and your brother-in-law Ba●●haa Quem into that of Digon, with his fifteen thousand men; as for Colonel Gipray and Monpocasser, they shall go with their thirty thousand soldiers into Ansedaa, and Danapluu, and Ciguamcan, with twenty thousand men shall march along to Xaraa, and so to M●lacou; moreover Quiay Brazagaran, with his brethren and kinsmen, shall go for General of the Frontier, with an Army of fifty thousand men, to the end that assisted with those forces, he may in person give order wheresoever need shall be. Behold, what the King hath written to me, whereof I pray you let us make an agreement, and all sign it together, for it is no reason that my head should answer for your want of care, and imprudence. His Commanders presently obeyed him, and without longer tarrying there, each of them went strait to the place, whither his Commission directed him. The Chaumigrem, by means of this so cunning and well dissembled a sleight, rid himself in less than three hours of all the hundred and fifty thousand Pegues, who he knew, if once they came to hear of the King's death, would fall upon the thirty thousand Bramaaes that he had there with him, and not leave one of them alive. This done, as soon as it was night, turning back to the City, which was not above a league from thence, he seized with all speed on the deceased King's Treasure, which amounted, according to report, unto above thirty millions of gold, besides jewels that were not to be estimated; and withal, he saved all the Bramaa●s wives and children, and took as many arms and as much ammunition as he could carry away. After this, he set fire on all that was in the Magazines, caused all the lesser Ordnance to be rived asunder, and the greater, which he could not use so, to be cloyed. Furthermore, he made seven thousand Elephants that were in the country to be killed, reserving only two thousand for the carriage of his treasure, ammunition, and baggage. As for all the rest, it was consumed with fire, so that neither in the Palace, where were chambers all seeked with gold, nor in the Magazines and arsenals, nor on the river, where were two thousand rowing Vessels, remained aught that was not reduced to ashes. After this execution, he departed in all haste, an hour before day, and drew directly towards Tanguu, which was his own country, from whence he came some fourteen years before to the conquest of the Kingdom of Pegu, which in the heart of the country was distant from thence about an hundred and threescore leagues. Now whereas fear commonly adds wings to the feet, it made him march with such speed, as he and his arrived in fifteen days at the place whither they were a going. In the mean time, whereas the Chaumigrem had cunningly sent away the hundred and fifty thousand Pegues, as I have declared already, it happened that two days after they understood how the King of Bramaa was dead: Now in regard they were mortal enemies of that Nation, sixscore thousand of them in one great body turned back in haste for to go in quest of the thirty thousand Bramaaes, but when they arrived at the City, they found that they were gone from thence three days before; this making them to follow in pursuit of them with all the speed that possibly they could, they came to a place, called Guinacoutel, some forty leagues from the City whence they came; there they were informed, that it was five days since they passed by, so that despairing of being able to execute the design which they had of cutting them in pieces, they returned back to the place from whence they were parted, where they consulted amongst themselves about that which they were to do and resolved in the end, since they had no lawful King, and that the Land was quite freed of the Bramaaes, to go to Xemin de Satan, as incontinently they did, who received them, not only with a great deal of joy and good entertainment, but promised them mighty matters, and much honour, by raising them to the principal commands of the Kingdom, as soon as time should serve, and that he was more peaceably settled. Thereupon he went directly to the City of Pegu, where he was received with the magnificence of a King, and for such crowned in the Temple of Comquiay, which is the chief of all the rest. CHAP. LXXII. That which arrived in the time of Xenim de Satan, and an abominable ●ase that befell to Diego Suarez; together with the Xemindoos expedition against Xenim de Satan; and that which ensued thereupon. THree months and nine days had this Tyrant Xenim de Satan already peaceably possessed the city and kingdom of Pegu, whenas without fearing any thing, or being contradicted by none, he fell to distributing the treasure and revenues of the Crown to whomsoever he pleased, whereupon great scandals ensued, which were the cause of divers quarrels and divisions amongst many of the Lords, who for this cause, and the injustice which this tyrant did them, retired into several foreign Countries and Kingdoms. Some also went and sided with the Xemindo●, who began at that time to be in reputation again: For after he had fled from the battle only with six horse, as I have declared heretofore, he got into the Kingdom of Ansedaa, where as well by the efficacy of his Sermons, as by the authority of his person, he won so many to his devotion, as assisted by the favour and forces of those Lords as adhered to him, he made up an army of threescore thousand men, with which he marched to Meidoo, where he was very well received by those of the Country. Now setting aside what he did in those parts, during the space of four months, that he abode there, I will in the mean time pass to a strange accident which in a few days fell out in this city, that one may know what end the good fortune of the great Diego Suarez had, who had been Governor of this Kingdom of Peg●; and the recompense which the world is accustomed to make at last unto all such as serve and trust in it, under the semblance of a good countenance which she shows them at first. The matter passed in this sort; There was in this city of Pegu a Merchant, called Manbagoaa, a rich man, and that of good reputation in the country: This same resolved to marry a daughter of his to a young man, the son of a worshipful and very rich Merchant also, named Manicaniandarim, about that time that Diego Suarez was in the greatest height of his fortune, and termed the King's brother, and in dignity above all the Princes and Lords of the Kingdom. So the fathers of these young couple being agreed on this marriage, and of the dowry that was to be given, which by report was three hundred thousand ducats; when as the day was come wherein the nuptials were celebrated with a great deal of state and magnificence, and honoured with the presence of most of the gentlemen of chiefest quality in the city, it happened that Diego Suarez, being come a little before Sunset from the royal palace, with a great train both of horse and foot, as his manner was to be always well accompanied, passed by Mambogoaas door, where hearing the music and rejoicing that was in the house, asked what the matter was, whereunto answer being made him, that Mambogoaa had married his daughter, and that the wedding was kept there, he presently caused the Elephant on which he was mounted to stay, and sent one to tell the father of the bride, that he congratulated with him for this marriage, and wished a long and happy life to the new married couple; to these words he added many others by way of compliment, yea and made him many offers if he would make use of him; wherewith the old father of the bride finding himself so exceedingly honoured, as not knowing how to acknowledge it, in regard the person who did him so much honour, was no less than the King himself in greatness and dignity, the desire which he had to satisfy this obligation in part, if he could not wholly do it, made him go and take his daughter by the hand, accompanied with many Ladies of quality, and so leading her to the street door, where Diego Suarez was, he prostrated himself on the ground with a great deal of respect, and with many compliments after his manner, thanked him for the favour and honour that he had done him. Thereupon the new married bride, having taken from off her finger a rich ring, presented it on her knees by her father's express commandment, to Diego Suarez; but he that naturally was sensual and lascivious, instead of using civility, whereunto the Laws of generosity and friendship obliged him, having taken the ring which the maid presented unto him, he reached out his hand, and plucked her to him by force, saying, God forbid that so fair a maid as you should fall into any other hands but mine; whereupon the poor old man seeing Diego Suarez hale his daughter so rudely, lifting up both his hands to heaven, with his knees on the ground, and tears in his eyes, My Lord, said he unto him I humbly beseech thee for the love and respect of the great God, whom thou adorest, and which was conceived without any spot of sin in the Virgin's womb, as I confess and believe, according to that which I have heard thereof, that thou wilt not forcibly take away my daughter; for if thou dost so, I shall assuredly die with grief and displeasure at it; but if thou desire of me that I should give thee her dowry, together with all that is in my house, and that I deliver up myself unto thee for thy slave, I will instantly do it, provided thou wilt permit that her husband may possess her, for I have no other good in the world but ●●e, nor will I have any other as long as I live. Whereupon offering to lay hold on his daughter, Diego Suarez making no answer to him, turned himself about to the Captain of his guard, who was a Turk by Nation, and said unto him, kill this dog The Turk presently drew out his Scymitar to kill the poor old man, but he suddenly fled away, leaving his daughter with her hair all about her ears in Diego Suarez his hands. In the mean time the Bridegroom came running to this tumult, with his cheeks all bedeawed with tears, but he was scarcely arrived there, whenas these Barbarians slew him, and his Father too, with six or seven other of his kinsmen. Whilst this past so, the women made such fearful cries in the house, as terrified all those that heard them, so that even the earth and the air seemed to tremble at it, or to say better, they demanded vengeance of God for the little respect which was had to his divine justice, and for so great a violence as this was; and truly if I do not more amply report the particularities of so black and so abominable an action, I desire to be excused, in regard I pass them by for the honour of the Portugal Nation. Wherefore it shall suffice me to say, that this poor Maid seeing herself upon the point to be forced, strangled herself with a string that she wore about her middle for a girdle, which she chose rather to do, then suffer this sensual and brutish man to carry her away with him by force; but he was therewith so displeased, as he was heard to say, that he repented him more for that he had not enjoyed her, then for using her in that sort as he did. Now from the day of this abhorred act, till four years after, the good old man, the Father of the Bride, was never seen to go out of his house; but at length to give a greater demonstration of his sorrow, and to show his extreme resentment of the matter, he covered himself with an old tattered mat, and in that sad equipage went up and down, begging an alms of his very slaves, never eating any thing, but lying all along naked, and his face fixed on the ground. Thus continued he in so sad a manner of life, until in the end he saw that the season invited him to have recourse unto justice, which he demanded in this sort; perceiving that in the Kingdom there was another King, other Governors, and other Jurisdiction, alterations which time ordinarily produceth in every country, and in all kind of affairs, he went out of his house in the wretched fashion he had so long used, having a big cord about his neck, and a white beard, reaching almost down to his girdle, and got him into the midst of a great place, where stood a Temple called Quiay Fantare●, that is to say, the God of the afflicted; there he took the idol from off the Altar, and holding it in his arms, he returned out of the Temple, to the said great place, where having cried out aloud three times to draw the people together, as accordingly they came flocking in unto him, he said with tears in his eyes; O ye people, ye people! who with a clean and peaceable heart make profession of the truth of this God of the afflicted, which you see here in my arms, come forth like lightning in a dark and rainy night, and join with me in crying so loud, that our cries may pierce the heavens, to the end the pitiful ear of the Lord may be drawn to hear our heavy lamentations, and by them he may know the reason we have to demand justice against this accursed stranger, as the most wicked man that ever was born into the world; for this abominable wretch hath not been contented with spoiling us of our goods, but hath also dishonoured our families; wherefore whosoever shall not with me accompany the God which I hold in my hands, and water with my tears, in detesting so horrible a crime, let the gluttonous Serpent of the profound pit of smoke abridge his days miserably, and tear his body in pieces at midnight. This old man's words so mightily terrified the Assistants, and made so deep an impression in their minds, that in a short time fifty thousand persons assembled in that place, with so much fury and desire of revenge, as was wonderful to behold. Thus the number of the people still more and more increasing, they ran thronging straight to the King's Palace, with so horrible a noise, as struck terror into all that heard them. In this disorder, being arrived at the outward Court of the Palace, they cried out six or seven times with a dreadful tone; O King come out of the place wherein thou art shut up, to hearken to the voice of thy God, who demands justice of thee by the mouth of thy poor people. At these cries the King put forth his head out of the window, and affrighted with so strange an accident, would needs know of them what they would have? whereunto they all answered unanimously with such loud cries, as seemed to pierce the heavens, justice, justice against a wicked infidel, who to spoil us of our goods hath killed our fathers, our children, our brothers, and our kinsmen. The King having thereupon inquired of them who it was, it is, answered they, an accursed thief, participating with the works of the Serpent, who in the fields of delight abused the first man that God created. Is it possible, said he unto them, that there should be any such thing as you tell me? whereunto they all replied, This same is the most accursed man that ever was born on the earth, and is so out of his wicked nature and inclination, wherefore we all of us beseech thee in the name of this God of the afflicted, that his veins may be as much emptied of his blood, as hell is filled with his wicked works. At these words the King turning towards them that were about him, What do you think hereof, said he unto them? What am I to do? and how am I to carry myself in so strange and extraordinary a matter? To which they all answered, My Lord, if thou wilt not hearken to that which this God of the afflicted comes to demand of thee, it is to be feared that he will take care no longer to aid th●e, and will refuse to support thee in thy dignity. Then the King turning himself again to the multitude that were below in the Court, bade them go to the place where the great Market was kept, and he would give order that the man whom they required should be delivered unto them to be disposed of at their pleasure. Whereupon having sent for the Chirca of justice, who is as the Sovereign Superintendent thereof above all others, he commanded him to go and apprehend Diego Suarez, and deliver him bound hand and foot to the people, that they might do justice upon him, for he feared if he did otherwise, that God would execute it upon him. The Chirca of Justice went immediately to Diego Suarez his house, and told him tsiat the King had sent for him; §. 2. he in the mean time was so troubled to see the Chirca come for him, that he remained a pretty while not able to answer him, as a man that was always besides himself, and had lost his understanding; but at length being somewhat come to himself again; He earnestly desired him to dispense with him at this time for going with him, in regard of a great pain that he had in his head, and that in acknowledgement of so good an office, he would give him forty ●isses of gold. Whereunto the Chirca replied, The offer which thou makest me is too little for me to take upon me that great pain which thou sayest thou hast in thy head, wherefore thou must go along with me, either by fair means or by force, since thou obligest me to tell thee the truth. Diego Suarez then, seeing that there was no means to excuse him, would have taken along with him six or seven of his servants, and the Chirca not permitting it; I must, said he unto him, fulfil the King's command, which is, that thou shalt come alone, and not with six or seven men, for the time is now past wherein thou wert wont to go so well accompanied, as I have oftentimes seen thee do; all thy support is gone by the death of the Tyrant of Bramaa, who was the quill wherewith thou blowedst up thyself to an unsupportable pride, as is apparent by the wicked actions which thou hast committed, which at this present accuse thee before the justice of God. This said, he took him by the hand, and led him along with him, environed with a guard of three hundred men, whereat we remained very much dismayed. Thus marching from one street to another, he arrived in the end at the Bazor, which was a public place where all kind of wares was sold; but as he was going thither, he met by chance with Balthasar Suarez his son, who came from a Merchant's house, whither his Father had sent him that morning to receive some money that was owing to him. The Son, seeing his Father in this plight, alighted presently from his horse, and casting himself at his feet; What means this, my Lord, said he unto him with tears in his eyes, and whence cemes it that you are led along in this sort? Ask it of my sins, answered Diego Suarez, and they will tell thee, for I protest unto thee my Son, that in the case I am in, all things seem dreams unto me. Thereupon embracing one another, and mingling their tears together, they continued so, until such time as the Chirca commanded Balthasar Suarez to get him gone, which he would not do, being loath to part from his father, but the Ministers of justice haled him away by force, and pushed him so rudely, as he fell and broke his head, yea and withal they gave him many blows besides, whereat his Father fell into a swoon. Being come again to himself, he craved a little water, which he had no sooner taken, but lifting up his hands to heaven, he said with tears in his eyes, Si iniquitates observab●ris Domine, Domine quis sustinebit? But, O Lord, added he, out of the great confidence I have in the infinite price of thy precious blood, which thou hast shed for me upon the cross, I may say with more assurance, Misericordias Domini in aeternum cantabo. Thus altogether desolated as he was in this last affliction, when he was come in sight of the place, whither the King had commanded him to be conducted, it is said, that perceiving so many people, he remained so exceedingly dismayed, that turning himself to a Portugal, who was permitted to accompany him, jesus, said he unto him, have all these accused me to the King? whereunto the Chirca made him this answer, It is no longer time for thee to think of this, for thou hast wit enough to know, that the people a●e of so unruly a humour, that they always follow evil whereunto they are naturally inclined. It is not that, replied Diego Suarez with tears in his eyes, for I know that if there be any unruliness in them, it proceeds from my sins. Thou seest thereby, said the Chirca, that this is the ordinary recompense which the world is accustomed to give to them, who during their life, have lost the memory of the divine justice, as thou hast done, and God g●ve thee the grace that in this little time thou hast to live, thou mayest repent thee of the faults thou committed, which possibly may avail thee more than all the gold that thou leavest behind thee, for an inheritance to him, who peradventure is the cause of thy death. Here Diego Suarez falling down on his knees, and lifting up his eyes to heaven, O Lord jesus Christ, cried he, my true Redeemer, I beseech thee by the pains which thou hast suffered upon the Cross, to permit that the accusation of these hundred thousand hungerstarved dogs against me, may serve to satisfy the chastisement of thy divine justice in my behalf, to the end that the inestimable price which thou hast employed for the salvation of my soul, without any merit of mine, may not be unprofitable unto me. This said, he ascended the stairs which led to the market place, and the Portugal that assisted him, told me, how at every step he kissed the ground, and called upon the name of JESUS; at length when he was come to the top, the Manbogoaa, who held the Idol in his arms, animating the people with great cries, said unto them, Whosoever shall not for the honour of this God of the afflicted, whom I have here in my arms, stone this accursed Serpent, let him for ever be miserable, and let the brains of his children be consumed in the midst of the night, to the end that by the punishment of so great a sin, the righteous judgement of the Lord above may be justified in them. He had no sooner made an end of speaking thus, but there fell so great a shower of stones on Diego Suarez, as in less than a quarter of an hour he was buried under them, and they that flung them at him, did it so indiscreetly, as the most part of them hurt one another therewith. An hour after they drew forth the poor Diego Suarez from under the stones, and with another new tumult of cries and voices they tore him in pieces, with so much fury and hatred of the whole people in general, as there was not he which did not believe that he did a charitable and holy work in giving a reward to the most mutinous amongst those, which dragged his members and entrails up and down the streets. This execution done, the King willing to confiscate his goods, sent men to his house for that purpose, where the disorder was so great, in regard of the extreme avarice which these hungry dogs had, they left not a tile unmoved; and because they found not so much as they expected, they put all his slaves and servants to torture, with such an excess of cruelty, as eight and thirty of them remained dead in the place, amongst which were seventeen Portugals, who bore the pain of a thing whereof they were not guilty. In all this spoil there were no more than six hundred bisses of gold found, which are in value three hundred thousand ducats, besides some pieces of rich householdstuff, but no precious stones, nor jewels at all, which persuaded men that Diego Suarez had buried all the rest; howsoever it could never be found out, notwithstanding all the search that was made for it, and yet it was verified by the judgement of some who had seen him in his prosperity, that he had in means above three millions of gold, according to the supputation of the country. Behold what was the end of the great Diego Suarez, whom fortune had so favoured in this Kingdom of Pegu, as she had raised him up to the degree of the King's Brother, the highest and most absolute title of all others, and given him withal two hundred thousand ducats yearly rent, with the charge of General of eight hundred thousand men, and Sovereign over all the other Governors or Viceroys of fourteen Kingdoms, which the King of Bramaa had at that time in his possession. But it is the ordinary course of the goods of this world, especially of such as are ill gotten, always to serve for a way to disgraces and misfortunes. §. 3. I return now to the Xemindoo▪ of whom I have not spoken a long time. Whereas that Tyrant and avaricious King Xenim de Satan gave daily new increases to the cruelties and tyrannies which he exercised against all sorts of persons, never ceasing killing and robbing indifferently those, who were thought to have money; nor sparing any thing on which he could lay his hands, his rapines proceeded so far, as it was that in the space of seven months only, wherein he was peaceable possessor of this Kingdom of Pegu, he put to death six thousand very rich Merchants, besides many ancient Lords of the Country, who by way of right of inheritance held their estates from the Crown. These extortions rendered him so odious, as the most part of those that were with him abandoned him to side with the Xemindoo, who had for him at that time the towns of Digon, Meideo, Dalaa, and Coulam, even to the confines of Xaraa, from whence he parted in haste to go and besiege this Tyrant with an army of two hundred thousand men, & five thousand Elephants. When he was arrived at the city of Pegu, where Xemin de Satan than kept his Court, he invested it round about with palisadoes and very strong trenches, yea and gave some assaults to it, but he could not enter it so easily as he believed, in regard of the great resistance he found from them within; wherefore judging it requisite for him to alter his mind, being prudent as he was, he came very subtis lie to a truce of twenty days with the Tyrant upon certain conditions, whereof the principal was, that if within the term of those twenty days he gave him a thousand bisses of gold, which are in value five hundred thousand ducats, he would desist from the pretention and right which he had to this Kingdom; and all this he did (as I have already said) cunningly, hoping by this means to bring him to his bow with less peril. So the time of the truce beginning to run on, all things remained peaceable on either side, and the besiegers fell to communicate with the besieged. During this pacification every morning two hours before day, they of the Xemindooes Camp played after their manner upon divers sorts of instruments very melodiously, at the sound whereof all they of the city ran to the walls to see what the matter was. Whereupon those instruments ceasing to play, a Proclamation was made by a Priest, accounted by every man a holy personage, who said these words with a very sad voice, O ye people, ye people! unto whom Nature hath given ears to hear, hear●en to the voice of the holy Captain the Xemindoo, of whom God will make use for the restoring you to your liberty and former quiet; in order whereunto he admonisheth you from Quiay Nivandel, the god of battles of the field Vitau, that none of you be so hardy as to lift up your hand against him, nor against this holy assembly which he hath made, out of a holy zeal towards these people of Pegu, as brother, that he is, to the least of all the poor: Otherwise whosoever shall come against the army of these servants of God, or shall have the will to do them any harm, let him be accursed for it, and as deformed and vile as the children of the night, who foaming with poison make horrible cries, and be delivered into the burning jaws of the dragon of discord, whom the true Lord of all the Gods hath cursed for ever; whereas contrarily, to those, that shall be so happy as to obey this Proclamation, as his holy brethren and allies, shall be granted in this life a perpetual peace, accompanied with a great deal of wealth and riches; and after their death their souls shall be no less pure and agreeable to God, than those of the Saints which go dancing amidst the beams of the Sun in the celestial repose of the Lord Almighty. This publication made, the music began to play again with a great noise as before, which made such an impression in the hearts of them that heard it, as in seven nights that it continued above threescore thousand persons went and rendered themselves to the Xemindoo; for most of them which heard those words gave as much credit thereunto, as if an Angel from heaven had spoken them. In the mean time the besieged Tyrant, seeing that these secret Proclamations of the enemy were so prejudicial unto him, as they could not choose but turn to his utter ruin, broke the truce at twelve day's end, and deliberated with his Council what he should do, who advised him by no means to suffer himself to remain any longer besieged, for fear left the inhabitants should mutiny, and fall from him to the enemy; and that the best and surest way was to fight with the Xemindoo in the open field, before he grew to any further strength. This resolution being approved of by Zenim de Satan, he prepared himself for the execution of it; to which effect he two days after before it was day sallied out at five gates of the city with fourscore thousand men, which then he had, and charged the enemies with strange fury. They then in the mean time, who always stood upon their guard, received them with a great deal of courage, whereupon ensued so cruel a conflict between them, that in less than half an hour, for so long lasted the heat of the fight, there fell on both sides above forty thousand men; but at the end of that time the new King Zenim was born from his Elephant by an harquebus shot, discharged at him by a Portugal, named Gonçalo N●to, which caused all the rest to render themselves, and the city likewise, upon condition that the inhabitants should have their goods and lives saved. By this means the Xemindoo entered peaceably into it, and the very same day, which was a Saturday the three and twentieth of February, a thousand five hundred fifty and one, he caused himself to be crowned King of Pegu in the greatest Temple of the city. As for Gonçalo N●to, he gave him in recompense for killing the Tyrant twenty Bisses of gold, which are ten thousand ducats; and to the other portugals, being eighty in number, he gave five thousand ducats, besides the honours and prsviledges which they had in the country; he also exempted them for three years from paying any custom for their merchandise, which was afterwards very exactly observed. CHAP. LXXIII. That which the Xemindoo did, after he was Crowned King of Pegu, with the Chaumigrems; the King of Bramaaes' Foster-Brothers coming against him, with a great Army; and divers other memorable things. THe Xemindoo seeing himself Crowned King of Pegu, and peaceable Lord of all the kingdom; began to have thoughts far different from those which Xemin de Satan had had, being raised to the same dignity of King; for the first and principal thing wherein he employed himself with all his endeavour, was to maintain his Kingdom in peace, and to cause Justice to flourish; as indeed he established it with so much integrity, as no man how great so ever he was, durst wrong a lesser than himself: withal in that which concerned the government of the Kingdom, he proceeded with so much virtue, and equity, as it filled the strangers that were there with admiration, so that one could not without marvel consider the peace the quiet, and union of the wills of the people; during the happy and peaceable estate of this Kingdom, which continued the space of a year, and better; at the end whereof the Chaumigrem, foster-brother to the same King of Bramaa, whom Xemin de Satan had slain, as I have before declared, having received advertisement, that by reason of the rebellions and wars, which since his departure from thence had happened in the Kingdom of Pegu; the principal men of the State there, had lost their lives; and the Xemindoo who then reigned, was unprovided of all things necessary for his defence; he resolved once again to adventure upon the same enterprise, which had formerly been undertaken by his late King. With this design, he entertained into his pay a mighty Army of strangers, unto whom he gave a Tincall of gold by the month, which is five dackets of our money; when as he had prepared all things in a readiness, he departed from Tanguu, the place of his birth: On the ninth day of March, a thousand, five hundred, fifty and two, with an Army of three hundred thousand men, whereof only fifty thousand were Bramaas, and all the rest Mons, Chaleus, Calaminhams, Sau●nis, Pam●rus, and Auaas. In the mean time the Xemindoo, the new King of Pegu, having certain intelligence of these great forces, which were coming to fall upon him, made preparation to go and meet them, with a design to give them battle; for which effect, he assembled in the same City where he was; a huge Army of nine hundred thousand men, which were all Pegues by nation, and consequently of a weak constitution, and less warlike than all the others, whereof I have spoken; and on Tueseday the fourth of April, about noon, having received advice that the enemy's Army was encamped all along the river of Meleytay some twelve leagues from thence, he used such expedition, as the same day, and the next night all his Soldiers were put into battle array, for whereas they had prepared every thing long before, and had also been trained by their Capt. there needed no great ado to bring them into order. The day ensueing, all these men of war begun about nine of the clock in the morning, to march at the sound of an infinite company of warlike instruments, and went and lodged that night some two leagues from thence near to the river Potar●u. The next day, an hour before Sunset the Bramaa Chaumigrem appeared with so great a body of men, as it took up the extent of a league and an half of ground; his Army being composed of seaventy thousand horse, of two hundred and thirty thousand foot, and six thousand fight elephants, besides as many more which carried the baggage and victuals; and in regard it was almost night, he thought fit to lodge himself all along by the mountain, that he might be in the greater safety. Thus the night passed with a good guard, and a strange noise that was made on either part. The day following, which was a Saturday, the seventh of April in the year one thousand, five hundred, fifty and three, about five of the clock in the morning, these two Armies began to move, but with different intentions; for the design of the Bramaa was to pass the foard, and recover an advantageous piece of ground, which lay near to another river; and the Xemindoo had a desire to keep him from it, and to stop his passage; upon this contention, some skirmishes ensued, which continued most part of the day, and wherein about five hundred men on the one side, and the other were slain, howbeit the advantage remained with the Chaumigrem, because he gained the place whereunto he pretended, and passed all the night there in banqueting, and making great bonfires for this good success. The next day betimes in the morning the Xemindoo, King of Pegu, presented the battle to his enemies, who did not refuse it; so that they encountered one another with all the fury that a cruel hatred is accustomed to kindle in such like cases; the two vantgards then, who were the best Soldiers amongst them, fell so lustily unto it, that in less than half an hour, all the Field was covered with dead bodies, and the Pegues began to lack courage. Whereupon the Xemindoo seeing his men give ground, came to succour them with a body of three thousand elephants, wherewith he set upon the seventy thousand horse so courageously, and to the purpose, as the Bramaaes lost all that they had gained; which perceived by the Chaumigrem, who was better experienced in matters of War, knowing full well what he was to do, to recover all again; made show of retiring, as if he had been vanquished; the Xemindoo thereupon, who understood not this stratagem, and that thought of nothing but the victory, pursued his enemy about a quarter of a league: but incontinently the Bramaa facing about with all his forces, fell upon his enemy with such violence and horrible cries, as not only men, but even the very earth, and all the other elements seemed to tremble at it. By this means the conflict renewed in such sort, as in a little time the air was seen all on fire, and the ground watered all over with blood; for the Pegu Lords and Commanders, beholding their King so far engaged in the battle, and likely to lose the day, ran instantly to his succour, the like did the Panonsaray, the Bramaaes' brother, on his side, with forty thousand men, and two thousand elephants; so that there ensued betwixt them, so bloody and dreadful a fight, as words are not able to express the truth of it; wherefore I shall say no more, but that half an hour, or there about, before Sunset, the Army of nine hundred thousand Pegues was utterly discomfited; and as it was said, four hundred thousand of them were left dead on the place, and all the rest, or the most part of them, grievously wounded; which the Xemindoo seeing, fled out of the field, and so escaped. Thus did the victory remain unto the Chaumigrem, who thereupon caused himself to be crowned King of Pegu, with the same royal Ensigns, magnificence, and triumph, as the other King of Bramaa, whom Xemin de Satan slew, had formerly been. And in regard it was already night, they bestowed the time in no other thing, but in dressing the hurt men, and keeping good watch in the Camp. The next day, as soon as it was light, all the victorious soldiers, Sect. 1. as well wounded as unwounded, ●an to the spoil of the dead bodies; wherewith divers amongst them were mightily enriched; for they found there great store of Gold and Jewels, by reason the custom of those Gentiles is, (as I think, I have heretofore delivered) to carry all their wealth about them to the War. The soldiers being well satisfied in this particular, the new King of this miserable Kingdom parted forthwith from the place where he had gotten the Victory, and marched towards the City of Pegu, distant so●● three leagues from thence. Now forasmuch as he would not that day enter into it, for certain considerations which I will relate hereafter, he set himself down in the view of it, about half a league off, in a Plain, called Sunday Patir: and after he had thus encamped his Army, he gave order for the guard of the four and twenty gates thereof, by placing at each of them a Bramaa Commander with five thousand Horse. In this manner he remained there five days, without being able to resolve to enter into the City, out of the fear he was in, lest the strangers should require of him the pillage of it, as indeed, he was obliged to grant it to them by the promise which he had made them for it at Tanguu. Now the custom of men of War, who live but upon their pay, being to have regard to nothing but their interests, these six Nations seeing the King thus defer his entry into the City, which they could not brook, began to mutiny, and this by the instigation of a Portugal, named Christonano Surnento, a man of a turbulent spirit, but otherwise a good and valiant Commander; and this mutiny proceeded so far, as the King of Bramaa for his own safety was constrained to retire into a Pagode, where he fortified himself with his Bramaaes, until that the next morning about nine of the clock he came to a truce with them, and causing them to assemble together, from the top of a wall he spoke to them in this sort, My worthy Friends, and valiant Commanders, I have caused you to come to this holy resting place of the dead, to the end that with a solemn Oath I may discover unto you my intentions; whereof, with my knees on the ground, and my eyes lift up unto heaven, I take to witness Quiay Nivandel, the God of Battle of the field Vitau, beseeching him to be judge of this between you and me, and to strike me dumb, if I do not tell you the truth. I very well remember the promise I made you at Tanguu, which was, to give you the pillage of this tumultuous City; as well because I believed your valour would be as it were the minister of my revenge, as in some sort to satisfy your avarice, whereunto I know you are naturally very much inclined: Now having given you this promise for a gage of my faith, I acknowledge that I am altogether obliged not to break my word with you But when on the other side, I come to consider the great inconveniences which may accrue to me thereby, and the strict account which I shall one day render for it before the equitable and rigorous justice of the Lord above, I must confess unto you, that I am very much afraid of charging myself with so heavy a burden: wherefore Reason advises me to render myself ●aulty towards men, rather than to fall into the displeasure of God: Besides, it is not reasonable that the innocent should pay for the guilty, and of whom I am sufficiently satisfied with the death which they have received in this last battle by your hands. Behold, how I earnestly entreat you, as children that you are of my bowels, that having regard to my good intention, you will not kindle this fire wherein my soul will be burnt, since you see well enough how reasonable that is which I desire of you, and how unjust it would be for you to refuse it me. Nevertheless, to the end you may not remain altogether without recompense, I do here promise you to contribute thereunto all that shall seem reasonable to you, and to supply this default in part with my own goods, with my Person, with my Kingdom, and with my State. Hereupon the Commanders of those six Nations hearing the King's justification, and the promise which he made them, yielded to agree unto whatsoever he would do: howbeit, they prayed him above all things to have regard unto soldier's pretensions, who were not at any hand to be discontented, but greatly to be made account of. Whereunto the King replied, That they had reason, and that in all things he would endeavour to conform himself to whatsoever they should judge reasonable. In the mean time, to avoid disputes which might ensue hereupon, it was concluded, that they should refer themselves to Arbitrators: for which effect the Mutineers were to name three on their side, and the King three others on his, which made six in all, whereof three were to be Religious men, and the rest Strangers, that so the judgement might be given with less suspicion. This resolution being taken between them, they agreed together, that the three Religious men should be the Menigrepos of a Pagode, that was named Quiay Hifaron, that is to say, the God of Poverty; and that for the other three Strangers, the King and the Mutineers should cast lots, to see who should choose one or two of them on his side. This Election being fallen to the King, he made a choice of two Portugals, of an hundred and forty that were then in the City; whereof the one was Gonçalo Pacheco, the King our Master's Factor for Lacre, a worthy man, and of a good conscience; and the other a worshipful Merchant, named Nuno Fernandez Teixeyra, whom the King held in good esteem, as having known him in the life time of the deceased King. By the same means the Commanders of the Mutineers elected another stranger, whose name I do not know. Things thus concluded, the Judges destined for the resolution of this Affair, were sent for, because the King was not willing to stir out of the place where he was, until the matter was determined; to the end he might dismiss them all peaceably before he entered into the City, for fear lest if they entered with him, they should not keep their word. For this purpose then the King about midnight sent a Bramaa on horseback to the Portugals quarter, who were in no less fear than the Pegues of being plundered and killed. After that the Bramaa was come into the City, and that he had asked aloud (for so they use to do when they come from the King) where the Captain of the Portugals was, he was presently conducted to his Lodging, where being arrived, It is a thing (said he to the Captain) as proper to the nature of that Lord above, who hath created the firmament and the whole heavens, to make good men for the conversion of the wicked, as it is ordinary with the pernicious Dragon to nourish in his bosom spirits of commotion and tumult, to bring disorder unto the peace which conserveses us in the holy Law of the Lord. I mean hereby (continued he) that amongst all those of your Nation there is one wicked man found, vomiting out of his infernal stomach flames of discord and sedition, by means whereof he hath caused the three strange Nations of the Chalons, Meleytes and Savadis to mutiny in the King my Master's Army, whereupon hath ensued so great a mischief, that besides almost the utter ruin of the Camp, three thousand Bramaaes have been slain, and the King himself hath been in such danger, as he was fain to retire into a Fort, where he hath remained three days, and still is there, not daring to come out, because he cannot put any trust in those strangers. Howbeit, for a remedy of so great unquietness, it hath pleased God, who is the true Father of concord, to inspire the King's heart with patience to endure this injury, being prudent as he is, to the end he may by that means pacify the tumult and rebellion of these three turbulent Nations, who inhabit the most desert parts of the mountains of Mons, and are the most accursed of God amongst all people. Now, to make an entry into this peace and union, a Treaty hath been had between the King and the Commanders of the Mutineers, whereby it hath been concluded on either part with an Oath, That to exempt this City from the plundering which had been promised to the Soldiers, the King shall give them out of his own estate, as much as six men, deputed for that purpose, shall award; of which number there are already four, so that to make up the whole six, there wants none but thee, whom the King hath chosen for him; and another Portugal, whose name is written in this paper, whereby thou shalt be ascertained of that which I have said unto thee. Thereupon he delivered a Letter unto him from the King of Bramaa; which Gonçalo Pacheco received upon his knees, and laid upon his head, with exterior compliments so full of civility and courtesy, as the Bramaa remained very much contented and satisfied therewith, and said unto him, Surely, the King my Master must needs have a great knowledge of thee, in that he hath chosen thee for a judge of his Honour and Estate▪ Hereupon Gonçalo Pacheco read the Letter aloud before all the Portugals, who heard it standing, with their hats in their hands: The contents of it were to this effect, Captain Gonçalo Pacheco, my dear Friend, and that appears before my eyes like a precious Pearl, as being no less virtuous in the tranquillity of thy life, than the holiest Menigrepos which live in the Deserts; I, the ancient Chaumigrem, and new King of fourteen States, which God hath now put into my hands by the death of the holy King my Master, do send thee a smile of my mouth, to the end thou mayest be as agreeable to me, as those whom I cause to sit at my table in a day of joy and feasting: Know then, that I have thought good to take thee for a judge of the Affair that is in question, and therefore have sent for thee, together with my good Friend, Nuno Fernandez Teixeyra, to come presently unto me, for to give an end to this business, which I wholly commit unto your trust. And for so much as concerns the security of your persons, in regard of the fear you may be in of the late Mutiny, I do engage my word, and swear to you by the faith which a King ought to have, whom God himself hath anointed, that I will take you, and all those of your Nation, with all others that believe in your God, into my protection. After that this Letter was read, to the great astonishment of all us that heard it, we could believe no other, but that by Divine permission it came from Heaven for the assurance of our lives, whereof we stood in very great doubt until then. Gonçalo Pacheco and Nuno Fernandez, with ten other Portugals which were chosen for that purpose, instantly prepared a Present of divers rich Pieces to carry to the King, unto whom they went that very same night an hour before day, in the company of the Bramaa who brought the Letter, in regard the haste the King was in would brook no delay. Gonçalo Pacheco, Nuno Fernandez, and the other Portugals, arrived at the camp an hour before Sunrising, and the King sent to receive them one of the chiefest Bramaa Commanders that he had, and in whom he very much confided, who was accompanied with above an hundred horse, and six Sergeants at arms that carried maces. This same received the Portugals, and lead them to the King, who did much honour unto Gonçalo Pacheco, and Nuno Fernandez; and after he had talked with them of divers matters, he put them in mind of the importance of the business for which he had sent for them, and willed them by any means to lean rather to the Commanders then to him, assuring them that he should be very well contented therewith, and said many things to them to that purpose. Then he caused them to be conducted by the same Bramaa Lord to the Tent, where the other four Arbitrators were with the high Treasurer and two Registers; when as they had commanded silence to all that were without, they fell to debating of the business for which they were assembled together; whereupon there were many opinions, which took up the most part of the day, but at last all six came to conclude, That albeit on the one side the King, by the promise which he had made at Tanguu to the foreign Soldiers, for to give them the spoil or pillage of the places which he should take by force, was exceedingly obliged to the performance thereof, yet seeing that on the other side this promise was of great and notable prejudice to the innocent, because it could not be put in execution without greatly offending God; these things considered, they ordained by their award; That the King, in regard of the promise which he had made them, should pay unto them a thousand bisses of gold out of his own treasure; and that upon the Soldiers receiving thereof, they should pass over to the other side of the River, and retire directly into their countries; but that they should first be also paid all that was due to them before this mutiny began, and that they should be furnished with victuals sufficient for twenty days. This award being published, was received with much content to either party; So that the King commanded it to be instantly and punctually executed; and for a greater testimony of his liberality, after he had paid them all this sum of money, he bestowed upon the Commanders and Officers of each Company many bountiful rewards, wherewith they were all of them very well pleased, and satisfied. In this sort were these three mutinous nations discharged; for the King would by no means trust, or make use of them any longer: Howbeit, he would not suffer these strangers to go all away together, but caused them to be divided into troops; each of them consisting of a thousand men, to the end that by this means, they should give the less suspicion in their return, and should be less able to plunder the open towns, by which they were to pass; and thus the next day they departed. As for Gonçalo Pacheco, and Nuno Fernandez Teixyra, the King gave them ten bisses of gold, for being his Arbitrators in this affair, whereunto he added a passport written with his own hand, whereby the Portugals were permitted to retire freely into the Indies, without paying any custom or duty for their merchandise; whereof we made more account then of all the money could have been given us, because that for three years before the precedent Kings had retained us in this country, with exceeding much vexation and tyranny, whereby we were oftentimes in great danger of our lives, by reason of the success of that which I have spoken heretofore. This done, there were Proclamations made by men on horseback, to give notice that the day following, the King would enter into the City in a peaceable manner, threatening all such as should do the contrary, with a cruel death. Accordingly, the next morning at nine of the clock the King parted from the Pagode, whither he had retired himself; and about an hour after arrived at the City, wherein to entering by the chiefest gate, he was received by an assembly (in form of a▪ Procession) of six thousand Priests of all the twelve Sects which are in this Kingdom; by one of whom, called Capizundo, an oration was made unto him, whereof the preface was thus, Blessed and praised be that Lord, who ought truly to be acknowledged of all men for such, in regard of the holy works which he hath made with his Divine hands, testified to us by the light of the day, the shining of the night, and all the other magnificences of his mercy which he hath produced in us; Praised be he, I say, for that by the effects of his infinite power, which are agreeable unto him, he hath been pleased to establish thee on the earth above all the Kings that govern it; and seeing we hold thee for his favourite, we humbly beseech thee our Lord, that thou wilt never more remember the faults and offences which we have committed against thee, to the end that these thy afflicted people may be comforted with the promise thereof, which they hope thy Majesty will make them at this present. This same request was likewise made unto him by the six thousand Grepos, all prostrated on the ground, and with their hands lifted up to heaven, who with a dreadful tumult of voices said unto him; Grant, our Lord and King, peace and pardon for that is passed to all the people of this thy Kingdom of Pegu, to the end they may not be troubled with the fear of their offences, which they confess publicly before thee. The King answered them, that he was contented so to do, and swore to them by the head of Quiay Nivandel, the God of Battle of the field Vitau, for the confirmation thereof. Upon this promise all the people prostrated themselves with their faces on the ground, and said unto him; God make thee to prosper for infinite years in the victory over thy enemies, that thou mayest trample their heads under thy feet. Hereupon for a token of great gladness, they fell to playing on divers instruments after their manner, though very barbarously, and untunably; and the Grepo Capizondo set on his head a rich Crown of gold and precious stones of the fashion of a Mitre, wherewith the King made his entry into the City, with a great deal of state and triumph, causing to march before him all the spoil of the elephants and chariots, as also the statue of the Xemindoo, whom he had vanquished, bound with a great iron chain, and forty Colours trailed on the ground; As for him, he was seated on a very mighty elephant, harnessed with gold, and environed with forty Sergeants at arms bearing Maces: there marched likewise all the great Lords and Commanders on foot with their Scymitars covered with plates of gold, which they carried on their shoulders, and three thousand fight elephants, with their Castles of divers inventions, besides a world of other people, as well foot as horse, which followed him without number. CHAP. LXXIV. The finding of the Xemindoo, and bringing of him to the King; with the manner of his execution and death; and other particularities concerning the same. AFter that the King of Bramaa had continued peaceably in this City of Pegu for the space of six and twenty days, the first thing he did was to make himself Master of the principal places of this Kingdom, which not knowing the defeat of the Xemindoo, held still for him: To this purpose, having given Commission to some Commanders for it, he wrote to the inhabitants of those places divers courteous Letters, wherein he called them his dear children, and gave them an abolition of all that was passed: He also promised them by a solemn oath, to maintain them in peace for the time to come, and always to minister justice to them, without any Imposts or other oppression; but that he would contrarily do them new favours, as to the very Bramaas which served him in the Wars. To these words he added many others, very well accommodated to the time and his desire; for the better crediting whereof, they that were already reduced under his obedience, wrote their Letters also unto them▪ wherein they made an ample relation of the Franchises and Immunities which the King had granted to them. All this, accompanied with the same which ran thereof in all parts, wrought so great an effect, as all those places rendered unto him, and put themselves under his obedience: so that in imitation of them all the other Cities, Towns, States and Provinces that were in the Kingdom did the like. For my part, I hold, that this Kingdom whereof the King of Bramaa made at this time a new Conquest, is the best, the most abundant, and richest in Gold, in Silver, and precious Stones that may be found in any part of the world. Things being thus accomplished, to the great advantage of the Bramaa, he dispatches divers Horsemen with all speed into all parts, to go in quest of the Xemindoo, who (as I have already declared) had escaped from the past Battle, and was so unhappy, that he was discovered in a place named Fauleu, a league from the Town of Potem, which separates the Kingdom from Aracam: Presently whereupon, he was lead with great joy by a man of base condition, to this King of Bramaa, who in recompense thereof, gave him thirty thousand ducats of yearly rent. Being brought before him, bound as he was with an iron collar, and manacles, he said unto him in way of derision, Thou art welcome (King of Pegu) and mayst well kiss the ground which thou seest; for I assure thee, I have set my foot on it; whereby thou mayest perceive how much I am thy Friend, since I do thee an honour which thou couldst never imagine. To these words the Xemindoo made no answer; so that the King falling to jeer this miserable man anew, who lay before him with his face on the ground, said unto him, What means this? Art thou amazed to see me, or to see thyself in so great honour? Or what is the matter, that thou dost not answer to that which I demand of thee? After this affront, the Xemindoo, whether it were that he was troubled with his misfortunes, or ashamed of his dishonour, answered him in this sort; If the clouds of Heaven, the Sun, the Moon, and the other creatures, which cannot express in words that which God hath created for the service of man, and for the beautifying of the Firmament, which hides from us the rich treasures of his power, could naturally with the horrible voice of their dreadful Thunder explain to them which now look upon me, the estate whereunto I see myself reduced before thee, and the extreme affliction which my soul doth suffer, they would answer for me, and declare the cause I have to be mute in the condition wherein my sins have set me: and whereas thou canst not be judge of that which I say, being the party that accusest me, and the minister of the execution of thy design, I hold myself for excused, if I do not make thee an answer, as I would do before that blessed Lord, who, how faulty soever I could be, would have pity on me, moved with the least tear that I should shed. This said, he fell down with his face on the ground, and twice together asked for a little water: Whereupon the King of Bramaa, the more to afflict him, commanded that the Xemindoo should receive this water from the hand of a Daughter of his, (held by him as a slave) whom he exceedingly loved, and had at that time of his defeat promised to the Prince of Nautir, Son to the King of Avaa. The Princess no sooner saw her Father lying in that manner on the ground, but she cast herself at his feet, and straight embracing him, after she had kissed him thrice, she said to him with her eyes all bathed in tears, O my Father, my Lord, and my King, I entreat you, for the extreme affection which I have always born you, and for that also which you have at all times showed to me, that you will be pleased to lead me with you, thus embracing you as I do, to the end that in this sad passage you may have one to comfort you with a cup of water, now that for my sins the world refuses you that respect which is due unto you. It is said, that the Father would fain have answered to these words, yet could not possibly do it, so much was he oppressed with grief and anguish of mind, to see this Daughter whom he so dearly loved, in such a taking; but fell as it were in a swoon, and so continued a good while; wherewith some Lords that were there present were so moved, as the tears came into their eyes; which observed by the King of Bramaa, and that they were Pegues, who had formerly been the Xemindoo's Subjects, fearing lest they should betray him in time to come, he caused their heads to be presently strucken off, saying with a disdainful and fierce countenance, Seeing you have so great pity of the Xemindoo your King, get you before and prepare a lodging for him, and there he will pay you for this affection which you testify to have for him. After this, his wrath redoubled in such sort, as instantly he caused this very Daughter to be killed in her Father's arms; which truly was more than a brutish and savage cruelty, in seeking to hinder the affections which nature hath imprinted in us. Then no longer enduring the sight of the Xemindoo, he commanded him to be taken from thence, and to be carried to a close prison, where he passed all the night following under a sure guard. The next morning, Proclamation was made over all the City, for the people to be present at the death of the unhappy Xemindoo; now, the chiefest reason why the Bramaa did this, was, that the inhabitants seeing him dead, might for ever lose all hope of having him for their King, as all generally desired; for whereas he was their Countryman, and the Bramaa a Stranger, they were in extreme fear, lest the Bramaa should become in time like unto him whom X●min de Satan slew, and that had been during his reign a mortal enemy to the P●gues; entreating them with such extraordinary cruelty, as their scarcely passed a day, wherein he did not execute hundreds of them; and all for matters of small importance, and which deserved no punishment, had they been proceeded against, by the ways of true Justice. About ten of the clock, the unfortunate Xemindoo was drawn out of the dungeon where he was, in the manner ensuing. Before him marched through the Streets, by which he was to pass, forty men on horseback with lances in their hands, to prepare and clear the ways; there were as many behind as before him, which carried naked swords, crying aloud to the people, whereof the number was infinite, to make room: After them followed about fifteen hundred harquebusiers with their matches lighted; next to these last, which they of the country use to call, the avant coureurs of the King's wrath, went an hundred and threescore elephants armed with their Castles, and covered with silk tapestry, marching by five and five in a rank; after them road in the same order by five in a rank, fifteen men on horseback, which carried black ensigns all bloody; crying aloud, as it were by way of Proclamation; Let those miserable wretches, which are the slaves of hunger, and are continually persecuted by the disgrace of fortune, harken to the cry of the arm of wrath, executed on them that have offended their King, to the end that the astonishment of the pain, which is ordained them for it, may be deeply imprinted in their memory. Behind these same were other fifteen, clothed with a kind of bloody garment, which rendered them dreadful and of a bad aspect; who at the sound of five Bell●, which they rung in haste, said with so lamentable a voice, as they that heard them were moved to weep: This rigorous justice is done by the living God, the Lord of all truth, of whose holy body, the hairs of our heads are the feet; It is he that will have the Xemindoo put to death, for usurping the Estates of the great King of Bramaa, Lord of Tanguu. These Proclamations were answered by a troop of people, which marched thronging before with such loud cries, as made one tremble to hear them, saying these words; Let him die without having pity on him, that hath committed such an offence: These were followed by a company of five hundred Bramaa horse, and after them came another of foot, whereof some held naked swords and buckle●s in their hands, and the rest were armed with corselets, and coats of mail; In the midst of th●se, came the poor patient, mounted on a lean ill-favoured jade, and the hangman on the crupper behind him, holding him up under both the arms. This miserable Prince was so poorly clad, that his naked skin was every where seen; withal, in an exceeding derision of his person, they had set upon his head a Crown of straw, like unto an Urinal case; which Crown was garnished with muscle-shells, fastened together with blue thread; and round about his iron collar were a number of onions tied: Howbeit, though he was reduced to so deplorable an estate, and that his face was scarce like to that of a living man, yet lest he not for all that, from having something of I know not what in his eyes, which manifested the condition of a King. There was besides observed in him, a majestical sweetness, which drew tears from all that beheld him. About this guard which accompanied him, there was another of above a thousand horse men, intermingled with many armed elephants; Passing thus thorough the twelve principal streets of the City, where there was a world of people, he arrived at last at a certain street called Cabam Bainhaa, out of which he went but two and twenty days before, to go and fight with the Bramaa, in such pomp and greatness, as by the report of them that saw it, and of which number I was one, it was without doubt, one of the most marvellous sights that ever hath been seen in the world; whereof notwithstanding I will make no mention here, either in regard I cannot promise to recount rightly how all past, or for that I fear some will receive these truths for lies; nevertheless mine eyes having been the witnesses of these two successes, if I do not speak of the greatness of the first, I will at leastwise declare the miseries of the second, to the end that by these two so different accidents, happening in so short a time, one may learn what little assurance is to be put in the prosperities of the earth, and in all the goods which are given us by inconstant and deceitful Fortune. Whenas the poor Patient had passed that street of Cabam Bainha●, he arrived at a place where Gonçalo Pacheco our Captain was, with above an hundred Portugals in his Company; amongst the which there was one of a very base birth, and of a mind yet more vile, who having been robbed of his goods some years before, as he said, at such time as the Patient reigned, and complained to him of those who had done it, he would not vouchsafe to give him audience; so that thinking to be revenged on him for it now, with extravagant and unseemly speech; as soon as this poor Prince came where Gonçalo Pacheco was, with all the other Portugals, the witless fellow said aloud to him, that all might hear him O Robber Xemindoo, remember how when I complained to thee of those that had robbed me of my goods, thou wouldst not do me justice; but I hope that now thou shalt satisfy what thy works deserve: for I will at supper eat a piece of that flesh of thine, whereunto I will invite two dogs that I have at home. The sad Patient having heard the words of this hare-brained fellow, lifted up his eyes to heaven, and after he had continued a while pensive, turning himself with a severe countenance towards him that uttered them, Friend, said he unto him, I pray thee, by the great goodness of that God in whom thou believest, to pardon me that for which thou accusest me, and to remember that it is not the part of a Christian, in this painful estate wherein I see myself at this present, to put me in mind of that which I have done heretofore; for besides that, thou canst not thereby recover the loss which thou sayest thou hast sustained, it will but serve to afflict and trouble me the more. Pacheco having heard what this fellow said, commanded him to hold his peace, which immediately he did; whereupon the Xemindoo with a grave countenance made show that this action pleased him, so that seeming to be more quiet, it made him to acknowledge that with his mouth, which he could not otherwise requite, I must confess, said he unto him, that I could wish, if God would permit it, I might have one hour longer of life to profess the excellency of the faith wherein you Portugals live; for, as I have heretofore heard it said, your God alone is true, and all other gods are liars. The Hangman had no sooner heard these words, but he gave him so great a buffet on the face, that his nose ran out with blood, so that the poor Patient stooping with his hands●downward, Brother (said he unto him) suffer me to save this blood, to the end thou mayst not want some to fry my flesh withal. So passing on in the same order as before, he finally arrived at the place where he was to be executed, with so little life as he scarcely thought of any thing: When he was amounted on a great Scaffold, which had been expressly erected for him, the Chirca of Justice fell to reading of his Sentence from an high Seat, where he was placed; the contents whereof were in few words these; The living God of our heads, Lord of the Crown of the Kings of Avaa, commands, that the perfidious Xemindoo be executed as the Perturbator of the people of the earth, and the mortal enemy of the Bramaa Nation. This said, he made a sign with his hand, and instantly the Hangman cut off his head at one blow, showing it to all the people, which were there without number, and divided his body into eight quarters, setting his bowels and other interior parts which were put together, in a place by themselves; then covering all with a yellow cloth, which is a mark of mourning amongst them, they were left there till the going down of the Sun, at which time they were burnt in the manner ensuing. Sect. 2. The eight quarters of the Xemindooes body were exposed from midday till three of Clock in the afternoon to the view of all the people, whereof there was an infinite company there, for every one came thronging thither, as well to avoid the punishment wherewith they had been threatened, as to gain in so doing, the Plenary indulgence called by them Axiperan, which their Priests gave them of their sins, without restitution of any thing of all the Theeveries by them formerly committed. After then, that the tumult was appeased, and that certain men on horseback had imposed silence on the people by making certain publications, whereby the Transgressor's therein were threatened with terrible punishments, a bell was heard to toll five several times; upon this signal twelve men clothed in black robes, spotted all over with blood, having their faces covered, and bearing silver Maces on their shoulders, came out of a house of wood, made expressly for that purpose, and distant some five or six paces from the Scaffold; after them followed twelve Priests, which they call Talagrepos, being, as I have said, the most eminent Dignities amongst these Pagans, and held by them as Saints; then appeared the Xemin Pocasser, the King of Bramaaes' Uncle, who seemed to be near an hundred years old, and was as the rest, all in mourning, and environed with twelve little boys richly apparelled, carrying on their shoulders Courtelasses curiously Damasked. After that the Xemin had with a great deal of Ceremony prostrated himself three times on the ground, in way of extraordinary reverence; O holy flesh (said he) which art more to be esteemed then all the Kingdoms of Avaa, thou orient Pearl of as many Carats as there be Atoms in the beams of the Sun, whom God hath placed in an height of Honour, with a Sceptre of Sovereign power above that of Kings, I that am the least of thy meinie, and so unlike thee through my baseness, as I can scarcely see myself, so little I am, do most humbly beseech thee, O thou Lord of my head, by the fresh Meadow where thy soul doth now recreate thyself, to hear that with thy sorrowful ears which my mouth says to thee in public, to the end thou mayst remain satisfied for the offence which hath been done thee in this world. Oretanan Chaumigrem, thy brother, Prince of Savady and Tanguu, sends to entreat thee by me thy slave, that before he departs out of this life thou wilt pardon him that which is past if he have given thee any discontent, and withal that thou wilt take possession of all his Kingdoms, because he doth even now yield them up unto thee, without reserving the least part thereof for himself; withal he protests unto thee by me thy vassal, that he makes this reconciliation with thee voluntarily, to the end that the complaints which thou mayest prefer against him there above in heaven, may not be heard of God: Moreover, for a punishment of the displeasure he hath done thee, he offers to be for thee during this pilgrimage of life, the Captain and Guardian of this thy Kingdom of Pegu, for which he does thee homage, with an oath to accomplish always upon earth whatsoever thou shalt command him from heaven above; upon condition that thou wilt bestow the profit which shall arise thereof upon him at an alms for his entertainment; for he knows very well, that otherwise he should not be permitted to possess the Kingdom, neither would the Menigrepos ever consent thereunto, nor at the hour of death give him absolution for so great a sin. Upon these words, one of the Priests that was present, and that seemed to have more authority than all the rest, made him answer, as if the deceased himself had spoken; Since I see, O my Son, that thou dost now confess thy past faults, and cravest pardon of me for them in this public assembly, I do grant it thee with all my hear●; and it pleases me to leave thee in this Kingdom for the pastor of this my flock, on condition that thou dost not violate the faith thou hast given me by this oath; which would be as great an offence, as if thou shouldst now come to lay hands on me without the permission of Heaven. All the people having heard these words, answered thereunto with joyful voices; Perform so much, my Lord, my Lord. After this, the Priest being got into the pulpit, began to speak thus to the assistants; Present me with part of the tears of your eyes for the entertainment of my soul, because of the good news I now bring you, which is, that by the will of God this Country is settled on our King Chaumigrem, without being tied to make any restitution thereof, for which you have all of you good cause to rejoice, like good and faithful servants as you are. He had scarcely made an end of speaking thus, when as all those of the assembly clapping their hands, gave great demonstrations of joy, and cried out in a way of thanksgiving, Be thou praised, O Lord. All this ceremony ended, the Priests full of devotion and zeal immediately took all the parts of this poor King, dismembered in that sort, and with great veneration carried them to a place below, where a great fire was kindled of Sandal, Aloes, and Benjamin, which cost a great deal; then three of them taking up of the body of the deceased, with the bowels, and all the rest, threw it into it, and afterwads with a strange ceremony offered many sacrifices unto him, whereof the most part were of sheep. The body burned all that night until the next mo●ning, and the ashes thereof was put into a silver urn, wherein, with a very solemn assembly of above ten thousand Priests, it was carried to a Temple, called The God of thousand Gods, and there was buried in a rich tomb within a Chapel guilt all over. Behold what was the end of the great and mighty Xemindoo King of Pegu, unto whom his subjects bore so great respect and honour, during the time of his reign, which was so flourishing, that it seemed there was no other Monarch greater than he on the earth; but such is the course of all the world. CHAP. LXXV. My embarking in the Kingdom of Pegu to go to Malaca, and from thence to Japan; and a strange accident which arrived there. THe death of the good King of Siam, and the adultery of the Queen his wife, whereof I have spoken at large heretofore, were the root and beginning of so many discords, and of so many cruel wars, which happening in those two Kingdoms of Pegu and Siam, endured three years and an half, with so much expense of money and blood, as is horrible to think of. Now the end of all those wars was, that the Chaumigrem, King of Bramaa, remained absolute Lord of the Kingdom of Pegu: howbeit for the present I will speak no further of him, but will deliver that which arrived in other Countries, until such time as the same Chaumigrem King of Bramaa returned upon the Kingdom of Siam, with so mighty an Army, as never any King whatsoever in the Indias brought a greater into the field, as consisting of seventeen hundred thousand men, and of sixteen thousand elephants; whereof nine thousand were for the carriage of the Baggage, and seven thousand for fight; an enterprise that was so damageable for us, as I learned afterwards, that it cost us two hundred and four score Portugals. I come now again to my design, from which I have wandered a good while. After that these commotions, whereof I have spoken heretofore, were all appeased, Gonçalo Pacheco departed from the City of Pegu, with all us the rest of the Portugals which remained there, and whom the new King of Bramaa had delivered, as I have already declared, causing their merchandise to be restored unto them, and obliging them with many other courtesies, as well of Honour, as of Liberty: So we, an hundred and three score Portugals as we were, embarked ourselves in five vessels, which were at that time in the Port of Cosmin, one of the principal Towns of that Kingdom; and there we divided ourselves as pilgrims and travellers to the Indias, for to go into divers Countries, according as each of us thought to be most convenient for him. As for me, I set sail for Malaca, with six and twenty of my companions; where when we were arrived, I sojourned there one month only, and then embarked myself again to go to japan with one jorge Alvarez, who in a Sip belonging to Simono de melo, Captain of the Fortress, went to traffic. Now having been already six and twenty days under sail, in continuing our course with a good wind, according to the season, we came in sight of an Island, called Tanixumaa, some nine Leagues South towards the point of the Land of japan; so that turning our prow that way, we went and road the next day in the midst of the haven of Ganxiroo: In this place the Nautaquin, who was Governor thereof, had the curiosity to come unto us for to see a thing which he had never seen before; to which effect he got aboard of us, where amazed with the fashion and equipage of our vessel, as being the first that ever arrived in that Country, he seemed to be infinitely glad of our coming, yea, and was very earnest with us to have us trade in that place with him: but jorge Alvarez and the Merchants excused themselves, saying, that this port was not safe for their Ship, if any contrary wind should happen to arise. The day following, being parted from this place, to go to the Kingdom of Bungo, from whence we were distant some hundred leagues to the Northward; in five days after our departure it pleased God that we arrived in the port of the Town of Fucheo, where we were well received, as well by the King as the people, who greatly favoured us in that which concerned the duties of our Merchandise; and the King had yet more obliged us, if in the little time that we abode there he had not been miserably slain by a Vassal of his named Fucarandono, a mighty Prince, Lord of many Subjects, and exceeding rich; a disaster, which happened as followeth, At the time when we arrived there, there was in the King of Bungoes Court a young man, called Axirandoo, Nephew to the King of Arimaa, who in regard of the ill entreaty which he had received from the King his Uncle, had retired himself into this Court, and continued there above a year, with an intent never to return into his Country again: but his good fortune was such, as his Uncle coming to die, and having no other to succeed him, he declared him for his Heir. Whereupon the Fucarandono, of whom I lately made mention, desiring to marry this Prince to a Daughter of his, entreated the King to mediate this marriage for him, which he easily condescended unto. For which effect the King one day invited the Prince to go a hunting with him into a Wood, which was some two leagues off, and where there was great store of game, which he much delighted in. When they were there in private together, he moved this Marriage unto him, and certified how exceedingly it would content him that he would accept of it; which accordingly he did; wherewith the King seemed to be extremely satisfied; so that upon his return unto the Town, he sent for the Fucarandono, and told him how he had prevailed for the Marriage of his Daughter with the King of Arimaa, and therefore willed him to go and acknowledge unto him with all thankfulness this grace and honour which he did him; for he assured him on the word of a King, that he himself had desired him for his Son-in-Law. Hereupon the Fucarandono cast himself presently at the King's feet, and in convenient terms for so great an obligation, kissed them, with much sense of so extraordinary a favour as he had showed him. That done, he went home to his Palace, where, with much joy and contentment, he gave an account of this Affair to his Wife, to his Sons, and his kinsmen, who showing themselves exceedingly satisfied therewith, congratulated one another for it, as they commonly use to do in such honourable Matches as this. In the mean time, the Mother of the Bride, as she that had the best part in this Joy, went unto a chamber where her Daughter was sowing, with divers other young Maids that served her; and taking her by the hand, lead her into the room, where her Father, Brethren, and kinsmen were, who rejoiced with her for so happy a fortune, and honoured her with the Title of Highness, as being already Queen of the Kingdom of Arimaa; and so all that day was spent in Feasts, Banquets, visits of Ladies, and presenting her with many rich Gifts. But whereas the good or evil of such like Affairs consists more in that which followeth, then in the original thereof, upon the good and joyful beginning of this Marriage, such great disasters ensued, as they almost equalled them of the Kingdom of Siam, whereof I have spoken heretofore: which I stick not to say, in regard I can affirm it with truth, as having seen these two Successes with mine own eyes, and been present at them which danger enough of my person. All this day was spent in the visits of the principal persons of the Kingdom; But in this public rejoicing there was none save the Bride alone that was discontented, in regard she was desperately in love with a young Gentleman, the son of one Groge Arum, who was as a Baron amongst us, but very much different in extraction and quality from the Fucarandono, the Father of the Bride: who, as soon as it was night, compelled by the violence of the love which she bore to him, sent him word by her whom she had always secretly made use of in this Affair, that she would have him come and steal her away out of her Father's house before some other mischief arrived. Whereupon the young man, who was no more free from this passion than she, failed not to come to her to a place in which they used to meet together, where his Mistress importuned him in such manner, as he was constrained to carry her away from her Father's house, and put her into a Monastery of Religious women, whereof an Aunt of hers was as it were the Abbess; in which she continued nine days concealed, without the knowledge or privity of any body. The next morning her Governess went into her chamber where she had left her the night before; but not finding her there, she presently repaired to her Mother's chamber, imagining that she was gone thither to trick up herself extraordinarily, in regard of the time, or for some other such like occasion; and missing of her there too, she returned to her bedchamber, where she found one of the windows that looked into a garden, open, together with a sheet fastened to one of the bars, and one of her sandals lying below on the ground. Presently misdoubting the business, she went without farther delay to impart the sad news unto her Mother, who was still in her bed, out of which in all haste she arose, and diligently searching all the women chambers, where she conceived she might be, and not finding her, it was said, that she was so overcome with grief, as she fell down dead in the place. In the mean time, the Fucarandono, who as yet understood nothing of the matter, hearing the noise which the women made, ran in haste to know the cause thereof: Whereupon, being assured of the flight of his Daughter, he sent with all speed to acquaint his kinsmen therewith; who amazed with the novelty of so unfortunate and unexpected an accident, came instantly unto him: Having consulted then amongst themselves what they should do in this Affair, they resolved to proceed therein with all the rigour that possibly could be used; so that presently beginning with the women of the house, they cut off I know not how many of their heads, under pretext of being complices of this rape or flight. After this execution, being of different opinions touching the place where this maid might be, they were all of the mind not to proceed any further, until they had first acquainted the King with the business; which instantly they did, and withal, very earnestly besought him to permit them to go and search the houses of some whom they named unto him, where they believed she was: Which the King refusing, as well to exempt the Masters of them from such an affront, as also to prevent the tumult which this disorder might cause; the Fucarandono offended for that the King did not grant him his request, returned with his kinsmen to his Palace, where he resolved with them to do therein all that in such a case he thought was for his honour, alleging that it was only for men of little worth, and base minds, to proceed by way of justice in matters which might be carried by force. This resolution taken, as it is the custom of these people of japan to be more ambitious of honour then all the Nations of the world, he determined to bring his design to pass at any price whatsoever, without regard to any thing that might arrive thereupon; so that giving intelligence thereof to all his friends and kinsmen that were in the Court, they came all to him that night, and approved of this his resolution, after he had declared it unto them; insomuch that they went without further delay to the houses of them where they were persuaded this Maid lay hid: but they being already fortified and furnished with men, upon notice given them beforehand of their intent, such a great and terrible uproar ensued thereupon, as there were above twelve thousand persons killed that night. To this disorder the King ran in person with his guard, to see if he could pacific it; but the quarrel grew so hot betwixt them, as it was impossible to appease it: so that after they had lost the respect which they owed to the King, they turned all their fury against him, and slew the most part of them that were with him, so that he was constrained to retire unto his Palace, where he gathered unto him as many as possibly he could upon a sudden; but all that served him to little purpose, for they pursued him thither, and killed him, together with very near all them that he had drawn to his defence, amounting to the number of seven or eight thousand men; amongst the which were six and twenty Portugals of forty that were with the King. But these ministers of Satan, not contented with having committed so horrible a Treason, went directly to the Queen's lodging, where having found her sick in her bed▪ they most mercilessly butchered her with three of h●r Daughters, and all the women they could meet withal. After this, with an enraged fury, they set fire on the Town in six or seven places, which kindling by the violence of the wind, that was very high at that time, it took hold of it in such sort, as in less than two hours it was almost burnt down to the ground. Whereupon, we seven and twenty Portugals that remained, retired with much ado to our Vessel, where we saved ourselves as it were by miracle, leaving our anchor in the sea, and setting sail with all the speed we could. The next morning the mutineers, who were about ten thousand, having sacked the Town, divided themselves into two troops, and retired to a hill, called Canaphama●; there they fortified themselves, with an intent to create a new Head that should govern them, because the Fucarandono had been slain with the stroke of a lance, which he had received in his throat, together with all the rest of his kinsmen, which had given a beginning to this Mutiny. Sect. 1. The same day, after the end of this disorder, advertisement was given thereof to the Prince, the King's Son, who was at that time in the fort of Osquy, some seven leagues from the town of Fucheo. This young Prince, extremely afflicted with this news, would presently have gone to the town with some of his favourites, which were all the company that he had then with him; but the Fingeindono his governor, was utterly against it, alleging many reasons to persuade him not to budge from that place, until he had been more amply informed in what terms this affair stood; for it was very credible, that they who durst kill his father, would not stick to dispatch him out of the way too, since it lay in their power so to do, he not being in a condition to defend himself: Wherefore he advised him to assemble all the forces he could, to the end he might by their means subdue and chastise his enemies. The Prince approved of this counsel, and having taken order for that which he judged was most necessary according to the estate wherein he as, he commanded some that were about him, to go and wind the horn, a thing observed in japan, which caused such a hurly burly over all the country, as words are not able to express it. Now the better to understand this same, you must know, that by an ancient custom of this Kingdom of japan, all the inhabitants, in whatsoever place they lived, from the least to the greatest, are bound to have in their houses a horn of a great sea-winckles shell, which they are forbidden at any time to wind upon pain of great punishment, save in one of these four cases, namely, a tumult, a fire, a robbery, and a treason; so that if one winds a horn, the cause of it is presently known; because if it be a tumult, one winds it once; if a fire, twice; if a robbery, thrice; and if it be a treason, four times; insomuch, that at the first winding of the horn, all others are bound upon pain of death to wind theirs, and in such sort as the first hath wound his, to the end that it may be distinctly known what it is, and that there may be no confusion. Now, because this signal of treason is not so ordinary as the others, which arrive very often; when it happens to be given, all the people are so affrightrd with it, as without further delay, they run thronging to the place where the horn was first wound; so that by this means, the bruit passeth from one to another with such speed, as within less than an hour, one is advertised thereof above twenty ●eagues about. But to return to that which I said but now; as soon as the Prince had given order for that particular, he retired into a Monastery of Religious persons, which stood in the midst of a wood; there he remained shut up three days, during the which, he did nothing but bewail his Father, Mother, and Sisters; and that with exceeding demonstrations of sorrow, testified by his sighs, and tears. At the end of that time, in regard great numbers of his subjects were assembled unto him, he went out of that Monastery to provide for that which he judged necessary, as well for the safety of his kingdom, as for the chastisement of the rebels; whose goods and estates were immediately confiscated, their houses demolished, and such terrible Proclamations published against them, as could not be heard without trembling. Seven days after this deplorable event, the Prince was counselled, in regard he had, as already I have said, great numbers come unto him, to go and besiege the ten thousand Mutineers in the place of their retreat: Whereupon he parted from the fort of Osquy, and marched directly to the town with his Army, which it was said, consisted of very near an hundred and thirty thousand men, whereof seventeen thousand were horse, and the rest foot, all lusty and well armed, and capable of executing any high enterprise. Being arrived at the town, he was wonderfully well received by the people, who testified a great deal of resentment for the death of the late King his father: He would not go at first to the Royal Palace, but went before he passed any further to the Pagode, where his father was buried; there he took care to make him a funeral Pomp, with a great deal of cost and honour, according to the manner of the country, which lasted the two nights following. In conclusion, he was showed the same robe all bloody, that his father had on when he was killed; upon which he took a solemn oath, never to pardon any of them that should be found guilty, no not if they were Bonzes; and to burn all the Temples whereinto those traitors had fled for sanctuary. The fourth day after his entry into the town, he was proclaimed King, though but with little ceremony and magnificence, in regard of the general mourning. That done, accompanied as he was, with an hundred and threescore thousand men, he marched directly to the place, whither the mutineers were retired: Now to the end he might the more easily take them, and keep them from flying away; he besieged them in the mountain where they were, and that for the space of nine days: But whereas they saw that they could hold out no longer for lack of victuals, and that they had no hope of succour, they thought it was better for them to die like valiant men, then to let themselves be besieged like cowards; with this resolution, under the favour of a very dark and rainy night, they descended from the mountain by four several ways, and falling on the King's Army, which was ready to receive them in battle array, as having been advertised of their design, there ensued so dreadful and furious a fight betwixt them, as it lasted two hours within day, but at length, the conflict ended with the death of seven and thirty thousand men; amongst the which, the ten thousand Mutineers were slain, not one of them deigning to save himself upon any terms whatsoever. In the mean time, the death of his men greatly afflicted the King, who after this punishment of the rebels, retiring to the town, the first thing he did was to provide for the curing of the hurt men, wherein he spent a good time, in regard they were very many, and whereof a great number died afterwards. CHAP. LXXVI. Our passing from the Town of Fucheo, to the Port of Hiamangoo; and that which befell us there; together with my departure from Malaca, and arrival at Goa. After that this revolt had taken an end by the death of so many men on the one and the other side, we few Portugals that remained, as soon as time would permit us, got to the port of the town, where seeing the Country desolated, the merchants fled away, and the King resolved to leave the town, we lost all hope of selling our comodities, yea and of being safe in this harbour, which made us set sail, and go ninety leagues further to another Port, called Hiamangoo, which is in the bay of Canguexumaa; there we sojourned two months and an half, not able to sell any thing at all, because the country was so full of Chinese comodities, as they fell above half in half in the price: for there was not a Port or Read in all this Island of japan, where there were not thirty or forty juncks at anchor and in some places above an hundred; so that in the same very year, at least two thousand merchants ships came from China to japan. Now most of this merchandise consisted in Silk, which was given at so cheap a rate, that the piece of Silk which at that time was worth an hundred Taies in China, was sold in japan for eight and twenty, or thirty at the most, and that too with much ado; besides, the prices of all other commodities were so low, as holding ourselves utterly undone, we knew not what resolution or counsel to take. But whereas the Lord doth dispose of things according to his good pleasure, by ways which surpass our understanding; he permitted, for reasons only known to himself, that on the new moon in December, being the fifth day of the month, there arose so furious a tempest of wind and rain, as all those vessels saving a few perished, in it: so that the loss caused by this storm, amounted unto a thousand, nine hundred, and seventy two juncks; amongst the which, were six and twenty Portugals ships, wherein five hundred and two of our nation were drowned; besides, a thousand Christians of other Countries, and eight hundred thousand ducats worth of goods cast away. Of Chinese vessels, according to report, there were a thousand, nine hundred, thirty and six lost, together with above two millions of gold, and an hundred and threescore thousand persons. Now from so miserable a shipwreck, not above ten or eleven ships escaped, of which number, was that wherein I was embarked, and that almost by miracle; by reason whereof these same sold their commodities at what price they would. As for us, after we had uttered 〈◊〉, and prepared ourselves for our departure, we put to sea on a twelfth day in the morning; and although we were well enough contented in regard of the profit we had made, yet were we not a little sad, to see things fall out so to the cost of so many lives and riches, both of those of our nation, and of strangers; But when we had weighed anchor, and hoist our sails for the prosecution of our course, the ties of our main sail broke; by which means, the sail yard falling down upon the of the ship, broke all to pieces; so that we were constrained by this accident, to recover the port again, and to send a shallop on shore to seek for a sail yard, and shipwrights to fit it for us. To this effect, we sent a present to the Captain of the place, that he might suddenly give us necessary succour, as accordingly he did; so that the very same day, the ship was put into her former estate, and better than before: Nevertheless, as we were weighing anchor again, the cable of our anchor broke, and because we had but one more in the ship, we were forced to endeavour all that we might for the recovery thereof, by reason of the great need we stood in of it; now, to do this, we sent to land for such as could dive, who in consideration of ten ducats that we gave them, fell to diving into the sea, where they found our anchor in six and twenty fathom depth, so that by the means which we fastened unto it, we hoisted it up, though with a great deal of labour, wherein we all of us bestowed ourselves, and spent the most part of the night. As soon as it was day, we set sail, and parting from this river of Hiamangoo, it pleased God, that in fourteen days, with a good wound, we arrived at Chincheo, which is one of the most renowned and richest Ports of the Kingdom of China; there we were advertised, that at the entrance of this river, there lay at that time a famous Pirate, called Cheopocheca, with a mighty fleet, which put us into such a fear, that in all hast we got away to Lamau, where we made some provision of victuals, which lasted us until our arrival at Malaca. Having stayed some time at Malaca, for the dispatch of certain affairs that I had there, I embarked myself for Goa, with an intent of length, to return into Portugal, if I could meet with shipping ready to depart from thence at that time; but some few days after my arrival there it happened, that a Portugal named Antonio Ferreyra, brought a present of very rich pieces to the Viceroy Don Pedro Mascarenhas, which the King of Bungo sent him from japan, to getherwith a letter, whereof the contents were these, Illustrious Lord, and of great majesty, Viceroy of the limits of the Indias, the dreadful Lion in the floods of the sea, by the force of thy ships and artillery: ay Yacatavandono King of Bungo, Facata●, Omangucha, and the Countries of the two seas, Lord of the petty Kings of the Lands of Tosa, Xemenarequa, and Miaygimaa, do give thee to understand by this my letter, that Father Francisco Xavier having been not long since in this Country, preaching to them of Omangucha the new law of the Creator of all things, I secretly promised to him, that at his return into my Kingdom I would receive from his hand the name and water of holy Baptism, howsoever the novelty of so unexpected a thing might put me into bad terms with my subjects, Whereupon, he also promised me on his side, that if God gave him life, he would come back again unto me as speedily as he could. And for as much as his return hath been longer than I looked for, I have sent thus expressly to know both of him, and of you, the cause of this retardment of his. Wherefore my Lord, I desire you, that he may hasten away to me with all the speed that the first season which shall be proper for navigation, will permit. For besides, that his arrival in my Kingdom is greatly important for the service of God, it will be also very profitable to myself, for the contracting of a new league with the great King of Portugal, to the end that by this amity, my country and his may hereafter be but one thing, and that his subjects may in all our ports and rivers be as free as they are in your Cochim where you are; wherefore your Lordship shall exceedingly oblige me by sending one unto me, that may be witness of the desire I have to serve your King; for I will do it as willingly, as the Sun is ready to hasten his course from the morning to the night. Moreover, Antonio Ferreyra will give thee the very same arms wherewith I vanquished the Kings of Fiangaa and Xemenarequa, and which I wore in the day of battle. I am ready in all things to obey my elder Brother, that invincible King of the other end of the world, Lord of the treasures of great Portugal. The Viceroy having read this Letter, sent for one father Belquior, Rector of the College of the Jesuits, and having imparted unto him the King of Bungoes desire, he told him, that in regard Father Xavier was dead, he could wish that he would in his stead undertake this voyage to japan, which in all probalitie would very much redound to the service of God, and the propogation of the Christian faith. The Rector upon the hearing hereof, willingly embraced the employment, wherewith the Viceroy was exceedingly well pleased, and very much commended him for such his good and pious resolution. After this, the Viceroy consulting with some of his friends about the choosing of a man, that in quality of his Ambassador, might accompany the Father in this expedition; I was nominated unto him, as the fittest he could fix upon, in regard of the knowledge I had, both of the Country, and of the then King thereof: whereupon, I was immediately also sent for, and the Viceroy acquainting me with the great desire he had, that I should take this negotiation upon me, which he said, did so much import the honour of God, and the King our Master's service; he pressed me so earnestly to it, that I knew not how to refuse him, although I must confess, I was very unwilling thereunto: So that consenting to what I could not well avoid, he commanded that all things necessary for our voyage should with all convenient speed be prepared. CHAP. LXXVII. Father Belquiors and my departure from the Indias to go to Japan, and that which befell us till our arrival at the Island of Champeiloo. FOurteen days after, namely on the sixteenth of April, One thousand five hundred fifty and four, Father Belquior and I set sail for Malaca in a ship, wherein also was Don Antonio de Noronha, Son to Don Garcia de Noronha, who had been Viceroy of the Indias, that was going to take possession of the Government of the Fortress there; from the which the Viceroy had sent order to displace Don Alvero de Tayda, who was Captain of it, as well for that he would not obey his Commands, as for many other misdemeanours which he had committed, whereof I will not speak in particular here, because they are altogether from my purpose at this time. The fifth day of June following, we and the new Captain arrived at Malaca, where the Licentiat Gasper jorge Superintendant General of the Indias, who was the man that prosecuted this business, caused the people of the Town to assemble together upon the tolling of a Bell; and having read unto them the Vice-Roys Letters Patents, whereby he displaced Don Alvero, he examined him upon divers Interrogatories, whereof two Registers made a verbal process, which was signed both by them and the said Superintendent, and the new Captain. After all this, Don Alvero was deposed from his Government, made a prisoner▪ and all his estate confiscated: the like was done to all his partakers who had favoured him in the imprisoning of Gamboa, Superintendent of the Treasure, and in disobeying the Vice-Roys Commissions, as also in many other disorders that had been committed thereupon: which was executed with so much rigour, as the most part fled to the Mahometans, whereby the Fortress remained so bare of men, as it was in danger of being undone, had not the new Captain provided for it with a great deal of prudence, granting a general Abolition unto all, although they returned for all that but with an ill will. These revolutions, and this excess of justice, which put all the Country into an uproar, were the cause that Father Belquior and I could not this year pass unto japan, as we had resolved; so that we were constrained to winter at Malaca until April following, in the year One thousand five hundred fifty and five, which was ten months. During that time, the Auditor Gaspar jorge continuing the rigorous executions which he exercised day by day, was a subject of great scandal to all the Country; wherewith not yet contented, and relying on the large Commission which the Viceroy had given him, he would needs intermeddle with the Captain Don Antonio's Jurisdiction; and indeed, he encroached so far on his Authority, as Don Antonio had no more but the name of it, and was no other than as a guard of the Fortress. Now though he was very sensible of this affront, yet he did dissemble and endure it with a great deal of patience: But these excessive rigours of this Auditor continuing for the space of four months; during the which there were many discontentments, whereof I will not treat here in particular, because the discourse of it would be infinite. One day Don Antonio, seeing the time proper for the execution of that which he had formerly resolved on, caused some, whom he had destined for it, to seize on him in the Fortress, and carry him to a private house; where (according to report) he was stripped stark naked, and his hands and feet being bound with cords, he was grievously whipped: After which, having dropped scalding oil on his bare flesh, (which had almost killed him) and clapped irons on his legs, and manacles on his hands, they plucked off all the hair of his beard, leaving him not so much as one, and did many other such like things unto him, as it was publicly spoken: so that the poor Licentiat Gaspar jorge, who termed himself Auditor General of the Indias, great Provisor of the deceased and Orphelins, and Superintendent of the Treasure of Malaca, and or the Countries of the South, for the King our Sovereign Lord, was thus handled by Don Antonio, if the report of it be true. Finally, when the season of Navigation was come, he was sent, so manacled as he was to the Indias, with an infamous verbal process; which the Parliament of Goa annulled afterwards: And Don Antonio had thereupon an express Commandment from the Viceroy Don Pedro de Mascarenhas, who governed the State of the Indias at that time, to appear personally before him as a Prisoner, for to be confronted in judgement with Gaspar jorge, and render an account of his proceeding against him; as indeed Don Antonio failed not in making his appearance at Goa accordingly: where being about to justify himself for that which had passed, he was ordered to answer within three days to an ignominious Libel, which Gaspar jorge had exhibited against him: But forasmuch as Don Antonio was naturally an enemy of Justifications by Answers and Replies, whereby it was said, the Councillors of the Parliament intended to surprise him, the report went (at least wise such was the saying of Detractors; for as for me, I neither saw nor am assured of it) that in stead of employing the three days which had been given him, in making answer to this Libel, he within four and twenty hours having met accidentally with Gaspar jorge, sent him to prosecute his Suit in the other World, laying him so sure on the ground, as he never rose again. Howbeit, there are those which recount this Affair quite otherwise, and that say, how in a Feast, whereunto he was invited, he was poisoned. By this death of his all this difference was decided, and this business wholly ceased, so that Don Antonio was by Sentence absolutely cleared, and sent back to his Government: wherein he continued not above two months and a half, at the end whereof he died of a bloody Flux: and so were all the storms of envy and discord wherewith the Fortress of Malaca had been beaten, appeased. When the season was come wherein we might continue our Voyage, Sect. 1. on the first day of April, in the year One thousand five hundred fifty and five, we parted from Malaca, after we had embarked ourselves in a Carvel belonging to the King our Sovereign Lord, which Don Antonio, the Captain of the Fortress gave us by the express command of the Viceroy. Three days after our putting to sea, we arrived at an Island called Pulho Pisan, at the entering into the Straight of Sincaapura, where the Pilot having never navigated that way before, ran us with full sails so dangerously on certain Rocks, as we thought ourselves to be utterly lost, without all hope of recovery: In regard whereof, by the advice of all the rest, the Father and I were constrained to get into a Manchua, for to go and demand succour of one Luis Dalmeida, who two hours before had passed by us in a Vessel of his, and lay at anchor two leagues off us, by reason the wind was against him: So the Father and I made to him with peril enough. For whereas all that Country, which appertained to the King of jantana, Grandchild to him that had been King of Malaca, our mortal Enemy, were at that time in arms, his Balons and Lanchares, that were assembled in a Fleet of War, continually gave us chase, with an intention to take us; but by God's providence we escaped them. At length, after we had got to this ship, with no little fear and trouble, he that was Captain of her furnished us with a Boat and Mariners, and so we returned to our Carvel as speedily as we could, for to succour and draw her out of the danger wherein we had left her: But it pleased the Lord that we found her the day after delivered from it; though it is true, that she took in water abundantly in the prow's side; but in the end we staunched it at Patana, where we arrived seven days after. There I went ashore with two others, to see the King; unto whom I delivered a Letter from the Captain of Malaca: and being received very graciously by him, he read it over, whereby he understood, that the cause of our coming thither was to provide ourselves of victuals, and some other things which we had not taken in at Malaca; as also that we were resolved to proceed on in our course directly to China, and from thence to japan, where Father Belquior and others with him were to preach the Christian Law to the Gentiles: which the King of Patana having read, after he had mused a little, he turned to them that were about him, and said smiling to them, O how much better were it for these men, since they expose themselves to so many travels, to go to China and enrich themselves there, then to recount tales in strange Countries? Whereupon, calling the Xabandar to him, Be sure, said he unto him, that thou givest these men here all that they shall demand of thee, and that for the love of the Captain of Malaca, who hath greatly recommended them unto me: and above all remember, That it is not my custom to command a thing twice. When we had taken leave of the King, exceedingly contented with the good reception he had given us, we fell presently to buying of Victuals, and other such things as we stood in need of; So that in eight days we were abundantly furnished with whatsoever was necessary for us. Being departed from this Haven of Patana, we sailed two days together with a Southeast wind along by the coast of Lugor and Siam, traversing the Bar of Guy, to go to Pulho Cambim, and from thence to the Islands of Canton, with an intent there to attend the conjunction of the new Moon: But it was our ill fortune to be surprised by East and Southeast wind, (which reign in that Coast the most part of the year) whereof the violence was so great, that we were in fear to be cast away: so that to decline the event thereof, we were forced to tack about again to the Coast of Malaya; and arriving at an Island, called Pullo Timan, we ran into great danger there, as well by reason of the tempest which we had upon the sea, as in regard of the great treason of the people of the Country. Now after five days that we had continued there, without having either fresh water or victuals, because for the easing of our Vessel we had cast out all into the Sea, it pleased God that we encountered with three Portugal Ships which came from Sunda, by whose arrival we were very much comforted in our travels: Whereupon Father Belquior and I began to treat with the Captains of those Vessels about that which they thought was requisite we should do; and all were of the opinion, that we should send back the Carvel wherein we were, to Malaca; saying, that there was no likelihood we should be able to make so long a Voyage in her as that of japan. Having approved of this counsel, we presently embarked ourselves in the Ship of one Fr●ncisco Toscano, a Worshipful and rich man, who defrayed our charge during all our Voyage, yea, and most part of the time that we were in China, not permitting any of our Company to spend a penny. From this Island Pullo Timan we put to sea on Friday the seventh of june in the same year One thousand five hundred fifty and five, and discovering the firm land of the Kingdom of Champaa, we sailed along the Coast with a North-West wind, and in twelve days we arrived at an Island called Pullo Champeiloo, in the Strait of Cauchenchina, where we took in fresh water at a River which descended from an high Mountain. There amongst the Rocks we perceived a very-fair Cross graven on a great free Stone, and under it 1518, with six letters abbreviated, which said, Duart Coelho: We observed also towards the River, and on the Southside, two flight shot off, threescore and two men hanged on trees alongst the Strand, besides others that lay on the ground half eaten; a thing which seemed to have been done not above six or seven days before. Upon another tree there hung a great Banner, wherein these words were seen in Chinese letters, Let every Ship or junck which shall arrive in this place, be sure to dislodg quickly from thence after she hath furnished herself with fresh water, whether she hath time, or hath it not; on pain of incurring the same justice as these wretches have done, whom the fury of the arm of the son of the Sun hath overwhelmed. We were mightily surprised with so strange an accident, so that we could make no other judgement of it, but that some Chinese Army had arrived there, and meeting with those wretches, had (as Pirates use to do) entreated them as we saw, under the specious pretext of Justice. CHAP. LXXVIII. Our departure from the Island of Champeiloo, and our arrival at that of Lampacau; with a relation of two great disasters which happened in China unto two Portugal Colonies; and of a strange accident that befell in the Country. WHen we were parted from the Island of Champieloo, we got to the Lands of Canton, so that on the fifth day of our voyage, it pleased God that we arrived at one of them, called Lampacau, where at that time the Portugals exercised their commerce with the Chinese, which continued until the year One thousand five hundred, fifty and seven; when as the Mandarins of Canton, at the request of the Merchants of the Country, gave us the port of Macao, where the trade now is; of which place (that was but a desert Island before) our country men made a very goodly plantation, wherein there were houses worth three or four thousand ducats, together with a Cathedral Church: Moreover, this Colony hath its Governor, Auditor, and Officers of Justice; whereunto I shall add, that the inhabitants of this place are in as great safety there, as if they were in the quietest part of Portugal. But God grant of his infinite mercy, and goodness, that this Colony may be of longer durance then that of Liampoo, which was another of the Portugals, and whereof I have spoken at large heretofore, being two hundred leagues from this same on the North Coast. But ill fortune would, that by the disorder of one Portugal, it was demolished in a very little time; in which disaster, I myself was present, and can say, that the loss which was made there, as well of people, as of riches, was inestimable. For in this plantation, were three thousand men, whereof twelve hundred were Portugals, and the rest Christians of divers nations: Yea, and I have heard many say, which spoke like knowing men thereof, that the Portugals traffic there, exceeded three millions of gold: Now, the most part of this traffic was in lingots of silver of japan, which had been found out not above two months before, and was such as a man doubled his money three or four times by the commodities which he sent thither. In this Colony, there was a Governor, who resided in the Country; there were also an Auditor, Judges, Sheriffs, Aldermen, a Provisor of the deceased and Orphelins, a town Clark, and all other Officers that are usually in a Commonwealth; together with four public Notaries, and six Registers, each of whose offices were sold for three thousand ducats; yea, and there were some far dearer. There were also two Hospitals, wherein above thirty thousand ducats was spent every year, and the Town house had in revenue six thousand per annum; So that it was generally said, that this Colony was the richest, and best peopled, of any that was in the Indias; besides, for matter of extent, it had not its fellow in all Asia. Furthermore, when the Registers or Secretaries passed any Grant, or when the public Notaries made any writings, they ordinarily used these terms; In this most noble and always faithful town of Liampoo, for the King our Sovereign Lord. Now, having said so much of it, I hold it not amiss to tell you, how and wherefore so noble and rich a Colony was destroyed, which arrived in this sort. There was living there a man of a good extraction and rank, named Lancerote Pereyra, born at Pont de Lima, a town in Portugal; it is said, that this same had lent some thousand ducats to certain Chineses, who were not men solvent, but became bankrupts, and never paid him any thing, nor could he hear any news of them afterwards; which was the cause that desiring to make good this loss, and to recover it of them which were not the occasion of it, he assembled for that effect some eighteen or twenty Portugals, idle fellows, and of lewd dispositions, with whom, under the favour of the night, he fell upon a village, some two leagues from thence where he rob eleven or twelve labouring men; and withal, seizing on their wives and children, killed about half a score persons, without any reason at all so to do. In the mean time, the Alarm being taken up by the whole country round about, by reason of this violence, the inhabitants went and complained to the Chumbin for Justice; and having made a verbal process of the business, they presented it in the name of the people to the Chaem of the Government, which is as one of the Vice-Roys of the Kingdom; who immediately thereupon, dispatched away an Haitau, who is as an Admiral amongst us▪ with an Army of three hundred Juncks, and four score Vançons with Oars; wherein there were threescore thousand men, which being all made ready in seventeen days, came and fell on this misfortunate Colony, and the matter passed in so strange a manner for them, as I must confess, I have not capacity enough to recount it sufficiently, neither understanding enough to imagine it; only it shall suffice me to say, as one who saw it, that in less than the space of five hours, which this dreadful chastisement of the hand of God endured; these cruel enemies, left not any thing at all in Liampoo to which one could give a name, for they demolished and burnt all that they could find; they put to death withal twelve hundred Christians, amongst the which, were eight hundred Portugals, who were all burned alive in five and twenty ships, and two and forty Juncks. It is said, that in this common ruin, there was lost to the value of two millions of Gold, as well in Lingots, Pepper, Sandal, Cloves, Mace, and Nutmegs, as in other Commodities; and all these desasters arrived by the ill conscience, and little judgement of an avaricious Portugal. Now, from this misfortune, was another far greater derived; which was, that we lost our credit and reputation so mightily over all the Country, as the inhabitants would no longer endure the sight of us; saying, that we were devils incarnate, engendered by the malediction of the wrath of God, for the punishment of sinners. This happened in the year, one thousand, five hundred, forty and two, Martim Alfonso de Sousa being Governor of the Indias, and Ruy Van Pereyra Marramaque Captain of Malaca. Two years after, the Portugals desiring to make another new Colony in a Port, called Chincheo, in the same Kingdom of China, five leagues lower than Liampoo, with an intention to settle their trade there, the Merchants of the Country coming to consider what great profit would redound to them thereby, entreated the Mandarins to make show of permitting it, and obliged them thereunto with many great presents; we had commerce then with those of the Country about two years and an half, until such time as by the express command of Simano de melo, Captain of the Fortress, there was sent into this place another man of the same humour as Lancerote Pereyra was of, unto whom the said Simano de melo gave a commission to be Governor of this Port of Chincheo, and Provisor of the Deceased: but the bruit went of him, that the extreme covetousness wherewith he was possessed, made him lay hands on all things, without any the least respect to aught whatsoever. It happened then that in his time there arrived in the Port of Chincheo a stranger, by nation an Armenian, who was held by every one for a very good Christian: This man, who had an estate of ten or twelve thousand ducats, and being a Christian, as I have said, and a stranger, as we were, passed out of a Mahometans Junck, wherein he was, into the ship of a Portugal, named Luis de Montaroyo. Now having lived some six or seven months very peaceably amongst us, and much respected and favoured of every one, he chanced to ●all sick of a fever, whereof he died, but before he gave up the Ghost, he declared by his Testament, that he had a wife and children in a town of Armenia, called Gaborem, and that of his twelve thousand ducats estate he left two thousand to the Hospital at Malaca; and for the rest, he desired it might be kept in safe hands, until there were an opportunity to have consigned it unto his children, as to his lawful heirs; and in case they were dead, he left it to the Hospital. Behold, what was the Testament of this faithful Christian, who was no sooner buried, but Ayr●z Botelho de Sousa, Provisor of the dead, seized on all his estate, without making any Inventory, or other kind of account, saying, that before any farther proceeding therein, they were to send to make enquiry in Armenia, which was above two thousand leagues from thence, to see whether there were not some engagements, or seizure of Justice upon it: There arrived also at the same time, two Chinese Merchants, who had to the value of three thousand ducats in silk, pieces of damask, musk, and porcelaines, appertaining to the deceased Armenian: the Provisor arrested them all, and not contented therewith, he would needs make the Chineses believe, that all the merchandise which they had, belonged also unto the Armenian; so that under the pretext thereof, he took eight thousand ducats from them, and bid them go to Goa and there demand justice of the Provisor General, by reason he could do no otherwise then he did; for that, he was obliged to deal in that sort by the duty of his Charge. Now, not to stand upon the delivering of the reasons, which in vain were alleged by them against this injustice of his; I will only say, that these two Merchants returning home without any of their merchandise, went with their Wives and Children, and casting themselves at the Chaems feet, represented unto him in a Petition the whole business, as it past: informing him, moreover, that we were men quite-void of the fear of God. The Chaem willing to do justice then to these Merchants, and to many others which had formerly complained against us, caused it to be every where proclaimed, that no man on pain of death should converse with us; whereupon, the scarcity of victuals came to be so great amongst us, as that which was wont to be bought for six blanks, was then worth above a ducat; so that necessity constrained us to go unto certain hamlets; whereupon ensued such disorders, as all the Country rose up against us with so much hatred and fury, that sixteen days after we were set upon by an Army of an hundred and twenty very great Juncks, which entreated us in that manner for our sins, as ofthirteen ships which we had in the Port, there was not one that was not burnt; and of five hundred Portugals which were abiding in the Country, thirty only escaped, who had not the worth of a penny left them. From these two sad histories, recounted by me, I infer, that it seems the Affairs which we have now in China, and the tranquillity and confidence wherewith we live there, (supposing that the treaties of peace which we have with them be firm and assured) will last but till our sins shall serve for motives to the inhabitants of the Country to mutiny against us, which God of his infinite mercy, permit not for the time to come. To return again now to my former discourse, you must understand, that after we were arrived at the Port of Lampacau, as I have declared before, we could not meet with any vessel that was bound for japan; so that we were constrained to pass another year too in this Port, with a design in May following, which was ten months off, to continue our voyage as we had resolved. Father Belquior and I perceiving that there was no hope of going to japan this year, as well for that the season was past, as for other inconveniences that fell out, we were forced to stay in this Island till the time should serve for us to make our voyage thither. Having continued there then till the seventeenth of Feb. following, certain news came to us from Cantan, that on the third day of the same month the Province of Sansy had been swallowed up in the manner ensuing. The first day of Frebruary, the earth fell a trembling from eleven till one of the clock at night, and the next day from midnight till two in the morning; as also the day following from one till three: During this trembling it was a dreadful thing to hear the terrible noise which the storms and thunder made: After all this such an horrible inundation of waters borke forth out of the centre of the earth, as in an instant, all the Country about, was swallowed up threescore leagues round, without the saving of any living creature from perishing, but only of one child of seven years of age, and which was for a great wonder presented to the King of China. In the mean time this news was no sooner come to the City of Cantan, but all the inhabitants thereof were terrified with it, yea and all ours were so amazed at it, that holding it for an impossible thing, fourteen of our company would needs go thither to know the truth thereof; which they immediately put in execution, and at their return affirmed, that the matter was very certain, whereof an attestation was made, signed by fourteen ocular witnesses, who had been upon the place; which attestation was afterwards sent by Francisco Toscano to the King of Portugal, Don joano the third of glorious memory. This prodigious event so affrighted the inhabitants of the City of Cantan, that all of them generally testified a world of repentance; and although they were Gentiles, yet must it be acknowledged that they confounded us Christians, who saw how far their devotion extended. For on the first day when the news thereof arrived there, Proclamations were made throughout all the Principal streets of the City by six men on horseback, who in long mourning robes, and with a sad and lamentable voice, road crying out these words; Miserable creatures as you are, that cease not from offending day by day, the Lord of all things: Hear, O hear, the most lamentable and dreadful adventure that ever was; For you are to know, that for our sins God hath drawn the sword of his Divine justice against all the people of Guy and Sansy, overwhelming pell mel with water, fire, and tempests from Heaven all that great Province of China, none being saved but one only Child which is carried to the Son of the Sun. And thereupon, they rung a little bell thrice, which they had in their hands; Then all the people prostrating themselves on the ground, said with fearful cries, God is Just in all that he doth. After this was past, all the inhabitants retired into their houses, which were shut up for five days together, so that the City was so desolate, as there was not a living creature seen stirring in it. At the end of the five days, the Chaem and the Anchassis of the government, together with all the rest of the people (wherein the men only were comprehended, for as for the women, they hold them incapable of being heard of God, by reason of the disobedience of the first sin committed by Eve) went as it were in procession, thorough the principal Streets of the City, while their Priests, which were above five thousand in number, cried with a loud voice that pierced the very skies, O marvellous and pitiful Lord, have no regard to our wickedness; for if thou takest account of them, we shall remain dumb before thee. Whereunto all the people with an other fearful cry, answered, Lord, we confess our faults before thee. And so the Procession continuing, still going on, they at length arrived at a magnificent Temple, called Nacapyrau, whom they hold for the Queen of Heaven, as I have heretofore related. From thence they went the next day to another Temple, called The God of justice: and in this sort they continued fourteen days; during which, were great Alms generally bestowed, and many prisoners freed; also divers Sacrifices were made of the odoriferous perfumes of Aloes and Benjamin: There were many others too, wherein there was good store of blood shed, and wherein many Kine, Stags and Swine were offered, which were all distributed in alms to the poor. In pursuance whereof, during the three months that we abode there, they continued in doing many other good works, which were performed with so much charge and charity, as it is to be believed, that if the Faith of Jesus Christ had been added thereunto, they would have been acceptable unto him. We heard afterwards, and this report was universal over all the Country, that during the three days of that Earthquake at Sansy, it had still reigned blood in the City of Pequin, where the King of China's Court was at that time, which made the most part of the inhabitants to forsake it, and the King to fly to Nanquin, where, it was said, he gave great alms, and set at liberty an infinite many of Slaves; amongst the which were five Portugals, who had been retained prisoners in the Town of Pocasser above twenty years together. When these came to Cantan, they recounted unto us divers marvellous things; and amongst others, they told us, that the alms which the King had given upon this occasion, amounted to six hundred thousand ducats, besides the magnificent Temples which he built to appease the wrath of God; amongst the which he made one in that very City, very sumptuous, and of great majesty, under the title of The Love of God. CHAP. LXXIX. Our arrival in the Kingdom of Bungo, and that which passed there. THe season being come wherein we might continue our Voyage, we parted from this Island of Lampacau the seventh day of May, One thousand five hundred fifty and six, after we had embarked ourselves in a Ship, whereof Don Francisco de Mascarenhas, surnamed Pallia, was Captain. So we proceeded on in our course for fourteen days together; at the end whereof we discovered the first Islands, at the height of five and thirty degrees; and which by gradation regard the West, Northwest of Tanixumaa: whereupon, the Pilot knowing that it was ill sailing there, steered to the South-west, to find out the point of the Mountain of Minatoo: We coasted Tanoraa then, and still ran along this coast to the Port of Finugaa. And forasmuch as in this Climate the winds are Northerly, and that the current of the water was contrary to them, the Pilot had a very bad opinion of his Navigation; so that when he came to know his fault, although out of an accustomed obstinacy of Mariners, he would not confess it, we were already past threescore leagues beyond the Port where we meant to arrive; by reason whereof, we were fain to tack about for the recovery of it fifteen days after, though with travel enough, for that the winds were cross; and (without lying) our goods and lives were in no little jeopardy, by reason all this Coast was risen up against the King of Bungo our Friend, and the inhabitants, who were greatly inclined to the Law of the Lord, which had formerly been preached unto them. At length, after that by the mercy of God we had got to the Town of Fucheo, whereof I have oftentimes spoken, which is the capital of the Kingdom of Bungo, where the chiefest Christians of all japan do now flourish; all they of the Ship thought it requisite that I should go to the Fortress of Osquy, where we heard the King then was: Now though I feared to undertake this Journey, in regard the Country was all up, yet I resolved for it, at the persuasion of them of the ship, who all in general entreated me very earnestly unto it. Having prepared myself then, and received a Present worth five hundred Crowns, which Don Francisco, Captain of the Ship sent to the King, I took four of my companions with me, and so went away. After I was landed at the Town Key, the first thing I did was to go to the house of the Admiral of the Sea, who received me with great demonstrations of friendship, and confirmed me against the fear I was in; whereupon, having given him an account of the cause of my coming thither, I desired him to give me horses and men that might conduct me to the King; which most willingly he did, and more freely than I required. Being departed from this Town, the next morning about nine of the clock I arrived at a place called Fingau, which might be a quarter of a league from the Fortress of Osquy; There I sent one of those of japan, which I had with me, to let the Captain of the place understand that I was arrived, and that I had an Embassy to deliver to his Highness from the Viceroy of the Indias: In which regard, I entreated him to appoint me such a time as he pleased, that I might speak with him. Hereunto he returned me this answer by a Son of his, That my Companions and I were very welcome, and that the King▪ was in the Isle of Xequa, where he was entertaining himself in the catching of a great Fish, whereof the name was not known, and which was come thither from the bottom of the Sea, with a great number of many other little fishes: and that having cooped him up in a Channel there, it was likely that he would spend all the day in that sport, and not return till night: But that he would howsoever immediately advertise him of my arrival. Thereupon he sent me to repose myself in a better lodging which he gave me, where I was abundantly furnished with all that was necessary for me; yea, and he told me by way of Compliment, that all this Country was no less the King of Portugals, than Malaca, Cochin and Goa. Then one of his Followers, whom he had appointed to wait on us, gave us an extraordinary good reception in a Pagode, whereof the Bonz●s made us a very sumptuous Feast. In the mean time, the King having notice of my arrival, dispatched away from the Island where he was catching that great Fish, three light Galleys, and in them his Chamberlain, a great Favourite of his, named Oretandano, who about evening came to me to the place where I was, and having told me that by word of mouth which the King had enjoined him, he drew forth a Letter, and having kissed it with the Ceremonies and Compliments used amongst them, he delivered it unto me, wherein I found this written, Being at his present employed in an exercise which is very pleasing unto me▪ I have been advertised of thy arrival in my Country, wherewith I am so contented, that I protest unto thee, I would have come away presently unto thee, had I not sworn that I would not part from hence, till I had killed a great Fish which I hold cooped up here: Wherefore I entreat thee, as my good Friend, since by reason thereof I cannot go to thee, that thou wilt come thyself to me in this Vessel which I have sent for thee: for on thy coming, and on the death which I hope to give to this Fish, my perfect content depends. Having read this Letter, I instantly embarked myself in the Galley wherein Oretandono came for me, and my followers in the other two, with the Present they carried. And forasmuch as those Galleys were very swift, we arrived within less than an hour at the Island, which was some two leagues and an half off. Now we came thither at such time as the King, with above two hundred men in boats, with darts in their hands, was pursuing a prodigious Whale, which was altogether unknown and strange to them, as having never seen such a Fish before in all that Country. After they had killed and drawn it to land, the King was so pleased therewith, that to recompense all the fishermen that were employed in the action, he exempted them from a certain Tribute which they had accustomed to pay before: as also conferred new Honours on some Gentlemen whom he loved, and that were there with him, and gave a thousand Taeis in silver to his Pages: withal, he received me with a smiling countenance, and questioned me very exactly about many particulars; whereunto I answered the best that I could, always adding something of mine own thereunto, as judging it necessary for the increasing of the Portugals reputation, and of the great esteem wherein we were at that time in the Country; for all the inhabitants held it for most certain, that the King of Portugal was indeed the only Prince, which might term himself the Monarch of the world, as well for the large extent of his territories, as for his power, and mighty treasure; in regard whereof chiefly they of these Countries made great account of our amity. These things done, the King went from this Island towards Osquy, and about an hour within night he arrived at his Castle, where he was received with a great deal of rejoicing, and applaved by every one for so honourable an exploit, as that of killing the Whale, attributing to him alone, that which all the rest had done; whereby one may see, that this pernicious vice of flatttery reigns so absolutely in the Courts of Princes, as it hath established its self a place even amongst the very Gentiles and Infidels. The King having dismissed all them that had accompanied him, went to Sup with his Wife and Daughters, and would not then be attended on by any body, because the feast was made at his wife's charge. And whereas we were then at a Treasurer's house of his, where we were appointed to lodge, he sent for us all five, and entreated us that we should eat in his presence after the manner of our Country, adding, that the Queen did infinitely desire it. Then having caused a table to be covered for us, and on it placed store of excellent good meat and well dressed, which was served up by very fair women; we fell to eating after our manner, of all that was set before us, whilst the jests which the Ladies broke upon us, in seeing us feed so with our hands, gave more delight to the King and Queen, than all the Comedies that could have been represented before them: for those people being accustomed to feed with two little st●cks, as I have declared elsewhere, they hold it for a great incivility, to touch the meat with ones hand, as we use to do. Hereupon the King's Daughter, a marvellous fair Princess, and not above fourteen or fifteen years of age, craved leave of the Queen her Mother, that she and six or seven of her companions might present a certain Play before them concerning the subject in question; which the Queen with the Kings consent granted her. That done, they withdrew into another room, where they stayed a pretty while, during the which, they that remained in the place, drove away the time at our cost, by jeering a●d gibing at us, who were much ashamed, especially my ●our companions, which were but novices in the Country, and understood not the language; for as for me, I had before seen such a like Comedy acted at Tai●xumaa against the Portugals. As we were thus ministering matter for the Comp●ny to laugh at us▪ and setting the best face on it that possibly we could amidst these affronts, in regard of the great pleasure which we observed the King and Queen took therein, we saw the young Princess come out of the other room disguised like a Merchant, wearing a Sy●mi●er by her side, covered all over with plates of gold; and the rest of her habit answerable to the person which she represented. In this equipage falling down on her knees before the King her father, with the respect she owed to him, Most mighty Lord and King (said she unto him) albeit this my boldness be worthy of great chastisement, in regard of the inequality which it hath pleased God to put between your greatness and my baseness; yet the necessity whereunto I find myself reduced, makes me shut my eyes against all that may happen to me thereby; For being old as I am, and charged with many Children, which I have had by several Wives, with whom I have been married, my extreme poverty, and the desire I have not to leave them destitute of means, hath made me have recourse to my friends for help, which they have granted me; So that having employed the money which they have le●t me, in a certain Commodity, which I cannot s●ll in all Japan; I have resolved to barter it away for any other whatsoever it be: And having complained hereof to some friends that I have at Meacoo, they have assured me that your Highness may do me some good. Wherefore, my Lord, I humbly beseech you, that in consideration of these white hairs, and feeble age, as also for that I have many Children, and am poor, you will be pleased to assist me in my need, which will be an alms very well bestowed, and most agreeable to the Chenchicos, which are lately arrived here in their Ship; for this commodity of mine will accommodate them better than any other, in regard of the want they have continually thereof. Whilst this discourse lasted, the King and Queen could not forbear laughing, to see that this old Merchant, who had so many children, and so many incommodities, was the Princess their Daughter, very young, and exceeding beautiful: But the King forbearing a little from laughing, answered her with a great deal of gravity, that she should show some samples of the Merchandise which she had, and if it were such as would accommodate us, he would desire us to buy it. At these words, the pretended Merchant having made a very low obeisance, retired into the other room again. In the mean time, we were so confounded with what we heard and saw, as we could not tell what to think, or what should be the event of it; whilst the women which were in the room, being about three score in number, (for there were no other men but we five there) fell to jogging one another, and laughing at us. Hereupon, the Merchant comes in again, bringing with her six fair young maids, richly clad, and disguised also like Merchants, carrying samples of the Merchandise they had to sell: They had Scymiters and Daggers by their sides all guilt, with grave countenances and high looks, being all of them Daughters to the greatest Lords of the Kingdom, whom the Princess had expressly chosen to act this Play with her. Each of these six Damsels bare on her shoulder a fardel of green Taffats, and all of them together, seeming to be Merchant's sons, danced a Ball to the tune of two Harps and a Viol, and ever and anon sung in verse with a very sweet and melodious voice, words of this substance, High and mighty Lord, by the riches which thou possessest, we pray thee to think of our poverty; we are miserable creatures in this strange Country, and consequently despised by the inhabitants thereof, which exposeth us to great affronts: wherefore we beseech thee by that which thou art, be mindful of our poverty. After that these young Merchants had finished their Dance and Song, they fell all on their knees before the King, and then the eldest of them having rendered him most humble thanks for the favour he did them, in helping them away with their Merchandise, they untied all their fardle●, and let fall in the midst of the room a great number of wooden arms with hands, the said eldest of them saying with a very good grace, Since that Nature for our sins hath subjected us to so villainous a misery, that our hands must of necessity smell always of flesh or fish, or of such other meat as we eat with them, this Merchandise will greatly accommodate us, to the end that whilst we make use of one sort of hands, the other may be washed. The King and Queen fell heartily a laughing at this Speech; whereas in the mean time we five were so ashamed, as the King perceiving it, desired us to take it in good part, saying, That the Princess his Daughter had done this to no other end, but for the better entertainment of us, whom she respected as her Brothers. Whereunto we made answer, That we hoped God our Master would reward his Highness for this honour and grace that he did us; which we confessed was very great, and for such we would publish it over all the world as long as we lived: Wherewith the King, Queen and Princess showed themselves very well satisfied, giving us thanks with many compliments after their manner: yea, and the Princess said to us moreover, If your God would take me for his servant, I should endeavour the best I could to please him: but I hope he will not forget me. At these words we prostrated ourselves on our knees before her, and kissing the hem of her garment, we answered her, That we hoped no less of her, and that in case she became a Christian, we should see her Queen of Portugal: Whereupon the Queen her Mother and she fell a laughing. Having taken leave then of the King, we returned to our lodging, and the next morning as soon as it was day, he sent for us again, and questioned us very exactly about the coming of Father Belquior, the intention of the Viceroy, the Letter which I had brought from him; our Ship, and the goods that were in her; and many other things, wherein we spent four hours at the least; after which he dismissed us, saying, that within six days he would be at the Town, and that there he would receive the Letter, see the Father, and make answer to all. CHAP. LXXX. My reception by the King of Bungo, as Ambassador from the Viceroy of the Indias. AFter the six days were passed the King parted from Osquy to go to the town of Fucheo, accompanied with a great number of Nobility, and a guard of six hundred foot, and two hundred horse, which made a goodly show. Being arrived there, he was received by the people with great demonstrations of joy, with Shows, Interludes, and many other inventions after their manner, that were very costly; after which, he went to his Palace, an exceeding fair and magnificent structure, whither the next day he sent for me, and bid me bring him the Vice-Roys Letter, as being come for no other end but to receive it, and that after he had read it, he would speak with Father Belquior touching the matters that were most important. Whereupon I presently returned to my lodging, and having made ready all that was necessary for me, about two of the clock in the afternoon, the King sent the Captain of the town, and four other of the chiefest men of the Court for me; who conducted me to the Palace, accompanied with forty Portugals, which marched all on foot, because it is the custom of the Country so to do. All the streets thorough which we passed, were very handsomely set forth, and there was such a world of people, as the officers had much ado to make way for us. Three Portugals on horseback, carried each of them a piece of the present; and a little after them followed two curious Spanish Gennets, with rich Saddles and Trappings, and with such Arms as are used in Justs. Upon our arrival at the first court of the Palace, we found the King there on a scaffold, which had been erected expressly for him, accompanied with all the Lords of the Kingdom, amongst whom, were the Ambassadors of three strange Princes, namely the first of the King of the Lequios, the second of the King of Chauchim, and Isle of Tosa, and the third of the Emperor of the Miacoo; and round about as far as the court extended, there were above a thousand harquebuziers, and four hundred men mounted on good horses, besides a multitude of people without number. After that the forty Portugals and I were come to the Scaffold where the King was, we performed all the ceremonies and compliments which are used to be done to him in such cases; and then approaching a little nearer to him, I delivered him the Letter from the viceroy, which he would not receive but standing. Then being set down again in his place, he gave it to one about him, that was as his Secretary who read it aloud that every one might hear. After it was read, the King questioned me before the three strange Ambassadors, and the great Lords with whom he was accompanied, about certain things which he was curious to know touching our Europe; whereof one was, how many men, armed cap-a-pe, and mounted on such horses as those were that I saw there, the King of Portugal could bring into the field? Whereupon fearing lest I should blush if I came to tell a lie; I must confess, that I was much troubled how to answer, which one of my companions who was near me, perceiving, speaking for me, made answer; That he could bring an hundred or sixscore thousand; a matter whereat the King was much abashed, and I too: But the King taking pleasure as it seemed, in the marvellous answer, which this Portugal gave him, bestowed above an hours time in ask him questions. In the mean season, even the King himself, and all they that were present with him, being exceedingly amazed to hear such great and strange things delivered, he turned to them and said; I swore truly unto you, that I should desire nothing so much in the world, as to see the Monarchy of this great Country, whereof I have heard such wonderful things▪ as well concerning the immense treasures, and the infinite number of ships which he hath; for could I but once do this, I should live very well contented the rest of my days. Thereupon having sent me, and those that accompanied me, away, he said unto me, When thou shalt think it a fit time, thou mayest bid the Father come unto me, for he shall find me ready here to receive him. After I was retired to my lodging. I gave Father Belquior an account of the King's good reception of me, together with all that had passed besides, Sect. 1. and how desirous he was to see him; in regard whereof I held it fit, since all the Portugals were then together, and in their best clothes, that he should go to him out of hand, which he liked very well of. Having furnished himself then with certain things necessary for the better setting forth of his person, he and I went away, accompanied with forty Portugals, all very well apparelled, and wearing chains of gold Scarfe-wise; and four pretty boys in cassocks, and hats of white taffeta, and silken crosses on their breasts, together with a converted japanois, Christened joana Fernandez, to serve for Interpreter. When we were arrived at the first Court of the King's Palace, we found some Lords attending us there, who with a great deal of courtesy and demonstrations of friendship brought the Father and me up to a chamber where the King stayed for him, who having taken him by the hand with a joyful countenance, said unto him; Believe me, Father, this day is the only one that I can call mine, in regard of the extreme pleasure I take to see thee before mine eyes, because, me thinks, I see Father Xavier, to whom I wished as well as to mine own person: Then leading him into another inner chamber, that was richlyer furnished, he set him down by him, and made very much of the four little Boys, for that it was a new thing to him, and never seen in that Country before. The Father rendered him thanks conformable to the great honour he did him, and after that manner which they are wont to use amongst themselves, and which joana Fernandez had taught him. After this, he entertained him with the principal cause of his coming, which was, that the Viceroy had sent him expressly to serve him, and to show him the assured way of salvation; which the King seemed to like of, by his action of bowing down of his head: The Father going on, made an holy speech somewhat like unto a Sermon unto him, agreeable to the business in hand; and which, he had directly studied for that purpose. Whereunto the King made this answer, Good Father, I know not how to express the great content which I take in seeing thee in this house, and in learning all that which my ears have heard thee say; which I do not answer for the present, in regard the affairs of my State are such, as thou mayest peradventure have heard: Wherefore, I earnestly entreat thee, since God hath brought thee hither, that thou wilt repose thee a while from the travel which thou hast endured for his service. And as for that which the Viceroy hath written to me, touching the business which I sent to him about by Antonio Ferreyra, I still avow it; but the Affairs of the present time, are reduced to that pass, as I am much afraid, if my subjects see any change in me, that they will approve of the Bonzoes' counsel; Besides, I make no question but the Christians which are here, have told thee the great danger I run in this Country, by reason of the mutinies that ●ave passed here, during the which, I have been in as great jeopardy as any other; so that for the safety of my person, I have been enforced to execute in one morning thirteen of the Principallest Lords of my Kingdom, together with sixteen thousand persons of their faction and league, besides as many more which I have banished. Bat if it ever happens, that God shall grant me that which my soul desires of him, I shall hold it a small matter, to consent to what the Viceroy advises me by his Letter. Hereunto, the Father replied, That he was greatly satisfied with his holy resolution; but he was to remember, that his life was not in the hands of men, because they were mortal; and that if he should chance to die before he effected it, what would then become of his soul? To which he answered smiling, God knows. The Father seeing that he could receive no other satisfaction from the King at that present but good words, without making any conclusion on a matter that was so important for him, dissembled with him, and changing discourse, talked to him of other things, wherein he knew he took more pleasure. So, having spent the most part of the night with the Father, in questioning him about divers novelties, whereunto he was much affected, he dismissed him in very plausible terms, with hope that he would become a Christian, but not so soon; a thing which was then well enough understood, and that sufficiently discovered his intention. The next day about two a clock in the afternone the Father went to see the King again, and setting aside his kind welcoming of him, this Prince never answeed him to purpose; and within a while after returned to his Fortress of Osquy, from whence he sent to desire him to continue abiding where he was, and to come some times and see him, for that he took extreme pleasure in talking with him of the great things of God, and perfection of his Law. In the mean space, above two months and an half past away, without giving in all that time any other fruit of himself, then certain kind of hopes, accompanied ever and anon with some excuses, which did not much content the Father: so that he thought it requisite for him to return to Goa, as well for the discharging of the duty of his charge there, as for many other reasons that moved him thereunto. Being resolved then for our departure, I went to the Fortress of Osquy to the King, to demand an answer of the Letter I brought him from the Viceroy of the Indias, which he presently gave me, having made it ready against my coming; and in exchange of the Present he had received, he sent him very rich Arms, together with two Scymitars garnished with gold, an hundred Ventiloes of the Country of the Lequios. In the Letter which he himself had written, were these words contained: Lord Viceroy of honourable Majesty, that art seated in the Throne of those which render justice by the power of the Sceptre: ay Yaretandono, King of Bungo, give thee to understand, that Ferdinand Mendez Pinto is come to me, with a Letter from thy Royal Lordship▪ and a present of Arms, and other pieces very agreeable to my desire, and which I very much esteem, for that they are of a Country in the other end of the world, which we call Chenchicogim, where through the power of great Armies, composed of divers Nations, reigns the Crowned Lion of Portugal, whose servant and subject I do by these presents declare myself to be: Wherefore I pray thee, that as long as the Sun shall not swerve from the effect for which God hath created him, nor the waters of the sea cease from rising and falling on the shores side, thou wilt not forget this homage, which hereby I make to your King, whom I acknowledge for my elder Brother; to the end, that thereby this my obedience may remain the more honourable, as I am confident it shall always be: And I desire thou wilt deign to accept of these Arms which I send thee, as a gage and assurance of my faith. From this my Fortress of Osquy, the ninth Mamocos of the third Moon, in the thirty and seventh year of our age. With this Letter, and his present I returned to our ship, which road at anchor some two leagues off in the Port of Zequa, where I found Father Belquior, and all the rest of our company, already embarked, and from thence we set sail the day after, being the fourteenth of November, One thousand five hundred fifty and six. CHAP. LXXXI. What past after our departure from Zequa, till my arrival in the Indias, and from thence into the Kingdom of Portugal. FRom this Port of Zequa we continued our course with Northerly winds, which were favourable unto us in this season, and on the fourth of December we arrived at the Port of Lampacau, where we met with six Portugal ships, whereof was General a certain Merchant, called Francisco Martinez, the creature of Francisco Barreto, at that time Governor of the State of the Indias in the place of Don Pedro Mascarenhas. And because that then the season for Navigation into India was almost past, our Captain Don Francisco Mascarenhas stayed no longer there then was necessary for providing of victual. We departed then from this Port of Lampacau a little before Christmas, and arrived at Goa the seventeenth of February. The first thing I did there was to go to Francisco Barreto, unto whom I gave an account of the Letter which I brought from the King of japan: but he having referred it to the day following, I failed not to deliver it to him the next morning, together with the Arms, the Scymitars, and the other Presents which that Pagan King had sent. Whereupon▪ after he had seen all at leisure, addressing himself unto me, I assure you, said he unto me, that I prise these Arms which you have brought me, as much as the Government of India: for I hope that by the means of this Present, and this Letter from the King of Japan, I shall render myself agreeable to the King our Sovereign Lord, that I shall be delivered from the fortune of Lisbon, where almost all of us that govern this State, do go and land for our sins. Then, in acknowledgement of this Voyage, and the great expense I had been at, he made me many large offers, which I would by no means accept of at that time: Nevertheless I was well contented to justify before him by attestations, and acts passed expressly for it, how many times I had been made a slave for the service of the King our Master; and how many times also I had been robbed of my Merchandise: for I imagined that this would suffice to keep me at my return into my Country, from being refused that, which I believed was due to me for my services; as indeed, the Viceroy past me an Act of all these things, adding thereunto the Certificates which I presented unto him: withal, he gave me a Letter, addressed to the King, wherein he made so honourable a mention of me and my Services, that relying on these hopes, grounded as they were on such apparent reasons as I had on my side, I embarked myself for to return into the Kingdom of Portugal; so contented with the Papers which I carried along with me, that I counted them the best part of my estate; at leastwise, I believed so, because I was persuaded that I should no sooner ask a recompense for so many services, but wont it be presently granted me. Upon this hope being put to sea, it pleased our Lord, that I arrived safely at the City of Lisbon, the two and twentieth day of September, in the Year One thousand five hundred fifty and eight, at such time as the Kingdom was governed by Madam KATHERINE, our Queen of happy memory. Having delivered her the Letter then from the Viceroy of the Indias, I told her by word of mouth all that I thought was important for the good of my business: whereupon she referred me to the Minister of her State, who had the charge of dealing in her Affairs: At first he gave me very good words, but far better hopes, as indeed I held them for most assured, hearing what he said unto me: But in stead of letting me see the effect thereof, he kept me these miserable papers of mine four years and an half, at the end of which, all the fruit I reaped thereby was no other, than the labour and pains which to no purpose I had employed in these vain solicitations, and which had been more grievous unto me, than all the troubles I had suffered during my voyages: Wherefore seeing of what little profit all my past services were unto me, notwithstanding all the suit I could make; I resolved to retire myself, and remain within the terms of my misery, which I had brought along with me, and gotten by the means of many misfortunes, which was all that was resting to me of the time and wealth which I had bestowed in the service of this Kingdom, leaving the judgement of this process to the divine Justice. I put this design of mine then in execution, not a little grieved that I had not done it sooner, because I might thereby peradventure have saved a good piece of money. For a conclusion, behold what the services have been which I have done for the space of one and twenty years, during which time, I was thirteen times a slave, and sold sixteen times, by reason of the unlucky events of so long and painful a voyage, whereof I have made mention amply enough in this Book. But although this be so, yet do I not leave to believe, that the cause why I remained without the recompense whereunto I pretended for so many services and travels, rather proceeded from the Divine providence, which permitted it to be so for my sins, then from the negligence and fault of him, whom the duty of his charge seemed to oblige to do me right. For it being true, that in all the Kings of this Kingdom who are the lively source from whence all recompense do ●low, though many times they ran thorough pipes more affectionate than reasonable, there is always found an holy and acknowledging zeal, accompanied with a very ample and great desire, not only to recompense those which serve them, but also to confer great estates on them which render them no service at all; whereby it is evident, that if I, and others, have not been satisfied, the same happens by the only fault of the pipes, and not of the source; or rather it is a work of the Divine Justice, which cannot fail, and which disposeth of all things for the best, and as i● most necessary for us; in regard whereof▪ I render infinite thanks to the King of Heaven, whose pleasure it hath been, that his divine will should be this way accomplished, and do not complain of the Kings of the earth, since my sin● have made me unworthy of meriting more. FINIS. ERRATA. PAg▪ 4. l. 17. read first Viceroy. p. 10. l. 36. r. victual and ammunition. p. 21. l. ult. r. of a Pagan. p. 60. l. ult. r. shrewd. p 77. l. 33. r. speech. p. 80. l. 30. r. lands aside. p. 83. l. 7. r. equalled. p. 95. l. 8. r. remorse of conscience. l. 49. for deserved, r. demanded. p. 100 l. 28. r. poor folks. p. 103. l. 33. for Ch●ucer r. Chau●●r. p. 104. l. 48. for as, r. us. p. 111. l. 20. r. picos o● silver p. 121. l. 10. for levied, r. lived. p. 123. l. 8. r. render. p. 124. l. 44. r. many light. p. 125. l. 3. r. canals. l. 12. r. praises. p. 127. l. 1●. r. conservation. p. 128. l. 19 r. allegations. p. 129. l. 1. for constrained, r. painted. p. 130. l. ●. r. standish. l. 17. for ye are, r. yea are. l. ●2. r. valuable. l. 40 r. who being able p. 132. l. ult. r. Paquin. p. 1●3. l. 19 r. ba●●sters. p▪ 13●▪ l. 30. r. Ushers. l. 44▪ for rightly r. richly. p. 136▪ l. 12. r. remarkable. l. 48. r. antiquity. p. 137. l. 10. r. P●a●●aes. l. 46. r. so extravagant. p. 138. l. 5. r. Exiles: l. 9 r▪ abutting on. p. 139. l. 1. r. plenary. p. 141. l. 23. r. arches or vaults. p. 142. l. 15. for entertained, r. ●nfolded. p. 144. l. 25. for love, r. loan. p. 149. l. 2● for stratagems r. strangeness. p. 150. l. 21. r. breaking. p. 155. l. 16. r. Nix●aticoo. p. 155. r▪ obliged to hold. p. 163. l. 13. r. at their pleasure▪ p. 241. l. 1. r. Timplan. l. 46. r. this Prince. l. 47 ●. leagues in breadth. p. 242. l. 21. r. reputation. p. 244. l. ult. for undivided, r. undiscovered. p. 248. l. 4●● r. sloghe. p. 243. r. savages.